You searched for social media - Crowd Content - Blog https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ Content Creation Advice You Can Actually Use Wed, 03 Jul 2024 09:05:55 +0000 en-CA hourly 1 The Complete Guide to Digital Marketing vs. Content Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/digital-marketing-vs-content-marketing/ Wed, 03 Jul 2024 09:05:54 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38336 Today’s business landscape is hyper-competitive, so modern marketers have their work cut out for them and then some. Digital interfaces, search engine algorithms, and consumer tastes are constantly changing, so there’s no guarantee that what worked well in the past will still work today, let alone in the future.  Fully understanding best practices when it […]

The post The Complete Guide to Digital Marketing vs. Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Today’s business landscape is hyper-competitive, so modern marketers have their work cut out for them and then some. Digital interfaces, search engine algorithms, and consumer tastes are constantly changing, so there’s no guarantee that what worked well in the past will still work today, let alone in the future. 

Fully understanding best practices when it comes to staple strategies like digital marketing and content marketing is a must. While digital marketing and content marketing definitely complement one another, they’re not the same concept, nor is one more important than the other. To get ahead in today’s fast-paced digital landscape and stay there, brands must master and combine both strategies.

In this comprehensive guide to digital marketing vs. content marketing, we’ll cover everything you need to know to do exactly that. We’ll touch on the differences between the two, the importance of each, and how you can leverage both to benefit your brand and ongoing marketing strategy.

What Are the Fundamental Differences Between Digital Marketing and Content Marketing?

Content marketing and digital marketing are both key approaches to marketing in the internet age. But they differ in their overall goals and the strategies a marketing pro might use to meet those goals. 

It’s also important to understand that content marketing is a type of digital marketing. So, while all content marketing is digital marketing, digital marketing covers much more potential ground. For that reason, you can have a digital marketing strategy without incorporating content marketing, but the reverse can’t be true.

Here’s an overview of some additional differences between the two:

  • Goals: Content marketing is about reaching a target audience via the creation and distribution of helpful, value-rich content. However, digital marketing collectively leverages many different marketing channels and techniques.
  • Strategies: Content marketing is largely focused on playing the long game by winning consumer trust, fostering strong brand-customer relationships, and empowering buyers to make better decisions. Digital marketing also leverages long-term strategies and approaches but incorporates short-term solutions into the mix to bolster sales.
  • Methodologies: Although both disciplines are ultimately about advertising, content marketing typically adopts a more subtle approach to reach consumers without making them feel like marketing targets. (Think blogs, podcasts, how-to guides, etc.) Digital marketing, on the other hand, can be more direct via solutions like pay-per-click (PPC) or social media advertising. 

Content marketing benefits

The benefits of including a solid approach to content marketing in your overall digital marketing strategy are numerous and include examples like the following:

  • It offers audiences a better overall user experience with your brand.
  • It helps you reach target audiences without alienating them via hard-sell tactics.
  • It’s cost-effective, as even professional solutions are often affordable and easy to scale.
  • It encourages existing and potential customers to engage with and advocate for your brand.
  • It helps foster brand loyalty and cultivate a sense of community associated with your brand.

Digital marketing benefits

And, of course, no modern approach to marketing can be considered complete without an essential ongoing digital marketing strategy in place. Here are the benefits digital marketing brings to the table for brands like yours:

  • The versatility of a marketer’s collective digital toolbox is near limitless, leaving room for plenty of creativity and possibility. 
  • It’s flexible, as go-to tactics and approaches are easy to adapt to a brand’s evolving needs over time.
  • It facilitates connection with a much larger audience and broader reach than you’d have without it.
  • It’s a solid way to boost lead generation and qualify those leads for further processing.
  • Results are trackable, measurable, and easy to analyze in real-time.

Why Incorporate Content Marketing into Your Strategy

Content marketing isn’t a mandatory part of your digital marketing strategy, but it is one that could be highly beneficial, especially in today’s marketing landscape. Modern audiences don’t like feeling blatantly sold to. They like buying from helpful brands that care about building customer relationships and providing exceptional value. 

Content marketing can help you achieve your marketing goals by:

  • Aligning your branding and business goals with audience needs and expectations
  • Boosting SEO efforts by providing search engine users with the helpful, in-depth content they’re looking for
  • Elevating conversion rates by earning and keeping the trust of your audience and customers
  • Providing structure and substance to support your branding efforts 
  • Complementing your social media efforts and encouraging a sense of community around your brand

Build a winning content marketing strategy that turns heads when you explore tailored strategy services from Crowd Content today! We’ve got the expertise and resources to make audiences sit up and take notice of your brand.

How Can Digital Marketing Enhance Content Marketing Efforts?

Even the most incredible content won’t make a winner out of your brand simply by existing. Dedicated digital marketing strategies and efforts help amplify the reach of your carefully crafted content and ensure it finds its intended audience. Here are some key examples of how:

  • Properly optimizing your content for search engines helps improve visibility and expand your website’s overall scope.
  • Using social media to help your content and brand message get around boosts engagement, generates sales leads, and helps prep curious consumers to one day become paying customers.
  • Advertising tactics like PPC and social media ads help get even more potential eyes on your content.
  • Email marketing and ongoing newsletter efforts can be effective outlets for fantastic content that gets results.
  • Digital marketing plays a role in setting your brand up as an industry authority.
  • Keeping track of digital marketing metrics as they relate to your marketing content helps you brainstorm increasingly more effective campaigns in the future.

Content optimization for SEO

Many modern purchase decisions start with a simple Google search. That search might be the consumer’s way of exploring what a specific type of product has to offer, but it could just as easily start with a simple question or two related to a problem they don’t even realize they have yet. 

Now, imagine that your content is what ultimately answers those questions. Those eager consumers will come to trust your brand as an authority on that topic and see your products or services as the solutions they’ve been looking for. But that will happen only if search engine users can find your content in the first place.

Content marketing and SEO go hand in hand in that they support one another beautifully. SEO ensures that users looking for content like yours can find and consume it, thanks to factors like high SERP rankings, readable formatting, and smart keyword use. Essential SEO practices that help optimize content and set it up for success include:

  • Keyword research: Smart keyword use helps your content align with both consumer pain points and search engine standards.
  • Metadata: Strong, fully optimized metadata, such as SEO titles, meta descriptions, and image alt text, improve visibility and overall user experience.
  • Relevant backlinks: Helpful internal and external links help users find answers to even more of their questions by providing easy access to supporting content on a given topic.
  • SEO-friendly formatting: Formatting is crucial to SEO success for your marketing content. Think keyword-optimized titles and headings, natural language, visual aids, and structuring that makes content easy to read and skim.
  • Regular updates: Google loves content that’s well curated and maintained, so adding regular content updates to your ongoing content strategy is a great way to ensure successful pieces continue to perform.
  • Professional services: Hiring trusted content marketing experts like the ones you’ll meet at Crowd Content can help take a given strategy from good to spectacular. Such services bring expertise and know-how to your campaigns that are affordable and scalable and can set your brand up for lasting success.

Integrating SEO with content marketing strategies is more than just a good idea. It’s a tried and true recipe for significantly improving the organic reach of your content, especially with seasoned professionals in your corner. 

For example, Crowd Content leveraged best SEO practices to help a leading commerce agency elevate its content marketing strategy and achieve page-one rankings for 57 target keywords. We accomplished this via a combination of optimization-focused methods, including assembling a team of ultra-qualified content writers to help produce content and aligning the agency’s content needs with top keywords and best SEO practices.

Leverage digital tools for content distribution

Digital marketing’s ability to influence the success of your marketing content doesn’t start and stop at search engine optimization. Digital tools like paid advertising interfaces, social media platforms, and additional content distribution channels are effective, convenient ways to take your content marketing efforts to the next level. 

For example, the right digital marketing platforms can help you distribute your content more effectively. Here are some key examples of how:

  • Like search engines, social media platforms like Facebook, X (formerly Twitter), Instagram, and TikTok are in the business of serving up helpful, entertaining content their users want to consume. This makes them solid channels for helping your content find a larger audience.
  • Partnering with industry thought leaders and social media influencers to help audiences connect with your content is another way to achieve wider distribution. Be sure to choose partners whose audiences overlap neatly with yours. Also, consider whether you want to join forces with bloggers, Instagram experts, TikTokers, etc.
  • Engaging with your audience across distribution platforms like your blog, newsletter, or favorite social media platforms helps inspire consumers to share your content with others and advocate for your brand.
  • You can maximize your reach by studying user metrics, assessing when your audience is most active, and scheduling your content distribution efforts accordingly. You can also use that data to understand your audience better and more accurately predict which content ideas resonate best with them.
  • Digital ads and PPC options are good for more than directly selling your products or services to appropriate consumers. They’re also excellent ways to gain more distribution for your best content offerings. 

Advanced Digital and Content Marketing Strategies

Fully understanding that both digital marketing and content marketing are key parts of any successful brand’s ongoing growth strategy is one thing. Successfully implementing a thorough system for maximizing both is another. Let’s go over a few advanced strategies for doing exactly that.

Master search engine optimization (SEO)

Crafting fantastic content no one can find isn’t going to do you much good when it comes to your marketing efforts, so mastering SEO should be a top priority. Conduct thorough keyword research and carefully choose competitive examples to target across your campaigns. 

Do supplementary research periodically to ensure the key phrases you’re targeting are still the right options for your brand. When it makes sense, target timelier keywords related to hot topics. Keep in mind that social media platforms have search functions and best SEO practices of their own. Research hashtags, trending topics, etc., and use them accordingly to make your content more visible.

Best for: Content marketing and digital marketing

Automate where it makes sense

Numerous tasks go into any digital marketing campaign, but only some truly require hands-on attention from a human team member. Many tasks are necessary but repetitive, making them an excellent fit for automation software. Possible examples include:

  • Email segmentation and content distribution
  • Lead nurturing via targeted content delivery
  • Lead scoring and qualification
  • Email personalization 
  • Landing page optimization
  • Data collection and pattern analysis

Best for: Digital marketing

Personalize, personalize, personalize

At this point, it’s pretty safe to say that hyper-relevant, personalized content experiences are no longer simply nice to have. They’re the new gold standard, and modern audiences expect the brands they do business with to measure up. 

When delivering content directly to a customer (as with newsletter marketing or trigger emails), make sure it’s as personalized as possible. Use the recipient’s name in your messaging, and ensure the content shown overlaps with their interests, preferences, or previous behavior. Regularly analyze customer data to develop a better understanding of what your audience wants and expects.

Be sure your content marketing efforts also cater to consumers at every stage of their buying journey. For example, consider which concerns people might have when first discovering a pain-point solution versus when they’re evaluating product options or almost ready to complete a sale. 

Best for: Digital marketing and content marketing

Supplement your efforts with paid advertising

If SEO is about playing the long game by building authority, earning top SERP rankings, and cultivating an audience in the first place, then paid advertising is about driving traffic in short but powerful boosts. Turn to solutions like pay-per-click Google Ads, Facebook advertising, and similar solutions to launch new products, promote special events, or help important content pieces gain more traction.

Additional solutions like sponsored posts can also be helpful additions to your marketing approach. Maximize your potential results by choosing partners carefully and ensuring their audience is the right fit for the content you plan to create. 

Best for: Content marketing and digital marketing

Maintain a comprehensive content calendar

Between your company blog, newsletter, email marketing blasts, social media feeds, etc., you have your work cut out for you as far as your ongoing content output is concerned. Keeping everything straight is no easy feat, but a thorough content calendar can help take the guesswork out of the process and keep things on track.

Use your calendar to organize and coordinate everything on your content to-do list, including which tasks are assigned to which team members. Plan production and deadlines as far in advance as possible to ensure you’re covered in case of scheduling snags or unforeseen emergencies.

Best for: Content marketing

Integrate AI into your marketing strategies

Artificial intelligence (AI) is everywhere these days, including digital marketing, and it can be an incredibly helpful resource. However, to keep quality and efficiency levels high, it’s crucial to know which tasks are a good fit for AI and which aren’t.

Try leveraging AI for digital or content marketing tasks like keyword research, customer behavior analysis, pattern identification, ad targeting, social listening, and customer segmentation. Leave tasks like creating important pillar content, thought leadership pieces, etc., to skilled human team members. Any AI-generated content you do use should be thoroughly edited, fact-checked, and polished by an experienced human editor before publication.

Best for: Content marketing and digital marketing

Deep Dive into Tools and Technologies

Having the right tools and tech applications in your corner can help you manage customer relationships, keep your website functional, and make short work of user data analysis. Let’s explore some of the most helpful, ubiquitous options that brands just like yours are using today.

CRM systems

Customer-brand relationships are everything when it comes to branding success these days, so it pays to take care of yours. Customer relationship management (CRM) systems help businesses boost customer retention rates, facilitate smoother communications, and make customer segmentation efforts significantly easier and more efficient. Examples include but are not limited to HubSpot, Zoho, and Salesforce.

Best for: Digital marketing 

Content management systems

Content management systems (CMS) provide effective, user-friendly ways to assist with content creation and organization. However, they also make it possible to deliver the right content to the right person at precisely the right time, enabling higher conversion rates and stronger brand-customer relationships. A good CMS also supports cost-effective scalability, smooth collaborations, and timely updates for existing content. Popular examples include WordPress, Wix, Drupal, and Joomla.

Best for: Content marketing and digital marketing

SEO tools

Comprehensive SEO tools like Ahrefs, SEMRush, and others help modern marketers make sense of adequately optimizing for Google and the rest of the search engines. Along with other benefits they bring to the table, they can assist with key concerns like brand awareness, user experience, organic traffic growth, authority-building, economic lead generation, and PPC success. The world of SEO tools is expansive and includes options to suit many different purposes, including additional popular examples like Google Analytics, Moz, SpyFu, Screaming Frog, and others.

Best for: Digital marketing and content marketing

Programmatic advertising platforms

Solutions like programmatic advertising platforms simplify the process of managing your collective catalog of digital ads via software and automation technology. The benefits of incorporating one into your ongoing marketing strategies include the ability to easily create data-driven ads. Top options can also support fraud detection, brand safety, ideal ad placement, format alignment, and overall campaign optimization. Examples include Adobe Advertising Cloud, AdRoll, MediaMath, and SmartyAds.

Best for: Digital marketing 

Evaluating the Integrated Impact of Digital and Content Marketing

Anytime you decide to change things up when it comes to your ongoing digital and content marketing strategies, it’s crucial to track and measure the success of each effort. This lets you know in real-time what’s working versus what’s not, making it possible to pivot and change tactics quickly and efficiently. Here are some factors to consider when assessing your various campaigns:

  • User data analysis gives you a window straight into the heads of your target audience. It lends insight into what people like, what they’re ignoring, what’s helping to convert leads,  when you should post new content, etc.
  • Competitive analysis lets you know where you stand in comparison to your competitors. Use what you learn to fill content gaps, address unmet audience needs, elevate your approach, and pull ahead of the pack.
  • Direct engagement with your audience is a reliable way to learn what your customers do and don’t like, straight from the source. You can leverage social media to do this by starting and facilitating ongoing conversations, as well as sending out surveys, requesting interviews, etc.

Numerous tools simplify the process of tracking and analyzing your marketing efforts, ranging from completely comprehensive to simple and niched. Popular examples include Google Analytics, HubSpot, SEMRush, and Facebook Insights.

Detailed metrics and KPIs for measuring success

Key performance indicators (KPIs) like conversion rates, bounce rates, and click-through rates are essential for assessing the success of any marketing strategy. However, which KPIs make the most sense for a campaign depends entirely on your goals. 

Here are a few to keep track of for digital marketing:

  • Website traffic: This metric is fundamental for any digital marketing effort. Be sure to not only assess overall traffic rates but also compare the sources of that traffic.
  • Click-through rate: Click-through rates help assess the effectiveness of your written copy and the relevancy of your targeting.
  • Conversion rate: This is one of the most important metrics for digital marketers, as it shines a light on how successful a campaign has been at turning leads into paying customers.
  • Bounce rate: High bounce rates can be a sign that visitors aren’t finding what they’re looking for when they hit your landing pages and suggest some tweaking might be in order.
  • Return on investment (ROI): This shows whether you’re getting back what you put into your campaigns as far as resources and to what degree. The higher the ROI, the more successful the campaign.

Most of the examples above also apply to content marketing. However, the following  KPIs are  used for tracking efficient content campaigns:

  • Backlinks: A link back to your content is like a vote of confidence for its quality. The more successful your efforts are, the more high-quality backlinks you will accumulate.
  • Social media engagement: Likes, comments, and shares are all signs that your content resonates as it should be with your target audience.
  • Subscriptions: Good content inspires people to follow you on social media, sign up for your newsletter, or take action to ensure they don’t miss future posts.

Sector-Specific Marketing Insights

Keep in mind that customization is the order of the day when it comes to successful digital and content marketing. Tailor your efforts according to your industry and target audience to ensure the ultimate success of your campaigns. Here are some examples.

  • Retail: Retail brands benefit from people-forward strategies that tap into various social trends, making tactics like influencer marketing, social media contests, and special events highly effective. Coordinated omnichannel marketing and trend-specific keyword research can also be helpful.
  • Healthcare: Audiences searching for healthcare services or information want fact-based solutions they can trust with the integrity of their health. Think top-tier content written by certified industry experts, in-depth research, relevant data or studies, etc. 
  • Technology: As with healthcare, tech-based services and products call for meaty content supported by data analysis, case studies, and detailed specs. Highly targeted, personalized digital marketing efforts and social proof can also be helpful here.

Case Studies: Successful Digital and Content Marketing Integrations

Want a closer look at how digital marketing and content marketing look in action when they’re well-integrated? Here are a couple of case studies from Crowd Content to help show you what’s possible. 

SEOPlus+

When award-winning marketing company SEOPlus+ first came to Crowd Content, they were looking to raise the bar when it came to EEAT-compliant niche content creation and increase conversion rates in the process. Thanks to a combination of authority content written by top-tier professional writers, full alignment with a robust SEO strategy, and easy scalability, SEOPlus+ was able to achieve an incredible average dwell time of six minutes.

FHEHealth

FHEHealth is a substance abuse and recovery institute that came to Crowd Content for help with SEO optimization and high-volume authority content production. By leveraging a combination of our platform’s content options, including managed content services, access to expert in-house writers, and infographic-related services, FHEHealth established a pattern of steady month-to-month organic traffic growth.

Build a Future-Proof Strategy Combining Digital and Content Marketing

Staying relevant and competitive in an ever-evolving digital world is about more than simply knowing what to do right now. It’s also about successfully future-proofing your strategy so you can stay ahead of the pack for years to come. Try the following tips and strategies:

  • User experience is a huge factor affecting the outcome of your branding, SEO, and customer retention efforts, and it will continue to be. Make it a top priority.
  • Save time and ensure resources go as far as possible by using automation to streamline content production and make short work of repetitive tasks.
  • Use digital analytics and market data to help predict future digital and content marketing trends. Be the first to the party when possible to ensure ongoing relevancy.
  • Keep your finger on the pulse of changing consumer expectations and use what you learn to inform ongoing marketing decisions.
  • Embrace tactics like social media engagement and user-generated content to make your customers part of your ongoing brand story and help them feel involved.

The Power of Combining Digital and Content Marketing

As you can see, the future of successful branding, customer connection, and conversion is about more than deciding whether digital marketing or content marketing is a better fit for you. It’s about mastering both, integrating the two, and customizing your approaches to suit your unique business goals and changing audience expectations.

Whether you’re looking to breathe fresh life into an existing marketing strategy or establish a new one that’s virtually guaranteed to succeed, Crowd Content has you covered with access to top writers, SEO resources, project management services, etc. Take your digital marketing efforts to the next level today with our expert SEO content services!

The post The Complete Guide to Digital Marketing vs. Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content Scaling Strategies to Amplify Your Content Production https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-scaling/ Wed, 03 Jul 2024 08:59:14 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38334 Attention spans are fleeting, and competition is fierce. Your content needs to be more than high-quality — it needs to be everywhere. But content scaling doesn’t mean churning out endless blog posts or flooding social media. It’s a strategic method for amplifying your message, reaching wider audiences, and driving tangible results without sacrificing quality. Consider […]

The post Content Scaling Strategies to Amplify Your Content Production appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Attention spans are fleeting, and competition is fierce. Your content needs to be more than high-quality — it needs to be everywhere. But content scaling doesn’t mean churning out endless blog posts or flooding social media. It’s a strategic method for amplifying your message, reaching wider audiences, and driving tangible results without sacrificing quality.

Consider this your ultimate guide to scaling content. We’re diving deep into strategies, tools, and real-world triumphs that will empower you to create content that resonates and dominates. AI-assisted brief creation, batch production, and content management systems are just the beginning. 

Prepare to break free from the mold and make your content unstoppable.

What Is Content Scaling?

Content scaling is the strategic process of amplifying your content so it reaches more people. Let’s look at two core concepts:

  • Multiplication: A single, well-crafted piece becomes the seed for a network of interconnected and repurposed content, maximizing its impact and longevity.
  • Diversity: Content scaling embraces the full spectrum of content formats — blog posts, social media snippets, videos, podcasts, and infographics — to engage different segments of your audience and keep them hooked.

Content scaling is the future of content creation. It’s a strategic, data-driven approach that empowers you to reach wider audiences, build stronger brand awareness, and drive meaningful results.

Why Is Content Scaling Important?

Let’s look at the benefits of scaling content output:

  • Expand reach: Scaling content allows you to reach a wider audience across various platforms and channels.
  • Build trust and authority: Consistently delivering high-quality, relevant content positions your brand as a trusted resource and thought leader in your industry. This essentially establishes your company as a go-to expert in your field — the one people turn to for advice and solutions.
  • Boost visibility: Optimizing your content for search engines can significantly improve your website’s ranking in search results, leading to increased organic traffic. Think of your website as a storefront on a busy street — a high ranking on search results is the equivalent of a prime spot on Main Street.
  • Generate leads: Compelling content acts as a magnet, drawing potential customers to your brand. Offer valuable information and insights to capture their interest and convert them into qualified leads.
  • Increase revenue: Content scaling drives tangible business results. Nurturing leads using targeted content throughout the customer journey accelerates conversions and boosts your bottom line.

Content scaling empowers you to connect with your audience on a deeper level, build brand loyalty, and ultimately drive sustainable growth. Work smarter, not harder, to amplify your message and achieve tangible business results. 

Leverage Scalable Content for Brand Amplification

Scalable content acts as a megaphone for your brand’s unique voice. Consistently deliver high-quality, relevant content across various channels to increase visibility and reinforce brand identity. Having a consistent presence solidifies your brand in the minds of consumers, making you the go-to source for information, products, or services. 

Still, beware of falling into the trap of producing quantity over quality. Losing the magic touch that made your content so engaging in the first place would be catastrophic. 

How to Maintain High-Quality Content at Scale

Scaling content must never mean sacrificing quality. Maintaining — or, ideally, elevating — your standards is pivotal for long-term success. Here’s how to create a content engine that seamlessly delivers quality and quantity:

  • Thorough intent and audience research
  • Quality briefs
  • QA, subject matter experts, and editors
  • Personalization
  • Clear expectations
  • Diverse content mix
  • A style guide

Thorough intent and audience research

Before writing a single word, learn about your audience’s needs, desires, and pain points. What questions do they ask? What information do they seek? This tells you about audience intent. Aligning content with intent ensures every piece resonates and delivers genuine value. Go beyond keyword research and think about connecting with your audience on a human level.

Quality briefs

A well-crafted brief is the blueprint for successfully scaled content. It sets clear expectations, outlines key messages, and provides direction for your content creators. Use your project brief to guide your team toward your goals and help them understand and capture audience intent. Invest time and maximize the use of technology to craft comprehensive briefs that leave no room for ambiguity.

QA, subject matter experts, and editors

Even the most talented content creators are prone to human error. That’s where quality assurance, subject matter experts, and editors come in. They’re a safety net to ensure content is error-free, factually accurate, and polished to perfection. Consider implementing a multi-step editing process, including automated checks and several layers of human review.

Personalization

Personalization is a marketing superpower. Tailor messaging to specific segments of your audience based on their interests, demographics, and stage in the buyer’s journey. Use dynamic content on your website, segment your email lists, and design ultra-personalized social media campaigns. Personalization should apply to audience segments — but you must also personalize content based on the platform you’re using. 

Clear expectations

When working with a team of content creators, establishing clear expectations and deadlines is essential. This helps everyone stay on track and ensures that projects are completed on time and to a high standard. Utilize project management tools to assign tasks, track progress, and maintain open communication.

Diverse content mix

Don’t rely on a single content format. Experiment with different types of content, such as blog posts, videos, podcasts, infographics, and social media posts. This not only keeps your audience engaged but also allows you to reach different segments of your target market that may prefer different formats.

A style guide

A style guide is a document that outlines your brand’s writing style, tone of voice, and formatting guidelines. It ensures that all your scaled content production is consistent and adheres to your brand’s standards, regardless of who created it. This is especially important when working with multiple content creators or outsourcing content creation.

Maintaining quality is paramount, but it doesn’t have to be a Herculean task. You can leverage tools and technologies to streamline the content scaling process without sacrificing an ounce of excellence.

Techniques and Tools That Enhance Content Scaling 

Ready to transform your content strategy into a well-oiled machine? These techniques and tools help you scale up content production, streamline your workflow, and maximize efficiency:

  • Content management systems
  • Batch content production
  • AI writing assistants 

Content management systems (CMSes)

Think of a CMS as your content’s air traffic control tower, orchestrating the seamless flow of information across your digital channels. It’s a centralized platform where you can:

  • Store all your content assets — blog posts, articles, images, videos — in one easily accessible location.
  • Enable your team to work together seamlessly, no matter where they are located. Say goodbye to endless email chains and version control nightmares.
  • Schedule posts in advance, manage revisions effortlessly, and track content performance with built-in analytics. Let the machines do the heavy lifting so you can focus on the big picture.
  • Implement search engine optimization best practices to amplify content to the right audience at the right time.

According to Alan Gleeson, CEO of Contento, 68% of the top 25 B2B SaaS companies in Ireland use WordPress as their CMS. While WordPress is a popular choice, research shows that options such as Contentful or Contento deliver a performance advantage in terms of site speed, which is a crucial factor for user experience and SEO.

Batch content production

If you’re overwhelmed by the sheer volume of content, batching is a productivity lifeline. Instead of jumping from task to task like a frantic squirrel, batch content production involves focusing on one specific type of content at a time.

This approach allows you to:

  • Enter a state of flow and complete tasks more quickly and efficiently.
  • Create a backlog of content, ensuring a steady stream of publications even when you’re juggling multiple projects.
  • Dive into the subject matter, research thoroughly, and craft your message with precision.

Many successful content creators swear by batch content production. For example, content marketing expert Clint Mally recommends creating multiple long-form pieces of content in a single week, then repurposing them into social media posts, email newsletters, and other formats. With this technique, you maximize the impact of your best content while saving time and energy.

AI writing assistants

Artificial intelligence isn’t here to steal your job; it’s here to streamline and enhance your workflow. Generative AI is a sophisticated tool that can:

  • Brainstorm new topics, headlines, and angles for content.
  • Analyze keywords, identify content gaps, and enhance your content’s discoverability.
  • Personalize your message to specific audiences based on their interests and demographics.

Technology is a powerful ally in your quest to scale content creation. From AI-powered brainstorming tools to templates, the right technology streamlines your workflow and enhances your creativity.

How Can Technology Help in Scaling Content Production?

Crafting top-notch content at scale isn’t a walk in the park. It takes time, creativity, and, typically, a whole lot of caffeine. The following tools are poised and ready to streamline your workflow, amplify your reach, and help you unleash your creative genius. 

ChatGPT

Ever dreamed of having a writing partner who never sleeps, never complains, and always has a thesaurus handy? Meet ChatGPT. 

Use it to:

  • Quickly generate first drafts of content briefs, blog posts, or social media captions.
  • Transform existing content into different formats, such as turning a blog post into a script for a short video.
  • Analyze keywords and suggest improvements to enhance your content’s discoverability.
  • Quickly create structured outlines and detailed briefs for your content team.

Pros of ChatGPT:

  • Increased efficiency: Drafts content quickly, freeing up your team’s time for other strategic tasks.
  • Versatility: Use it for various content types and formats.
  • Scalability: Helps you generate a high volume of content without sacrificing quality.

Cons of ChatGPT:

  • Requires human oversight: Always review and edit ChatGPT’s output to ensure accuracy and maintain your brand voice.
  • Potential for generic content: Often produces content that lacks originality and can require extensive additional refinement.
  • Ethical considerations: Be mindful of potential biases and limitations of AI-generated content.
  • Cost: Free for basic use, with paid plans offering more advanced features.

Crowd Content’s Templates 

Crowd Content’s content brief template and blog post templates enable you to consistently create content that’s structurally sound and visually appealing. Use them to:

  • Save time and mental energy by following a proven formula for content creation.
  • Ensure content aligns with your brand voice and messaging, creating a cohesive brand experience across all channels.
  • Glean expert tips and insights on how to craft content that captivates and converts. 

Pros of using CC templates:

  • Simplified content creation process: No more staring at a blank page, wondering where to start.
  • Improved content quality and consistency: Create content that adheres to your brand standards and resonates with your audience.
  • Cost: Free to use, making it a valuable resource for content creators of all levels.

Cons of using CC templates:

  • May not be suitable for all types of content or industries: Some customization might be necessary to adapt the templates to your specific needs.
  • Requires some level of knowledge and experience: While the templates provide a helpful framework, you still need to bring your own expertise and creativity to the table.

Be sure to conduct regular maintenance checks to keep your content machine well-oiled. Let’s explore the metrics that help you calculate the success of scaled content and ensure it’s making an impact.

How Do You Measure the Success of Scaled Content?

Here’s how to measure content performance:

  • Website traffic
  • Engagement metrics
  • Lead generation
  • Conversions

Website traffic

Are more people visiting your site? Are they lingering longer and browsing your pages with interest? Tools such as Google Analytics tell you which web pages are most popular and where visitors get lost or leave too soon.

Let’s say you run an online store selling eco-friendly products. Tracking website traffic might show a spike in visitors after you publish a blog post about sustainable living tips. This tells you that this type of content resonates with your audience and gets them onto your site.

Engagement metrics

Engagement metrics reveal whether users are actually getting value from your content. Are they reading, watching, listening, sharing, and commenting? Are they hooked on your every word, or do they tune out after the first few lines? Metrics such as time on page, bounce rate, social shares, and comments are real-time representations of how engaging your content is. 

Perhaps you create a series of videos demonstrating how to use your product. If viewers watch all the way through and leave positive comments, you know you’ve struck a chord.

Lead generation

Your content is a magnet for potential customers. Lead generation metrics tell you how many people are drawn to your brand. Are they subscribing to your newsletter, downloading your whitepaper, or filling out your contact form? Leads are the seeds of future sales, so nurturing them with valuable content is key.

Conversions

Conversions are the ultimate goal of any content marketing strategy. It’s the moment when a prospect raises their hand and says, “I’m in!” Whether it’s subscribing to your socials, making a purchase, signing up for a free trial, or requesting a demo, conversions are the proof that your content is performing as it should.

You’re practically an expert in scaling content by now. Let’s look at some real-world case studies of brands that successfully scaled their content efforts. 

Successful Content Scaling Examples

These brands didn’t just dip their toes into content scaling — they dove in headfirst and emerged victorious. Their brand stories offer valuable insights for anyone looking to amplify their content’s impact:

BoConcept

Here’s a glimpse at how Danish furniture brand BoConcept, enhanced content scaling using AI and centralized marketing.

The challenge: BoConcept faced the formidable task of creating and adapting marketing campaigns for numerous products, channels, sub-brands, markets, and languages. Local production agencies struggled to maintain consistency and meet the brand’s high standards.

The solution: BoConcept centralized its brand marketing efforts and partnered with an AI-powered agency to streamline content production. This allowed the brand to create master campaigns that could be scaled and localized across 64 different languages, ensuring consistent messaging and brand voice across all markets. An extraordinary level of accessibility and global inclusivity are two of AI and content scaling’s true superpowers, helping brands reach customers around the world. 

Paris Mechanical

Let’s look at HVAC company Paris Mechanical’s approach to scaling up using AI and automation

The challenge: Paris Mechanical was experiencing rapid growth but struggling to keep up with the increasing demand for services. Its sales and marketing processes were largely manual, leading to bottlenecks and missed opportunities.

The solution: Paris Mechanical partnered with a consulting firm specializing in AI and automation to develop a scalable marketing strategy. It implemented a suite of tools, including HubSpot Marketing Hub, Unbounce, and Google Ads, to automate lead generation, capture, and nurturing. What’s more, it tapped into the power of AI tools to generate personalized content and streamline the quoting process.

What Strategies Can Manage Increased Content Volumes?

With great content comes great responsibility. As output ramps up, you need a strategy to keep scaled content organized, efficient, and aligned with your goals. 

Here’s your roadmap to content scaling success:

  1. Assemble a strong content team
  2. Craft a content calendar 
  3. Streamline your workflow
  4. Integrate into existing campaigns

1. Assemble a strong content team

Assemble a strong team of content specialists, each with their own unique skills and expertise, including:

  • Content strategists: The masterminds behind the overall content vision and direction.
  • Writers: The wordsmiths who bring your ideas to life with captivating prose that sings with your brand voice.
  • SMEs: The frontline industry experts who edit for technical accuracy and enhance your content’s authority.
  • Editors: The grammar stalwarts who ensure content is polished and error-free.
  • Designers: The visual wizards who create eye-catching graphics and layouts.
  • SEO specialists: The search engine whisperers who optimize your content for maximum visibility.
  • Social media managers: The social butterflies who amplify your content across various platforms.

2. Craft a content calendar 

content calendar is a visual representation of your planned content, including:

  • Topics: What are you going to write, record, or film about?
  • Formats: Will it be a blog post, video, infographic, or something else?
  • Channels: Where will you publish and promote your content?
  • Deadlines: When will each piece of content be ready?

3. Streamline your workflow

Streamline your workflow by:

  • Automating repetitive tasks such as scheduling social media posts, sending email newsletters, and delivering analytics reports.
  • Creating reusable templates for different content types to save time and maintain consistency.
  • Using project management tools to track progress, assign tasks, and collaborate with team members seamlessly.

4. Integrate into existing campaigns

Integrate content into your broader marketing campaigns to maximize its impact. This means:

  • Sharing it across your social media channels, email newsletters, and other marketing channels.
  • Repurposing your blog posts into videos, podcasts, and shareable infographics to reach different audiences.
  • Using content as a way to guide potential customers through the buying journey.
  • Creating a cohesive and powerful brand narrative that resonates with your audience, building a community and driving them toward action.

Content Scaling Limitations and How to Address Them

Scaling content isn’t always a smooth ride. There are a few bumps in the road you might encounter along the way. But don’t worry. With a little foresight and strategic planning, you can overcome these challenges and keep your content engine purring:

  • Maintain quality at scale: As output increases, it can be tempting to cut corners to save time and resources. However, this is a recipe for disaster. Quality should always be your top priority. To maintain high standards, invest in skilled content creators, implement rigorous editing processes, and use tools to automate time-consuming tasks.
  • Avoid content fatigue: Publishing a large volume of content doesn’t guarantee engagement. If your content becomes repetitive or irrelevant, audiences tune out. To avoid content fatigue, create diverse content that appeals to different segments of your audience. Experiment with new formats, topics, and angles to keep things fresh and engaging.
  • Measure ROI: Content scaling requires an investment of time, money, and resources. Make sure you track ROI carefully to ensure your efforts are paying off. Use analytic tools from Google and social media to measure your content’s impact on engagement metrics such as website traffic, time on page, and conversion rate.
  • Adapt to algorithm changes: Social media algorithms are constantly evolving, and that can impact your content’s visibility and reach. Stay up-to-date on the latest changes and adjust your strategy accordingly. Experiment with different posting times, formats, and content types to find what works best for your audience.
  • Stay ahead of the competition: The content landscape is constantly evolving. To stay ahead of the curve, you must constantly learn and adapt. Follow industry trends, experiment with new technologies, and keep an eye on what your competitors are doing.

Proactively addressing these challenges ensures your content scaling efforts are sustainable and aligned with your business goals. 

See How to Scale Your Content Now

If content scaling sounds like a lot of effort and expense, that’s because it is. Even large brands with huge marketing budgets can struggle to manage each step of the process in-house. Let’s look at the pros and cons of outsourcing versus in-house content scaling. 

The Creation Process: In-House versus Outsourcing Scalable Content

Should you build your content team in-house or outsource to the pros? There’s no one-size-fits-all answer. The best approach depends on your specific needs, budget, and existing resources.

First, let’s explore the pros and cons of in-house content scaling:

  • Pros: More control and the ability to iterate and experiment quickly if you have an existing in-house content team.
  • Cons: It’s extremely expensive and time-consuming to build a team of skilled strategists, content creators, editors, quality assessors, AI experts, and SMEs from scratch.

Now, let’s study the pros and cons of outsourcing content scaling:

  • Pros: Access to a wide pool of talent and expertise, making it a cost-effective solution for businesses. Outsourcing also offers the flexibility to scale up or down as needed.
  • Cons: Less control over the creative process and potential for communication challenges.

Many businesses opt for a hybrid approach, combining in-house expertise with the flexibility and scalability of outsourcing. This allows them to leverage the strengths of both models while mitigating the weaknesses.

For guidance on how to find the right content creators for your needs, check out our article: How to Find Content Creators [LINK TO FORTHCOMING ARTICLE].

Your Content Scaling Strategy

Content scaling is a marathon, not a sprint. It requires a strategic mindset and a relentless commitment to quality. Following the strategies and using the tools outlined in this guide will get you on your way to creating a powerful content engine that drives results, fosters brand loyalty, and propels your business to new heights. 

Always keep in mind that increasing quantity must never compromise quality. Prioritize providing helpful, insightful, and actionable content that exceeds your audience’s expectations.

Don’t just take our word for it. Go forth and experiment. Test different approaches, track your results, and refine your strategy over time.

The post Content Scaling Strategies to Amplify Your Content Production appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Find Your Audience Using Simple Steps for Big Results (With Examples) https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-find-your-audience-using-simple-steps-for-big-results-with-examples/ Wed, 03 Jul 2024 08:52:35 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38332 Effective marketing hinges on knowing how to find your audience. Demographics such as age or location are just the beginning. To build a brand community, you must understand the ideal buyer’s deepest fears and aspirations. What are their challenges? How do they see themselves? Where do they turn for information and inspiration online? Customer data […]

The post How to Find Your Audience Using Simple Steps for Big Results (With Examples) appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Effective marketing hinges on knowing how to find your audience. Demographics such as age or location are just the beginning. To build a brand community, you must understand the ideal buyer’s deepest fears and aspirations. What are their challenges? How do they see themselves? Where do they turn for information and inspiration online?

Customer data is a codebreaker for pinpointing your ideal audience. Demographic analysis, behavioral insights, engagement KPIs, and consumer feedback serve as marketing encryption keys. 

This comprehensive guide will teach you how to locate a brand’s target audience. It unpacks the tools and strategies needed to find those who will benefit most from buying a product or service.

Why Is It Important to Know Your Target Audience in Marketing?

Knowing your audience is the difference between marketing campaigns that fizzle out and those that yield results.

Let’s explore why relentless audience targeting marketing strategies are so important, along with some examples of how they work:

  • Improved engagement: When you know your audience, you can craft content that deeply resonates with their interests, pain points, and values. In turn, they’re more likely to comment, share, and keep coming back for more. For example, a yoga studio knows its audience cares deeply about wellness and stress relief. Its social media posts highlight mindfulness tips and the benefits of yoga to mental health, leading to high engagement.
  • Higher conversion rates: Targeted marketing ensures your products, services, and messages reach the people most likely to buy. For example, a company selling eco-friendly cleaning products targets ads to members of environmentally conscious subreddits. Ads reach customers poised to use its products, increasing clicks and sales.
  • Optimized marketing budget: Detailed audience targeting cuts wasted spending. For example, rather than paying for a generic billboard on a busy highway, a local restaurant uses social media ads to target people within a 5-mile radius with a lunchtime meal deal.
  • Strengthened brand message: When you know who you’re talking to, you can tailor your brand voice, tone, and visuals for maximum impact. For example, an athletic apparel brand targeting younger, active customers uses vibrant colors and energetic imagery, while a luxury brand aims for a sophisticated, minimalist aesthetic.

Understanding your target audience is the bedrock of effective marketing. Without this knowledge, you’re essentially throwing darts blindfolded. You might get lucky occasionally, but most efforts will miss the mark.

How Do You Identify Your Audience?

Identifying your target audience takes a combination of research, analysis, and creative thinking. Here are the essential steps to get started:

  1. Start with your product or service
  2. Analyze existing customers
  3. Scrutinize the competition
  4. Leverage audience research tools
  5. Conduct direct research

1. Start with your product or service

The secret to identifying your audience lies in knowing the core problem your brand solves. 

Here’s an insight from Rick Leach, our VP of Content Operations:

“Have a clear idea of the problem, who has it, and how you solve it better than anyone else. Profoundly understand the audience intent for that problem and know exactly where it intersects with your objectives. Be as specific as possible and test, test, test. Leverage content marketing and analytics to put your theories to the test and definitively see whether you’re targeting the ideal persona.”

Create promo material for each buyer persona, using PPC and social media ads to target them where they already hang out online. 

2. Analyze existing customers

If you have a customer base, there’s a gold mine of information at your fingertips. Analyzing existing customers reveals common characteristics and behaviors of people who gravitate toward your brand.

Consider these key areas:

Core demographics: Age, location, income, and job title. Seemingly basic details can paint a detailed picture. Are your customers young professionals in urban areas or retirees living in suburbia? For urban, young professionals, short-form content on trend-driven platforms such as TikTok or YouTube Shorts would be better. Posting long-form videos in Facebook Groups or on YouTube will resonate more with suburban retirees. 

Online behavior: What websites do your customers visit other than yours? Do they engage most with articles, videos, or infographics? What social media platforms are they active on? Knowing which demographic favors which platform is a critical step. Are there common values, opinions, or preferences your customers share? Being aware of these behavioral insights helps you create content that resonates deeply, inspiring engagement and loyalty.

Purchase history: Don’t just look at what your customers buy from you. Explore further by getting to know their broader purchasing habits. This reveals more about their needs and interests, helping you create content that targets their lifestyles and preferences

3. Scrutinize the competition

Your competitors are a treasure trove of information, especially if you don’t have your own audience yet. Their social media pages are chock-full of actionable insights into your prospective buyers. This includes demographic data, behavioral insights, and purchase history. 

Find competitors with brands as similar to yours as possible. First, study posts with the most likes, shares, and comments. Note the design, copy, and CTAs. How do these posts drive engagement? What problems do they solve? Pay close attention and take inspiration, but don’t copy. You have to deliver something fresh and uniquely on-brand to stand out to your audience — and to social media’s algorithms.

Next, identify weaknesses in your competitors’ approach. These gaps are opportunities. Use them to stand out and capture a portion of the market your competitors have overlooked.

4. Leverage audience research tools

Audience research tools offer an inside scoop on the types of people who are interested in your business. Still, don’t get overwhelmed by fancy tools. Google Analytics and social media analytics provide valuable data to get you started. As your budget and market knowledge grows, consider investing in more advanced research options.

5. Conduct direct research

Sometimes, the best way to understand your ideal customer is by simply asking. Here are two straightforward methods that provide invaluable direct feedback:

  • Surveys: Using online survey tools such as SurveyMonkey and Google Forms are an easy way to gather insights from current and potential customers. Keep them brief, offer a fun incentive, and ask specific questions that speak to your audience’s pain points and preferences.
  • Interviews: Have in-depth conversations with a few carefully selected people who fit your ideal customer profile. Ask open-ended questions about their challenges, why they chose your brand, and what influences their buying decisions. Individual interviews provide wonderfully rich insights that even the best surveys miss.

Direct research is all about asking relevant questions and targeting the right people to draw out truly useful feedback. 

What Are Four Key Ways to Identify a Target Audience?

Here are four techniques for identifying the exact customers who will champion your brand:

  • Demographic analysis
  • Behavioral data
  • Engagement metrics
  • Consumer feedback

Demographic analysis

Demographic analysis is the foundational audience identification technique. This includes researching factors such as:

  • Age: Needs and communication styles differ vastly across generations.
  • Location: Urban, suburban, and rural customers have different priorities and access to resources.
  • Income: Messaging and pricing should be tailored based on income level.

Behavioral data

Analyze who interacts with your website, social media, and content to build upon demographic data. Look for consistencies in:

  • Websites they visit: Go beyond what they purchase from you. Noticing that your customers frequently visit fitness forums suggests an opportunity to partner with fitness influencers or take a health and wellness angle in blogs and social media posts.
  • Products they view or purchase: Identify patterns in their shopping habits. A customer who frequently buys baby clothes is easy to retarget once you know what they’re buying. You also know they’ll be receptive to deals on toys or children’s furniture in the near future.
  • How they interact with your brand: If customers regularly share blog posts, they likely care about information and thought leadership. Use this as a sign to develop more content-driven marketing campaigns.

Engagement metrics

Engagement metrics reveal how deeply your content resonates with your audience, enabling you to focus on: 

  • Social media shares: Content that gets shared widely tends to spark an emotional response, whether it’s humor, inspiration, or an opinionated reaction. Analyze the most successful posts to understand your audience’s emotional preferences.
  • Comments and questions: Recurring themes show pain points and what people truly care about. Numerous comments asking about a product’s environmental impact indicate that it’s a major concern for your customers. This type of insight is crucial for creating audience profiles.
  • Website dwell time: Short visits might mean people aren’t finding what they need due to confusing navigation or slow loading times. Low dwell times might also suggest that your content isn’t engaging. This is a strong indication that you need to conduct deeper research into your audience and tailor your content accordingly. 

Consumer Feedback

Say you’re up and running with a steady customer base — that doesn’t mean you’re safe. Just like the business landscape, audience segments are constantly in flux. People age, their values evolve, and purchasing behaviors change. Keeping up with customer feedback is the only way to ensure your audience profiles are fresh and relevant. 

Effective ways to gather direct consumer feedback include:

  • Surveys: Use surveys to learn about changing priorities, new pain points, and emerging preferences within your customer base. Let’s say initial product-related results are replaced by broader concerns about environmental impact or social responsibility. This suggests a growing eco-conscious segment within your audience that deserves tailored messaging and possible product adjustments.
  • Reviews: Pay attention to the specific words and sentiment expressed in reviews. Perhaps reviews start regularly mentioning a “quick and easy setup.” Congrats! You’ve located a distinct audience segment you weren’t initially targeting. These customers are showing a preference for simplicity that should be reflected in future marketing efforts.
  • Customer support interactions: Recurring questions and frustrations can indicate misaligned expectations. For example, confusion about shipping options could reflect a disconnect between your marketing materials and the reality of the purchase process. This price-sensitive segment will respond well to free shipping over a certain threshold.

Existing customers are a microcosm of your broader market. Shifts in their needs and language offer clues about new audience segments to pursue. They also showcase untapped ways to refine your messaging to keep existing customers loyal in the face of evolving preferences. 

Create Blog Posts That Pinpoint and Engage Your Target Audience

Case Studies: Successful Audience Identification

Let’s analyze two real-world examples where pinpointing the right audience led to remarkable marketing success.

Dove

The early 2000s beauty industry largely catered to a narrow ideal, i.e., young, thin, and conventionally beautiful women. Dove predicted and spearheaded a more inclusive and realistic approach to beauty advertising. In-depth market research uncovered a deep dissatisfaction among women, with only 2% describing themselves as beautiful.

Dove’s Real Beauty campaign boldly challenged industry norms. The brand featured women of diverse ages, body types, and ethnicities in its ads. These ads showcased the real-life beauty of unairbrushed bodies. The campaign’s focus on self-acceptance and redefining beauty on your own terms resonated powerfully with its target audience.

The campaign had a stratospheric impact:

  • Sparked a global conversation: The Real Beauty campaign went viral, sparking important discussions about body positivity and the harmful impact of unrealistic beauty standards. It changed the landscape of beauty marketing and strengthened Dove’s brand identity globally.
  • Increased brand loyalty: Dove’s focus on championing real women helped build trust and fostered a loyal customer base over competitors that maintained outdated marketing approaches.
  • Inspired long-term growth: Dove saw continued growth throughout the Real Beauty era, demonstrating that a focus on solving customers’ pain points can have profound results.

Audiences yearn to feel seen and understood. Reflecting customers’ real-world concerns created a sustaining competitive advantage for Dove. 

Gymshark

Traditionally, the gym apparel market catered to elite athletes, with a focus on peak performance. In 2012, Gymshark founder Ben Francis noticed that a massive, underserved segment of fitness enthusiasts existed. These individuals were passionate about their workouts but didn’t want high-performance gear. Instead, they sought streetwear apparel that reflected their gym-focused lifestyle, prioritizing style and functionality.

Gymshark’s strategy was built on a deep understanding of its audience. Its strategies included:

  • Influencer marketing: Gymshark paved the way in influencer marketing. It bypassed traditional athlete endorsements, instead partnering with micro-influencers who embodied the brand’s values. Early collaborations with YouTubers such as Lex Griffin and Chris Lavado established credibility within the brand’s target audience.
  • Social community building: Gymshark doesn’t just sell products — it fosters a sense of belonging using platforms such as Instagram. Encouraging user-generated content builds camaraderie between community members, and its multiple IG accounts are hubs for shared fitness experiences and support.
  • Fashion and function: Gymshark knew its audience wanted workout apparel that performs and reflects their dedication to fitness as a lifestyle. Focusing on function and aesthetics helped it fill a clear gap in the market.

In terms of impact, the numbers speak for themselves:

  • Rapid growth: Gymshark’s audience-centric approach led to exceptional growth, with annual revenue exceeding $500 million as of 2023.
  • Loyal following: Its dedicated online community drives continued growth through word-of-mouth and a strong sense of brand identity. This loyalty sets them apart from competitors, with around 7 million followers on Instagram.
  • Disruptive innovation: Gymshark proved that understanding your audience deeply, even in a saturated industry, can disrupt the status quo.

Gymshark has excelled by building a brand that reflects its audience’s values, passions, and desire for a sense of community.

What Tools Help With Audience Analysis?

Using analytics for audience discovery involves turning raw data into actionable insights. Here are some useful ideas to get you started:

  • Google Analytics
  • Instagram Insights
  • YouTube Analytics
  • SurveyMonkey
  • Nielsen

Google Analytics

Google Analytics is the powerhouse of free web analytics. It tracks basic demographics, how people find your site, and what they do once they’re there.

Pros: Free, robust, integrates with other Google products.

Cons: Can be complex for beginners and focuses only on your website data.

Best for: Understanding website traffic patterns, audience demographics, and conversion tracking.

Instagram Insights 

If you have a business profile on Instagram, you have access to built-in analytics. Analyze your follower demographics, their interests, when they’re most active, and which of your posts get the most engagement.

Pros: Free to use, shows you exactly who your Instagram followers are, and helps you track growth over time.

Cons: Data is limited to Instagram, and some metrics might be less accurate if you have a smaller follower count.

Best for: Identifying the ideal person who follows your Instagram, crafting the kind of content they’ll love, and knowing the best times to post for maximum reach.

YouTube Analytics

Dig into the performance of your YouTube channel. See viewership patterns, what parts of your videos people rewatch (or skip), and where your viewers are coming from.

Pros: Free. Shows you how long people watch your videos, which parts they rewatch and skip, and where your traffic comes from.

Cons: Provides insights about your YouTube channel specifically, not a broader picture of the market.

Best for: Figuring out the optimal length for your videos, refining content topics that resonate best, and discovering ideal days and times to publish new videos.

SurveyMonkey

Design and distribute custom surveys to go straight to the source — your target audience! Ask the questions that matter most: motivations, buying preferences, pain points, and more.

Pros: Allows for flexibility in the questions you ask and provides detailed insights into the gathered responses.

Cons: Getting meaningful data requires careful survey design to avoid bias. The free version also has limitations on features and the number of survey responses. Paid plans start at around $35 per month.

Best for: Gathering customer feedback about your products or services, conducting market research to understand what people want, and identifying the pain points that drive purchase decisions.

Nielsen

Access a huge repository of consumer research data and market reports. Nielsen holds the keys to industry trends and how to meaningfully segment your audience.

Pros: Data is reliable, and the platform has robust audience segmentation benefits built in.

Cons: Services are very expensive and often require a subscription. Additionally, the sheer volume of data may be overwhelming for small businesses.

Best for: Big-picture market analysis, validating the potential of a new product or service idea before launch, and getting a detailed grasp of competitors’ strategies.

How Can You Use Demographics to Identify Your Audience?

Age, location, and income are demographic clues about how to reach your target audience effectively. The better you get to know your current audience, the easier it will be to refine content so it attracts more like-minded folks. 

Here’s how to make demographics work for you:

  • Beyond the basics: Age and gender are starting points, but not the whole story. Dig deeper. Are they homeowners? College grads? Knowing their life stage paints a clearer picture.
  • Uncover pain points: Demographics hint at struggles. Retirees might worry about healthcare costs; young professionals might worry about student debt. Let solving those problems become your selling points.
  • Speak their language: Messaging that resonates with a 25-year-old microinfluencer living in Los Angeles won’t land with a 55-year-old doctor in Wyoming. Tailor your tone and focus based on the demographic segments that interact most with your brand.
  • Smart targeting: Knowing where your audience hangs out is vital. For instance, young parents might be on parenting forums, while affluent retirees are on luxury travel sites. Use demographics to inform your ad placement.

How Do You Create a Detailed Audience Profile?

Generic audience profiles lead to generic marketing — the kind that blends into the endless stream of content your customers are bombarded with daily. Here’s how to go beyond the usual data points and uncover those hidden insights:

  1. Identify your marketing goals: Are you aiming to increase sales, build brand awareness, or launch a new product? Being clear on your objectives informs the type of audience data you need to prioritize.
  2. Gather data from as many sources as possible: Tap into a variety of sources to uncover a complete picture of your audience.
  3. Analyze demographic data analysis for precise marketing: Access this type of data through website analytics, targeted customer surveys, and industry-specific market research reports.
  4. Explore psychographic segmentation techniques: Get into the mindset of your audience using psychographic analysis. What are their underlying values, passions, daily challenges, and lifestyle patterns? Discover these insights through social media listening, analyzing competitors, and observing discussions in niche online forums.
  5. Track online behavior and note patterns: Analyze the websites they frequent, the social media platforms they prefer, and the keywords they use when searching for solutions.
  6. Collect direct feedback and research reviews: Design thoughtful surveys, conduct in-depth customer interviews, and meticulously analyze positive and negative reviews.
  7. Spot trends and segment your audience further: As you analyze the collected data, look for recurring patterns and similarities. Group your audience into distinct segments based on shared characteristics, problems, and desires.
  8. Craft detailed personas of each segment: The importance of customer personas in marketing can’t be overstated. For each audience segment, craft a detailed persona, envisioning them as a fully formed individual. Give them a name, a backstory, and specific interests, and outline their typical day-to-day challenges.
  9. Maintain and update profiles: Continuously monitor data, track emerging trends, and refine your profiles to ensure your marketing strategies remain aligned with your customer base’s changing needs.

How Do I Find My Social Media Audience?

Your ideal audience is already on social media, having conversations, sharing their interests, and seeking solutions. Here’s how to find social media insights for audience profiling:

  • Competitor analysis
  • Hashtag tracking
  • Strategic searches
  • Sentiment analysis

Competitor analysis

Use competitive analysis to study your competitors’ most successful posts, focusing on engagement metrics and content style. This will give you a strong understanding of what resonates with your shared target audience.

Hashtag tracking

Monitor hashtags and keywords relevant to your industry or niche. This helps you identify common pain points and questions potential customers express, as well as the type of content they enjoy and share. For example, do they prefer memes, videos, or infographics? Explore niche communities on places such as Quora and Reddit where your ideal customers congregate.

Strategic searches

Seek out posts on social media where people ask for recommendations in your product or service area. Become part of the conversation by giving them helpful suggestions. Keep track of keywords related to the problems your product solves, uncovering potential customers actively seeking solutions.

Sentiment analysis

Track the overall tone of comments on your and your competitors’ posts. This helps you tailor your messaging to match your audience’s emotional state, increasing the chances of resonating with them on a deeper level.

Build Your Audience with a Tailored Content Strategy

The Strategic Advantage of Knowing Your Audience

Audience knowledge isn’t a static set of data points; it’s an evolving relationship. And the advantages of audience analysis in content creation are clear to see. Knowing your audience means creating content that seamlessly meets their needs and solves their problems. 

Stay curious, monitor trends, and use every tool at your disposal to continually refine audience profiles. Businesses that prioritize their audience enjoy more sustainable growth and enduring brand success.

The post How to Find Your Audience Using Simple Steps for Big Results (With Examples) appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Create a Landing Page That Converts https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-create-a-landing-page-that-converts/ Wed, 03 Jul 2024 08:45:09 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38330 A landing page is a powerful marketing tool designed to lead and drive conversions. Its primary function sets it apart from other web pages. Designed to be streamlined and persuasive, landing pages eliminate distractions — like navigation and other menus — to guide users toward a desired action. Landing pages get their name from their […]

The post How to Create a Landing Page That Converts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
A landing page is a powerful marketing tool designed to lead and drive conversions. Its primary function sets it apart from other web pages. Designed to be streamlined and persuasive, landing pages eliminate distractions — like navigation and other menus — to guide users toward a desired action.

Landing pages get their name from their role as the page a visitor “lands” on after clicking a link or ad from another source, such as an email marketing campaign, social media post, search engine result, or online ad. They serve one purpose: converting visitors into customers or leads. 

Ready to create a high-converting landing page? Below, we’ll tell you how.

What Is a Landing Page?

A landing page has many names. Whether you call it a lead capture page, a static page, a squeeze page, or a destination page, you’re talking about the same thing: a standalone web page designed specifically to encourage visitors to take an action as a result of a marketing or advertising campaign. 

A typical website has multiple pages, sub-pages, and sections that visitors can navigate to, often from the homepage. A landing page is different because it is a standalone web page that’s excluded from a website’s navigation. 

A customer won’t just stumble across a landing page. They can only find it by entering your sales funnel through targeted efforts such as email campaigns, social media posts, search engine results, or online advertisements. 

Landing pages are purposefully minimal, focusing only on the main call to action (CTA), like a sign-up page or a purchase button. By eliminating navigation and focusing solely on a conversion goal, landing pages streamline the user experience and guide visitors toward completing the intended action.

The Purpose and Types of Landing Pages

A marketing strategy can incorporate landing pages in a variety of ways. 

  1. Lead generation: These landing pages offer something of value such as an e-book, webinar access, or a free trial in exchange for the visitor’s contact information, which allows you to nurture them in the future. 
  2. Click-through: A clickable headline, for instance, gets visitors to click through to another page where the actual conversion will take place.
  3. Product launch or promotion: Create landing pages to build anticipation or generate buzz. Collect pre-orders or registrations for a new product or service. Get visitors to sign up for a newsletter.
  4. Event registration: As people click around on an event page, they are funneled to another page where they can buy tickets or register.
  5. Contests or giveaways: An exciting prize encourages participants to enter, leaving their contact information for future marketing purposes.
Graphic detailing the purpose and types of landing pages including lead generation, click-through, event registration, and contests.

Are Landing Pages Still a Thing?

Yes, landing pages are still a highly effective tool! You probably encounter landing pages all the time without even knowing it, especially if they’re well-designed. 

Despite the many new marketing channels and technologies in today’s world, landing pages remain a powerful tool for meeting marketing goals. The laser-focused, campaign-specific nature of landing pages continues to make them valuable.

How Do I Know If I Need a Landing Page?

Use a landing page in situations where you want to drive a specific action or conversion from your target audience.

Here’s a checklist to help decide whether creating a landing page is the right approach:

  • Do you have a specific marketing campaign, promotion, or offer to run? A dedicated landing page can help you laser-focus the user experience to ensure that visitors are directed towards the intended goal without distractions.
  • Are you driving visitors toward a single targeted action or conversion? A landing page eliminates distractions and guides users toward that goal, which increases the likelihood of conversion.
  • Are you running paid advertising campaigns? Landing pages are ideal for optimizing post-click conversion rates to make your advertising efforts more effective.
  • Do you need to capture leads for a future nurturing campaign? Lead generation landing pages with forms are highly effective as they allow you to nurture these leads over time.
  • Are you looking to sell a product or service in a direct transaction? A focused click-through landing page streamlines the purchase journey to make it easier for customers to complete their transactions.

Landing Page vs. Website

While you could theoretically refer to any destination page as a “landing page,” an actual landing page is technically more strategic than your average website or web page. A true landing page focuses on a single CTA or conversion goal and does not take visitors to other parts of the site.

Here’s a quick and simple guide to the differences between a landing page and a website:

Landing page:

  • Focused on a single conversion goal
  • Minimal navigation and distractions
  • Designed for a specific campaign or offer
  • Optimized for conversions
  • Often temporary or campaign-specific

Website:

  • Provides broad information about a company
  • Offers multiple pages and navigation options
  • Designed for a general audience
  • Typically long-term and evergreen

Can I Create a Landing Page Without a Website or Domain?

Yes, you can create a landing page without having a separate website or domain, using tools called landing page builders.

Landing page builders or platforms often have templates to choose from that can be customized with your own text, images, colors, and videos. This allows you to quickly create a professional-looking landing page tailored to your specific needs.

Building a fully functional website can be time-consuming. If you are in need of a marketing-focused page now with no delay, using a landing page builder is an excellent solution. This approach allows you to launch your campaign without delay and ensures you don’t miss out on potential leads or sales.

In the long term, though, it is wise to establish a domain and website so your business has a professional online presence to aid in building credibility and trust. 

What’s the Difference Between a Homepage and a Landing Page?

A homepage and a landing page serve different purposes and have distinct designs. A homepage is the broad entry point to your business, and is not optimized for a specific conversion goal. Its goal is to introduce visitors to your brand and direct them to various areas of interest.  

A landing page, on the other hand, is designed for a specific marketing campaign or offer. It is a standalone page without navigation — so no navigational menus. There won’t be a link to go back to the previous page, social media links, or page footers.The reason for this is to minimize navigation away from the page and distractions that could get your visitor interested in something else. The page is focused on a single conversion goal.

What’s the Difference Between an Entry Page and a Landing Page?

An entry page is the first page a visitor encounters when arriving at a website. It may be the homepage, or a blog post. An entry page is like an open door, leading visitors to a variety of other places on the site, so it probably doesn’t have a specific purpose or design. 

While an entry page can serve various purposes, a landing page is laser-focused on a single conversion goal. Landing pages are typically minimal, with no distractions or additional navigation, and guide visitors toward completing one desired action.

Should I Use AI?

There’s nothing wrong with using AI tools. Many people use AI as a starting point to save time, reduce effort, and cut costs. However, it’s important to understand that the content generated by AI often requires editing before it can be used effectively.

Why is that? Because AI tools have limitations. While AI can produce content based on the data it was trained on, it does not have a deep comprehension of the subject, audience needs, or broader context like a human does. 

Since AI models stitch together content based on language patterns, they can sometimes generate factual inaccuracies or nonsense statements, called “hallucinations.” Humans can identify  and correct these errors.

AI may have biases or blind spots since its training data can’t include every possibility. Sometimes, AI-generated language can feel “flat” or “fake,” lacking nuance and depth that human-generated content typically has. Be sure to test and refine the language you get from AI, just like you would with content created by humans.

Quality is key. In essence, AI content generation is a powerful tool in the content-creation process, just like any other powerful tool. Use it to quickly generate initial drafts and ideas, then have someone you trust modify it with the details that your project requires. 

Do I Need to Hire a Designer or Professional?

Hiring a professional may be the best route if you have a larger budget, require a highly customized and on-brand design, or if you’re running a high-stakes campaign where conversion rates are critical. However, for smaller projects or tighter budgets, DIY tools and templates can also produce effective landing pages.

[consider making these into a table] 

Pros of hiring a professional:

  • Access to design expertise and industry best practices
  • Professionally crafted visuals and layouts that align with your brand
  • Efficient execution saves time
  • Potential for higher conversion rates with optimized designs

Cons of hiring a professional:

  • Higher upfront costs compared to DIY options
  • Potential communication gaps or misalignment with your vision
  • Limited control over the design process
  • Reliance on the design professional for updates or changes in the future

If you decide to create the landing page yourself, remember that quality should be the top priority.

Alternatively, consider partnering with a content creation service like Crowd Content. This gives you the benefits of an agency, which can handle the entire landing page creation process while also considering your unique brand needs and integrating with your in-house team as necessary. 

What Makes a Great Landing Page?

“Great” here means “effective.” While a landing page may be visually appealing, it must also deliver results to be truly considered successful 

Here are some key elements that contribute to an effective landing page design:

  • Consistent graphics: When a visitor arrives at your landing page from a social media post, email, or another page on your website, the visual continuity from page to page must be preserved. It should be clear that they are still interacting with the brand they started with. This is not the place to introduce surprises and disrupt their experience.
  • Attention-grabbing headline: Include a compelling, benefit-driven headline that reinforces what the visitor is here to do. It needs to quickly capture their interest and convey the value they will receive.
  • Short and targeted copy: The content on the landing page should be focused and easy-to-read to address the visitor’s pain points or desires directly.
  • Persuasive visuals: High-quality, relevant images or videos should be used to  reinforce the message conveyed in the text. These visuals help engage visitors and support the overall narrative of the landing page.
  • Prominent CTA: Include an unmistakable button or form that motivates the visitor. Clicking the button or filling out the form should be the only thing they can do on the page. 

An Example of a Fantastic Landing Page Design That Converts

We’ve been describing the features of a successful landing page. Now, let’s look at an actual landing page in action, like this sign-up page from Crowd Content.

Visitors find this page from Crowd Content’s “Services” page. After clicking on “Local SEO City Pages,” they are directed to a more detailed page about that service. A CTA button in the middle of the page says, “Get Started Now.”

Clicking that button takes visitors to the page where they can book a meeting. It’s a simple visual layout of side-by-side blue and white rectangles. The blue sidebar on the left offers social proof in the form of benefits, review stars, and a testimonial. 

The right side has visually hierarchical headline elements that lead directly to the form. 

The form asks for only the most critical info. Then, a bright blue button says, “Sign Up.” Beyond that, the only links are to the Terms & Conditions and Privacy Policy, or a sign-in link if the visitor already has an account. 

The only other piece of information is a phone number. The potential customer has traveled this far through your sales funnel to reach the account creation form, so that is all you want them to do here.

How to Create a Landing Page From Scratch

Driving conversions and capturing leads is crucial to any marketing campaign’s success. Follow this easy step-by-step process to craft a high-converting landing page from the ground up.

1. Identify Your Target Audience 

Create a detailed outline of your ideal customer. Understand their demographics, interests, and pain points to tailor your landing page to their needs.

2. Set Your Goal 

Determine the specific, single purpose of your landing page. Is it to generate leads? Sell a product? Promote an event?

3. Create an Outline 

Map out the essential elements of your landing page. The headline, value proposition, features/benefits, social proof, and CTA should be short, clear, and obvious. 

4. Develop the Design 

Develop a visually appealing yet clean and distraction-free design that aligns with your brand identity. Create mock-ups to experiment with different layouts and elements before finalizing the design.

5. Craft the Content

Write persuasive, benefit-driven copy that speaks directly to your target audience’s needs and desires. Use clear, concise language and avoid jargon or fluff.

6. Get the CTAs Right 

Your call-to-action buttons or forms should be prominent and enticing, and clearly communicate the desired action. Strategically place the CTAs right next to the information to maximize engagement.

7. Highlight Social Proof  

Build trust and credibility by showcasing customer testimonials, case studies, industry badges, or statistics that validate your offer.

8. Preview & Test

Before launch, thoroughly test your landing page across devices and browsers. Ensure the flow works smoothly and the visuals are consistent. This step helps identify and fix any issues before going live. 

9. Get Tracking & Performance in Place  

Integrate analytics tools to track metrics such as traffic sources, conversion rates, and user behavior. Use this baseline data to determine if the campaign needs adjustments in the future.

10. Refine & Optimize 

Continuously analyze performance data and user feedback to identify areas for improvement. Experiment with different headlines, designs, or CTAs through A/B testing to maximize conversions over time. Regularly refining and optimizing your landing page ensures it remains effective and continues to drive results.

Flowchart showing steps to create a landing page from identifying the target audience to refining and optimizing the page.

Should I Use a Template?

Using a pre-designed landing page template can seem like a tempting shortcut. Weigh the pros and cons before deciding if a template is the right approach for your needs.

Pros:

  • Templates save time because they provide a ready-made structure.
  • Many template options are free or budget-friendly, making them an affordable solution.
  • Most templates allow for simple customization of colors, fonts, and content.
  • Templates are typically already responsive and mobile-optimized.

Cons:

  • You risk having a landing page that looks similar to other landing pages or looks “generic,” because templates are widely available and used for numerous different promotions.
  • Customization options may be limited, which prevents you from fully tailoring the template to meet your specific needs. 
  • Templates may not match your specific marketing goals or target audience.
  • Free templates may not provide the high-quality user experience your brand needs.

While templates can be a viable option for businesses with limited resources, professional help may be the better route for those seeking a truly customized, high-converting landing page. Remember, quality is key when it comes to landing pages, and a unique, well-designed page can make a significant difference in your campaign’s success. 

At Crowd Content, our team of expert copywriters, designers, and marketers can collaborate with you to craft a bespoke, high-performing landing page tailored to your unique needs. Let us help you create a landing page that truly stands out and delivers results.

How to Create a Landing Page for Free

In today’s digital landscape, having an effective landing page is crucial for driving conversions and capturing leads. Fortunately, creating a professional-looking landing page doesn’t have to break the bank. 

Start by selecting a free landing page builder like Unbounce (free trial); Leadpages (offers a money-back guarantee if you don’t get at least 30 leads within 30 days); or Instapage (14-day free trial). These platforms provide easy interfaces for creating landing pages without coding skills.

Once you’ve chosen a platform, browse through the available templates and select one that aligns with your brand and campaign goals. 

After selecting a template, customize it to fit your needs. Most builders allow you to edit the text, images, colors, and layout, enabling you to create a landing page that reflects your brand identity.

Social proof can go a long way toward building trust and credibility with your visitors. Include customer testimonials, case studies, or industry badges to showcase your expertise and past successes. This validation can make visitors more likely to convert.

Make sure your CTA is prominently displayed and unmissable. Use contrasting colors and strategic placement to guide visitors toward the desired action, whether it’s signing up for a newsletter, downloading a resource, or making a purchase. 

While your landing page builder might offer basic analytics, consider integrating more robust tools like Google Analytics (free) to track your page’s performance and make data-driven optimizations.

Once your landing page is live, continually test and refine it. Experiment with different headlines, visuals, and CTAs through A/B testing to find the winning combination.

Remember, while creating a landing page for free is possible, it’s essential to prioritize quality over cost. If you find yourself struggling or lacking the time and resources, consider working with experienced landing page experts like Crowd Content to ensure your landing page is optimized for maximum conversions and ROI.

Our Picks for the Best Landing Page Tools

1. Unbounce

  • Overview: Unbounce allows users to create, publish, and test landing pages without the need for coding knowledge or IT resources.
  • Ideal for: Building high-converting landing pages for various marketing campaigns including lead generation, click-through campaigns, and product launches.
  • Suitable for: Businesses of all sizes, from small startups to large enterprises, across various industries.
  • Pros: Drag-and-drop builder, mobile-responsive templates, A/B testing capabilities, integration with popular marketing tools.
  • Cons: Limited customization options for advanced users, additional costs for premium features.
  • Cost: Starts at $99/month, with a 14-day free trial available.

2. Instapage

  • Overview: Instapage is a landing page solution that focuses on creating post-click experiences and optimizing for conversions.
  • Ideal for: Creating landing pages for PPC campaigns, product launches, webinars, and other marketing initiatives.
  • Suitable for: Businesses of all sizes, particularly those with a strong focus on paid advertising and conversion rate optimization.
  • Pros: Intuitive builder, heat maps, conversion analytics, integration with popular advertising platforms.
  • Cons: Limited free plan, relatively steep learning curve.
  • Cost: Starts at $199/month, with a 14-day free trial available.

3. Leadpages

  • Overview: Leadpages is a versatile platform that allows you to create landing pages, websites, pop-ups, and alert bars.
  • Ideal for: Building landing pages, opt-in forms, and lead magnets for capturing leads and growing email lists.
  • Suitable for: Small businesses, entrepreneurs, and marketers looking for an all-in-one solution.
  • Pros: Affordable pricing, intuitive drag-and-drop builder, more than 250 templates, integrated email marketing tools.
  • Cons: Limited customization options, some features may be overkill for simple landing page needs.
  • Cost: Starts at $37/month, with a free trial available (limited features).

4. HubSpot

  • Overview: HubSpot is a comprehensive marketing, sales, and customer service platform that includes a landing page builder.
  • Ideal for: Creating landing pages as part of an integrated marketing strategy, including email campaigns, lead nurturing, and CRM integration.
  • Suitable for: Businesses of all sizes that are looking for an all-in-one solution for their marketing, sales, and customer service needs.
  • Pros: Seamless integration with other HubSpot tools, extensive customization options, advanced analytics and reporting.
  • Cons: Expensive for small businesses or those only needing a landing page builder — price includes much more than landing pages.
  • Cost: Starts at $15/month for the Marketing Hub (includes landing pages), free trial available.

These are just a few of the many landing page tools available on the market. If you’re unsure which tool is best for your business or you need professional assistance with landing page creation, consider reaching out to Crowd Content’s team of experts for personalized guidance.

Legal Considerations for Landing Pages

Don’t overlook your legal compliance responsibilities. As you capture leads and drive conversions, you must also adhere to privacy laws and regulations to protect user data. 

One of the most significant legal considerations for landing pages is compliance with data protection and privacy laws, such as the General Data Protection Regulation (GDPR) in the European Union and the California Consumer Privacy Act (CCPA) in the United States. These laws govern how businesses collect, store, and use personal data, including the information gathered through landing page forms and lead capture mechanisms.

Have clear and accessible privacy policies and terms of service that outline how you handle user data. Where applicable, include consent forms that allow visitors to explicitly agree to your data collection and usage practices. This transparency is essential for building trust and staying compliant with legal requirements.

Beyond data privacy, there may be other legal considerations depending on your industry, your location, and the nature of your landing page content. For instance, certain claims or representations made on your landing pages may need to be substantiated to comply with advertising and consumer protection laws. Making unverified claims can lead to legal repercussions, so always ensure your content is accurate and supported by evidence.

Reputable organizations, such as the International Association of Privacy Professionals (IAPP) and the Association of National Advertisers (ANA, formerly known as the Direct Marketing Association), also offer educational resources, best practices, and industry-specific guidelines to help businesses stay compliant.

Leveraging Landing Pages for Enhanced Marketing Outcomes

Even though digital marketing is ever-evolving, landing pages remain a powerful tool. By strategically incorporating well-designed landing pages into your marketing strategy when there is a specific goal in mind, you can maximize marketing impact and drive tangible results.

Landing pages are dedicated post-click destinations that allow you to laser-target specific audience segments, eliminate unnecessary distractions, and guide visitors through a carefully curated journey that leads them directly where you want them to go.

A landing page is not a one-and-done concept. Check your ROI and A/B test to keep your campaigns relevant and successful. 

Whether you hire a content company to create a customized landing page for you or create your own, a strong landing page will strike a balance between targeted content and the buyer’s journey. Ultimately, leveraging landing pages as a core component of your digital marketing strategy is a strategic investment that yields tangible returns. 

The post How to Create a Landing Page That Converts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content Marketing vs. Social Media Marketing: Key Differences and Which to Use When https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-marketing-vs-social-media-marketing-key-differences-and-which-to-use-when/ Wed, 26 Jun 2024 07:10:24 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38316 Conversations about both content marketing and social media marketing continue to dominate the digital marketing landscape. However, many people still confuse the two, often mistaking one for the other. Some even treat them as identical, using both terms interchangeably. In actuality, content marketing and social media marketing are two very different disciplines. But they do […]

The post Content Marketing vs. Social Media Marketing: Key Differences and Which to Use When appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Conversations about both content marketing and social media marketing continue to dominate the digital marketing landscape. However, many people still confuse the two, often mistaking one for the other. Some even treat them as identical, using both terms interchangeably.

In actuality, content marketing and social media marketing are two very different disciplines. But they do overlap, support, and complement one another in some fascinating ways. They’re also both essential parts of any thorough digital marketing strategy.

In this comprehensive guide to content marketing vs. social media marketing, we’ll touch on everything you need to know to knock your marketing goals out of the park. We’ll cover the differences between the two and let you in on some best practices for knowing when and how to apply each.

What is the Difference Between Content Marketing and Social Media Marketing?


Content marketing and social media marketing each play unique roles in reaching audiences. Content marketing is about crafting and sharing informative materials like blog posts, videos, and ebooks, usually on your own website. It aims to educate and engage specific groups over time. The goal is to build authority and trust by providing valuable content that appeals to potential customers’ interests and needs.  

On the other hand, social media marketing focuses on creating content tailored for platforms like Facebook and Instagram to interact directly and instantly with users, sparking conversations and building community. While both strategies aim to boost brand awareness and engagement, they target audiences and achieve their goals in different ways.

Both content and social media marketing serve your business goals by raising brand awareness, contributing to conversions, and putting your brand in front of target audiences. However, each does this in its own unique way:

  • Marketing content most often lives on your website (or possibly someone else’s), while social content is created specifically for individual platforms like Facebook, X (formerly Twitter), or Instagram.
  • Content marketing is about educating and influencing an audience, while social media marketing is about engaging audiences and starting conversations.
  • Social content is typically ephemeral and short-term, while marketing content is usually long-form, in-depth, and crafted to be useful over the long term.
  • Content marketing builds authority and trust, while social media marketing humanizes brands and makes them more relatable.

In other words, content marketing is more about long-term engagement and building trust through valuable information, while social media marketing focuses on immediate interaction and community building. The two concepts complement one another greatly, and you need both to make your marketing strategy work in today’s ever-changing digital landscape. However, this doesn’t change the fact that content and social media marketing are distinctly different.

What is content marketing?

Content marketing is a strategic discipline that involves planning, crafting, publishing, and distributing targeted content to serve an audience, drive sales, and attract new customers while retaining existing ones. This marketing discipline involves a detailed process of planning, developing, and sharing content through various formats including blog posts, ebooks, videos, podcasts, infographics, and long-form articles. This is done to engage potential and existing customers by offering useful content that meets their needs and interests.

What is social media marketing?

Social media marketing is the process of planning, creating, and posting content across one or more social media platforms to connect with target audiences in a personable, accessible way. Specific posts may aim to promote products, drive traffic, initiate conversations, build community, and make the brand appear more relatable and human.

Content Marketing and Social Media Marketing Have Different Objectives

All marketing strategies and tactics have clear, actionable goals, and this is just as true for social and content marketing.

Again, there’s some overlap between the two. Many marketers may even track and analyze the same key performance indicators (KPIs) to evaluate the success of both. However, the primary underlying objectives are different.

Content marketing emphasizes the funnel and lead generation

The primary focus of content marketing is to draw potential customers into  the sales funnel and guide them through buyer’s journey. By providing valuable, relevant content at each stage of the funnel, content marketing helps nurture leads, builds trust and strengthens budding brand-client relationships.

Here are a few examples of some of the many ways this can look:

  • Well-crafted blog posts, videos, or infographics—especially those with viral potential—attract and educate potential customers.
  • Top-tier gated content like ebooks and whitepapers can generate high-quality leads at the top of your sales funnel.
  • Robust email marketing content and ongoing blog content answer consumer questions and influence decisions as they navigate the middle of your funnel.
  • Advanced content like webinars, how-to guides, online courses, and similar resources help establish the brand’s authority in the field and deepen trust with the audience.

This strategy requires high-quality copy to succeed, and services like Crowd Content provide robust copywriting solutions tailored to meet diverse goals across different niches and industries.  From crafting detailed blog posts for content marketing or engaging tweets for social media, professional copywriting services can truly elevate your brand’s marketing efforts.

Social media marketing emphasizes direct engagement with audiences

These days, social media is more than just a way to stay in touch with friends or kill a few minutes while waiting in line for coffee. It’s an important part of how consumers research purchase decisions and become aware of new product options. For that reason, a solid social media strategy is a key way for today’s brands to engage with existing and potential customers.

Here are some examples of how brands like yours leverage social platforms to satisfy this objective:

  • Eye-catching social media posts draw attention as people scroll through their feeds, stopping them in their tracks and introducing them to new products or brands. This can make a memorable impact in a brief interaction.
  • Successful posts start conversations, encourage sharing, and boost engagement rates. They broaden brand reach through compelling questions, call-to-action prompts, and interactive content like polls and quizzes.
  • Becoming a regular presence on consumers’ social media feeds boosts brand awareness and raises the chance of a potential future purchase. This consistent visibility keeps the brand top-of-mind.
  • Social media and regular engagement help humanize your brand and make it relatable.
  • Many brands use social media to field customer service issues and address concerns directly. This helps in resolving issues efficiently and improves customer satisfaction and loyalty by showing that the brand is attentive and responsive. 

Which is Better: Social Media Marketing or Content Marketing?

Neither social media nor content marketing is definitively better than the other across the board. However, content marketing is better suited to long-term business strategies, while social media is ideal for more immediate results. A complete digital marketing strategy includes both and uses them in a way that complements one another.

Targeting audiences with content marketing vs. social media marketing

Both social media and content marketing require marketers to truly know their audiences. Market research, customer feedback, and tools like buyer personas can really help you here. However, how you apply these to your targeting efforts will vary.

  • SEO is an audience-targeting staple with both types of marketing. Both leverage well-researched keywords to boost visibility in relevant search results. However, content marketing SEO revolves heavily around long-tail keywords and natural language processing, while social media SEO involves elements like hashtags for content discoverability and engagement.
  • Content variety matters with both content marketing and social media marketing. However, while content marketing spans a wide array of formats, from written content to videos to podcasts, social media marketing will likely use a variety of content types suited for quick consumption (e.g., short videos, images and concise text posts).
  • Techniques like audience segmentation are significant in personalizing marketing content and delivering the right options to the right people. With social media marketing, knowing how to create effective social media posts to suit individual platforms and playing the algorithm helps serve your posts to the right folks.
  • Paid advertising can be helpful in both types of marketing to support ongoing organic efforts and drive quick bursts of traffic as needed.

Content marketing and social media marketing engagement models

Although driving engagement is one of the primary objectives behind social media marketing, it’s still essential in content marketing. Engagement can be any interaction an audience member has with a piece of your content. Examples include likes, comments, social media shares, link click-throughs, subscription sign-ups, and long dwell times.

Methods for driving engagement across both types of marketing include examples like the following:

  • Investing in dynamic content that stops people in their tracks and demands attention, including unique social media posts, in-depth blog content, and exciting videos
  • Inviting audiences to participate in top-tier interactive experiences to boost information retention and brand recognition
  • Leveraging social proof like user-generated content, testimonials, and case studies to enhance credibility and trustworthiness
  • Actively inviting readers and followers to offer their feedback, occasionally offering incentives in exchange for doing so
  • Outsourcing portions of the content production process to streamline workflows while keeping quality high

Techniques and approaches like these work, and numerous case studies prove it. Here’s a brief overview of a couple to consider as you plan your next marketing move.

INK’s traffic success story

INK was looking for a way to show rather than tell their customers that their content optimization tool can move mountains in SEO, so they turned to Crowd Content for help.

We worked with them to craft a strategy that involved creating a series of fully optimized blog articles and measuring the results to create impressive proof that INK’s tools perform as advertised. As a result, INK saw an incredible 1700 percent increase in blog traffic in just over a month.

GLOBO’s success with content variety

Variety is more than just the spice of life. It also lends flavor and interest to your collective digital marketing campaign. The language-support company GLOBO needed help with its messaging and encouraged more readers to become service subscribers.

Creating a strategy that tailored content to cater to customers at various stages of the sales funnel worked. GLOBO’s website views jumped by 200 percent, and brand messaging improved accordingly.

Craftjack’s smart use of outsourcing

When keeping up with your ongoing marketing demands is more than your team can handle on its own, outsourcing content can be a fantastic option to consider. Lead-generation company Craftjack needed a go-to way to keep their marketing content flowing smoothly but couldn’t handle the job alone.

Partnering with Crowd Content gave Craftjack instant access to experienced niche writers, skilled project managers, and eagle-eyed editors who banded together to boost production. Craftjack was even able to connect with skilled Spanish-language writers to better reach another sector of their client base. The result was a 70 percent increase in organic traffic over a year.

When to use content marketing

Brands can lean into content marketing at any stage of the sales journey to help accelerate progress toward goals, connect with new customers, and keep existing audiences engaged. Some objectives that would make that an excellent choice include:

  • Establishing industry expertise and authority
  • Raising overall brand visibility, primarily via Google and other search engines
  • Elevating SEO rankings and staying competitive on key search engine results pages (SERPs)
  • Drawing new users and readers into the top of your sales funnel by showing how your brand can solve their problems
  • Strengthening existing relationships by delivering valuable ongoing solutions

You can brainstorm and create better, more effective marketing content by implementing strategies and best practices like the following:

  • Deliver value that goes above and beyond what your competitors are doing. Demonstrate how your products and services can uniquely solve problems and improve your customers’ lives.
  • Use tools like surveys and buyer personas to develop a deeper understanding of your audience’s preferences, challenges, and behaviors. This will allow you to tailor your content more effectively to meet their needs.
  • Create a detailed content calendar and follow it to the letter to keep your content efforts focused and the quality consistent.
  • Offer lots of variety to keep your content flow fresh. Think videos, infographics, webinars, podcasts, and ebooks in addition to standard fare like blogs.
  • Extend the reach and lifespan of your most successful content by updating it with the latest information and repurposing it into different formats. For example, a popular blog post can be turned into a video tutorial or an infographic that allows you to reach a broader audience.

When to use social media marketing

Social media marketing is a solid way to stay perpetually connected with your customers and create exciting ongoing conversations about your brand that attract plenty of fresh leads. Business objectives that call for a greater focus on social media marketing include:

  • Identifying demographics and markets that could be a solid fit for your products
  • Embracing cost-effective ways to get more eyes on your marketing content and drive traffic to your website
  • Generating useful analytics that can help you optimize your entire marketing strategy
  • Engaging directly with your audience on a one-to-one basis
  • Providing better, faster, more robust customer care options
  • Building overall brand awareness and recognition

Make the most of your social media marketing efforts by considering best practices like the following and looking for ways to integrate them into your strategy:

  • Meet your audience where they live by building a presence on the platforms they frequent most.
  • Fine-tune your approach to social media marketing to suit each platform. What works like gangbusters for Facebook posts may not resonate the same way with your TikTok audience or your Instagram strategy.
  • Explore influencer marketing to tap into readymade audiences that fit your products and services perfectly.
  • Encourage and share user-generated content to show social proof that people already love what your brand is doing.
  • Chime in on hot topics and trends related to your industry or niche. ​​This keeps your content fresh and relatable, and can help attract new followers who are interested in those topics.

Examples of Content Marketing and Social Media Marketing

Remember that neither content nor social media marketing is about just one thing. Creative, novel approaches that combine multiple approaches often yield the best results. Here are some popular examples of approaches to content marketing:

  • Blog posts
  • Email marketing
  • Ebooks
  • Infographics
  • Videos
  • Podcasts
  • Webinars
  • Whitepapers
  • Case studies
  • Interactive content experiences

Popular approaches to social media marketing to mix, match, and try include:

  • Influencer marketing
  • Community creation
  • Contests and giveaways
  • User-generated content
  • Sponsored social media posts

How Can Content Marketing and Social Media Marketing Work Together?

Content marketing and social media marketing work hand in hand to boost your digital strategy. Sharing your blog posts, videos, and other content on social platforms not only increases visibility but also engages your audience effectively. Social media offers a direct way to gather quick feedback and encourages your followers to share their own content, increasing engagement further. By combining these strategies, you can leverage each to maximize your reach and interaction, making your marketing efforts more dynamic and effective. 

Here are a few key examples of how content marketing and social media marketing go together as beautifully as peanut butter and jelly:

Promoting marketing content

Leveraging your reach on social media is an effective way to amplify the reach of your content, make audiences aware of new product drops, etc. Share articles, your latest blog posts, etc. Content like infographics and videos translate exceptionally well to engaging social media shares and extending your visibility beyond your immediate followers.

Zeroing in on an audience’s wants and needs

Social media is a fantastic way to acquire valuable feedback on what your audience really thinks. You can ask them directly for feedback on specific products, ideas, or content. You can also utilize solutions like social listening tools to follow conversations about your brand across multiple platforms.

Getting audiences involved

Your audience is likely one of your arsenal’s most powerful untapped marketing resources. Mobilize them by encouraging them to create and share user-generated content like photos or videos on social media, asking them to share your content to their feeds, etc.

Effective Strategies for Leveraging Both Content and Social Media Marketing

Investing in your content marketing and social media marketing campaigns separately is a solid start to making the most of both. Combining these two strategies can result in a more cohesive and powerful marketing approach. Here are some expert strategies to try.

Keep your tone cohesive across both

Brands are just like people in that each has its unique personality, voice, values, and approach to connecting with others. It’s crucial that those characteristics are consistent across all platforms. This consistency ensures that your audience receives a unified brand experience, regardless of where they interact with your content..

For example, a customer should be able to visit your Facebook page or X profile and consume content there that “feels” the same as what they’re already reading on your blog or in your email newsletter. If that’s not the case for your brand, now is the time to tighten things up. Check out how brands like Wendy’s, Go Pro, or Nike handle this and get inspired.

Integrate both into your content calendar

Thorough planning as far in advance as possible is the key to an ongoing content strategy that really cooks. Content calendars take the guesswork out of managing, planning, and creating content, especially as your business grows and you take on additional team members to help with various tasks.

Include both your marketing content and your social media posts. Identify opportunities to combine the two in creative ways that serve your audience. As always, ensure that everything you plan fully aligns with your brand voice and company values.

Cross-promote content where it makes sense

Social media posts and standard content work better together than you might think, and there are plenty of opportunities for cross-promotion.

For example, you can promote your latest blog posts and product launches across your social media channels using engaging visuals like screenshots, infographics, or custom imagery to grab attention and add value. You can also embed tweets and YouTube videos or add screen grabs of various social media posts to add visual interest to your blog posts and written content.

Find creative ways to repurpose content

Keeping multiple content channels and social media profiles perpetually filled with terrific content is no easy feat, so it pays to do what you can to make your best ideas go as far as possible. Content repurposing is one highly effective way to do that.

Here are some examples of how creative content repurposing can work:

  • Break down YouTube videos and how-to guides into graphic sequences you can post to Instagram.
  • Sum up key points and important takeaways from popular informative blogs in an infographic you can share on Facebook, Pinterest, X, or Threads.
  • Expand your best long-form blogs into ebooks and use social media to promote them.
  • Repurpose long-form content into social media-friendly short-form videos.
  • Translate a popular webinar or e-course into a series of Instagram reels or TikTok videos.

Hire experts to help you

As your business grows and the demands on your content strategy increase, considering outsourcing to maintain quality and innovation can be beneficial.  Some people purchase pre-written articles to help fill in crucial content gaps.

You can also hire a trusted full-service content creation service like Crowd Content to help you with the entire process. We’ll help you manage the workload and inject fresh ideas into your strategy.  We’ll also provide assistance that cover  everything from dynamic web content to engaging social media posts to expert content management.

Benefits of Integrating Social Media Insights into Content Strategies

Insights gained from your experiences engaging with audiences on social media can be priceless assets when it comes to fortifying your content marketing strategies. You can get a read on what your audience truly likes and dislikes, as well as how they feel about various content approaches. You can then apply what you learn to reap benefits like the following.

Higher engagement rates

When you know for sure what your audience is genuinely into, you can apply what you know to create more of the kind of content your customers like best and find most useful. Applying these insights allows you to tailor your content more precisely, producing material that not only attracts attention but also encourages interaction. 

Stronger brand loyalty

Think of someone you know who’s always there for you—who always has the right answer to your questions and the best advice on a particular topic. You trust them, and you’re loyal to them, too. That’s how consumer relationships with brands develop through similar dynamics, and using social media insights wisely can help that happen for your business.

Improved SEO

Forms of social media-related engagement like shares are powerful signals to search engines that a brand is putting exceptional content out there. Using what you learn about your customers on social media to boost engagement drives traffic to your website and enhances your greater SEO efforts.

Higher overall ROI

Both content marketing and social media marketing represent investments in your business. It’s not just about money or budgets, either. Time, labor, and mental energy are resources, too, so facilitating a high return on that investment is crucial. Integrating social media insights into your strategy can help you hit the right notes more often, sending your ROI through the roof.

Budgeting for Each Approach

No two brands are exactly alike, and neither are any two approaches to digital marketing, so costs can vary for individual campaigns. However, average costs range between $6,000 and $60,000 a month for a content marketing campaign and between $500 and $5,000 per month for a basic social media management campaign.

Opting for a scalable approach via a company like Crowd Content can ensure you get the most bang for your buck right out of the gate and on an ongoing basis.

Ultimately, neither content nor social media marketing fits your company’s digital marketing strategy better. You need both to stay competitive and keep your finger on the pulse of what modern audiences are looking for. Exploring opportunities to leverage how they complement one another can eliminate the confusion of both processes.

Ready to dive into your future success and get more out of your marketing strategies? Let Crowd Content help you fill in the gaps and create something truly dynamic with quality content services on demand.

The post Content Marketing vs. Social Media Marketing: Key Differences and Which to Use When appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Visual Content Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/visual-content-marketing/ Wed, 26 Jun 2024 07:01:29 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38310 Remember the last time you scrolled through social media and felt captivated by imagery? Perhaps it was a heartwarming video, a cleverly designed graphic, or a thought-provoking animation. Visual content marketing connects on an emotional level and leaves a lasting impression, even after words fade. In this guide, we’ll share our comprehensive knowledge of visual […]

The post Visual Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Remember the last time you scrolled through social media and felt captivated by imagery? Perhaps it was a heartwarming video, a cleverly designed graphic, or a thought-provoking animation. Visual content marketing connects on an emotional level and leaves a lasting impression, even after words fade.

In this guide, we’ll share our comprehensive knowledge of visual content marketing. You’ll learn about the diverse types of visual content and how to use them strategically, explore real-world examples of successful campaigns, and discover a step-by-step process for creating your own robust strategy. We will discuss innovative tools, best practices for integration, and techniques for building trust using visuals. 

Get ready to craft unforgettable brand stories using eye-catching visuals that resonate with your audience.

What Is Visual Content Marketing?

Visual content marketing is the strategic use of visuals to achieve your marketing goals. This includes images, videos, infographics, illustrations, and any other format that visually communicates your message.

Leverage imagery to:

  • Quickly attract and retain the attention of fickle scrollers
  • Simplify complex concepts and data
  • Evoke emotions and build stronger brand connections

Images, graphics, and videos often convey information and drive action more effectively than text alone. Picture the difference between assembling new furniture using only written instructions versus diagrams or a video tutorial. 

What’s more, visuals allow you to personalize your brand, fostering a deeper emotional bond with your audience. Authenticity is a game-changer for building trust and standing out in the increasingly crowded digital landscape.

Why Is Visual Marketing Important?

Our brains are wired for visuals. Since the dawn of humanity, we’ve communicated through visual storytelling. Cave paintings, hieroglyphs, and modern emojis all convey meaning and emotion universally. An innate preference for visual information shapes how our content consumption patterns today. 

In particular, our brains process visuals 60,000 times faster than text. This has profound implications for today’s marketers. The benefits of visual content marketing include:

  • Improving comprehension and recall: The brain processes visual communication better than text, which equals better information retention.
  • Triggering an emotional response: Visuals evoke feelings, forming strong connections between your brand and your audience.
  • Driving action: Compelling visuals, paired with clear calls to action, can increase engagement, clicks, and conversions.

Visual content marketing isn’t just a nice-to-have. It’s a necessity for brands that want to be seen, understood, and remembered.

Key Elements of Impactful Visual Content

Here’s what sets truly impactful visuals apart:

Clarity and purpose: Every piece of visual content should have a clear objective. Are you simplifying a complex process? Design an infographic to break it down. Highlighting a product’s features? Create a short, stylish product demo video. Understanding the “why” will ensure that every visual aligns perfectly with your brand goals.

Strong visual hierarchy: Don’t make viewers work. Guide their eyes effortlessly through your visual, emphasizing the most significant elements. Use strategic pops of color, bold typography, and clever composition to create a clear visual journey. Be sure to make your branding consistent across all channels to ensure a cohesive experience for the audience. 

Visual storytelling: Even the simplest image can tell a story. For instance, a heartwarming social media image for an animal shelter could show a recently adopted pet with its loving family. This picture will trigger stronger emotions and inspire more engagement than text alone. Such visuals make your message more memorable and likely to prompt a response because they connect with your audience on an emotional level.

Related: Learn more about the power of narrative in our article, Unlock the Power of Digital Storytelling With a Content Marketing Strategy.

Authenticity: Move away from generic stock photos. Instead, create visuals that genuinely represent your brand and resonate with your audience. This builds trust and a sense of connection, both key ingredients for long-term success.

Accessibility: Don’t leave anyone behind. Consider users with visual impairments by ensuring all images have descriptive alt text and videos have closed captions and transcripts. This extends your reach and demonstrates that you’re a brand that cares.

Exceptional visual content requires more than a pretty picture. It’s a strategic combination of design, storytelling, and an understanding of how your audience engages with the world.

Types of Visual Content That Captivate and Convert

There’s a never-ending flow of content out there. According to experts at Yale, it’s visual elements that cut through and leave a lasting impression. Creating compelling visuals drives the conversions that supercharge your business and boost revenue. Let’s look at the most effective types of visual content. 

Infographics

Infographics simplify complex data, statistics, or concepts into clear, concise summaries. Look at it this way: People are more likely to share a well-designed infographic than a wall of text. This expands your reach and earns your brand valuable exposure.

Critically, infographics make complicated topics easy to grasp. This is empowering for your audience, and it positions you as a trusted source of information.

Say we’re working with an online wellness brand. We might create an infographic for an article exploring the benefits of exercise. It would feature colorful illustrations, statistics, and simple explanations to show physical activity’s life-changing impact on health and well-being. Your audience might share the graphic on social media or their own website to educate their audience — promoting your brand at the same time.

Video content 

Video content is the easiest way to unpack complex information, demonstrate expertise, and build a bond with your audience. Think dynamic product demos, engaging how-to videos, and behind-the-scenes glimpses that reveal your brand’s personality and offer a peek into the culture and people behind the products or services.

What’s more, videos excel in humanizing your brand. Authentic videos showcase your brand identity and offer social proof. Create videos that brim with passion, shoutout loyal customers, and help viewers solve common pain points.

For instance, if we were working with an HVAC company, we’d recommend they produce a series of short videos that provide troubleshooting tips. Each one would explain a common heating or cooling issue and guide homeowners through simple fixes. These videos save customers a service call, establish the company as go-to experts, and provide an opportunity to connect emotionally.

Interactive content

Interactive content creates two-way conversations with your audience. It encourages active engagement through quizzes, polls, interactive infographics, and calculators. Giving your audience something to click, answer, or play with keeps them on your page longer and increases their investment in your brand.

As a bonus, interactive content helps you collect zero-party data about your audience. Gain actionable insights into their preferences, pain points, and interests, and use those to inform future campaigns.

For instance, if we were working with a beauty brand with a blog post titled, “Find Your Perfect Skincare Routine,” we’d add a quiz. It would ask questions about skin type, major concerns, and product preferences, ultimately providing a customized routine at the end. This keeps customers on your page, builds trust, and drives product discovery.

Virtual reality (VR) and augmented reality (AR)

VR and AR push the boundaries of traditional marketing. VR immerses users in entirely digital environments, while AR overlays digital elements onto the real world. These technologies offer unparalleled opportunities for customer engagement and interactive experiences, especially for brands with products customers need to “try on” or visualize. 

An excellent example is the augmented reality IKEA Place app. It lets customers virtually “place” furniture in their own homes before buying. This reduces uncertainty about size and fit, increasing confidence in purchase decisions. The concept is practical and innovative, and sets IKEA apart in a competitive market. 

Memes and GIFs

Memes are funny viral images or videos with catchy text. GIFs are short, looping animations. Both are popular formats for infusing a dose of personality and relatability into your online presence.

[insert screenshot of meme and GIF]

The inherent shareability of memes and GIFs makes them powerful tools for organic brand growth. Their humor or relatability can tap into trending conversations and expand your brand’s reach organically. Plus, they add a relatable touch that’s more likely to connect with modern audiences than text alone.

Let’s say we’re working with a pest control company. To promote a blog post, we might create a meme to share on social media when we hit publish. It could be a cartoon of a startled homeowner facing a spider and a member of your staff holding pesticide, captioned “Say goodbye to your little friend.” This is funny, relatable, and nods to a familiar pop culture reference for maximum impact.

Never underestimate the effectiveness of humor and shareability. When done right, memes and GIFs humanize your brand and drive engagement with your audience.

Social media stories

Social media stories are short-lived, visually engaging posts on platforms such as Instagram, Facebook, and Snapchat. They exploit the FOMO (fear of missing out) factor, usually disappearing after 24 hours. Sharing limited-time offers, sneak peeks, and exclusive content via stories creates FOMO, driving engagement and quick action.

Starbucks is renowned for using Instagram Stories to promote seasonal drink launches. The brand creates visually enticing teasers with countdown graphics, fueling excitement and urgency. This motivates customers to visit their nearest Starbucks to try the new drinks before they’re no longer available, leveraging the FOMO effect to boost sales and customer interaction.

Data visualizations

Well-designed data visualizations make complex ideas easy to grasp. Additionally, visual data allows for quick identification of trends and patterns, catering to audience members seeking instant answers.

If we were helping a digital marketing agency design its annual report, instead of spreadsheets alone, we’d add a mix of eye-catching visuals, such as:

  • An interactive timeline showcasing key milestones and major client wins over the past year
  • A pie chart breaking down website traffic sources and highlighting growth areas
  • A line graph comparing client ROI against industry averages, demonstrating their superior results

This approach establishes the agency as data-driven and transparent, building trust with investors and clients. 

Embracing Technology in Visual Content Creation

The visual content landscape is constantly evolving, with new tools and technologies emerging regularly. While the convenience of AI-generated imagery is tempting, customers increasingly crave authenticity. Like stock imagery, AI-created visuals often lack the human touch and brand-specific details that resonate.

That said, AI isn’t the enemy. These tools can be valuable assets for:

  • Creative inspiration: Use AI to generate new ideas, explore design variations, and overcome creative roadblocks.
  • Placement and composition: Some AI tools can analyze existing imagery and suggest optimal layouts or color palettes, streamlining your workflow.

While AI is excellent at ideation, prioritize on-brand, human-made designs. They speak directly to your brand personality and build a stronger connection with your audience.

The Importance of Professionalism in High-Impact Visual Content

Using amateur visuals on your website is like showing up to a board meeting in sweatpants. On the other hand, professionally produced visuals command respect and make a strong first impression. 

Here are a few more reasons why investing in pro-level design is a smart move:

  • Brand guardians: Top-tier designers do more than enhance aesthetics; they fiercely protect your brand’s identity. Every image, graphic, and video feels undeniably yours, building recognition and trust.
  • Attention to detail: Professional designers have mastered those tiny details that separate polished visuals from amateur ones. Perfect image resolution, balanced layouts, and fonts that amplify your message, not distract from it.
  • Cutting edge insights: Skilled designers know how to translate your goals into visuals that resonate with the right people using the latest techniques. They know what grabs attention, feels trustworthy, and inspires action.

DIY visuals can have their place, but for high-stakes content such as your website or major campaign, leave it to the pros. It’s an investment that reflects your brand’s value and attracts the right customers.

CTA: Strategize Your Content to Complement Visual Marketing

Successful Visual Content Marketing Examples

Examining real-world success stories gives you valuable insights to use for your content marketing initiatives.

McDonald’s

McDonald’s tapped into anime’s rising popularity with a campaign that deeply resonated with a growing audience segment. The WcDonald’s campaign leaned into Studio Pierrot’s vibrant colors, iconic characters, and bold design elements. 

Visual storytelling and brand integration

The campaign featured a series of short videos starring anime characters from shows such as Naruto and Bleach. The visuals stayed true to the original animations, fostering a sense of authenticity and nostalgia among fans. Subtle product placements, like characters eating McFlurries, were smoothly woven into the storyline, making McDonald’s presence natural rather than intrusive.

Social media frenzy and fan engagement

A ton of WcDonald’s videos went viral on social media. The eye-catching visuals, combined with the novelty of seeing beloved characters in a fast-food setting, sparked a wave of excitement and online discussion. Fans created and shared memes, fan art, and cosplay photos, further amplifying the campaign’s reach and engagement through user-generated content (UGC).

Spotify

Spotify’s annual Wrapped campaign is a cultural phenomenon that highlights the power of personalized content and community engagement. It’s widely anticipated and shared, teaching invaluable lessons to anyone seeking to level up their visual marketing game.

Visual storytelling powered by data

Spotify transforms raw listening data into a compelling story about each user’s year in music. Instead of providing a list of statistics, the brand crafts vibrant personalized infographics highlighting top songs, artists, genres, and total listening time. Bold colors, playful animations, and a shareable format create an experience that’s informative and fun.

Interactive and shareable for maximum impact

Wrapped’s success lies in the fact that it invites interaction. The format guides users through their musical recap using dynamic transitions and instilling a sense of discovery. Most importantly, these infographics are designed for social media sharing. It’s a subtle yet effective way to turn users into brand ambassadors and encourage conversation between followers.

Building anticipation and community

Every December, music lovers around the world buzz with anticipation for Spotify Wrapped. The brand fuels excitement with social media teasers, countdowns, and hints, and they’ve managed to transform it into an annual event. When Wrapped finally goes live, it becomes a global conversation starter, with users eagerly comparing their streaming habits with others. This shared experience solidifiesSpotify’s role as a connector and curator of personalized music experiences.

How Do You Use Visuals in Marketing?

Visuals aren’t just eye candy. They’re powerful tools for achieving your marketing objectives. Here’s your roadmap to success with visuals:

  • Define your goals: What do you want your visuals to do? Is it increasing web traffic, enhancing brand awareness, or boosting sales? Clarity is everything when it comes to choosing the right formats.
  • Understand your audience: What are your audience’s pain points and preferred digital spaces, and what kind of visuals resonate with them? Tailoring your approach will yield maximum impact.
  • Build brand consistency: Every visual should feel like it undeniably belongs to your brand. Maintain a cohesive color palette, font choices, and overall aesthetic. Consistency builds recognition and trust.
  • Choose wisely: Think of each visual type as having a specific superpower. Need to simplify a complex topic? Infographic. Want to be meme-able and get shares? GIF. Match the visual type to the goal.
  • Know the rules: Each social platform has its own preferences and peculiarities. Research image size requirements, optimal video lengths, and what looks best on each platform.
  • Quality matters: Sloppy visuals reflect poorly on your brand. Ensure that each visual is crafted with care, from resolution to framing, to maintain a professional appearance in all your marketing efforts.
  • Analyze and optimize: Track your KPIs. Are your infographics driving traffic? Do your video demos increase sales? Use data to pinpoint what works, ditch what doesn’t, and refine your strategy over time.

Download our checklist for clear guidance on which content types and platforms to use for common content goals.  

How to Craft Your Visual Content: Tools, Tips, and Tactics

Below, we’ll break down tools and tactics that will help you bring content to life.

Integrating visual content marketing into your marketing mix

Here are some tips for strategically integrating visuals and making maximum impact:

  • Repurpose: An effective way to extend the life and value of your visual content is through repurposing. One impressive infographic can become multiple social media posts, a blog header, and a slide for a presentation. This approach maximizes your investment and ensures consistency across different platforms. Think creatively to get the most mileage from your best content.
  • Your website is home base: It’s your brand’s online storefront. Optimize visuals for your website to improve user experience, boost SEO, and drive conversions. Make sure visuals on your website are optimized for fast loading, appropriately tagged for SEO, and aesthetically aligned with your brand identity.
  • Don’t forget email: Email marketing works best when it has visual oomph. Break up text with eye-catching images, GIFs, and short videos relevant to your customer base.

Choose the right tools for effective visual content marketing

No matter your skill level or budget, there are visual content creation tools you can use to bring your creative vision to life.

Canva

  • Pros: User-friendly with tons of templates and a wide range of content types, even with the free version. AI tools make complex design features accessible to amateurs. 
  • Cons: Limited customization options, although paid plans unlock more elements and features
  • Best for: Anyone focused on social media graphics, simple infographics, and presentations. It’s also particularly useful for marketers and business owners who need to produce attractive visual content quickly and without extensive design training.

Adobe Creative Cloud

  • Pros: Gold standard in the industry with unmatched creative control, customization, and polish
  • Cons: Expensive with a steep learning curve, which can be overkill if you don’t require the full suite of programs
  • Best for: Professional designers and those needing advanced image-editing capabilities. It’s the go-to choice for high-end content creation that demands meticulous detail and complex compositions.

Piktochart

  • Pros: Infographic-specific templates and tools make it much easier than starting from scratch with design software.
  • Cons: Designs can feel template-y and it’s limited to infographics and data visualization.
  • Best for: People who create infographics regularly but don’t have professional graphic design skills

Lumen5

  • Pros: Turns text into videos quickly, and good for repurposing blog posts and creating shareable social clips
  • Cons: Limited customization options, free version has a watermark, and some features are paywalled
  • Best for: Content creators who want simple video creation for social media — ideal when speed is key

Imagery evokes feelings that can get lost with words. Use these tools to make visual content that builds trust, makes your brand relatable, and builds a community around your brand.

Leverage visual content for brand amplification 

Imagery is an impressive tool for brand amplification. Think of your logo, colors, and overall visual style as your brand’s uniform. When those elements are consistent across your visual content messaging, they become instantly recognizable signatures that identify all communications as distinctly yours. Recognition equates to trust over time, positioning you as a leader in your space. 

In a world overflowing with information, strong visuals help you stand out, build meaningful connections, and leave a lasting mark on your audience.

The Creation Process: DIY vs. Professional Visual Content

Do you go the DIY route or outsource to professional designers? There’s no one-size-fits-all answer. Here’s how to decide what’s right for your brand:

  • DIY pros: Budget-friendly, full creative control, and ideal for making simple visuals
  • DIY cons: Requires time investment, potential for less-polished results, and possible steep learning curve. This could become a drawback if your team already has a full workload.
  • Outsourcing pros: High-quality outcomes and access to specialized skill sets, freeing up your time
  • Outsourcing cons: More expensive, with potential for miscommunication if you don’t have clear brand guidelines and expectations. Relying on external resources might also lead to delays or challenges in project timelines if not managed properly.

Find a balance that works for you. Consider your budget, resources, visual content needs, and internal skill sets when making this call. Also keep in mind that you can mix and match, handling some things in-house and outsourcing big ticket projects.

How Do You Measure the Success of Visual Content?

Measuring visual content effectiveness gives you the power to optimize your strategy and achieve your business objectives. By tracking specific metrics, you can gather insights into how your visuals are performing and make informed decisions to enhance their impact.

Metrics to track include:

  • Engagement: Likes, comments, shares, and saves
  • Reach and impressions: How many people see your content?
  • Website traffic: Click-throughs from visuals to your site
  • Conversions: Did visual content contribute to sales/leads?

Say a fashion brand notices its product demo videos get significantly more shares and website clicks than static product photos. This insight tells them to allocate more resources to creating video content, ultimately driving better results.

Your Visual Content Marketing Strategy

Your visuals are competing for people’s attention in a crowded space. Generic content gets ignored, while standout visuals make people stop scrolling and engage. 

For your visual marketing strategy to be effective, you need to know your audience inside and out. What grabs their attention? What makes them stop and think? Use visuals to tell your brand story in a way that connects authentically and resonates deeply. Do this well, and your visuals will build instant recognition and help you achieve your goals.

This guide has armed you with the tools and knowledge to take your visual content to the next level. Experiment, analyze results, and let your audience show you what works best. With solid strategy and a dash of creative flair, visuals can tell your unique story and propel your brand forward.

The post Visual Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Humanize AI Content https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ai-content-creation/how-to-humanize-ai-content/ Wed, 26 Jun 2024 06:18:15 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38298 Learning how to humanize AI content is necessary to forge a connection with your target audience and avoid getting labeled as spam by Google. AI is a powerful tool for rapidly generating words and ideas. However, speed and efficiency aren’t everything. A skilled writer’s touch transforms AI outputs into meaningful, authentic stories that resonate with […]

The post How to Humanize AI Content appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Learning how to humanize AI content is necessary to forge a connection with your target audience and avoid getting labeled as spam by Google.

AI is a powerful tool for rapidly generating words and ideas. However, speed and efficiency aren’t everything. A skilled writer’s touch transforms AI outputs into meaningful, authentic stories that resonate with real people. Without human touch, you risk your articles risk becoming mere echoes in the digital void. 

Below, we outline 10 actionable techniques that breathe life into AI-generated text.

What Is AI-Generated Content?

AI-generated content is any text, image, or video created by artificial intelligence systems. 

AI writing assistants are like inexperienced writing apprentices. They can research topics, draft outlines, and write at speed. Just as a junior writer demonstrates raw talent but needs constant guidance, AI-generated content requires an expert touch. Left to its own devices, an AI writing assistant may pepper content with misinformation and telltale signs of AI-generated text.

Human insight, careful editing, and creative storytelling transform AI drafts into content that feels genuine and inspires action. 

Check out our article on the top 10 AI content creation tools.

Why is so much AI content bland and detached?

Large language models,  such as ChatGPT, are nifty tools, but they have limitations. One of the most glaring problems with AI-generated content is a bland and generic voice and tone. 

Here are a few reasons why engaging AI content remains elusive:

  • Reliance on patterns: These tools learn from vast amounts of existing text. As such, they tend to generate content that’s distinctly average, lacking a unique spark and individual voice. This also means telltale words, phrases, and structural patterns show up in its output. 
  • Lack of nuance: AI-generated text can’t capture the subtle complexities of human emotion, humor, and persuasion. As such, the basic text it generates feels generic and uninspiring.
  • Missing context and factual errors: LLMs don’t possess real-world knowledge and can’t put themselves into the shoes of your target audience. Without these elements, output often misses the mark and contains random factual errors. Oh, and LLMs double down on mistakes instead of owning up to them — so you can’t use AI to fact-check itself.
  • Difficulty with originality: AI remixes existing information. To pique an audience’s interest, content needs fresh insights, expert perspectives, and a human-crafted narrative.

Recognizing these shortcomings is the first step to knowing how to humanize AI text.

Why Do I Need to Humanize AI Text?

You should humanize AI text because your content won’t rank on search engines otherwise. AI can generate content quickly, but that doesn’t equate to quality. Google prioritizes articles that are helpful, authoritative, and informative for users. Content that’s low-effort or designed to trick search engines will be banished to obscurity as spam. 

Since Google’s helpful content update, it’s become necessary to create content that fills knowledge gaps and provides web users with value.

To ensure your content achieves its goals, consider these key points:

  • User-first content: You have to focus on the readers’ needs to write something compelling. That means conducting deep research so you can solve problems, answer questions, and provide value. AI struggles to achieve this depth without expert input. 
  • Search engine alignment: Google and other search engines aim to connect users with the best possible answers. Superficial, low-effort, and repetitive content — AI- or human-generated — won’t rank well.

What makes human writing unique and relatable?

Human beings are driven by emotion, and emotion is the magic marketing ingredient that sparks connection. Without emotional experience to draw from, AI struggles to produce authentic content.

Let’s explore why human oversight remains essential for crafting content that connects:

  • Empathy: Humans intuitively grasp the nuances of emotion, allowing them to write with a warmth and understanding that resonates on a deeper level. AI systems may analyze sentiment, but they can’t replicate the genuine feeling that builds trust with a reader.
  • Context: People bring a lifetime of experiences and knowledge to their writing. This allows them to precisely tailor content and address real challenges while catering to cultural nuances and the target audience’s needs.
  • Originality: Ideas are derived from unique perspectives. AI may recombine existing information, but true originality comes from the human ability to think creatively and develop fresh insights.
  • Storytelling: Human beings are natural storytellers who craft narratives that captivate and persuade. AI may follow basic structural forms, but it’s the human ability to weave emotion, surprise, and take readers on a journey that moves audiences.

How to Humanize AI Content 

The human touch remains essential to creating exceptional content that resonates with your audience. Success lies in transforming those initial AI outputs into content that feels uniquely yours.

Here’s a roadmap for infusing your AI-generated drafts with the emotional depth and authenticity readers crave.

1. Leverage AI for research and drafting — not publishing

AI excels at the legwork of content creation, but it’s never publish-ready in its raw form. It can sift through information, identify trends, and provide a rough draft or framework. But remember, AI-generated drafts lack the critical analysis and creative spark that elevate content from informative to engaging. 

  • Original analysis: Use AI-generated research as a foundation for your deeper research. Look into authoritative sources from the past year and use your industry knowledge to elevate the draft.
  • Real-world examples: Connection is built on shared experiences and emotions. Weave in relatable examples, personal anecdotes, or a compelling narrative arc to make content unforgettable.

Assess AI-generated information for accuracy and bias and fill it with unique, expert insights. It’s down to you to shape the final piece so it resonates with your audience. AI is a tool that accelerates the workflow, not a replacement for your mastery.

2. Learn how to prompt AI like a pro

Transform your AI output by injecting details about your audience into prompts. Your prompts have the power to program emotional intelligence into your AI assistant. The better you understand and specify your reader’s pain points and desires, the more likely your AI-generated text will connect with them.

Here’s how to guide your AI assistant:

  • Tell it about the reader’s aspirations: What does your audience hope to become? How do they want to feel?
  • Example: “Write a blog post that inspires amateur bakers to feel confident tackling their first layer cake, emphasizing the joy of the process.”
  • Acknowledge vulnerabilities: Explain readers’ fears or insecurities so the AI can generate content that speaks directly to them, making them feel seen and understood.
  • Example: “Write a social media post acknowledging the anxieties of jobseekers, providing practical tips to boost their confidence.”
  • Use vivid imagery: Sensory details help the AI understand you’re seeking a response that demonstrates empathy and detail.
  • Example: “Describe a decluttered workspace to help the reader envision the sense of calm and focus it brings.”

3. Cut the fluff

AI tools are prone to producing text that feels overly wordy, with redundant words and phrases. Creating impactful content means sharpening your editing skills. Content writing should be concise, focused, and packed with value for your reader.

Here’s how to identify filler:

  • Empty phrases: Look for words or phrases that add no real meaning, such as “at the end of the day” or “in order to.” Cut these ruthlessly.
  • Rambling sentences: If a sentence takes too long to get to the point, break it into shorter, more powerful ones.
  • Repeated words: AI gets attached to certain words. Examples include “specific,” “dive in,” “delve,” “it’s about,” and “meticulous.” Just as you’d make sure your content uses fresh vocabulary throughout, you must edit AI-generated copy for repetition.
  • Redundancy: Does your text repeat the same concept in different ways? Consolidate for clarity.

Why conciseness matters

Here’s why you should avoid unnecessary wordiness and repetition:

  • Engagement: People are busy. Get to the point quickly to hold their attention.
  • Clarity: Filler words and phrases obscure your core message, and eliminating them makes your writing more powerful.
  • SEO: Search engines favor clear, focused content. Editing out fluff can improve your rankings.

Every word should earn its place. When editing AI-generated text, be merciless about cutting anything that doesn’t serve your audience or your core message.

4. Embrace storytelling

Facts and figures inform, but stories invoke emotions and inspire relatability. Even the most cutting-edge AI tool can’t compete with the age-old tradition of storytelling

Imagine your article as a journey. Instead of listing features, guide your readers through and paint a picture they can put themselves into. 

Here’s how to unlock the power of storytelling:

  • Anecdotes: Use brief, relatable stories that illustrate the pain point your content tackles.
  • The hero’s journey: Even in short content, you can create a sense of transformation. Frame your reader as the hero, overcoming a challenge with the help of your product, service, or resource.
  • Sensory details: Engage the reader’s senses with vivid descriptions. This immerses them in the narrative so they feel part of something bigger.

Stories matter because they create an emotional bond between the reader and your content.

Thanks to the connection between memory and emotion, narratives are more likely to stick in a reader’s mind than plain facts and figures. Put simply, when readers are emotionally invested, they’re more likely to take the desired action.

Turning facts and figures into stories 

Let’s look at some examples of turning facts and figures into stories. 

Example 1: Product feature to story

Factual statement: Our software offers real-time collaboration features.

Story: Ever felt the frustration of endless email chains and conflicting edits? With our tool, your team sees the same document, updates appear instantly, and ideas flow effortlessly. That’s the power of real-time collaboration.

Example 2: Statistical data to story

Factual statement: Studies show customers prefer self-service options for simple questions. That’s why you should invest in our AI chatbot. 

Story: Put yourself in a tired customer’s shoes, late at night, searching for a quick answer. They don’t want to sift through long help articles or leave a voicemail. An intuitive chatbot guides them to the solution in minutes, capturing the lead and building trust and loyalty. What’s more, studies show customers prefer self-service options for simple questions. Who doesn’t love convenience?

Storytelling is an age-old superpower. Use it to inject your AI-generated content with the magic that makes it unforgettable.

5. Prioritize emotional intelligence and use active voice

Emotional intelligence in writing goes beyond acknowledging a reader’s feelings. It means empathizing with the deeper aspirations and feelings driving their behavior.

AI excels at analyzing patterns and generating language. But it can’t truly grasp the power of an active writing style. It’s down to you to ensure it demonstrates emotional intelligence.

Along with emotional depth, an active voice makes your writing more dynamic and engaging. Instead of blandly stating what happened, active voice puts the focus on who or what is driving the action. This creates a sense of immediacy and places the reader closer to the heart of your content. 

Here’s an example of active vs. passive voice:

  • Passive voice: The phone was answered promptly.
  • Active voice: Sarah promptly answered the phone.

The first one is bland and doesn’t inspire a reaction. It sounds like a complete and finite statement. However, placing “Sarah” in an active position piques the reader’s curiosity. They may start asking questions and perhaps even making assumptions about her motivations. Once engaged, they want to keep reading and find out more.    

6. Capture your brand’s unique voice

Your brand has a unique personality. People should be able to recognize it the same way they’d recognize a trusted friend. LLMs generate text, but you need to tailor the content to align tone and voice with your brand identity.

Think of your brand voice as a filter all your content passes through. Is it playful and friendly, authoritative and informative, or bold and disruptive? 

Once you’ve clearly defined this voice, here’s how to integrate it with your AI tools:

  • Training data: Feed your AI a curated selection of existing content that embodies your desired tone. For the best results, this should include a mix of blog posts, social media updates, and marketing copy.
  • Fine-tuning: Many AI tools allow you to adjust settings or provide feedback to refine the output’s tone. Experiment until you achieve the desired balance.
  • Word choice: Create a list of words and phrases that do and don’t fit your brand voice. Reference this list when editing your AI-generated content.

Tailoring tone for different audiences

While your core brand voice must remain consistent, subtle shifts in tone may make content resonate with certain audience segments. Consider:

  • Formality: Technical audiences demand a more formal tone, while a casual demographic prefers something more conversational.
  • Humor: When used sparingly and tastefully, humor is a powerhouse. That said, it must align with your brand personality and the audience’s expectations, or it will feel jarring and out of place.

7. Train AI to write like you

Training AI tools on your style encourages consistency across content outputs.

Think about your favorite author or influencer. You recognize their voice through their choice of words, mannerisms, and the themes they explore. Similarly, a distinct style in your content establishes a recognizable brand identity and keeps readers coming back for more.

AI content personalization works best if you use a single AI tool and have an established brand voice. Feed your AI with a curated selection of your writing, such as previous blog posts, articles, scripts, or social media captions. The more data you provide and the more specific your prompts, the better an AI writing assistant becomes at replicating your writing style.

8. Showcase your experience and expertise

AI can’t replace a subject-matter expert’s depth of knowledge and real-world experience. 

Expert collaboration levels up your content creation process. Working with an SME brings fresh perspectives, access to industry data, and the topical authority Google craves. This translates into accurate content that addresses your audience’s pain points and questions.

Let’s look at several ways to integrate expert knowledge:

  • Interviews: In-depth interviews with SMEs allow you to tap into their experience and share it in an engaging, conversational format.
  • Direct quotes: Even short, impactful quotes from experts add credibility and weight to your content.
  • Guest authorship: Inviting SMEs to author or edit articles positions your brand as a hub for thought leadership.

Want to build trust and position yourself as a reliable authority in your field? Demonstrating expertise in your content is essential. When you feature expert voices, you let readers know you go the extra mile to provide them with well-sourced information. 

9. Include user-generated content 

User-generated content is the strongest form of community-building because it encourages your audience to interact directly with each other. 

Reviews, testimonials, social media comments, and photos of customers sporting your product or service showcase the value you deliver to real people. Social proof is powerful. It fosters trust in an environment where readers can be skeptical of polished marketing messages.

Want to learn more about user-generated content? Take a look at our article about UGC, with examples

10. Fact-check and AI-detect

AI-generated text is often full of inaccuracies and biases. Rigorous fact-checking is vital for maintaining the integrity of your content and keeping your audience’s trust.

Here are some strategies for fact-checking AI content:

  • Identify the source: Always trace AI-generated information back to its original source. Evaluate the source’s credibility and double-check for potential biases.
  • Cross-reference: Verify facts across multiple reliable websites, publications, or databases.
  • Be skeptical: Approach AI output with skepticism, especially when it comes to complex or controversial topics.
  • Use primary sources: Go directly to primary sources, such as research papers, government data, educational resources, and original expert interviews.

Utilizing AI detection tools to guarantee content accuracy

AI detection tools are still an evolving technology, but they can help identify potentially problematic content. They analyze text patterns to flag content likely to be AI-generated. While far from foolproof, they add an extra layer of protection. This signals your commitment to transparency with your audience.

Humanizing Your AI Content Journey 

AI writing techniques will continue to improve. For now, you have to know how to humanize AI content for it to stand out and rank in searches. Embracing storytelling, infusing content with brand voice, prioritizing emotional intelligence, and incorporating expert insights transform AI text.

The most effective content creators see AI as a powerful tool, not a replacement for their expertise and creativity. Following these strategies helps you unleash AI’s full potential. Use it to create content that ranks high and establishes your brand as a trusted voice in a crowded digital world.

Bridge the gap between technology and human connection. Discover how our copyediting services can transform your AI content into engaging narratives that delight target audiences and capture your brand’s unique voice.

The post How to Humanize AI Content appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
The Ultimate Guide to Content Distribution https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-ultimate-guide-to-content-distribution/ Wed, 19 Jun 2024 07:10:35 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38282 Does publishing your content sometimes feel like shouting into an abyss? The truth is, even the best ideas need a push to reach their full potential. Effectively accomplishing content distribution will help you consistently connect with the right people, build authority, and achieve your marketing goals. Distribution is a powerful step of a well-constructed content […]

The post The Ultimate Guide to Content Distribution appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Does publishing your content sometimes feel like shouting into an abyss? The truth is, even the best ideas need a push to reach their full potential. Effectively accomplishing content distribution will help you consistently connect with the right people, build authority, and achieve your marketing goals.

Distribution is a powerful step of a well-constructed content strategy. After developing a solid plan and a clear understanding of your audience, distribution is the final touch that amplifies your reach and fuels success. 

As you continue reading, you will find valuable information in this guide that will help transform your content into a powerful business asset.

What Is Content Distribution and Why Is It Important? 

Content distribution is the process of sharing content across relevant online channels to maximize its reach. It’s the final step in your content’s journey, connecting your brand with your audience at the perfect time. 

Benefits of an effective content distribution strategy

Content creation is a labor of love. We get it. And a well-executed distribution strategy makes certain your efforts deliver results.

Meaningful engagement: Quality content sparks conversations. Getting people to talk about your content fosters brand loyalty and establishes thought leadership.

  • Content distribution example: Say a marketing agency publishes an article on the evolving landscape of influencer marketing. Sharing it on LinkedIn starts discussions and debates in the comments section. This engagement establishes the agency as a thought leader and provides readers and potential customers with useful information about the industry.

Increase website traffic: Effective distribution strategies drive qualified traffic back to your website, ultimately bringing in more leads and sales.

  • Content distribution example: An e-commerce company creates a comprehensive guide on “Essential Winter Hiking Gear.” Distributing it on outdoor enthusiast forums, with a clear call-to-action prompting users to visit the website for the full product range, can significantly increase website traffic. 

Enhance brand visibility: A well-curated and consistent distribution strategy across various channels keeps your brand top-of-mind with your target audience.

  • Content distribution example: A bakery creates recipe videos showcasing its signature desserts. Distributing these videos on the brand’s YouTube channel as well as relevant food blogs and subreddits builds brand awareness and recognition. The engaging format and targeted distribution channels ensure the content resonates with specific customers who are actively searching for baking inspiration.

Better SEO: Distributing your content across authoritative websites can improve your website’s search engine ranking and drive organic traffic.

  • Content distribution example: A legal firm publishes an informative blog post on “Understanding Common Clauses in Employment Contracts.” Uploading this content to legal resource websites and sites such as Quora and Reddit can generate backlinks. These backlinks act as signals to search engines that the content is valuable and trustworthy, potentially boosting ranking for relevant search terms.

Establish thought leadership: Consistently sharing valuable and insightful content across relevant platforms establishes your brand as an authority in its industry.

  • Content distribution example: A financial advisor creates a series of educational videos on personal finance tips for young adults. Posting them on YouTube and Reddit positions the advisor as a credible source of information. As a bonus, it attracts potential clients who are actively seeking financial guidance.

Content distribution transforms content into a powerful tool for growth. It ensures your content reaches the right audience, sparks meaningful engagement, and drives real business results.

What Are the Three Types of Content Distribution Strategies?

Your content’s reach hinges on three distribution channels: owned, earned, and paid.

Owned channels: These are your digital properties, such as your website, social media pages, and email newsletters. They’re your content’s home base, where you have full control over the messaging.

Earned channels: You gain visibility organically on these channels. Picture your content being shared across social media, mentioned in industry publications, or linked to from other websites. This buzz of engagement builds credibility, boosts reach, and helps you establish a community.

Paid channels: Propel content using strategic investments such as paid ads on search engines, social media platforms, and sponsored articles. These channels guarantee visibility to a highly specific target audience.

Understanding the three distribution channels is essential for designing a content strategy that maximizes your content’s impact.

Maximize your content’s impact by refining your approach with Crowd Content’s Strategy Services. We highlight the crucial role of planning and creation before distribution, ensuring your content strategy is as effective as possible. Let us help you widen your reach, meet business goals, and engage your audience more deeply.

Click to review and enhance your content strategy now.

Let’s expclore the major distribution channels in depth.

Owned channels

Owned channels are your digital properties. You have complete control over the content, messaging, and distribution. They include your website, blog, social media accounts, email lists, and any other platforms you manage directly.

Here are some examples of how businesses use owned channels:

  • Digital marketing agency: Blogs packed with industry insights and case studies solidify a digital marketing brand’s expertise. 
  • Chain of retirement homes: Websites and blogs feature heartwarming resident stories, advice for families, and details on amenities.
  • Freelance SEO specialist: An optimized website with compelling blog content is vital to demonstrating a freelance SEO expert’s prowess. 

How owned channels differ from earned and paid:

  • Control: You decide what gets published, when, and how it’s presented. This allows for consistent brand messaging and targeted content.
  • Audience: Owned channels tap into your existing audience of followers, website visitors, and subscribers, strengthening relationships.
  • Sustainability: While requiring ongoing effort, owned channels often provide the best long-term return on investment compared to reliance on paid tactics.

Who benefits the most from owned channels? 

  • Businesses of all sizes: Owned channels form the backbone of any digital marketing strategy.
  • Brands building trust: Consistent, valuable content nurtures a loyal audience that views you as reliable and credible.
  • Audience engagement: Direct two-way communication through comments, social media interactions, and email fosters a sense of community.

Pros of using owned channels:

  • Shape your brand voice and tailor your message without leaning heavily on external platforms or algorithms.
  • Build direct relationships with your audience, fostering trust and brand advocacy.
  • The initial investment in content creation pays dividends over time compared to continuously buying paid advertising.
  • Owned channels have rich analytics on audience preferences and content performance, enabling you to refine your future strategy.

Cons of using owned channels:

  • Success requires an ongoing passion for content creation, community management, and audience growth strategies.
  • Building reach on owned channels usually takes significantly longer compared to the immediate reach of paid advertising.
  • Understanding SEO principles, effective content creation, and social media engagement is essential for maximizing results.

Owned channels are the foundation of a well-rounded content distribution strategy. Investing time and resources in these platforms establishes a firm brand presence and generates insights for long-term growth.

Earned channels

Earned channels come from others organically promoting your content through shares, mentions, and backlinks. This type of distribution hinges on building relationships, establishing credibility, and creating genuinely valuable content that resonates.

Here are some examples of how businesses use earned channels:

  • Addiction recovery center: A blog post about overcoming addiction could gain traction on social media and get shared by influencers in the recovery community.
  • SEO agency: Active participation on relevant subreddits, providing insightful advice, builds trust and attracts clients. 
  • HVAC company: Helpful videos on furnace maintenance from YouTube get shared in home improvement Facebook groups, leading to a spike in calls.

How earned channels differ from owned and paid:

  • Trust and credibility: Earned distribution often carries a greater sense of trust, as it comes from an impartial source, serving as social proof. Over the past couple of decades, social proof — as demonstrated in online reviews and testimonials — has emerged as a leading factor in purchase decision-making. Think of it like digital word-of-mouth. 
  • Amplified organic reach: Content can gain exposure to new audiences beyond your existing network.
  • Cost effective: While it requires time and effort, earned distribution is cost effective, with the potential for long-term impact.

Who benefits the most from earned channels:

  • Brands seeking credibility: Endorsements from external sources strengthen your reputation.
  • Companies targeting new audiences: Earned channels open up opportunities to reach beyond your existing followers.
  • Organizations with a limited budget: Earned channels work well for creative brands with budget constraints for paid advertising.

Pros of earned channels:

  • Opens your content up to a wider audience, maximizing reach.
  • Third-party validation strengthens trust and positions your brand as an authority.
  • Quality backlinks from authoritative websites attract new audiences and boost search engine rankings.
  • Exceptionally shareable content has the potential to “go viral” and spread rapidly, reaching a massive audience.

Cons of earned channels:

  • You can’t dictate if or when others share your content, so earned channels require a focus on quality and relationship building.
  • Cultivating relationships and creating share-worthy content takes time and persistent effort.
  • While tools offer insights, tracking the direct impact of earned distribution can be more complex compared to owned or paid channels.

Earned distribution is a testament to the value of your content. While less predictable than other channels, it offers the potential for significant gains in reach, reputation, and authority.

Paid channels

Paid channels are paid investments that guarantee visibility. There are a vast array of options to choose from, allowing you to target your ideal audience with laser focus. From pay-per-click (PPC) advertising to sponsored content partnerships, paid channels deliver shockingly precise targeting.

Here are some examples of how businesses use paid channels:

  • Pest control company: Targeted Google Ads ensure services appear at the top of local search results for keywords such as “pest extermination near me.” Social media ads showcase positive customer testimonials and promotions to a geographically focused audience.
  • E-commerce brand: Retargeting ads on social media remind users of products they viewed, encouraging them to return and complete a purchase. At the same time, sponsored search results drive traffic to specific product pages. 
  • Content writer: Paid guest posts on niche industry blogs offer valuable insights and backlinks to their portfolio. Meanwhile, targeted Google Ads appear for searches such as “freelance copywriter for [industry] in [location].”

How paid ads differ from owned and earned:

  • Guaranteed visibility: Paid channels offer immediate exposure, unlike owned and earned, which largely rely on organic growth.
  • Hyper-targeted reach: Advanced targeting options let you pinpoint your ideal audience by demographics, interests, location, and behaviors.
  • Faster results: Paid distribution can drive traffic and conversions more quickly compared to strategies focused solely on organic growth.

Who benefits the most from paid channels?

  • Businesses seeking rapid growth: Paid channels accelerate reach and boost conversions, especially when entering new markets.
  • Anyone targeting a niche audience: Precise targeting options are ideal for reaching specific demographics or segments.
  • Those looking to measure results: Paid ads usually come with analytics that allow you to track ROI and optimize future campaigns for maximum performance.

Pros of using paid channels:

  • Reach your target audience instantly and bypass the slow build of organic methods.
  • Detailed analytics allow for continuous refinement and improvement of your campaigns.
  • Easily increase or decrease your investment based on your goals and budget.
  • Track conversions and leads to determine the exact return on your advertising spend.

Cons of paid channels:

  • Depending on your industry and keywords, paid advertising can become expensive.
  • Successful paid campaigns require planning, targeting, and optimization.
  • Users can become desensitized to ads, potentially resulting in lower click-through rates over time.

Paid channels are a major boost, helping you reach your ideal audience and achieve desired outcomes. Using strategic execution and exploring advanced options such as native advertising and programmatic buying can propel your content toward widespread success.

How Do I Create a Content Distribution Strategy? 

This section will guide you through the essential steps of creating a content distribution strategy that propels your message to the right people, at the right time.

1. Understand your audience and their expectations

A deep understanding of your target audience is the cornerstone of any successful content distribution strategy. Moving beyond basic demographics, craft detailed audience personas outlining pain points, goals, preferred content formats, and the online platforms your visitors frequent. 

Next, map out how your audience interacts with content. Where do they go for information? What type of content influences their decision-making? Social media is a gold mine for these insights. Extensive research is nonnegotiable for this step. 

2. Identify the ideal content types for your brand and audience

With your target audience firmly in mind, identify the ideal content types that align with your specific marketing goals. Are you aiming for brand awareness, lead generation, or boosting website traffic? Different content types excel in different areas.

For instance, informative blog posts nurture leads and establish brand expertise, while visually engaging videos capture attention and drive social media shares. A successful content mix caters to various learning styles and keeps your audience engaged.

Important note: Don’t get stuck in a single format. Explore the diverse landscape of content options, including blog posts, infographics, videos, social media updates, podcasts, ebooks, and webinars. Allowing your audience to engage with your brand in various formats helps them connect deeply with it, while catering to a variety of tastes.  

3. Plan

A content calendar acts as your roadmap, outlining the content you’ll produce, the distribution channels you’ll use, and your publication dates. This structured approach ensures consistency and aligns content marketing efforts with your broader marketing goals. 

Be sure to map out a purposeful distribution strategy, whether you use a content calendar or not. Carefully considering which channels best suit each piece of content is vital. Not every format is ideal for every platform. Customize and tailor your distribution approach accordingly.  

Finally, keep in mind that timing is everything in the world of digital marketing. Knowing when your audience is most active online and thoughtfully scheduling your content distribution helps maximize engagement and reach.

4. Ensure uniform branding and brand voice across channels

Developing clear brand guidelines is foundational for online success. Your brand’s ingredients include voice, tone, and visual style. They’re the secret sauce for maintaining consistency across all platforms.  

Customize your content for each platform while remaining true to your brand identity. Ultimately, a cohesive brand image across channels builds immediate recognition and solidifies your brand’s reputation in the minds of your audience.

5. Test

A willingness to experiment is vital. Test different content formats, distribution channels, and messaging to analyze what yields the best results for your specific audience and goals.

Pay close attention to analytics. They’re your north star. Monitor insights such as time on page, bounce rates, and click-through rate. Use these insights to refine your strategy, making data-driven decisions to optimize your content distribution efforts. Finally — and very importantly — don’t be afraid to pivot. If something isn’t achieving the desired results, be agile.

6. Execute

Sticking to your content calendar is vital for maintaining steady momentum and a reliable presence in your audience’s eyes. Why? Because consistent publishing signals dedication to potential customers and helps you ride that elusive algorithmic wave. 

Just keep in mind that you must always prioritize quality over quantity. Two high-quality content pieces per week will always outweigh 20 pieces of low-value content. Each asset you publish should provide true value to your audience. 

7. Measure

Focus on the metrics that directly align with your established goals. And whatever you do, be sure to utilize the wealth of analytics tools at your fingertip. These insights tell you exactly what your audience likes and dislikes.

Platforms such as Google Analytics, social media ad tools, and email marketing reports provide detailed data. Creating regular reports helps you analyze performance patterns and highlight areas for improvement.

8. Optimize and iterate

Optimize your strategy by making data-driven decisions and avoiding guesswork and assumptions at all costs. Continuously tweak your content formats, distribution channels, and messaging based on the insights derived from your analytics. 

Poise yourself to experiment with trends and adapt your approach as technologies and audience behaviors shift.

Best Practices to Enhance Your Distribution Strategy

What are the key elements of content distribution? Let’s look at the most critical best practices.

Tool 1: Multiple Formats

Go beyond a blog post. Transform your content into various formats to cater to diverse learning styles and preferences. 

Tool 2: Brand Assets

Create high-quality on-brand visuals such as infographics, images, and videos to elevate content, connect deeply with your audience, and strengthen brand recognition.

Tool 3: Smart Repurposing

Extend your content’s lifespan by adapting it for different platforms. Repurpose infographics into social media posts and video clips into Reels or TikTok content.

Tool 4: Thoughtful Interlinking

Connect your content with internal links to improve user experience and boost SEO, while encouraging exploration of your website.

Tool 5: Guest Posting and Interviews

Tap into new audiences by contributing content to relevant websites and interviewing industry leaders.

Tool 6: Search Engine Optimization

Optimize content with relevant keywords, language that’s relatable to your audience, and meta descriptions to improve search ranking and organic traffic.

Tool 7: Social Media Mastery

Cater content to each social media platform, leveraging features like Stories, Reels, and live streams to maximize engagement.

Tool 8: Email Marketing

Nurture leads and drive conversions with targeted email campaigns featuring your best content.

Eight key strategies to enhance content distribution including SEO, social media, and email marketing.

Top Content Distribution Platforms

Now that you understand the “why” and “how,” all that’s left is “where?” Here’s a breakdown of the four best content distribution channels. 

1. Social media distribution

Social media platforms are where your audience spends time online. Strategize for each platform to meet your audience where they are. Let’s take a closer look:

Overview: Social media is unparalleled for building community, amplifying brand voice, and targeting content to specific audiences through organic posts and paid ads.

Best for: Each platform has its strengths.

  • Facebook: Wide reach, versatile for B2C and B2B
  • Instagram: Visually focused for lifestyle brands, strong with younger demographics
  • X: Live updates, trending news, and niche conversations
  • LinkedIn: Excellent for B2B, networking, and thought leadership
  • YouTube: Great for video tutorials, product demos, and in-depth content

Time to see results: It can yield a quick engagement boost, but long-term success requires consistency and audience understanding.

Why it works: Social media fuels discovery and taps into the power of social sharing for extended reach.

2. Email marketing

Your email list is a direct line to a highly engaged audience. Nurture your audience with compelling content, and they’ll become your biggest advocates and most loyal customers.

Overview: Email marketing is ideal for nurturing leads and driving conversions. Directly reach your most engaged audience: those who opt in to receiving your content. 

Best for: Businesses with an established email list, regardless of industry.

Time to see results: Immediate delivery, open rates, and click-throughs are trackable right off the bat. Nurturing campaigns show results over time. Just be sure to factor in the time and effort it takes to build an engaged email list.  

Why it works: It allows for audience segmentation and provides valuable analytics on content preferences.

3. Content syndication networks

Supercharge your content’s visibility by republishing it on high-traffic websites. Content syndication expands your reach and builds brand awareness.

Overview: Publish content on third-party websites and platforms to expand reach and build brand awareness among new audiences.

Best for: Businesses aiming for high visibility across various reputable sites.

Time to see results: Quickly boosts traffic and reach when done right.

Why it works: Leverages the established audience of external platforms and may boost domain authority for SEO benefits.

4. Online forums and communities 

Become part of the conversation on Quora and Reddit to subtly build your brand’s reputation. Offer genuine advice and insights to establish yourself as a go-to source of information.

Overview: Actively participate in discussions related to your industry, offering helpful answers and subtly referencing your own content where relevant.

Best for: Businesses aiming to build a positive brand reputation by demonstrating expertise and engaging directly with potential customers.

Time to see results: It’s a slow burn, but consistent participation yields trust and brand loyalty, directing interested users to your resources.

Why it works: Leverages the power of conversation and social proof, organically highlighting your brand as a problem solver.

Additional Content Distribution Services 

Digital content distribution services are more far-reaching and targeted than DIY efforts because they lean on broad databases packed with insights. They provide expert support in crafting and implementing a comprehensive distribution strategy. 

Crowd Content can deliver custom content distribution solutions that align with your unique goals. Our team of marketing experts can leverage data-driven insights to optimize your content’s visibility and engagement across various channels.

The post The Ultimate Guide to Content Distribution appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Key Distinctions to Know About Content Strategy vs. Content Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/key-distinctions-to-know-about-content-strategy-vs-content-marketing/ Wed, 19 Jun 2024 06:58:11 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38278 You shouldn’t be asking whether to go with content strategy vs. content marketing. It isn’t an either-or proposition. Both are vital if you intend to reach your audience successfully. Read on for an explanation of content strategy and content marketing, two different but interrelated aspects of your overall digital content strategy. What’s the Difference Between […]

The post Key Distinctions to Know About Content Strategy vs. Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
You shouldn’t be asking whether to go with content strategy vs. content marketing. It isn’t an either-or proposition. Both are vital if you intend to reach your audience successfully. Read on for an explanation of content strategy and content marketing, two different but interrelated aspects of your overall digital content strategy.

What’s the Difference Between Content Strategy and Content Marketing?

Content creation is no longer as simple as blogging once a week. What qualifies as valuable content has evolved, and businesses now rely on content as a powerful tool to differentiate themselves from competitors and reach new customers.

When businesses publish content, they engage current audiences, attract new customers, establish authority, and drive growth. But, to deploy content successfully, it’s essential to understand the nuances between content strategy and content marketing.

While these terms are often used interchangeably, they represent distinct components of a comprehensive digital strategy. Both are geared toward achieving business goals, and they work synergistically together. 

Content strategy acts as a roadmap that guides content creation, laying the foundation for creating and managing your content assets. The strategy guides the purpose, direction, and execution of the content you create, just like a map tells a driver the direction they need to go. 

On the other hand, content marketing leverages your content so it actually reaches the audience. The idea is to use your content to establish authority, foster trust, and ultimately drive customers to choose you when they’re ready to act on their needs. 

Defining Content Strategy

Content strategy guides effective content marketing efforts. Creating a content strategy provides a plan for how your business can use content to achieve specific goals.

Four steps are typically used when creating a content strategy template:

  1. Conduct research to understand your audience. Identify your target audience and create buyer personas. Analyze their pain points so you can address them. Understand what your audience needs at each stage of the buyer’s journey.
  2. Define the purpose and messaging for the content. Establish clear objectives based on your business goals. Define the key messages and themes you want to convey and ensure your messaging aligns with your brand’s values.
  3. Use the information you gather.  This research can guide decision-making about what types of content to produce, when to publish it, and where to distribute it. Identify the channels and platforms where your target audience is the most active. 
  4. Establish metrics to measure the success of your content efforts. Note a baseline of current activities, so you know when there’s a positive or negative change. Continuously revise and adjust your content strategy based on performance data and what your audience asks for.

Content strategy comes before content creation. Developing the strategy first ensures that your content serves a purpose — it should contribute to the overall success of the business.

A strategy should encompass short-term and long-term goals. Decide what you want to achieve in the next month, 6 months, year, and beyond. Content isn’t something you can forget about once you’ve published it, either. A successful strategy also incorporates long-term content management. Your content needs to be updated as time goes on to ensure consistency and relevance across all channels and platforms.

The building blocks of a solid content strategy

Okay, so you’re convinced you need a strong content strategy, but how do you actually build one? Start with a plan that aligns your content efforts with your business goals so your published material drives results. 

A robust content strategy typically includes the following elements:

  • Content mission and goals: The mission provides the overarching purpose for why your organization is creating content. These reasons for content creation should align with and support your business objectives. 
  • Audience research and persona development: Who uses your services or buys your products? Create personas with as much detail as you can. Include ages, genders, locations, income levels, education, and personal values and interests. 
  • Style guide: Create guides covering brand voice and tone, how to use logos and colors, and basics like grammar. 
  • Content audit and gap analysis: Identify areas where your competitors have content that you don’t. When you start publishing content, you can later identify areas where your competitors have content that’s similar to your content but performs better.
  • Content monitoring and processes: Establish workflows and oversight processes to ensure quality and consistency across every piece of content you create. Decide how you plan to evaluate and approve your content and define a procedure for revisions.
  • Content types and formats: Specify the mix of content types that best suit your target audience. This may include blog posts, social media posts, videos, infographics, e-books, podcasts, or webinars.
  • Content creation and curation plans: Once the content types are defined, decide how to ideate and produce new content.
  • Content distribution and promotion strategies: Outline when, how, and where to distribute and promote your content. Establish your company on YouTube and social media platforms, but also consider paid promotion through ads or influencers. On-page SEO should also be considered as an important part of the strategy.
  • Content measurement and optimization: Define which metrics you’ll rely on to determine success once your content is live. Track conversions and analytics so you can spot what’s working and what isn’t. Then, refine your plan as needed. 

Aligning Content Strategy With Business Objectives

Producing content for the sake of producing content is like setting out on a road trip without knowing where you’re going. First, define your business’ purpose, values, and goals. Then, shape the content strategy to support those. 

Every piece of content you create should be a stepping stone that leads your audience where you want them to go. Your content strategy provides the roadmap for your goals, whether that’s to increase brand awareness, generate leads, nurture customer relationships, or drive sales.

Content can deliver tangible results, so your organization’s goals play a crucial role in defining your content creation and content marketing tactics. You can spend time and energy creating all sorts of content, but with a little forethought, that time and energy can lead to your desired outcome.

Content Strategy Examples

Let’s say you’re the owner of a software company looking to develop a content strategy. A majority of your audience needs user manuals and other product documentation. To answer this need, you develop a comprehensive content strategy for creating and managing product documentation. First, you should conduct user research to determine what information your audience needs. Then, define the content types that make sense for your audience. This may include short video tutorials or an expanded FAQ section on your website. 

As another example, you might be revising the corporate website for a manufacturing company to enhance its online presence. Define your target audiences, identify the key messages, and create a content calendar for regular updates. To help search engines easily find and rank your content, implement SEO best practices.

What about a content strategy to develop thought leadership? First, you’d need to identify relevant topics. Then, develop a mix of content formats. This would likely include blog posts, white papers, and webinars. Develop a plan to distribute these formats and establish relationships with other websites where you could contribute. 

Regardless of the types of content you settle on, there should be an established voice and tone. An oversight plan helps to ensure accurate, relevant, and up-to-date information for consistency across all access points.

Understanding Content Marketing

A content strategy provides the recipe, but content marketing is when you really start cooking. Creating, distributing, and promoting content brings your content strategy to life.

Remember, the strategy defines the goals of your content marketing efforts. Unlike traditional advertising, in which a potential customer might walk by a billboard or see a few seconds of one of your TV ads while channel-surfing, content marketing is targeted and focused. Because you’ve developed your audience personas, you know who you’re trying to reach and what their buyer’s journey looks like. 

Effective content marketing tactics

What do you want your customers to do? Create a separate plan for each outcome. Do you want your existing customers to make a new purchase or to purchase an upgraded product to replace one they already have? Do you want people who are new to your brand to subscribe to your newsletter? Or maybe you want to increase your social media followers. Define the goals as part of the strategy, then create an effective content marketing tactic to achieve them. 

Effective content marketing tactics include:

  • Storytelling and brand journalism: Share customer stories and case studies that demonstrate success with your products or services.
  • Educational and informative content: Knowledge-based content can take many forms. Showcase step-by-step tutorials or data-driven research that addresses your audience’s needs.
  • Thought leadership and industry insights: Weigh in on and share transparent information about anything that impacts your industry. 
  • User-generated content and social media engagement: Encourage and reward your customers for engaging with your brand. Acknowledge their comments and reshare. Giveaways or other rewards can help your customers know they’re appreciated.
  • Content repurposing: Get the most out of your content by using it in different ways. For example, turn a video script into a blog post. Convert a webinar into a series of social media posts. Extract key insights from a white paper to create shareable infographics.
  • Cross-promotion: Cross-promote your content on your social media channels, on your website, and in your newsletters. People interact with your brand in different ways and through different means, so this gives them multiple touch points.
  • Lead nurturing and email marketing campaigns: Keep the conversation going once someone has engaged with your brand by sending them information that helps them learn about and grow with your products or services. 
  • Influencer collaborations and guest posting: When people see influencers or other brands they respect using or promoting a product, it often reinforces trust and credibility.

Choosing the right channels for content distribution

Where does your audience spend time online and consume content? A brand that appeals to young people may want to optimize interactions on TikTok. A DIY-oriented brand would likely find success on a highly visual platform, such as YouTube or Instagram. Steer your content toward the platform that’s right for your audience.

Different distribution channels appeal to different demographics, interests, and behaviors. Research your audience’s preferences through surveys, social listening, or analytics. Find them where they’re already active.

Content Marketing Examples

Imagine you’re developing a content marketing framework for a clothing company. Your marketing may start with a TikTok account featuring fashion tips. A lookbook on your website could show different ways to style the outfits. You could share behind-the-scenes stories of how your clothes are made and how you decide on your styles. Finally, you might share photos of actual customers wearing your clothes to build brand loyalty. 

Content marketing examples for a software company, on the other hand, might involve creating a podcast featuring interviews with industry experts and customer success stories. You might share regular product updates through a newsletter. You could foster engagement with existing users on social media channels and attract potential customers by contributing content to other popular sites with industry-leading blogs. 

In both examples, the created content could be promoted across your social media channels and through email newsletters.

Synergizing Content Strategy and Marketing for Impact

While content strategy and content marketing have distinct roles, they rely on each other for success. A well-defined content strategy provides the foundation for effective content marketing. If you’re creating content that doesn’t take your organization’s goals into account, or if you’re creating content that doesn’t align with your values as a company, your content efforts will likely be ineffective. For example, if your brand relies on a message of sustainability, you should avoid creating content that inadvertently promotes environmental harm.

Integrating strategy and marketing for enhanced impact

When content strategy and marketing work together, it creates a cohesive experience for your audience. When the efforts are aligned, messages are consistent across all platforms, and your content resonates with the people you’re trying to reach. This integration is important to ensure your content drives desired outcomes. 

Adapting content strategies in dynamic markets

If there’s one thing any content creator will tell you, it’s that the digital market is an ever-changing target—but there are ways to ensure you can still hit it. In addition to being flexible, keep an eye on the overall market so you’re aware of when you need to adapt. Ideally, you’ll figure this out before the need arises instead of responding to something you didn’t anticipate. 

Successful organizations understand effective content strategies and marketing efforts are adaptable. Consumer behaviors change, trends emerge, and technologies evolve. By combining best practices with a flexible approach, businesses stay responsive.

Measuring Success

Consistently measure your content’s performance through well-defined key performance indicators. Identify the key metrics necessary to determine the effectiveness of your content marketing efforts. Without knowing what numbers you’re tracking, it’s impossible to understand what’s working, what’s not, and how to optimize for better results. Use a range of analytics tools and techniques. 

Key metrics for content success

In general, there are several broad categories of metrics content teams should measure.

  • Website metrics: Page views, unique visitors, traffic sources, engagement, conversion rates
  • Search metrics: Organic search traffic, keyword rankings, technical SEO factors
  • Social media metrics: Reach, engagement, shares, mentions, audience growth
  • Email metrics: Open rates, click-through rates, unsubscribe rates, conversions
  • Lead generation: Lead volume, marketing qualified leads, sales qualified leads 
  • Sales impact: Opportunities influenced, deal value, customer acquisition costs
  • Return on investment: Content costs for your efforts compared to the profit your efforts generate

Overcoming Challenges in Strategy and Marketing

Even with the best content strategy and marketing, challenges inevitably arise. As mentioned above, the market changes quickly, which means goals change too. Organizations often face obstacles when it comes to adapting and executing. 

To ensure success in the face of difficulties, it’s essential to understand your audience and your market in as much depth as possible. Continuously monitor how you allocate your resources to be sure you’re using them wisely. Assess the messages you’re sharing and why. Determine if you’re reaching enough people to achieve your goals. Empower your team to communicate with you about any concerns, challenges, or opportunities they encounter. This knowledge should help you stay on course.

Navigating common content strategy and marketing challenges

One common challenge arises when teams are working on different aspects of a single goal without the knowledge of what the other is doing. You can prevent this by fostering cross-team collaborations. Ensure everyone in your organization knows what the overall goals are and what part they play in reaching those goals.

You should establish shared goals and metrics that keep everyone working toward the same objectives. Clear guidelines and responsibilities for everyone on your team may help support this. Delegate an individual or a group to review the content for consistent and appropriate messages. 

And don’t forget to stay agile. It’s imperative you develop a plan that’s also flexible with changing market conditions or audience needs. 

Bridging Strategy and Marketing for Content Excellence

Remember, excellent content follows naturally from an excellent plan. A harmonious relationship between your content strategy and your content marketing brings your strategy to life. Whether your goal is to increase sales or establish yourself as a leader in your industry, fuel your growth by creating a plan and using it to create compelling, goal-driven content.Tap into Crowd Content’s content strategy expertise to boost your digital impact. See how our content strategy services can revolutionize your marketing efforts and elevate your brand. Start planning your content strategy now.

The post Key Distinctions to Know About Content Strategy vs. Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
30 Essential Content Marketing KPIs You Can’t Ignore https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/30-essential-content-marketing-kpis-you-cant-ignore/ Wed, 19 Jun 2024 06:48:18 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38276 Head-turning content marketing campaigns that get people excited about brands don’t simply happen. They result from thorough planning, an in-depth understanding of the target audience, and an airtight strategy for monitoring continuous progress. Tracking the right content marketing KPIs is a crucial part of that equation. But what exactly are content marketing KPIs, and what […]

The post 30 Essential Content Marketing KPIs You Can’t Ignore appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Head-turning content marketing campaigns that get people excited about brands don’t simply happen. They result from thorough planning, an in-depth understanding of the target audience, and an airtight strategy for monitoring continuous progress. Tracking the right content marketing KPIs is a crucial part of that equation.

But what exactly are content marketing KPIs, and what do you use to measure content success when you’re serious about staying competitive? Here, we’ll discuss some of the most critical content marketing KPIs to keep in mind as you map out your next strategy.

What Is a KPI in Content Marketing?

KPI, or “key performance indicator,” refers to quantifiable values that content marketers use to assess the health and progress of a long-term strategy or a particular campaign. Engagement, audience reach, and conversion rate are a few examples that can help a marketer better measure progress toward a specific objective.

Data is the key to tracking the success of any endeavor. It offers clear evidence of whether your goals have been met, surpassed, or not reached. Analyzing data can also help savvy marketers identify golden opportunities for cost savings, brand expansion, or engagement with new demographic groups.

Today’s content marketing landscape is ever-changing, and successful marketers evolve accordingly. Proactively leveraging your data and tracking carefully selected content marketing KPIs keeps you ahead of the curve in all the right ways. The following examples are 30 critical content marketing KPI examples to watch moving forward.

Website Content Marketing KPIs

A website’s ability to attract and engage visitors is critical to the success of your content marketing efforts. Here are some essential KPIs for measuring content success related to website performance.

1. Impressions

If impressions are lower than expected, try tweaking your keyword strategy or reassessing your targeting goals to ensure you’re going after the right demographics. In the case of paid advertising, consider whether it might be worthwhile to kick your budget up a notch.

Impressions count the total number of times content is displayed to unique users on various platforms. 

It’s also important to note that as search engines evolve, the number one search result on Google isn’t necessarily the most desirable SERP position anymore. Features like knowledge panels and featured snippets are much more visible, and SEO strategies are evolving to include them. However, such features often fulfill user queries directly on the search page, potentially reducing traffic to websites.

2. Website traffic

When it comes to primary digital marketing analytics, website traffic is one of the first KPIs that most marketers think of, and with good reason. Website traffic numbers help you better understand your site’s overall reach and user interaction.

Gain additional insights into this metric by delving into individual traffic sources to learn more about how people find your sites. Reinvest in successful entry points (social media, Google ads, etc.) and content types. Analyze the paths visitors follow as they explore your site for additional insights into user behavior.

3. SEO rankings

Visibility is important; even the most well-written content won’t help a brand if no one can find it. Keeping tabs on your SEO rankings allows you to measure the effectiveness of your ongoing efforts.

Ensure your rankings keep moving in the right direction by making keyword research an ongoing part of your approach, taking care to include plenty of trending terms. Focus on building your backlink catalog, crafting uniquely useful content, and updating your high-performing content articles to keep them relevant.

4. Time spent on page

Attracting visitors to your content is only part of the battle when it comes to winning the content marketing game. You also need to hold their attention once you’ve got it, and tracking content marketing metrics like time spent on a page can help you determine how well you’re doing this.

Longer page dwell times generally correlate to higher engagement rates, so explore different ways to drive those numbers up. Add graphics and videos to lend visual interest. Ensure content is readable and easy to consume by organizing it well, using clear headings, and a narrative flow that guides readers smoothly from section to section.

5. Repeat visitor ratio

How do new visitors behave once they’ve discovered your content? Is that the last you see of them, or do they keep returning for more? Your repeat visitor ratio clues you into how well you’re cultivating user loyalty and fostering ongoing interest in what you’re doing content-wise.

Content marketers can improve this metric by giving audiences more of what they want, personalizing the user experience, updating popular content, and consistently publishing new articles. Additionally, promote engagement through social media and email subscriptions so your audiences never miss a content drop.

6. Lead generation

While content marketing is certainly about delivering standalone value to audiences, it’s important to remember it’s also about turning curious consumers into paying customers. Content manager KPIs like lead generation help lend valuable insight into this process.

Before you can begin nurturing leads, you need to generate qualified ones via ethical but effective tactics. Examples to consider include:

  • Using powerful calls-to-action (CTAs).
  • Implementing gated content to capture data.
  • Offering incentives like freemium content to encourage visitors to opt into mailing lists or follow on social media.

7. Quality of leads

Beyond quantity, quality of leads is also important, especially for brands in the SaaS sector and other highly specific niches. However, all brands can benefit from targeting consumers who are not only likely to convert but also ready to.

Personalized content is key, as relevance is essential for capturing and retaining user interest. So can targeting individuals across all stages of a typical buyer’s journey. Utilize tools like buyer personas to help your content production team better target and personalize key content efforts.

8. Voice search optimization success

With the rising popularity of voice-operated options like Alexa and Google Assistant, voice search optimization is ever more important. Keep track of metrics that help assess how voice search-friendly your content is.

Make your content easier to discover via voice search by using long-tail keywords and conversational tone that reflects natural speech patterns. Leverage schema markup to structure your data to help search engines understand it better. If your business is location-specific, pay attention to local SEO, as well.

Content-Focused Marketing KPIs showcasing eight metrics.

Content-Focused Marketing KPIs

Naturally, your content (both written and visual) is the heartbeat of any digital marketing strategy, so KPIs related to its structure and performance are crucial concerns. Here are a few content performance metrics to watch closely.

9. Content production speed

Quality may be king in content production, but consistency is queen. Content marketing success in 2024 calls for more than just informative, high-quality content. Marketers aiming to keep their brands top of mind must also generate content regularly, making content production speed an important KPI to know.

Developing a comprehensive content calendar that includes everything from updates to your company blog to your social media channels and newsletter can help you stay ahead of content production. Consider repurposing existing content and delegating creation tasks to expert writers and creators to streamline the process.

10. Content accessibility score

Inclusion and accessibility are the orders of the day in 2024, including when it comes to content marketing. Tracking your content accessibility score helps ensure your output adheres to all current quality standards and is as helpful as possible to all users, including those with disabilities.

You can keep your content accessibility score high by making your content as easy to consume as possible. Use large fonts that are easy to read, pay attention to strong contrast between text and background colors, and use headings to lend structure and readability to written content. Look into additional options like video captions, text transcripts, and accessible visual elements.

11. Content innovation index

In a digital landscape where every brand competes online with eye-catching content, genuine uniqueness is priceless. The more innovative and original your content is, the better it will perform in capturing the attention of your target audience.

You can boost your content innovation index by developing a deep understanding of your target audience and their needs. Pay attention to what’s already working for you, and use what you know to strike a solid balance between familiar and novel moving forward. Also, be sure to add your unique voice to your content – your most distinct asset that cannot be replicated by others. 

12. Content update frequency

While producing plenty of fresh, original content is crucial, you don’t want to leave your existing content out in the cold when it comes to your ongoing strategy. Updating existing web content frequently – especially any that consistently draws traffic your way – keeps it visible to search engines and relevant for your audience.

To optimize this KPI, plan for quarterly updates for topics that change often.  Annual updates are sufficient for key evergreen topics that are more stable.Integrate content updates into your ongoing content calendar to keep efforts consistent and timely.

13. User-generated content volume

Saying user-generated content (UGC) is a game-changer for brands in 2024 is a real understatement. UGC boosts engagement rates, drives interest in key products or services, and builds trust through compelling social proof. For that reason, tracking UGC volume can lend marketers powerful insight into how well they’re engaging their audience.

Encourage more UGC by actively requesting your to share their experiences or give feedback. Hold contests, giveaways, and similar events to incentivize incredible UGC, and be sure to engage with those who follow through by commenting and sharing.

14. Multimedia content engagement

Successful content marketing involves more than just written content like blogs, ebooks, and social media status updates. Today’s audiences crave and seek out variety in their content, and different demographics may have specific preferences to keep in mind.

Include multiple forms of media in your own content strategy – for example, videos, infographics, interactive graphics, etc. – alongside your standard written content. Add multimedia content engagement to your running list of trackable content marketing KPIs to gauge which content formats are most popular with your audience. Pay special attention to universally popular options like short-form videos as they tend to attract broad interest.

15. Content sentiment analysis

As important as facts and information are when it comes to getting a consumer to finalize a purchase decision, emotions are a lot more powerful. Create content that makes people feel things, and you’re well on your way to crafting an established, popular brand. Tracking content marketing KPIs like content sentiment ensures you stay aligned with these goals.

Sentiment analysis evaluates your content by comparing the frequency of positive versus negative expressions. Mood-associated words that invoke feelings of confidence, encouragement, professionalism, etc., also factor into the mix. Utilize AI tools – like Grammarly, to name just one – to help in this analysis. Apply what you learn to fine-tune the emotional appeal of your content and invoke desired responses.

16. Content experimentation rate

Constant experimentation and innovation are crucial to maintain a vibrant and successful content marketing strategy. But it’s equally important to track the success of all your attempts, so you know what’s working and what’s not. Monitoring content experimentation rate and related content marketing KPIs can help you here.

A/B testing is a proven method for comparing two or more versions of a campaign or content approach. Monitor specific metrics like test velocity, quality, win rate, and percentage uplift to gain additional insights into what’s really working and why.

Various Content Marketing KPIs including impressions and SEO rankings.

Branding and Marketing-Focused Content Marketing KPIs

Effective KPI tracking in marketing means staying on top of metrics that reveal how you’re doing with your branding efforts, content performance, and overall return on your marketing investment. Here are some KPIs to help you do that.

17. Return on investment (ROI)

At the end of the day, content marketing is a business investment, so tracking the ROI of content marketing efforts is imperative. ROI is expressed as a percentage that compares the gains from your investment against the initial costs. To calculate ROI, use the formula: (return – investment ÷ investment) x 100 = ROI.

However, ROI also has a qualitative aspect. In addition to the financial numbers, consider factors like lead generation, customer loyalty rates, and overall brand awareness when determining ROI.

18. Brand awareness lift

In a nutshell, brand awareness speaks to how likely consumers are to instinctively recognize your brand or any of its products, services, slogans, or visual assets. The better your brand awareness, the more likely people are to actually choose your brand in competitive markets.

And what do you measure in content marketing when you want to gauge your ongoing brand awareness lift rate? Be on the lookout for metrics like share of voice, referral traffic, branded search volume, and earned media coverage. Enhance visibility by creating relevant content, distributing it across multiple channels, and supporting it with consistent promotion efforts.

19. Share of voice

Don’t underestimate the importance of share of voice (SOV) when assessing potentially useful content marketing KPIs. SOV measures how well your audience is vibing with your brand overall and how well it’s doing compared to your competition. You can leverage SOV to help you analyze social media performance, PPC advertising strategy, organic traffic, etc.

Ensure a healthy share of voice metrics by researching your audience and staying on top of their evolving needs and expectations. Develop shareable content to match and infuse it with your unique brand voice. Collaborating with influencers, thought leaders, and other brands can also help with SOV.

20. Content cost vs. performance

Just as it’s important to keep track of your overall content marketing ROI, you’ll also want to track your content cost vs. performance to ensure your efforts are as productive as possible. Useful metrics to consider include views, engagement rate, user behavior, number of new users, traffic numbers, etc.

Maximize your content’s efficiency by fully optimizing and repurposing it across multiple platforms in ways that make sense for your brand. Form strategic partnerships to expand your reach and help your content find new audiences. Invest in content types and approaches that resonate well with your audience.

21. Influencer collaboration effectiveness

Influencer marketing can be a powerful way to expand your reach for several reasons. Influencers come attached to highly engaged audiences who take recommendations to heart. Partnering with the right candidates in your niche can really take your brand awareness to the next level. However, keeping track of metrics related to influencer collaboration effectiveness is important.

Specify clear goals for your collaborations, communicate them to your partners, and track KPIs that align accordingly. Analyze ongoing collaborations and make adjustments as needed to optimize results. Learning from past campaigns can strengthen future efforts.

Branding and Marketing-Focused Content Marketing KPIs with five categories.

Audience and Customer Content Marketing KPIs

No comprehensive list of the best KPIs for content marketing would be complete without metrics that help you fully gauge how your content is landing with existing and potential customers. Here are some examples of essentials to keep in mind.

22. Engagement rate

Tracking engagement rates is a key part of gauging the overall success of your content. People engage with content that resonates with them. They comment on it, share it on their social media feeds, and reference it when producing their own content. Algorithms take note of all those little interactions and show engaging content to even more people.

To elevate engagement, consider incorporating calls for audience interaction or developing dynamic, interactive content. Such types of content not only captivates but also improves memory retention and overall brand recall due to its immersive nature.

23. Conversion rate

In content marketing, your conversion rate (CVR) reflects the overall percentage of web visitors who successfully complete a desired action. That action could be to finalize a sale, but it could also be to download freemium content, sign up for a mailing list, follow on social media, etc.

Higher conversion rates imply effective content that successfully educates, persuades, and leads audiences to act. You can fortify your content conversion rates by improving your overall user experience, crafting compelling calls to action, and highlighting key value propositions in your copy. Implement A/B testing to refine your messaging and improve content strategies across different formats.

24. Email open rates

If you’re like most people, you’re on multiple branded mailing lists but don’t necessarily have time to open every email you receive. Chances are you open the ones that seem most relevant to you or otherwise pique your curiosity and forego the rest. Your customers are the same.

The likelihood of an email being opened increases with its relevance and personalization. Segment your recipient lists according to criteria like past behavior, demographics, or location, and personalize email blasts accordingly. Craft irresistible subject lines, and be sure to send messages at optimal times to boost the chances of engagement.

25. Social shares

In a digital world where almost everyone has a social media presence and spends time on their favorite platforms daily, your social share metric is one of the most critical content marketing KPIs to monitor. People share content that resonates with them and that they’re proud to endorse to their friends and followers.

Determine where your target audience spends their social media time and build a strong, active presence on those platforms. Tailor your content for maximum shareability on each platform, incorporating visuals, strong headlines, and social sharing buttons into website content to boost your content’s shareability.

26. Customer retention rate

Well-crafted content is more than an effective way to attract new potential customers in your direction. When used wisely and approached skillfully, it can encourage loyalty and repeat business.

After defining your goals, do a deep dive into your audience’s pool of interest. Serve up content that meets their needs as repeat customers and brand-loyal consumers. You could include options that help clients get more out of existing purchases or take better care of the products they already own. Serialized content can also be effective in making sure your customers are engaged over time.

27. Audience growth rate

Tracking and analyzing your audience’s growth rate can give you valuable marketing insight into how well your overall content strategy is going. Examining details like traffic sources and comparing the strength of your presence on different platforms can tell you a thing or two about your current market reach.

You can supercharge your audience growth rate metric by prioritizing innovation in your content approach. Focus on informing, entertaining, and genuinely delighting your customers with your content offerings. Form partnerships with influencers and other thought leaders in your niche to expand your reach even further.

28. Customer satisfaction score (CSAT) post-content interaction

Monitoring how satisfied your customers are after interacting with your branded content is a solid way to assess how well your content offerings meet their needs. Content that is interacted with, shared, or endorsed typically meets or exceeds expectations.

Examining engagement KPIs (like conversion rate, churn rate, retention rate, and bounce rate) helps you get a more detailed read on how you’re doing here.

Customer feedback loops also lend valuable insight. Pay attention to what customers say in their comments and share captions. (Social listening interfaces may help catch everything.) Utilize  feedback via polls, surveys, and social media posts to enhance your content strategies

29. Net Promoter Score (NPS) related to content

Net Promoter Score (NPS) is a simple but informative metric that measures overall customer satisfaction, loyalty, and enthusiasm about a brand. To obtain one, you ask customers one simple question: “On a scale of 1 to 10, how likely are you to recommend us to a friend?”

A high NPS often correlates with customers who enjoy their experience enough to recommend it to others. Apply NPS to gain insight into how your customers feel about your content. Focus your content strategy on delivering helpful, entertaining content throughout every stage of the customer life cycle to maintain high NPS levels.

30. Content reach by geographic location

Understanding where your customers are from can help you more effectively tailor content to their needs. Examine your content and traffic metrics to assess where your reach is the strongest. Are most of your customers local or global? Are there specific cities or regions where your reach is particularly strong?

Explore unique behaviors, preferences, and purchasing patterns  of these areas to create tailored content. Ensure you’re paying enough attention to local SEO related to those locations to enhance your reach further.

Audience and Customer Content Marketing KPIs with eight categories.

Elevating Your Content Strategy with KPIs

Although commonly tracked KPIs like web traffic, customer engagement, and customer retention rate should always make your list of go-to content marketing KPIs, they’re not all there is to the picture. Monitoring and analyzing a well-rounded list that includes gems like the examples listed above gives you a much fuller understanding of how you’re really doing and helps you stay competitive in an increasingly crowded digital space.

Ready to take your content marketing game to the next level? Let the seasoned content experts at Crowd Content help you revolutionize your strategy and fully leverage key content marketing KPIs to maximize your brand success. Get in touch today, and tell us more about your content goals.

The post 30 Essential Content Marketing KPIs You Can’t Ignore appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Master Content Planning With Editorial Calendar Templates https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/master-content-planning-with-editorial-calendar-templates/ Wed, 19 Jun 2024 06:19:23 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38269 Business goals are the cornerstones of any content strategy. Without established brand messaging, people, search engines, and social media algorithms won’t understand your brand or care about your content. Plus, in the era of multichannel distribution, each piece must be tailored to the various platforms your customers prefer.  Using editorial calendar templates is the only […]

The post Master Content Planning With Editorial Calendar Templates appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Business goals are the cornerstones of any content strategy. Without established brand messaging, people, search engines, and social media algorithms won’t understand your brand or care about your content. Plus, in the era of multichannel distribution, each piece must be tailored to the various platforms your customers prefer. 

Using editorial calendar templates is the only way to make it happen. It creates structure, enabling you to publish consistent, quality content and keep your brand at the top of customers’ minds. 

Consumers’ thirst for content is limitless. If you deliver value and know your audience, you can reach them. But if you don’t publish enough to keep them hydrated, they quench their curiosity elsewhere. Here’s our guide to creating, implementing, and maintaining an editorial calendar. 

Components of an Editorial Calendar Template

From evergreen articles to seasonal campaigns, you can tailor an editorial calendar template to back your brand’s goals. Let’s look at the essential components:

  • Content type: From blog posts to social media updates and email newsletters, editorial calendars accommodate various content types. This versatility ensures you attract a broad audience.
  • Publication dates: Stay on track with scheduled publication dates to maintain engagement and visibility for all team members. Flexibility is key here, allowing you to adapt to shifting priorities and seasonal trends. 
  • Channels: Specify where each piece of content should be published to ensure a cohesive schedule across all platforms.
  • Viral opportunities: Anticipate and capitalize on viral moments by aligning your content with industry events and trending topics. Forward planning prevents last-minute scrambles.
  • Responsible team members: For complex projects, incorporate a simple RACI chart detailing roles and responsibilities. This streamlines collaboration and creates accountability within your team.
  • Status: For straightforward projects where designated roles are established, use status columns to indicate the production stage of each order. As the statuses shift, collaborating team members are notified it’s their turn to step in. 
  • Content brief: While the project brief’s instructions apply to the content type as a whole, each piece typically pairs with a content brief. Content calendars simplify the review process, so why not provide all the resources in one spot? 

Why every content team needs a template 

Proactivity delivers better results than reactivity. Planning content a week ahead of time doesn’t leave wiggle room for shifts in your marketing strategy, which is likely to change occasionally. But there’s more to it than punctuality. Here are more benefits of using an editorial calendar:

  • Improved organization: Centralizing content planning and scheduling helps your team stay on track with content goals.
  • Enhanced collaboration: Clear assignment of roles and responsibilities fosters better collaboration among team members, reducing confusion and doubling-up of efforts.
  • Consistency: A structured editorial calendar ensures a consistent publishing schedule, which is essential for maintaining audience engagement and brand credibility and surfing the elusive algorithms.
  • Strategic alignment: Editorial calendars enable teams to align content with marketing objectives by providing high-level overviews of how each piece of content contributes to business goals.

An editorial calendar brings order to chaos. If you’re always chasing your tail, going from ideation to strategy to publication, you need a template. Download our editorial calendar template, and breathe a sigh of relief.

How to Craft an Editorial Calendar Template

If only content creation were as easy as hiring a skilled writer and asking them to create an article for you. Your brand strategy, business goals, ideation, and content strategy must be watertight long before pen meets paper. This requires relentless attention to detail and a deep knowledge of your audience’s pain points. 

Brand strategy comes first 

Your brand must have a clear identity, including unique personality, tone, values, and objectives. Next, craft a brand story that speaks to your audience’s desires, fears, and aspirations. With a brand strategy firmly in place, you never run out of content ideas or post articles that misalign with business goals. 

Step-by-step guide to crafting an editorial calendar

Here’s a step-by-step guide to creating an editorial calendar:

  1. Define goals and objectives. Nail down your goals and objectives, whether they’re boosting brand awareness or driving leads. Your editorial calendar should be laser-focused on your targets.
  2. Research your audience. Get to know your audience inside and out. Dive deep into demographics, preferences, and pain points to tailor your content accordingly.
  3. Ideate and plan the content. Brainstorm content ideas for the upcoming year that hit the mark with your audience and brand messaging and nod to potential viral moments. 
  4. Map ideas onto your content calendar. Once you have a pool of content ideas, map them out on your editorial calendar. Consider seasonal relevancy, industry trends, and key events that may impact your audience’s interests.
  5. Be specific. Allocate dates for each piece of content, ensuring a balanced mix of topics and formats each month. This helps you maintain engagement and motivates your audience to return for more.
  6. Initiate content creation and collaboration. Assign tasks to your team and ensure everyone knows their role and deadlines. Collaboration is key here — writers, designers, and stakeholders should all be on the same page.
  7. Start to publish and distribute the finished product. It’s time to get your content out there. Determine the best channels and timing for publication, maximizing your reach and engagement.
  8. Maintain flexibility. Allow space for spontaneous content opportunities and last-minute adjustments to accommodate changes in your marketing strategy or the industry landscape.
  9. Monitor your content’s success and optimize early on. Keep a close eye on your content’s performance using tools like Google Analytics. Track metrics such as impressions and organic traffic to fine-tune your editorial calendar.

SEO integration within your calendar

As Google’s algorithm grows ever more sophisticated, SEO becomes increasingly important. You’re not just optimizing content to meet a few criteria anymore — search algorithms expect high-quality, people-first content that delivers value. 

Here’s how to weave SEO into your editorial calendar:

  • Keyword mapping: Make sure each piece strategically targets specific keywords to enhance its visibility in the SERPs. Use keyword research tools and allocate relevant phrases to each piece on your editorial calendar. Consider search volume, competitiveness, and how the phrases fit into the marketing funnel to pinpoint search intent. 
  • Content mapping: Harmonize your editorial calendar with content mapping exercises. Identify topics and themes that resonate with your audience and integrate them into your calendar for a cohesive SEO strategy.
  • Content gap analysisIdentify gaps in your content coverage using SEO tools and analytics. Schedule content ideation sessions to address gaps so you can capture untapped search opportunities.
  • Topic clusters and pillar content: Consider organizing your calendar around topic clusters and pillar content. Identify core topics and supporting subtopics to create a cohesive content ecosystem that strengthens your website’s topical authority.
  • Seasonal planning: Capitalize on seasonal trends and search queries when crafting your editorial calendar. Embed timely themes related to seasonal events, holidays, and industry trends to leverage spikes in search traffic.
  • On-page optimization schedule: Incorporate on-page optimization directly within your editorial calendar. Assign specific time slots or deadlines for optimizing metadata, headers, and other on-page elements.

Infuse your editorial calendar with SEO best practices so your content attracts more organic traffic and solidifies brand authority online. 

Best Practices for Implementing Your Editorial Calendar

Looking for ways to level up your editorial calendar game? Follow these editorial calendar best practices to drive organic traffic and establish your brand as a force to be reckoned with. 

Collaborative excellence 

Forge strong cross-functional partnerships within your team to drive collaborative content planning. Reward experimentation and creativity whenever possible to demonstrate you embrace bold ideas and innovative approaches. 

Data-driven insights 

Regularly cast a keen eye over key performance indicators to determine areas for improvement. Use these insights to guide future content decisions, prioritizing initiatives with the highest ROI. 

Experiment with A/B testing to gauge perception and optimize engagement. Keep refining your approach based on this type of solid evidence, focusing on strategies that deliver tangible results. 

Content repurposing and amplification

Breathe new life into content through strategic repurposing. Locate the timeless gems within your content library and reshape and revitalize them to reach fresh audiences. You can even repurpose content for different social platforms to extend your content’s reach.

For amplification, play with diverse multimedia formats, such as videos, infographics, and podcasts, to cater to varied preferences and consumption habits.

Crowd Content’s Downloadable Editorial Calendar Template

Designed to streamline your planning process and maximize efficiency, our template is your ticket to organized and strategic content creation. 

How to use your downloadable template

Getting started with our editorial calendar template is a breeze. Navigate to the resources section of our website or scroll to the bottom of the page, where you’ll find the template available for download. Once downloaded, open the file using your preferred spreadsheet software, and you’re ready to roll.

The template is intuitively designed, with clearly labeled sections for content type, publication dates, channels, viral moments, responsible team members, and more. Input content ideas, deadlines, and team assignments, and marvel as your content strategy comes to life.

Customizing Crowd Content’s editorial calendar template 

What sets Crowd Content’s template apart is its flexibility and adaptability to various content strategies. Whether you’re a solopreneur managing a blog or a marketing team overseeing multiple campaigns, you can tailor our template to suit your needs.

Customization options abound, allowing you to add or remove columns, adjust date formats, and personalize categories to align with your brand’s unique requirements. Need to incorporate SEO keywords or track content performance metrics? Our template can accommodate it all.

Say goodbye to scattered content planning and hello to a results-driven strategy.

The post Master Content Planning With Editorial Calendar Templates appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Use AI for Content Creation https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ai-content-creation/how-to-use-ai-for-content-creation/ Wed, 29 May 2024 03:36:24 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38232 Using AI for content creation is about to change your life. AI isn’t here to steal your creative thunder; it’s a secret weapon you can use to brainstorm fresh angles, conduct deeper research, and refine your writing with precision. In today’s digital marketing battleground, understanding AI-powered content creation isn’t just a clever move — it’s […]

The post How to Use AI for Content Creation appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Using AI for content creation is about to change your life.

AI isn’t here to steal your creative thunder; it’s a secret weapon you can use to brainstorm fresh angles, conduct deeper research, and refine your writing with precision. In today’s digital marketing battleground, understanding AI-powered content creation isn’t just a clever move — it’s a necessity. 

Savvy marketers are already using AI to unlock new levels of efficiency and transform their workflows. But like any powerful tool, AI has a learning curve. Understanding how to navigate its complexities is key to harnessing its power and staying at the top of your game.

The Evolution of AI for Content Creation

The evolution of AI in content creation was slow and steady until the turn of the millennium, when technological advancement suddenly skyrocketed. The idea of AI might feel cutting-edge today, but the groundwork has been laid for decades. 

Timeline showing milestones in AI development from the 1950s to present.

Let’s break down the key milestones:

  • Early days (1950s-1990s): The foundation for AI was initially laid with Alan Turing’s 1950 paper, Computing Machinery and Intelligence, and the development of Eliza, a rudimentary chatbot. Basic spell-checkers and grammar tools later hinted at AI’s potential.
  • Natural language processing (NLP) advances (2000s): Significant strides in NLP led to more sophisticated language understanding for AI. This paved the way for tools offering summarization, synonym suggestions, and basic sentence structuring assistance.
  • The rise of large language models (LLMs) (2010s-present): Google developed transformers in 2017 and revolutionized NLP. LLMs such as OpenAI’s GPT-3 emerged around 2020, demonstrating impressive language generation, translation, and content optimization capabilities.

These days, AI isn’t just about automating small tasks. It can partner with you at every stage of the content creation process, including research, ideation, writing, and refinement. And the pace of innovation shows no signs of slowing down, with new tools coming out each year.

AI Tools for Enhancing Content

Deadlines loom, and you’re buzzing with ideas. What if you had a digital assistant to kick-start creative flow, streamline research, and polish prose until it shines?

That’s the power of AI-powered content creation tools. Actually, they’re more like content enhancement tools at the moment. They aren’t going to write your viral blog post with the click of a button, but they are valuable partners in your content journey. 

Gemini

Gemini scouts out competitor content, locates authoritative sources, and highlights gaps for you to fill with insightful and original copy. 

When you’re done writing an article, paste it into Gemini and specify areas you’d like it to analyze. It offers suggestions for improvement and tells you what you’ve aced. Detailed and specific prompts always inspire the best outcomes.  

SEO evangelist, George Varkey, shares his Gemini prompt for brainstorming content ideas.

Dark interface of an AI assistant offering various services.

What it does best: Research and analysis

We’ve all been there. Drowning in tabs and buried in PDFs, trying to piece together the big picture. Gemini does the heavy lifting — well, part of it. Asking it to do research on your behalf is risky, as it’s prone to hallucinations

However, it can summarize studies, web pages, and posts that would take you hours to read yourself. It can also analyze vast data sets to reveal hidden connections and patterns that might have slipped past you, giving your content a strategic edge.

How does Gemini compare to Google Search? 

Sure, Google Search is a knowledge powerhouse. But it’s similar to a massive, unorganized library. Gemini is your personal research assistant within that library. It fetches the right books, summarizes key sections, and highlights critical insights.  

Copy.ai

Copy.ai is a go-to tool for short, punchy content creation. Think marketing slogans, snappy social media posts, and persuasive product descriptions. Need fresh angles for an ad campaign? Copy.ai brainstorms ideas, suggests catchy headlines, and helps you achieve the right tone. Plus, it can whip up basic research summaries to get you started.

Don’t expect it to write your next thought-leadership article, though. Accuracy is hit-or-miss, and you’ll need to think carefully about plagiarism. Tech Report’s William Baxter offers some crucial advice:

User interface of a content creation tool with features for transforming bullet points into paragraphs.

What it does best: Content inspiration 

Copy.ai excels at generating a flurry of ideas quickly. Its strength lies in its ability to generate creative variations, helping you break out of a rut or find the perfect word choice. It’s your brainstorming buddy, always ready to bounce ideas around.

How does Copy.ai compare to CoSchedule’s Headline Analyzer?

While a headline analyzer scores your headline and recommends improvements, Copy.ai does the whole thing for you. It helps you craft short-form content pieces and offers research assistance.

Grammarly

Grammarly hunts down typos, suggests word replacements, and flags potential grammatical errors. Plus, it analyzes tone and overall clarity. Need feedback on a draft’s readability? Grammarly has your back. However, don’t rely on it to catch complex factual errors, offer creative ideas, or help structure your content strategy.

Editing tool interface highlighting grammatical suggestions in a text about budget decorating.

What it does best: Helps you catch spelling, grammar, and awkward phrasing

Grammarly excels at boosting the clarity and correctness of your writing. The tool is particularly adept at catching the sneaky typos and awkward phrasing that tends to slip past human eyes. Each week, it gives you a report with insights into your writing that you can use to improve your writing in the future. 

How does Grammarly compare to spell-check?

Grammarly is like Windows spell check on steroids. The premium version can even help you find weak adjectives and better alternatives. This type of feature helps you improve as a writer over time. 

Can LLMs check for grammar and spelling?

Keep in mind that even advanced LLMs, such as ChatGPT and Gemini, aren’t capable of reliable copy editing or grammar checking. While they can give you an overall analysis of your content’s grammar, style, and punctuation, they can’t do what Grammarly does.

For example, if you ask Gemini to fix your punctuation and grammar, it will likely give you a more concise version of what you wrote. However, it probably won’t make sense.

You’ll notice it has amended the text a little but hasn’t added anything in terms of grammar. In fact, it’s taken two sentences and joined them together into one giant mega-sentence.  

Always double-check facts, figures, and everything else in AI-generated content. Accuracy is crucial for maintaining trust. Without your human spark, content won’t demonstrate E-E-A-T, and Google will consider it spam — yes, even if it was written by Google’s own Gemini. If you become overly reliant on AI for content creation, expect your engagement metrics to fall drastically. 

Engage Your Audience With AI Personalization Tools 

Through analysis of your audience’s preferences and behaviors, AI personalization tools help you craft content that feels tailor-made, leading to deeper engagement and stronger connections.

Albert.ai

Albert.ai is an autonomous AI marketing strategist, specializing in personalized content and ad campaigns. It analyzes vast swathes of customer data, identifying patterns and trends within your audience. Based on this, Albert.ai tweaks ad targeting, optimizes content delivery, and even suggests new content formats to maximize engagement.

That said, it requires a significant amount of data to function effectively, and setup can be complex for smaller businesses without dedicated tech support. It’s also incredibly expensive. 

Dashboard with marketing data including graphs for cost, impressions, and conversions.

What Albert.ai does best: Tailoring marketing efforts at scale

This tool excels at analyzing data to identify highly specific audience segments, and then dynamically adjusts content or bidding strategies across multiple platforms in real time.

How does Albert.ai compare to audience segmentation tools?

Albert.ai’s personalized ad campaign management is similar to the audience segmentation tools on platforms such as Mailchimp, but it has a broader reach and more advanced automation capabilities.

Although Albert.ai is a powerful tool, it still clearly reinforces the importance of human-AI collaboration.

Rytr

Rytr is a low-cost AI writing assistant that includes several personalization tools. It generates alternative text variations so you can test what resonates with different audiences. Impressively, the tool can rewrite content in various tones, such as formal or casual. 

Tool for generating SEO-friendly blog outlines and content.

What it does best: A/B testing 

Need to tailor social posts, emails, or ads for different audiences? Rytr quickly generates variations in your chosen tone, from formal to friendly. In turn, you can test which versions resonate best with your target audience. All in all, it’s an easy-to-use platform that introduces you to the benefits of AI content personalization, without any complex setup.

How does Rytr compare to Buffer’s A/B testing tools?

Rytr’s personalization features are comparable to Buffer’s A/B testing tools, allowing you to see how different word choices impact engagement.

As a writing assistant, it can also create content on your behalf. However, like any LLM, it generates basic, uninspired content that’s full of errors. Regie Njoki Kibugu’s example of what Rytr can do showcases its limitations as an actual writer:

Remember that Google indiscriminately flags low-effort content as spam. Even with the best intentions, it’s impossible to rank without expert writing, editing, and strategy guiding your efforts.   

Climb the SERPs Using AI Tools for SEO

While user intent has always been important, the latest upgrades to Google’s algorithms mean it’s now front and center. These AI-driven technologies have a deep understanding of context, signaling a shift toward more conversational content that directly answers users’ questions.

SurferSEO

Interface displaying SEO analysis and suggestions for creating title tags.

SurferSEO is a powerful AI-based content optimization tool. 

Take a look at our in-depth review of SurferSEO to learn more about what it can do.

QuestionDB

Blue interface showing a database of questions related to electric cars.

QuestionDB is one of the best free AI tools for capturing user intent and turning it into content. Learn more about it in our AI tools for SEO article.   

What AI-driven SEO strategies can content creators adopt?

AI can help you analyze what competitors are ranking for, spot gaps you can fill with killer content, and suggest the best conversational keywords. What’s more, Google adores well-structured content that’s easy to navigate — AI tools can help you get the formatting just right. 

How is AI influencing SEO practices in content creation?

The influence of AI means analyzing search trends and understanding user intent should go way beyond keywords. It’s about deciphering what people truly need. AI can crunch enormous data sets, identifying patterns and subtle nuances in how people search. This reveals the questions they’re asking, the problems they’re trying to solve, and their emotional state.

Access to this type of information gives you a serious edge. Yes, you can optimize for high-traffic keywords, but that’s table stakes. To win at SEO and rank high on the SERPs, you must craft content that resonates deeply with your audience while aligning with search engines’ understanding of context. 

A Guide to Building Your AI Content Strategy

Integrating AI into your content strategy isn’t about replacing your existing processes. Instead, aim to strategically enhance them. Here’s how to strike the right balance:

  • Start with goals: Don’t adopt AI for the sake of it. What specific bottlenecks does AI address? Are you aiming for faster ideation, deeper research, or more efficient editing? Define your goals to guide your tool selection.
  • Choose wisely: Consider budget, team skills, and content needs. A powerhouse such as Albert.ai is overkill for a small blog, while Rytr lacks the depth required for in-depth articles. 
  • The human touch: AI is a powerful teammate, not a replacement for your team — unless you’re prepared to significantly increase your own workload. Use AI for its strengths, such as data analysis, content ideation, and creating content briefs. Leave strategy finessing, nuanced understanding, and consistent brand voice to human experts.
  • Do and learn: AI and content landscapes evolve rapidly. Regularly reassess how your tools are performing against your goals. Don’t be afraid to experiment and keep looking for new solutions.

Innovative approaches to using AI for content planning

Beyond efficiency gains and research assistance, AI unlocks novel possibilities for content planning.

  • AI-assisted content briefs: You’re juggling multiple clients and projects as a content agency. AI tools can analyze a client’s existing content, competitors, and target audience. This provides a strong foundation for content briefs. Add your expertise and refine the brief, saving hours on research and strategy while leveling up your content game.
  • Predictive analytics: Say you run a travel blog. AI tools can monitor trending destinations mentioned on social media and competitor websites. This gives you first dibs on emerging hotspots, positioning you to create timely content with a better chance of ranking high on the SERPs.
  • Hyper-personalization: AI tracks user interactions, identifying their areas of interest. Using that intel, you can suggest personalized content journeys and strategically show relevant articles, videos, and resources, deepening their engagement on your site.
  • Repurposing with a twist: You’ve written a comprehensive industry report for your tech company. AI can break it down into digestible, catchy social media posts, create explanatory infographics, and even generate a basic webinar script.

AI Will Continue to Transform Content

Technology keeps marching forward. Don’t get left in the dust. It’s time to experiment, adapt, and harness the power of AI to elevate your content. 

Sign up for our newsletter so you can stay updated on AI’s impact on content creation and tap into the resources and ideas you need to thrive in the age of AI-powered content.

The post How to Use AI for Content Creation appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What Are the Best AI Landing Page Builders on the Market in 2024? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ai-content-creation/ai-landing-page-builders/ Tue, 21 May 2024 13:31:43 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38190 Dynamic landing pages are often the X-factor that takes a solid digital marketing campaign from good to fantastic. But efficiently producing enough of them without sacrificing quality can be a real challenge — this is where AI landing page builders come in. Today’s AI landing page creation tools leverage emerging artificial intelligence tech to significantly […]

The post What Are the Best AI Landing Page Builders on the Market in 2024? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Dynamic landing pages are often the X-factor that takes a solid digital marketing campaign from good to fantastic. But efficiently producing enough of them without sacrificing quality can be a real challenge — this is where AI landing page builders come in.

Today’s AI landing page creation tools leverage emerging artificial intelligence tech to significantly speed up the process of producing stunning pages, saving you time and effort in the process. They also make your production routine more efficient by reducing the potential for human error and bridging any possible design or copywriting limitations. 

The individual benefits AI landing page builders bring to the table vary from tool to tool, but some key examples to keep in mind include:

  • Features like A/B testing tools to optimize layouts and smart copywriting assistants to craft compelling headlines and CTAs
  • Help creating or fine-tuning written copy
  • Seamless integration with your existing digital marketing stack

Whether or not you decide to make AI part of your ongoing strategy, making multiple landing pages part of the mix is always advisable. Doing so significantly boosts search engine visibility while giving your conversion rates wings, and using AI wisely is one way to take the hassle and tedium out of the process.

However, it’s also crucial to understand that while AI tools like landing page builders are genuine game-changers, they should always be approached as tools. Even the best AI-generated content requires a round of human-powered editing, fact-checking, and polishing to ensure accuracy, proper brand messaging, and alignment with your long-term business goals.

Why AI Landing Page Builders Are Game-Changers

Putting together even one high-converting landing page that successfully drives traffic and converts visitors frequently takes hours, even for experienced marketers. Producing multiple pages, each as efficient as the last, naturally takes even longer. 

Today’s cutting-edge AI technology streamlines this process by speeding it up, removing the guesswork, and saving you a fortune in time and money. Here are some key examples of how.

Automation

As any experienced digital marketing professional already knows, automating repetitive tasks changes the game entirely. An AI landing page builder saves you time and reduces the likelihood of human error by automating tasks like image optimization, filling pages with content, swiftly inserting keywords, etc.

Effective personalization

In 2024, audiences expect more from the content they consume than thin, generic information, landing pages included. They want relevant, personalized content that feels on-target when it comes to their needs and goals. AI builders bridge this gap by analyzing user behavior and suggesting appropriate improvements.

Dynamic variations

The more landing pages your campaign calls for, the harder it becomes to keep each one as distinctive and engaging as all the others. AI helps facilitate the different variations on a theme that you need for your campaign to be truly successful.

Improved efficiency

Whether you’re working solo or with an entire marketing team, the right AI tools fill in the gaps in expertise. They allow you to create high-performance landing pages without needing specialized skills in design, copywriting and layout. You can achieve awesome results without being a design or marketing expert.

Helpful insights

AI page builders often offer users additional insights into each page’s efficiency. Instead of crossing your fingers, publishing your page, and hoping for the best, these tools offer predictive analytics and performance suggestions to help you optimize future performance.

Naturally, it’s not impossible to create high-conversion landing pages without AI. But adding AI to your workflow can make it easier to accurately personalize your user experience and make your pages more engaging. When brands make consumers feel valued and understood, they earn sales and win customers.

Top AI Landing Page Builders on the Market

AI is red hot in 2024, and getting hotter by the second. As a result, there are numerous page builders and helpful tools on the market today, making it tough to choose the right option for you. Check out our comprehensive AI landing page software comparison round-up below for a closer look at some of today’s best, most widely trusted options.

Sitekick

Sitekick

Superlative

Best for businesses of all types and sizes

Intro to the builder

Sitekick’s biggest claims to fame are its speed and versatility. Designed to serve businesses of various sizes and types, Sitekick leverages cutting-edge automation tech to produce stunning landing pages that are both aesthetically pleasing and fully optimized with conversions in mind.

Pros and cons

Sitekick’s user-friendly interface makes it easy to customize the tool to suit your needs. You can customize your dashboard and analytics tools to better match your business goals and preferences. It also integrates seamlessly with popular platforms like Mailchimp, Google Analytics, Shopify, and WordPress.

However, some users report having issues using Sitekick on older devices or with niche browsers. It’s also less focused on key digital marketing factors like SEO, website accessibility, and website performance than other options may be, so you’ll want to adopt additional measures to cover those bases.

Special features

What features set Sitekick apart from the rest of the options out there? Let us count the ways:

  • One-click landing page creation lets you create your next page in just seconds.
  • Conversion is front and center thanks to high-performance design, development, and copywriting options.
  • Sitekick users get ongoing access to DALL-E 3, which means endless original AI-generated images that are just right for your pages.
  • Integrated AI is the result of high-level training on over 1,000 top-performing landing pages for maximum results.

Pricing

At the time of this posting, there isn’t a free trial available. However, Sitekick offers three different pricing tiers, the better to suit a wide range of businesses. Monthly rates come in at $20 for the Basic package, $49 for Pro, and $99 for Agency.

What we’ve heard

“Sitekick has helped me save time and money,” says Andy Matthews of Nicely Network. “I’m able to quickly build great-looking, conversion-focused landing pages with just a few clicks of the mouse!”

Use case and best practices

Sitekick’s interface is fairly foolproof, even if you have little experience creating landing pages. Additionally, you can maximize the quality of your initial results by accurately describing your product or service in detail. It’s also a good idea to further polish and refine your copy via a human touch to ensure accuracy, tone, and flow.

Headlime

Headlime

Superlative

Best for easy customization

Intro to the builder

Featuring a user-friendly drag-and-drop system, Headlime is a solid choice for would-be landing page designers who want to create genuinely unique landing pages regardless of their skill level. Think hundreds of pre-built templates, stunning fonts, and unique features to help your page stand out.

Pros and cons

Headlime goes beyond simply helping you generate compelling copy with AI to fully integrating it into an optimized HTML template. The extensive range of available templates and customization options takes the guesswork out of helping your pages look sleek, original, and unique. You can also try Headlime out for free when you sign up for a trial.

One possible drawback is that Headlime operates on a credit-based system for individuals and smaller businesses, which may not suit everyone. There are also only two tier options to choose from with a significant price difference between them.

Special features

What features help Headlime stand out and make it a particularly solid choice? Here are some examples:

  • A streamlined algorithm-based interface ensures all generated copy is properly personalized to suit your audience.
  • The highly user-friendly editor lets you drag and drop various elements to create unique designs, choose from a wide range of colors, select unique fonts, etc.
  • Headlime’s AI is designed with conversion in mind.
  • The page builder is ultra-fast, choosing and optimizing ideal templates based on the provided product description in just seconds.
  • Besides the landing page builder, Headlime offers a document generator and an AI blog assistant.

Pricing

Headlime offers two different user tier packages — the individual package for $59 per month or the business package which scales starting at $399 per month based on number of users. You can try either package on for size before committing via a free trial, with no credit card necessary.

What we’ve heard

“A fantastic little gem,” says speaker and author Robin Good regarding his Headlime experience. “It truly does what it promises.”

Use case and best practices

Headlime isn’t just great at taking the hassle out of generating beautiful, effective web pages in instants. It can also help you give important portions of your content some pop. Be sure to try out the headline generation option for some eye-catching ideas, as well as all of the customization choices.

Unbounce

Unbounce

Superlative

Best for boosting conversions

Intro to the builder

Unbounce is true to its name with a strong focus on maximizing conversions and lowering bounce rates. It accomplishes this by routing web visitors to the most appropriate of your landing pages for their needs. Features like personalized recommendations, popups, and sticky bars make the creation process easy, too.

Pros and cons

Unbounce is ideal for marketers looking to improve user experience (UX) thanks to features that ensure mobile responsiveness, a simple A/B testing option, and various personalization approaches. It also comes equipped with a suite of highly effective conversion tracking tools.

However, prospective users should be aware that split-testing options are only available via the higher tiers. There are also monthly conversion limits to consider. Some users report minor alignment issues between the standard and mobile versions of the builder, as well.

Special features

The following are just a few examples of features that set Unbounce apart for those looking to build fantastic landing pages with AI:

  • You can easily create proven standout page features with Unbounce, including pop-ups, sticky bars, and similar options.
  • Templates are industry-optimized to maximize results and make getting started easy.
  • Dynamic text options let you adjust the copy of your landing pages to better match with the search terms that bring in visitors.
  • A/B testing takes the guesswork out of improving your pages over time.
  • Advanced copywriting tools let you expand and remix content, in addition to generating it.

Pricing

You can try Unbounce free for fourteen days, making it a great option for those looking for the best free AI landing page builders. From there, you can choose from four different pricing tiers. Monthly fees are $79 for the Build tier, $149 for the Experiment tier, $249 for the Optimize tier, and $649 for the Concierge tier.

What we’ve heard

Nick Heim of Hotjar reports a major jump in new users after integrating Unbounce into the company workflow. “We’re getting 60-70 new users per month as a result of Unbounce popups,” he says.

Use case and best practices

Get the most out of Unbounce’s exceptional potential for boosting conversions by taking full advantage of its customization tools. Creator recommendations guide you through the building process step by step, regardless of your skill level. Take advantage of the A/B testing feature to help ensure all of your pages are measuring up to their full potential.

Canva

Canva

Superlative

Best for builders who need a free option

Intro to the builder

Canva is a long-time favorite among bloggers, marketers, and content creators everywhere for its user-friendly selection of design tools. These include a free AI landing page builder that simplifies processes like building newsletter audiences or showcasing key products.

Pros and cons

Canva’s unparalleled popularity is largely due to its ease of use and low learning curve. Creating landing pages is simple, intuitive, and easy to facilitate via mobile devices, making it a great choice for content creators and marketers who frequently work this way. There are plenty of dynamic, beautiful design options to explore for various purposes, as well.

However, Canva may not be the best fit for marketers in search of an advanced SEO-forward option. There are also limits to what Canva can accomplish when it comes to important factors like web responsiveness and advanced optimization.

Special features

Thinking of giving Canva a shot at helping you generate your next collection of landing pages? Here’s a closer look at some of the key features you can look forward to exploring:

  • Choose from a free catalog of thousands of customizable templates.
  • You can easily use Canva to put together a stunning color palette based on any image — perfect for matching branded assets you already have.
  • Canva is extremely share-friendly with lots of tools for exporting and distributing content.
  • Access a wide range of free imagery, icons, graphics, and other visual assets with Canva.
  • You can use Canva to customize tables, charts, and similar features with ease.

Pricing

Canva users have four different pricing tiers to consider. The first is the free tier, which is available to single users. When you’re ready to upgrade, monthly rates for additional tiers shake out to $14.99 for Canva Pro, $15.99 per person for Canva for Teams, and a case-by-case pricing system for Canva Enterprise.

What we’ve heard

“Canva has become our one-stop shop,” says Expedia Group’s own Molly Martin. “Just being able to be in one centralized place and grab a logo, photo, or template is incredible.”

Use case and best practices

Canva is terrific for creating landing pages that blend seamlessly into your ongoing approach to branding. Be sure to take advantage of options like the color palette creator to ensure your creations make it clear your brand is behind them. Experiment with additional features to add elements like video, vectors, icons, and textures for added creativity.

Writesonic

Writesonic

Superlative

Best for high-quality written copy and headlines

Intro to the builder

Marketers looking for an AI landing page builder that can handle copy like a champ are great candidates for Writesonic. Top-tier text-generation tools take the confusion out of generating options like dynamic headlines, calls-to-action, feature-benefit breakdowns, and pain point-focused copy.

Pros and cons

Writesonic is truly impressive when it comes to AI-generated copywriting. Not only can it help you generate amazing headlines, conversion-focused calls-to-action, and well-structured copy, but you can also adjust voice or style and seamlessly integrate target keywords into generated text. It’s also a great tool for content creation teams due to its collaborative features.

But as effective as Writesonic is on the copy front, it’s somewhat limited when it comes to other advanced editing features, especially as compared to other options on the market. Some users also say it has a steeper learning curve than average.

Special features

Need a closer look at some of the individual features that make Writesonic such a popular choice in 2024? Here are a few examples to consider:

  • Writesonic guarantees 100% original content 
  • It can create  everything from blog posts, to advertising copy and dynamic meta descriptions.
  • Summaries are also easy to create, thanks to a one-click article summarizer feature.
  • Need to adjust existing copy to better suit your needs? Try the text expander to flesh out or otherwise lengthen your copy.
  • Choose from a wealth of content-generation templates designed for optimizing website copy, social media content, product descriptions, blog posts, standalone articles, and ads.

Pricing

Writesonic features a good range of usage tiers and pricing options, so there’s truly an option here for everyone. (Different tiers grant access to different Writesonic features.) There’s a free tier available for single users who’d like to try it on for size. Monthly fees for additional tiers are $15 for Chatsonic Pro, $20 for Individual, $30 for Teams, and custom case-by-case pricing for Enterprise.

What we’ve heard

Writesonic’s Wall of Love is full of testimonials from happy customers who love it. Verified Writesonic user Kevin Mooney loves the quality level of Writesonic’s output and says, “The AI sometimes generates better ideas and writes better than me.” Other users praise the product for its impeccable grammar, accuracy, and versatility.

Use case and best practices

Writesonic is best used to help out with copy-focused landing pages and features, like headlines, meta descriptions, basic blog posts, and advertising copy. It can also help with overcoming writer’s block andgenerating new content ideas. 

For best results, consider adding Writesonic to a broader workflow that also includes page design tools and professional copy editors who can help add a human touch to your content.

Take Your AI Landing Page Builder Results to the Next Level

In 2024, it’s safe to say that AI tools are more than just a fad or a passing trend. This is revolutionary technology capable of making brands and marketing teams significantly more productive while also helping them maximize creativity.

Top AI landing page builders like Sitekick, Headlime, and Writesonic help compensate for knowledge gaps and democratize the ability to create genuinely stunning landing pages that convert. Comparing AI landing page builder features and pricing before pulling the trigger on a purchase ensures a choice you’ll be happy with.

However, pages that rocket to the top of key search engine results pages (SERPs) should also pass through the hands of expert human copy editors to guarantee high quality, pinpoint accuracy, and consistent brand voice. The key to succeeding with AI isn’t to treat it as a replacement for human creativity but to leverage it to make talented human creators more productive.

Don’t have a full-time copy editor on the payroll? Let Crowd Content’s copy editing team take your AI-generated content and transform it into something absolutely unstoppable. Take the next step, learn more about our trusted copy editing services today, and treat your online presence to the polish it deserves.

The post What Are the Best AI Landing Page Builders on the Market in 2024? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content Analytics Tools for Data-Driven Insights https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-analytics-tools-for-data-driven-insights/ Mon, 20 May 2024 22:14:13 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38143 Content analytics tools are essential for any writer or marketer looking to make their content stand out in a saturated online environment. While many people might think of content as just words on a page, data-driven strategies are crucial for creating successful and engaging content. In fact, 77% of marketers say that the importance of […]

The post Content Analytics Tools for Data-Driven Insights appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content analytics tools are essential for any writer or marketer looking to make their content stand out in a saturated online environment. While many people might think of content as just words on a page, data-driven strategies are crucial for creating successful and engaging content. In fact, 77% of marketers say that the importance of measurement, data, and analytics to their work will continue to increase in the coming years.

These platforms help gather and deliver valuable insights into audience behavior, keyword performance, and overall content effectiveness. To help leverage this intelligence, we evaluated some of the top content analytics software on the market. Read on to learn about available options, features, and pricing and how these tools can help refine your marketing strategies and boost the impact of your content.

Benefits of Content Analytics Tools

Sometimes, you might feel like you’re submerged in data. You’ve got stats flowing in from your website, social networks, marketing emails, paid ads, and influencer campaigns. How do you harness this data and make informed decisions about your digital strategy?

You could manually compile bits and pieces in a spreadsheet and attempt to find patterns and trends, but it’s more effective to use software built just for this purpose. Some benefits of using content analytics tools include:

  • Efficiency: Content marketing analytics tools automate the gathering and processing of data, eliminating repetitive and time-consuming tasks. This lets you focus on interpreting the numbers rather than compiling them.
  • Integration: Technology can streamline the process of gathering data, instantly pulling information from various channels.
  • Accuracy: Automated platforms process large volumes of data with precision, eliminating human mistakes and inconsistencies in approaches.
  • Versatility: You can segment data across channels, formats, and audiences to look at interactions from different perspectives and more accurately adapt your strategies.
  • Artificial intelligence: Powerful content analytics tools leverage predictive analytics, machine learning, and AI-driven insights. In other words, by analyzing historical trends and learning as new information comes in, these tools can make your business highly responsive and competitive.

Essential Features for Content Analytics Tools

To choose a tool that meets your brand’s unique needs, consider what you want to achieve with your analytics. Common functionalities include:

  • Insights into audience demographics and behaviors to help tailor content
  • Engagement metrics to determine which content performs the best
  • SEO analysis to help boost search visibility
  • Competitor analysis to ensure you’re keeping up with similar websites
  • Content optimization to help fine-tune content to better engage audiences
  • Conversion tracking to evaluate how well you’re driving desired actions
  • AI-powered analytics to personalize user experience and capitalize on predicted trends

Not all tools have the same robust features, so use our list below to narrow down possible options. Before making a final decision, read reviews from other users, consider scalability and integrations with your existing systems, and take advantage of free trials and demos to find a platform that’s a good fit for your business.

10 Content Analytics Tools: Features, Reviews, Prices, and More

It’s hard to single out one content analytics tool as being the best on the market. They all have different approaches. Some are all-in-one tools, and others aim for simplicity. Some focus on search visibility, and others zero in on user behavior or content engagement.

We looked at each tool’s strengths, unique features, and weaknesses and added in pricing information and user reviews. Here’s what we determined:

  • Google Analytics: Best Tool for Audience Insights
  • Semrush: Best Overall Content Marketing Analytics Platform
  • Clarity: Best Software for Behavior-Focused Analytics
  • Simple Analytics: Best Analytics Tool for Beginners
  • SE Ranking: Best Platform for Local Search Analytics
  • DYNO Mapper: Best Software for Content Audits
  • Google Search Console: Best Tool for Search Engine Insights
  • Parse.ly: Best Analytics Platform for Publishers 
  • ImpactHero: Best Software for Aligning Content With the Buyer Journey
  • Fathom Analytics: Best Privacy-First Analytics Platform

Google Analytics

Best Tool for Audience Insights

We’ll lead off with a tool from the search engine giant. Google Analytics (GA) helps you understand who’s using your website and how they interact with the content. Simply place a tracking code on your site, and GA begins gathering data related to traffic, referral sources, and user engagement.  

One advantage of GA is that it provides demographic information for users logged into their Google accounts, including age, gender, and interests. The platform can also track whether users complete desired actions, such as filling in forms or making purchases. Its machine learning capabilities can look at historical data to predict customer actions and churn.

Pros

  • Easy to set up
  • Provides insight into user behaviors and interests
  • Manages multiple properties, including apps
  • Helps track return on investment
  • Integrates with Google platforms, such as Search Console and Ads Manager

Cons

  • Can be difficult to use
  • Lacks robust customer support
  • Data is aggregated, so you can’t track individual users

Special Features

While it’s easy to look at a graph and see sudden spikes or drops in data, GA’s Trend Change detection alerts you to subtle changes in the direction of your data over longer periods of time. It works by comparing a forecasted value to the actual value.

Pricing

  • Free 

What We’ve Heard

“Google Analytics is the biggest name in website and mobile app intelligence. It has a steep learning curve, but it is an awesome business intelligence tool.” – Pam Baker, PC Magazine

Use Cases and Best Practices

Use GA to get an overall picture of your user journey. You can segment data by content distribution channel (search engine, social media, paid ad, email) and get nuanced insights about audience experience. For example, if people arrive on your landing page through a paid ad but aren’t converting, the ad might not match expectations, or you may need to make the offer more clear. 

Semrush

Best Overall Content Marketing Analytics Platform

Another leader in the SEO field is Semrush. Its comprehensive suite of digital marketing utilities ranges from keyword research tools to AI writing assistance. It’s especially powerful for tracking keyword rankings so you can identify content that needs more visibility. You can also set up alerts if your positioning changes for specific keywords or pages and use the share of voice metric to compare your visibility with other brands in your niche.

The tool also provides insight into how users engage with your content, including page views, time spent on page, click-throughs, conversions, and return on investment.

Pros

  • All-in-one digital marketing platform with reports related to search engine, pay-per-click, and social media marketing
  • Vast keyword research database with insight into search volume and difficulty
  • Data on organic traffic, keyword rankings, backlinks, and social media engagement
  • Integrates with Google products, social networks, and tools such as Monday.com and Wix to streamline workflow

Cons

  • Vast amount of tools and data can make it hard to know what information is relevant
  • Provides historical data only when you upgrade to Guru or Business Plan
  • May be costly for some businesses

Special Features

Semrush’s On-Page SEO tracker analyzes your content and provides concrete ideas to improve organic traffic. The suggestions relate to content readability and helpfulness, as well as SEO factors, such as backlinks, technical issues, and user experience.

Pricing

  • Pro: $129.95 monthly
  • Guru: $249.95 monthly
  • Business: $499.95 monthly
  • 7-day free trial available

What We’ve Heard

“Semrush is used by both our marketing team and our editorial team. [Our] marketing team uses Semrush for paid and earned marketing research, competitive analysis, and tracking performance. Our editorial team uses multiple research and writing tools that help them make decisions about SEO.” – Melissa D. Cooper, TrustRadius review

Use Cases and Best Practices

Use Semrush for all stages of content marketing, including keyword research, competitor analysis, and content creation. You can then monitor your content’s performance in the SERPs, social media reach, and most visited pages to assess how well your content attracts audiences.

Microsoft Clarity

Best Software for Behavior-Focused Analytics

Your website metrics reflect how well you’re attracting traffic and the URLs your audiences are visiting, but what do users do when they’re actually on a page? Clarity uses advanced heat maps and session recordings to reveal how audiences interact with content on a page level. You can see where they click, how far they scroll before abandoning a page, and whether they click to another page but quickly return to the one they’re on. Best of all, Clarity is free.

Pros

  • Shows which areas of a page generate the most interaction
  • Identifies where users get frustrated
  • Records all sessions, not just a sampling
  • Filters data by location, browser, campaign, or session duration
  • Integrates with Shopify, Weebly, Wix, WordPress, Squarespace, and Unbounce

Cons

  • Data is only retained for 30 days
  • Can’t segment audiences
  • Only provides click-and-scroll heat maps, not movement heat maps

Special Features

Clarity’s session recordings let you watch anonymized recordings to see how users navigate your web pages and when they abandon them. You can also detect issues, such as rage clicks — elements they try to click that aren’t links — and page errors. In addition to individual recordings, you can view a heat map aggregation.

Use these insights to fine-tune your content for better engagement. For example, if users aren’t scrolling deep into a page, revise your content to put more relevant information at the beginning. If they drop off without converting, consider a stronger call to action or more prominent buttons.

Pricing

  • Free

What We’ve Heard

“Knowing how and where your user interacts most on your page gives you another level of on-page content and call-to-action optimization. Why have your best banner ads or action buttons in areas that turned out to be dead-space?” Olaf S., review on G2

Use Cases and Best Practices

For more powerful insights, connect Clarity to Google Analytics. This lets you view data on both platforms. You can watch playback links of relevant segments right in GA or check metrics from GA while you’re in Clarity.

Simple Analytics

Best Analytics Tool for Beginners

Like its name implies, Simple Analytics gets right to the point. Its straightforward user interface presents key metrics clearly. You can quickly monitor traffic, where your visitors come from, and the content they engage with.

Simple Analytics is also a privacy-first content analytics platform that doesn’t store personal data, which means you don’t need cookie banners on your site. Its lightweight script minimizes impact on your site speed. Because the tool doesn’t collect data, it doesn’t use machine learning or predictive analytics.

Pros

  • Simplifies how you access data
  • Measures traffic, referrals, top pages, page views, and time on page; and monitors devices, browsers, and countries
  • Allows you to segment data to get a detailed picture of site visitors
  • Provides AI chat for analytics questions
  • Offers responsive customer support
  • Imports data from Google Analytics

Cons

  • Not as robust as other tools, but new utilities continue to roll out

Special Features

The tool’s AI chat helps you access your data more easily. Instead of trying to read reports and charts, for example, you can ask analytics questions in real time. For example, you can prompt the AI tool to compare traffic for different time periods or create a pie chart breaking down referral sources. The AI chat can also answer questions about using the tool’s features, which may be easier than searching the documentation.

Pricing

  • Starter: $9 monthly
  • Business: $49 monthly
  • Enterprise: Contact for pricing
  • Free 14-day trial

What We’ve Heard

“It’s good to have raw data of the visits in the website and easy to implement the tracker/events. Also, it is really fast to adapt for those who [have] already used Google Analytics.” – Mateus A., GetApp review

Use Cases and Best Practices

Set up goals in the platform to determine if your content achieves key metrics or encourages conversions. A goal can be a certain amount of time spent on a page or an increase in free trials, for example. You can then use the Goal Tracker to monitor your progress and adjust your content if you’re falling short of your objectives.

SE Ranking

Best Platform for Local Search Analytics

SE Ranking may be a good fit if you’re looking for a straightforward tool to track search performance and optimize pages to boost visibility. Like Semrush, it provides keyword research, SEO monitoring, AI content creation, and on-page SEO tools.

Pros

  • Daily ranking updates
  • Website audit for technical issues and Core Web Vitals
  • Recommendations to improve content for relevance and user experience
  • Insight into keyword density, word count, and readability metrics
  • SERP analysis of competitors
  • Easy-to-use interface

Cons

  • Costs extra for some tools, even if you have a subscription
  • Keyword database isn’t as large as some other tools
  • Doesn’t track on-site metrics, such as page views, time spent on page, or session duration

Special Features

Although it’s an add-on, SE Ranking’s Local Marketing tool is worth mentioning. This tool is ideal for finding effective keywords and tracking rankings across multiple locations. You can see what search terms customers use to determine where you need to optimize your content. You can also manage reviews and check listings in different directories to improve local visibility.

Pricing

  • Essential: $44 monthly (Local Marketing add-on is $5.60 monthly)
  • Pro: $87.20 monthly (Local Marketing add-on is $38.40 monthly)
  • Business: $191.20 monthly (Local Marketing add-on is $144.80 monthly)

What We’ve Heard

“This all-in-one platform helps me view the bigger picture for analytics when it comes to web traffic and really understand how my clients’ sites are doing. I like that I can easily audit websites, add keywords and competitors, and then identify weak areas within their backlinking.” Hillary Glaser, TrustPilot review

Use Cases and Best Practices

SE Ranking monitors your performance on Google, Bing, Yahoo, YouTube, Google Maps, and Google Ads. You can identify content that needs improvement and make data-informed decisions based on backlinks, competitor results in the SERPs, and your site’s on-page SEO.

DYNO Mapper

Best Software for Content Audits

Before you can optimize your website, you need to understand its current structure. This can be challenging if you’ve been adding to your site ad hoc over the years. DYNO Mapper crawls and maps your site and provides you with a detailed inventory of its content assets. Once you have an overview of your catalog, you can begin pinpointing areas for improvement and filling in content gaps.

Pros

  • Generates an interactive visual sitemap
  • Catalogs subdomains, pages, images, videos, documents, and other files
  • Audits your site for broken links, errors, and duplication in metadata
  • Tracks keyword position in Google, Yahoo, and Bing
  • Tests for accessibility issues

Cons

  • Lacks concrete recommendations for improving search rankings
  • No AI-powered insights or content creation tools

Special Features

DYNO Mapper integrates with Google Analytics. This lets you view important data on each page of your site map, such as sessions, users, page views, pages per session, bounce rate, and average session duration. It also pulls in your content inventory so you can see what assets are on each page. 

Pricing

  • Lite: $39 monthly, billed annually
  • Pro: $49 monthly, billed annually
  • Standard: $99 monthly, billed annually
  • Organization: $360 monthly, billed annually

What We’ve Heard

“Being able to see the sitemap visually allows everybody to see in a much clearer way how the site manages content. Premium features are great for SEO / Content Managers. Seeing keywords and pageviews is quite useful.” – Daniel R., G2 review

Use Cases and Best Practices

DYNO Mapper helps you visualize how your content is organized for search engines and users. Analyze the sitemap to ensure your site is logically structured for indexing and navigation. Then, use the inventory list to manage your content — check which URLs are ranking, ensure pages are relevant and up to date, and search your existing content before creating new pieces. 

Google Search Console

Best Tool for Search Engine Insights

Google Search Console (GSC) ensures your pages are crawled and indexed so they appear in the SERPs. The tool measures search performance, such as rankings, impressions, and clicks. It also helps troubleshoot problems that can affect your search presence. 

Pros

  • Monitors changes in keyword position
  • Measures your site’s technical health through Core Web Vitals
  • Alerts you to crawl errors, manual penalties, and broken links
  • Integrates with Google Analytics

Cons

  • Data takes a few days to appear in GSC
  • Historical data is limited to 16 months

Special Features

Your content won’t appear in the SERPs if issues prevent Googlebot from crawling it. GSC’s Page Indexing Report gives you a count of your total indexed and non-indexed pages. Regularly monitor this report to check for pages that aren’t crawled and why. Once you fix the issues, you can ask Google to try crawling it again to ensure your site has visibility.  

Pricing

  • Free

What We’ve Heard

“This is the only truly reliable source of data for performance in Google’s organic search, from search impressions to a breakdown of countries where search users come from. This allows a site owner to better optimize their site’s content and structure to improve organic rankings, and increase click-through rates.” – Josh Bender, TrustRadius review

Use Cases and Best Practices

While you can use GSC as a standalone tool for tracking keyword position and visibility in the SERPs, you get more data when linking Search Console to Google Analytics. This combined data gives you access to Search Console’s Insights report, which is a snapshot of your overall content performance. It shows at a glance which pages are most successful, what audiences search for before they visit your site, and which websites refer visitors to your domain. You can also track the performance of newly published content.

Parse.ly

Best Analytics Platform for Publishers 

Parse.ly analyzes website metrics from the perspective of content performance, making it an ideal tool for content marketers and media sites. The tool tracks user engagement with content in a variety of ways, including by topic, section, author, campaign, channel, and publication date. As a bonus, it also promotes itself as an analytics platform that doesn’t require a data analyst to use. The easy-to-use platform allows you to focus your energies on your content strategy. 

Pros

  • Tracks page views, unique visitors, engaged time, and conversions
  • Offers geo-segmentation for insight into content preferences of international audiences
  • Segments users by group, such as subscribers and members
  • Tags content automatically using AI
  • Provides video analytics to gauge the success of embedded videos and video topics
  • Intuitive and easy to use

Cons

  • Historical data is available for only 13 months
  • Pricing isn’t available on website

Special Features

Parse.ly leverages data aggregation, predictive analytics, and machine learning to help you identify content trends. You can determine the metrics that indicate a trend — page views or conversions, for example. You can also set the time frame for monitoring the trend, such as months, days, or even half-hour intervals. Parse.ly alerts you when it detects a trend so you can act on it.

Pricing

  • Three different plans are available, but you must book a demo to learn about pricing

What We’ve Heard

“Parse.ly allows us to dive into articles categorized by tags, as well as authors, and see not only traffic but where that traffic is being referred from, e.g., Google, AMP, and social networks. All of this gives a better indication of how to respond both to the performance of singular articles and on a wider scale.” – Alice Marshall, Trust Radius review

Use Cases and Best Practices

Use Parse.ly to dig deeper into traditional metrics, such as page views and time spent on a site. The tool puts the metrics in the context of content types and audience segments. For example, you might compare content read by new visitors to content read by returning visitors. These insights can inform your content production process so you can create more relevant content.

Parse.ly’s Content Conversions tool also helps you better determine the ROI of your content. You can specify events to track, such as sign-ups, downloads, or purchases, and attribute them to your content. For example, you can track the last page a user visited before they completed an action.  

ImpactHero

Best Software for Aligning Content With the Buyer Journey

An effective content strategy provides audiences with the exact information they’re looking for at each stage of their path to purchase. ImpactHero helps you plan content according to the buyer journey. It monitors how well your content performs and uses AI to help you improve it. This tool is powered by Semrush and can be used as part of the SEO platform or a standalone. 

Pros

  • Streamlines analytics for content teams
  • Provides automated distribution of content according to funnel stage
  • Shows where users are abandoning your site so you can refine the content
  • Measures impact of content on conversion
  • Provides AI-generated recommendations to improve content effectiveness at each stage

Cons

  • Price may be costly for many businesses

Special Features

Using artificial intelligence, ImpactHero maps your customer journey to help you visualize how users interact with your site. It breaks down performance by content types, such as lists, tutorials, questions, and guides. You can also segment by traffic sources to see which channels provide the most engagement.

Pricing

  • $200 monthly
  • Free trial available

What We’ve Heard

“ImpactHero helps us measure results and pivot to ensure we’re accomplishing what we’ve set out to do — engage and convert website visitors. We can now see the complete content user journey and identify new ways to convert website visitors.” – Debra B. McCraw, ImpactHero review

Use Cases and Best Practices

One of the most useful ways to leverage the platform is to choose a funnel stage: content that attracts visitors (attraction), content that keeps visitors on the site and builds loyalty (impact), and content that inspires action (conversion). You can then analyze metrics such as traffic, engagement, bounce rate, leads, and conversions. ImpactHero’s algorithms suggest ways to optimize content for each stage to help you build a cohesive overall strategy.

Fathom Analytics

Best Privacy-First Analytics Platform

Fathom Analytics positions itself as an alternative to Google Analytics. Like Simple Analytics, it delivers key website data, such as traffic, views, referral sources, and conversions, focusing on ease of use. It also emphasizes digital privacy, tracking website usage without collecting personal data, such as IP addresses. Fathom is compliant with many privacy laws, including GDPR and CCPA.

Pros

  • Blocks bots, scrapers, and spam for more accurate data
  • Anonymizes data without the use of cookies
  • Tracks conversions, such as sales, clicks, and sign-ups
  • Imports historical Google Analytics data and saves it indefinitely
  • Provides email reports so you can share information easily with colleagues

Cons

  • Doesn’t provide keyword rankings or SEO analysis
  • Lacks AI optimization
  • May not have enough functionality for some businesses

Special Features

Fathom’s defining feature is its simplicity: a single-page dashboard that gives you an overall picture of your site performance. You can see key metrics for any time period, including visitors, views, bounce rate, event completions, average time on site, referring sources, browsers, devices, and countries. 

To drill into details, click on the elements you’re interested in. For example, you can filter data to learn about visitors from Reddit on mobile devices from the United Kingdom. You can add up to 10 filters.

Pricing

  • $15 monthly for up to 100,000 data points (page views and events)
  • Tiered pricing based on monthly data points
  • 30-day free trial

What We’ve Heard

“Simple user interface, no GDPR banners required, easy light-weight loading script, privacy-focused, and I own the data!” – Jess J. review on G2

Use Cases and Best Practices

While Fathom’s single-screen dashboard lets you see common metrics, such as traffic and top pages, at a glance, you can customize data by setting up events. These are specific actions that provide insight into how customers are interacting with your content. 

You can track form submissions, free trials, and purchases. You can even track different clicks to see what users are more drawn to. Do they use breadcrumb or sidebar navigation? Are they clicking through slideshows? Downloading PDFs?  

Content Analytics Tools Overview

Drive Your Business Forward With Content Analytics Tools

Content analytics tools are an essential part of modern content strategies, helping you gather intelligence to make informed decisions. Bolstered by AI and machine learning, these platforms are increasingly more powerful, guiding you to your audiences with precision.

Now is the time to incorporate these tools into your workflow if you want to gain a competitive edge. According to a study by Adobe, just 37% of underperforming organizations have the data they need to understand their customers, while 61% of leading organizations are already putting data to work. The sooner you can leverage analytics in your content strategy, the greater advantage you’ll have over your competitors.

Crowd Content can help you translate your data insights into finely tuned content that’s optimized for search visibility, appeals to readers, and propels your business toward its goals. Contact us today to learn more about our SEO content writing services.

The post Content Analytics Tools for Data-Driven Insights appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Mastering Brand Voice and Tone for Dynamic Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/mastering-brand-voice-and-tone-for-dynamic-marketing/ Sun, 19 May 2024 04:49:01 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38121 Wondering how you give life to your company? It boils down to your brand voice and tone — how your business communicates. Whether writing a blog post or recording a video, consistent branding helps harmonize messaging across content and makes your business instantly recognizable. Brand voice is the personality of your business. It can be […]

The post Mastering Brand Voice and Tone for Dynamic Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Wondering how you give life to your company? It boils down to your brand voice and tone — how your business communicates. Whether writing a blog post or recording a video, consistent branding helps harmonize messaging across content and makes your business instantly recognizable.

Brand voice is the personality of your business. It can be professional, quirky, friendly, or even inspirational. It transforms a simple message into something customers feel was written just for them.

Tone, on the other hand, builds upon your voice. Think of how a person’s personality changes subtly to reflect the environment around them. Your brand’s tone does the same. It adjusts your company’s voice to fit the medium, mood, and goal.

Voice and tone are two integral parts of your communication strategy, and you need to master both to captivate your audience.

Understanding Brand Voice and Tone

Your marketing efforts are more successful when your content resonates with customers. This is where the concepts of brand voice and tone come into play.

Your voice is your choice of language, the pacing and rhythm of your communication, how you use humor, and even the ways you tell a story. Does your business use formal words or slang? Do you inject wit into your content or just stick to the facts? What about the use of metaphors?

Major companies build their voices around both the identities they wish to forge and the audiences they target. Here are some noteworthy brand voice examples to illustrate this point:

  • Apple: Apple is bold, confident, and direct, but it’s also friendly. While it usually avoids humor, the brand adds warmth to messaging by referring to itself and its audience inclusively as us. Company communications highlight Apple’s innovation by stressing how its products are unique or better.
Screenshot of Apple's Vision Pro operating system with a man using a desktop.
  • Nike: Nike strives to be that friend who inspires and encourages you. Beginning with the iconic “Just Do It” slogan, the brand uses motivational language and an empowering, confident tone.
Nike tweet celebrating Jannik Sinner's Grand Slam victory.
  • Disney: Disney wants to make its audience feel childlike wonder with innocent and whimsical messaging. It uses magical and surreal wording while focusing on universal, inclusive themes such as love and friendship.
Disney tweet with cartoon of a chicken and a duck from The Wise Little Hen.

The Importance of Brand Voice in Marketing

You need a unique brand voice in marketing because your brand’s voice helps you:

  • Differentiate your business: Most markets are crowded, and new technology continues to lower entry barriers. What you say and how you say it can make your brand more memorable than others.
  • Build trust and credibility: Credibility affects business performance in many ways, from convincing new customers to try your products to ranking higher on Google.
  • Maintain consistency across platforms: Whether you’re speaking to your audience through your business blog or a YouTube video, the way you communicate should remain consistent. It’s challenging to do this without having a defined brand voice.
Melanie Deziel tweet about brand identity without names and logos.

A distinct voice helps you connect with your audience. It’s also your ticket to higher engagement and smooth communication.

Enhanced audience engagement

Engaged customers are 90% more likely to buy something. Better yet, they’re five times more likely to shop exclusively from your brand in the future.

Engage your customers by adjusting your brand voice to relate to them.

More effective communication

A well-defined brand voice creates engaging messaging and helps your business convey ideas easily. That’s because your brand voice caters to your audience.

If your audience needs complex jargon broken down into simple terms, be the company that does this. Shape your voice around being informative and approachable to limit the potential for confusion.

Different Types of Tones

Tone of voice is somewhat subjective, but there are ways to use it, making branded communication more straightforward and consistent.

One method used in marketing is the Nielsen Norman Group’s Four Dimensions of Tone of Voice framework.

  • Formal vs. casual: Should you use formal or laidback language?
  • Respectful vs. irreverent: Should communications show respect or be more edgy and playful?
  • Enthusiastic vs. matter-of-fact: Is speaking with passion and energy okay, or should messaging stick to the facts?
  • Funny vs. serious: Is it okay to use humor, or should communications remain serious?

You can also approach brand voice by orienting it to common tones used in marketing that fit E-E-A-T guidelines:

  • Motivational tone: Prioritizes language that inspires and encourages, driving customers to make purchases or complete other actions
  • Serious tone: Avoids humor and slang to give your brand an image of authority and expertise when talking about research or world events
  • Conversational tone: Speaks like a friend to help inform and guide your audience, building trust
  • Professional tone: Conveys credibility and authority through straightforward and polite language

Catering tone to your goals and audience

When targeting a specific goal, consider your audience and work backward. For example, LinkedIn uses a professional tone, avoiding complex language and whimsical metaphors to appeal to its B2B audience.

In contrast, Old Spice has targeted a young audience in recent years, using humor and wit in advertisements. The brand uses bold, catchy phrases juxtaposed with quirky characters, such as Old Spice Man, to project a lighthearted image.

Advertisement for Old Spice with man on horse holding product on beach.

Think about what tone best suits your image and goals while connecting with your audience.

Challenges in Developing a Consistent Brand Voice

Maintaining a consistent brand voice can be more complex than developing proper tone, especially as your business grows. Common challenges include:

  • New brand managers, writers, and social media professionals
  • Expansion of product and service offerings
  • Diversification across new social media channels

New contributors

How well new contributors maintain your brand’s voice depends mainly on training and resources. You can give new hires and freelancers the tools they need to succeed by providing comprehensive training and ensuring they know who to contact if questions arise.

It’s also essential to create brand voice guidelines that outline the language and tone contributors should use when writing communications for your business.

New products and services

You can’t always market all products the same way, especially if you’re targeting several demographics, which requires adjusting your brand voice accordingly.

For example, if you normally sell to consumers but release a product for the B2B market, let your content creators know how to adapt your voice to fit a B2B audience while retaining your identity.

New social media channels

It’s easy to forget how to maintain your brand’s voice when creating content for social media channels. What works for a blog post won’t necessarily feel natural in an Instagram post or TikTok video.

To overcome this challenge, give specific recommendations to match each platform and regularly review the cohesiveness of blogs, social media posts, advertisements, and videos using a formal process.

Crafting the Right Tone for Different Marketing Situations

Brand voice needs to be consistent, but you should adjust aspects such as tone to suit specific marketing scenarios and improve the effectiveness of your copy. As you enhance engagement, your audience is more likely to follow through with intended actions, such as clicking links or subscribing to your email newsletter.

You can adapt your tone to any situation by following these simple steps:

  1. Analyze your audience.
  2. Adjust to the content type.
  3. Review and optimize.

If you market to several demographics, you may need to use various tones of voice.

For example, Old Spice transforms its image from that of an old-fashioned brand by using an energetic and irreverent tone when marketing its newer product lines. This change in tone played a crucial role in “The Man Your Man Could Smell Like” campaign, where fast-paced and surreal scenarios appealed to younger adults accustomed to internet humor.

A change in tone also helped Airbnb weather the COVID pandemic. The brand used language with a community focus, stressing safety, to help comfort customers and put their minds at ease.

Airbnb webpage highlighting community support during a crisis.

To achieve similar success to these major brands, consider how the following factors apply to your audience:

  • Cultural perspectives
  • Values and desires
  • Demographics and psychographics

Record everything you know about your audience to construct a detailed customer persona. Initially, you should base your brand’s tone of voice on this persona,, customizing it slightly for each communication channel.

For example, TikTok audiences resonate with humor, slang, and memes, while people on LinkedIn prefer a more professional tone. The motives for using specific social media platforms flow through to audience expectations.

Lastly, always track engagement metrics such as view time, click-through rates, likes, and shares. Whenever you tweak your brand’s voice or tone, use this data to gauge the effect.

Integrating Brand Voice and Tone Into Content Strategy

Your brand’s voice intertwines with your content strategy, and you should integrate guidelines for voice and tone into all aspects of content planning.

So, how do you do this? Ensure you have the following essentials:

Brand style guide

Make your style guide the definitive source of information for anyone who plans, writes, edits, or reviews your content. Your guide should contain detailed information about the voice and tone expectations for various types of content.

Content creators will find it easier to understand your brand voice when you give clear examples rather than simply use descriptive language. List specific words and phrases you like, and link to examples of completed blogs or social media posts matching your requirements.

You can also refer to specific public figures or fictional characters to provide examples of the messages and tones you want to convey to help writers understand your voice requirements.

Brand voice chart

A brand voice chart is another effective tool that aids content strategy. It lists the qualities of your voice alongside columns that provide descriptions, things to do, and things to avoid.

Empty chart for documenting brand voice characteristics.

You can use separate charts for each communication channel for more detailed guidance.

SEO considerations that affect voice and tone

Your brand’s voice and tone should match your audience and goals, but you should also consider SEO strategy. 

One key consideration is Google’s E-E-A-T guidelines, which stress the need for content that displays experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness. Consider how you can match these guidelines through your voice and the information you provide.

You should also consider how to integrate keywords and other metadata into content. Match keywords to your brand voice where possible so the audience these keywords attract is closer to your target customer. Assess the user intent — transactional, commercial, navigational, or informational — and adapt your voice to ensure you deliver what your audience wants.

Diagram showing different types of search intent with icons.

Tools for maintaining consistency

Other tools you can use to maintain consistency include:

  • Content management systems 
  • Voice and tone-tracking software, such as Grammarly Business
  • Social media management platforms, such as Hootsuite
  • Collaboration tools, such as Asana
  • Generative AI, such as ChatGPT

Step-by-Step Guide to Developing Your Brand Voice

Developing the perfect brand voice doesn’t mean you need to reinvent the wheel. Just follow these steps:

1. Define your brand’s core values and personality

What does your brand stand for? What’s its mission? Summarize this information into one sentence and use that sentence to define your business’ personality.

For example, LEGO’s mission is to inspire and develop the builders of tomorrow. Its personality, stemming from that mission, is playful, creative, and educational.

LEGO brand values and framework outlined with colored tabs.

2. Analyze your audience

Get to know your audience. Create a profile with basic information, such as their age range, location, and interests, alongside the needs you can target and pain points to avoid.

For example, Tesla’s audience is tech-savvy and cares about the environment, so the brand’s communication highlights innovation and eco-friendliness.

Tesla company impact report, metrics on emissions, renewable energy, and recycling.

3. Create a brand voice chart

Create a basic voice chart based on five adjectives that describe your brand while matching your mission and audience. For example: friendly, authoritative, informative, whimsical, and energetic.

Provide descriptions and examples that illustrate how to translate each adjective into the voice and make a list of things writers should or shouldn’t do, to offer further guidance.

4. Develop content guidelines

Construct a detailed style guide. Ensure you include instructions for various platforms and contexts so content creators know how to match voice, tone, and style to any situation.

5. Implement training procedures

Put training and workshops in place to help your team learn how to use your brand voice effectively.

You also need a review process to check adherence to voice guidelines. For smaller companies, one editor may handle this task.

Larger companies or those that target multiple communication channels may need to simplify these reviews through a dedicated QA team and a standardized review process.

6. Optimize

Your voice should be consistent but never completely set in stone. Always be open to optimization. Use tools such as Google Analytics to track engagement metrics and run occasional A/B tests to assess how subtle changes in brand voice versus brand tone affect engagement.

Using Technology and Tools for Brand Voice Consistency

Technology drives innovation while making many tasks easier, and this is particularly true for communication. You can leverage several tools to match the tones of voice you’d like to target or ensure content maintains a consistent brand voice. Here are some of the best tools:

  • ChatGPT: ChatGPT and other large language models can generate content matching tone and voice examples or guidelines. It can also scan content to assess if the voice and tone match a brand’s target audience, but the power of these AI tools extends much further. When training a GPT model to your brand’s style, you can assess large volumes of content to ensure it matches voice requirements, automating part of your review process.
  • Grammarly Business: Most people know Grammarly for its spelling and grammar checks, but the platform also lets you select various tone and style settings. Doing so helps ensure content matches your brand voice and remains consistent.
Screenshot of style guide interface for importing rules.
  • Acrolinx: Acrolinx provides similar capabilities to Grammarly but also includes a more extensive generative AI tool to help match style guidelines while scaling up content creation.
  • Hootsuite: Hootsuite lets you manage most social media accounts from one platform, ensuring consistent communications. The platform includes engagement tools that optimize your brand voice to match specific social media platforms, and you can also use the OwlyWriter AI feature to discover new content ideas or create posts
Graphic showing steps for creating content with icons and captions.

  • Asana: Asana is a project management tool. While it doesn’t assess or improve brand voice directly, it makes these processes (as well as content creation and publishing) easier for everyone involved by implementing a collaborative workflow.
  • SurveyMonkey: Direct insights from your audience are invaluable for optimizing your brand voice. SurveyMonkey is one of the tools you can use to determine whether your communications resonate with customers. You can also survey your audience for future content ideas or website-user-experience improvements.

Future Trends in Brand Voice and Tone

Brand voice reflects your business’ personality, but it’s also a product of the marketing environment. Shifts in the environment readily change how brands communicate. Here are some trends we’ve noticed:

  • Desire for personalization and humanization: People increasingly favor brands with conversational, empathetic tones. They also seek personalized customer service — a shift partly driven by the uptick of AI chatbots.
  • Emphasis on authenticity and transparency: People prefer open and honest businesses, and many brands now follow this trend. For example, Patagonia now discusses its manufacturing processes and environmental impact through “The Footprint Chronicles” to improve transparency.
Collage of diverse workers in sustainable fashion, facts on progress from Patagonia.

New technologies

Shifts in consumer sentiment aren’t the only thing affecting the marketing landscape. Businesses are also adapting their brand voice through the power of new technologies. The most noteworthy include:

  • Augmented and virtual reality: AR and VR enable more vibrant communication between businesses and customers. For example, Patrón Tequila uses VR to give distillery tours. The immersive visuals breathe life into the brand’s storytelling, reinforcing its voice.
Immersive virtual field with purple flowers and distillery tour path, The Art of Patron at the top.
  • AI and machine learning: Advances in AI and machine learning help businesses adapt their voice and tone to specific situations. These technologies also enable personalized real-time communications. For example, Amazon’s Alexa provides targeted information and shopping recommendations through the brand’s helpful, friendly voice.

Don’t miss out on opportunities to communicate with your customers in newer and more personalized ways than your competitors have done. Invest in emerging technology now, and always keep an eye on the horizon, because things can change in an instant.

Discover Expertise to Elevate Your Voice

Mastering brand voice and tone sets you on the right path to establishing strong relationships with your audience and becoming a household name like Coca-Cola or Microsoft. However, consistency is essential.

Integrating your voice into your content strategy is essential to ensure communication matches your brand’s personality, whether you’re reaching out to customers through an email or a Facebook post. It is also important  to follow SEO best practices.

If you don’t have the time to create detailed style guides and project briefs or refine the nuances of your brand messaging, we’ve got you covered. Look into our content strategy services. We can refine your brand’s personality, creating impactful messaging that resonates with your audience and grows your online presence. Our comprehensive services include everything from planning to streamlined production to help you dominate content marketing in every area. 

The post Mastering Brand Voice and Tone for Dynamic Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Write a Content Brief: A Comprehensive Guide for Effective Content Planning https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-write-a-content-brief-a-comprehensive-guide-for-effective-content-planning/ Fri, 17 May 2024 06:12:20 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38090 Publishing content without a clear plan is like heading into the woods and leaving your compass at home. Sure, you might have a sense of the direction you need to go in, but there’s a good chance you’ll miss the mark. Knowing how to write a content brief can help you find your way in […]

The post How to Write a Content Brief: A Comprehensive Guide for Effective Content Planning appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Publishing content without a clear plan is like heading into the woods and leaving your compass at home. Sure, you might have a sense of the direction you need to go in, but there’s a good chance you’ll miss the mark. Knowing how to write a content brief can help you find your way in the digital wilderness, zeroing in on your audience and crushing your marketing goals. 

What exactly is this essential tool? A content brief is a set of instructions that lays out what your team needs to accomplish with a piece of content. It outlines details such as objective, word count, keyword placement, formatting, and tone, all backed by solid audience research and data. Follow along as we show you how to create an effective brief to maximize the impact of your content strategy. We’ll also share a downloadable content brief template that you can customize for your own needs.

How to Write a Content Brief to Guide Content Creation

A content brief is like an instruction manual, summarizing the requirements for building each piece of content. Everyone on your team, including writers, editors, subject matter experts, SEO specialists, and designers, should be using this reference document to guide them in the content-production process.

It might feel like a time-consuming and unnecessary step; after all, can’t you just give your writer a topic and some keywords and call it a day? In our experience, the time spent building a content brief pays off handsomely down the line. You’ll get closer to your goals on the first draft while also ensuring your content strategy is properly implemented.

A thorough content brief:

  • Establishes the goal of a piece
  • Defines the target audience
  • Ensures your content stays on brand
  • Reduces uncertainty and time spent clarifying issues
  • Summarizes important points to be covered
  • Boosts productivity by allowing writers to focus on execution
  • Reduces editing and the need for rewrites
  • Speeds up approvals, because stakeholders have signed off on the brief
  • Supports content outsourcing, allowing anyone to step in and immediately understand project requirements

Tools for content brief creation

You can accelerate the creation of your content briefs by leveraging some of the AI-powered tools on the market. These platforms automate tasks like keyword research, audience analysis, and ideation, freeing up your time to focus on storytelling, creativity, and ways to make your content stand out.

A few different tools are worth having at your fingertips:

  • Content creation tools: AI content creation tools can help generate ideas for blog posts, develop outlines, and lay the groundwork for content briefs. The key to these platforms, however, is to use them as a launching pad. To make your final product unique, you’ll still need to take the time to customize your brief for your particular audience and business goals.
  • SEO tools: Keyword research tools are critical for creating the content your audience is searching for. Use these platforms to generate keyword ideas, analyze competitor strategies, and clarify user intent. Some tools can also generate outlines and recommend target keywords, word count, and readability scores based on top-ranking pages.
  • Audience analytics: Segment your audience to tailor your content more precisely. Google Analytics provides aggregate information on who’s visiting your website, where they’re located, and what their interests are. You can also see which pages they’re engaging with on your site — and which ones they’re not — to help you better address your audience’s needs and preferences. 
  • Content brief generators: Platforms such as Thruuu and Keyword Insights analyze search result pages to generate briefs for your content. Use these to get a head start on your brief and supplement them with your own expertise and knowledge to ensure your content is valuable and unique and meets Google’s E-E-A-T guidelines.

Step 1: Define Your Project Goals

Now it’s time to write a content brief. The first stage of the process is to set your content marketing goals, which should be guided by the needs of your business.

HubSpot infographic outlining the SMART goals framework with colorful icons.

Many brands use the SMART framework to clarify what they need to accomplish when setting goals. SMART stands for: 

  • Specific: What do you want the content to achieve? Why does it matter?
  • Measurable: What does success look like? Make sure it’s quantifiable.
  • Attainable: Do you have the resources available to meet the goal?
  • Relevant: Does the goal matter? Is it aligned with your brand’s priorities?
  • Time-bound: What’s the time frame for achieving the goal?

You might decide your objective is to increase website traffic. Use the SMART framework to break down the goal and give yourself a clear sense of direction: 

  • The specific goal is to increase website traffic by 20%.
  • It will be measured through metrics such as keyword position, click-through rates, and traffic.
  • It will be achieved by scaling the production of helpful, optimized blog content.
  • The goal is relevant because it supports lead generation and revenue.
  • The time frame for the goal is six months.

Realizing your goals through purpose-driven content

With your objectives in hand, determine the type of content needed to achieve them. Each piece of content should have a clear role in your overall strategy. 

Many businesses focus on blog posts, but you can use a variety of formats, depending on what you want to convey. We’ve highlighted some common content types below, organized by why you might use them for audience engagement.

Generating leads

  • White papers
  • E-books
  • Blog posts
  • Landing pages

Establishing authority

  • Thought leadership
  • Guest blogs

Building brand awareness

  • Social media posts
  • Informational blog posts
  • Infographics

Retaining customers

  • Product tips
  • How-to guides
  • Tutorials
  • Email newsletters

Step 2: Identify Your Target Audience 

Your audience is at the heart of your content strategy — they’re the reason you craft and share content. They influence the type of content you create, the way you express your message, and the content distribution channels you use. Your content must be authentic and engaging. The more insight you have into your audience’s motivations and preferences, the better you can tailor your content.

Audiences aren’t uniform, so begin by segmenting them according to shared characteristics such as age, gender, location, or interests. You can then use these segments to customize their user experience. For example, some customers may prefer shopping directly on social platforms while others like product recommendations in their inbox. Make sure you’re marketing in the right places with content that speaks directly to your customers’ interests.

Incorporating audience personas into your content brief

Audience personas are extremely powerful tools for guiding your content marketing strategy. When it comes to content briefs, however, the challenge is making this information useful for writers. Rick Leach, our VP of Content Operations, elaborated on this in a Crowd Content podcast. He notes that vague audience demographics don’t help writers tailor their content in an impactful way: 

“What I’ve started to do in the briefs we create is to give audience insights rather than a persona,” he says. “What are our audience’s pain points … What resonates with this audience as it relates to this content? That type of information in the hands of a writer is very valuable.”

He goes on to say that pain points change, depending on the topic, so you should revise this section in every content brief to sufficiently equip your writers. “Now it’s informing how they write that article,” he explains. “It helps [the writer] empathize with the audience’s specific pain points on the subject matter and present solutions that should resonate.”

Advanced techniques for audience research

So how do you go about gathering these insights about your customers? Here are a few suggestions:

  • Communicate directly. Use surveys, interviews, and focus groups to understand their priorities, frustrations, and concerns.
  • Listen in on social networks. Learn what customers are saying about your industry, brand, and competitors in online communities and on blogs and social platforms.
  • Leverage market research tools. Build in-depth profiles of your customers using audience intelligence platforms such as SparkToro or Audiense.
  • Conduct behavioral analytics. Understand how your customers engage with your marketing channels through web analytics tools, heatmaps, and session recordings. You can see where your content successfully engages them and where you may need to improve.

Step 3: Outline Content Specifications 

When you’ve determined the type of content you want to create, it’s time to drill down to the details. Your team will need certain information to execute the content, so use the list below as a checklist for your content brief. The more precise you can be in the brief the better, so include any additional resources or notes you think may be helpful. 

  • Content type: Specify the type of content you’re creating, such as a blog post, white paper, landing page, or case study. 
  • Summary: Describe in a few sentences what the content should cover to guide the piece and ensure it stays on track. For example, the summary for the article you’re reading right now might be “Explain how to write a content brief, covering steps such as audience research and SEO.”
  • Objective: Explain what the piece should accomplish and the key takeaways.  
  • Content outline: Detail the topics to cover, including suggested section headers.
  • Target audience: Provide insights about audience pain points and the type of problems they want to solve.
  • Style: Establish stylistic requirements such as formatting, point of view, abbreviations, and comma usage. These should be consistent across your content inventory.
  • Voice and tone: Elaborate on how the writer should communicate to your readers. Voice and tone affect how audiences perceive and relate to your brand. 
LinkedIn post by Areti Vassou on tailoring content tone to audience demographics and interests.

Defining your content’s voice and tone

Let’s talk a little more about voice and tone, because the way you express your message is critical to how audiences react to your content. Two elements come into play here — your brand voice and the content’s tone.

  • Brand voice is the overall personality of your business. It’s tied to your organization’s mission and values and helps distinguish your brand from others. For example, your voice might be sophisticated, humorous, socially conscious, or bold. Voice should be consistent throughout your content so audiences know what to expect and can begin to build a relationship with your brand.
  • Tone is the mood or feeling you set within a specific piece. Tone often changes, depending on the purpose of the piece or distribution channel. You might use a playful tone on social media to capture attention and a formal tone in a white paper to establish authority.

Writers need to know your voice and tone because it affects:  

  • Word choice
  • Sentence structure
  • Point of view 
  • Vocabulary level
  • Descriptiveness or storytelling techniques

For example, to achieve a professional tone, a writer might use third-person point of view, longer sentences, and a formal vocabulary. Conversely, acasual tone usually consists of shorter sentences, colloquialisms, and rhetorical questions. You can also specify these requirements in your content brief.

Step 4: Structure Your Content 

You can give writers the freedom to create content as they see fit, but the more structure you provide, the more likely the final product will satisfy your goals and audience needs. 

Research your topic and add value

The key to ranking well is to tackle a topic better than your competitors. Review the pages that are ranking for your keyword — not to copy your competitors’ content but to find ways to improve on the content. A content gap analysis can help you gain ground on the competitors. During your research, gather ideas, statistics, examples, and case studies that will help you create a useful, valuable piece. 

Crafting an engaging and coherent outline

Organize your ideas into sections. Use your main points as headers and add supporting points in the relevant sections. Try to build a logical structure for your content.

Inverted pyramid infographic explaining the hierarchy of information importance.

Use an inverted pyramid style of writing to present the most important information first, working your way to the details. This approach works well for the overall structure of a piece as well as for individual sections. It helps create a logical flow so you can lead your reader through the content seamlessly.

Each section should tie back to the purpose of your article. If it’s not relevant, it should probably be removed to ensure your article is cohesive. For example, if the purpose of your article is to explain how to make the perfect cup of coffee, a recipe for coffee cake likely isn’t relevant — no matter how delicious it sounds.

Integrating UX design principles into content structure

Consider implementing a user-friendly structure for each type of content on your website. You might have one structure for blog posts, for example, and another for service pages. Writers will know right away how to structure the relevant piece of content.

Browse through the Poppy & Peonies website, and you’ll see that they use the same structure for all of their product descriptions — a descriptive paragraph, followed by bullet points. This structure is easy for readers to consume. 

Product description for a versatile travel bag from the website Poppy & Peonies with detailed features and color options.

MoneyTips, which writes on complex financial topics, structures each article with an introduction followed by a three-bullet summary. “The Short Version” helps surface key information right at the top of the article.

Article on mortgage rates with a brief explanation and tips for locking in low rates.

Step 5: Incorporate SEO and Keywords 

Your content marketing strategy should be guided by keywords to ensure audiences can discover your content in search engines. List your target keywords in your content brief so your writer can incorporate them according to SEO best practices. 

Typically, you’ll focus on a primary keyword and a few secondary keywords that are variations of the primary keyword. According to best practices, you should use your primary keyword in:

  • The title
  • Introductory paragraph
  • One H2 header
  • URL slug
  • Meta title and description

Secondary keywords can be used once in the body copy, but use keywords only if they fit easily into your copy. You can adjust awkward keywords to make them sound more natural.

Keywords should just be a guide for your content. Writers should focus on creating helpful content that engages readers, not on search engines. That’s where you’ll find the most success. For example, while there are tools that check your content for keyword density, relying on them often means you’re writing to satisfy Google and not your human readers. Search engines are sophisticated enough to understand your content if you address a topic comprehensively. There’s no need to stuff it with keywords.

Mastering the art of keyword research

Keyword research tools help you find search terms related to your product or service, along with data such as the number of times users search for it and how hard it is to compete for the top spots in the SERPs. Strike a balance between search volume and keyword difficulty when choosing keywords to target.

Start your research with a broad keyword related to your product or service and then sift through to find other relevant terms. You might use “backpack” as a starting point and then discover audiences are also searching for “work backpack” and “best backpack for hiking.” Decide which keywords are relevant to your business and use these to guide your content creation.

Remember that search volume usually drops as keywords get more specific, but this isn’t necessarily a bad thing. Customers further along in their research usually use more precise keywords and are easier to convert.

Step 6: Finalize and Provide Feedback

Before finalizing your brief, invite your stakeholders to share their thoughts. Depending on your company’s organizational structure, you may want input from:

  • Content strategists
  • Editorial directors
  • Marketing directors
  • Product managers
  • SEO specialists
  • Subject matter experts
  • Senior leadership
  • Creative team (for design elements)

You can draw on your colleagues’ expertise to refine your outline and enhance the value of your piece. This step also helps manage expectations: If your stakeholders sign off at the beginning of the content production phase, there should be fewer revisions during editing and approvals.

Revise the document based on the feedback and then put the brief into the hands of your content creation team for implementation.

Embracing agile feedback loops in content strategy

Publishing your content and sending it into the world can feel like the conclusion of your content strategy, but it’s just one part of an ongoing process. To maximize your content’s impact, you need to gather feedback and data, adjusting your tactics over time to improve performance and respond to shifts in audience behaviors.

  • Ask your content creation team for feedback on the brief. Was it helpful? What additional information do they need to do their jobs better in the future?
  • Invite your stakeholders to share thoughts on the final product. Did it meet their expectations? How would they improve on it?
  • Determine how audiences engaged with your content. Analyze key performance indicators (KPIs) and metrics such as page views, time on page, bounce rate, social shares, and conversions.
  • Adjust your strategy. Based on the insights, refine your content strategy. Experiment with messaging, format, and content distribution channels, or perform testing to see how audiences respond to variations of headlines and other elements. Then use your findings to inform your next set of content briefs.
X post by Joseph J. Master discussing the importance of a circular strategy with feedback.

From Blueprint to Breakthrough: Download Our Content Brief Template

An effective content strategy can help convert audiences, but each piece of content you publish needs to pull its weight. A content brief helps you keep each piece tightly focused, summarizing details about content goals, audience, keywords, messaging, tone, and style. Backed by solid research and analytics, this document is a valuable reference for everyone on a content team and will ensure your final product aligns with your target audience and business goals.

Are you ready to elevate your content strategy to engage audiences and drive results more effectively? Discover how this essential tool streamlines your workflow, ensures consistency, and improves outcomes. Download Crowd Content’s expertly designed content brief template and get started today.

The post How to Write a Content Brief: A Comprehensive Guide for Effective Content Planning appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
16 Subject Matter Expert Interview Questions https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/16-subject-matter-expert-interview-questions/ Mon, 06 May 2024 15:25:48 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=38001 Do you know how to ask the right subject matter expert interview questions? Gone are the days when content was all about getting as many high-value keywords onto a page as possible or churning out backlinks through guest posts. Today’s search landscape is all about authority and expertise — something SMEs have in spades. Readers […]

The post 16 Subject Matter Expert Interview Questions appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Do you know how to ask the right subject matter expert interview questions? Gone are the days when content was all about getting as many high-value keywords onto a page as possible or churning out backlinks through guest posts. Today’s search landscape is all about authority and expertise — something SMEs have in spades.

Readers want information they can trust, and Google wants to give it to them. In fact, Google’s manual raters specifically look for elements of experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness — the E-E-A-T guidelines — when evaluating page and website quality.

How do you use SMEs to insert this kind of credibility into your content? It requires getting a feel for their professional experience and discovering if it’s compatible with your niche market. We’ve prepared 16 targeted questions to guide your interview.

Preparing for the Interview

So, you know you need a SME to build authority and create content that tops the search results. But how do you go about finding prospective experts within your niche?

Identifying your ideal SME

Finding the ideal SME will depend on the type of content you’re providing, your goals, and what expertise is most valuable to your audience. Here are some valuable resources you can use to find these experts:

  • Networking sites such as LinkedIn
  • Professional associations
  • Academic institutions
  • Consulting firms
  • Social media
  • Industry publications

Pre-interview research essentials

Once you have a short list of business-relevant experts, be thorough during the selection process, as interviewing SMEs takes a lot of time and research. You want to avoid discovering halfway through the process that someone simply isn’t a good fit for your needs.

That’s where pre-interview research comes in. Do it right, and you’ll avoid headaches later. At the bare minimum, you should check the following details before approaching a SME for further discussion:

  • Check audience alignment: Does the SME resonate well with your target audience? SMEs aren’t merely a source of knowledge. Just look at how science communicator Bill Nye enchants audiences — the right SME can turn an average article into high-ranking content filled with insights.
  • Evaluate past work:  Your SME should have a body of work you can examine. Read through their documents and listen to past public speaking engagements so you have a clear understanding of  their experience and personality.
  • Look for unique insights: A lot of web content is unoriginal or unhelpful — a problem Google seeks to fix with updates such as Helpful Content. SMEs who provide a unique perspective are a gold mine in today’s search landscape. As digital marketing pioneer Ann Handley says, “In a sea of mediocre content, a brave tone can be a big differentiator.”

Crafting Effective Subject Matter Expert Interview Questions

Eventually, you’ll need to interview your SMEs to explore the depth of their knowledge. However, there’s a right and wrong way to go about this.

For example, asking questions that yield simple yes or no answers won’t reveal much, so stick to open-ended questions when possible. You should also frame your questions neutrally if the potential for bias is a concern. Often, the best types of questions are the ones that prompt your SME to reveal personal or professional anecdotes, as this highlights the kind of personal experience and authority Google loves.

Sample SME interview questions by category

One of the easiest ways to plan your interview is by organizing questions into categories. Through these categories, you can learn more about an expert’s background, while leading the interview and staying on topic.

While it’s essential to adjust your questions based on the specific content and goals, the following list provides a solid foundation for most purposes.

Background and experience

1. What drew you to your field?

Discover what’s interesting about a specific subject through this question. This may help you tweak your content direction or learn ways to increase audience engagement.

2. Do you recall an experience that profoundly impacted your professional career?

Remember how Google prioritizes personal experience? Use this question to target Google’s E-E-A-T guidelines and meet its demand for helpful content.

3. What key lessons from your early career still influence your work today?

Learning about a subject’s foundational aspects allows you to provide relevant, valuable advice that remains evergreen.

Industry insights

4. What current trends do you find most influential in our industry?

Clean and simple — this question will empower you to make bold, accurate claims about the future of your industry, showcasing authority.

5. How do you see customer expectations or needs evolving in our industry?

In a 1989 interview with Inc. magazine, Steve Jobs said, “You can’t just ask customers what they want and then try to give that to them. By the time you get it built, they’ll want something new.” Your SME offers a unique perspective into customer psychology, so make sure you benefit from it.

6. What emerging technologies or methodologies excite you the most?

Want to provoke thought and fascinate your audience? Talking about future technologies is sure to do it.

7. What do you believe is the next big thing in our field?

This question lets you build trust in your audience by positioning yourself as an industry leader.

Challenges and solutions

8. What strategies do you use when confronted with challenges?

Use this question to insert practical advice into your content, improving its helpfulness.

9. Can you describe a complex issue you resolved that significantly impacted your company or industry?

Like some of our earlier recommendations, this question helps you add experience to your content. It can even lead you to valuable case studies.

10. How do you adapt problem-solving principles for interdisciplinary teams?

This question lets you add practical advice to your content to help your audience navigate collaboration — something crucial in most industries.

Personal philosophy and approaches

11. How do you stay motivated and focused in your field?

12. What approach do you take to manage your work-life balance?

13. How do you ensure continuous growth in your professional life?

Personal questions such as the ones listed above offer a unique opportunity to give your audience practical advice. This not only adds value to your content but also makes it more link-worthy, driving future growth.

Innovation and thought leadership

14. How do you cultivate a culture of innovation within your team or organization?

15. How do you see your role evolving as the industry changes?

16. What challenges do you face when introducing new ideas or changes in your industry?

These types of questions give you the information needed to craft compelling and useful leadership content. They target common pain points your audience may face, allowing you to provide the answers they seek.

During the Interview

SMEs are a wellspring of valuable insights and experience that can elevate your content and ensure that it’s helpful and engaging. However, getting to this information requires finesse.

Building rapport with SMEs

As an interviewer, it’s your job to steer the conversation in the right direction. Think of yourself as the ship’s captain. You need to navigate the vast ocean of information to find useful facts, quotes, and anecdotes.

Easier said than done, right? Well, follow these tips for a smoother interview.

  • Organize things beforehand: Schedule a suitable time, choose the software you’ll use for the call, and let your expert see the questions in advance. Set up recording during the interview to ensure you have something to analyze later.
  • Do your research: You can’t ask relevant questions if you don’t understand the subject. Learn as much as possible about the interview’s subject to ensure you can also ask useful follow-up questions.
  • Establish common ground: Use mutual interests to build a connection with your SME and put them at ease. If you’ve had a similar experience, discuss it with them.
  • Listen and acknowledge: Active listening is crucial to a good interview. Don’t just nod and agree — offer input to show you’ve understood everything and that you value the expert’s time and opinion.
  • Maintain a conversational tone: A friendly, energetic tone and pace are ideal. While you need to stay on track, don’t be afraid to let your SME set the direction at times.

Mastering the art of follow-up questions

The other major challenge to a successful interview is the art of follow-up questions, knowing when and how to dive deeper.

Part of this goes back to a previous tip — doing your homework. But it’s also important to seek clarification if you don’t understand a concept. If you find something particularly insightful, build on your previous question to probe for more knowledge.

You can also approach follow-up in these targeted ways:

  • Rephrase a question if the SME finds it difficult to answer.
  • Ask for further information about any unfamiliar concepts or jargon.
  • Ask about related topics to form links between separate ideas.
  • Ask your SME to quantify or define anything ambiguous.

Post-Interview

Before you can incorporate insights from your SME into your content, you’ll need to analyze and refine the information you’ve gathered.

Analyzing SME insights

During the interview, it’s important to record everything said so you can transcribe and refer to it later. Then, approach the analysis.

  1. Highlight key points, including advice, predictions, and stories.
  2. Identify unique perspectives that competitors aren’t already leveraging.
  3. Sort all information based on categories such as industry trends and solutions to problems.
  4. Assess the information’s relevance for your audience.
  5. Determine where and how you can integrate insights into your content.

Refining and integrating interview findings

After analyzing the interview, there are many ways you can refine your content and integrate insights from your SME seamlessly:

  • Use quotes: A quote is a powerful way to add authority to various kinds of content. Use direct quotes for impact or paraphrase your expert’s major points to support arguments and ideas in articles, videos, and social media posts.
  • Condense information: SMEs have the professional experience to cover topics in great detail. It’s often necessary to summarize and simplify some concepts so your audience finds the information approachable and easy to understand.
  • Add examples: Incorporate SME anecdotes into your content as real-life examples to illustrate complex points and make your content more relatable.
  • Provide comparisons: Comparing your expert’s insights with other prominent figures balances your content. However, you can also use this technique to add contrast. For example, you can use your SME’s expertise to dispel a widespread myth.

SME Interviews: Enhancing Content Quality and Engagement

Experts bring extensive knowledge and unique experiences to the table, allowing you to position your business as an authority figure in the eyes of Google. They also help you craft engaging content that visitors will love to read from beginning to end.

However, you’ll miss out on these benefits if you don’t have a way to draw out the potential of your SMEs. That’s why you need methods to vet each expert and an interview process that gets to the heart of their expertise.If you need a professional to review your content, take a look at our SME services. We’ve vetted and verified each member of our network, giving you easy access to experienced professionals and streamlined content creation.

The post 16 Subject Matter Expert Interview Questions appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
The Ultimate Guide to Landing Page Structure https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/article-writing/the-ultimate-guide-to-landing-page-structure/ Mon, 29 Apr 2024 21:17:53 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37968 Your marketing campaigns have done their job, parachuting audiences onto your website. Now, it’s time for your landing pages to take over. Whether you want customers to sign up for a trial, subscribe to a list, or make a purchase, having an effective landing page structure can be the difference between a successful conversion and […]

The post The Ultimate Guide to Landing Page Structure appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Your marketing campaigns have done their job, parachuting audiences onto your website. Now, it’s time for your landing pages to take over. Whether you want customers to sign up for a trial, subscribe to a list, or make a purchase, having an effective landing page structure can be the difference between a successful conversion and a bounce.

Crafting a page that converts is both an art and a science. You need a generous dose of creativity and a flair for design that inspires readers, supported by an analytical approach that subtly moves customers toward a goal. When you hit that optimum point, you can really drive results. Learn how to strike this delicate balance by putting best practices for creating effective landing pages to work.

Breaking Down Landing Page Structure

A landing page is a web page designed to coax visitors toward a specific action, usually attracting traffic drawn from search engines, email marketing, or social media campaigns. Visitors typically approach a landing page in two parts.

The content at the top of the page sparks interest, concisely communicating the benefits or offer, and provides a call-to-action (CTA). This content typically fits on the screen above the fold, meaning no scrolling is required to read it. As visitors scroll down, they can then access detailed information to support their decision-making, such as product features and social proof.

Check out this landing page example from Unbounce. It has a clear call-to-action (CTA) above the fold and persuasive details below the fold.

screenshot of unbounce landing page hero

Core elements of landing page design

Your landing page should be engaging and user-friendly to compel readers to take action. Include these key elements:

  • Headline: Lead the way with a catchy headline that communicates the value of your offering.
  • Subhead: The subhead is a concise sentence or two providing additional context.
  • Hero image or video: Reel in your reader with a striking image or embedded video to make an impactful first impression.
  • Call to action: Your CTA is a prominent button, form, or link that directs visitors to take a desired action, such as “Download” or “Buy Now.” 
  • Persuasive content: Write highly convincing content that communicates your value proposition and the benefits or features of your product. Make the content easy to skim, and consider using bullet-point lists or charts.
  • Social proof: Reassure your audience of the value of your brand with testimonials, reviews, and trust symbols, such as logos of companies using your product or service.

Enhancing traditional structures with modern design

Bring the elements of your landing page together so it’s visually appealing and easy to consume. You might be inclined to cram the page with tons of information to help your reader make a decision, but if you bombard them with too much detail, it becomes harder for them to decide.

Instead, opt for a clear, intuitive layout that highlights key information and the CTA. Modern design principles work well, as white space and contrast can direct the reader’s attention. To create interest, use expressive typography in different weights and colors to set the mood. In the example below, Dropbox takes a minimalist approach that’s still highly effective.

screenshot of dropbox landing page hero

In comparison, beauty subscription brand Boxy Charm leverages color and a hero image on its landing page. In marketing color psychology, pinks and lavenders create a soft, soothing aesthetic and are often used for beauty products. 

screenshot of boxy charm landing page hero

Adhering to SEO principles

Landing pages are often paired with email, social media, and PPC campaigns, but you can also capture audiences through search engines. Make sure your page is discoverable on Google by following best practices for SEO:

  • Use keyword research tools to target search terms for ranking
  • Create helpful, informative, and high-quality content
  • Ensure the page loads quickly and is mobile-friendly
  • Include descriptive meta titles and descriptions
  • Compress images and include alt-text

Designing for Conversion: Key Elements of Effective Landing Pages

Now, how do you leverage these elements to drive readers toward a goal? Let’s look at a few strategies to design for conversion.

Crafting compelling headlines for maximum impact

The headline welcomes readers with a concise statement highlighting the value of your offering. Place the headline prominently on the page and make sure it’s simple and clear — technical terms and jargon only cloud your message. The fewer words you use to convey your message, the better. You can use  a subheader that provides more context or elaboration to complement the headline.

To grab the reader’s attention, try:

  • Creating energy with action verbs
  • Posing a question that invites them to discover the answer
  • Teasing a benefit to spark curiosity (but get to the point ASAP)
  • Using numbers and statistics for credibility

Check out Proof’s landing page — the headline is incredibly simple, uses action-oriented wording, and promises tangible results that are pretty hard to turn down. Notice it’s accompanied by a clear call to action and social proof.

screenshot of proof landing page hero

The role of visuals in conversion optimization

Visuals make a landing page more enticing and exciting by reinforcing your headline message and evoking an emotional response in your customer. Let’s look at a landing page for Trusted Housesitters, a platform that connects pet lovers with pet owners who need someone to care for their furry companions. The image on this page appeals to both target audiences. It emphasizes the joy in caring for a pet while assuring pet owners that their pets are in good hands while they’re away. This page also uses social proof, descriptive CTAs, and a down arrow directing users to scroll to learn more.

screenshot of trusted housesitters landing page hero

Breather, a provider of workspaces for quiet, focused work, also has a prominent image on its landing page. The photo of a bright, airy, and empty workspace backs up the value proposition. 

screenshot of breather landing page hero

If you want to step up your landing page game, consider adding a short video. According to a WyzOwl survey, 89% of people say watching a video has convinced them to buy a product or service. Videos help customers see your product in action and get a better feel for its features and benefits. You can also use customer testimonial videos as a form of social proof to drive your audience toward conversion.

Writing irresistible CTAs

The call to action is a critical element of your landing page, allowing your reader to take you up on your offer. Make it easy for them to complete the action.

  • Positioning: Place your CTAs strategically. CTAs should be placed above the fold for those who have done their research and are ready to take action and should be placed at the end of each section for those who need a little more persuasion. “You never know where a user will pause or how far they’ll go,” Cassandra Parsons, VP of Operations at ViziSites, explains in our webinar about optimizing your website for conversions.
  • Prominence: Effective calls to action should be large, legible, and easy to find on the page. Use contrast to help buttons stand out and make sure they appear clickable.
  • Precise wording: While your CTA should be short and sweet, it should also be descriptive and should generate excitement. Create a sense of urgency and explain exactly what the consumer gets when they click. Instead of “Get Started,” for example, try “Get 30 Days Free” to compel readers to convert.
screenshot of a shopify dos and donts table

Tailoring Landing Pages to Your Audience

Audiences are more likely to convert if your landing page aligns seamlessly with their needs. Use customer surveys, analytics data, focus groups, and market research to gather insights and tailor content to their interests and pain points.

Even within your customer base, there can be differences in needs and preferences. When analyzing data, divide your audience into segments based on factors such as age, gender, location, interests, browsing history, or purchase history. You can improve conversions by customizing landing pages and offering better user experiences for each segment.

Using audience insights to inform design choices

From your research, you should have a good picture of who’s clicking on your ad, email, or social post to get to your landing page. Stay true to your branding, but design custom pages and direct users appropriately.

Let’s say you sell outdoor gear. Some of your customers may be single, tend to lean toward outback adventures, and frequent TikTok. Others may have children, plan family camping trips, and get information from Facebook. You can customize images, messaging, and product recommendations based on lifestyle. If you have retail storefronts, you can also create a dynamic landing page based on user location and provide store-specific information. 

With dynamic content, you can also personalize messaging based on past interactions and display relevant recommendations or offers. By adapting your landing page to your audience, you’re speaking directly to their needs and interests, inspiring engagement and stronger customer relationships.

Personalization techniques for enhanced engagement

Sometimes, you can gather information right on your landing page to customize an experience. Let’s deconstruct this MailChimp landing page.

screenshot of the intuit mailchimp landing page hero

All the essential above-the-fold elements are checked off: headline, relevant copy, hero image, and trust symbol. At the bottom of the screen, readers are posed with a question: “How many contacts do you have?” Readers will receive a package suggestion based on their answer to help narrow down their choices. If readers are looking for more personalized content, they can click on “Find my plan” to the left and complete a quiz for a recommendation.

mailchimp find my plan screenshotv

Optimizing Landing Page Performance

Just as you might fine-tune a sports car for precision and speed, you can monitor, test, and refine your landing page. Optimization requires critical attention to every aspect of your landing page structure, design, and functionality, creating a well-oiled machine that efficiently carries your reader across the finish line.

Technical optimization to retain visitors

Test your page loading time to improve user experience. Most online viewers desire and expect quick and easy experiences. If your page is running slowly, it won’t take long for most of them to bounce. Shift your site into high gear by compressing images, minifying files, and implementing browser caching to improve page speed and get your message across as quickly as possible.

Your page should also be mobile-friendly. Customers will get frustrated by buttons that are too small to tap or content that runs off their smartphone screen. Make sure your landing page works smoothly across devices and is responsive for all users.

A/B testing for data-driven design solutions

During your creative brainstorming, you likely came up with a few different headlines, visuals, and CTAs. Once your page’s basic functionality is in place, conduct A/B tests to compare variations of landing page elements. You might be surprised at which ones you think will generate a positive response compared to the ones that actually do. Analyze the performance metrics to see which version resonates best with your audience and helps you seal the deal.

Analyzing and Interpreting Landing Page Metrics

As we stated previously, landing page structure is art and  science. It’s now time to don your lab coat and use analytics to assess if your page is working the way it should.

Essential KPIs for landing page analysis

Key performance indicators (KPIs) are quantifiable measurements that help you gauge page performance. Are your visitors taking time to read your content or bouncing off right away? What percentage converts? Quality data helps you pinpoint areas of weakness so you can make data-driven decisions, improve your landing page, and get closer to your intended goals.

Here are some common KPIs to consider when evaluating landing page performance:

  • Bounce rate: Bounce rate measures the percentage of visitors who leave a landing page without engaging. If you have a high bounce rate, check your page speed and mobile friendliness. Scrutinize above-the-fold content to see if your headline and image are communicating the value of your offer in a compelling way.  
  • Click-through rate (CTR): CTR measures the percentage of visitors who click on a link or button on the landing page. A high CTR indicates the page successfully captures visitors’ attention and encourages them to engage further.
  • Conversion rate: The conversion rate measures the percentage of visitors who complete a desired action, such as making a purchase, downloading an e-book, or signing up for a free trial. Aim to improve your conversion rate over time.
  • Video views: Track whether people are engaging with your video content to determine its effectiveness. If video views are high but the conversion rate is low, the video may be too long, not interesting enough, or weak at conveying your value proposition.
  • Average session duration: How long are visitors staying on the page? A longer session duration suggests visitors are engaged with the content and considering your value proposition. If they aren’t converting, you might review your CTA.

Tools and techniques for advanced analytics

Gathering the data is just the first step. It can be challenging to interpret numbers and draw meaningful conclusions when there might be multiple reasons a landing page isn’t performing. Often, you have to make incremental adjustments and continue monitoring.

Analytics tools, such as Smartlook, Hotjar, and Lucky Orange, can offer insight into customer intent and behavior. These platforms use heat maps, journey mapping, and session replay to give you an idea of how customers interact with your page. These tools can detect where users stop scrolling, how much of a form they complete, and where they try to click. This data can help put your KPIs into context, zeroing in on problem areas that are confusing or frustrating audiences so you can refine your content or design.

screenshot of linkedin session replay techniques comment by Neeraj Kumar

Mastering Landing Page Structure for Digital Success

The landing page is a critical point in the customer journey, transforming traffic into leads or customers. To maximize conversions, the key elements of a landing page must come together cohesively, including the headline, images and/or video, social proof, and CTAs. When you consider audience needs and shape page content and design according to best practices, you can nudge customers toward considering your offer and converting.

Elevate your landing pages beyond the competition with Crowd Content’s expert website content services. Discover how our team can help you enhance your landing page content for improved SEO and conversion rates. Visit Crowd Content’s website content services page today to learn more and start optimizing your digital presence for maximum success.

The post The Ultimate Guide to Landing Page Structure appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Unlock the Power of Digital Storytelling With a Content Marketing Strategy https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/unlock-the-power-of-digital-storytelling-with-a-content-marketing-strategy/ Tue, 23 Apr 2024 16:10:34 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37367 You can use various types of content to draw audiences to your business — helpful blog posts, insightful webinars, and clever social media posts. But all these bits and pieces of content simply scatter in the wind unless you ground them in a content marketing strategy. A content strategy is a detailed plan laying out […]

The post Unlock the Power of Digital Storytelling With a Content Marketing Strategy appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
You can use various types of content to draw audiences to your business — helpful blog posts, insightful webinars, and clever social media posts. But all these bits and pieces of content simply scatter in the wind unless you ground them in a content marketing strategy.

A content strategy is a detailed plan laying out how your business plans to engage customers using digital assets, such as online articles, videos, case studies, or podcasts. Think of it like a professional map pinpointing destinations from the top to the bottom of the funnel — a guide that delivers value, creates brand awareness, and carries your customer through every stage of the buyer’s journey. 

Core Elements of a Content Marketing Strategy

Just like you can’t make grilled cheese without bread, a content marketing strategy has nonnegotiable ingredients that pull everything together. You need to know who you’re targeting, the channels you’re using to reach them, and the goals you need to hit.

Identifying and understanding the target audience

Good content marketing revolves around your customers. You must know your audience and empathize with their needs to create content that resonates. After all, you can create a fascinating article or slick video. But if your customers shrug their collective shoulders and scroll past it, your message tumbles into the internet equivalent of a black hole.

Man looking at a computer screen with a data vortex coming out, symbolizing data transfer.

That’s why your strategy must be customer-centric. Conduct in-depth research and analysis to learn about your browsers’ demographics, interests, behaviors, preferences, and frustrations. Use this information to determine the type of content to produce, topics to cover, and tone to adopt. 

Choosing content distribution channels

The next part of your strategy focuses on distributing content so audiences discover your brand. Choose channels that align with their preferences and behaviors, which you ideally established during your audience research. Consider the channels’ reach, engagement potential, and cost-effectiveness when finalizing your choices.

To maximize reach, we recommend a mix of channels for diversity.

  • Owned channels, such as your website, blog, app, and email newsletter, are fully under your control.
  • Paid channels can give you a significant lift in exposure, but they have a price tag. PPC ads, influencer partnerships, and sponsored content fall into this category.
  • Earned channels include media mentions, user-generated content, and guest blogs. They require a third-party endorsement of your brand, which makes them feel more authentic to customers.

How to Create a Content Marketing Strategy: Step-by-Step

As you can tell, it takes time to develop a content marketing strategy that grows your business. It might seem daunting, but if you break the process into steps, your strategy slowly and surely comes together.

Define your audience

Start by defining your target audience. Buyer personas are useful for seeing your customers as people rather than a demographic. 

  • Talk to your product team. Your colleagues likely performed audience research when designing and branding the product.
  • Review website analytics. Google Analytics, for example, offers insights into audience demographics, location, interests, and their favored devices.
  • Conduct surveys and focus groups. Ask questions about preferences, challenges, and where customers get information from.
  • Monitor social media conversations. Listen to what audiences say about your industry, brand, and competitors.

Research keywords

SEO goes hand in hand with a content strategy. Perform keyword research using tools such as Semrush to ensure your content appears in the SERPs when your audience searches for your product or service. Lean on different keyword research tools to generate and analyze search terms so you can prioritize the ones with the most potential for your business. 

SEO tool screenshot showing keyword overview and difficulty for honey.

We recommend using keywords to guide your content — they’re not meant to be stuffed onto each page. Organize keywords into themes, and don’t forget long-tail keywords that reach customers with specific search intent. 

Set goals and choose KPIs

Remember that a content marketing plan needs a clear purpose to drive results. Your content goals might be to boost brand awareness, traffic, engagement, leads, conversions, or sales. Pair your goals with quantifiable metrics. These benchmarks are reference points for your progress, telling you which parts of your strategy might need a little TLC.  Over time, some metrics may spike, plateau, or drop. Use this data to keep your strategy on track and refine your tactics. Track key performance indicators regularly, especially after specific campaign rollouts. 

Determine content types and channels

Most content strategies rely heavily on blog posts because they easily adapt to your messaging. But you can (and should) draw on various content types to make your strategy more dynamic. Always keep your audience in mind, and match content to the buyer’s journey.

  • E-books and white papers let you dive deep into a topic and provide thought leadership.
  • Case studies draw on real-life examples to demonstrate a solution to a problem.
  • How-to guides and instructional resources help readers accomplish a task.
  • FAQs provide quick answers to common customer concerns.
  • Webinars and podcasts are interactive workshops, presentations, and discussions that share expertise. 

Here’s a content strategy example. If you want to use content to generate leads, and your customer is a B2B decision-maker, consider a gated white paper on your website. If they frequent LinkedIn, create a video as a teaser to capture their interest, and link to your landing page in the post.

Conduct a content audit

You don’t need to start your content production from scratch. See what assets you already have by auditing your content and creating an inventory of previously published assets. List each item in a spreadsheet and track title, URL, content type, category or theme, buyer stage, and target keywords. Then, you can determine what content you need to complete your strategy.

Pro tip: At the same time, evaluate each page to ensure it contains high-quality content that meets Google’s excellence standards. Add any necessary content refreshes into your strategy.

Build a content calendar

A content calendar helps you visualize how the pieces of your plan should roll out. Plan it at least 6 months in advance, scheduling each piece with a publication date and working backward to determine writing, editing, and design deadlines. You can also use the calendar to assign your team specific roles, especially if you have a pool of writers. Editorial calendars are essential for staying organized and keeping things going after ideation. 

Executing Your Content Marketing Strategy

While a documented content marketing plan can lead you to your goals, you unlock its potential once it’s implemented and brought to life. Create an organized content production process to ensure what you publish strikes a chord with your audience. Then, promote your content diligently so they can discover it.

Content creation best practices

Audiences quickly decide if a piece of content is relevant or interesting. Use our content creation tips to produce stellar blog posts, articles, landing pages, and web content.

  • Understand search intent. Users have a specific query in mind when they plug keywords into a search engine. If you’re targeting the search term “hatha yoga,” for example, determine if someone wants to know the history of hatha yoga, how to do it, or where to take classes. SEO tools can help with this, or you can look into the types of content currently ranking for the search term.
  • Create content briefs. Use our content brief template, and give your writers guidelines for crafting each piece. A brief covers keywords, search intent, target audience, People Also Ask questions, tone, style, word count, and deadlines. 
  • Make your content exceptional. Follow the basics of good content creation, such as writing concisely and proofreading before publishing. Every piece should provide value, such as original research and real-life examples.
  • Incorporate multimedia. Perk up written text with graphics, slide shows, or video to help tell your story in a visually appealing way. 
  • Optimize for SEO. It can seem like Google’s algorithms are random and mysterious, but there’s a method to the madness. Improve your chances of ranking by helping search engines understand the content. Add meta titles and descriptions, organize content with headers, use descriptive anchor text and URLs, and optimize for featured snippets. Videos should include transcripts for those who prefer to read, and images should have alt-text for accessibility.
  • Include CTAs. Help readers navigate your website and get to the next stage of their journey with strong, clear calls to action. You can incorporate these as links within your copy or as more prominent buttons.
  • Stay true to your brand. To build loyalty, each piece of content should reflect the essence of your brand so audiences know what to expect. Marketing specialist Ann Handley describes this as “artisanal content.” In a recent Crowd Content webinar about the future of content marketing, Handley explained, “[It’s] content that can only come from you … that’s really infused with your voice, with your point of view, or with your face, in some situations. It can’t come from anyone else; it won’t sound the same. [It] feels almost handcrafted for us specifically.” 

Effective distribution channels

Search engines, newsletters, social media, and paid ads all help distribute your content to a broad audience. To get the most impact, ensure the format suits the channel. Buffer, for example, promotes articles on LinkedIn as carousels. As users have to swipe through the content, it’s more engaging than simply posting a text summary. 

LinkedIn post by Buffer discussing engagement rates of carousel posts.

At Crowd Content, we use multiple channels to distribute content more widely. Our blog post about whether AI content can rank in Google doubled as a jumping-off point for a podcast discussion.  

“There’s no one size fits all recipe when it comes to determining what channels you should use for your business as far as what’s going to work well for you — not just the mix, but the weighting,” our VP of Content Operations, Rick Leach, recently explained. “I encourage you to try, measure, adjust … then increase or decrease the percentage of resources that go toward that channel as the data tells you.” 

Measuring the Success of Your Content Marketing Strategy

Once you have your strategy in motion, monitor your progress across your distribution channels. Platforms such as Google Analytics, Hootsuite, HubSpot, Semrush, and Ahrefs capture website analytics and integrate with social networking and email platforms to consolidate data into a single dashboard. 

Key performance indicators in content marketing

Choose KPIs related to your content marketing goals so you can make data-informed decisions and fine-tune your tactics. 

Infographic detailing common content marketing KPIs like traffic and engagement.

Analytics for strategy optimization 

You might feel like you’re swimming in numbers once the data starts rolling in. Tackle your analytics in the same way you put together your content strategy: methodically.

Colorful fish in goggles with numbers in a pool indicating caution in swimming.

Search for patterns, trends, and possible issues with your content performance. For example, begin investigating if your engagement metrics show audiences aren’t interacting. Look at individual pieces of content that are drop-off points in the funnel, or segment audiences by demographics, device, or behavior to see if a particular group isn’t engaging.

Based on the findings, you might improve navigation, design, or CTAs. You could also experiment with formats, topics, and storytelling techniques that better resonate with audience preferences. Using your data and analysis, make incremental adjustments to your content to optimize it, and continue monitoring and adjusting.

Future Trends in Content Marketing Strategy

When you think you’ve got your content marketing strategies nailed down, things shift. It’s one of the realities of our chaotic, digital world. You can expect audience preferences to change, new competitors and technologies to pop up, and algorithm updates to steer content in new directions. Adopt a proactive approach so you can prepare for these inevitable shifts.

Emerging technologies in content marketing

Businesses are already exploring how artificial intelligence and machine learning technologies can support content marketing. Be open to experimentation and innovation that can refine your strategies and set you apart from competitors. For example:

  • Content intelligence platforms identify topics for different stages of the buyer’s journey and predict the best distribution channels.
  • AI writing tools can help with research and outlining. (But make sure your final content has a human touch.)
  • AI-powered web analytics tools quickly process data to detect trends and patterns and anticipate future behavior.
  • Augmented and virtual reality offer new formats for storytelling.
Google AR & VR Twitter post about #AR guided tour in Singapore.

Changing consumer behaviors

No matter what technology you leverage, don’t lose sight of your audience. Keep a pulse on your customers. Continue to talk to them through focus groups and surveys to understand their priorities. Employ social media monitoring to listen in on real-time concerns. When you understand what’s driving audience behaviors, you can provide better content solutions to meet their needs.

LinkedIn post by Stephanie Shirley about customer demographics with a city street photo.

Crafting a Successful Content Marketing Strategy for Your Business

Once you build a solid framework for your content marketing, it’s easier to create pieces that appeal to your audience and inspire them toward desired goals. Spend some time laying the groundwork by getting to know your customers, establishing objectives, and choosing relevant distribution channels. Stay on track by monitoring KPIs and audience behaviors, and refine tactics with your sights set firmly on your goals. 

Maximize your content potential

Ready to revolutionize your brand’s digital presence? Discover how Crowd Content’s content strategy services can elevate your business. Our team of experts is dedicated to crafting bespoke strategies that resonate with your audience and drive results.

The post Unlock the Power of Digital Storytelling With a Content Marketing Strategy appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Topic Clusters https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/topic-clusters/ Fri, 19 Apr 2024 14:40:20 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37719 If there’s one thing you can always count on when it comes to digital marketing, it’s that the game is always changing. Search engines update their rules, people’s preferences shift, and competitors always seem to be onto the next big thing. In other words, what may have worked like gangbusters for your brand only a […]

The post Topic Clusters appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
If there’s one thing you can always count on when it comes to digital marketing, it’s that the game is always changing. Search engines update their rules, people’s preferences shift, and competitors always seem to be onto the next big thing.

In other words, what may have worked like gangbusters for your brand only a couple of years ago might not be doing the job anymore. The solution is to adapt and freshen up your approach to digital marketing with some savvy moves of your own.

In 2024, the trend is clear: organized, user-friendly websites filled with helpful content are where it’s at, and mastering the fine art of topic clusters can help keep you relevant. Here’s a closer look at what you need to know to bring your site up to speed with a killer topic cluster strategy of your own.

Understanding Topic Clusters

Also sometimes referred to as content clusters, topic clusters are organized groups of web pages with a centralized theme in common.

Each individual topic cluster has a pillar page that presents a broad introduction to a particular subject. It also includes multiple cluster pages that focus on a variety of related subtopics. For example, a cooking website might feature a pillar page on basic techniques with subtopic pages on subjects like baking, roasting, steaming, and frying.

A classic topic cluster model positions the pillar page as the primary hub on a broad topic by having it link out to each of the related cluster pages. Each cluster page then also links back to the associated pillar page.

Organizing related pages in this way and seamlessly linking them together comes with many potential benefits for a site, including the following:

Easier navigation for visitors

The more organized your site is, the easier it will be for your visitors to find what they’re looking for and explore your content further. Topic clusters turn browsing for information into an intuitive, user-friendly experience, often leading to lower bounce rates and higher engagement.

Stronger search engine optimization (SEO)

Grouping related pages together using the topic cluster approach helps signal to search engines that your pillar pages are worthy authorities on particular topics. It’s also an excellent way to potentially target a wider range of choice keywords.

Better brand authority

Well-organized authority content, high engagement rates, and top SERP (Search Engine Results Pages) rankings can help transform a brand into an industry authority over time. Imagine being the go-to source for information on your niche of choice. Well-strategized topic clusters can help you get there.

Impact of Topic Clusters on SEO Performance

The more you can do to show search engines you’re serious about providing your visitors and potential customers with a top-tier experience, the better it will be for your ongoing SEO strategy. In addition to making your site easier to use overall, topic clusters help boost your rankings by:

Improving your site’s internal linking structure

The internal linking method associated with topic clustering helps Google better understand what your site is really all about, why it’s important, and how your various pages are connected.

Effectively expanding the scope of your site

Search engines tend to favor sites with a consistent, organized structure and navigation system. A cluster-based system helps present information using a system search engines understand.

Potentially winning the trust of users, peers, and search engines

Google and the rest of the search engines are in the business of providing users with the best, most relevant possible solutions to their queries. Sites that are organized, user-friendly, helpful, and informative are more likely to provide those solutions and achieve top SERP rankings as a result.

Showing that your site digs deep into topics that are important to users

Pillar pages and related cluster pages allow you to organize vast amounts of information using a cohesive system that intuitively makes sense to your visitors. This makes it easy to efficiently deep-dive into the subjects your readers care about most on a level your competition may not be doing.

Helping Google better understand the hierarchy of your website

The better Google understands how your website is set up and how the content contained within it interconnects, the easier it will be to rank it. Clustering also provides a framework that lends itself well to establishing serious authority in a given niche.

Supporting your keyword strategy

Smart, natural keyword usage is already a huge part of climbing the SERPs. Adding topic clusters to your strategy can help you further focus your efforts and better plan future content, especially on a long-term basis.

Structuring Topic Clusters

Topic Clusters

Without a cohesive internal linking structure in place, it’s hard for a website to avoid becoming overwhelmingly complex as it grows. Over time, as the number of total pages increases, the overall structure of a site tends to get increasingly complicated.

Naturally, this complexity can make it tough for visitors to find the valuable content they’re looking for and equally challenging for search engine bots to figure out how your pages are connected.

As a result, Google may have trouble understanding which of your pages are the definitive authorities on the topics you cover. Instead of working together cohesively to earn you better rankings, your related pages might end up competing with each other, not just for search engine rankings but also for your visitors’ attention.

Topic clusters address all of these problems with a consistent, easy-to-follow structure that makes sense even at a glance, to human readers and search engines alike. Here’s a quick look at how they work:

Pillar page

Think of a topic cluster as a wheel with a fixed center and multiple spokes branching out from that center to support it. The cluster’s pillar page constitutes the center, providing a broad overview of a single key topic or subject.

Good pillar pages are general but fairly comprehensive, providing visitors with a solid introduction to the topic at hand and a good idea of where to go next for more answers.

Cluster pages

Your cluster pages form the spokes of your cluster wheel, supporting the main topic and providing visitors with additional, more targeted information on a variety of subtopics (one per cluster page).

Effective cluster pages cover their designated subtopics in detail, ideally answering common questions readers have and delivering useful, on-topic information.

Internal linking

The internal link structure of a topic cluster is the glue that holds the whole thing together and makes it functional. Pillar pages contain organized links to each related cluster page, and each cluster page links back to the pillar page in turn.

From your visitors to search engines, this setup helps everyone understand how your content is related and structured, which makes navigation a breeze.

Initiating Topic Cluster Strategy

Ready to start leveraging topic clusters to drive quality organic traffic and engage your target audience more effectively? Let’s break down the steps to create a cluster strategy that works:

Choose your main cluster topic

Every effective content cluster begins with a central theme. This is your foundation. Consider the following to settle on something that will really resonate with your target audience:

  • Content you already have versus any gaps that need to be filled
  • Content topics that have already worked well for you in the past
  • Subjects your audience cares deeply about or actively asks about
  • Topics your competitors are already covering that should also be part of your strategy

Be sure to select something expansive enough to yield multiple strong subtopics for fleshing out your cluster. It should be something that genuinely interests your audience and serves the needs of visitors.

Research compatible keywords

Remember, well-orchestrated content clusters and well-chosen keywords go hand in hand, so starting a new cluster should always include a fresh round of keyword research. How might a potential visitor query Google to find content like yours?

A solid keyword research tool like SEMRush Keyword Manager, KWFinder, or Google Keyword Planner can help you brainstorm lush groups of topics, subtopics, and target phrases using simple seed keywords as a starting point.

Organize your keywords throughout your cluster

Consider which core keywords are the best fit for your pillar page by reflecting on the search opportunity attached to each option. Here are some factors to keep in mind:

  • The search intent behind each keyword (in other words, the user’s true reason for entering a particular query)
  • The competition for ranking on each keyword
  • The search volume for each keyword

Next, go back to your list of possibilities and select options for each of your cluster/subtopic pages. Ensure that each of your chosen subtopics realistically relates to your pillar topic, and evaluate the possibilities for search opportunity.

Knock your content out of the park

Once you’ve mapped out the skeleton of your topic cluster, it’s time to start filling it with next-level content your audience will love. Start with your pillar page, then expand on your cluster pages, taking care to include opportunities to link back to your pillar.

The fundamentals of robust content that both human readers and Google will love include:

  • Readable formatting that includes headings, bulleted lists, images, etc.
  • Dynamic, engaging language that fits your brand voice
  • Strategically used keywords in prime places like the first paragraph and headings
  • Clear, concise wording and phrasing that’s easy to digest
  • Well-incorporated internal links that make the content more useful
  • Something extra readers won’t be able to find on competing pages

Tools and Strategies for Topic Research

Effective topic clusters that deliver don’t simply happen. They’re the results of careful, thorough research, and the right tools (including keyword research tools) can help take the guesswork out of the process. Here are a few popular options that are well worth exploring:

BuzzSumo

Buzz Sumo screenshot

You may already be using BuzzSumo in your content creation strategy, but you should know it’s perfect for brainstorming topic clusters as well. Use it to audit your existing content and identify gaps to fill. You can also leverage the Topic Explorer tool to discover potential topics related to a chosen keyword.

SEMRush

SEMRush screenshot

SEMRush is a full-service suite of tools that streamlines many aspects of keyword research, content creation, and organic research, among other necessities. It’s packed with useful features for topic cluster research, including Keyword Magic Tool, Topic Research Tool, Keyword Gap, and Organic Research.

SpyFu

SpyFu screenshot

Keeping an eye on what your competitors are doing and how your site measures up is a crucial part of staying ahead in the rankings game, and SpyFu can be quite helpful for that. Easily find out which keywords the competition is ranking for, analyze how your own strategy compares, and use the findings to brainstorm high-performance clusters.

Google Trends

Google Trends screenshot

This tool from Google itself is fantastic for comparing the search volume attached to different keyword options, especially over time. Use it to study and keep track of the topics that resonate with readers in your niche to better inform your content choices.

While picking topics you are passionate about is important, you definitely don’t want to sleep on what your competitors are up to. At the end of the day, SERP rankings are all about which pages best serve the user behind a particular query, and knowing where you stand is an important part of getting ahead. 

Pay attention to pages that rank ahead of yours for important target keywords, too. What are those pages doing that you’re not? Is there anything missing from comparable competitor pages that your site could do a bang-up job delivering? Use tools like these to stay on top of what competing brands are putting out there and look for ways to improve upon it.

Real-World Examples of Topic Clusters

Curious how topic clusters play out in real life when they’re well crafted? Here are some examples to get you inspired about the possibilities:

Wine Folly

Wine Folly’s expertly crafted Wine 101 hub is a prime example of a topic cluster that delivers. The pillar page covers key basics about wine concisely but informatively before leading the reader to a list of cluster page links that promise even more fascinating information. Examples include overviews of common varietals, wine-tasting tips, and breakdowns of the wine-making process.

HubSpot

HubSpot nails it with their guide on Instagram marketing. To begin with, Instagram marketing is absolutely a key topic of interest to their audience, and HubSpot covers it in detail across their pillar page. They also further support the pillar with multiple spoke topics for interested readers to explore next.

Podia

Online courses are red hot right now, and all-in-one marketing brand Podia leverages that to perfection with its comprehensive pillar page on how to build a course. The pillar page is treated as an “everything you need to know” guide with the cluster pages serving as supporting chapters, which works well for the type of content presented.

As you can see, the concept of the content cluster is pretty simple. However, that’s exactly what makes it so effective. It’s easy to adapt to any industry, niche, or business focus. It can be simple and concise or elaborate and detailed. It’s an effective approach to organizing content in appealing, attractive ways that encourage visitors to spend time on your site and dig a little deeper into available topics while they’re at it.

How could you use this approach to spotlight a favorite topic on your site better appeal to your audience?

Crafting High-Quality Content for Topic Clusters

Content is king when it comes to all aspects of increasing the authority and visibility of a website, and this is just as much the case with topic cluster content as with anything else. Here are a few quick and dirty tips for crafting content that’s a terrific fit for a cluster-based content strategy:

Conduct a thorough content audit

Whether you’re reorganizing existing content to fit a cluster-based content strategy or crafting new content to add to an existing cluster system, it’s crucial to know where you already are with your catalog. A content audit can help give you the perspective you need.

Look for existing content that can be refreshed and regrouped into effective new clusters. Address any issues with duplicate, irrelevant, or outdated content you find. Then plan content to fill in any obvious content gaps and make your clusters sing.

Consider key visitor pain points

People turn to search engines looking for answers or solutions. Some people have specific problems they’re hoping to solve, while others are simply on a mission to gather information.

Topic clusters provide rich opportunities to serve these users and show them how your products or services could help provide the solutions they’re looking for. Start by considering key pain points your target audience has and see how they align with your current clusters or be used as the basis for a new one.

Do plenty of market research

Market research is a highly effective way to get another angle on what your audience really wants to see from you. Perform a round of competitor and market research to get a solid read on what matters to your audience.

Consider getting feedback from your existing audience via surveys, social media, or questionnaires, as well. Assess how you can refine what you’ve learned about your readers into rock-solid content that resonates.

Hire experts to help

Crafting a top-notch, informative content that’s ideal for content clusters is a tall order, especially if you need to create a lot of it to meet your goals. It’s probably not the kind of thing you’ll be able to tackle all on your own, so consider assembling a team of professionals to help you with the job.

Think about bringing in specialists like SEO professionals, content strategists, and professional freelance writers. These people have the content creation chops to help your cluster strategy blossom, allowing you to focus on other aspects of running your business.

Measuring Topic Cluster Success

Putting together a clustering strategy you’re sure will work is only half the battle when it comes to achieving success. The rest is about monitoring, measuring, and analyzing the potential returns of your efforts. Keep a close eye on the following key performance indicators (KPIs) to properly assess your results.

Keyword rankings

Perhaps the most important factor to track is your search ranking for your pillar and subtopic pages. Improvements here are likely signs that search engines find your content informative and valuable.

Search traffic

How do the organic search traffic rates look for your cluster-related pages? An uptick in visitors naturally suggests improved search engine visibility.

Conversion rates

If you’re using topic clusters to drive sales or increase interest in products or services you sell, keep a close eye on conversion-related data. Examples include actual sales, of course, but also mailing list sign-ups and similar actions.

Internal click-through rates (CTR)

Watch the CTR attached to your internal links within your different clusters. Those links are there to encourage visitors to migrate from one page to the next and spend more time on your site, and higher CTRs suggest they’re doing their job.

Quality backlinks

High-quality backlinks are the gold standard when it comes to signs your content is resonating with all the right people. They prove that visitors from your industry or niche not only find your content valuable, but like it enough to recommend it to their own audiences.

Audience feedback

Positive user feedback is another valuable sign that you’re knocking your cluster game out of the park and then some. Encourage your audience to provide some by offering appealing incentives or engaging them directly.

Advanced Technical Insights in Topic Clusters

Even an exceptional approach to content clustering can always stand to become even better, especially over time. Here are some insights to help refine your strategy

Think like your visitors

One reason topic clusters are so effective is that searcher behavior is changing and algorithms are evolving to match. The cluster system makes it easier for today’s search engines to understand and accurately recommend websites.

However, consider the fact that people are entering sentence fragments and single words into search engines much less frequently than in the past. These days, they’re using complete sentences and tools like voice search to find answers, too. Looking for ways to state and answer common questions with unique content can help make clusters more effective.

Avoid ranking cannibalization

There’s no hard and fast rule that dictates an ideal number of subtopic pages per cluster. Generally speaking, you want to include enough to cover your subject of choice, but don’t simply assume that more is always more.

More content doesn’t always mean better coverage. If some of your subtopics are too similar to one another, you risk having them cannibalize each other and compete for rankings. Keep an eye out for telltale signs like multiple pages with similar ranking results or pages that inexplicably don’t rank as expected. If you see these, you may need to tweak things to keep your website from competing against itself.

Refresh your content often

Keep your content clusters effective by revisiting them often and refreshing them frequently so they stay as up-to-date and visible as possible. Some good rules of thumb to keep in mind include:

  • Topics that change quickly: Review at least every quarter
  • More stable topics: Check in at least annually, or more often if your field sees rapid changes
  • Evergreen content: Refresh every 18-24 months, even if it doesn’t change much
  • High-traffic pages: Give them an update every 2-3 months

You’ll also want to evaluate your clusters to assess whether it’s time to add new subtopics or even remove existing ones.

How Crowd Content Can Enhance Your Topic Cluster Strategy

Ultimately, topic clusters bring a lot of potential to the table when it comes to establishing your brand as an industry authority and providing a five-star user experience to readers. However, there’s a fine art to getting them just right.

Use clusters to explore fascinating topics in depth that will keep your readers coming back for more. Whip your existing website into shape from an organizational standpoint and ensure continued navigability moving forward as your site grows. Leverage your creativity to set yourself apart from the rest of the pack.

To really polish your strategy and ensure your content hits the mark every time, consider partnering with a premier content creation service like Crowd Content.  Crowd Content is your go-to resource for professionally crafted, search-engine-optimized content on demand that’s fully in line with your brand voice and audience expectations.

Explore Crowd Content today to discover more about how our content experts can help you make your content sparkle and boost your bottom line.

The post Topic Clusters appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
5 Strategies for Writing Blog Intros That Engage Your Audience https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/5-strategies-for-writing-blog-intros/ Tue, 26 Mar 2024 15:07:16 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37331 Today’s the day. You’re about to unearth a treasure map outlining how to create content that captivates your audience and ranks high in the SERPs. It all begins with mastering the art of writing blog intros.  Intros set the stage for that all-important first impression — not just for a specific article but for your entire […]

The post 5 Strategies for Writing Blog Intros That Engage Your Audience appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Today’s the day. You’re about to unearth a treasure map outlining how to create content that captivates your audience and ranks high in the SERPs. It all begins with mastering the art of writing blog intros. 

Intros set the stage for that all-important first impression — not just for a specific article but for your entire brand. They establish trust, help readers understand what to expect, and let them know if your content aligns with their search goals. Nail them and watch bounce rates tank while engagement and time on page soar. These are the types of metrics Google cares about — not backlink counts.  

The treasure map doesn’t lead you to any clever tricks or shortcuts. You have to demonstrate expertise, trustworthiness, and relatability through focused storytelling. Below, we outline five strategies for writing introductions that engage readers and compel them to take action. 

1. Meet Readers’ Expectations

Specializing in the practice of rhetoric, George Gopen believes engagement hinges on a writer’s ability to meet readers’ expectations. That means being able to anticipate and fulfill their needs.

Like trail markers on a hike, clear signals of an article’s argument, purpose, and intent keep people moving in the right direction. 

the right direction

You have to provide obvious cues about content, structure, and direction along the way — in titles, headings, introductions, and section transitions. Each point serves as a signpost, setting up an expectation in the reader’s mind and drawing them in closer. 

In the Gonzaga Law Review, Denise Riebe backs Gopen’s theory, saying, “By consistently placing pieces of information where readers expect it, writers gain readers’ trust.” An intro that follows smoothly and logically from your headline establishes trust right off the bat. To maintain it, demonstrate experience and expertise, and meet readers’ expectations throughout the piece.

Based on Gopen’s teachings, some things to avoid when writing blog intros include:

  • Intros that don’t relate to the headline
  • Unclear purpose and direction
  • Overly complex, wordy, or dense intros
  • Lack of engagement techniques, such as storytelling, rhetorical questions, or filler quotes

For content creators, that means writing highly focused blog intros that capture the intent of your target audience. Show off your expertise, share opinions, write with confidence, and use transition words to guide your audience seamlessly from point to point. 

Never overpromise and underdeliver. Engage your audience with well-thought-out examples, opinions, and scenarios — not gimmicks or clickbait.  

What about hooks?

Writers have been using hooks since the dawn of storytelling, but a hook alone isn’t enough to make a blog engaging. 

When marketers write blog post intros, they want readers to take action. Storytelling paints a picture of how the article directly relates to them. It creates an emotional connection between your brand and the audience by holding up a mirror to their fears, pain points, and desires.

2. Master the Art of Storytelling

Master the art of brand storytelling, and you’re well on the way to being crowned as content royalty. 

Look at it this way: Imagine yourself sitting by a crackling fireplace, listening to Grandpa spin a tale. He doesn’t throw facts at you. He draws you in with vivid descriptions, relatable characters, and a touch of mystery. That’s the power of storytelling we’re aiming for.

Our Vice President of Content Operations, Rick Leach, says,

“Storytelling is an effective tactic for engaging audiences in an article’s intro. It’s more relatable than tired and readily available statistics and builds reader trust better than gimmicky hooks. It also sets the stage for the reader, showing them what’s coming next is what they need.”

Let’s explore some dynamic ways to use storytelling in intros.

Paint a captivating picture

Describe a captivating scene to set the stage for your article. Use imagery in a way that immediately grabs the reader’s attention, places them right in the thick of it, and makes them curious about what unfolds next.

Say you’re writing an article for an inbound sales company about how to close more deals. The intro might start like this:

Ever feel like you’re battling uphill against a relentless current, desperately trying to close more deals? You’re not alone. Our guide acts as your trusty raft, navigating you through calmer waters and revealing insider secrets to closing deals that’ll have you riding the wave of success in no time.

Introduce a relatable character

Introduce a relatable character facing a challenge your audience experiences. As readers visualize themselves in the character’s situation, they’re compelled to discover how the story unfolds and what lessons they can learn. Continue referencing the character throughout the piece to keep readers engaged in their story. 

Here’s an example intro opening for a blog post about conversion rates for a digital marketing agency:

Meet Sarah, a brand-new digital marketer feeling lost in the jungle of online engagement. Among the tangled vines of clicks and impressions, Sarah uncovers a hidden gem: conversion rates. 

Tell a personal story

Share a personal anecdote or experience that aligns with your audience’s search intent. This adds authenticity and depth to your writing while building trust and rapport with your audience. Offering a glimpse into your world makes you relatable and demonstrates your topical authority to help them problem-solve. 

Let’s look at the first few lines of a recruitment company’s fictional blog intro about the top 10 traits of impactful leaders:

I’m Alex, a seasoned recruiter with a proven track record of hiring exceptional leaders. After running a business for 12 years, I’ve crafted a definitive list of the top 10 traits possessed by impactful leaders.

Set up a mystery

Begin with a mysterious or puzzling scenario that intrigues readers and makes them want to uncover the answers. Using precise, targeted language throughout your article ensures flow and seamless transitions as readers move through the piece.  

If an HVAC company writes a blog post about upgrading your cooling system, the intro might look like this:

Is your home suddenly a sauna? Perhaps your energy bills are soaring, yet you’re still shivering under thin blankets. These might be signs it’s time to investigate your cooling system’s health.

Invoke emotion

Craft your introduction to evoke specific emotions, such as empathy, aspiration, and a sense of belonging. This fosters deep connections and makes storytelling compelling and memorable. Everyone agrees striking an emotional cord with their targetted audience is the holy grail of marketing in the digital age. 

Here’s an example of how to start a blog post for an addiction treatment center. The article discusses the first step on the path to recovery: 

In the journey toward healing, every step, no matter how small, is a testament to your courage and resilience. Take the first step on the path to recovery with us, where compassionate guidance and practical advice await. 

3. Pose Questions and Integrate Quotes

Quotes and questions are powerful tools for writing blog intros, captivating readers, and arousing interest from the outset. Strategically incorporate these elements into your storytelling efforts.

Questions immediately pique readers’ curiosity and invite them to reflect on the topic at hand. Use questions to introduce a problem, prompting readers to continue reading in search of answers. Asking questions in this way creates a two-way dialogue between writer and reader, sparking deeper engagement with the content.

Quotes can add credibility, authority, and depth to blog intros — but they need to provide value. Source them from experts, industry leaders, or influencers to offer fresh or thought-provoking perspectives on a topic. Always remember to tailor the quote to user intent. For example, if you’re writing for an audience that seeks reassurance, don’t use a negative quote. Let’s say you’re working on a blog post for a rehab clinic titled Do I Need Addiction Treatment? If you start with a quote that suggests 60% of people relapse, you won’t be particularly persuasive. 

4. Strike a Balance Between SEO and Reader Engagement

Since Google’s helpful content update and the relentless march of AI, crushing SEO and reader engagement with equal force has become critical for success. Content marketers practicing the dark arts of keyword stuffing and backlink buying have been banished to irrelevance. Now, the name of the game is balance — juggling the demands of search algorithms with the desires of real people.

But how do you approach this tussle between optimization and engagement? Let’s explore some advanced optimization strategies that go far beyond keyword placement.

Advanced SEO strategies

Improve your content’s visibility using advanced SEO techniques for writing blog intros.

  • Semantic search optimization: Embrace semantic search optimization to align with the evolving nature of search engines. Focus on understanding the intent behind search queries and delivering relevant content accordingly. Use synonyms, semantic variations, and related terms to naturally weave keywords into intros.
  • Content structuring: Structured data markup provides context to search engines and improves the chances of your intro appearing as a rich snippet. Focus on providing clear and concise information, using relevant headings and subheadings, and ensuring your content is navigable by users and search engines.
  • Natural language processing: Use NLP techniques to analyze user queries and create intros that resonate with their specific language patterns. Understanding how your target audience phrases their questions and searches allows you to tailor your content and improve search engine ranking.

Remember, SEO is more than just keywords. By combining these advanced strategies with compelling storytelling and engaging writing, you can create content that ranks highly, speaks to your audience, and drives tangible outcomes.

AI and voice search optimization

Stay ahead of the curve by tapping into AI and voice search optimization. Integrate these strategies into blog intros to enhance their relevance, resonance, and performance in voice-enabled search environments.

  • AI-driven content optimization: Experiment with AI tools, such as Jasper and Rytr, to optimize your intros for engagement and SEO. AI can analyze data to identify trends, predict user behavior, and suggest content optimizations. 
  • Voice search optimization: Tailor intros to the conversational nature of voice queries. Use natural language patterns and concise language. Remember, voice searches for services often go straight to Google Maps local results. Optimize your Google Business Profile and gather stellar customer reviews to climb the local pack.

Legal and ethical guidelines when writing blog intros

Handle the complexities of content creation with ethics and legal compliance front and center. Avoid plagiarism and adhere to advertising standards while crafting authentic intros.

  • Avoid plagiarism: Conduct thorough research and cite sources properly. Use plagiarism detection tools, such as Copyscape, to verify content originality. Plagiarism destroys credibility and tarnishes your brand’s image.
  • Comply with advertising standards: Be transparent with your audience. Disclose sponsored content and affiliate links in your intros to instill Google’s final E-E-A-T guideline: trustworthiness. 

Global audience consideration

Expand your reach and impact by crafting culturally sensitive and inclusive intros that resonate with a multicultural audience. Find customers in new territories by learning how to customize intros effectively across different cultures and regions, enhancing SEO performance and reader engagement on a global scale.

5. Measure Audience Interaction Using Hard Data

Understanding your audience is crucial for creating compelling blog intros. Embrace feedback as the gold mine for improvement it truly is.

Comments

Analyze reader comments to identify common themes, recurring questions, and areas for improvement. Use technology to streamline the process and aim to focus on patterns instead of individual comments.

Social shares

Track which intros receive the most social media shares to gauge what sparks audience interest. Research the granular details of these intros so you can replicate successful elements.

Blog engagement KPIs

Engagement metrics, including bounce rate, time on page, and click-through rate, are prime KPIs for measuring blog intros’ effectiveness. Tracking these metrics over time helps you identify trends and patterns that indicate whether intros successfully capture and retain readers’ attention. For example, a high bounce rate indicates your intros aren’t effectively engaging readers, and low time on page likely means your intros aren’t up to scratch.  

 A/B testing 

To conduct an A/B test:

  • Craft two intro variations with distinct elements, such as tone, length, or formatting.
  • Present each variation to your audience and track performance through relevant metrics.
  • Analyze A/B test results to determine the winning intro and incorporate its elements into future content.

In addition to A/B testing, try out analytics tools and social listening platforms. They can give you valuable insights into audience preferences and reactions to your intros. For example, Google Analytics tracks engagement metrics, while social listening platforms monitor conversations and sentiment around your brand and content.

Case studies from the trenches 

Crowd Content

At Crowd Content, we used A/B testing to compare two variations of an intro format: one with a conversational, concise intro and one with a long, technical intro. We measured how the posts performed using time on page, average session duration, and bounce rate and found readers engaged more with the conversational intro. As a result, we adopted the conversational intro format across all blog posts.

LinkedIn

LinkedIn provides a clear example of integrating feedback mechanisms into blog posts. Their buttons, conveniently placed at the end of each post, invite readers to engage.

LinkedIn: integrating feedback

These feedback loops serve several purposes. First, they offer readers an opportunity to go beyond passive consumption and express their reactions, questions, and opinions, and that increases engagement. Second, they provide valuable insights for content creators, enabling them to gauge audience sentiment and identify areas for improvement.

Unleash the Power of a Captivating Blog Intro

When writing blog intros, use compelling storytelling, strategic SEO techniques, and data-driven optimization to attract readers like a magnet. Bring them along on journeys of discovery and engagement, using each intro to lead customers into the valuable content that lies within your website.

Elevate your blog with professional intros. Discover our blog writing services, and learn how we can help you captivate your audience from the first line. Explore our services today! 

The post 5 Strategies for Writing Blog Intros That Engage Your Audience appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
User-Generated Content Examples https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/user-generated-content-examples/ Wed, 20 Mar 2024 15:13:26 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37298 We’re in an era of authenticity in marketing, where real stories feed business objectives.  In an increasingly saturated business landscape, trust perseveres as a key determining factor for consumers. Web users conduct research before buying anything. They compare your website with reviews and your brand’s social platforms to make informed decisions. According to PWC, only […]

The post User-Generated Content Examples appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
We’re in an era of authenticity in marketing, where real stories feed business objectives. 

In an increasingly saturated business landscape, trust perseveres as a key determining factor for consumers. Web users conduct research before buying anything. They compare your website with reviews and your brand’s social platforms to make informed decisions. According to PWC, only 27% of customers trust the brands they buy from. So, who do they trust? Other consumers — and that’s where UGC comes in, serving as social proof and validating brands’ claims in prospective customers’ eyes.

Learn about UGC as we reveal the secrets of two successful examples and show you how to turn your customers into brand ambassadors.

What Is User-Generated Content (UGC)?

UGC is any form of promotional content that’s created and shared by users rather than brands.

UGC diagram

You can use UGC across various channels, including social media, websites, email marketing, and in-store displays. Reposting your customers’ experiences humanizes your brand’s image and instills trust in their eyes, and displaying UGC on product pages incentivizes buyers.

What sets UGC apart from conventional ads is its ability to foster genuine connections and evoke visceral responses. Unlike corporate messaging, UGC carries an air of authenticity and relatability that resonates with audiences. It speaks directly to people, reflecting their experiences, aspirations, and emotions in a way traditional marketing can’t replicate.

UGC is a powerful tool for sparking conversations. It cultivates a sense of belonging and camaraderie, transforming passive observers into engaged advocates who champion your values and find meaning in being part of your community.

The rise of UGC 

Content marketing has turned traditional advertising on its head. Thanks to digital disruption, ordinary people can reach vast audiences and make millions of dollars producing blogs and videos from their homes. As it turns out, there’s a substantial public demand for content created by consumers for consumers. 

Plus, with so much access to information, people have become mindful of traditional advertising techniques and more wary of inauthentic media campaigns. They don’t trust the polished images projected by brands as much as a recommendation from another human being. User-generated content is the new word of mouth — with the bonus of global reach.

Benefits of UGC

Let’s look at the benefits of UGC in more detail:

  • Social proofWhen consumers see a real person endorse a product or service, it verifies your brand story’s credibility.
  • Unlimited free ads: UGC is often free and is always more affordable than a full-scale ad campaign. 
  • Conversion influence: In 2023, around 50% of consumers said UGC videos help them discover new things to buy. Plus, according to a cumulative analysis, 90% of consumers are more likely to buy something if they see a video of someone positively endorsing a brand without sponsorship
  • Community building: In the past, companies tried to garner loyal customers. Thanks to social media, you can go a step further and build a community that’s connected to each other and your brand. People have a strong drive to feel included and live with a sense of purpose. Brands can tap into this through storytelling and creating spaces where customers rally together. UGC thrives on platforms such as Reddit and TikTok because people use them to form and find communities.
  • Appeal to Millennial and Gen Z audiences: Younger generations seek immersion in their content, and Deloitte Insights suggests that UGC (and video games) most effectively fulfill this need. 
  • Drive engagement: UGC is a nifty tool for driving engagement on your social media pages. 
  • SEO: Brand mentions, reviews, and an active social media presence are some of the biggest drivers of organic SEO. 
  • Voice of the customer: Gathering UGC gives you access to indispensable customer data to refine and improve your brand.  

Barriers to UGC Success

Weak branding and lack of clarity regarding values are the main barriers to UGC’s success because consumers can’t form an emotional connection if certain elements are lacking. For the brands we’ve helped, the solution was targeted content production. Focusing on storytelling that showcases consistent brand values, personality, and voice sets the stage for community-building and UGC. 

A strong brand identity is underpinned by engaging content that’s tailored to each distribution channel. Website copy, blog posts, and videos help prospects decide whether to connect with your company. Considering that 7 in 10 consumers are more likely to buy from brands that share their values, purpose is another essential element of a strong brand identity.

Use these values to inform content ideation and spark the emotional connection that inspires customers to become UGC contributors. 

User-Generated Content Examples

These user-generated content examples demonstrate UGC’s potential to shape the digital landscape. Below, we outline how industry leaders SHEIN and HelloFresh leverage UGC to drive growth, increase engagement, and create opportunities for their audiences to interact meaningfully with each other. 

SHEIN 

This case study explores how fast-fashion retailer SHEIN strategically uses UGC.

Social proof and community building

Social proof is at the heart of SHEIN’s UGC strategy, with real-life recommendations validating the brand in consumers’ eyes. Users post reviews with photos that are prominently displayed under each item’s product description.

This feature has turned the platform into an active community hub where shoppers share styling tips, outfit inspirations, and feedback on product quality. 

SHEIN case study

Rewarding engagement

SHEIN’s innovative approach to UGC extends beyond traditional product reviews, encouraging users to show off pictures of their SHEIN hauls alongside reviews, including detailed sizing information.

SHEIN rewards

To incentivize users to contribute, SHEIN rewards them with points, giving discounts on future purchases for sharing their experiences. 

Consumers as collaborators and Gen Z appeal

One of SHEIN’s strengths lies in the company’s ability to tap into the preferences and aspirations of Gen Z consumers. These buyers prioritize self-expression, authenticity, and social connection in their shopping experiences. Prominently displaying honest, uncensored reviews with photos on each product shows a commitment to transparency and gives customers a platform. 

By positioning consumers as collaborators, SHEIN empowers them to play an active role in the brand’s success. This approach resonates strongly with the target market, driving engagement and brand affinity. 

SHEIN vs. PrettyLittleThing

A study comparing PrettyLittleThing and SHEIN supports the idea that consumers — especially younger generations — trust UGC more than branded content. All 12 participants preferred having the option to compare themselves to real people on SHEIN’s website rather than only models on PrettyLittleThing. For this reason, they all said they’d prefer to shop with SHEIN. 

One expressed a clear lack of trust in PrettyLittleThing’s branded imagery. 

PrettyLittleThing

Prioritizing social proof, community building, and consumer empowerment has helped SHEIN captivate Gen Z consumers and establish itself as a leader in the fast-fashion industry. 

HelloFresh

Through a carefully curated blend of branded and user-generated content, HelloFresh has established a thriving community and transmitted its brand message across multiple digital channels. The meal-kit delivery service uses UGC to manage customer expectations, foster community engagement, and drive business growth. 

By prominently showcasing real-life experiences and testimonials from satisfied customers, HelloFresh creates authentic and relatable narratives that resonate with its target audience.

Influencer marketing

HelloFresh relies on influencer marketing to amplify its UGC campaigns. Partnering with food bloggers, home chefs, and lifestyle influencers enables the brand to expand its reach, piggybacking on the creators’ reputations. 

In sponsored ads, YouTubers and TikTokers make DIY content, where they cook HelloFresh recipes. They also ask viewers to send pictures and videos of their HelloFresh cooking triumphs and disasters and offer discounts for using their branded codes.

HelloFresh
DIY content

Social media

Another core element of HelloFresh’s UGC strategy is social media engagement. The company asks customers to share photos of their meal creations using the hashtag #HelloFreshPics. 

Winners are chosen randomly to be featured on the website homepage, with their Instagram username and photo caption prominently displayed.  

HelloFresh's customers

Consistently curating and reposting UGC amplifies HelloFresh’s customers’ voices while inspiring others to try its products. Consumers are excited by the opportunity to be featured on the brand’s homepage, driving engagement and brand mentions for the company. 

Email marketing

HelloFresh integrates UGC into email marketing campaigns. The company gets results from email newsletters featuring customer testimonials, reviews, and photos. 

Content marketing 

Crucially, HelloFresh’s content strategy underpins its UGC initiatives. Its team focuses on creating visually appealing content that showcases the produce and educates its audience. High-quality yet relatable blog posts, recipe cards, and cooking tutorials include call-to-actions recommending HelloFresh customers share their culinary creations.

Even the brand’s in-house ads are intentionally shot to look realistic and relatable instead of highly stylized. 

HelloFreshs content strategy

In a 2021 interview, Carrie Crow at HelloFresh explained, “We want to make sure that what we’re representing is what the customer is going to be able to do. Maybe it’s slightly more aspirational, but we want it to be a realistic interpretation of what they’re going to make for themselves.” 

UGC is authentic and relatable  

For decades, advertisers exclusively displayed products in their most polished, picture-perfect state. You might fear putting your brand image into your customers’ hands in case you lose control of the narrative. But remember, when you have consistent and clear brand messaging that aligns with reality, consumers know what to expect. As SHEIN and HelloFresh have proven, UGC’s DIY, less-than-perfect aesthetic isn’t off-putting to prospects — in fact, it’s quite the opposite.

Brands should consider customers’ emotions, desires, and pain points to spark interest and establish meaningful connections. Here’s a summary of how the companies in our case studies did it:

  • SHEIN realized people were asking, “Sure, that dress looks awesome on the model, but how will it fit me?” The brand displays reviews with pictures of real people so customers have authentic reference points to gauge how clothes will fit them.  
  • HelloFresh understands that meal kit customers often think, “The food looks beautiful on the recipe card, but if mine looks nothing like it, I’m going to feel disappointed.” UGC and relatable branded content helps them manage expectations. Instead of being disheartened when dishes don’t look perfect, customers feel a sense of achievement because they’ve made something that looks like the UGC photos they’ve seen.

Getting Your Audience to Produce UGC

Incorporating UGC on top of written and branded content is an affordable and effective way to establish trust and increase conversions. Per PWC’s 2023 Consumer Insights Survey, 63% of consumers reject middlemen and prefer to purchase directly from brands, and this trend is predicted to increase. With more eyes on your website and social media pages, optimizing these touchpoints is essential. 

Use the following strategies to encourage your customers to produce user-generated content:

  • Interactive elements: Polls, quizzes, challenges, and contests drive participation and bring a sense of ownership to your brand’s community. Making them active participants empowers them to contribute their unique perspectives.
  • User-generated hashtags: Create branded hashtags that resonate with your audience and encourage them to share their stories, photos, and experiences with your brand. By curating and amplifying user-generated content with these hashtags, you increase brand visibility and make your customers feel a sense of belonging.
  • Cocreation: Cocreate content with your audience that reflects their interests, preferences, and aspirations. Ask them about their ideas for product development or UGC campaigns. As you can see from our case studies, involving your audience in the creative process strengthens their emotional connection to your brand and drives engagement.
  • Incentivized participation: Offer rewards, incentives, and exclusive perks to motivate audience members to contribute to UGC. Whether it’s discounts, freebies, or a prominent feature on your website or social pages, incentivizing participation sparks action and enhances the perceived value of making a contribution.
  • Authenticity: Embrace imperfection and celebrate diversity by showcasing real-life stories. Authenticity resonates with today’s consumers, who value transparency and genuineness more than image alone.
  • Community building: Foster a vibrant online community where your audience feels connected, supported, and valued. Start conversations, reply to comments on social media, and celebrate the contributions of your most engaged followers. This creates a supportive environment and inspires brand advocacy.
  • Emerging technologies: Champion innovative tools and platforms that enable new forms of UGC, such as augmented reality, virtual reality, live-streaming, and interactive storytelling. 

How to Measure UGC Success 

To measure UGC’s success, focus on: 

  • Sentiment analysis: Natural language processing gauges the emotional tone of user-generated content and how it aligns with brand messaging. 
  • Engagement metrics: Track likes, comments, shares, and other forms of interaction to measure audience engagement levels.
  • User demographics: Use analytics tools to understand the demographic characteristics of people creating your UGC so you can target them in the future.
  • Influence mapping: Identify key influencers to find partners who are able to make a sizable impact within your community.
Measure UGC Success
  • Trend analysis: Monitor trends and patterns in UGC to anticipate shifts in consumer preferences.

Common challenges and solutions in UGC management

These are common difficulties brands run into when deploying and overseeing a UGC strategy, along with solutions:

  • Authenticity: Implement robust curation processes to ensure only genuine and relevant UGC gets showcased.
  • Verification: Establish verification procedures to authenticate user-generated content and maintain credibility.
  • Integration: Develop integration methods to incorporate UGC into marketing campaigns across channels.
  • Negative feedback: Embrace transparency and respond constructively to negative UGC, turning criticism into opportunities for improvement.
  • Legal considerations: Adhere to copyright and privacy regulations when using UGC to safeguard your brand and the people creating content on its behalf.
  • Community management: Curate a supportive and engaged community around UGC, setting rules and using strict moderation to encourage collaboration and positive interactions.

UGC Drives Authentic Engagement and Growth

To grow, brands must engage audiences across more channels than ever. That means fostering communities and forging emotional connections instead of relying on conventional advertising methods. But it isn’t easy. Your target market needs to hear, see, and recognize your brand’s voice and values for them to resonate. 

Let Crowd Content craft website content, blog posts, podcast scripts, and e-books reflecting your values and amplifying your brand voice. With a solid foundation of content speaking directly to your target audience, UGC can flourish. 

The post User-Generated Content Examples appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
E-Commerce Content Strategy in 2024: A Comprehensive Guide https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/commerce-content-strategy-in-2024/ Wed, 13 Mar 2024 09:14:38 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37258 Consumers are filling their virtual shopping carts to the brim, pushing retail online sales to an estimated $6.9 trillion in 2024. A comprehensive e-commerce content strategy can help you chisel out a piece of this lucrative market, boosting your brand’s visibility and persuading customers to choose your business for their needs. To stand out, you […]

The post E-Commerce Content Strategy in 2024: A Comprehensive Guide appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Consumers are filling their virtual shopping carts to the brim, pushing retail online sales to an estimated $6.9 trillion in 2024. A comprehensive e-commerce content strategy can help you chisel out a piece of this lucrative market, boosting your brand’s visibility and persuading customers to choose your business for their needs.

To stand out, you need exceptional content for all stages of the buyer’s journey: articles that answer burning questions, convincing case studies, and irresistible product descriptions that compel conversions. A successful digital content strategy helps business owners understand customer needs, engage their curiosity, and leverage technology to make an impact in a highly competitive landscape.

The Role of Content in E-Commerce Success

Content is a powerful tool for enticing customers to your e-commerce store and encouraging them to take action. The most effective content strategies reel in your customer no matter where they are on their path to purchase:

  • Awareness: At this stage, customers aren’t entirely sure they need your product. Your content positions you as a source of knowledge and addresses pain points. Introduce your brand with how-to guides, articles, problem-solving content, quizzes, and engaging social media posts.
  • Consideration: Now, your customer is actively thinking about solving a problem, and your content explores possible solutions. A kitchenware store might publish blog posts about choosing between pressure cookers and slow cookers or the purposes of different kitchen knives.
  • Decision: Your customer has decided on a solution, so it’s time to set your brand apart. Convince them with comparison guides, product pages, product demos, FAQs, testimonials, and landing pages offering free trials. You could also use augmented reality to help customers visualize a product’s appearance in their space.
  • Retention: Once you make a sale, provide resources to continue engaging your customers. User guides, product tips, newsletters, and exclusive or personalized content encourage satisfaction and build loyalty.

SEO and Content Marketing in E-Commerce

Fuse your content marketing efforts with a solid SEO strategy to ensure your audience finds you. According to data from 2023, 39% of consumers start their e-commerce journeys on search engines such as Google or Bing. In fact, search engines are the first stop for online shoppers in the United States behind Amazon.

Search engine optimization (SEO) helps lift your content higher on search engine results pages (SERPs), which are the lists of webpages returned by a search engine in response to a user’s query. The higher your result, the more exposure you have and the more enticing your website is to potential customers. Once readers click through to your store, your content can work its magic. You can nurture prospects through every stage if you’ve matched content to the buyer’s journey. 

How to integrate SEO and content marketing

Google offers many opportunities for your website to appear in search results. Your SEO content strategy can target:

  • Organic search results: These listings appear below paid ads and include rich snippets that display images, videos, and star ratings.
  • Featured snippets: Google sometimes displays an excerpt from a web page that concisely answers the search query. These results often get more of the clicks because they’re prominently displayed on the SERP. 
  • Google Images: In addition to crawling text, Google can index optimized images. For example, this enables someone to search for “heart-shaped earrings” and see relevant products in search results.
  • Local searches: When you use local SEO strategies, your content displays for searches in a specific geographic region.
  • Voice search: Speech recognition technology enables users to search by voice. Use long-tail keywords and a natural, conversational style to surface in these search results. Content that aligns with the way searchers ask questions, that is Who, What, Why, When, How, are more likely to win at voice search.
  • Search generative experience: SGE uses artificial intelligence to present a snapshot of a topic. Optimize content for these search results with concise and unique answers to fill in content gaps.
SGE

Incorporating SEO tactics in your content strategy improves your chances of appearing in these search results:

  • Perform keyword research to plan appropriate content.
  • Provide superior user experiences with intuitive navigation and fast page loading times.
  • Give search engines the confidence to recommend your content by demonstrating E-E-A-T principles.

Emphasize content quality

Before we get too immersed in SEO-speak, let’s shift the focus back to the content you’re publishing to win over customers. E-commerce content is all about communicating with humans whose problems need solving. SEO tactics and data-driven approaches are essential for search visibility, but your content must resonate with audiences to convert.

Make it a priority to create content that offers value to readers. Share your expertise generously, and offer substance and depth. Mix in original research and thought. It takes time and effort to produce high-quality, helpful content, but the end product intrigues your readers and improves your chances of converting.

Some marketers use artificial intelligence for content creation. While AI can help with research and ideation, it doesn’t have the same creative chops as a human. By all means, use AI to get started, but make sure the end result appeals to your customer’s curiosity, intelligence, humor, and emotions — something that usually requires deft human touch.

Developing Your E-Commerce Content Strategy

Finding and using relevant keywords effectively

Effective SEO content begins with keyword research, which is the process of finding the search terms your customers use and choosing ones to build your content around. Use keyword research tools to generate ideas and gather data to help you decide which search terms to pursue. Semrush, Ahrefs, Moz, KWFinder, and AnswerThePublic are tools that identify high-performing search terms.

Promising keywords have enough search volume to send the right traffic flowing to your site. Target ones that are lower in competition so you can more realistically rank for them. Keyword competition is often rated on a scale from 0 to 100, and a lower score means less competition. You can pursue more difficult keywords, but it takes time to build up the backlinks and authority needed to knock competitors out of the top spot. 

Add in some long-tail keywords with a lower search volume. Because they’re precise, they typically send highly qualified traffic your way that’s more likely to convert. For example, “women’s dress shoes” is broad. 

But “women’s ballet flats” can help you reach someone who knows what they want to buy and is further along in the buyer’s journey.

Leveraging topic cluster strategy

Organize your e-commerce content into clusters, each focused on a specific topic. A topic cluster strategy gives your website structure and establishes your expertise.

  • Sort your keywords into categories or themes.
  • Create a pillar or overview page that anchors the cluster.
  • Bolster the pillar page with detailed articles around subtopics.
  • Interlink between the pieces in the topic cluster, guiding search engines and users to related content.

Audit your existing content, and place it in the appropriate cluster. You can then see what additional pieces you need to build out your topic.

SEO Strategies Tailored for E-Commerce

SEO best practices apply regardless of your business niche, but e-commerce sites need to pay particular attention to a few areas.

Product pages

Product descriptions generate excitement for an item and provide enough detail for customers to make a purchasing decision. Even if manufacturers provide product information, we recommend crafting unique copy rather than duplicating what other sites publish.

Incorporate keywords in the following places:

  • Product name
  • Page title and meta description
  • Near the beginning of the product description
  • URL
  • Image file name

Take a look at this product description for wet cat food from Purina. It includes the keyword “wet cat food” in the product title and URL. The description also mentions “wet formula” in the first sentence. These tactics help search engines match the product to appropriate queries.

Category pages

Category pages serve as a home page for related products. Not all websites need a category page, but if you have enough products, it can help users navigate them. For example, Williams Sonoma has a category page for knives, distinguishing between paring knives, steak knives, carving knives, and cleavers. The page includes a few paragraphs of content that offer opportunities to rank for related keywords.

Long-tail keywords

Long-tail keywords are at least three words long and are used to find a specific answer to a query. These phrases often have lower search volumes but can be lucrative if they have commercial search intent since the consumer may be close to the decision stage. 

You can find long-tail keywords in keyword search tools or head to Amazon and try the autocomplete feature to see what people are searching for. If you enter “backpack with” into the search box, the autocomplete suggests “laptop compartment” and “wheels for adults.”

Incorporate long-tail keywords into product descriptions or blog posts to attract these customers and guide site visitors to a conversion.

Mobile-friendliness

Consumers aren’t just shopping on desktop computers. They’re also making purchases on mobile devices, such as smartphones and tablets. In the United States, mobile commerce accounted for 43.2% of retail e-commerce sales in 2023. By 2027, m-commerce is expected to make up nearly 50% of U.S. e-commerce sales.

mobile friendliness

While sites optimized for mobile aren’t guaranteed to rank better in Google, mobile-friendliness is one of the search engine’s positive signals when it comes to page experience. To encourage conversions, optimize your e-commerce store for screens of all sizes to ensure customers have seamless experiences as they shop. Other ways to improve your mobile responsiveness include using image compression tools for faster loading times, and simplifying the navigation to improve usability.

Importance of Knowing Your Target Audience and Tips on Audience Research

Before creating content that engages your audience, you need to get up close and personal, understanding who they are, what motivates them, and how they behave online. Define each target customer with basic information such as age, marital status, income, job title, and geographic location.

You can create personas to make them seem like real people instead of a collection of statistics. This helps you create content in the right tone and format to engage these customers authentically.

Research your customer by:

  • Talking to your product development and marketing departments
  • Analyzing website traffic to see where visitors come from
  • Surveying customers and offering discounts to encourage participation
  • Listening in on social media, online forums, and message boards
  • Asking sales and customer service teams what they’re hearing on the ground
  • Analyzing competing brands to see where they engage customers

Content Personalization in E-Commerce

Consumers have plenty of options for where to spend their online dollars. Content personalization, which caters to audience preferences based on past interactions, can sway them to your brand. Customized content increases your brand’s relevance, improves user experience, and boosts your conversion rates.

AI and machine learning make personalization easier by analyzing customer data and helping you display information based on behaviors. Here are some ways to personalize content and encourage more engagement and sales:

  • Product recommendations that pop up while customers browse: These are typically “You May Also Like” or “Other Customers Viewed” suggestions.
  • Personalized email campaigns: Offer discounts on birthdays or let someone who hasn’t shopped for a while know that you miss them. You can also segment your email lists based on behavior, like recent purchases, or industry, like B2B, so you can personalize your outreach.
  • Dynamic website content: Content changes depending on location or user behavior. If you notice someone keeps viewing the same product, you might have a pop-up offering a discount to nudge them toward a sale.
  • A/B testing: Gather data on how different landing pages or ads work to assess the most effective copy to convert sales.

Utilizing Emerging Technologies

At its most basic, digital marketing in e-commerce consists of static pages of product images and descriptions. But with technologies such as artificial intelligence, augmented reality, and virtual reality, you can help your website come to life. You can’t replicate in-store service, but you can engage your customers online and offer a unique digital experience.While customer preferences are always changing, websites can meet those demands by creating personalized shopping experiences.

Conversational commerce

AI chatbots can be programmed to answer questions in real time, such as how long shipping takes and what your return policy is. This removes friction by preventing cart abandonment and helps keep customers on a website. Italian designer Ad Hoc Atelier uses a chatbot that triggers when a visitor leaves their cart. The company reduced its cart abandonment rate and increased its conversion rate by engaging customers.

Video commerce

Clothing brand Free People makes products shoppable on livestreams. The hosts provide product demos and model clothing, and shoppers can ask questions and make purchases. According to a case study, Free People gets an average of 2,000 viewers per video with a conversion rate that’s three times higher than average.

Virtual try-ons

Augmented reality, popularized by Snapchat filters, can be creatively applied to e-commerce stores. Zenni Optical has a try-on feature that superimposes eyeglass frames on your face to help you pick a style you like.

In Germany, H&M took this a step further. Customers were invited to make an avatar with a body scanner so they could try on items virtually at home.

Leveraging Social Media for E-Commerce Engagement

Social media is an important content distribution channel for e-commerce brands. According to data compiled from a 2023 survey, 50% of shoppers worldwide learned about products on social media.

While social media can send users to your online shop, nearly 60% of shoppers buy products directly through networking platforms — a practice known as social commerce. Salesforce estimates that in 2024, 64.6 million users will shop on Facebook, 46.8 million on Instagram, and 40.7 million on TikTok.

Your brand can make the most of social media by:

  • Building a community of followers: You can market directly to your audience through social posts. Take a look at H&M’s creative TikTok video. It grabs attention with an “invisible” model and provides product ideas in a viewer’s feed.
  • Encouraging engagement: Your post can appear in other people’s social feeds through shares, likes, and comments.
  • Placing social ads: Paid advertising gets your content in front of a wider audience.
  • Partnering with creators: Consider collaborating with influencers or businesses with a similar target audience to help promote your brand.

Innovative Monetization in E-Commerce

We’ve focused primarily on traditional product sales, but modern e-commerce offers additional opportunities to generate revenue for brands and content creators.

Affiliate marketing

Affiliates are third parties who promote a brand and receive payment in exchange for clicks or sales. This is a win-win situation: Brands tap into a fresh audience and boost sales. Affiliates can generate revenue by reviewing a product, hosting a contest, or offering a promo code to their followers.

Subscriptions

If you sell items customers need to replace regularly, a monthly or quarterly subscription encourages customer retention. Consumers commit to a recurring purchase in exchange for a discount, free shipping, or other incentive. Similarly, content creators can build subscription models that offer exclusive or enhanced content offerings.

Blockchain technology

While blockchain technology is commonly linked to Bitcoin, it has other applications. A blockchain is a transparent ledger where transactions are shared within a network, verifying ownership and the movement of goods.

The technology is in its early stages regarding retail applications, but we’re beginning to see its potential. In 2021, H&M launched an innovative clothing rental service in Berlin that used blockchain to track who had borrowed items.

Similarly, in the automotive sector, BMW Group used blockchain technology to make its supply chain more transparent and traceable. This means they can track where materials and parts come from, all the way to the finished car, and this ensures that everything meets ethical standards. 

BMW group uses blockchain

Measuring Success: Analytics and KPIs

You’ve put your online retail content strategy into action, and now it’s time to see if it’s driving awareness, traffic, and sales. Track key performance indicators to learn where to fine-tune your strategies for more impact and which tactics successfully yield results.

Common KPIs to track include:

  • Keyword ranking: Where are you landing in the SERPs for your target keywords? Keywords that aren’t getting traction may need better optimization.
  • Referral sources: Where are your visitors coming from? This metric tells you how users find your site and which content distribution channels work best.
  • Click-through rate: If you’re not getting clicks from the SERPs, adjust your meta title and description or optimize for rich snippets.
  • Page traffic: Which content pages perform the best, and which need more optimization?
  • Impressions: How many people are viewing your product pages?
  • Time spent on page: Are users spending time engaging with your content? If they abandon the page quickly, your content may need adjusting.
  • Add-to-cart rate: Combine this KPI with impressions to gauge whether the content on your product pages is convincing people to purchase.
  • Conversions: Assess how well your site drives desired actions, such as subscribing to mailing lists, adding products to wish lists, and making sales.

Knowing which KPIs to track is the first step. The next step is to understand how to accurately measure them, and this is where analytics tools come into play.

Analytics tools

You may need a few analytics tools to obtain a complete picture of your content’s performance. Google Analytics is ideal for monitoring page-level activity and user behavior on your site, while Semrush or Moz can provide in-depth insights into your keyword rankings and search performance. Platforms such as Instagram, X, and LinkedIn provide data on user engagement, but it’s easier to use a tool such as Buffer to compile data and generate all-in-one reports on channel performance.

Adapting to Consumer Behavior and Trends

McKinsey & Company notes that customer expectations change with each new successful digital venture. Online shoppers embrace speed and convenience, thanks to the bar set by Amazon, while short video snippets have been popularized by TikTok.

Brands need to be open and responsive to changing customer preferences to stay relevant. You should keep a pulse on digital marketing trends and developments in your industry, but you can also look to your customers for signals.

Regularly check in with your customers through reviews, feedback, and surveys, or practice social listening. These tactics dig up real-time insight into how your customers are feeling.

Artificial intelligence is a powerful partner when it comes to anticipating customer behaviors and preferences. Predictive analytics uses various inputs — including customer demographics, website analytics, and interactions at different touchpoints — to find patterns in behavior. AI then predicts what a customer might purchase or do next. As data is updated, the AI is better trained. These insights help you create content and marketing messages that precisely meet customer needs, improving their experience and guiding them toward conversions.

AI helps us predict and fulfill customer needs, but it also highlights our responsibility to use technology ethically. We need to make sure our approaches are aligned with what customers expect in terms of ethical and sustainable practices.

Ethical Considerations and Sustainable Practices

Let’s step back for a moment and look beyond financial transactions. Your overall business practices influence how audiences view your brand and impact your bottom line. Consumers expect companies to conduct themselves with integrity and a sense of responsibility. According to a 2023 survey, 45% of respondents considered themselves ethical or sustainable consumers.

Ethical conduct

When it comes to your e-commerce content, set high standards. Create fair, well-researched, and accurate content, and disclose any conflicts of interest in what you’re writing about. You can expect diverse audiences to visit your website and social accounts, so be inclusive and sensitive with your language. Finally, as brands ramp up data collection, be clear in your privacy policies about how and why you’re gathering information.

Sustainable practices

Consumers, especially younger generations, are increasingly concerned about social issues and how brands impact the environment. Among Gen Z, 62% prefer to buy from sustainable brands, and 73% are willing to pay higher prices for sustainable products.

Engage ethical consumers with content about your sustainability initiatives and practices. This includes information about materials, production processes, and packaging. If you have eco-friendly programs in place, such as REI’s online store for used gear, create content to promote and highlight the benefits of these practices.

Additional Resources and Tools

Successful content marketing for e-commerce involves many components, but an array of tools are available to make the process easier. Whether you’re tackling the work in-house or outsourcing to a content strategy service, check out some of the following resources to help get your campaign off the ground.

  • Semrush: Perform keyword research, discover content ideas, and improve your site’s on-page SEO.
  • Keyword Insights: Generate keyword ideas, and create topic clusters with a click.
  • CoSchedule: Organize your content strategy and manage deadlines.
  • Alchemer: Collect feedback across channels to understand customer needs.
  • Make My Persona: Build buyer personas to inform your content strategy.
  • Feedly: Monitor developments and trends in your industry.
  • Google Search Console: Monitor site traffic and the keywords visitors use and find issues that may impact your site’s SEO.

Drive Results With a Dynamic Content Strategy (and a Helping Hand)

Customers find their way to your website through content: insightful tips and articles, convincing product pages, clearly presented case studies, and your brand story. But to really pull in your audiences, your content must offer unique value and insight.

Your e-commerce content strategy begins with keyword research and a deep understanding of your audience and the buyer’s journey. You can then develop highly targeted content that encourages engagement.

Consider our e-commerce writing services to produce professional, results-driven content that’s optimized for search engines and your readers. Find out how our experienced team of writers, editors, subject matter experts, and content managers can fuel your online visibility and help your business hit its growth goals.

The post E-Commerce Content Strategy in 2024: A Comprehensive Guide appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
White Label Content Writing for Agencies https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/white-label-content-writing-for-agencies/ Wed, 13 Mar 2024 08:39:51 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37250 The landscape of digital marketing is like one of those Zen sand art displays people love to plop on their desks. As soon as the sand settles into eye-catching lines and you get to know the picture in front of you — flip! Everything is on its head, and it’s time to recalibrate and see […]

The post White Label Content Writing for Agencies appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
The landscape of digital marketing is like one of those Zen sand art displays people love to plop on their desks. As soon as the sand settles into eye-catching lines and you get to know the picture in front of you — flip! Everything is on its head, and it’s time to recalibrate and see what’s going to emerge next. But one thing that never budges is the need for compelling and relevant content, which is why white label content writing services will never go out of style.

As audience and Google standards increase, so does the need for relevant, quality, high-volume content production. Outsourcing your content can help you meet your targets, exponentially expanding your revenue and your foothold in the industry.

Understanding White Label Content Writing

White label content is created by a third party but sold by the primary entity — your agency, for example — as a firsthand product. For example, you tell your end clients you can produce 1,000 product descriptions a week, but really, you’re outsourcing those batches to another agency perhaps, and then passing them on as your own product.

The concept of white labeling isn’t limited to the content world, and it might be easier to understand how it all works if we look at a noncontent example. A handful of manufacturers produce much of the essential oil products currently on the market. All those bottles of patchouli, peppermint, and “immune-boosting blend” come off the same assembly lines and boast the same contents, but they get different labels and marketing campaigns based on which brand is buying the primary product from wholesalers.

It’s a brilliant way for small businesses to expand their catalog with products they can’t produce on their own, and bigger brands can test new niches without switching up their assembly lines or investing in ground-up R&D.

White labeled content works the same way; you’re just swapping out tinctures of sage and chamomile for bespoke articles and blog posts.

Benefits of white label content for agencies

You’re known for having fingers in every pie in your agency’s service buffet, but you can’t be everywhere at once. If you’re looking to build a better, smarter business, investing in white label content can help you:

  • Save time: Partnering with a content creation team plugs you into a talent pool that’s pre-vetted, talented, and ready to write. Skip time-consuming recruitment, onboarding, and writer testing and head straight to steady, reliable output.
  • Maintain quality: Those pre-vetted writers you tap into with a white label content partner have already showcased their skill sets. You get the quality content you need without training anyone yourself. And if you already have an in-house team, white labeling allows you to scale up without stretching your resources and sacrificing quality.
  • Offer more of your product: White label content helps you increase your service offerings to include not only strategy but also execution of that strategy. Already have your own writers? You can white label niche content by taking advantage of contracted subject matter experts who specialize in fields such as fintech, health care, travel, real estate, and law — many of whom have the lettered credentials beside their name to go with a proven track record.  

Common Uses of White Label Content

Some of the most common use cases for outsourced writing include:

Digital marketing agencies

Digital marketing agencies are first in line to help clients understand the value of email campaigns, social media posts and thought leadership bylined by the client’s highest-profile personas. But what happens when you recommend a strategy but can’t help execute it?

Agencies can use white label content services to offer packages encompassing everything from a basic consultation to a turnkey strategy, all but guaranteed to generate long-term success. No more sending clients to spend their money elsewhere when you can serve up quality content on a silver platter.

Ecommerce platforms

Ecommerce platforms that serve makers, retailers, and resellers have a prime opportunity to upsell members by offering add-on services, such as copywriting. While a basic package might include web hosting, payment services, and on-site promotional opportunities, platforms can generate multiple revenue streams by white labeling product descriptions, how-to blogs, and other content. Every asset added could help appeal to the end customer and increase conversion rates.

Software as a Service providers

SaaS companies can help shave a few degrees off a learning curve that might otherwise make products seem insurmountable. When backed by white label content services, you can offer educational resources for clients, such as tutorials and explainer video scripts, customizing each offering and infusing assets with authority and value.

Small and medium-sized businesses

SMBs are the most likely candidates to have plenty of vision but not enough resources to turn everything on their entrepreneurial wish lists into reality. The ability to execute on your content strategy without having to hire and train a full writing and editing staff can be invaluable.

Types of Content for White Label Agencies

White label copywriting and content services cover a huge breadth of collateral. You’re not limited to About Us web blurbs and the occasional blog — although both of those are on the table. You have access to all types of content that can help you achieve those KPI milestones essential to success. Some of the content provided by white label agencies includes:

  • Blog content: Sell blog content to your end clients and help them improve both search rankings and conversion rates in one fell swoop. Blogs written by research-savvy writers or reviewed by subject matter experts can also help brands establish authority and position company heads as thought leaders.
  • Social media content: Hand over responsibility for a thriving X and Facebook feed to an army of writers. Maintaining a steady flow of content on social media can boost visibility and keep consumers engaged, generating much-needed likes and clicks.
  • SEO and web content: A copywriter versed in the latest SEO tactics can cater to Google’s standards. Let white label writing squads populate your site with content and landing pages with the long-tail keywords and metadata necessary to hit the top of the SERPs. 
  • Case studies: Partner with a white label writing service to produce case studies of your best success stories to show prospects that what you have to offer is more than just a proposal.
  • White papers and ebooks: You can offer these assets to end clients or use them yourself as gated content, generating leads and establishing authority at the same time.
  • Article writing: Hire writers to craft articles for industry publications, showcase company achievements, highlight events to promote a new product, or underscore company values.

Selecting a White Label Content Writing Service

Like so many services, a white label content writing service partnership is only as effective as the partner you choose. Before you sign on the dotted line, consider what you’re looking for in a writing platform and what you need to scale your offerings.

Build the right team

One of the biggest challenges when dealing with white label content writing is figuring out how you’ll maintain content quality without having direct involvement with every member of the team. One of the easiest ways to do that is to have a project or content manager act in your stead. They serve as a single point of contact and intermediary between you and the team creating your content. They gather and train the best-suited writers, answer basic questions, review content for quality, and handle revisions as needed.

Create content guidelines

Your brand voice is extremely important and you want to maintain it regardless of who is writing your content. This is where your content brief comes in handy. The more information and guidelines you give your writers, the easier it is for them to give you exactly what you need the first time around. Remember, freelancers are experienced in words, not mind reading — provide detailed instructions once, and you’ll save yourself a lot of effort down the road.

Assess content quality

The term “good writer” has so many meanings. Most writing services will lob terms such as “quality writing team” and “experienced talent” in your direction without a second thought. But the proof really is in the pudding, and that means you need to see samples before you consider a contract.

You can also ask for case studies. Crowd Content is thrilled to show off past work, including how we helped one client increase their page views to a staggering 6 minutes. Or how we helped an agency get their client to page one of Google for 57 of their target keywords.

Consider customization options

Your agency isn’t a dime a dozen, and your content shouldn’t be generic or bland either. Ask potential white label partners how in-depth their customization options go. Can you use your own style guide? Can they match brand voice and specific requirements, such as comma and bullet point usage? How often can you change parameters to meet a particular client or project’s needs?

Understand pricing models

Content marketing partners differ in how they charge clients for content production. Some require a membership or subscription fee, with content available on a discounted basis thereafter. Crowd Content’s Managed Services extend a helping hand from content managers who post tasks and manage writers on your behalf in exchange for meeting a monthly minimum, or with our Marketplace, you can pay for content as you go and control the job posts, reviews, and final approval. 

Consider how much content you’ll need and how involved you want to be as you evaluate pricing. The best platforms can talk you through the process and recommend the right approach so you get the most bang for your buck and have room to scale your account alongside your business.

Integrating White Label Content Into Your Business Strategy

The right partner should be able to deliver content that’s ready to be integrated into your existing strategy — a strategy you’ve had time to prep and roll out, since you haven’t been spending time recruiting writers and going over first drafts with a fine-tooth comb.

To make the most of the product you’re paying for, it’s important to go in with a clear game plan:

  • Know what you’re asking for. Give your white label service partner a list of expectations, including information on your preferred style, brand voice, and target audience. Using a content brief template removes questions and helps ensure consistency.
  • Provide samples. Include content that demonstrates what you like — and what you don’t like — so writers know what’s a hit and what’s considered a major miss.
  • Calibrate each project. If you’re ordering big blocks of content that include hundreds or even thousands of pieces that all fit a similar brief, use a calibration round to test the writing team and dial-in requirements before you go into full production.
  • Have a plan for promotion and distribution. The last thing you want is to order a ton of content and then realize you have no idea what to do with it all. Part of your prewriting strategy should be putting together a content calendar that illustrates the when, where (which channels), how (content types), and who (the person in charge of pushing the content live).

View analytics and feedback. After content is live, check analytics to see which content assets are getting traction and which aren’t quite on target. Use that information to fine-tune your brief and work with the writing team to bring the next batch of content even closer to perfection.

White Label Content Writing: The Next Step in Scaling Your Business

White label content creation is the perfect storm of productivity and efficiency.. It’s like bringing on a second string of talented employees, but without the overhead and long hiring processes that goes along with investing in a  full-time team. Whether you’re looking to augment the writers already churning out quality content or you want to add content to your growing slate of services, white labeling could be your ticket to growing your business.

To see how Crowd Content’s talented pool of writers can help you stay competitive and scale on demand, check out our managed services, and create quality content without the in-house hassle.

The post White Label Content Writing for Agencies appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
The Ultimate Guide to Content Marketing ROI https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-marketing-roi/ Mon, 11 Mar 2024 15:32:20 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37244 In a cubicle not far from you, a content marketing guru sits hunched over analytics dashboards, looking like a modern-day Indiana Jones trying to decipher ancient hieroglyphs. The endless parade of numbers and charts would make even a seasoned accountant’s eyes glaze over, but our hero decodes the secret language of clicks, impressions, and conversions […]

The post The Ultimate Guide to Content Marketing ROI appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
In a cubicle not far from you, a content marketing guru sits hunched over analytics dashboards, looking like a modern-day Indiana Jones trying to decipher ancient hieroglyphs. The endless parade of numbers and charts would make even a seasoned accountant’s eyes glaze over, but our hero decodes the secret language of clicks, impressions, and conversions with Indy-like prowess.

Meanwhile, in the C-suite, the CEO and shareholders are tapping their feet impatiently. They don’t care about the nitty-gritty details or want a run-down of statistics. What they want to see is one magic number to put on their PowerPoint slides, one that answers the often dreaded question: “What’s the ROI of our content marketing, buddy?”

Sound familiar? If you’ve been in the marketing game for any length of time, you’ve wrestled with this same ROI question. It can be like trying to pin down water — slippery and always changing shape. But the good news is that content marketing ROI is quantifiable if you ask the right questions, and we’re here to help you identify exactly what those are. 

We’ll start by guiding you through the basics of content marketing metrics. We’ll discuss how to decode them and even teach you to speak the language of C-suite executives. In these uncertain economic times, understanding and proving ROI isn’t just a fun brain exercise; it’s a bulletproof vest that protects your budget and showcases just how powerful content marketing can be.

So grab your hat, Indy (or maybe just a really strong cup of coffee), and let’s dive into this ROI adventure together.

What Is Content Marketing ROI?

Content marketing ROI measures the financial return of content efforts compared with the resources invested. It’s a benchmark that guides marketers, helping them determine how their content resonates with current and potential customers and how it ultimately impacts the business’ bottom line.

ROI can be calculated as [(Revenue – Cost) / Cost] * 100.

Envision your content marketing strategy as a process similar to wooing the love of your life. You initially learn everything you can about this person — their favorite color, their hobbies, and the places you’re most likely to run into them. Then, you find small ways to catch their attention through conversations, gifts, and shared interests. The goal is for them to see you as someone who values them and someone they can trust. Every carefully planned interaction is meant to get you closer to your goal of winning them over and making them want to choose you. 

With each email, blog piece, social media post, whitepaper, or infographic you create, you’re convincing your audience to choose you. Each piece of content should be strategically placed to get their attention and establish trust. Your promotion channels might change based on the demographic of your audience, but each touch point needs to have the ultimate goal of winning them over. When you accomplish this, your content marketing ROI will be the proof. 

Imagine an online clothing retailer that invests $500 in a series of comical TikTok videos showcasing their latest summer collection. This bite-size content goes viral, attracting 5,000 new followers and generating 200 orders with an average value of $50. That’s a total of $10,000 in sales that resulted from the content strategy. When you do some simple math: [(Revenue – Cost) / Cost] x 100, you get an ROI of 1,900%. That’s a content marketing ROI that’ll make any C-suite happy!

So, understanding and optimizing your content marketing ROI isn’t just about creating stellar content. It’s about learning your audience, bonding with them, establishing trust, and winning them over.

KPI vs. ROI — Measuring What Matters

We see these acronyms thrown around a lot for measuring the effectiveness of  content marketing strategy, so let’s clarify the difference between Key Performance Indicators (KPIs) and ROI. Put simply, it’s like comparing a treasure map to the actual treasure chest.

KPIs are the indicators on the map focused on specific goals, such as increasing website traffic or boosting social media engagement. They offer small snapshots along the customer journey that gauge customer interest and let you know if you’re heading in the right direction. Think of them as the small winks and smiles you get while trying to win over the love of your life. 

Common content marketing KPIs include click-through rates, time spent on a page, and lead generation. When these numbers are high, it’s a good sign. If they aren’t, it might be time to rethink your strategy. Keep in mind, however, that KPIs measure engagement and interaction, but they don’t predict a certain outcome. They’re merely indicators that your content marketing efforts are working.

Let’s use lead generation as an example. A surge in leads can potentially result in a spike in sales, directly impacting your ROI. This intricate dance between KPIs and ROI is why strategic measurement matters. It’s your job as a content marketing expert to track those KPIs and figure out how they contribute — directly or indirectly — to business growth.

But hold on; there’s another twist! The relationship between KPIs and ROI can change, depending on your specific business factors, including your:

  • Short-term goals and long-term strategy
  • Business model and target audience
  • Industry landscape and competition
  • Available resources and budget constraints
  • Customer demographics and their behavior
  • Content format and distribution channels

For example, if your email KPIs are stagnant, it could mean email campaigns aren’t the best way to reach your audience. You can change how you write the emails, but there’s a real possibility they’ll still end up in Junk folders simply because the people on your mailing list get too many emails from other businesses to sift through daily. 

As businesses navigate new marketing trends and consumer preferences, understanding this dynamic between KPIs and ROI empowers them to track metrics effectively while also translating those numbers into a winning content strategy for long-term success. Because let’s face it, a treasure map is only useful if it leads you to actual treasure.

Defining Key Metrics for Content Marketing

Here’s where the fun part happens. Let’s look at the key metrics most businesses use to determine if their current content marketing strategy is heading in the right direction and gaining enough traction. 

Qualified leads

This is the crème de la crème of metrics — the people who are practically begging you to take their money. They’ve engaged with your content, clicked all the right buttons, and are ready to become loyal customers. 

  • Example: Your e-book on industry secrets turns Joe Customer into a super fan who devours every webinar and downloads every case study. He’s practically banging on your door to try your product or service. 
  • Significance: These folks are worth their weight in gold, so track those qualified leads like a hawk and nurture relationships with them. They’re the key to unlocking higher content marketing ROI.

User experience

Providing an amazing user experience means your content isn’t just informative — it’s also engaging and keeps visitors glued to your website. Think smooth navigation, snappy website loading times, and content that’s as addictive as buttered popcorn at the movies.

  • Example: Your blog posts have readers scrolling for hours, posted videos get multiple likes and shares, and that interactive infographic makes a lot of lives easier. Good job for providing a stellar user experience!
  • Significance: Happy visitors = engaged customers = successful business. This simple math on content marketing shows the importance of connecting with your audience where they are instead of using marketing channels that don’t interest them.

SEO performance

Not only do you need to grab the attention of potential customers, but you also want Google’s attention. This involves using keywords, backlinks, and domain authority as secret weapons to attract organic traffic.

  • Example: Your blog post “10 Ways to Save on Groceries” lands near the top of search engine results. This causes a massive rise in organic traffic to your website.
  • Significance: More eyes on your content means increased opportunities to convert those visitors into paying customers.

Web traffic

The more your content engages audiences, the more traffic you’ll get to your website. Once they’re there, give them additional content that informs, entertains, and strengthens your brand. 

  • Example: You launch a social media campaign that goes viral and doubles organic traffic to your website. Along with this increased traffic comes a significant boost in sales. 
  • Significance: Knowing where your audience lives online and how you’ll most likely catch their attention helps you tailor your content strategy to produce a higher ROI. 

Onsite engagement

Your website is your content’s home, so make sure it’s a welcoming one.

  • Example: You design an interactive infographic that helps your audience understand a complicated issue better. This establishes you as an expert who wants to help make their lives easier. Bounce rates plummet, time spent skyrockets, and your content becomes the ultimate conversation starter.
  • Significance:  Fine-tune your content for maximum impact, optimizing the user journey and creating an unforgettable experience.

Social media ROI

It’s not just about pretty pictures and witty captions — those shares, comments, and clicks are your social currency that directly impacts content marketing ROI.

  • Example: Your hilarious company Christmas party bloopers reel gets thousands of views, shares, and comments. Many follow links to your website to learn more about you and your products/services. 
  • Significance: Harness the power of social media to amplify your content’s reach and influence.

Exposure & authority

When audiences start connecting your company’s name to engaging, useful content, you become the expert in the field. 

  • Example: Bloggers in the industry regularly cite your case study or survey to prove their point.
  • Significance: Establish yourself as the go-to authority in your field, building a reputation that goes beyond the digital realm.

Sales

This is the moment you’ve been waiting for — when your content marketing efforts translate into cash.

  • Example: Your content strategy is directly associated with sales figures going through the roof, and your CEO gives you a standing ovation. 
  • Significance: All the marketing efforts you’ve made achieve quantifiable results.

By mastering these metrics, you can transform data into actionable insights and craft a journey for your audience that leads them straight to your door. 

Industry-Specific ROI Insights

Deciphering content marketing ROI across different industries can feel like a guessing game with varying outcomes.

Just like you wouldn’t compare apples to oranges, judging a company’s content marketing success solely on another’s ROI is a recipe for confusion. Why? Because the effectiveness of content marketing can vary wildly depending on your industry, target audience, and even the type of content you produce.

Tech titans and finance gurus: ROI champions?

The tech and finance sectors seem to have cracked the content marketing code with impressive average ROI figures. Tech companies, for example, are raking in a whopping 650% ROI, suggesting they know a thing or two about how to do it right. Similarly, the finance industry isn’t holding back — with a solid 590% ROI, likely due to its focus on providing valuable insights and building trust with clients.

Healthcare and nonprofits: A slower climb, but don’t count them out

Businesses within the healthcare and nonprofit sectors face unique content marketing challenges, resulting in slightly lower average ROIs (425% and 350%, respectively). These industries often deal with more complex customer journeys and fewer direct sales opportunities. However, with a strategic approach, content marketing can still be a powerful tool for building brand awareness, fostering trust, and ultimately driving positive outcomes.

Beyond the numbers: Understanding your industry’s content ecosystem

It’s important to analyze your industry’s content landscape and understand your target audience’s content consumption habits. Specifically:

  • How does your audience engage with content in your industry? Do they prefer reading blogs or watching videos?
  • Which social media platform do they use?
  • What types of content do best in your sector?
  • How does your content compare to your industry rivals? A little competitive analysis never hurt anyone.

By delving into these aspects and considering industry-specific ROI benchmarks, you can create a content strategy that’s tailor-made for your unique market. Remember, it’s not always about chasing the highest numbers — it’s about understanding those numbers within a specific context. 

Tracking Content Marketing ROI

We won’t mince words — tracking content marketing ROI isn’t a one-size-fits-all endgame. You can’t just throw darts in the dark and hope for the best. It’s about equipping yourself with the right tools and techniques to uncover the hidden secrets of your content’s performance, so let’s take a look at them now. 

Integrating analytics tools

First things first, let’s unpack the necessities in your content toolkit. Analytics platforms, such as Google Analytics, SEMrush, and HubSpot, reveal valuable insights into website traffic, user behavior, and conversion rates. They show how your audience interacts with your content pieces. 

Evaluating SEO success

Don’t underestimate the power of SEO. Tools such as Moz and Ahrefs help you track keyword performance, backlinks, and overall domain authority compared to your direct competitors. By aligning your content strategy with SEO best practices, you’re not only creating engaging content, but you’re also ensuring the right people in the right places are seeing it.

Social media tracking

Measuring how your audience reacts to the content you post on Facebook or X (formerly known as Twitter) is no easy endeavor. Social media content strategy can be a massive undertaking that requires a lot of time and manpower, and companies that jump on the social media bandwagon without understanding this are in for a rude awakening. 

Analytics tools built into these platforms provide detailed insights into who’s interacting with your content, how often, and what kind of impact it’s having. But if your audience simply isn’t there, no strategy will change that. In those situations, social media can waste more time than it’s worth and actually lower your content marketing ROI. 

Lead tracking and conversion

Content isn’t just about creating buzz. It’s also about generating leads and nurturing them into loyal customers. CRM and marketing automation tools, such as Salesforce and Marketo, help you follow the trail of your content, revealing how it contributes to lead generation and customer acquisition. This is where you discover your content’s true impact on the company’s bottom line. 

Using dashboards for comprehensive views

Dashboards bring together data from all your analytics platforms, SEO tools, and social media platforms for a comprehensive view of your content’s performance. It’s like looking at a giant map of your content, with every detail plotted out for easy analysis.

Making data-driven decisions

Now that you’ve unlocked content insights through various analytics tools, you can use those data-driven nuggets of wisdom to refine your content strategy, optimize existing content, and allocate resources where they’ll have the most impact. Remember, content marketing ROI is a continuous journey of exploration and refinement. It requires enough sense of adventure to experiment with various tracking methods and platforms while listening carefully to your audience’s feedback. 

Strategies For Improving Content Marketing ROI

Clearly, there is no universal strategy for improving content marketing ROI. Achieving success (and numbers that impress the C-Suite) means looking at a lot of moving parts and being open to adapting your strategy quickly when the data tells you to. 

 Here are a few tips that can make the process smoother: 

Align content types with business goals and funnel stages

Working with your customers is similar to a river journey that requires different types of boats to navigate it successfully. Each piece of content you create is a certain kind of boat designed for different stages of the journey. 

  • Awareness Stage: Cast a wide net with educational blog posts, infographics, and videos that introduce your brand as the answer to your audience’s problems. Think of these as friendly rafts, welcoming curious travelers aboard for a journey down the river.
  • Consideration Stage: It’s time for a boat that handles rougher waters. White papers, webinars, and case studies showcase your expertise like sturdy canoes guiding potential customers through the rapids of decision-making.
  • Decision Stage: This stage of the river requires product comparisons, testimonials, and detailed guides to help solidify your expertise. These are your lifeboats, helping customers reach the shore of conversion while feeling confident they’re safe in your company’s hands.

Clarify content purpose and goals

Every piece of content you publish should have a clear mission for a definitive stage of the customer journey. It’s not enough to throw words at the wall. Each article, video, or infographic needs a target audience and expected outcome. Are you aiming for brand awareness, lead generation, or a specific conversion? At which stage of the journey will your audience see this content? Define your goals and align your content accordingly.

Let data drive content optimization

By tracking page views, time on page, and conversion rates, you’ll decipher which content resonates and which falls flat. Use these insights to refine your approach or take an entirely different approach when the numbers aren’t moving in the right direction. 

Balance SEO with audience value

SEO is the wind in your sails for getting content in front of online audiences. However, it’s also highly dynamic and can blow your ship away from your audience’s needs if you only focus on algorithms that are in constant flux. Keywords should guide your strategy but not dictate it because no one wants to read keyword-stuffed content. It’s essential to maintain harmony between search engine optimization and genuinely valuable material that establishes trust and authority while engaging your audience. 

The power of unconventional content: A zombie apocalypse success story

Sometimes, the key to ROI lies outside conventional tactics. Take SunGard Availability Services, for example. It turned its IT security solutions into a zombie apocalypse survival guide, complete with an e-book, infographics, and email campaigns leading audiences back to its website and services. The result? A 150% increase in click-through rates and a 200% higher click-to-open rate. That’s the power of creative, unexpected content.

The Evolving Quest for Content Marketing ROI

Unlocking the mysteries of content marketing ROI isn’t just about crunching numbers or running analytics; it’s about understanding your audience, crafting compelling content, and using that data to make adjustments when the numbers don’t line up. By staying adaptable and creative, you’ll gain content marketing ROI success. 

Ready to create your own content marketing strategies? Partner with a team that understands the art of storytelling and the science of analytics. Contact us today and let our experienced content marketers guide you toward your ROI goals.

The post The Ultimate Guide to Content Marketing ROI appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Start a Blog in 2024: An All-in-One Guide https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-start-a-blog-in-2024/ Mon, 04 Mar 2024 14:01:55 +0000 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37215 You can’t go far on the internet without coming across a blog, but let’s be honest: Many sites struggle to stand out in a jam-packed digital landscape. You need to understand how to start a blog that your audience will want to read — while also satisfying your business goals. The thing is, blogs aren’t […]

The post How to Start a Blog in 2024: An All-in-One Guide appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
You can’t go far on the internet without coming across a blog, but let’s be honest: Many sites struggle to stand out in a jam-packed digital landscape. You need to understand how to start a blog that your audience will want to read — while also satisfying your business goals.

The thing is, blogs aren’t a novelty anymore. Readers can spot mediocre content as fast as they can close the tab on their browsers. They crave unique insight and experience, leaving plenty of room for authoritative blogs that offer value.

So, how do you leverage technology and build a blog that appeals to audiences today?

  • Our journey starts with the basics: identifying a profitable niche, evaluating competitors, choosing a blogging platform, and designing a user-friendly site. 
  • After you set up your site, we’ll cover how to grow your blog with content creation, audience building, and monetization tips.
  • Finally, we’ll go over legal and ethical considerations to position you for long-term success.

What Is a Blog? 

A blog is an online information hub sharing knowledge about a specific niche. Blogs are created for several reasons, including personal interest, for generating income, or for serving as a content marketing tool to attract a target audience.

Blogs started out as “weblogs” in the mid-1990s as people began testing the internet waters. Early blogs acted as an online diary, connecting with people with similar journeys or interests. Soon, platforms such as Blogger and Live Journal made it easy for anyone to start a blog without technical expertise. In the early 2000s, Google AdSense enabled blogs to display ads so bloggers could turn a pastime into an income-generating activity. Brands also began partnering with bloggers who had built loyal audiences to promote their products.  

Today, blogs are more dynamic than ever, leveraging technology and multimedia to engage users. In 2024, you can find an array of tools — including AI — powering content creation. SEO, social media, and a variety of marketing channels are helping blog writers find new ways to monetize their online presence.  

Reasons for Creating a Blog

With so many blogs out there, why create a new one? Well, a blog can help you:

  • Explore your creativity and interests. A blog offers a rewarding platform to share your knowledge and skills. You can use your blog as a portfolio to document a journey or help inspire others. 
  • Build a personal brand. Create a blog to position yourself as an authority and develop a reputation as a credible resource. Matt Kepnes built Nomadic Matt, for example, to share his tips and expertise for traveling the world on a budget.  
Nomadic Matt
  • Build a business brand. Blogs are often the centerpiece of a company’s content marketing strategy. Posts are distributed through channels such as social media and email, building brand awareness and driving traffic to support business goals. Hostelling International uses a travel blog to draw readers to its website. 
  • Support financial goals. Blogs can be monetized through advertising, affiliate marketing, and brand partnerships. They can also be used for selling products and services such as online courses.

How to Start a Blog: Identifying Your Niche 

To build an audience, you need to strike a balance between a subject you’re passionate about and what others are interested in learning.

Use SEO tools

Semrush and Ahrefs offer SEO tools to help you analyze keywords for various topics. In addition to comparing search volumes, you can uncover related terms to focus your blog’s content.

Google Trends can tell you if active searches for a particular topic are trending. For example, if you plug “baby food recipes,” “keto recipes,” and “vegan recipes” into the tool for the past 5 years, you can see how interest in these topics is changing over time. 

Google Trends

Explore online communities

Reddit, Quora, Instagram, X, and other social media platforms give insight into topics people are curious about. Analyze conversations to see how audiences talk about a topic and the language they use. This can help optimize your blog for voice, tone, and niche interests, as users tend to be more conversational in online communities than with traditional search engines.

Talk to your audience

If you already have a customer base, survey them to understand their pain points. Ask about the content types they prefer and where they spend time online to help align your blog with their interests.

Listen in on social media

Social media listening tools help gauge what your target audience is talking about online. Create a list of keywords related to your industry, brand, and competitors then monitor reach and engagement. You can also zero in on emerging trends.

Conduct Competitive Analysis 

Once you’ve established demand for the topic, get a sense of where you fit in the blogging landscape. Understanding your competitors can help you differentiate your blog.

Tools such as SpyFu can give you the scoop on competitors. For example, if you’re starting a financial tips blog, enter a competing site, such as “nerdwallet.com,” into the tool. SpyFu will identify competitors, such as Business Insider, Investopedia, and Forbes. The provided data shows keywords these sites rank for and performance gains or losses. You can leverage this information to learn what your competitors are doing well and where you might be better at meeting audience needs. 

SpyFu

Take this a step further and evaluate how your competitors position themselves:  

  • What type of content do they publish?
  • What kind of user experience do they offer?
  • What social platforms are they active on, and how do they interact with audiences?
  • What advertisers and partners do they work with?

It’s a lot of information to sift through, but it’s critical for developing a blog strategy. For example, you might find a competitor’s blog to be text-heavy and differentiate yours with podcasts and video content. Or, you might see an opportunity to distinguish your travel blog by incorporating accessibility tips.

Establish your authority

Website authority emphasizes to Google that you’re an expert on a subject, which is easier to demonstrate if you specialize in a niche. You can build a comprehensive content inventory and cultivate a targeted audience to attract ads, partners, and brands that want to reach this customer segment.

Choosing the Right Platform and Hosting 

When you’re ready to build your website, choose a blogging platform that satisfies your immediate needs and offers opportunities to expand in the future. You might not need ecommerce capabilities now, but once your site gains traction, you may want to sell courses, ebooks, or merchandise. Leave yourself room to grow without switching platforms.

You’ll also need to consider your technical expertise. Platforms such as Wix and Squarespace offer easy drag-and-drop editors, so there’s no coding involved. 

WordPress provides full customization with plenty of plug-ins and integrations.

WordPress screenshot

When evaluating blogging platforms, consider whether they offer:

  • Simple, easy-to-use interface
  • Variety of templates
  • Integrations for customizing user experience and workflow
  • Built-in SEO tools, such as keyword research, image-alt text, customizable meta descriptions, and suggested optimizations
  • Ecommerce capabilities, including product pages, shopping carts, and payment processing
  • Sign-up forms for mailing lists
  • Analytics for monitoring site traffic and growth
  • 24/7 support, including live chat or telephone service
  • SSL security

AI website builders

AI website builders, such as Hostinger and Wix ADI, use artificial intelligence to create blogs. Simply enter your blog name, a description of your site, and relevant keywords. The platform chooses the layout, colors, font, and images. You can adjust and customize the site to your preferences. For those with coding experience, platforms such as CodeWP use AI to help develop advanced features for WordPress sites.

Hosting

Depending on the server that hosts your blog, your site speed and security may differ. A shared hosting service, like HostGator or Bluehost, where multiple sites share one server, is cost-effective but may run slowly if other sites are consuming significant resources. However, you pay more for a dedicated server. Cloud hosting platforms, such as AWS and Google, use a network of servers to increase resources and enable you to scale when needed. 

Blog Design and User Experience

A clean, attractive website is like a welcome mat, inviting readers to step into your site and explore. Make sure your blog is easy to navigate, as any friction in clicking links or filling out forms may cause visitors to abandon the site. Use the following as a checklist for optimizing your blog’s visual appeal and functionality. v

Aesthetic appeal

Consider the look and feel you want to achieve with your blog, and pick colors that set the right tone. Choose a layout that balances text and visuals — pages should be attractive but not cluttered. White space helps distinguish different site elements so users can find what they need. 

Readability

Use a legible font size and line spacing so it’s easy for the eye to move smoothly from one line to another. Be consistent in applying the font throughout the site and choose contrasting colors for the text and background.

Intuitive navigation

Create a logical site architecture and group content so it makes sense to the user. Use standard navigation cues, such as a menu bar, across the top of the page.

Page speed

Things happen quickly online, so your site should load pages and process requests quickly. Test your site’s Core Web Vitals regularly, as they affect user experience and search rankings. 

Mobile responsiveness

About 58% of all web traffic comes from mobile devices, so your readers are likely browsing on a smartphone or tablet. To accommodate these users, Google crawls and indexes the mobile version of most sites first. Ensure your content resizes to fit neatly on smaller screens, and links and buttons are large enough to select. Fonts should be legible without users zooming in, and mobile pages should load quickly. 

Dynamic content

Make your blog a dynamic experience to spark curiosity and engage audiences. Where appropriate, consider using:

  • Images, charts, graphs, and infographics to break up copy and make points easier to understand
  • Video content to bring concepts to life
  • Interactive quizzes and slideshows
  • Augmented or virtual reality for creative storytelling
  • Virtual tours for immersive experiences, such as the ones offered by the Smithsonian National Museum of Natural History
Smithsonian Museum

Content Creation and Strategy 

To help your blog gain traction, you’ll need a sound strategy and process. It all starts with research, then you’ll need to create a system to publish exceptional content regularly, like a content calendar.

Perform keyword research

With your target audience in mind, use keyword research to guide your topic selection. Identify a mix of broad keywords for core content and long-tail keywords to answer precise questions. Consider the buyer’s journey and create content for audiences both at the beginning of their discovery and further along in the decision-making stages.

Organize themes

With keywords in hand, organize your content into themes so you can take a strategic approach to writing. Let’s say you’re building a financial tips blog. Start with a few topic clusters, such as loans, savings, and mortgages. 

Break these down further. Within the loans category, you might focus on car loans, student loans, and lines of credit. Research long-tail keywords related to these subtopics, such as tips for paying off loans and student loan repayment calculators. This method ensures that your content doesn’t overlap and ideas don’t fall through the cracks.

Manage content creation

Once you’ve identified individual blog topics, consider the format types your audience prefers, and plan your content.

  • Use an editorial calendar. Schedule blog posts with deadlines to keep you on track. If you’re struggling to maintain your schedule, consider outsourcing to a blog writing service.
  • Create content in batches. Instead of writing in bits and pieces, set aside time to create related content all at once. This ensures a consistent approach, and you won’t have to duplicate research. 
  • Write detailed content briefs. A content brief summarizes article details, such as keywords, word count, intended audience, purpose, and topic outline. This document keeps you and your content team on the same page. 
  • Repurpose content. Consider presenting content in different formats to satisfy audience preferences and quickly grow your content inventory. Take key points from an article and translate them into an infographic, or turn a webinar into an ebook. As you publish more content, you’ll cement your topical authority.

Balancing content quality and quantity

It might be tempting to push out as much content as possible when starting your blog, but search engines and audiences are increasingly discerning about quality. Google’s E-E-A-T guidelines and the more recent helpful content system update emphasize content with experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness. In other words, your content must deliver exceptional value before it can surface in search engines. Incorporate unique insight, such as examples based on your experiences, case studies, or statistics from your research. 

A note of caution: Many bloggers are dabbling in AI to speed up content creation. While AI can help with ideation, OpenAI’s terms of use state you can’t represent its output as human-generated. In other words, you can’t ask ChatGPT to write an article and publish it as your own — but this is a good thing. While AI content could rank in Google in theory, it still requires human assistance to address the first-person experience and perspective that satisfies E-E-A-T principles.

Building an Audience

You’ve built your blog and put together a brilliant content strategy. The next step is to create awareness and cultivate an audience, because quality alone won’t attract traffic to your blog. Here are some tactics to raise your online visibility:

  • Search engine optimization: Follow industry standard best practices for getting your site to rank well in search engine results.
  • Social media marketing: Identify the platforms and online communities where your audience is most active. Begin building an online presence and engaging audiences using hashtags.
  • Social networking conversations: Share your expertise by commenting on posts or answering questions. For example, LinkedIn’s collaborative articles are making an impressive splash in search results.
  • Cross-promotion: Partner with websites that have a similar target audience so you can reach new readers. 
  • Guest posts: Offer a guest post to authoritative sites in exchange for a link that drives traffic to your site.
  • Email marketing: Build your email subscriber list to market directly to your audience. 
  • Analytics: Regularly analyze your blog’s performance. See which pages are most popular or where most of your readers are coming from to build on your success.

Once you drive traffic to your site, keep your readers engaged. Link strategically between posts to encourage audiences to explore other pages on your site, and ensure your content remains fresh and interesting. 

Monetization Strategies

When your blog gains momentum, you can generate income. You have to demonstrate a minimum level of traffic to attract advertisers and partners, but as your blog grows, more opportunities to earn become available.

Balance your need to create revenue with the needs of your audience. Littering your site with ads can get in the way of the user experience and impact your credibility. Similarly, your audience depends on you for your opinions, so don’t recommend products simply to earn money through sponsorship or affiliate links. 

Advertising

Ad networks, such as Google AdSense, Mediavine, and SHE Media, place ads from brands interested in reaching your audience and get paid by the view or click. You can also sell space directly to advertisers if you find a business interested in sponsoring your site.

Courses and workshops

Many bloggers generate revenue through courses, workshops, or coaching. There are a few different models for this. The website Simply + Fiercely supplements its home organization tips with courses at various price points. 

Simply + Fiercely

Meanwhile, cooking blogs such as the Canto Cooking Club offer a monthly subscription for on-demand cooking classes. 

Canto Cooking Club

Affiliate marketing

With affiliate marketing, you earn a commission each time someone from your site clicks a link to purchase on another website. These links are usually included in blog posts as product recommendations. Amazon is the most well-known affiliate partner, but The Home Depot, Walmart, and Lowe’s also offer affiliate programs. The Penny Hoarder, for example, uses affiliate links and discloses them at the start of articles.

The Penny Hoarder

Product or services

Offer personalized coaching or consulting services to your audience so they can benefit first-hand from your expertise. The courses we mentioned on Simply + Fiercely include live coaching calls with the blog founder. 

You can also set up an ecommerce shop to sell items your audience might be interested in, whether it’s an ebook you’ve written or products you’ve developed. Yoga with Adriene, for example, has a shop featuring branded clothing. 

Yoga with Adriene

Brand sponsorships

Some bloggers secure sponsorships with brands that have a similar target audience. With these arrangements, you receive compensation for mentioning or promoting products in posts — through financial payment or products to review. You may also receive giveaways to run contests or promo codes for your readers.

Legal and Ethical Considerations for Your Blog

When you’re publishing in a public space, you’re obligated to do so responsibly. Taking an ethical approach to your blog helps establish professionalism and credibility and sets the foundation for your site’s longevity.

  • Trademarks: Perform due diligence when branding your blog by ensuring the name isn’t already in use. Consider trademarking your final choice for protection. 
  • Copyright: Don’t use images, text, video, or other content without permission or attribution. It’s best to create your own content and use royalty-free or stock photography. 
  • Disclosure: Disclose whether you’re paid to write about something, receive a commission, or have a stake in something you write about. 
  • Libel and defamation: Take care not to make false statements on your blog that can negatively impact someone’s reputation, as this can lead to legal action.
  • Be respectful: Be careful about sharing personal stories, photographs, or information without permission.
  • Inclusive language: Use gender-neutral terms and watch for language that marginalizes or excludes certain groups. Consider that a diverse audience may be reading your content.
  • Headlines: Be respectful of your audience and deliver what you promise in your content — misleading headlines can diminish your audience’s trust.
  • Accuracy: Verify facts with credible sources. If you make a mistake, correct it as soon as possible.
  • Accessibility: Make your content accessible to users of all abilities. This includes alternative text for images and ensuring your website is compatible with assistive devices.
  • Privacy policies and disclaimers: Explain how and why you collect information and any terms and conditions for using your site. Disclaimers can protect you if you’re writing about health-related, legal, or financial topics — suggest that readers consult with a professional before taking action.

Additional Resources

While starting a blog can be daunting, you don’t have to go it alone. Plenty of tools can help you get your work done efficiently, as well as lead you to communities where you can ask questions and interact with other bloggers. Some of these tools and communities include:

  • Grammarly: Use this popular writing assistant to polish your copy and improve grammar, spelling, and writing style.
  • Canva: This graphic design tool makes it easy to create images for blog posts and social media content. Both free and paid versions are available.
  • Looka: Need a logo? This tool uses AI to create one for you.  
  • Pexels: Find free stock photos and images for your blog.
  • Lumen5: Make your blog more dynamic with AI-generated videos.
  • Yoast SEO: This WordPress plug-in helps you optimize your content to rank better in search engines.
  • Google Analytics: Monitor key metrics and find ways to improve your blog’s performance.
  • Trello: Organize your workflow and keep track of deadlines with this project management tool.
  • Google AdSense: Display ads on your blog to earn revenue.
  • Reddit: Connect with fellow bloggers on the r/Blogging subreddit. You might also pick up some search engine optimization tips on r/SEO.

Your Roadmap to Blogging Success

Building a sustainable blog begins with researching topics your audience is interested in, ensuring a demand, and differentiating your blog from competitors. But to shine online, you need to plan and create outstanding blog posts that demonstrate expertise and offer more value than other sites in the SERPs.

Helpful, thought-provoking, and original content connects you to your audience. Learn how Crowd Content’s blog writing services can help you scale your content creation, from keyword research to quality assurance, and take the day-to-day details of writing and editing off your plate.

The post How to Start a Blog in 2024: An All-in-One Guide appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Write High-Performing Content Using Blog Post Templates https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/write-high-performing-content-using-blog-post-templates/ Thu, 22 Feb 2024 13:43:40 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37175 Crafting a compelling blog post from scratch is like trying to invent a new recipe off the top of your head. Throwing words at a page and hoping for the best won’t engage readers or help your content rank on search engines, so what’s the answer? Enter blog post templates.  In this guide, we explain […]

The post Write High-Performing Content Using Blog Post Templates appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Crafting a compelling blog post from scratch is like trying to invent a new recipe off the top of your head. Throwing words at a page and hoping for the best won’t engage readers or help your content rank on search engines, so what’s the answer? Enter blog post templates. 

In this guide, we explain the time-saving benefits of incorporating structured templates into your content writing routine. From consistency and improved search engine optimization to engagement and scalability, blog templates are the secret sauce to streamlining and refining your blog writing process.  

Leveraging Blog Post Templates for Content Success

Blog post templates provide marketers with a strategic advantage and streamline the content creation process. They save time, guarantee brand consistency, and create a baseline for quality standards. 

Plus, by addressing common challenges, such as writer’s block and lack of direction, templates provide a structured framework, boosting efficiency and creativity. They empower writers to consistently produce high-quality content that ranks on the SERPs and resonates with audiences.  

Rick Leach
Rick Leach
Director, Content Creation

“Look at it from a scalability viewpoint: Imagine someone trying to get consistent output from a team of writers tasked with creating listicles. Using a template in your instructions helps get the same result from a group of disconnected/remote writers. From the individual writer standpoint: Templates can help remind you of (or teach you) best practices for different types of content — especially if you’re an amateur blogger who may have never learned what’s effective or not a good idea.”

Essential Elements of Any Blog Post Template

Here are the key elements of any blog post structure worth using:

  • Clear and engaging headlines: Using SERP analysis to discover what ranks, craft compelling headlines that capture readers’ attention and accurately convey the content’s value proposition. 
  • Relevant long-tail keywords in headings: Construct headings using relevant keywords that address user intent, including People Also Ask questions from Google. This improves search engine visibility and attracts targeted traffic.
  • High-quality visuals: Incorporate informative videos, visually appealing infographics, and interactive elements, such as quizzes or polls, to enhance visual appeal and support the content’s message. Ensure multimedia is relevant to the content, optimize file sizes for fast loading, and maintain consistency in style and branding.
  • Consistent grammar, spelling, and formatting: Polish your template’s instructions to affirm readability and professionalism.
  • Engagement prompts: Encourage reader engagement by including a call-to-action. These prompts invite readers to book a service, make a purchase, or share their thoughts, experiences, and feedback.
  • Advanced SEO optimization: Don’t forget technical elements such as schema markup, a structured data format providing search engines with detailed information about your content. Ticking these boxes makes it more likely for your content to appear as a rich snippet in search results. This is a concise summary with a link to your site that appears at the top of the SERP — and it’s often the first thing a searcher sees. Website loading speed, site structure, and mobile optimization are also important.   
  • Optimization through data-driven insights and experimentation: Utilize A/B testing to refine templates. Compare elements, such as headline structures, content layouts, and CTA placements, to determine the most effective variations for engagement and conversions.

Tips for optimizing a blog post for SEO

Optimizing posts for SEO is critical for boosting visibility and attracting readers. Here’s how to do it while keeping your writing style authentic:

  • Keyword placement: Strategically scatter keywords throughout your content only when it makes sense. Focus on long-tail keywords and semantic relevance — and never keyword stuff. Google cares deeply about readability and context, so avoid creating search-engine-first content and cater to your actual readers. 
  • Meta descriptions: Write meta descriptions summarizing your content and entice readers to click through. 
  • Balanced SEO and style: Find the sweet spot between SEO optimization and a consistent writing style.
Rick Leach
Rick Leach
Director, Content Creation

“Sometimes, we see entirely too much focus on SEO in how we equip writers to execute on content. Optimizing for search is just one piece of the puzzle. What good is ranking content that doesn’t engage the reader and perform to your business goals? Modern SEO involves more than strict and zealous keyword usage. To really move the needle, you need smart SEO tactics, something of value to share with an audience that needs/wants it, and a strategy on exactly what goal the piece should help accomplish. Once you have all that, you need a skilled writer who can bring it all together in a way that works for readers and search.”

6 Tried-and-True Blog Post Templates

The first four examples below are simple templates. They’re popular with readers and consistently perform well on the SERPs. Use them to answer frequently searched questions, establish authority, and drive initial traffic. These go-to content formats help you load your website with relevant, scannable, and engaging content to attract visitors.

Conversion-focused posts and pillar content require a more strategic approach, delivering long-term results and tying into your overarching marketing goals. They influence user behavior, drive conversions, and pack your website with comprehensive and authoritative resources that reinforce domain authority.

1. How-to blog template

Think of these posts as trusty guides — beacons, lighting the way to help readers achieve a specific goal or solve a problem. They’re written in an easy-to-digest, step-by-step format, making them simple to follow. Readers leave your site armed with the answers they’ve been looking for, thinking of your brand as a trustworthy and authoritative source. 

Example title: How to [Achieve a Specific Goal or Solve a Problem]

  • Introduce the topic, and let readers know why they need to address it ASAP.
  • Establish trust by including an interesting fact or valuable statistic and linking to an authoritative source.
  • Use the final sentence to confidently inform the reader of what they’ll know/be able to do by the end of the article.

Elements of a how-to article

  • Divide the task into manageable steps.
  • Offer clear and concise instructions for each step.
  • Use bullet points or numbered lists for readability.
  • Incorporate relevant images, diagrams, or videos.
  • Anticipate and tackle common questions or hurdles.
  • Offer tips or shortcuts for improved results.

Conclusion

  • Summarize the main points covered in the post.
  • Add a bonus takeaway point related to the subject to affirm authority.
  • Include a CTA.

2. Listicle blog writing template

Listicles are the fast food of blog posts. These snackable nuggets of wisdom are served up in a numbered list format for easy consumption. They offer quick, actionable tips and insights into a subject, guiding readers from the top to the bottom of the page. Providing web users with information that’s easy to process and act on is one of the best ways to secure returning visitors.  

Example title: [#] Tips to [Achieve Specific Outcome]

  • Introduce the topic’s relevance and urgency.
  • Keep the intro short and snappy.

Elements of a listicle

  • Present each tip in a numbered format.
  • Use scannable H2s and H3s.
  • Provide concise explanations for each tip.
  • Include practical examples or scenarios to demonstrate experience and expertise. 
  • Offer a bonus tip in a separate H2 relating to your brand, sliding seamlessly into the conclusion.

Conclusion

  • Summarize the article and reiterate any practical and relevant advice.
  • Tie the article back to your brand’s offering to segue into the CTA.
  • Add a CTA.

3. Definition blog article template

Definition blog posts are readers’ go-to guides for demystifying complicated concepts or industry-specific ideas. They open with a clear definition, offer contextual explanations, and rely on real-world examples and expert insights for depth and clarity.  

Example title: What Is [Concept], and Why Do You Need to Know?

Introduction

  • Introduce the topic and its significance in the context of the audience’s interests or needs.
  • Point to a relevant statistic from the past year and link to an authoritative source.
  • Preview the key elements and insights covered in the post to enhance understanding.

Elements of a definition blog post

  • Clear definition: Immediately provide a concise and precise definition of the concept, avoiding jargon or ambiguity. 
  • Contextual explanation: Explain the concept’s relevance and implications in real-world scenarios or industries.
  • Examples and illustrations: Enhance understanding with relevant examples, case studies, or illustrations that demonstrate the concept in action.
  • Comparison and contrast: Differentiate the concept from related terms or concepts, clarifying its unique attributes and characteristics.
  • Historical background: Provide context by exploring the origins and evolution of the concept over time, highlighting key milestones or developments.
  • Expert insights: Incorporate insights and perspectives from subject matter experts or thought leaders to enrich the discussion and add credibility.
  • Practical applications: Discuss the concept’s practical applications or use cases, demonstrating its value and relevance in various contexts.

Conclusion

  • Summarize the key insights and takeaways.
  • Link to internal resources to help readers deepen their understanding of the concept.
  • Include a CTA.

4. Cheat sheet template

Picture cheat sheets as quick-reference guides, jam-packed with essential information in a condensed format. They answer big questions in as few words as possible, so readers in a hurry can get the skinny on a topic in no time.   

Example title: [Topic] Cheat Sheet: A Quick Reference Guide to [Subject]

Introduction

  • Introduce the topic, and explain the purpose of the cheat sheet in providing quick and easy access to essential information.
  • Highlight the value of having a condensed and actionable resource for readers to reference.
  • Preview key sections for quick navigation.

Elements of a cheat sheet

  • Overview: Briefly summarize the topic or subject covered in the cheat sheet.
  • Key concepts: Organize the main concepts, principles, or steps related to the topic in a clear format.
  • Quick tips: Offer actionable tips, tricks, or shortcuts to help readers succeed or overcome common challenges related to the topic.
  • Valuable resources: Include links or references to additional resources, tools, or further reading materials for readers to explore.
  • Visual aids: Incorporate visual elements, such as diagrams, charts, or infographics, to enhance understanding and retention of information.
  • FAQs: Address common queries related to the topic, providing clear and concise answers readers can default to if they’re in a rush.

Conclusion

  • Summarize key takeaways from the cheat sheet.
  • Encourage readers to download or bookmark the cheat sheet for future use and easy access.
  • Add a CTA.

5. Conversion-focused blog template

Conversion-focused posts are all about persuasion. These content powerhouses are designed to drive action and generate leads and sales. They’re exemplified by compelling headlines, action-driven content, and CTAs that directly align with search intent. 

Example title: [Persuasive, Action-Driven Headline]

Introduction

  • Introduce the product, service, or contextually related subject.
  • Add a hard-hitting fact or statistic to emphasize your point.
  • Use a hook to draw the reader in and compel them to keep reading.

Elements of a conversion-focused blog post

  • CTA: Ensure posts include compelling CTAs that align with the proper stage in the buyer’s journey.
  • Engaging headlines: Use attention-grabbing, SEO-optimized headlines that communicate the benefit of taking action.
  • Persuasive content: Craft compelling content that resonates with the target audience’s needs and desires.
  • Visual appeal: Incorporate appealing elements, such as images, videos, or infographics, to enhance engagement and interest.
  • Social proof: Include social proof elements such as testimonials, reviews, or case studies to build trust and credibility.
  • User-friendly design: Optimize the blog post layout and design for easy readability and navigation, reducing friction in the conversion process.
  • A/B testing: Experiment with different elements and strategies through A/B testing to optimize conversion rates over time.

Conclusion

  • Summarize the key elements of the article.
  • Offer an extra tip to help readers implement the strategies and techniques discussed in the post.
  • Use a CTA that directly relates to search intent. If you own a heating and cooling company called HVAC123, create a bottom-of-the-funnel CTA that addresses users typing “fast emergency HVAC repair” into Google. For example: “Call now for emergency HVAC repairs — HVAC123 guarantees rapid response times.” 

6. Pillar content blog post template

Pillar content is the foundational center in a hub and spoke content campaign, offering in-depth coverage of a core topic and linking to related content. Consider pillar pages as guides, covering high-level explanations about specific topics. When optimizing your site for SEO and serving as a go-to resource for readers, the hub and spoke strategy is an almighty titan.

Example title: The Ultimate Guide to [Topic] (Be clear that it’s a lengthy but broad source of information.)

Introduction

  • Use language to indicate this is a comprehensive and authoritative exploration of the subject.
  • Highlight subtopics and link to them using a graphic or list toward the top of the page.
  • Preview the key components and actionable steps covered in the guide.

Elements of pillar content

  • Thorough coverage: Provide comprehensive coverage of the core topic, briefly describing and linking to all relevant subtopics that offer more in-depth answers.
  • Strategic organization: Organize content logically, using clear headings and subheadings to structure information for easy navigation.
  • Multimedia integration: Enhance pillar content with multimedia elements, such as videos, infographics, or interactive features, to engage and educate audiences.
  • Evergreen value: Ensure pillar content remains relevant and valuable over time by focusing on evergreen topics and updating content as needed.
  • Authoritative links: Position pillar content as authoritative resources in the industry, only using credible, recent sources to back up claims and statistics. This helps build trust with audiences and search engines.

Conclusion:

  • Summarize the article, and offer a couple of valuable, original insights.
  • Offer suggestions for further reading, or encourage readers to speak their minds in the comments section or on social media.
  • Include a CTA.

Tools and Resources for Blog Post Templates

There’s a treasure trove of tools and software solutions out there that can supercharge your blog post templates:

  • AI: Tools such as ChatGPT and OwlyWriter AI can create blog template outlines for you or create content according to your specifications. 
  • Content management systems: WordPress and Squarespace offer easy template integration.
  • Project management tools: Trello and Asana assist with collaborative template development. 
  • Graphic design: Canva and Adobe Creative Cloud allow you to create visually appealing template customization with minimal expertise. 
  • SERP analysis: Software such as MarketMuse and Clearscope dives deep into the SERPs, using natural language processing and machine learning to categorize content types, such as how-to guides and listicles. Don’t make the mistake of using a how-to template if most top-ranking articles for your intended query are listicles. 
  • Analytics platforms: Google Analytics and HubSpot help track template performance and optimization opportunities.
  • Content intelligence tools: Platforms such as Clearscope and MarketMuse analyze top-ranking SERP content to recommend the most effective content types and templates.
  • Content ideation tools: Tools such as BuzzSumo and Semrush provide insights into popular topics and content formats, guiding template selection.
  • Visual content tools: Utilize platforms such as Piktochart and Visme to create visually engaging templates for infographics and slides.
  • Professional services: Sign up for Crowd Content’s blog writing service to get expert assistance in template implementation.

Optimize Your Blog Writing Process and Drive Traffic

Leveraging blog post templates and using the right tools transforms your content production process. From enhancing efficiency to maintaining brand consistency, these resources empower you to create compelling content that resonates with your audience and boosts your online presence. 

As you explore them, remember — success lies not just in creation but also in strategy. Armed with a full kit of insights and technology, you can conquer any content challenge. 

Ready to skyrocket your content game and achieve consistent results? Let our seasoned wordsmiths turn your visions into captivating listicles, how-to articles, and pillar pages. Sign up for our blog writing services, and witness the magic of strategic content creation. 

The post Write High-Performing Content Using Blog Post Templates appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What’s Google’s Stance on AI-Generated Content? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ai-content-creation/can-google-detect-ai-content/ Mon, 19 Feb 2024 13:26:09 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37149 AI is the biggest game-changer for content marketing since Google Analytics came onto the scene in ’05. From simplifying tedious tasks to crafting targeted content, AI tools promise to streamline, innovate, and enhance.  But, amidst the hype and noise, there’s a burning question: Can Google, the digital gatekeeper, tell if content is created by steel […]

The post What’s Google’s Stance on AI-Generated Content? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
AI is the biggest game-changer for content marketing since Google Analytics came onto the scene in ’05. From simplifying tedious tasks to crafting targeted content, AI tools promise to streamline, innovate, and enhance. 

But, amidst the hype and noise, there’s a burning question: Can Google, the digital gatekeeper, tell if content is created by steel and silicon instead of a human mind?  Join us as we reveal the depths of Google’s AI content detection powers and empower you to harness the full potential of your new AI sidekick. 

Can Google Detect AI Content? 

Google’s technology is far too sophisticated to be fooled by AI content — and for readers with a trained eye, AI-generated content can stick out like a sore thumb. But does that mean Google punishes you for utilizing it?

Google’s mission is to organize the world’s information and make it universally accessible and helpful. This quest means a relentless battle against low-quality content designed to manipulate search rankings — AI-generated or not. 

The search engine is transparent about spam policies for Google web search. Some of its flagged criteria include keyword stuffing, cloaking, and hidden links. Just as keyword-stuffed articles written by humans are penalized as spam, so is spammy AI-generated content. In other words, AI-generated content has just as much opportunity to be flagged as spam as content typed straight from the hands of creatives.

Google uses algorithms to determine an article’s creator. Let’s explore how Google’s algorithms have flourished in recent years and how these procedures affect whether AI ranks in the SERPs.

The evolution of Google’s algorithms

Google has developed complex algorithms designed to separate the wheat from the chaff to deliver reliable, helpful content to users. In recent years, the advent of AI has bolstered its ability to detect and penalize spam content — and reward high-quality, original content.

These upgrades had the most significant impact on AI detection:

  • Bidirectional Encoder Representations from Transformers (BERT) in 2019: This model helps Google understand conversational queries and search intent.
BERT
  • Multitask Unified Model (MUM) in 2021: 1,000 times more potent than BERT, MUM can generate comprehensive search results across various languages and formats and understand the context behind complex queries. This advancement considerably improved accuracy and depth, delivering more relevant results to intricate searches.  
  • SpamBrain in 2022: This AI-based system targets behaviors that manipulate search rankings, such as keyword stuffing and link buying to give users better results. It identifies and penalizes websites that engage in tactics deemed to be search-first instead of people-first. 
  • MUM’s rollout in 2022: Boosting search accuracy and speed, MUM uses a T5 model that leads to more precise and relevant search experiences and dooms low-effort content to oblivion. 
MUM's T5 model

Other Google algorithms impacting SEO and relating to AI-generated content include:

  • Freshness systems, which show recent content where appropriate
  • The helpful content system, which prioritizes useful, human-written content
  • PageRank, which analyzes links for relevance, authority, and integrity
  • Neural matching, which connects user intent to content context 
  • RankBrain, which helps Google understand the context behind words
  • Reliable information systems, which help elevate quality journalism and demote low-quality writing

If you’re relying too heavily on AI, you may have plummeted into a pit of low-ranking content and irrelevancy. However, not all AI-generated content is created equally. 

What’s Google’s Official Stance on AI-Generated Content?

Google’s official stance on AI-generated content has shifted dramatically in a short space of time. You’re forgiven if you think Search Advocate John Meuller‘s words from April 2022 still stand.

John Meuller's speech

But note that guidance about AI-generated content on Google’s website reveals a different picture. Today, the company’s official stance reflects a dual commitment to search quality and user experience. 

automation

These guidelines highlight the need for content to prioritize originality and user-centricity. If you’re using AI, you can’t slam a few prompts into ChatGPT and copy and paste your way to success. 

If you’re using AI to create original, high-quality content that demonstrates expertise, experience, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness, Google rewards you — however the content is produced.

Our VP of Content Operations, Rick Leach, expands on the principles behind E-E-A-T:

“With E-E-A-T, Google has all but ensured that pure AI content and low-effort human content won’t stand much of a chance in the SERPs. Content that succeeds has insights, advice, and opinions that come from what the people in your business have learned by doing a job, performing a service, or creating a product day in and day out. You can’t fake that stuff, and you certainly won’t get it from quick, one-prompt AI outputs.”

How Does Google Detect AI Content?

Google can detect AI-generated content because it understands how generative AI works.

Dr. Vivek Pandley, CEO of Vrata Tech Solutions, explains what sets modern AI tools like ChatGPT apart. “These models are trained on massive datasets, learning patterns, styles, and contextual cues to generate coherent and contextually relevant content,” Pandley says. “Unlike traditional AI models that follow predetermined rules, generative AI has the ability to generate novel outputs, making it a powerful tool for tasks ranging from content creation and natural language processing to image synthesis.”

So, how does Google know AI wrote your content? While the search giant keeps its secrets notoriously close to its chest, we know the following methods:

  • Pattern recognition detects unusual language structure, grammar, syntax, and semantics.
  • Google trains machine learning algorithms on massive data sets of human and AI-written content, helping it learn subtle cues that indicate AI or human writing. 
  • Ensemble deep learning combines multiple detection models, strengthening Google’s ability to detect AI content. 
  • Natural language processing analyzes semantics and context, highlighting differences between human and AI writing patterns. 

Despite Google’s advancements, AI models constantly up their game, getting ever-closer to looking and sounding indistinguishable from human writing. Plus, with AI-driven adversarial attacks on the rise, there’s a battle underway to keep AI as a force for good.

Thanks to advanced neural network architectures, Google appears proficient at recognizing complex patterns suggestive of AI-generated content.  

AI’s Impact on Engagement and UX

AI is here to stay, and Google is on board, provided you “produce original, high-quality, people-first content demonstrating qualities of E-E-A-T.” But what does that mean? Ultimately, it boils down to crafting content focused on user engagement and experience — and having relevant, demonstrated expertise.

Bankrate taught the world a valuable lesson about focusing solely on scaling up and neglecting to optimize AI content for E-E-A-T. Futurism’s Jon Christian exposed the CNET sister site by writing a scathing piece listing all the factual errors in a single AI-generated Bankrate article.

AI generated article

Following public outcry, Bankrate pivoted on its AI policy.

how we will use AI

Anyone who’s used generative AI knows there must have been little — if any — human input into Bankrate’s AI-generated articles. Inaccurate information, absence of expert writers, and focus on pumping out reams of content eroded away at E-E-A-T.

AI alone isn’t enough

In April 2023, Google released a statement: “AI and automation can be a useful tool to create helpful content, but if AI is used for the primary purpose of manipulating search rankings, that’s a violation of our long-standing policy against spammy automatically-generated content.”

You need to apply E-E-A-T principles, engage users, and provide them with a memorable experience that compels them to return. You can use AI to create it, but here’s the kicker — AI is a powerful, fantastic tool for making content, but it can’t create it for you. Every sentence of every article needs human involvement to meet Google’s exacting standards. 

Bankrate prioritized search over people and had to unlist 6 months’ worth of content as a result. While embarrassing for them, it could push a smaller company into the red. That’s why human touch is crucial when producing AI-generated content.

If you’ve used AI to generate articles and you’re on the brink of banishing them to the recycle bin, stop! Use them as foundational pieces, adding expert quotes and opinions, valuable graphics, and a consistent brand voice. 

Tips for Using AI to Craft Content That Converts

To make sure your content doesn’t fall short of Google’s quality standards:

  • Know Google’s rules. Keep yourself in the loop with Google’s quality guidelines. Your AI content should tick the boxes for originality, relevance, and user-friendliness, in line with Google’s playbook.
  • Mix in human flavor. AI can churn out bland content, but people add the seasoning. Experiment with an AI-generated draft, then sprinkle in personality, expertise, and authenticity.
  • Serve value. Give your audience something worth reading by never rewriting someone else’s article. Your content should solve problems, answer questions, and offer fresh insights to keep readers coming back for more.
  • Keep it readable. Avoid making your audience work too hard. Use precise language, short sentences, and tidy formatting to make your AI-generated content a breeze to read and understand.
  • Shake things up. Don’t be a one-trick pony. Try different content types, including articles, blogs, infographics, videos, and podcasts. 
  • Test and tweak. Watch your AI content’s performance, and listen to what your audience says. Use the data to find ways to make your content even better.

Creative uses for AI in content creation

With these AI-powered tricks up your sleeve, you can craft content that works for you without breaking a sweat:

  • Tailored recommendations: Use AI tools such as ChatGPT and Gemini to determine what your audience wants, and serve up personalized content recommendations that hit the spot.
  • Visual content enhancement: Spruce up your visuals with AI tools for special effects — it’s a whole lot cheaper than licensing stock photography. 
  • Natural language generation: Effortlessly generate content such as product descriptions and social media posts. But never forget to match it with your brand’s style and tone, or it’ll get lost in a sea of similar posts.
  • Voice search optimization: Stay one step ahead by writing AI-optimized content for voice search queries. Use conversational language and long-tail keywords to make sure your content gets heard loud and clear.

What Does the Future Hold for Google AI-Detection?

As we navigate AI’s impact on the world of SEO content, one thing remains clear: Adaptability is key. AI marches forth, as do Google’s detection methods, ensuring that only high-quality, user-centric content prevails. The future holds endless possibilities for AI-driven content, but it has yet to find a workaround for Google’s standards. 

To stay ahead, content creators need to adhere to Google’s guidelines, blend AI with human creativity, and prioritize their audience over quick fixes to climb the SERPs. 

Ready to transform your AI-generated content into pieces that embody E-E-A-T principles? Try out Crowd Content’s expert editing services.

The post What’s Google’s Stance on AI-Generated Content? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Top 10 AI Content Creation Tools https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ai-content-creation/top-10-ai-content-creation-tools/ Mon, 12 Feb 2024 10:47:47 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37098 When the first artificial intelligence program in the United States emerged in 1952, it’s likely that its creator, Arthur Samuel, had no idea AI would one day be as pervasive as it’s become in the 21st century. But the soaring popularity of AI content creation tools underscores our collective desire for smarter, more streamlined ways to drive […]

The post Top 10 AI Content Creation Tools appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
When the first artificial intelligence program in the United States emerged in 1952, it’s likely that its creator, Arthur Samuel, had no idea AI would one day be as pervasive as it’s become in the 21st century. But the soaring popularity of AI content creation tools underscores our collective desire for smarter, more streamlined ways to drive engagement. As writers, editors, marketers, publishers, and business people, it’s our job to reach people — and if AI can support that goal, why not leverage all that ripe-for-the-picking tech?

To help you along, we’ve compiled a comprehensive guide to the AI tools we love to use all through the content-creation process.

Use Cases for AI Content Creation Tools

AI content creation tools leverage the many intricacies of natural language processing and machine learning algorithms to create content that looks and sounds human but originates deep within the inner workings of the World Wide Web.

Over the past couple of years, the majority of public focus has been on AI’s increasing role in content generation. With the help of a human operator, artificial intelligence tools draw on existing content, data, and other inputs across the internet to create new copy used for everything from blog posts and news articles to product descriptions and About Us pages. But the written word is far from the only way to utilize AI.

AI tools are also invaluable for:

  • SEO: AI can help with search engine optimization, by identifying quality keywords and generating metadata that appeals to Google’s algorithm.
  • Social media management: Platforms such as Hootsuite and FeedHive tackle vital social media tasks, such as identifying the best time to post a meme and using social listening to track and analyze consumer conversations.
  • Email marketing: Creating content for emails can be especially tricky because you have to pack a lot into a relatively small space. AI can draft personalized email content, improving your marketing campaigns without taxing your brain power.
  • Translation: Looking to break into a new market? Use AI to translate existing content into another language without losing context and tone.
  • Chatbots: Providing 24/7 customer service can be expensive, which is why so many companies are training chatbots to interact with customers and answer their questions when human agents are unavailable.
  • Graphics: AI image generators can create images based on prompts, reducing reliance on those generic stock images people love to hate.

And those use cases are just the tip of the iceberg. AI can also help with editing content, analyzing data, scripting, creating quizzes, crafting how-to guides and tutorials, drafting legal documents such as contracts, aiding developers in generating code snippets, scheduling appointments, and hundreds of other useful things.

Top 10 Content Creation Tools

Using AI content creation tools to improve your business practices or to lighten your personal workload is a clever play. But the even more brilliant move is learning which tools are the best overall for the task at hand.

1. ChatGPT

ChatGPT35

Classification: Broad-spectrum content generation

Overview: Large language models (LLMS) are used to power platforms such as ChatGPT, creating a methodology that generates blogs, social media updates, content summaries, and just about every other content imaginable based on text data originally used to train the LLM’s neural network. In other words, ChatGPT has learned how to create content just like a human would (or pretty close, anyway).

You can use ChatGPT in multiple ways, depending on your role and your goals. Are you a writer who needs help brainstorming? A content strategist building a content map with pillar pages and spokes? A content manager tasked with generating briefs and outlines? You can do all this, plus tons of other jobs, from one chat interface — you just need to tweak the copy before sending it down the pipeline to the next person.

Features: ChatGPT has the ability to answer questions, summarize text, translate content, generate code, etc.

Pros: ChatGPT’s prompt and response format is easy to use and works for everything from writing blogs to figuring out how to fix your washing machine.

Cons: If in the hands of a novice user, long-form writing can easily come off as formulaic (or, dare we say robotic?). Also, because these models train on potentially outdated data, you still need to fact-check everything the platform generates.

Pricing: The basic model is free, but a $20/month subscription provides faster responses and more consistent access when the site is overloaded with users. 

2. ClickUp

ClickUp

Classification: Project management and AI writing assistant

Overview: This productivity-boosting tool empowers teams that can benefit from having multiple utilities all under one umbrella. Functionality is the name of the game, and the completely reconfigurable setup means each user or organization can find a way to make ClickUp fit their needs — even if those needs continuously change.

ClickUp’s tagline is “One app to replace them all,” and it makes sense. Instead of flipping back and forth between apps used to monitor tasks, write content, track goals, and chat with team members, ClickUp puts it all in one place and creates new connections powered by all-knowing AI. It’s like having a personal assistant who knows what you need before you do.

Features: ClickUp has hundreds of features on tap, including tools for task management, marketing campaign management, visual collaboration, real-time reporting, content ideation and creation, editing, and checklist generation.

Pros: The platform is customizable and built to integrate with over 1,000 other tools. It also has a library of customizable templates for work-ready shortcuts.

Cons: AI features are available only through higher subscription tiers.

Pricing: Subscriptions range from free (best for personal use) to business accounts for $12/month. Larger enterprise-level accounts are priced by request.

3. Narrato Workspace

Narrato

Classification: End-to-end AI content creation and planning

Overview: Narrato Workspace isn’t a single tool — it’s an entire workspace that puts research, planning, and content creation all in one applause-worthy box. It doesn’t matter if your to-do list includes automating publishing for a couple dozen blogs, coming up with ideas for video scripts, or writing a press release for that upcoming product launch. Narrato can do it all — and add some custom AI images for good measure.

Features: Narrato’s SEO content brief generator is a total powerhouse. Other features, such as workflow automation that streamlines repetitive tasks, AI image generation, and built-in content planning and organization tools, are equally indispensable.

Pros: The all-in-one workspace saves time, and the template generator helps users keep dialing in their own processes.

Cons: Users report few cons, but the content editor can lag a bit when processing larger docs.

Pricing: Plans start at $36/month for a base Pro subscription and increase to $76/month for a larger business account.

4. Lately

Lately

Classification: AI social media post generator

Overview: Turning long-form content into easily digestible nuggets suitable for social media can feel like a slog. Lately generates social posts in a jiffy, which serves several purposes: You can reuse existing content, populate your social feeds, and generate more engagement all at once. And you don’t have to strain your bandwidth to do it. With Lately, you can create dozens of social posts with a simple click of a button, and that’s not limited to text. The platform also distills audio and visual content.

Features: Lately’s solutions list includes tools that generate content and transcripts, create clips of videos and podcasts, and build social posts with all the necessary elements (copy, images, tracking links, etc.) intact and ready to go.

Pros: As easy to use as it is focused, Lately gives small businesses and busy marketers a way to power up social media without getting distracted by other functionalities.

Cons: The platform’s narrow focus means you’ll need other tools for other tasks.

Pricing: Pricing depends on the number of social channels linked; subscriptions start at $49/month for four channels.

5. Jasper

Jasper

Classification: AI content generator for blogs

Overview: Jasper is kind of like ChatGPT’s lesser-known cousin, but don’t let marketing make your decision for you. Jasper is adept at understanding tone, something that’s often missing in AI-generated content. Cross-app integrations make it easier to transfer content between Google Docs and the Jasper platform, and you can even use the built-in API to create new integrations that aren’t automatically supported.

Features: Use Jasper’s Boss Mode to create more detailed long-form content. SurferSEO integration helps finished content rank, and with 30-plus languages available for translation purposes, that content is poised to reach an even bigger audience.

Pros: Jasper’s ability to understand and replicate tone is ideal for branded content, and Boss Mode helps avoid some of the pitfalls that usually come with content built off AI-driven templates.

Cons: Like other AI content generators, Jasper isn’t built for nuance. Have specialty and sensitive content reviewed by human subject matter experts for the best results.

Pricing: Creator-level subscriptions start at $39/month and go up from there. Enterprise pricing is available on request. 

6. Copy.ai

copy.ai

Classification: Freestyle AI writing tool

Overview: Copy.ai is another content generator, but this one responds well to additional guidance. Instead of entering a general prompt, such as “zoo animals,” you can provide more context, such as “zoo animals most prevalent in the United States, written from 2nd person POV, geared toward kids, with a humorous undertone.” Similar to ChatGPT, Copy.ai has a chatbot interface that assists with research by answering questions and hunting down data in response to prompts.

Features: Unlike other AI content generators that require you to copy output and paste it into a third-party word processor for further work, Copy.ai has an in-line doc editor so you can polish as you go. You can also build email sequences, translate copy, and use the AI prompt library to help cut to the chase.

Pros: Real-time data collection helps improve factual accuracy and prevent copy from being out of date, and the in-line editor streamlines workflow.

Cons: Copy.ai doesn’t check generated content for plagiarism, and pricing is relatively high once you bypass max inputs for a free account.

Pricing: Basic accounts are free; Pro accounts start at $36/month.

7. Synthesia

Synthesia

Classification: AI video generation

Overview: Video production can be a pricey endeavor. Between equipment, casting, post-production editing, and time off from all the other tasks on your plate, you can easily rack up five-figure costs. Synthesia makes video creation more accessible by using AI to generate videos based on plain-text prompts. Instead of human leads, videos are led by an AI-generated avatar that also handles narration. This tool puts the power of video creation in the hands of small businesses and solopreneurs who might not otherwise be able to share pro-level explainer videos or support their blogs with advanced visual aids.

Features: There are over 140 stock avatars and 120-plus languages available to help you speak to your core audience. Use customization options to dial in your branding and the 60-plus video templates to jump-start “filming” if you feel stuck.

Pros: All the plug-in-play type features make it easy for total newbies to get up and running quickly.

Cons: The editing process takes some time and practice to master, and some features (such as the number of scenes you can include) are limited, depending on your subscription level.

Pricing: Start accounts are $22/month, with an annual billing discount; Enterprise account pricing is available on request. 

8. Murf

Murf

Classification: AI voice generation platform

Overview: Murf helps you create AI voiceovers in record time, using the scripts you provide to bring life and an almost-human touch to everything from new client introduction videos to how-to guides. You can choose what type of voice you want and even which accent you prefer, matching your finished voiceover to your business or target demographic.

Murf has also solved the once-universal issue with computer-generated voiceovers: stilted, robotic speech. Use the built-in editing feature to eliminate strange pauses, and switch up vocal emphasis so your end product is less William Shatner and more relatable for the average customer.

Features: Text-to-speech input creates voiceovers from written content; multilingual support increases diversity; and AI cloning can even mimic inflections that indicate emotions.

Pros: If you can write something (or have someone write it for you), you can create a voiceover using Murf.

Cons: Editing is possible but requires oversight by someone who understands speech patterns and knows how to achieve a more natural result.

Pricing: Basic accounts are free; paid accounts with additional features and support start at $19/month.

9. Canva

canva

Classification: AI image generation and graphic design

Overview: What-you-see-is-what-you-get (WYSIWYG) editors changed how the average person created, organized, and published blogs, and now the same tech is revolutionizing image and graphic generation. You don’t have to be a graphic designer to use Canva — the knowledge and taste level are already there. No-code editors offer multiple menus of design elements, along with templates that act as a foundation for almost any type of imaging possible. Create business cards, presentations, posters, videos, social media posts, whiteboards, and animations — as soon as you catch up, Canva will have something new to announce.

Features: Canva has stacked the deck with features such as a huge library of free stock photos, graphics, design elements, fonts, and templates galore. You can export in a variety of formats, and there’s a built-in sharing mode to get finished designs up ASAP.

Pros: It’s useful for everyone from complete newbies to design pros, as templates can stand alone or be tweaked down to the tiniest details.

Cons: Many of the best graphics, fonts, etc., are only available via a paid subscription.

Pricing: Basic accounts are free. Canva Pro is $14.99/month, and Canva for Teams of five people costs $29.99/month. 

10. Podcastle

Podcastle

Classification: Blog-to-podcast conversion

Overview: Approximately 42% of Americans age 12 and up say they’ve listened to at least one podcast in the past month. Podcast formatting is increasingly popular, and Podcastle is helping content creators and businesses step up to the plate, thanks to software that turns blogs into podcast-ready scripts. The technology also works to create audiobooks and other audio-based content. You can also do the creation process in reverse and turn your existing podcasts into blogs. It’s a win-win situation that multiplies functionality.

Features: The platform provides studio-level sound without studio equipment, plus there’s an audio editor you can use to enhance tone, edit recordings, and remove background noise.  The AI tech makes it possible to create digital copies of your voice.

Pros: You can go from text to voice and back again using one utility, and there are a lot of customization options up for grabs.

Cons: The platform is still a bit clunky. But updates keep coming, and the interface should be more user-friendly soon.

Pricing: Basic membership is free for a single creator; multi-creator subscriptions start at $11.99/month per creator; and Pro-level subscriptions cost $23.99/month per creator. 

Top 4 AI Content Creation Tools – Bonus SEO List

AI is also storming the SEO castle, and these tools can help you conquer the SERPs without scouring content for keyword placement manually — and really, who wants to do that?

1. Semrush

semrush

Overview: Semrush is all about SEO, with a slate of 55-plus tools on hand so you can optimize content from every possible angle. While basic keyword tools just look at phrases you need to include, Semrush takes a much wider view. Content marketing, PPC, competitor research, and social media marketing — you can do it all with Semrush.

With Semrush, you have a market research tool that also does SEO, making you more competitive and eliminating lag time between seeing a content problem and finding a solution.

Features: Use the AI-driven site auditor to pinpoint gaps in your SEO strategy, then act on the bot’s recommendations. The keyword magic tool rates short- and long-tail keywords by search volume and difficulty.

Pros: So many utilities, so little time! Semrush does a lot, and much of it is available for free.

Cons: Higher plans can get pricey, and with many functions on tap, those new to SEO could get confused.

Pricing: Basic searches are free; paid plans start at $129.95/month and go up to $499.95/month for large agency and enterprise accounts. 

2. SurferSEO

Surfer SEO

Overview: SurferSEO’s main strength is in content optimization. It uses data-driven insights to create suggestions users rely on to improve their on-page SEO. The goal is to improve visibility and SERP rankings based on the targeted keywords, current search engine algorithms, and lengthy competitor analysis. AI can see patterns the average human won’t notice, increasing the likelihood that SurferSEO’s recommendations can give you a competitive edge and improve your ranking more than you’d be able to achieve on your own.

Features: SurferSEO has its own on-platform content editor, plus analytics tools that track performance and generate reports. It also has a robust resource library, including tutorials, to help you get the most out of your subscription.

Pros: Multiple integrations increase utility, and it has a user-friendly interface that minimizes the scare factor for newbies.

Cons: SurferSEO’s basic plans have limited functionality, and higher plans are expensive. There’s also a learning curve, and those new to SEO may have to dedicate time to reading guides and familiarizing themselves with the platform.

Pricing: Essential AI plans start at $119/month; Advanced AI costs $239/month; and full Surfer AI power requires a Max AI account for $419/month.

3. Diib

Diib

Overview: Diib is like a scaled-down version of SurferSEO and Semrush, but smaller doesn’t mean less than. In fact, Diib’s focus is one of the platform’s biggest benefits. Small businesses looking to scale can jettison the noise that comes with too many features and concentrate solely on SEO and traffic insights designed to automate SEO and promote growth.

With Diib, you get a clear growth objective you can work toward, along with alerts that let you know how you’re doing with SEO, social media, mobile conversions, and overall UX. Instead of checking up on your website 800 times a day and neglecting other tasks, Diib does it for you.

Features: Daily health scores keep your finger on the pulse of your website’s well-being. Diib’s 12-metric system ensures a holistic view of your progress, and AI-powered SEO gap checks and competitor monitoring buoy your success even further.

Pros: Diib is affordable, focused, and easy to understand, and the mostly hands-off daily operations are perfect for bootstrapped startups.

Cons: If you need a lot of extras, such as a built-in content editor or lots of templates, you’ll have to supplement Diib with another platform or tool.

Pricing: Self-service plans are free. Pro plans with unlimited access to Diib tools cost $7.99/month.

4. RankIQ

RankIQ

Overview: RankIQ is another specific SEO tool. This one only cares about blogs. The utility’s sole goal is to help businesses and enterprising individuals write blogs that rank on the first page of the SERPs. It does that by handpicking low-competition, high-traffic keywords niche by niche and generating content briefs and outlines that put those keywords to work.

Features: The software uses a call-and-response formula — you enter a keyword, and RankIQ comes back with everything you need to know. It also prepares detailed AI-generated SEO reports and checks rank regularly.

Pros: The interface is remarkably straightforward, and all you need to know going in is your original target keyword.

Cons: There are no advanced features or customization options here. It’s bare bones, and if you want help with website content or social stuff, you won’t get it from RankIQ.

Pricing: Plans start at $49/month.

Is It OK to Use AI Content Creation Tools?

AI content tools are pretty darn useful. From fueling ideation and assisting in research to creating briefs and publish-ready prose, AI plug-ins and platforms are indelibly woven into the future of writing. But, an over-reliance on these tools can lead to lower-quality content, something that can negatively impact your brand and your SERP ranking. That’s why it’s so crucial that you learn how to balance the potential of AI with frequent reminders of the importance of human oversight.

There are legal and ethical considerations, too. It’s your responsibility to ensure everything you publish and put your name on complies with copyright laws and ethical standards. Saying “AI did it” won’t fly.

The Future of AI Tools and Revolutionary Content

From increasing efficiency and offering new insights to giving professional assists that would otherwise cost companies tens of thousands of dollars a year, these platforms are stepping up to make life easier and content better. In many ways, AI content-creation tools are the wingmen we need at a price we can (usually) afford. It enhances our creativity, improves our outcomes, and puts voice and image creation in the hands of people who have never held a microphone or video camera. It’s magical — but even an enchanted bunny needs a person around to pull it out of the hat.

As you scale your business, keep experimenting. But always think of and treat AI as an enhancement, not a totally hands-off alternative to people-first processes.

The post Top 10 AI Content Creation Tools appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Crafting Content That Counts: Inside the Content Production Process https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-production-mastery/ Tue, 06 Feb 2024 11:52:32 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=37069 Let’s face it: Creating and publishing outstanding content on your own is next to impossible. Thankfully, most businesses use a team — but with teams comes scale, and with scale comes bottlenecks, inefficiencies, and ineffectiveness.  Gone are the days of just winging it. Today’s cluttered blog landscape and the developing metaverse of tech and talk […]

The post Crafting Content That Counts: Inside the Content Production Process appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Let’s face it: Creating and publishing outstanding content on your own is next to impossible. Thankfully, most businesses use a team — but with teams comes scale, and with scale comes bottlenecks, inefficiencies, and ineffectiveness. 

Gone are the days of just winging it. Today’s cluttered blog landscape and the developing metaverse of tech and talk mean spontaneous posting just isn’t enough to get your brand noticed. That’s why it’s so important to understand what makes a strong content production process.

See how infusing every step of your content strategy with a triple-optimization approach (SEO, reader engagement, and business goals) can get you where you need to go.

What Is Content Production and How Does It Connect to Your Digital Marketing Strategy?

Content production is a comprehensive process and includes planning, creating, refining, and publishing content to meet your business objectives. This is so much more than dashing off a blog post and pushing it through your WordPress dashboard.

Properly producing effective and on-brand content requires equal parts art and science. The artsy end of things comes when your writer crafts a pithy turn of phrase or your graphics team creates a memorable infographic. The science portion of the process involves things like keyword research, evaluation of potential distribution channels, and analytics review.

All these components feed into and become one with your digital marketing strategy. Think about how you choose to spend time on and funnel resources into:

  • Audience engagement
  • Brand awareness
  • Search engine optimization
  • Lead generation
  • Social media presence
  • Email marketing
  • Analytics and iteration
  • Consumer education

Lay the proper foundation; tick all the boxes, and visibility and audience reach will soar. Skip steps or engage in random marketing — think paying freelancers for content without a brief or review process — and you might as well convert your marketing budget into dollar bills, throw the pile into gale-force winds, and try to get your stack back in place. 

content production

The Process of Content Production: Strategies for Guaranteed Results

We should preface: There are no guarantees in content or marketing overall. But there are ways you can construct your content production process to increase your chances of success. For your content to be a hit, you should pay attention to every stage of the process and understand the true goal for each phase. 

Hint: Too much of what should happen early in the process is often left to writers. 

1. Initial strategy/keyword research/analysis

This is where you establish the initial whos, whats, and whys of content creation.

  • Why are you producing content in the first place?
  • What business goals are you trying to achieve with content? 
  • Who is the content for?
  • What does that audience need or want?
  • What are your competitors doing better than you? 
  • What are your competitors not doing well?

Keyword research, market research, and market trend analysis can aid your search for those answers. The goal is to understand what your competitors are up to and how your target audience behaves to better fuel your strategy.

2. Ideation

Brainstorm unique and competitive ideas that address the keywords and their respective search intent. Every concept should build on the research in step one and answer those whos, whats, and whys.

3. Pre-production

Pre-production is like planning for the plan. What kind of timeline are you thinking, and what outside influences (an upcoming product launch date, for instance) impact your decisions?

During this phase, create content briefs and infographic templates, conduct interviews, or send out surveys that will become part of the content created down the line. Don’t leave the opinions and insights captured in your content to chance here; determine what they’ll be before moving onto the next phase.

4. Writing

Now, the content briefs, resources, and instructions land in the hands of talented freelancers or your in-house writing team, and the actual writing begins.

5. Editing

Fully drafted content is sent to editors, who review everything for clarity, coherence, grammar, and style. This stage is not just a case of dotting an “i” here and crossing a “t” over there. Editors contextually review the content, double-checking that it aligns with brand guidelines and the messaging fits the campaign.

6. Review

Send the edited draft to anyone who needs or wants to give their input. This may include subject matter experts, peer reviews, or other decision-makers on your team. Content that’s on point moves to the next step. Everything else gets marked up and sent back for further work.

7. Design

Support written content with bespoke images, graphics, and videos. Everything should slot in well with existing branded material and be formatted for the intended distribution channels — no long-form videos for TikTok or long-winded rants for X.

8. Publishing

Send your finished, multifaceted content out into the world. Channels might include your company website, a branded blog, social media pages, email newsletters, industry publications, podcasts, or e-books.

9. Tracking/analytics

Use key performance indicators to track how your content is doing and whether you’re meeting your brand’s goals. Metrics such as page views, conversion rates, social shares, and post likes and comments can give you insight into what’s working well and where you could improve. Be sure the primary metric you track for each asset aligns with the reason you created the content in the first place. 

10. Content refresh

Update content that has grown stale or isn’t performing as you’d hoped by adding insights, recent developments in the topic, and updated statistics. At this stage, you should also ensure that the content still aligns with the search intent of your primary keywords. 

Joe Pulizzi's quote

Best Practices for SEO and Content Production

There are lots of bits and pieces that go into planning stellar content, but SEO is a big one — it’s integral in producing compelling content that ranks high in the SERPs. Best practices demand you incorporate SEO at least three times during the content production process:

  • Keyword research: During the ideation phase, spend time researching what keywords can help you achieve business goals and which best answer your target audience’s queries.
  • Search intent optimization: As your team creates content, they incorporate the keywords chosen during the ideation phase. These should address users’ questions and individual stages of the buyer’s journey. By determining the intent behind KWs, you can ensure you attract the right online traffic.
SEO best practices

Image Source: semrush.com

  • SEO analysis: After publishing your content, track and analyze key metrics that show how that content is performing. This requires looking at organic search traffic and click and conversion rates to see which KWs are effective and which may not best serve your purpose.

Working SEO into your content production process offers a range of benefits, such as improved visibility and rankings, increased organic traffic (saving money on paid ads), and advantages over the competition. But SEO is also closely tied to user experience. When you serve your research KWs properly versus simply shoving them into existing content, you give searchers valuable content that satisfies their needs and wants.

AI and Other Advanced Strategies in Content Production

Storytelling is the foundation of content production. It doesn’t matter if you’re talking about product descriptions, white papers, or press releases. The bottom line is that you’re telling a story. This is more important than ever with Google’s E-E-A-T guidelines, which favor personalization and experience. While weaving a tale is a tradition as old as time, the methods you can use to convey your message have evolved.

Artificial intelligence

Not too long ago, AI seemed like something to be feared rather than embraced, but machine learning is transforming digital marketing at a rapid pace. For content production, AI has several purposes:

  • Content personalization: Use AI to get to know your core audience’s behavioral patterns and preferences. Algorithms can review massive data sets and find patterns in record time, efficiently informing your strategy.
  • Content optimization: Tools that oversee A/B testing and analyze content can help evaluate context, sentiment, and technical SEO needs.
  • Predictive analytics: Knowing what lies ahead can help you stay ahead of the curve. AI-powered predictive analytics look at future trends and expected content performance to see what audiences might love tomorrow as well as today.
  • Content creation: You can use AI to create outlines, brainstorm topic clusters, and even write actual content — as long as there’s always human oversight and final review processes in place.
  • Content distribution: Figure out where to distribute your content and use AI scheduling tools to push out social posts and other assets when they’ll have the most impact.

User-generated content

User-generated content is all the content created by fans or followers of your brand. Testimonials, hashtag campaigns, social media posts, case studies, and even comments on blogs or social profiles are all types of UGC that can help create a more authentic content experience.

UGC is a win-win proposal. You save money on paid content creation and take advantage of social proof. Consider that, out of 500-plus surveyed marketers, 92% reported increased brand awareness due to UGC. 

In recent years, Formula 1’s racing team, Mclaren, has encouraged fans to use the hashtag “FansLikeNoOther” to increase brand awareness.

#FansLikeNoOther

Top Tools and Resources for Effective Content Production

You can use top-rated tools and platforms to help guide and streamline the content production process. Here are some of our favorites.

  • Content management systems facilitate content creation, modification, and overall management. They’re primarily used to manage website content, as seen with sites like WordPress and Squarespace. Some, like Shopify, have additional utilities to facilitate running an online store or creating a digital portfolio.content production tools
  • SEO tools: Google Keyword Planner and Ahrefs are two of the biggest SEO tools in the marketplace. They help brands identify relevant keywords and provide in-depth analysis of goodies like backlink potential and competitor strategies.
  • Analytics platforms: Master business intelligence’s nuances with platforms designed to discover and analyze data and provide actionable insights. With tools like Google Analytics, Semrush, and HubSpot, you can make data-driven decisions that fuel your overall digital marketing strategy.
  • AI-driven technology: AI content creation tools focusing on the written word are everywhere these days, with sites like OwlyWriter AI and ChatGPT making major waves. But there are also tools for creating AI graphics (Midjourney), recording and editing podcasts (Podcastle), and building competitive content strategies (Crayon).
  • Project management: Make no mistake, scattered communication and a lack of centralization can bring a robust content production team to its knees. Look for tools that support the collaborative process that content production has to be. Tools like Trello, Asana, monday.com, and Basecamp should fit the bill here. 

Key Challenges and Solutions in Content Production

Even experienced content production specialists run into hurdles from time to time, and for newbies, content creation can be a minefield. Understanding common challenges and approaching them armed with solutions can mean the difference between achieving success or stumbling.

  • Maintaining content quality: When you start to generate more content or branch out from your initial content type or topics, it’s easy to watch quality sink as you just focus on getting it out there. It’s important to post consistently and stay visible, but if that means you start churning out content that lacks value and authority, the tradeoff isn’t worth it.
  • Scaling production: Companies often experience temporary surges in production needs, such as wanting to populate a new blog in under a month or needing tons of local SEO service pages lumped into a one-off order. Other brands want to rapidly scale from a couple of pieces of content a week to a couple dozen. That’s hard to accomplish when relying solely on in-house staff.

These concerns can be mitigated — if not eliminated — by outsourcing content creation. At Crowd Content, we funnel our resources into building vetted, experienced networks of writers, editors, and subject matter experts who know how to generate high-quality content. With a pool of talent already in place and a three-step quality assurance process on tap, you can get a single piece of content or 1,000 product descriptions at a time, all while preserving quality.

The Role of Visuals and Multimedia Content in Content Production

The word “content” is often tied to text-based assets, but content production encompasses visual elements and multimedia creations. A whopping 91% of consumers prefer viewing visual content over something written. 

Incorporating so-called visual aids such as videos, infographics, images, and interactive elements into your content — or as the content itself — can make content more appealing. It may also make the things you publish more memorable and more desirable for consumers to share.

And while infographics, videos, and tables do take some effort to create, images that illustrate, entertain, and break up lengthy articles are now merely a few keystrokes away. 

role of visuals

Future Trends in Content Production

As we tiptoe further into the year, expect the landscape of content production to change. Some shifts may feel small, like shifting consumer behavior that hints at more significant changes in years to come. Other trends are poised to smack into industry norms hard enough to make the industry quake.

Take Google’s Search Generative Experience, for example. This feature, unveiled by Google in 2023, uses the power of AI to give searchers insight into their topic of interest without the need to repeatedly click on links in the SERPs. The risks and opportunities presented by this extension of Google’s search ecosystem aren’t yet known. Still, companies will have to adapt to more zero-click search and fight to be featured and preserve organic traffic.

Content Production Today, Tomorrow, and Beyond 2024

Crowd Content’s content creation services lead the industry with a pool of content managers, writers, SMEs, and editors who are as talented as they are committed to all things content. 

While there’s no such thing as a turnkey content production process, getting to know the top tools, strategies, and trends can undoubtedly make it easier to produce content that resonates. Given the importance of crazy-good content in digital marketing, it’s more important than ever that you get expert guidance and ultimately produce content that makes you — and your audience — proud.

The post Crafting Content That Counts: Inside the Content Production Process appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Parallelism Demystified: A User-Friendly Approach to Effective Writing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/what-is-parallelism/ Tue, 23 Jan 2024 13:55:45 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=36959 Key Takeaways: The rules of parallelism in writing offer a trusty guide that brings order to your words. It’s about making sure similar ideas, elements, or parts of speech come together harmoniously. By embracing parallelism, you can craft sentences and lists that make your message clear. Defining Parallelism Parallelism is a rhetorical device that balances […]

The post Parallelism Demystified: A User-Friendly Approach to Effective Writing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Key Takeaways:
  • Parallelism is a tool that brings order, clarity, and rhythm to your writing.
  • It involves aligning similar ideas, elements, or parts of speech in a balanced way.
  • Common parallelism pitfalls include mixing parts of speech and creating nonparallel lists.
  • Parallelism errors can be corrected by ensuring similar elements share the same grammatical structure.
  • Parallelism is a straightforward concept that can improve anyone’s writing.

The rules of parallelism in writing offer a trusty guide that brings order to your words. It’s about making sure similar ideas, elements, or parts of speech come together harmoniously. By embracing parallelism, you can craft sentences and lists that make your message clear.

Defining Parallelism

Parallelism is a rhetorical device that balances parts of a sentence or a series of sentences. The device is commonly used in various aspects of language, including sentence structure, lists, comparisons, and more.

To create parallelism, use similar grammatical structures or parts of speech for elements that perform the same function.

Why Parallelism in Writing Matters

Parallelism helps structure information in a way that makes it easier for readers or listeners to understand and process. Here’s why parallelism is important for comprehensible writing:

  • Consistency: Parallelism ensures you present similar ideas or elements consistently. 
  • Easy processing: When you write information with a parallel structure, the brain can process it more efficiently. 
  • Reduced ambiguity: Without parallelism, sentences may become ambiguous or confusing. 
  • Enhanced emphasis: Parallelism as a literary device can emphasize specific ideas or elements. 
  • Rhythm and balance: Parallelism adds rhythm and balance to sentences, enhancing a piece’s readability.

Examples of Parallelism

  • Nouns: She enjoys reading, swimming, and hiking.
  • Verbs: He runs, swims, and cycles.
  • Prepositional phrases: He is interested in sports, music, and art.
  • Infinitive phrases: Her goals are to learn, to grow, and to succeed.
  • Clauses: She is both intelligent and hardworking.

Common Parallelism Pitfalls

Common parallelism pitfalls include mixing different parts of speech, creating nonparallel lists, and misaligning elements used in comparisons. Mixing parts of speech within parallel structures can be confusing, such as “She enjoys skiing, reading books, and to take long walks,” where gerunds (“skiing” and “reading books”) clash with the infinitive (“to take long walks”). 

Nonparallel lists lack uniformity in grammatical structure, such as “He’s a great husband, a loving father, and cooks deliciously,” where “cooks deliciously” differs from the other elements. By changing the final characteristic to “an amazing chef,” the list becomes parallel.

Fixing Parallelism Errors

Identifying and correcting parallelism errors in your writing is crucial to avoid confusion or awkwardness in your writing. To address these issues, you should follow a systematic approach.

  • Carefully read your text, paying attention to sentences that might exhibit parallelism problems. Keep an eye out for conjunctions such as “and,” “or,” “but,” and “not only…but also,” which often signal the need for parallelism.
  • Focus on ensuring similar elements within the sentence or list share the same grammatical structure. Common areas to check include nouns, verbs, adjectives, adverbs, and prepositional phrases. 
  • Proofread your text to confirm you’ve successfully addressed all parallelism errors.

Parallelism in Literature and Rhetoric

Parallelism plays a vital role in rhetoric and literature by enhancing the persuasive impact of speeches and the aesthetic quality of written works. It serves as a powerful rhetorical device, emphasizing key ideas through patterns in language. 

Emphasis and Repetition

In Martin Luther King Jr.’s “I Have a Dream” speech, he famously used parallelism with the phrase, “I have a dream that my four little children will one day live in a nation where they will not be judged by the color of their skin but by the content of their character.” The repetition of “I have a dream” also reinforces the central theme of the speech and makes it memorable.

Clarity and Symmetry

In Abraham Lincoln’s Gettysburg Address, the opening phrase follows a parallel structure to  creates a sense of balance and clarity — “Four score and seven years ago our fathers brought forth on this continent a new nation, conceived in Liberty, and dedicated to the proposition that all men are created equal.” 

Rhythmic Flow

In Winston Churchill’s famous wartime speech, he said, “We shall fight on the beaches, we shall fight on the landing grounds, we shall fight in the fields and in the streets…” The repetition of “we shall fight” emphasizes resolve and adds a powerful cadence to the speech.

Beyond Sentences: Parallelism in Ideas

Parallelism isn’t just for sentences; it’s a tool that keeps your writing in sync, whether you’re crafting a paragraph or weaving a whole narrative. It ensures your ideas and themes flow smoothly, making your message clear and engaging for readers. So, whether you’re writing an essay, a heartwarming story, or a lively article, parallelism ensures your piece provides a welcoming reading experience.

Common Misconceptions and Myths

Myth: Parallelism is about lists.

Reality: Parallelism can appear in comparisons, sentences, paragraphs, and even entire articles.

Myth: Parallelism is reserved for those fancy, formal pieces of writing.

Reality: It’s a versatile tool that can jazz up everyday conversations, emails, and social media posts. 

The Importance of Mastering Parallelism in Writing

Mastering parallelism can level up your writing and make it more digestible for readers. Don’t be fooled into thinking it’s overly complex — parallelism is a straightforward concept that anyone can master. So, keep practicing, and let parallelism elevate your writing.

The post Parallelism Demystified: A User-Friendly Approach to Effective Writing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
A Marketer’s Guide to Exploring Effective Content Distribution Channels https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/a-marketers-guide-to-exploring-effective-content-distribution-channels/ Mon, 22 Jan 2024 10:51:43 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=36910 Your customers are here, there, and everywhere, scrolling social media, searching Google, and shopping on mobile apps. As a marketer, you have more opportunities than ever to engage audiences, but the trick is to deliver your messages on the content distribution channels they most frequently use.  This guide offers clarity around the content channels you […]

The post A Marketer’s Guide to Exploring Effective Content Distribution Channels appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Your customers are here, there, and everywhere, scrolling social media, searching Google, and shopping on mobile apps. As a marketer, you have more opportunities than ever to engage audiences, but the trick is to deliver your messages on the content distribution channels they most frequently use. 

This guide offers clarity around the content channels you can choose from, with examples of how other brands are leveraging these platforms. We’ll explore how to choose channels to share your content and ways to track performance to build a robust brand presence. To wrap up, we’ll peek into the crystal ball to see what the future of content distribution might look like.

The Essence of Content Distribution Channels

If you’re producing high-quality content, you’re on your way to building brand awareness, nurturing leads, and closing sales. However, you still need to nail down your distribution strategy to get that content in front of potential customers. 

If you feel it’s hard to find and connect with your audience, you’re not alone — there’s a lot of competition for their attention. Consider what happens in a single minute on the internet:

  • Emails sent: 241 million
  • Terms searched on Google: 6.3 million
  • WhatsApp messages sent: 41.6 million
  • Facebook posts liked: 4.0 million
  • X (Twitter) posts sent: 360,000
  • Years of streaming content watched: 43
  • Global hours spent online: 25.1 million

With all this digital commotion, taking a measured approach to content distribution helps cut through the noise. By assessing the effectiveness of potential channels, you should come closer to your goals.

As you continue through this guide, remember: Content channels overlap. Your social profiles send traffic to your blog; your website promotes your latest posts, and paid ads funnel traffic to your landing pages. Your content distribution strategy needs to work cohesively to engage customers and guide them through your marketing funnel.

Types of Content Distribution Channels

Content distribution channels are the various platforms and media you use to promote and share content with your target audiences. They’re divided into three categories: owned, earned, and paid. 

1. Owned channels

Owned content distribution channels are properties you manage or control. You can distribute content on your schedule and customize it to suit your branding and messaging goals. Some examples of owned channels include:

Websites

A website is the foundation of your digital presence, containing official information about your company’s products and services and generating and converting leads. Visitors from search engines, social media platforms, paid ads, and newsletters often land on your website.

Since you have autonomy over user experience and functionality, you can publish an array of web content and get creative with engagement tools.

Blogs

Blogs are an extension of your website. By delivering helpful content to your audience, blogs position your business as an authority in your field. You have the flexibility to plan and distribute content for different audiences and stages of the buyer’s journey. 

IBM, for example, has a comprehensive blog with topic clusters that demonstrate their depth of knowledge. Users can navigate to subjects such as artificial intelligence, security and identity, and business automation. 

highlights-by-topic-1

Social media accounts

Your social media accounts let you connect with online customers wherever they hang out. Even if they don’t follow you, they can discover you through a hashtag. To leverage social channels effectively, you’ll need an in-depth understanding of which platforms your audience uses.

You can use social media to tease content on your blog or deliver content on the platform. Lululemon’s Instagram reel, for example, promotes a New York pop-up event.

Lululemon

Newsletters

Newsletters let you reach your customers directly in their inbox. You can set your distribution frequency and customize the content of your mailings to link to blog posts, promote new products, and offer discounts.

The beauty of newsletters is you can segment recipients by audience, personalizing content based on customer demographics, interests, and behaviors. Want to reach out to customers who haven’t purchased in a while? Tailor content based on what they ordered previously to reignite their interest.

At Crowd Content, we opt for both written and video newsletters. 

Crowd Content's written and video newsletters

Consumer-facing apps

Customers reach for mobile apps when shopping and ordering food, but forward-thinking brands are using them to keep audiences engaged.

Check out Nike’s group of mobile apps, focused on interests such as shopping, workouts, running, and new product drops. Nike Training Club, for example, is dedicated to wellness and distributes content such as yoga videos and healthy eating tips. 

Nike-Training-Club

2. Earned channels

Earned or shared channels are organic, unpaid avenues owned by third parties. Snagging a mention on these channels can give you exposure to a wider audience, but you do have to earn the opportunity by:

  • Generating interest or loyalty in your brand, which inspires users to recommend or promote your company
  • Demonstrating credibility so a third party feels confident associating with your business

Media coverage

A highly coveted earned distribution channel is media coverage. A profile in a reputable publication or industry blog can amplify your brand and send users flowing to your website. Audiences view these channels as especially trustworthy because you can’t control your placement or pay for it.

It might be hard to land a mention on a site like Wirecutter or authoritative sources for your industry, but you can sometimes coax similar results through press releases and some savvy PR. Just make sure you have a newsworthy reason for reaching out. 

BrightLocal publishes data-filled reports that are frequently cited. Shout About Us published an entire article summarizing one of their reports, providing BrightLocal with unpaid promotion and authority-building backlinks.

BrightLocal

Guest blogging

With guest blogging, you contribute content to third-party sites. This practice is a win-win for both sides. You’re introducing your brand to potential new customers, and the partnering site benefits from your expertise and content. Make sure the site you’re contributing to has the same target audience as your brand, and make the most of the opportunity with exceptional content to emphasize your credibility.

Littledata, an e-commerce data platform, authored a guest article on Smile.io, a loyalty app. Both businesses target online retailers. The piece delivers useful information to readers, but more importantly, it highlights the Littledata brand with links to Littledata’s X account, white paper landing page, and free GA4 order checker tool. 

a guest article on Smile.io

User-generated content

User-generated content (UGC) is influential word-of-mouth information created by your customers and fans. UGC comes in many forms: images of new purchases, fun unboxing videos, beauty product tutorials, reviews, and testimonials. UGC carries significant weight with audiences because it tends to feel genuine.

Instagram user charlesjpgs tagged RockCreek Seafood & Spirits during a recent dining experience, providing the restaurant with potential exposure to nearly 50,000 followers. On a larger scale, GoPro promotes UGC by giving their users a tool to share their video adventures to social media. 

Rock Creek

Keep an eye on social media review sites for user-generated content around your brand, and interact with posts by liking, sharing, and commenting. It helps if you’ve built a community of engaged followers — you can create your own hashtag and invite customers to share their experiences. 

3. Paid channels

Paid content channels help you tap into a targeted audience, providing significant exposure to customers you don’t normally reach through other channels. 

Digital advertising

Digital ads are also known as pay-per-click (PPC) because you only pay when someone clicks the link. They’re found throughout the internet in different forms:

  • Search engine marketing ads appear on search results pages above the organic snippets.
  • Social media ads appear in the feeds of users who match the ad’s target audience.
  • Display ads include banners and other clickable ads on websites and apps.

You can zero in on the audience you want to reach based on their demographics, location, device, interests, search terms, and other targeting options. Customize your ads with text, images, or video, and support them with a well-crafted landing page to convert clicks.

Influencer partnerships

Influencers have an audience of followers who look to them for niche recommendations. These content creators can give your brand a sizable boost by talking about or using your product, offering discount codes to their followers, or running contests and giveaways. If their audience matches your target demographic, you’ve got an opportunity to connect with a fresh segment of customers.

Influencers typically create content in their own style for authenticity. KitchenAid’s most high-profile partnership may be with actor Jennifer Garner, who uses the mixer to whip up recipes in her “Pretend Cooking Show” posts. However, the brand has many online ambassadors promoting its products.

JenniferGarner

Sponsored content

With sponsored content, you pay a third-party site to distribute your content to their audience. It’s similar in concept to guest blogging, but you’re paying for the exposure.

Software company Accelo has a sponsored post on the Search Engine Journal site about mitigating agency churn. It’s created in the form of a blog post, delivering expertise on a topic while also promoting their client work management platform. The piece ends with a link to a free trial to generate leads. Search Engine Journal does identify sponsored posts to distinguish them from their regular content.

Accelo

Evaluating Content Distribution Channels

So many channels, so little time. How do you choose between them? To begin, each type of channel has advantages and limitations that you’ll have to weigh:

  • Earned channels carry a lot of credibility but can be hard to secure. You can work toward these organic endorsements by cultivating relationships, but don’t rely on them solely for promoting your brand.
  • Paid channels generate quick results, helping you reach a specific demographic in a short period. But on the flip side, they can be costly to maintain long-term and you lose visibility when ads stop running. 
  • Owned channels give you complete control over messaging, style, and branding, and you can update content whenever you wish. These properties help you build a strong online presence but take time and resources to build and manage.

The channel, combination of channels, and investment for each channel you choose greatly impacts the results you’ll get. Here’s where research, trial, analytics, and adjustments come into play. 

Perform due diligence 

Picking content distribution channels is a bit like matchmaking: You’ve got to make sure the channel is compatible with your goals and target audience. What you shouldn’t do is randomly push out content on different channels in the hopes that somewhere, something clicks. 

You can make purposeful and informed decisions when you:

  • Research your audience: Conduct market research to understand where your target customers go for information and their preferences for consuming content. If they’re not on Pinterest, you don’t need to be either.
  • Identify your business goals: Look at your short- and long-term goals. Determine which channels are best, whether you’re focused on product launches, customer acquisition, lead generation, or customer retention.
  • Review past performance: Analyze the channels you’ve used previously, and look at the costs and results. You may decide to continue distributing content on some channels or, based on audience research, move on to others. 
  • Stay competitive: What are your competitors doing? Monitor your industry to see where brands are finding their customers. If competitors are having success engaging audiences on another channel, you may want to test it out, too.
  • Optimize resources: Track data to understand the best return on investment, and adjust your strategies accordingly. We’ll explore this in more detail a little further down.

Diversify your channels

As you develop your content distribution strategy, aim to make it sustainable. If any of your channels lose traction, you should have others in place to pick up the slack. We recommend a mix of owned, earned, and paid distribution channels so you enjoy stability and growth.

“Marketers need to look at their different channels as an investment portfolio in terms of diversification and return,” suggests Carlos Meza, President and CEO of Crowd Content. “Double down on your winners, invest in other channels to mitigate risk, and make some bets on high-potential channels.”

Here are some examples of what a content channel portfolio might look like in practice:

  • Double down on your winners: Is your website making progress in generating organic search traffic? Direct more resources to the channel to accelerate growth.
  • Invest in other channels: While you’re reaping the benefits of your proven assets, strengthen other channels. You might focus on growing your newsletter mailing list to safeguard leads in case your search rankings take a hit.
  • Bet on high-potential channels: Based on your market research, test out promising new avenues for content distribution. Maybe you can check out TikTok or try your hand at digital PR. 

Avoid having all your eggs in one particular channel, as it can leave you exposed. You may be one Google algorithm update away from having your traffic, engagement, and inbound leads vanish overnight.

Carlos Meza

Measuring and Analyzing Performance

Your content distribution strategy may be sound in theory, but you can’t always predict customer behavior or the impact of external factors.

Set benchmarks so you can compare performance after specific campaigns and on a monthly, quarterly, and annual basis. Regular tracking gives you the data you need to guide decisions and refine strategies. You may want to test messaging and timing, for example, to see if any adjustments impact performance. 

Select your metrics and tools

There are many metrics you can measure, but focus on ones that deliver meaningful data. They should be tied to the content channel and the goals you’ve set so you can measure your progress. We’ve listed below some common metrics for various channels, along with tools you can use to gather insight.

Sample website metrics 

  • Organic traffic
  • Unique visitors
  • Page views
  • Time spent on page
  • Bounce rate
  • Time spent on site
  • Conversion rate (for desired actions, such as white paper downloads or free trials)

How to track website metrics: Google Analytics, Google Search Console, Semrush, Ahrefs

Sample PPC metrics

  • Impressions
  • Reach
  • Click-through rate
  • Cost per click
  • Return on investment

How to track PPC metrics: Google Ads and individual social media platforms

Sample social media metrics

  • Engagement (followers, likes, shares, comments, views)
  • Reach/impressions
  • Click-through rate
  • Conversion rate

How to track social media metrics: Analytics features on individual platforms or dashboards such as Hootsuite and Rival IQ

Sample newsletter marketing metrics

  • Open rates
  • Click-through rates
  • Conversion rates
  • Subscriber growth

How to track newsletter marketing metrics: Email marketing tools, such as HubSpot, Mailchimp, and Constant Contact

Future Trends in Content Distribution

The playing field for content distribution is ever-changing. Competition is ramping up, new channels are vying for attention, and audience preferences change. Here are some content distribution trends we’re keeping an eye on:

  • The role of content intelligence: This AI-driven technology processes existing content, behavioral data, and market research to provide in-depth audience insights. Watch for marketers to lean on content intelligence platforms to choose content types, formats, and distribution channels.
  • Data-driven personalization: There’s more data than ever to analyze, and the focus will be on harnessing information to deliver hyper-personal experiences. Marketers can use proprietary data, third-party data, and AI technologies to build a better understanding of how people move through channels. Based on these patterns, they can deliver precise content.
  • Holistic content distribution: Instead of having SEO, social media, and digital ad teams working in silos, brands will begin to unify content across touchpoints to provide a seamless experience.
  • Renewed emphasis on owned channels: With so many changes in the distribution landscape, marketers will focus on properties they have control over to ride out any rough patches. This may include strengthening brand websites as a trusted source of information, creating loyalty through memberships, and building first-party mailing lists.

Trying to balance the pieces of your content strategy? Our experts can help with your content production or distribution needs. Contact us today for a free consultation about how to maximize your content marketing to keep in step with your customers, no matter where they’re spending their time online. 

The post A Marketer’s Guide to Exploring Effective Content Distribution Channels appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
7 Advanced Keyword Research Tools for 2024 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/7-advanced-keyword-research-tools-for-2024/ Tue, 09 Jan 2024 14:00:07 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=36795 Ask a dozen digital marketers what keyword research tools they use, and you’ll probably get 12 different answers. If you’ve dabbled at all with these platforms, you’ll understand the reason for the diverse opinions. Every keyword tool has unique features to weigh and ranges wildly in terms of the depth of data available.  For your […]

The post 7 Advanced Keyword Research Tools for 2024 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Ask a dozen digital marketers what keyword research tools they use, and you’ll probably get 12 different answers. If you’ve dabbled at all with these platforms, you’ll understand the reason for the diverse opinions. Every keyword tool has unique features to weigh and ranges wildly in terms of the depth of data available. 

For your SEO strategy to have an impact, you need a reliable keyword research sidekick giving you advice on what your customers are searching for. But how do you find a tool that meets your business needs and budget with so many options on the market? Before you throw your hands up in despair, check out our list of seven keyword research tools that can help your brand climb the SERPs and stay in the search engine spotlight. 

Short List of Keyword Research Tools

In evaluating keyword tools, we considered criteria such as ease of use and available metrics. We’ll dive into the pros, cons, and intricacies of each platform to help you find a well-matched partner, but here’s a bottom-line summary: 

  1. Moz: Best overall 
  2. Semrush: Best for user intent analysis
  3. Ahrefs: Best for keyword tracking and analysis
  4. QuestionDB: Best for long-tail keywords
  5. Google Keyword Planner: Best for paid advertising keywords
  6. SECockpit: Best for competitive keyword analysis 
  7. TopicRanker: Best for finding competitor weaknesses

The Science Behind Keyword Research

Each tool takes a unique approach to collecting and processing data, which is why you’ll find variations when looking at metrics such as search volume, difficulty, and page authority.

The tools extract data across the web, scraping sources such as:

  • Search engine results pages
  • Autocomplete suggestions
  • Google’s related searches and People Also Ask
  • Google Keyword Planner and Google Trends
  • Social networking sites and online forums
  • Clickstream data tracking user movements across the internet

Some also work backward from search results, inspecting top-ranked pages for content, keyword frequency, and backlinks. Artificial intelligence helps interpret this information, pinpointing patterns that can help you make up ground in the rankings. 

Each platform then waves its respective algorithm wand, magically turning big data into the bite-size metrics you see on your screen. Because each tool uses unique data sources and processes, they end up with different results. 

That’s why it’s best to compare keywords within a tool and not across platforms. You wouldn’t look at metrics for “picture frames” on Ahrefs and “wall art” on Semrush to choose between the two keywords. You can, however, feel confident that comparisons run within a single platform are accurate. 

Andrei Prakharevich compared search volume ranges for keywords on four tools. While each reported a different number, they all concluded “mountain bikes” was the most popular and “gravel bikes” the least, which is key in deciding which keyword to target.

Search volume ranges

Essential Features for Keyword Research Tools

Let’s put together our keyword tool wish list. Ideally, you want a large database to draw keyword ideas from and reliable metrics so you can decide which keywords to pursue.

Some essential features include:

  • Keyword suggestions: A robust tool provides a variety of keyword ideas. Most draw from Google, but some collect data from other search engines, YouTube, and Amazon. If your business is international in nature, look for a platform that lets you query by language and geographic region.
  • Search volume: This metric is nonnegotiable. Search volume tells you the number of times a keyword is searched for in a specific period, which helps assess the keyword’s popularity. It’s not worth your time to try ranking for keywords that aren’t in demand. 
  • Keyword difficulty: This metric reflects how hard it is to land in the top positions for a keyword, based on the strength of the pages currently ranking. Keywords with low to medium difficulty are easier to rank for and can improve your visibility while you tackle more competitive search terms.
  • Search intent: Your content must meet the expectations of the user to rank. Some tools tell you whether a keyword’s search intent is navigational, commercial, informational, or transactional. This helps you formulate content matched to the buyer’s journey. 
  • Competitor analysis: Some tools help you size up the competition, providing insight into how your competitors are ranking and the backlinks they’ve built. You can compare competitor keywords with your own to ensure you don’t miss out on opportunities. 
  • Website authority: This metric is also known as domain authority, domain rating, or authority score, depending on the tool you use. It reflects the overall credibility of a website based on factors such as backlinks. Pages with high authority are often hard to dislodge out of the top spots.

You’ll find platforms with an array of other features such as site audits, on-page SEO recommendations, and content creation tools. These are all useful for building well-rounded marketing strategies, but they’re outside of the scope of this guide.

7 Advanced Keyword Research Tools for 2024

Below, we’ve compiled some keyword research tools we feel are worth your time, whether you’re marketing for a small startup or enterprise. Our round-up includes free and paid platforms, from basic to comprehensive solutions. You might find a couple of free tools that meet your needs or decide to invest in a larger, all-in-one platform. Take advantage of free trials and try the tools on for size.

1.  Moz Keyword Explorer

Best Overall

Intro to the Tool

Moz’s Keyword Explorer presents a variety of metrics in a user-friendly format. We especially like its proprietary Priority Score, which helps you find keyword opportunities without bogging you down in the numbers. Keyword Explorer is free but limited in scope, and subscription services are available. A paid subscription also offers access to rank tracking, site crawls, on-page optimization, link research, and custom reports.

Moz's Keyword Explorer

Pros and Cons

Advantages:

  • Multiple options for exploring keywords, including searching by URL or keyword
  • Ability to research keywords by region
  • Ability to create and save lists for categorizing and comparing keywords
  • Detailed insight into the top-ranking pages through the SERP Analysis
  • Competitive analysis to see what keywords your competitors rank for 
  • Data from Google, Bing, and Yahoo
Competitor overlap

Disadvantages:

  • Provides only a range for monthly search volume
  • Requires an account to access the free tool
  • Limited queries in the free tool
  • Doesn’t provide information on keyword trends
Keyword explorer

Special Features Highlight

If you often feel like you’re drowning in data when analyzing keywords, Moz throws you a lifeline. The platform takes factors such as search volume, keyword difficulty, and opportunity into consideration and wraps them up as a Priority Score. This metric is a simple way to identify keywords with good potential for ranking. Rand Fishkin explained that a Priority Score above 80 indicates high demand, moderate difficulty, and not too many SERP features detracting from the organic search results. Lower scores have some combination of these factors.

Pricing

  • Free for 10 keyword queries
  • Monthly subscriptions range from $99 to $599 

What We’ve Heard

“Great at everything with outstanding capabilities that made us organically visible on search engines.”

— Reviewer on Gartner Peer Insights

Use Cases and Best Practices

To leverage Keyword Explorer effectively, begin with a few seed keywords or topics related to your products and services. Enter them one at a time into the search box and hit analyze to see an easy-to-navigate results page. 

Note the data visually presented in the top row — monthly volume, difficulty, organic CTR, and priority — you can use these to compare keywords and decide which ones to allocate resources to. To expand your keyword list, click through the keyword suggestions on the left. As you rub your hands in glee at the plethora of options, select “Add to Keyword List” to build groups of keywords. You can also check out high-performing pages for the keyword in the SERPs Analysis section.

2.  Semrush

Best for User Intent Analysis

Intro to the Tool

It’s hard to beat Semrush when it comes to breadth. The platform has more than 55 tools in its suite covering keyword research, site audits, PPC, backlinking, and website optimization — essentially, it’s an end-to-end solution for digital marketing. This comes at a cost, but you can get started with free tools, such as Keyword Magic and Keyword Overview.

Keyword magic tool

Pros and Cons

Advantages:

  • Keyword suggestions from a database of 25.3 billion keywords
  • Keyword questions, keyword variations, and related keywords
  • More than 140 geographic databases
  • Search intent behind keywords (informational, navigational, commercial, or transactional)
  • Search trends for the past 12 months
  • Metrics such as search volume, keyword difficulty, cost-per-click, and number of competing SERP features

Disadvantages:

  • Only draws from Google data
  • Only provides 10 keywords with the free tool
Long tail keywords

Special Features Highlight

Finding keywords is just the first step of the SEO puzzle. You also need insight into why someone’s using that keyword so you can develop content that addresses their needs as fully as possible. Are they trying to learn something, compare products, or find the best deal? Semrush uses an algorithm to mark up each keyword as having navigational, informational, commercial, or transactional intent. You’ll see these tags in the Search Intent column on the keyword results page. Group keywords with the same intent to help you plan content.

Special features highlights

Pricing

  • Free account with limited queries
  • 7-day free trial
  • Monthly subscriptions range from $129.95 to $499.95  

What We’ve Heard

“Semrush is the best of the best for all things keyword research, managing backlinks, and auditing the health + quality of your website.”

Capterra reviewer 

Use Cases and Best Practices

While a Semrush subscription gives you access to keyword research tools, Keyword Magic is enough for translating a seed keyword into thousands of keyword suggestions. You can sort these to find:

  • Low-competition keywords that you can quickly rank for
  • Related search terms, which are other phrases users are searching for
  • Long-tail keywords to target a niche audience that’s more likely to convert
  • Question keywords to help shape your content 

Another nifty detail is the SERP features tool. This tells you which keywords are triggering featured snippets, videos, carousels, knowledge graphs, and other attention-grabbing elements on the search results page. You can then customize your content to try to rank for these elements — or you might decide there’s too much zero-click competition and focus your efforts elsewhere.

3.  Ahrefs

Best for Keyword Tracking and Analysis

Intro to the Tool

Ahrefs is an industry leader, often grouped alongside Moz and Semrush. It provides an array of tools to optimize your search visibility, including keyword research, link building, competitor analysis, content creation, and website audits. It’s especially powerful for monitoring analytics and performance.

Ahrefs tool

Pros and Cons

Advantages

  • Pulls keyword ideas from 10 search engines
  • Provides a variety of in-depth metrics 
  • Identifies SEO issues on your site
  • Tracks keyword rankings for mobile and desktop
  • Performs backlink analysis
  • Connects to Google Search Console and archives data for easy access
Ahrefs results

Disadvantages

  • No free trial
  • Monthly subscriptions that are pricier than tools

Special Features Highlight

The Ahrefs dashboard is a powerful hub for monitoring site performance. It provides a snapshot of key metrics pulled from a variety

Ahrefs special features

of Ahrefs tools. You can keep an eagle eye on changes in your site health, domain rating, organic keywords, backlinks, and traffic. Click specific boxes to see the details behind the report and adjust your SEO strategy as needed.

Pricing

  • Monthly subscriptions range from $99 to $999 

What We’ve Heard

“If you’re serious about improving your website’s traffic and search engine rankings, Ahrefs is a tool you need in your arsenal.”

Shane Barker, Digital Marketing Consultant

Use Cases and Best Practices

To generate keyword ideas, enter your seed terms into Keywords Explorer. It pulls ideas from 10 different search engines, including Google, Bing, Yahoo, YouTube, Amazon, Baidu, and Yandex.

The results page shows you metrics for the keyword you’ve searched, including search volume, global volume, and traffic potential, which is the total organic traffic the first result gets. You’ll also get the scoop on how hard it might be to crack the top 10 spots in the SERPs, with estimates of keyword difficulty and the number of backlinks and referring domains you’ll need. From here, you can also explore matching, suggested, and autocomplete terms, as well as question keywords.

To see what your competitors are up to, navigate to the SERP Overview for insight into the top-performing pages, including the featured snippets and videos. Finally, fill in the holes in your content strategy by plugging your competitors’ sites into the Content Gap tool to see what keywords others are ranking for.

4.  QuestionDB

Best for Long-Tail Keywords

Intro to the Tool

QuestionDB takes a grassroots approach to keyword research, pulling data from online forums where users answer each other’s questions. Designed to tap into what audiences are curious about, this tool provides long-tail keywords in the form of questions.  

Pros and Cons

Advantages:

  • Generates keyword questions to help you thoroughly address a topic
  • Sources ideas from places other than search engines, providing fresh angles
  • Uses conversational-style language similar to voice search
  • Supplies keyword difficulty and competition data
  • Simple and affordable

Disadvantages:

  • Limited metrics
Question DB

Special Features Highlight

QuestionDB retrieves information from online user forums, such as Reddit. It’s like eavesdropping on how your audiences chat naturally around a topic, which aligns perfectly with the conversational style of voice and Google’s SGE.

Question keywords are long-tail phrases, which have lower search volume because they’re so specific in nature. However, they’re less competitive and can help you reach highly qualified, niche audiences with precise search intent. Use the results from QuestionDB to build topic clusters and establish expertise in a subject.

Pricing

  • Free plan (up to 60 questions and no data)
  • $15/month Solo Plan (100 searches per month)
  • $50/month Agency Plan (500 searches per month)

What We’ve Heard

“QuestionDB is a blog topic goldmine, drawing from various Q&A platforms like Reddit and Quora to deliver questions related to your keywords.”

@websearchmktg on X

Use Cases and Best Practices

To get started with QuestionDB, enter a seed keyword of up to three words. The tool will give you a list of questions and related topics to explore. For example, when we tested the tool, the search phrase “vitamin C” generated 315 questions. It also suggested topics such as “serum” and “pregnancy” to refine our query. Choosing the topic “soluble” generated another 50 highly targeted questions.

Question DB use cases

Once you’ve got your results, download them into a spreadsheet to organize keywords and plan content. General questions can be used as the core of an article, while related questions can be grouped into a single in-depth piece. You can also leverage the results to create featured snippets and FAQs.

5.  Google Keyword Planner

Best for Paid Advertising Keywords

Intro to the Tool

Keyword Planner helps advertisers choose relevant keywords and estimate their ad spend for pay-per-click campaigns. Because the data comes directly from Google, SEO specialists also leverage this tool to help drive organic traffic. Keyword Planner is limited in features compared to some third-party platforms but can uncover lucrative keywords and core themes for building topic clusters. You can find Keyword Planner in the Tools menu of your Google Ads account.

Google Ads

Pros and Cons

Advantages:

  • Free and easy to use
  • Search volume data directly from Google
  • Ability to target by device, language, and location
  • Search for keywords by entering a URL (entire site or single page)

Disadvantages:

  • Provides averages for search volumes 
  • A limited list of keyword suggestions compared to other tools
  • Only takes Google Ads into account for competition metric
Google Ads keyword planner

Special Features Highlight

While Keyword Planner doesn’t identify search intent, you can find keywords with high commercial intent. Organize the keyword results by “Top of page bid (high range).” This uncovers the keywords advertisers are willing to pay top dollar for, so chances are high that they’ll deliver lucrative traffic.

Pricing

  • Free with a Google Ads account

What We’ve Heard

“You can utilize Google Ads Keyword Planner, a free tool provided by Google Ads, as you prepare your marketing approach. With the help of this tool, you may find new keywords, come up with keyword suggestions, and launch a successful PPC campaign. This tool is useful for estimating bids as well.”

Reviewer, G2

Use Cases and Best Practices

Keyword Planner is a good starting point for discovering keywords related to your business, although you may want to combine it with another tool for more in-depth data.

For example, enter up to 10 keywords related to your products or services, separated with a comma and space. For best results:

  • Use a keyword and website.
  • Avoid using adjectives in your seed keyword, such as “affordable.”
  • Use multiple keywords or phrases if they’re related: children’s books, picture books, early readers, chapter books.

You’ll generate a list of results, which you can filter by category. If you aren’t happy with the results, click on relevant phrases to expand your search. Once you’ve selected possible keywords, head over to another tool for more precise search volume numbers or insight on keyword difficulty.

6.  SECockpit

Best for Competitor Keyword Analysis

Intro to the Tool

This robust tool provides plenty of data points to help you choose the right search phrases for your strategy. The intuitive interface makes the depth of data manageable. Keywords are presented in tables with color-coded metrics, which can be clicked on to see underlying data.

SECockpit

Pros and Cons

Advantages:

  • Data pulled from sources such as Moz and Semrush
  • Queries by location, language, and source
  • Customizable search results so you can choose the metrics you want to see
  • Web search trends and search volume from different periods
  • Comparative analysis with top 10 competitors
  • Optimized for mobile devices

Disadvantages:

  • No free tool
  • Requires an account for a trial
SECockpit pros and cons

Special Features Highlight

SECockpit provides an in-depth competitive analysis. When you search for a keyword, you’ll immediately see the top 10 pages for the keyword with data including MozRank, page authority, domain authority, and backlinks. You can delve further and run semantic searches for these pages. The tool returns a list of keywords that two or more competing domains rank for to help fill gaps in your keyword strategy.

SECockpit special features

Pricing

  • $25/month Personal Plan (10 keyword searches per day and 800 results per search)
  • $42/month Pro (50 keyword searches per day and 10,000 results per search)
  • $75/month Agency (unlimited keyword searches and 10,000 results per search)

What We’ve Heard

“SECockpit is by far the easiest, fastest, and most comprehensive and accurate keyword research tool I’ve ever used.”

Peter Sundstrom, Ultimate Marketing Strategies

Use Cases and Best Practices

Your SECockpit journey begins with a seed keyword, list of keywords, or website. You can specify language, location, and different platforms such as Google Ads, Google Suggest, Amazon Suggest, YouTube Suggest, and Google Related Search. Amazon, for example, can be a good source for high-value, transactional keywords.

Once you generate a keyword list, sort the table with the desired filters, such as search volume. SECockpit has also developed a proprietary metric called Niche Value, which weighs monthly search volume and difficulty to help you immediately see the potential of a keyword.

As you review the keywords, move them into lists and print or export them. Agencies can add their logo on the top of the report and easily provide the list to clients.

7.  TopicRanker

Best for Finding Competitor Weaknesses

Intro to the Tool

To rank in the top positions in the SERPs, you need to surpass your competitors in quality. That’s the theory behind TopicRanker, which inspects the top-ranking pages for issues such as thin content or poor loading speeds. You can then design your content to leapfrog these pages in the rankings. This platform also helps kick-start your writing with AI-powered tools for creating content briefs and first drafts.

Pros and Cons

Advantages:

  • Helps find less competitive keywords
  • Identifies weaknesses in top-ranking pages for a keyword
  • Provides content ideation

Disadvantages:

  • Must provide an email 
  • No long-tail keywords or semantic search
Topic Ranker

Special Features Highlight

Once you’ve decided to pursue a keyword you’ve found on TopicRanker, hit “Generate Content” to start the writing process. Choose from title ideas, meta descriptions, content briefs, and articles. This is helpful for those who want a leg up on the writing process.

Topic Ranker special features

Pricing

  • $9/month Starter (three reports per month with three keyword suggestions per report; no AI-assisted writing tools)
  • $59/month Basic (10 reports per month with six keyword suggestions per report)
  • $129/month Premium (30 reports per month with 12 keyword suggestions per report)

What We’ve Heard

“Hands down TopicRanker is the future of keyword research.”

Brian Dean, Backlinko

Use Cases and Best Practices

To get started with TopicRanker, enter your website and the topic you want to rank for. The tool generates a list of keywords based on issues it finds in the SERPs. As you click each keyword, you’ll see data for your site and the highest-ranking pages: load time, word count, readability, missing words in titles, and spam score. The tool also lists target benchmarks for each of these categories.

TopicRanker use cases

You can then launch the content ideation process, which puts a content brief or article draft in your hands. While these tools are a good starting point for writing, be sure to make the content your own. Add your expertise and shape it to fit your business goals and target audience. Remember, other businesses are also using these tools, so you need to find ways to add value and set your content apart from others.

Building Keyword Research Tools for In-House Use

As you can see, there’s a copious amount of data available to help develop your keyword strategy. The trick is to find the tool that gives you the information you need efficiently. It can be time-consuming to pull data from multiple sources, export it into spreadsheets, and navigate it all.

So, here’s one more hat tossed into the ring.  

If you know precisely what you need to execute your SEO strategies and your business has the resources and technical know-how, consider building your own keyword research tool aligned with your business objectives. You don’t have to start from scratch, either.

Platforms such as Ahrefs, Semrush, Moz, and Google Ads have APIs that let you tap into their data, giving you much more information than what’s available on the tools’ consumer interfaces. It’s a data gold mine. Pull backlink, keyword, traffic, and position tracking stats. Mold and shape the data to your heart’s content and present it in the format that’s most useful for you. This is how SECockpit incorporates Moz’s data into its interface.

A custom keyword tool is an investment, but in the long run, it can streamline your workflow. You can feed current data into your internal dashboards and custom reports, saving you from switching between tools and running separate tasks. In other words, spend less time pulling data from keyword tools and more time leveraging it to boost performance.

Can ChatGPT or AI Help With Keyword Research? 

Artificial intelligence has been making its presence felt across industries. ChatGPT can do a lot of things well but doesn’t have the same data as keyword tools, such as Ahrefs, Semrush, and others. However, you can strike up a conversation and ask ChatGPT to speed up keyword research in a few ways.

  • Brainstorming general keywords: Try prompts such as “What are questions someone might have about [topic]?” or “What are popular keywords related to [topic]?” ChatGPT can get overenthusiastic in its responses, so add “List only” to the end of your query to limit the result to keywords and avoid generating descriptions. You can broaden or refine the results and enter promising ones into a keyword research tool for more in-depth metrics.
  • Completing manual tasks: ChatGPT is a wizard at helping with tasks such as identifying search intent for a list of keywords or clustering keywords by topic. Simply paste in your list, and ask the tool to organize your information. You’ll have it done in a jiffy.
  • Ideating content: Content marketers are already leveraging AI to come up with titles, topics, outlines, and briefs. Content intelligence platforms powered by AI are taking this to the next level, providing customer insights and recommending topics.

AI isn’t yet ready to replace keyword research tools and human insight. Still, it’s an efficient assistant. “My educated guess for the near future of ChatGPT is that it’ll be integrated into keyword planning tools, content, and topic analysis features,” wrote Adam Tanguay in Search Engine Land. “AI-driven chatbots will become more entwined in the SEO planning landscape, not a separate workflow.”

The Future of Keyword Research

While a good keyword research tool (or two) is indispensable, there’s one thing to keep in mind. Modern SEO is shifting from a keyword-centric to a user-centric approach. Google sent us down this path with its helpful content system that prioritizes valuable and useful information.  

What does this mean? You still need a primary keyword to understand search intent, but you can spend less time fitting lists of semantic keywords into your content. Search engines have become highly skilled at understanding context and no longer rely on exact keyword matches in many cases. 

Instead, the value of keyword research is finding out what your audience wants to know about a topic and in what formats. You’re not relying on a keyword, in other words, but a theme. You need to roll up your sleeves, assess the competition, and provide the charts, videos, FAQs, or other content components that satisfy an audience’s appetite for a topic. 

Listen in as Crowd Content’s Rick Leach, and I discuss this shift from keywords to topics.

Finally, while AI tools such as ChatGPT aren’t replacing keyword research tools, we expect artificial intelligence will be increasingly integrated. And this is a good thing — the more powerful the tool, the easier it is to find that sweet spot between high-volume keywords, brand expertise, and your audience’s needs. 

Elevate Your Content Strategy

Keyword research tools come in all shapes, sizes, and prices. Your shopping list should include essential metrics such as search volume and keyword difficulty, with features such as competitive analyses and performance tracking as the icing on the cake. Whatever tools you add to your arsenal, combine them with human insight to create content that engages your readers. You can learn more tips and tactics for enriching your content strategies in our webinars with industry experts or sign up for Crowd Content’s newsletter

The post 7 Advanced Keyword Research Tools for 2024 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Does AI Content Rank in Google? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ai-content-creation/does-ai-content-rank-in-google/ Thu, 14 Dec 2023 14:52:33 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=36711 Does AI content rank in Google? Or could you torpedo consumer trust and your business’s future by taking advantage of one of the hottest tools on the internet? When ChatGPT burst into public consciousness in late November 2022, the tech seemed to draw a line in the virtual sand, separating the earlier times of content from […]

The post Does AI Content Rank in Google? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Does AI content rank in Google? Or could you torpedo consumer trust and your business’s future by taking advantage of one of the hottest tools on the internet?

When ChatGPT burst into public consciousness in late November 2022, the tech seemed to draw a line in the virtual sand, separating the earlier times of content from the robot age. But in reality, the rise of AI content has been a slow burn, and those within the content marketing industry have seen both the potential and the pitfalls on the horizon for years. The big question now isn’t just how AI text generators can be used but whether they should be used at all by anyone hoping to get (and stay) in Google’s good graces. 

One of the reasons Google has been so successful is its commitment to total world dominance. Just kidding (mostly). But really, Google dominates because it’s willing to constantly reevaluate its position on hot-button topics and what constitutes the general standard of excellence. However, changing standards can lead to an overload of confusion.

The doubt and uncertainty are real, but the key takeaway is just as potent: Combining AI with practical SEO strategies (and a heaping helping of human insight and oversight) is a recipe for success, and even Google agrees.

Does AI Content Rank in Google?

Google doesn’t penalize AI content simply for being produced by artificial intelligence. But to truly understand whether AI-generated text could affect your ranking, we have to dig a little deeper. It isn’t a yes or no answer but an analysis of how AI-generated content actually performs, what role human editorial oversight plays, and what Google’s official stance is. Because, at the end of the day, that almighty Google algorithm remains king.

The importance of EEATing

Google has confirmed (several times now) that AI-generated content gets a big, fat A-OK as long as it follows the same E-E-A-T guidelines used to evaluate content overall. In September 2023, Google updated the wording of its philosophy on valuable content, changing “helpful content written by people, for people” to “helpful content created for people.” That short edit made it clear Google was more interested in whether content delivered value — according to E-E-A-T — than in who created the content in the first place.

So, if you can use ChatGPT to generate a blog that meets Google’s standards for experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness, your content should be in line to rank well.

But there are also other factors that influence how content, AI-generated or not, ultimately lands on Google’s results pages.

SEO: Perception vs. reality and what works when you want to rank

How content is produced is only one piece of the SERP-y pie. Even if your content is strong, your SEO game has to be just as impressive, and that includes knowing the truth about search engine optimization.

Timeframes

  • Perception: SEO is a one-time-only production.
  • Reality: There’s no end to search engine optimization. Even if your AI-generated content ranks well now, you may need to tweak it in the future to answer Google algorithm updates.

Keyword stuffing

  • Perception: The more keywords you include, the better your ranking.
  • Reality: Google looks down on and penalizes articles with obvious keyword stuffing — even if it’s AI’s fault.

Links are links

  • Perception: All links feed into the algorithm and boost your content’s rank.
  • Reality: Quality is paramount. Google likes high-quality, highly relevant links from sources with proven authority.

Your content determines your ranking

  • Perception: All you need is a solid blog and decent meta tags, and your SEO is done and dusted.
  • Reality: AI content won’t get your site to rank if you aren’t paying attention to other factors, including social media, linking, and online reputation.

AI + human editorial oversight = magic

By this point, you’re hopefully convinced that AI text generators can be useful, but they can’t be left to operate completely independently. After all, the robot overlords don’t need to get it in their heads that we humans are totally superfluous, right? But how does that human oversight manifest?

In most cases, you’ll use yourself or other members of your human team in three ways:

  • Editorial assistance: Use human editors to refine AI-generated content briefs, edit content drafts, and otherwise provide insight and polish that isn’t possible with 100% reliance on technology.
  • Subject matter experts (SMEs): AI content-generating programs rely on existing data points and can only respond depending on what they know and when that data was input. This could lead to inaccurate or outdated content, which is less than ideal since Google looks for signals of reliability to help weed out content that propagates misinformation or contradicts popular consensus on certain topics. As of November 2023, many ChatGPT responses lead with, “As of my last knowledge update in January 2022…” Human SMEs can go through content with a fine-toothed comb, ensuring accuracy — something that’s especially important for companies in sensitive industries, such as healthcare and fintech, that can’t afford to disseminate erroneous content. 
Image showing chatting with  ChatGPT
  • Offpage SEO: You need all the off-page SEO in place to support your content. Even if you use technology as part of your SEO strategy, you need a human to review the checklist and help knit everything together.

And if you need any more convincing that AI isn’t ready to go it alone, listen to the wise words of John Mueller, Google’s search advocate. When tagged on X (formerly Twitter) in a post asking, “Should we use ChatGPT from now onwards for publishing content on our website??? It giving 80% unique content.” [sic], Mueller’s response was epic: “It’s like food with only 20% toxic chemicals? Sounds tasty.”

John Mueller's words about AI

Content Generated With AI

Digital guru and NP Digital Co-Founder Neil Patel put AI-generated content to the test following Google’s fall 2022 spam update, analyzing data from 100 experiment sites populated exclusively with AI-written content. His findings are more than worthy of a gasp and well-timed clutching of pearls:

  • Sites that used AI-generated content with zero human oversight dropped eight positions in the SERPs and lost an average of 17% in traffic.
  • Sites that paired AI-written content with some type of human oversight dropped just three positions in the SERPs and lost only 6% of their traffic.

It’s confirmed that problems arise when content creators expect AI to meet E-E-A-T standards independently. The human element may not be sacrosanct any longer, but it also isn’t extinct.

Boosting traffic thanks to artificial intelligence

Content Growth Founder Jake Ward is no stranger to building and scaling businesses. So, when Ward ran an experiment with sites brimming with AI-generated content, people took notice — especially when he published the results.

Ward’s barrage of AI content — paired with human oversight and revisions — helped take a website with zero traffic to 750,000 hits per month. The experiment involved 7,000 pages (all created using Byword.ai), and the growth took about a year to realize. At the end of the year-long study, that same site had 4,000 keywords in positions 1-3 and 13,000 keywords in positions 4-10.

Boosting traffic with AI

Why Is High-Quality Content Important?

Most of us remember our elementary school teachers drilling grammar rules into our rapidly growing brains. I before E, except after C, right? But even as objective or mechanical writing quality remains integral to producing content of value, the definition of quality content has expanded.

  • Does the content satisfy intent?
  • Does it provide actionable insights?
  • Are there unique perspectives?

It goes back to Google’s E-E-A-T principles. When you’re sharing experience, showcasing expertise, stating facts with authoritativeness, and proving your trustworthiness, you can’t help but churn out quality content that gives people what they want. This is true whether you’re prioritizing AI-generated content or writing everything yourself.

If you’re blending human and AI input, you have the best opportunity to produce content you and Google will love:

  • Relevancy: AI ensures content is relevant to search intent, while humans ensure the emotion is intact.
  • Credibility: AI uses existing data points to generate strong, quality content, and humans review that content for accuracy. This builds authority, too.
  • User engagement: AI can dig up tidbits that might take humans days to unearth and put together an outline that reduces knowledge gaps and increases coverage of the given topic. Humans add entertaining language and emotion that keeps text from being robotic and helps forge connections.

It’s almost a matter of left brain vs. right brain, but you have to let the creativity and uniqueness run free without trampling on the information and complexity the topic is due. And if you do all that while avoiding comma splices, all the better. Otherwise, Google’s SpamBrain will notice, seeing the patterns that indicate poor-quality content created to influence rankings rather than to please people.

Tactics to Integrate AI Into Your Content Creation Process

Adding AI to your existing content creation process takes planning and a deft hand. You should proceed with the following tips with one overarching thought in mind: AI is only successful in content when you use it to improve your processes, never when your sole goal is to make content generation cheaper.

  • Prioritize AI on the front end of content creation. AI is a research powerhouse, and ignoring that is almost criminal. Ask AI tools about trends and then use them to conduct research and generate outlines that can spark ideation and guide your writing teams.
  • Optimize existing content. What better way to go toe-to-toe with Google than to use AI to optimize existing content, looking at ways to improve keyword usage and metadata? You can even use AI to analyze the behavior and preferences of your target audience and rework old blog posts to speak to a new demographic.
  • Proofread and polish. Grammarly and ProWritingAid are just two of the AI-driven editing tools that can help you find errors and improve the style and quality of your content. These tools aren’t perfect (please don’t accept every suggestion), but they’re worthy grammatical wingmen.
  • Infuse content with your brand voice. You can actually train AI models, such as OpenAI’s GPT-4, to understand and utilize your brand voice so it can replicate what it sees.
  • Create custom images and videos. AI-powered visual content platforms haven’t made as big of a splash as text-generating platforms, but they should. Plug a request into Deep AI or Hotpot, and you can have a picture of a unicorn dressed as a cowboy sitting in a pile of spaghetti in mere minutes.
unicorn-2

Evaluating the Impact of AI on SEO Trends

As AI grows and continually fine-tunes itself, it has a parallel increasing impact on SEO. Artificial intelligence was woven throughout Semrush’s predictions for SEO trends in 2023, including:

  • Generative AI creates new content based on data it was fed during training, such as formulating summaries that answer search queries. Think of it as Google’s featured snippets on steroids.
  • Accelerated content creation, thanks to AI’s ability to produce words at record speed. The more content there is, the more competitive SEO can be, and the harder it may become for startups with limited bandwidth to gain traction.
  • Google continues to remind us of the importance of people-first content that meets search intent. AI-generated content is included and must meet the same standards — and yes, Google is watching.
  • Microsoft Bing has integrated ChatGPT into its search engine, making it a serious contender for the title of the World’s Top Search Engine. Eventually. It’s worth watching because how we use AI may one day no longer completely depend on Google’s input and guidelines.

But the SEO industry isn’t a monolith, and expert opinions on AI and SEO vary.

  • “AI is one of the most profound things we’re working on as humanity. It’s more profound than fire or electricity.” – Sundar Pichai, CEO of Alphabet and Google, via an interview with Verge
  • “The future of SEO will be heavily influenced by two key factors: the continued rise of mobile search and the increased use of artificial intelligence in the search industry.” — Neil Patel

And then there’s ChatGPT’s say-so. When asked, “Will AI kill SEO?” the platform first hedged its bets (“As an AI language model, I cannot predict the future . . .”) before underscoring the need for adaptable SEO strategies. It then stated, “SEO will not be killed by AI . . .  it will evolve to become more sophisticated and data-driven, with a greater emphasis on quality content, user experience, and technical optimization.” Mic drop.

Future Outlook: AI in Content Marketing and SEO

AI hasn’t reached its peak — not in terms of efficacy or accuracy or in the ways in which it can affect content production. There will be more applications joining the ranks in the years to come. Some may help with strategy and ideation, while others might pave the way for more efficient brief and content creation. We will, one day, be able to rely even more on artificial intelligence as a standalone tool to generate, evaluate, and refine content.

Now, imagine these tools connected to existing workflows, perhaps via a single, umbrella-like chat environment — increased visibility, a user-friendly format, and a gradually declining need for your team to stand over the apps like helicopter parents. Is your spine tingling yet?

The idea that AI could spearhead trend forecasting, conduct in-depth data analysis, deliver hyperlocal content, automatically analyze backlink profiles, and identify opportunities to improve all of the above isn’t just exciting. It promises an age in which anyone can use content to build their business without being a whiz with grammar or spending years learning the ins and outs of SEO.

AI: Writing and Ranking, With a Little Help From Your Friends

AI-generated content has the potential to rank as well (or even better) than content written entirely by human hands. But favoring artificial intelligence over human expertise, or vice versa, is like trying to sail across the Atlantic with only half a boat. You can keep doggy paddling, but why do yourself such a disservice? By combining AI with editorial oversight and SMEs, you can serve up high-quality text with a distinctly human touch.Step up your content efforts with an assist from Crowd Content’s managed services. We help businesses, agencies, and publishers across a wide variety of industries generate quality content at scale. Whether you want to explore the possibilities of AI-generated content or desire a fully human experience, our content managers can help you understand your options and build a process that expertly serves your needs.

The post Does AI Content Rank in Google? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
13 Reasons Why You Should Outsource Content Creation in 2024 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/13-reasons-why-you-should-outsource-your-content-creation/ Mon, 08 May 2023 15:40:50 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=36058 Whether you’re thinking about outsourcing content creation for the first time or just looking for a better way to get the job done, there’s good news: Experts agree that not only is outsourcing content writing a good idea, but it also may be the best way to take your business to the next level. Here’s […]

The post 13 Reasons Why You Should Outsource Content Creation in 2024 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Whether you’re thinking about outsourcing content creation for the first time or just looking for a better way to get the job done, there’s good news: Experts agree that not only is outsourcing content writing a good idea, but it also may be the best way to take your business to the next level.

Here’s a baker’s dozen’s worth of reasons to outsource your content marketing efforts in 2024.

1. Shave Expenses Off Your Bottom Line by Outsourcing Content Creation

Quality content can cost a pretty penny — or lots of pennies, really, when you consider forecasts that the content creation market will hit $53.6 billion by 2033. When you commission a blog or a white paper, you’re not just paying for words. You’re paying for the years those writers and editors spent perfecting their grammar, learning about SEO, and mastering various content types.

That said, outsourcing content still saves you considerable amounts of money, as contractors don’t come with the same costs associated with hiring in-house talent. You don’t need to give them a company computer, pay 401(k) and insurance, or cover their sick days.

2. Save Time for Other Must-Do Tasks

For most business owners and marketing department heads, 40-hour workweeks are the dream, not the reality. That’s especially true if you tackle content creation firsthand. From ideation to publishing, there’s an endless stream of tasks to complete.

If you outsource your content, you’ll free up your schedule to tackle those tasks only you can do, such as coaching your managers or pitching new ideas to the board.

3. Scale Content and Expand Your Content Calendar

When it comes to content, it can be difficult to balance quality and quantity. Most experts agree that frequent blogging and a steady stream of social media posts are better for connecting with consumers and engaging your audience. But pushing tons of poor-quality content isn’t the answer — it may even harm your business.Content outsourcing allows you to pull from a vast talent pool, generating high-quality content at whatever speed you need. Have you suddenly found yourself growing from a small start-up to a competitive, midsized enterprise? When you hire contract writers, they can churn out quality landing pages or blog posts at a lightning-fast pace.

4. Leverage Subject Matter Experts

Unless you’re ready to hire an entire stable of in-house writers, your team can’t possibly cover all the subjects you may want to reference as part of your overarching content strategy. Outsourcing with a company or platform that offers subject matter experts connects you with people who provide thought leadership and credentialed expertise in fields such as law, finance, health care, insurance, hospitality, and tech.

SMEs add significant value to your content by imbuing it with more authority and expertise. These days, Google craves trustworthy content written by experts. It’s a central aspect of the search giant’s E-E-A-T quality guidelines that prioritize experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness.

5. Mine Your Talent Pool for Fresh Ideas and Varied Viewpoints

We’ve already touched on some limitations of relying 100% on in-house writers, but here’s another factor to consider: People run out of ideas. Even the most innovative creatives stumble sometimes, and content written by a small team can start to drift toward sameness. In other words, ideas, phrasing, and even content structure can get staler than a month-old biscuit.

Outsourcing lets you switch up writers at will. You can create your own team of freelancers and release batches of content to the group as a whole, or ask for pitches and see which ideas are most exciting.

6. Publish Faster and More Efficiently

Outsourcing doesn’t always just involve contracting a writer. Editors, subject matter experts, and content managers play an essential role in the process. Choose the right platform and service options, and your content partner can handle everything from ideation to multistep quality assurance. That means you get deliverables that are error-free and publish-ready.

Eliminating the need to edit or peruse just-delivered content for accuracy allows you to fast-forward the production process. Assign work, switch focus to wherever you’re needed, and wait for the finished product to arrive.

7. Reach a Wider Audience

Subject matter experts and content pros can help you expand your audience, meaning more potential customers and theoretical dollars in your pocket.

Outsourcing boosts reach by:

  • Giving you access to marketing agencies that can help you create a content calendar and ramp up distribution
  • Assisting in creating multiple content types, which expands to email marketing, paid ads, social media posts, and B2B or B2C content such as white papers and case studies
  • Giving you the experts you need so you can approach your niche from multiple angles

8. Experiment With Different Content Types

Speaking of different content types, do you know how many there are? Hint: There’s a lot, including:

  • Blogs
  • Testimonials and reviews
  • Case studies
  • E-books
  • Videos
  • Infographics
  • White papers
  • Guides and how-tos
  • Scripts for podcasts, videos, speeches, and webinars
  • Web copy
  • Landing pages
  • Product descriptions
  • Buyer’s guides

Some writers dabble in multiple content types, while others only specialize in marketing copy or scripts. You can’t necessarily expect a blog writer to knock a case study out of the park, but you can outsource to a platform that has already vetted writers specializing in all types of content. That way, you’re covered no matter what.

9. Boost Your ROI

Getting a great return on your investment is crucial in marketing because you want to ensure you get back more than you put in. That way, you can reinvest in your business, ramp up content production, and build your brand, all without spending more of your budget than you initially intended.

We’ve already discussed how outsourcing content creation can reduce overhead and increase efficiency. It can also boost ROI by ensuring your content hits the target the first time, every time, so you don’t have to test out whether your favorite blogger can produce decent results with their first buyer’s guide. Instead, you draw from an already-vetted, well-managed group of writers who know how to make every word count.

10. Meet Goals Faster

Even the best content strategy takes time to execute and come to fruition. SEO doesn’t happen overnight, and neither does building a blog or revamping a website. 

Consistency counts, but so do quality and volume. You can win over your audience by crafting just one stellar blog a month and building your website over a year. But it’ll take that much longer for you to reach your objectives.

When you outsource content creation, you amplify your reach and grow your team overnight. It doesn’t matter that contracted writers aren’t actual employees or full-time workers. 

You’ll get the help you need when you need it, and that’s true whether you work with a single writer or a team of 100. You can generate a couple of quality blogs or hundreds of landing pages at the speed you need.

11. Enhance SEO and Rank Higher

With search engine optimization, you can determine how to structure your content and website to please Google’s algorithm — the enigmatic yet all-important equation that drives search rankings. Without SEO, you can’t expect to rank high on the search engine results pages, dampening your marketing efforts.

The thing is, keeping up with SEO updates can be a full-time job. Even the best writers in the world may be a step or two behind on SEO, which is why so many people work with agencies that specialize in optimization. But that means another contract, another bill to pay, and another step in the content creation process.

Instead, partner with a platform like Crowd Content that offers soup-to-nuts content creation services. Keywords, content briefs, writing, editing, QA — it can all be included. Choose what you need, and leave the details to the pros so you can get back to your to-do list.

12. Outsourcing Content Creation Helps Increase Authority

Publishing quality blogs reviewed by SMEs helps you become an established authority in your given niche. People who love a particular topic know when someone equally passionate wrote the content they’re reading. They also know when someone is just regurgitating basic facts. Which do you think resonates better?

Trust your content and your relationship with your audience to writers and SMEs who take your project seriously and have the credentials and portfolios to back it all up. Each piece of authoritative content will grow the overall authority of your domain.

13. Protect Your Reputation With Higher Quality Content

Poor-quality content is no joke. Content littered with typos, grammatical errors, and factual inaccuracies tanks your reputation and makes you less trustworthy in the eyes of consumers. You can’t afford to buy or create subpar content, and outsourcing can save you that headache 100 times over.

But what is quality content? Two articles can vary in so many ways yet still rise to the top of the search results. Ultimately, high-ranking content takes a person-first approach and includes insightful, authoritative information. 

This is easier if you outsource content production to an agency that follows an extensive content quality checklist through every step of the process.

What Are the Best Practices for Communicating With Outsourced Teams?

So, you’ve decided to take the plunge and expand your content creation efforts with outsourcing. But how do you communicate with your team of freelancers?

Communication shouldn’t be more complicated than it is with an in-house writing team, but outsourcing definitely creates a different dynamic. You can’t necessarily expect freelancers to be available to talk at any point during business hours like you would employees.

Instead, set clear expectations from the get-go, including regular check-ins and updates. Outline your preferred communication methods, whether those include email, calls, or platforms such as Teams and Slack, so your team knows how to contact you with questions or ideas.

Of course, time and optimization are the ultimate factors in outsourcing, and you can’t expect to get everything right on your first try. After the work is done, look for any improvements you can make to instructions, briefs, and communication, then offer detailed feedback for your writers to do the same. Content calibration lets you scale things up next time with even smoother results.

How Do You Monitor and Measure the Success of Outsourced Content?

Regardless of whether you’re working with an in-house team, hiring freelancers from across the ocean, or doing everything yourself, you need a way to measure the success of your content. It’s how you know when to scale up or cut your losses.

There are several tools you can use to track content performance, including free options such as Google Analytics and full-service marketing platforms that can become costly. As long as you can see how many views your content gets and observe the search rankings over time, that’s all you need to start.

Of course, you may eventually want to track user experience and engagement. Throw in a way to also assess the social media impact of your content, and you’re set for the future.

Budgeting and Investing for the Future

Outsourcing content creation may saves money over the long run — especially if your in-house team is finding it hard to keep your content supply flowing. However, content marketing offers slower returns than paid marketing streams, so you won’t see new leads immediately. Patience is key.

Over the weeks and months to come, the budget you invest in content marketing should establish trust, authority, and brand awareness for your business. High-quality content continues to attract new customers without much additional investment — something that can’t be said of pay-per-click marketing. 

Half of today’s marketers say they’re already outsourcing at least part of their content marketing workload, and this is one time you should follow the crowd. For more information on outsourcing or to see how Crowd Content can help you with your content marketing strategy, sign up for an account today.

The post 13 Reasons Why You Should Outsource Content Creation in 2024 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How Ghostwriters Help You Conjure Up the Right Words https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-ghostwriters-help-you-conjure-up-the-right-words/ Wed, 29 Mar 2023 04:13:46 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=36028 Customers love to get insights and tips to grow their businesses, especially from experts in the know. But how can you reach prospective customers and share knowledge when your company’s leadership doesn’t have time to write guest posts and articles? Cue the ghostwriter. These professional writers lurk behind the scenes and are invisible to audiences, […]

The post How Ghostwriters Help You Conjure Up the Right Words appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Customers love to get insights and tips to grow their businesses, especially from experts in the know. But how can you reach prospective customers and share knowledge when your company’s leadership doesn’t have time to write guest posts and articles?

Cue the ghostwriter. These professional writers lurk behind the scenes and are invisible to audiences, but there’s nothing supernatural about them. Learn how ghostwriters deliver meaningful content on your behalf, putting an expert face on your company. We’ll fill you in on their role in content marketing and how you can leverage a ghostwriting service to raise your brand profile and build trust with audiences.

What Is Ghostwriting?

Ghostwriting is the practice of creating content that’s credited to someone other than the original writer. This process is common in book publishing, where public figures often hire professional writers to craft memoirs or autobiographies on their behalf.

With digital content playing an increasingly important role in brand marketing, many companies are hiring ghostwriters to produce online content. Thought leadership pieces, blog posts, articles, e-books and white papers are extremely valuable for raising brand awareness and establishing a company’s authority in a field.

These types of pieces can be attributed to senior leaders and executives or published as general website content. Think of ghostwriters as playing a similar role to speech writers shaping a keynote delivered by a CEO or publicists putting together quotes that appear in press releases. People want insights from those at the top and ghostwriters help get important ideas across in an expressive and compelling way.

Why Use a Ghostwriter?

Companies use content marketing to reach audiences and demonstrate authority in a niche. A smart thought leadership piece from your CEO, published in a respected industry journal, gives your company valuable exposure. It also helps develop the personal brand of senior executives and makes it easier for audiences to relate to your company.

However, while your leadership has plenty of wisdom to convey, they likely have more urgent work priorities. Ghostwriting gets your company’s expertise out to audiences when potential authors are too busy to devote hours to writing. It also makes sense to use professional writers to create copy, as the quality reflects directly on your company. It takes superior writing skills to produce highly polished, engaging content that also fits into your brand image.

When to Hire a Ghostwriter

If you have an in-house writing team, you can get started on your content marketing strategy right away. But some companies may not have staff writers or their team may be stretched thin on other projects.

In this case, you have a couple of options for ghostwriting.

  • You can hire your own freelance writers to call on when needed, reviewing applications and vetting them to ensure their skills match your needs. You might have to try a few writers to find one that can hit the tone or style you’re looking for or that charge rates within your budget. Freelance writers tend to have a stable of clients, so you also need to make sure they’re available when you need content delivered in a timely fashion.
  • You can use a ghostwriting service and tap into a group of writers with different backgrounds and areas of expertise. You can outsource an array of content, including blog posts, articles, opinion pieces, columns and e-books. And, with a large pool of freelancers, you’re usually assured of finding one who can turn content around quickly and meet deadlines. 

How to Work With Ghostwriters

If you’re investing resources in creating content, make sure your efforts pay off. Here are a few guidelines to ensure you receive impactful copy, whether using a ghostwriting service or your own freelancers.

Determine Goals

Set out the purpose of the piece so your team is working toward the same objective. Some examples of content goals are:

  • Increasing brand awareness by publishing guest posts on other websites
  • Boosting site traffic through blog posts you promote on social media
  • Encouraging readers to download an e-book or white paper by teasing key highlights in a LinkedIn article
  • Improving your search engine ranking by building an inventory of quality SEO content on your site

Once you know what your content should accomplish, set out a plan to achieve it.

Create a Content Brief

Provide the ghostwriter with as much detail as possible to guide their work. The more clarity you give, the more likely the final piece meets your expectations. Writers need details such as:

  • Content objective. What should readers take away from the piece? What impression do you want to make?
  • Context. Where will the piece be published?
  • Topic. Outline key points to cover, including key information or data.
  • Word count. Provide a range to give the writer some flexibility.
  • Keywords. List primary and secondary keywords with placement guidelines.
  • Links. Provide a list of the types of internal and external links to use.
  • Tone. A good ghostwriter can capture different tones and styles. Provide direction to ensure the piece fits seamlessly into your brand voice.
  • Formatting. Provide a link to your brand’s style guide or specify any preferences.

Collaborate If Needed

In most cases, ghostwriters with expertise in the subject can deliver accurate, well-researched content to meet your needs, whether in the area of finance, law, real estate, health or technology. 

For personal pieces, you may need to provide the writer with quotes and stories. For example, if you want to publish an article by the company founder about the early years of the business, you’ll need to conduct an interview and gather necessary anecdotes. Let the ghostwriter know the type of personality or language to infuse into the piece if you want it to reflect the personal brand of a CEO or executive.

Implement a Review Process

Content marketers talk a lot about demonstrating authority, which is important for establishing credibility and respect. Authority helps persuade customers to do business with you and gives search engines confidence in placing your site higher in search engine rankings. 

To establish authority and achieve brand goals, your content must be impeccable in quality. It’s good practice to ensure the content is reviewed for accuracy, either by your in-house team or ghostwriting service.

  • Editors ensure logic, flow and style
  • Proofreaders look for grammar and spelling errors
  • Subject matter experts review for content and accuracy
  • Editorial directors or content strategists ensure the piece meets corporate goals

The person receiving the byline should also review the piece for voice and to ensure they agree with the contents.

Benefits of Hiring a Ghostwriting Service

Ghostwriting services can be a cost-effective solution when you don’t have in-house resources to devote to content creation. Here are some benefits of outsourcing to an agency such as Crowd Content.

High-Quality Professional Copy

Content marketing is highly competitive. According to Semrush’s 2023 State of Content Marketing survey, 53% of content marketers are focusing on improving content quality and 55% are creating more content and posting more often.

As standards increase and competition ramps up, your content needs to stand out to make an impression. Professional ghostwriters can transform your content strategy into well-structured, compelling copy that reflects positively on your brand, captures attention and motivates readers toward your goals.

Maximize Productivity

Content creation can be time-consuming, but a ghostwriting service offers a pool of writers ready to produce articles, blog posts and other content to meet your needs. You can leverage this talent and use ghostwriters to execute your full content strategy. By planning an editorial calendar with deadlines and scheduling regular delivery of content to publish, you can grow your online presence quickly and effortlessly. 

Better Online Visibility

The more quality content you create, the better your chances of reaching your target audience. Each web page is a fresh opportunity to rank in search engines and drive audiences to your page through social media, marketing emails and internal linking.

You can also build important backlinks to your web pages from other sites, which Google sees as an endorsement of the value of your content. These backlinks improve your site’s authority and search engine ranking.

Save Time and Money

Crowd Content’s flexible pricing makes outsourcing cost-effective. Freelancers are prescreened according to experience so you can build a team that suits your budget. You can access thousands of writers with different specialties without the hassle of vetting each one and negotiating individual rates. 

Our ghostwriters fit into your workflow as needed. If you have a specific vision, provide an in-depth outline and writers will follow your instructions. If you prefer to be hands-off, offer general direction about the topic and trust our skilled writers to develop and produce a compelling article on your behalf at the same standardized per word rate.

Need to add more than a writer to your team? Tap into editors, subject matter experts, keyword researchers and content managers, taking more tasks off your to-do list.Whether you want a high-profile article under your CEO’s byline or snappy content to perk up your website or blog, our ghostwriting services make content production simple and efficient. Find out how to get started today and put your content strategy into action.

The post How Ghostwriters Help You Conjure Up the Right Words appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What Content Writing Services Did Right in 2022 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-content-writing-services-did-right-in-2022/ Fri, 24 Mar 2023 01:42:36 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35923 Content is the fastest-moving trend in marketing. The sector grew by 14.8% in 2022, and is expected to produce $107 billion in revenue by 2026. Website content writing services are a major driving force behind the accelerated growth — let’s take a look at what they did right in 2022 and determine how last year’s […]

The post What Content Writing Services Did Right in 2022 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content is the fastest-moving trend in marketing. The sector grew by 14.8% in 2022, and is expected to produce $107 billion in revenue by 2026. Website content writing services are a major driving force behind the accelerated growth — let’s take a look at what they did right in 2022 and determine how last year’s trends will affect the content world in 2023.

Created Helpful, Relevant Content

You know the old saying: content is king.

We’d like to propose a slight alteration — quality content is king.

The content-marketing sphere is crowded, and competition is steep. If you want to rank on the first page of the search results, you’ll need to meet higher standards.

In 2022, the most successful content writing agencies rose to the occasion by producing helpful, relevant content. They focused on fulfilling search intent and ensuring that each piece was the best possible resource on the topic.

The focus on quality will intensify in 2023 as Google rolls out an update to its Search Quality Rater Guidelines. The traditional E-A-T framework is now E-E-A-T: experience, expertise, authoritativeness and trust. That’s good news for both brands and content writers; it means that for many topics, Google will consider personal experience when assessing the quality and trustworthiness of a page.

To improve quality and relevance, content writers are:

  • Producing original content. It’s no longer enough to regurgitate the ideas in the highest-ranking pages; your content must add substantial value.
  • Choosing helpful formats. Select the format that’s most useful for your audience, whether that’s written content, video, audio or a combination.
  • Write for people. Create comprehensive content that’s geared toward people rather than the Google algorithm.

As programs such as ChatGPT flood the internet with AI-generated content, originality is more important than ever. Search engines are developing algorithms to detect and penalize AI content, so publishers can thrive in the long run by bringing human-centered value to the online space.

Doubled Down on Written Content

Short-form video has been the star of the content world over the past few years, but 2022 saw a shift toward a more balanced approach. As brands recognized the longevity and power of written content — and the value of owning a platform rather than relying on the whims of a third-party service — content writing services began producing more long-form pieces.

In this latest iteration of lengthy web articles, the “more is more” ideology is a thing of the past. The best content writers aren’t aiming for the longest possible word count; they’re covering a topic in-depth and creating comprehensive, evergreen resources that maximize time on page, minimize bounce rate and send positive signals to Google.

Written content will expand in 2023 as companies look for ways to increase content and audience ownership. Expect to see an increase in ebooks, white papers and other lead magnets that provide value and build engaged mailing lists.

Found New Ways To Personalize Content

Personalization was one of the biggest website content trends in 2022. Writers took steps to connect with readers on a personal level. Driven by extensive keyword and audience research, they created:

  • Content that resonates deeply with the ideal customer’s emotions and state of mind
  • Topics that correspond to each part of the sales funnel or customer journey
  • Calls to action that speak directly to the reader’s immediate needs and pain points

Content intelligence programs are poised to revolutionize the personalization process in 2023 and beyond. Brands and content writing agencies are already using these data-intensive programs to predict the type, topic and format of content that will work best for specific audience segments. AI-driven systems also deploy custom calls to action in real time and trigger specific communication sequences in response to customer signals.

As intelligence platforms become more accessible, SEO content writing services will help brands take full advantage of the technology. This year, expect to see more writers using AI-generated insights and optimization suggestions to create precisely targeted content for specific buyer personas.

Embraced a Broader Content Strategy

The focus on personalization gave way to another content-writing success of 2022: diversification. The best writing services realized that when building lasting connections with a broad range of readers, it’s not enough to rely on a single type of content. They encouraged clients to branch out to a variety of formats, including:

  • Informative articles
  • How-to guides
  • Marketing emails
  • Infographics
  • Ebooks
  • Product reviews
  • Case studies
  • Videos
  • Podcasts
  • Social media posts

The most successful content strategies in 2023 will use a mix of formats and topics, particularly for brands marketing to a diverse demographic. The goal is to provide value for audience members at every stage of the journey, whether they need a quick infographic overview or a detailed troubleshooting guide.

Encouraged Niche Topic Selection

Every SEO content writer is familiar with the idea of “niched down” content — media that addresses the needs of a specific audience segment. This type of highly focused content was key in 2022 as brands sought ways to differentiate themselves from competitors.

Niche content is here to stay, especially as more players enter the content-marketing game. Customers are overwhelmed with choices, both for the content they consume and the brands they patronize. Writing services that provide precise keyword selection and target specific queries can help you attract engaged, loyal customers.

Looking back at 2022, it’s clear that content is evolving. Gone are the days of general, broad-focus writing; in 2023, top website content writing services will embrace topics that are tailored to specific profiles and scenarios to help clients succeed.

The post What Content Writing Services Did Right in 2022 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What Is Content Intelligence & How Does It Work? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-content-intelligence-how-does-it-work/ Fri, 17 Mar 2023 02:45:55 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35791 If you use content to promote your business, you know that the content marketing landscape is ever-changing and increasingly crowded. In this competitive environment, it takes more effort to get in front of your target customers. Content intelligence enables you to work smarter, not harder, so you can improve quality and scale efficiently. What Is […]

The post What Is Content Intelligence & How Does It Work? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
If you use content to promote your business, you know that the content marketing landscape is ever-changing and increasingly crowded. In this competitive environment, it takes more effort to get in front of your target customers. Content intelligence enables you to work smarter, not harder, so you can improve quality and scale efficiently.

What Is Content Intelligence?

Content intelligence is the practice of using software — typically, programs powered by AI and machine learning — to predict impactful content types and topics, generate optimized content and measure the performance of published pieces. Intelligence insights make it easier to develop a refined, highly targeted content marketing strategy that resonates deeply with your ideal customer. The process also helps you allocate resources effectively, boosting ROI for SEO content writing services, video, social media, influencer marketing and other tactics.

How Can Marketing Firms Use Content Intelligence?

Content plays a vital role in many companies’ marketing strategies. That’s no surprise, given that globally, content marketing brought in $63 billion in revenue in 2022. By 2026, experts believe this figure will reach $107.5 billion.

As more people enter the content space, marketers must step up their games — which is where content intelligence comes in. A data-driven strategy provides critical benefits that give your business a competitive advantage.

Develop More Effective Content Plans

Traditionally, marketers implement content strategies, analyze the results and make adjustments accordingly. Content intelligence tools streamline this process by providing insights up front and eliminating costly, time-consuming trial and error.

The magic lies in the data. Intelligence platforms draw from a vast digital pool of competitor information, behavioral data and market research to help you:

  • Identify topics that your audience will respond to
  • Predict the most effective channel and type of content
  • Choose the best-performing format for any given channel or objective
  • Set a competitive publishing schedule
  • Create appropriate content for every stage of the customer journey
  • Determine when to outsource content to a white paper writer or another freelancer

Create Compelling Content

Content is expensive, and marketing budgets are limited. Content intelligence platforms help creators and content writers get it right on the first try, which minimizes revision requirements and compresses the publishing schedule. As a result, you can produce high-performing content quickly and at scale while keeping labor costs in check.

Many tools go well beyond keyword research; they suggest relevant topics and subheaders, recommend style adjustments and generate click-worthy headlines. If you’re creating videos or podcasts, intelligence software can tell you where to place calls to action to boost conversions. Some programs can even use AI to monitor user behavior and display a call to action when audiences are most receptive.

Analyze Content Performance

Content intelligence tools begin analyzing your content from the moment you hit the publish button. The steady stream of real-time data enables you to change course quickly to maximize performance and improve ROI. When a specific ad performs poorly, you can adjust the wording and see the results immediately.

As your chosen platform learns more about your audience and content performance, it can deliver customized recommendations for each of your marketing objectives.

Consistent analytical data enables more efficient spending, both in the short and long term. If you notice that customers engage with long-form content but ignore social media, for example, you might invest in a professional white paper writer but ease up on Facebook and Instagram.

Personalize Digital Experiences

Personalization is a growing trend among content marketers, and for good reason — McKinsey research shows that 71% of customers expect it. Successful companies tailor the entire customer experience to the user’s needs. This might include:

  • Recommending relevant products or content
  • Customizing messaging to match the buyer profile
  • Offering personalized promotions based on shopping or browsing history
  • Sending follow-up communication

The right content intelligence system helps you identify and capitalize on these key opportunities. Many programs use automation to get relevant content in front of customers when they need it most; the system monitors behavioral triggers and initiates a predetermined action on the fly, all with no input from you.

Understand Your Customers

A steady stream of intelligence data gives you a better understanding of the people who are consuming your content. This critical information is essential in developing detailed customer profiles — in fact, some tools can segment the audience for you based on demographics, purchase history or behavioral metrics. To refine each profile, you can run split-tests and content experiments that clarify user preferences and search intent.

A deep understanding of your audience informs every aspect of the marketing process, enabling the team to develop content that fulfills searcher intent. It also provides valuable insights for other aspects of the business, including development and sales.

How to Choose a Content Intelligence Platform

Content intelligence platforms can come with a high price tag and a considerable learning curve; it’s worth your time to research different options to find a solution that works for your business and your budget.

  1. Identify your goals. Consider your short-term and long-term business objectives. Use them to identify what you need most in a content intelligence tool, both now and in the future. A comprehensive platform might have higher up-front costs, but it will prepare your company to tackle aggressive growth goals.
  2. Verify data options. A powerful content intelligence program should offer customer, market and competitor data, both historically and in real time. Examine the company’s data-collection practices to ensure that your team has the capacity to manage the process. While you’re at it, look through the available reporting options.
  3. Check features. Make sure each contender has robust features that can help your company improve and scale content production. Top options include AI-powered content creation tools, automations, experiments and AI-driven insights and optimizations.
  4. Consider compatibility. Go through the different integrations the platform offers and ensure they’re compatible with your existing tech stack and any planned expansions. You can also check the provider’s other solutions to see how they might suit your growth objectives; programs from the same company are often easier to implement than third-party solutions.
  5. Test platforms thoroughly. Before you commit, test your chosen platform, paying attention to ease of navigation, the setup process for each feature and day-to-day operation. Try all support channels and ask questions about the initial integration.

If you’re planning to invest heavily in content marketing in the coming years, a content intelligence platform could be a valuable investment. The right program can offer data-driven insights for revenue-boosting content that supports your company’s growth goals.

The post What Is Content Intelligence & How Does It Work? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Simplifying the Complex: Why Technical Writing Matters https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/simplifying-the-complex-why-technical-writing-matters/ Sat, 04 Mar 2023 06:13:17 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35734 Suppose you’re preparing to roll out an exciting new app, and you need a step-by-step guide to show customers how to use it. Or, maybe your organization recently completed a groundbreaking study and you’re eager to share what you’ve learned — except you have no idea where to start. If these — or similar — […]

The post Simplifying the Complex: Why Technical Writing Matters appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Suppose you’re preparing to roll out an exciting new app, and you need a step-by-step guide to show customers how to use it. Or, maybe your organization recently completed a groundbreaking study and you’re eager to share what you’ve learned — except you have no idea where to start. If these — or similar — dilemmas sound familiar, you probably need a technical writer.

A technical writer helps make complex topics understandable, so you can effectively deliver information to employees, colleagues and customers. For many companies, particularly those in the technology, scientific or medical space, this can mean the difference between success and failure.

So, can technical writing benefit you? To answer that question, let’s take a deeper dive into what technical writing is and why it’s so important in certain industries and departments.

What Is Technical Writing?

Technical writing aims to make the complex simple. It’s a form of written or digital communication that documents specific processes or imparts information about complex or specialized subjects with a high level of accuracy and in the most efficient way possible. For example, technical writing may deliver research findings, forecast or analyze industry trends or provide instructions for difficult tasks. If you’ve ever had to create a user guide or assembly instructions, you’ve used technical writing skills.

Technical writing often targets a narrow audience consisting of industry professionals, such as engineers, doctors or scientists. However, content may also be aimed at a general audience, which often includes users of a product or service. In the latter case, technical writing must present complex topics in a way that even a layman can understand. 

Who Needs Technical Writing?

STEM-related industries, including scientific or medical organizations and computer-related companies, often hire technical writers to create product documentation, operator manuals and other instructional materials to help employees and customers understand complex topics and to teach them how to execute technical tasks. Additionally, technical writing is important in the management space, particularly in industries that must deliver complex quarterly or annual financial reports.

However, any business that needs to share accurate or complex information with their employees, customers or other industry professionals, can benefit from technical writing services. For example, a restaurant may require training materials to help new staff learn to use kitchen equipment, or a furniture manufacturer may need to provide assembly instructions with their products.

How Does Technical Writing Work?

There’s no universal formula for technical writing. The process can vary widely depending on the type of content, the targeted audience and the industry. However, regardless of type, most technical writing involves several stages:

  1. Defining the content: Typically, the person who orders the content lets the writer know what tone, writing style and difficulty level they should aim for. Writers should also know the target audience and its needs. In some cases, technical writers may have a say in choosing the best medium for the message or audience.
  2. Gathering resources: A technical writer should have access to all relevant resources, which may include item specifications, research data and product samples.
  3. Consulting with relevant experts: Often, technical writers work directly with technical staff, product liability specialists and customer service managers to ensure the content they create is as clear and accurate as possible, complies with safety regulations and meets any other organizational requirements.
  4. Creating the content: Technical writers may write text from scratch or update existing content to meet new or changing needs, or to address revised product specifications or corrected information. Content creation may also involve incorporating visual elements, such as photos, illustrations, graphs or animation to enhance clarity and comprehensibility.

What Are the Characteristics of Technical Writing?

Although technical writing spans a continuum of written and digital content, high-quality examples typically share several common characteristics:

  • Accuracy: The main goal of technical writing is to convey information, so it must be accurate. Incorrect, vague or outdated information can result in costly mistakes, lost customers and, in extreme cases, legal action.
  • Thoroughness: To be effective, technical writing must be thorough and comprehensive. It should address all relevant aspects of the topic and may include visual accompaniments to complement written text.
  • Logic: Technical writing must make sense, so actionable steps are easy to follow. It should never include contradictory information or gaps in logic that could diminish authority or credibility.
  • Sequence: Technical writing embodies the philosophy of one step at a time. Particularly in operator guides and other “how-to” instructional materials, writers should make sure all steps are listed in the order they must be performed.
  • Organization: Readers don’t want to skip around to find important information. Technical writers should present the material in a well-organized, intuitive fashion.
  • Economy: Because technical writing is meant to inform or instruct, every word matters, and text should include no wasted words. If you can convey information sufficiently in 50 words, don’t use 75.
  • Audience appropriateness: Technical writing may target different audiences. The complexity and style of writing should be appropriate for the intended audience. For example, technical writing aimed at a general user should be substantially different in tone, vocabulary and style from writing aimed at engineers or other technical professionals.

What Are the Different Types of Technical Writing Services?

Depending on the industry and a company’s unique needs, technical writing can take many forms. Although the applications are numerous, common types of technical writing services include:

  • Case studies: These in-depth studies may focus on individuals, groups or events.
  • Assembly manuals: Step-by-step assembly guides show consumers how to safely and correctly put together a product.
  • User guides/user manuals: These guides provide comprehensive information about operating a product or using a service.
  • Product specifications: Spec sheets highlight features and functions of an item. They may include dimensions, materials and safety specifications.
  • FAQs: Often used on websites, FAQs answer frequently asked questions about products and services.
  • White papers: These informational documents typically highlight information about a product, service or solution
  • Quarterly or annual reports: These public-facing reports summarize a company’s financial statements. They typically include a profit-and-loss statement.
  • API documentation: API documents typically include tutorials, references, tutorials and other materials that help developers understand and use your application programming interface.
  • Statements of work: These legally binding documents define the scope of a project. They may include a project’s goals, deliverables and schedule.
  • Literature reviews: These documents summarize previous research and scholarly sources on a given topic.
  • Technical video scripts: Scripts may be written for television, radio, Internet or podcast.

How Technical Writing Skills Differ From Copywriting Skills

Both technical writers and copywriters must be able to write clear, readable content, but they differ in many areas. Copywriters need to create engaging, marketing-focused content that drives sales, while technical writers deliver objective instructional or informative content designed for employees, customers and industry professionals.

Besides knowing how to write well, technical writers often have a specialized skill set, which includes experience in or knowledge of the topic they’re writing about. In many cases, technical writers must be able to distill complex information into language that the general population can understand. They must also be able to share, discuss and understand the information received from technical professionals about a given subject. Because of this, technical writers often start out in technical or scientific jobs. In some industries, technical writers may need to hold a bachelor’s degree in a relevant field of study.

A Comparison of Copywriting, Business Writing and Technical Writing


CopywritingBusiness WritingTechnical Writing
CharacteristicsCompellingConciseClearReadableEngagingSales-orientedSEO-optimizedInformative or entertainingCasual, conversational or formalClearPersuasivePurposefulAccurateConfident and polite

InformativeProfessionalObjectiveOften contain a call to action
DirectInformativePreciseTargetedLogicalSequentialComprehensiveOrganizedObjective and/or neutral
ApplicationsBrochuresNewslettersAdvertisementsBranding materialsWebsite contentSocial media adsTV, radio or podcast scriptsProduct descriptionsPromotional materialsMemosEmailsPrint correspondenceBusiness reportsHandbooksPress releasesBusiness plansMeeting agendasResumes and cover lettersOperator manualsProject plansWhite papersScientific or medical articlesProduct documentationAssembly instructionsProduct literature reviewsScripts on technical subjectsProduct recalls
FocusSales and marketingAll business functionsTechnical aspects of a company

It’s worth noting that many projects, such as video scripts or trade magazine articles, may combine elements of two or more types of writing. 

How Technical Writing Services Can Benefit You

Whether you lack the resources to hire a full-time technical writer or you just want to leave the writing to someone else, outsourcing technical writing services can help your company gain the competitive edge. No matter how big or small your business is, you can acquire the top-notch instructional materials you need through Crowd Content. 

Through Crowd Content’s world-class content writing services, you can order spec sheets, technical manuals and any other written documentation your business needs. Many of our dedicated, professional freelancers are subject matter experts and have the experience and expertise to create engaging, copy in technical areas, such as computer science and engineering. 

When you work with Crowd Content, you’ll receive publish-ready, SEO-rich content that drives organic traffic to your website while meeting your company’s high standards. We can also accommodate any requirements you have regarding style and format, including citations, to cement your industry reputation. So, if your latest white paper or e-book is still nothing more than notes, leave the writing to Crowd Content and rest easy.

The post Simplifying the Complex: Why Technical Writing Matters appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Create a SEO Content Strategy for 2024 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-create-a-seo-content-strategy/ Thu, 02 Mar 2023 02:50:45 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35710 When you’re trying to boost your website’s prominence in search engine rankings, it’s good to aim high. But getting to those prized top spots takes work. You need a comprehensive SEO content strategy built around audience, keywords, and user intent, as well as a pulse on the ever-changing search landscape. In this article, we look […]

The post How to Create a SEO Content Strategy for 2024 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
When you’re trying to boost your website’s prominence in search engine rankings, it’s good to aim high. But getting to those prized top spots takes work. You need a comprehensive SEO content strategy built around audience, keywords, and user intent, as well as a pulse on the ever-changing search landscape.

In this article, we look at how high-quality, SEO-driven content fits into your overall search visibility efforts. We also show you how to build an effective SEO campaign in 2024, taking into account Google’s helpful content update, the growing popularity of AI, voice search, and search generative experience.

4 Elements of an Effective SEO Strategy

Before we dive in, let’s look at the big picture. It’s said that more than 200 Google ranking factors impact where pages fall in the SERPs. SEO content writing is an important part of it — but it’s only one component. 

robot writing SEO content

A comprehensive SEO strategy has four parts:

  • On-page SEO helps search engines understand the meaning of a page so it can be matched to relevant search queries. These tasks include writing meta titles and descriptions, using headers, optimizing images, creating descriptive URLs, and adding internal links. 
  • Off-page SEO involves building backlinks from external sites to demonstrate your content is trustworthy and valuable. A link-building strategy can involve creating guest posts, partnering with influencers, and requesting links in resource directories.
  • Technical SEO helps search bots crawl your site easily and addresses elements such as site speed, loading times, mobile responsiveness, security, and site errors.
  • Content SEO, the focus of our article, is the creation of content that readers want to consume. The content should answer the search query and be easy to read and insightful.

If your business caters to audiences in a specific region or has multiple locations, you should also complement your strategy with a local SEO component to reach customers in those areas.

How does search engine ranking work?

When your site is optimized using the above tactics, search engines can more effectively crawl, index, and rank your pages. 

  • Crawling: Google uses software called crawlers to gather and store information from every web page it can access. 
  • Indexing: The information gathered by search bots is organized and indexed according to SEO elements, such as keywords and metadata. When a user performs a query, search engines pull the relevant page. 
  • Ranking: Search engines weigh factors such as relevance, quality, and user experience to determine how useful the page is and where it should surface in the SERPs.

Google’s Emphasis on Content Quality

Google’s objective is to provide users with the best, most reliable information for their searches. Pages that say the same thing as a dozen other sites? They’re not nabbing that top spot in the SERPs. Blog posts written to hit certain keyword densities with little value? They’re not on Google’s wish list, either.

Instead, create original content for human readers that inspires them to say, “I learned something new!” Google consistently refines search algorithms to find and prominently display these in-depth pages. 

E-E-A-T

Google introduced E-A-T principles in 2014 to ensure the content it promotes is expert, authoritative, and trustworthy. A couple of years ago, an extra “E” was added to these guidelines to emphasize experience or first-hand knowledge.

Search algorithms look for signs of E-E-A-T on your website through backlinks from other sites, traffic and engagement metrics, and topical authority. Consider establishing your credentials in online bios or on an “About” page and leveraging the knowledge of subject matter experts to show your content is credible. 

Helpful content system

Designed to distinguish between high-quality and low-value content, Google’s helpful content system rolled out in 2022. Soon after a 2023 update, pages that didn’t meet the criteria for useful content tumbled in the SERPs.

Google has a checklist to assess the helpfulness of your content. Essentially, you should offer in-depth analyses and comprehensively answer a reader’s questions on a topic. Aim to produce a piece that’s so original and perceptive that a reader would recommend or bookmark it.

These standards also apply if you’re experimenting with AI content creation. Search engines don’t care who (or what) wrote the content as long as it’s meaningful. But you’ll likely find AI-generated content needs some human involvement to deliver the firsthand experience and personalization Google prioritizes.

Building the Foundation of Your SEO Content Strategy

For your content to rank well, it should meet or surpass reader expectations and outdo the pages already occupying the top spots in the search results. Build your strategy around the following components to tailor content to user queries and drive traffic to your site.

Target audience

The first step of SEO content writing is to know who you’re writing for. What are their pain points? Where do they look for information? Do they prefer short-form videos or in-depth articles? Align your content to your customers, and deliver your message in a tone that resonates. 

Industry niche

SEO content strategies vary depending on the industry. Research the keywords customers use when searching for products and services, along with the keywords your competitors target. Landscapers, event planners, plumbers, realtors, and automobile mechanics need to focus on local SEO. Businesses in the health and finance sectors that publish YMYL, or “your money, your life,” topics need to be attentive to quality and subject matter expertise, due to the impact their advice can have.  

Search intent

A good SEO content strategy focuses on keywords and the meaning behind them. Understanding search intent ensures you shape content to answer a user’s questions. For example, a cosmetics company targeting the keyword “moisturizer with retinol” should determine if someone using this phrase wants general information about the product’s benefits or already knows they want the product and are evaluating brands. A look at top-ranking pages or assistance from keyword research tools can help you determine search intent.

SEO specialist Lily Ray notes that search intent can shift, using the example of Barbie. Recently, movie reviews replaced general information about the toy at the top of the SERPs. 

The Doll movie

“A key strategy for handling intense shifts in search intent is to build content that serves every possible intent for your important keywords,” Ray says. “This may require different site sections, articles, videos, images, etc., that each serve a unique purpose for searchers.” 

Content clusters

Sites Google considers reliable sources of content tend to rank better. Build your site’s topical authority to establish expertise. Instead of targeting random keywords, build purposeful content clusters and explore topics in-depth. 

topic cluster example

Image Source: Semrush 

These content clusters serve as your website’s core and help you grow an inventory of content that continually demonstrates knowledge about a specific topic. 

Exceptional content

We’ve talked a lot about optimizing your website for Google, but it’s just as important to remember your content will be read by potential customers, business partners, and stakeholders. As mentioned earlier, focus your SEO content writing on original pieces that provide value to readers. Align your content with E-E-A-T guidelines and the objectives of the helpful content system.

Semrush’s 2024 Ranking Factors Study looked at the content of top-performing pages and found relevancy and quality correlated most strongly with higher rankings. On average, the top 10 ranked pages have 90.6% text relevance and a 76.9% content quality score. Keyword coverage came third at 67.8%. “Don’t waste your time obsessing over keyword count or updating content dates for the sake of making your content appear fresher,” the report advises. “Focus on the things that matter, which is creating content that covers its topic in a way that meets readers’ needs.”

ranking factor study

Key performance indicators

Set goals so you can track the impact of your SEO content strategy and refine your tactics to improve performance. Choose KPIs that reflect what you want to achieve — for example, the number of impressions can be a measure of brand awareness. Common metrics include traffic, keyword rankings, click-through rates, session duration, and conversions. Determine your benchmarks, and measure progress regularly. 

10 Steps to Create a Top SEO Content Strategy

Now that you know the ingredients of an impactful strategy, you’re ready to put the pieces together. Here’s how to create an effective SEO content strategy to land higher in search engine rankings and hit your business goals.

1. Understand your customers

The more precisely you know your target audience, the better you can tailor your campaign to meet their needs. This means understanding their needs, concerns, and motivations at each stage of the buyer’s journey. 

buyer's journey

Image Source: Ahrefs

For example, if you sell baked goods, determine if your audience is most interested in quality (organic), cost (affordability), or a solution to a problem (gluten-free). Create content to capture them at the awareness, consideration, and decision stages. 

2. Research keywords 

Once you identify who you’re writing for, perform keyword research to find the search terms they’re most likely to use. Sort the keywords into topic clusters and begin building an SEO content strategy.  

You’ll want a mix of head and long-tail keywords. For example, “artificial grass” is a head keyword that generates a high search volume, but it’s tough to rank for. You can aim for more precise long-tail keywords with lower search volumes. These keywords make it easier to gain visibility, such as “What are the benefits of artificial grass?”

Long-tail keywords also help you optimize for voice searches. People tend to be conversational when speaking to a voice assistant, saying, “What trees are native to Maryland?” instead of typing “Maryland trees” into a search engine. Similarly, while SGE is still at an early stage, the preciseness of long-tail keywords may improve your chances of surfacing in AI-driven searches.

research keywords

3. Plan your content

Look at your chosen keywords and choose the best format for each piece of content. 

  • Blog posts are simple to publish and can be outsourced to an SEO content writing service to help you scale output.
  • Videos are helpful for product demonstrations, how-to guides, tutorials, presentations, and fun behind-the-scenes content.
  • Podcasts give your brand a personal touch and enable you to bring in experts and leverage their audiences.
  • Infographics are a visual way to deliver information and are easily shareable.
  • E-books share valuable expertise and can be used to generate marketing leads when gated.
  • Case studies show customers how your product or service makes a difference.
  • Interactive content, such as mortgage calculators, quizzes, games, polls, and interactive maps, encourages user engagement. 

4. Create a content calendar

Use an editorial calendar to plan the content rollout. This helps manage workflow and ensures everyone on the team works toward the same goals. It also ensures you don’t miss out on seasonal marketing opportunities in your industry. 

Build deadlines into your calendar for writing, editing, and publishing, assigning each task to a team member. Prioritize pieces that focus on important core keywords first, and grow your content clusters later. 

If you don’t have the in-house resources to devote to content writing, consider a blog writing service to implement your strategy. Freelance writers can support your team when you need extra hands on deck or ensure a continuous output of content to steadily grow your blog.   

5. Ensure content can be crawled and indexed

Optimize each piece of content according to SEO best practices before you publish. Format content with headers, use metadata, add internal links, and ensure pages load quickly for desktop and mobile devices.

Remember, search engines can’t crawl webinars, videos, images, infographics, and other visual content. You can provide transcripts or written summaries to convey the meaning of content and help with indexing.

6. Develop an off-page SEO strategy

Complement your SEO content strategy by building backlinks from third-party sites that are respected in your niche. There are a few ways to create these links:

  • Share your expertise by publishing guest posts that link back to your site.
  • Partner with influencers or businesses that may have the same target audience.
  • Add your site to directories with local chambers of commerce or business associations.
  • Make new content shareable on social media.

7. Engage users

As your pages climb the search rankings, you should see an increase in organic traffic. Make sure those who land on your site have a great user experience. The site should be easy to navigate, visually appealing, and filled with relevant, interesting information. The more you engage users and the longer they stick around, the more likely you are to establish trust and brand awareness.

I am John quote: how to engage users

8. Track performance

Set goals for your SEO content strategy and track your progress toward achieving them. You can monitor the impact of specific campaigns and compare quarterly or annual performances. Use the data to build on successes or refine your approach if performance falls short. 

For example, if a page ranks well but isn’t generating click-throughs, you might need to rewrite your meta title and description to be more compelling to readers. If a page has a high bounce rate, the content might fall short of reader expectations. 

9. Understand the search landscape

Search engines are continuously updating algorithms and ranking factors to better serve users. Read up on SEO with Crowd Content’s blog, and ensure you’re following best practices. This helps you respond to changes in the search landscape as they occur and stay ahead of your competition.

10. Update content regularly

As the bar rises on quality SEO content, readers expect timely and accurate information when clicking through to sites. Regularly review your posts to ensure you’re providing the best information possible. Remove outdated information, use current statistics, and fix broken links.

Put Your SEO Content Strategy to Work

Whether your SEO content strategy involves blog posts, e-books, case studies, or landing pages, harness the power of Crowd Content’s skilled freelance writers. Our SEO content writing services deliver high-quality, publish-ready content to help you drive traffic and conversions. Ask us about our writing and editing services, and put your SEO content strategy into action today. 

The post How to Create a SEO Content Strategy for 2024 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What You Need to Know About Google’s Recent Update on AI-generated Content https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/google-recent-update-on-ai-generated-content/ Tue, 21 Feb 2023 19:56:02 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35620 We all know about OpenAI and ChatGPT – it’s become the fastest growing consumer application in history with over 100 million monthly active users in January. AI is here to stay and as content creators, we need to find ways to adapt to it. For many, the rapid growth of AI seems like the end […]

The post What You Need to Know About Google’s Recent Update on AI-generated Content appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
We all know about OpenAI and ChatGPT – it’s become the fastest growing consumer application in history with over 100 million monthly active users in January. AI is here to stay and as content creators, we need to find ways to adapt to it. For many, the rapid growth of AI seems like the end of original content as we know it – fortunately, I doubt that will be the case. In fact, the recent statement by Google seems to back up this opinion. 

On February 8th, Google released a quick statement around guidance on AI-generated content. Although this wasn’t a major algorithm update, there were some important takeaways that will give us potential insights into future updates and what Google will be focusing on moving forward. 

Below, I’ll go over some of my key takeaways and steps to take moving forward. 

Why is This Statement Important to Me?

This is something you might be asking yourself, so let’s quickly go over the importance of this recent update, and why future updates will be important to keep an eye out for. 

As someone who oversees the production of millions of words of content each month, ChatGPT’s capabilities definitely concerned me. Was this the future of content? Will human writers become irrelevant? How will this affect our business?

Albeit these were all fair questions to ask myself, I came to realize they were extremes. After using ChatGPT (as well as other AI tools over multiple years), the more likely reality is ChatGPT (and others) will become excellent tools for content creators and websites. They’ll make procedures more efficient, results more effective, and (hopefully) create higher quality content. 

I know this sounds counterintuitive to what ChatGPT currently does – we’ve all probably seen it churn out a low-quality, robotic-sounding article. But doing that isn’t the most efficient way of utilizing its capabilities. If you’re using ChatGPT to write an entire article for you based on a single command, you’re not utilizing it to its fullest ability. It’s like buying a yacht and sailing it around a pond. 

Just like any other AI tool that’s existed in the last decade, ChatGPT and other content-related AI tools will become great at assisting our processes. The recent statement by Google also seems to back up this point. 

Google Search’s Guidance About AI-generated Content

On February 8th, Google released a quick summary about how their search algorithm will be affected and react to AI-generated content. Although they don’t mention it directly, the timing of this seems to be an obvious response to the rapid growth and overwhelming popularity of ChatGPT. You can check out Google Search’s Guidance on AI here, but to save you some time, I’ll go over the key points and what we can learn from this below. 

Quick Summary: Google’s Response to AI-generated Content

  • As part of their policies to ensure websites are delivering people-first content, Google has always rewarded high-quality content that demonstrates E-E-A-T (expertise, experience, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness). This was specifically demonstrated through last years implementation of the Helpful Content System. This will continue to be a major point of emphasis for them moving forward. 
  • Creating content through the use of AI (i.e. ChatGPT) for the primary purpose of manipulating your rankings in search results is a direct violation of their policies (notice my emphasis on “primary purpose”).
  • Using some form of AI or automation to create your content is not necessarily considered “spam” or against Google’s policies. In some cases (sports scores, weather forecasts) and under the appropriate circumstances, the use of AI is acceptable. 
  • Despite the recent mainstream popularity of AI tools, such as ChatGPT, there are already systems put in place by Google to address and prevent poor quality content or misinformation from taking over search results (i.e. AI-generated content is not a new concept to them). 

What Can We Learn From This?

Anytime Google releases an update or statement around a change in policies, it’s never as direct as we want it to be – and that’s purposeful. Google will obviously never share the exact details of how search rankings are sorted – instead they give us guidelines and tips, such as their Search Quality Rater Guidelines. This ensures website and content creators aren’t manipulating search results, giving everyone an even playing field. 

With that being said, many times we need to ‘read between the lines’ so to speak. Here are my key takeaways from their recent response to AI-generated content. 

Google will continue to place more emphasis on E-E-A-T

The majority of content creators and site owners, specifically ones that focus on YMYL content, already understand how important E-E-A-T is and how much value it can provide. With the rising popularity of AI tools like ChatGPT, this might actually become the biggest factor in SERPs. Why? Because E-E-A-T is a great way for readers to understand and verify where their content is coming from, who it’s coming from, and how it was created. In other words, in a world where AI starts to become more prevalent, determining whether or not content is original (i.e. was it written by a human) and how accurate the information is (i.e. can I trust it) will become extremely important. 

In their response, they state “however content is produced, those seeking success in Google Search should be looking to produce original, high-quality, people-first content demonstrating qualities of E-E-A-T”. You actually don’t even have to read between the lines here – Google is clearly stating that it will always reward content that provides high value to readers (i.e. people-first content), and that ‘value’ comes from E-E-A-T. 

Utilizing AI is acceptable, but there are limitations on how to use it

Although it might come as a shock that using AI for content creation is acceptable under Google’s policies, there are strict limitations on how it can be used. Using it for the “primary purpose of manipulating search rankings” is directly against their policies. It’s important to emphasize this to illustrate that Google is not completely against AI or automation, and they shouldn’t be. AI has been used amongst content creators for years (Marketmuse, Ahers, SEMrush, Frase) to help assist in generating high quality, valuable content to readers. 

The key takeaway is to not use AI to generate high quantities of content to rank for a specific keyword, or keyword stuffing to manipulate search rankings through poor quality content. Here are some good questions to ask (these are directly from Google’s SEO fundamentals) which can help determine whether or not you’re using AI for the purposes of manipulating search rankings:

  • Is the content primarily made to attract visits from search engines?
  • Are you producing a lot of content on many topics in the hopes that some of it might perform well in search results?
  • Are you using extensive automation to produce content on many topics?
  • Are you just summarizing what others are saying without adding value?
  • Does your content leave readers feeling like they need to search again to get better information from other sources?
  • Did you enter a niche topic area without any real expertise, but instead because you thought you’d get search traffic?

If you answer yes, you need to reevaluate how you’re creating your content.

Google search is not banning AI or automation

As with almost any new technological advancement, the way we react to it and how it’s implemented in our daily lives is never simple … and neither is the implementation of AI. Banning AI and automation altogether may seem like the easy solution, but it’s not the right one. We know AI can be, and has been, used to assist in generating high quality content online, and it will continue to do so in a variety of ways. The question Google (and everyone in the online world for that matter) shouldn’t be asking is “how do we ban AI”, but rather “how do we implement AI in an ethical, useful, and valuable way to readers”. The goal here is to prevent spreading poor quality content and misinformation, while rewarding E-E-A-T policies. 

The 2010’s gave rise to social media, which has been an amazing tool in bringing people and information together throughout the world. It’s also had negative consequences (screen time, isolation, bullying, spreading of misinformation, etc). The biggest factor, in my opinion, that will need to be addressed in the 2020’s is how to ethically incorporate AI – and this is something Google will most likely be combatting over the next decade. 

How Can We Adapt to AI?

There are a number of ways to integrate AI and automation into your procedures, businesses, websites, etc. It’s less of a question of what you do, and more of how you do it. Many content creators are using AI to improve their brief creation procedures, perform better keyword research and topic ideation, or automating content that doesn’t require human interaction. You can also adapt by ensuring that you follow E-E-A-T policies – for example, creating content by subject matter experts, ensuring your content is fact-checked, or creating personalized video content. 

However you choose to move forward, know that AI will inevitably start to become more integrated into our daily lives, and adapting to that will become critical to those in the online space. 

The post What You Need to Know About Google’s Recent Update on AI-generated Content appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Is There an Ideal Blog Post Length for SEO? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-long-should-a-blog-post-be/ Mon, 13 Feb 2023 05:35:18 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35554 We’ve all heard chatter about what search engines deem the perfect blog post length, but is there such a thing? In short, no.  Still, length is an important consideration, and determining how much to write takes more than guesswork. If your posts are too short, it might leave readers wanting more, impact crucial SEO signals such as time on […]

The post Is There an Ideal Blog Post Length for SEO? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
We’ve all heard chatter about what search engines deem the perfect blog post length, but is there such a thing? In short, no. 

Still, length is an important consideration, and determining how much to write takes more than guesswork. If your posts are too short, it might leave readers wanting more, impact crucial SEO signals such as time on page, and diminish your authority. A post that’s too long can cause readers to lose interest — unless it’s packed with eye-catching visuals and captivating storytelling.  

Want to know how to work out how long a blog post should be? This article breaks down the factors that contribute to the ideal length of an article.

What’s the Ideal Length for a Blog Post?

Blog posts aren’t one-size-fits-all, and typically range from about 500 to upward of 3,000 words. Ideal article length varies based on your industry, chosen topic, and the angle you take. Let’s take a closer look at the contributing factors to blog post length.

How many words does it take to achieve the article’s purpose?

It sounds obvious, but the most important thing to consider when deciding how long to make a blog post is what you aim to achieve. Here’s what to consider:

  • Complexity: If the topic is intricate, explores multiple perspectives, or involves detailed instructions, you’ll need more words to provide necessary explanation and context. For instance, a post titled, A Complete Guide to SEO in Content Marketing will be longer than one called, Should I Use the Oxford Comma? Simple news updates, quick tips, and straightforward questions don’t require lengthy explanations. In these instances, it’s best to focus on clarity and expertise within a shorter word count.
  • Audience: If your target audience primarily seeks quick information, break your topics down into multiple shorter posts. On the other hand, invested readers crave thorough content that offers new insights and information. If your audience prefers in-depth exploration, longer posts with examples, images, and expert insights are more valuable.
  • Search intent: You have to decipher the intent behind common search queries in your niche to customize content length. For example, searches such as “what does target market mean” seek brief answers, while “how to tailor content to my target audience” indicates a need for a comprehensive guide.

A crucial point to remember is to prioritize value over bumping up word count. Adding unnecessary content or repeating information just to reach a target length inevitably weakens your blog post’s potential. Every sentence should be useful, compelling, and easy to understand so the overall piece enhances readers’ understanding of the topic.

Considerations for search optimization

Don’t listen to advice that tells you writing long articles automatically means you’ll rank high on search engine results pages (SERPs). Crafting long posts for the sake of word count alone won’t boost your visibility online. For instance, a poorly written 3,000-word post won’t outperform a well-crafted 500-word article that directly answers a user’s query. Prioritizing substance over a specific word count should be written into your content strategy in stone.

Longer posts tend to perform better not because of their word count but due to the factors that typically accompany them. Here’s what matters most when it comes to blog post length and SEO:

  • Dwell time: Well-crafted, lengthy blog posts encourage visitors to spend more time on your page. Increased dwell time signals to search engines that your content is engaging and valuable, positively influencing rankings.
  • Comprehensive coverage: Longer posts give you the luxury to explore topics in greater depth. This allows you to naturally incorporate your primary keyword and a bunch of relevant, long-tail semantic keywords. 
  • Backlink potential: In-depth articles are more likely to be shared and linked to by other websites. These serve as signals to search engines that your content is authoritative and trustworthy, boosting your rankings.
  • E-E-A-T: Google prioritizes content that demonstrates experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness. Longer blog posts showcase these qualities by covering a topic in its entirety with insights, data, multimedia, and examples.
  • User experience: While not a direct ranking factor, longer posts have the potential to improve user experience, indirectly bolstering SEO. Well-structured articles with headings, visuals, and clear formatting make it easier for readers to navigate the content and find the information they need.

Researching average word counts of top-ranking posts for your keywords gives you a concrete benchmark to aim for. Perform data analytics on your own posts and your competitors’ to determine the perfect length. 

Analyze your existing content 

When deciding on blog post length, it’s best to use data rather than assumptions. Your website has concrete data on what long and short mean for your readers. 

Pay attention to metrics such as:

  • Average time on page: This shows how long readers spend engaging with your content. If they spend a long time reading, it indicates that lengthier posts work well. On the other hand, if you notice drop-off points before they reach the end of the article, your posts are too long.
  • Bounce rate: High bounce rates on longer articles may signal they’re intimidating or don’t provide the quick answers readers seek. This might indicate a need for shorter, snappier content on certain topics.
  • Scroll depth: See how far down visitors usually read. If most people barely make it past the intro with longer posts, it signals you may need to tighten your content or focus on more compelling openings.

Analytics may show that your detailed guides generally see better engagement and lower bounce rates if they have higher word counts. For straightforward information or roundup posts, your audience might prefer a focused, quick-read format. 

Use analytics to customize blog post length strategically based on what works within your content marketing and SEO strategies. This data-driven approach will ensure you don’t write overly long or disappointingly short articles, and instead focus on delivering content that resonates with your audience.

What are your competitors doing?

Conduct SERP analysis to see what others in your industry are writing. Pay close attention to articles that cover similar topics — especially those already ranking high on search engines.

Das Writing Services shows you one way of doing it, but there are several approaches you can take. A good starting point is analyzing top-ranking results for your target keywords to see what format and length performs well for similar searches. 

Pay attention to:

  • Dominant lengths: Notice if there’s a clear trend in post lengths of top-ranking content. This gives you a starting point for what’s common in your industry and informs how much detail you need to add to be competitive.
  • Content quality: Don’t just focus on length — analyze the quality of the top posts. If shorter content ranks highly, it probably excels in other areas such as information density or exceptional writing. Taking a well-rounded approach helps you determine the length necessary to outrank competitors while maintaining quality.

Look for opportunities to stand out, such as:

  • Writing shorter posts in a sea of fluff: If the top results are lengthy and detailed, a well-written, concise post that captures the essence of the topic while adding something new could be a refreshing alternative for readers seeking a quicker answer.
  • Offering depth instead of superficial answers: Say your competitors’ content is superficial and lacks detail. In this case, aim to create a comprehensive, data-driven article. This can position you as an authority in your field and may outperform shorter pieces.

Conducting SERP analysis helps you find the optimal length that allows you to compete effectively while offering a valuable and differentiated perspective to your audience.

Who’s your target audience?

Your audience ultimately determines how much time they’re willing to invest in your content. Here’s how to adjust to different search demographics:

  • Busy professionals: If you cater to casual readers who juggle packed schedules, such as businesspeople or working parents, concise, informative posts and scannable content are more likely to keep them engaged.
  • Hobbyists and enthusiasts: An audience deeply interested in your topic wants to see in-depth analysis, detailed instructions, or multi-perspective long-form articles. They tend to appreciate more comprehensive discussions.
  • Casual scrollers: Readers who browse casually on mobile devices prefer shorter, visually engaging posts optimized for smaller screens.
  • Desktop researchers: If your audience is into in-depth research sessions, such as students or industry professionals, longer articles that dig deep into a topic could be ideal.

The bottom line? The key to determining blog post length is knowing your audience so well that you deliver content they find valuable, engaging, and informative.

The Benefits of Long-Form Blog Posts

Longer blog posts typically perform better in search results because they:

  • Deliver more value. Long-form blog posts provide readers with more value than short-form posts. They answer all the questions a searcher seeks, providing them with all the information they need in one place.
  • Demonstrate authority. These deeper dives can also help businesses cement their authority in a space, often giving potential customers the confidence to purchase products or services from the company.
  • Avoid keyword stuffing. Shorter posts often risk keyword stuffing to improve SEO. In longer posts, writers have the room to weave keywords in effectively, enhancing SEO without sacrificing readability.
  • Increase dwell time. Dwell time measures the time between when a visitor clicks through a search result to your page and when they leave and return to the search results. If visitors read most or all of a longer blog post, you’ll have a better dwell time, which could potentially result in a higher Google search ranking.
  • Get shared on socials. Readers may be more likely to share longer-form content on social media, which improves visibility and may attract more visitors to your site.

Although long-form blog posts have substantial benefits, you have to prioritize quality over quantity to rank high in search results. That means avoiding fluff and filler to make sure your content remains engaging and informative. If you can adequately say something in 500 words rather than 2,000, do it. 

Want to lengthen a blog post without sacrificing quality? Take a deeper dive into your chosen subject,add multimedia elements, incorporate expert quotes, and include updated statistics. Adding examples and insights delivers value for readers while encouraging them to stay on the page longer.

Are Blog-Writing Services Worthwhile?

Outsourcing blog content is a strategic move that yields significant rewards — when you work with the right people. Not all blog-writing services are equal. To maximize the return on your investment, select a content partner who understands your unique brand voice, target audience, and SEO goals. 

Ready to get serious about using content marketing to grow your business? Explore Crowd Content’s blog writing service. We become an extension of your brand, freeing up your valuable time and resources and delivering targeted content that drives results.

The post Is There an Ideal Blog Post Length for SEO? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Improve Your Search Visibility With SEO Content Writing Services https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/improve-your-search-visibility-with-seo-content-writing-services/ Wed, 01 Feb 2023 07:07:26 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35416 When your customers turn to Google for information, your website should appear near the top of search results. These coveted spots are key to attracting new audiences and generating sales. But to rise through the ranks, you need rich content optimized for both search engines and readers. Expert SEO content writers can help you build […]

The post Improve Your Search Visibility With SEO Content Writing Services appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
When your customers turn to Google for information, your website should appear near the top of search results. These coveted spots are key to attracting new audiences and generating sales. But to rise through the ranks, you need rich content optimized for both search engines and readers.

Expert SEO content writers can help you build a steady output of articles, blog posts and other content to boost your online visibility. In this guide, we’ll look at how optimized content helps achieve your business goals and the role SEO content writing services can play.

What Is SEO Content Writing?

SEO content writing is the creation of high-quality content that gives your site prominence in search engines. The content should use search engine optimization best practices for optimum ranking and be insightful and compelling for readers.

What Does SEO Content Look Like?

To land one of the top spots in the SERPs, your content needs to clearly satisfy a search query, cover a topic comprehensively and demonstrate that you’re a trusted, expert source. You can read more in our previous post about optimizing content for SEO, but here are some best practices to follow.

Incorporate Relevant Keywords

Each piece of content should focus on a different primary keyword. Most SEOs recommend placing the primary keyword in the title, the introduction, one H2, the meta title and the meta description. Primary and secondary keywords should also be used at least once naturally in the body.

Understand User Intent

Make sure your content answers a user’s query. For example, determine if someone who searches for “nutritious baby food”  is interested in ideas of what to feed a baby or actual products they can purchase. You can research user intent by entering the keyword into Google to see what kind of content is currently ranking. 

Write for the Reader

While you should optimize your site for search engines, don’t get caught up in the algorithms. Your SEO content marketing strategy is most effective when you write naturally for the reader and aim to deliver comprehensive, useful information. Readers should find value in your content and leave your site feeling their questions have been answered.

Make Content Easy to Consume

Readers should effortlessly understand your content, so be sure to edit for logic, flow and grammar. Write clearly, use multiple headings to organize content and make use of bullet points or lists. 

Guide Readers With Internal Links

Improve user engagement and experience by adding internal links to other sections of your site, such as service pages or blog posts. These links help direct readers to additional information they might be interested in to keep them on your site longer.

Build Backlinks

Inbound links from other sources demonstrate your site is trusted and contains useful content. You can earn backlinks through guest posts or reach out to other sites and ask for links from resource pages or business mentions.

Why SEO Content is Important

Every piece of content on your site is an opportunity for your business to rank in search results and be discovered by audiences. In this way, SEO content writing is an investment. As long as content is evergreen and optimized, it can remain on your site and continue working for you long after it’s published. Here are a few ways SEO content can help you achieve your goals.

Improving Search Visibility

When users plug a query into the search box, they may not know your business exists. If you can create content that readers find valuable and that Google determines is trustworthy, you can reach a whole new audience and increase brand awareness. 

Driving Organic Traffic

It’s worth it to aim high in search rankings. According to Backlinko, the top three search results generate half of the clicks on the page. On average, moving up a position improves click-through rates by almost 3%.

To help turn your high ranking into leads, use compelling meta titles and descriptions or add schema markup to your pages to create rich, visually appealing results. 

Establishing Topical Authority

To rank well, your site must be authoritative. One way to signal your credibility to Google is to demonstrate expertise, or topical authority, in your field. The more thoroughly you cover a topic, the more authority you have.

Expand your digital footprint for a topic by using SEO content services to publish regularly and create clusters of expert articles.

Improving Customer Engagement

Once customers arrive on your site, engage them with stellar content. Publish blog posts on interesting topics and create eye-catching infographics, free downloadable templates and other helpful content.

This is also an opportunity to gently lead visitors through your marketing funnel. You might link from a service page to a case study, for example, to demonstrate how impactful your business is. Or you can end a blog post with a compelling CTA and a sign-up form for a free consultation.

Building an Effective SEO Content Strategy

A good SEO content strategy begins with keyword research. You need to know what your customers are interested in and searching for so that you can tailor content to answer their queries. Once you have a list of keywords, begin planning the content and create an editorial calendar to roll out new posts. An SEO content service can help manage output. Here are some types of content you can outsource.

Blog Posts

Blog posts are an opportunity to incorporate keywords into your website and create compelling content. When you regularly publish blog posts, you give readers a reason to return to your site and build trust and engagement.  

Service Pages

Create a separate service page for each of your offerings. This gives you an opportunity to rank for different queries. A photographer, for example, could create individual pages for wedding, newborn and portrait photography. You can delve deeper into what each service provides, improving user experience and, of course, ranking for more keywords.

Local SEO Content

When your business relies on local customers, it’s essential to appear in searches that specify “in” or “near” your community. Local SEO starts with your Google Business Profile, which can be optimized to highlight products and services and provide mini-updates. But you should also create website content with a local angle. A fitness studio might publish a blog post on local running trails, and a landscaping company can provide tips on plants that grow well in the climate. 

Ebooks and White Papers

Long-form SEO content marketing, such as white papers and ebooks, helps you showcase your expertise in your field and drives interested customers to your site. Typically used by B2B companies, these assets provide readers with in-depth information about a problem or challenge. Ebooks and white papers should be based on solid research, provide actionable advice and focus on educating rather than selling.

According to a 2022 survey by the Content Marketing Institute, 67% of the most successful B2B content marketers incorporated ebooks and white papers into their marketing mix, compared to 56% of all respondents.

Product Descriptions

Customers looking for a specific product may not always know where they want to purchase from, so ecommerce companies need compelling product descriptions for every item in their stores. Product descriptions should incorporate a keyword and be as descriptive as possible to stand out in search results.

Category Pages

Include SEO content on category pages to help rank for other keywords. You can add a few paragraphs with an overview of products or tips on choosing the right one. A store selling rugs, for example, could create content for their outdoor rug category with information about different materials and how to care for the rugs. 

Leverage Experts and Influencers

Another way to drive traffic to your site is by focusing content on experts or influencers in your niche. You could interview them for a profile or mention their work in an article. This provides an opportunity for them to create a backlink to your page or share it on social media. Your page might also appear in Google searches for the person or company.

Guest Posts

A guest post is content that you create but is published on another site. Guest posts help raise brand awareness and expose your business to new audiences. These are often used as part of a link-building strategy, as sites usually permit you to add a link back to your site. 

Accomplish More With SEO Content Writing Services

It can be time-consuming to produce well-written, high-quality content. Streamline your efforts with Crowd Content’s SEO content writing services. Our qualified writers can create keyword-rich blog posts, landing pages and product descriptions to help engage your audiences and grow your traffic.

The post Improve Your Search Visibility With SEO Content Writing Services appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
10 Tips for B2B Copywriting That Converts https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/10-tips-for-b2b-copywriting-that-converts/ Tue, 24 Jan 2023 03:02:26 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35368 Discover ways to improve your B2B copywriting and create content that attracts attention and convinces business customers to work with your company. Boost Conversions With Better B2B Copywriting Copywriting is the heart of every content marketing strategy for B2B companies. The text bears a heavy burden when you’re ranking a business website or driving traffic with […]

The post 10 Tips for B2B Copywriting That Converts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Discover ways to improve your B2B copywriting and create content that attracts attention and convinces business customers to work with your company.

Boost Conversions With Better B2B Copywriting

Copywriting is the heart of every content marketing strategy for B2B companies. The text bears a heavy burden when you’re ranking a business website or driving traffic with online ads — it determines whether the reader takes the next step or bounces over to a competitor.

Whether you’re handling B2B copywriting in-house or outsourcing to B2B content writing services, concise, compelling copy is a surefire way to increase ROI and boost revenue.

What Is B2B Copywriting?

B2B copywriting is the process of creating written marketing content that’s targeted to business customers. It focuses on the unique needs and pain points of companies. Typically, in-house writers and B2B content marketing services use this type of copy to educate customers and promote their products.

B2B vs. B2C Copywriting

The difference between B2B and B2C copywriting lies in the audience; B2B copywriting is directed at businesses, while B2C copywriting targets individual consumers. This critical distinction affects everything from the tone to the calls to action. After all, businesses and consumers have dramatically different problems, budgets and timelines.

While B2C sales are typically about speed and convenience, the B2B process often involves educating customers and forming strong, long-term relationships. A single B2B sale can lead to years of repeat business, so communication is key. High-level copywriting is so valuable, in fact, that many companies opt to work with B2B content writing services to access professional writers on demand.

10 Tips for Successful B2B Copywriting

Whether you’re writing copy for a client or your own business, use these tips to sharpen your insights and tighten up your text.

1. Write to Buyer Personas

The people who read B2B copy might be administrators, purchasing managers or even business owners. When you understand exactly who you’re writing for, it’s easier to create effective, targeted copy.

That’s where buyer personas come in. These profiles describe a specific type of customer, giving you a clear picture of their buying process. It’s not unusual for companies to use multiple personas.

A buyer persona might include details about the customer’s:

  • Business priorities and needs
  • End goals
  • Decision-making timeline
  • Reporting structure
  • Challenges and pain points
  • Working environment
  • Age and gender
  • Communication preferences
  • Current solution

Buyer personas inform a laser-focused copywriting and marketing process. They also help you create B2B content ideas and build an editorial calendar that coincides with customers’ purchasing cycles.

2. Define a Target Channel

For each writing project, identify where the text will be published. Are you writing a Facebook post? Creating an informational article for the company website?

Your target channel drives the structure and content of your copy. An Instagram post needs an attention-grabbing hook and a short paragraph that creates a human connection. A sales page, on the other hand, is longer and focused on conversions.

Make sure to keep your buyer personas in mind as you’re selecting a channel and crafting text. This is particularly important when it comes to different generations. For example, Gen Z office managers and Baby Boomer technical sales directors often have disparate tone and platform preferences.

3. Focus on Benefits

When you’re writing for business customers, it’s critical to focus on the benefits your products or services offer. What value do you bring to clients’ companies?

If you’re selling accounting software to small businesses, you could explain that the payment reminders go out automatically, so managers don’t have to hassle clients about unpaid invoices. This strategy zeroes in on the client’s pain points and provides a quick solution.

It sounds simple, but many companies miss the mark. They focus on their own philosophies, processes and products but fail to address customers’ needs. Purchasing managers don’t have the time to connect the dots — they just want an effective solution.

4. Position Your Business as an Expert

B2B purchases can have a significant impact on a company’s bottom line. Given the high stakes, it’s important to position your business as an industry expert. The content, phrasing and insights should display a commanding knowledge of the field and the client’s needs. Your goal is to make the customer feel comfortable and confident putting a piece of their company’s operations in your hands.

The right vocabulary can go a long way toward establishing yourself as an authority. If you’re selling to hospitals, for example, you might use “census” instead of “the number of admitted patients.” They mean the same thing, but the former is more common among health care professionals. It’s a small, subtle touch that demonstrates insider insight.

Bear in mind that the people who read B2B content aren’t always subject matter experts, which means that your copy must walk a fine line. The content must clearly communicate your expertise, all without using jargon that alienates people in administrative and support roles. 

5. Get Clear on Your Brand Voice

Brand voice — the way a company’s personality shines through in text — sets great copy apart from the crowd. If you can capture your business’ unique character in the style and tone of your writing, it leaves a lasting impression.

A great brand voice should:

  • Align with brand values
  • Resonate with the target audience
  • Stay consistent across all customer interactions
  • Distinguish the business from competitors

6. Tell Your Brand Story

A brand story explains the history and importance of your company in a way that speaks to customers’ deep-seated beliefs and feelings. It goes beyond the facts on an “about us” page, capturing the essence of the business and explaining why buyers should care.

Compelling brand stories weave together facts and emotions. Legendary adventurer Yvon Chouinard founded Patagonia because he couldn’t find lightweight, functional climbing gear; Burt’s Bees arose from a love story between an off-grid artist and an eccentric beekeeper.This strategy capitalizes on the way humans respond and connect to stories. When you weave a narrative into your B2B content, it makes the copy more memorable and convincing.

7. Understand the Purpose of the Copy

Exceptional B2B copywriting is artfully relentless — every sentence and phrase moves the reader closer to a specific objective. Before you start writing, define the purpose of the content. It serves as a reference for everything from word count to word choice.

The most obvious B2B copy goal is to sell a product or service, but that’s just one option. It all depends on your business objectives. When you have an upcoming product launch, you might create copy that builds anticipation and awareness. If your company wants to strengthen existing relationships, your goal could be to help customers get the most value from a past purchase.

8. Make Customers’ Lives Easier

Once you’ve crafted a snappy, persuasive piece of B2B content, edit ruthlessly. Brevity and clarity are the hallmarks of powerful B2B copy. If you can express an idea in five words, don’t use 10. Likewise, stick short, focused paragraphs to keep readers’ attention.

Business customers are often juggling multiple projects and deadlines, so it’s important to get your message across quickly. To avoid an off-putting wall of text and make readers’ lives easier, you can:

  • Place important information higher on the page
  • Use tables and infographics
  • Break up text with headers and bullet points
  • Put key ideas in bold

Customers should be able to scan the page in seconds and understand the content in seconds. When readers can find the information they need quickly, they’re less likely to click the Back button.

9. Create a Clear Call to Action

When a potential customer finishes reading your copy, do they know what to do next? If not, it’s time to rethink. Every piece of content should have a clear call to action (CTA) that helps the reader engage further with your brand. In most cases, your CTA should be closely related to the purpose of the copy.

Possible B2B CTAs include:

  • Buy a product
  • Get a free quote
  • Schedule a consultation
  • Download a white paper
  • Join the email list
  • Chat with a representative
  • Read a related article
  • Connect on social media

10. Know When to Get Help

B2B copywriting takes both time and skill, which can present a challenge when you’re ready to scale. If your writing needs are beginning to exceed your capacity, it might be time to look into B2B content development services. Companies like Crowd Content work with large teams of experienced writers, so they can help you ramp up production quickly or tackle smaller projects that require specific expertise. To find out how our expert writing and editorial teams can streamline your company’s copywriting, contact us today,

The post 10 Tips for B2B Copywriting That Converts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Create B2B Content Ideas for Your Blog https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-create-b2b-content-ideas-for-your-blog/ Tue, 29 Nov 2022 17:11:21 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35245 If you want your business to rank well on search engines, your content must appeal to your audience and establish you as an expert in your niche. But effective B2B content marketing ideas aren’t always easy to come by. They must be intriguing enough to generate traffic, offer plenty of value so audiences stick around, […]

The post How to Create B2B Content Ideas for Your Blog appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
If you want your business to rank well on search engines, your content must appeal to your audience and establish you as an expert in your niche. But effective B2B content marketing ideas aren’t always easy to come by. They must be intriguing enough to generate traffic, offer plenty of value so audiences stick around, and distinguish your brand to drive results.

It’s a demanding task — but achievable. Below, we offer ways to get your creative juices flowing so you can generate impactful ideas for your niche. We explore content formats to attract customers and ways to source topic ideas. And because you need more than random pieces of content to make an impact, we discuss how to fuse your ideas with a solid content marketing strategy.

B2B Content Marketing Ideas: Where to Start

When creating B2B content, you target business decision-makers who are solving commercial challenges. These customers make decisions that can impact an entire company and need reliable, industry-specific information to grow their businesses. That’s why B2B marketing differs from B2C methods, which may incorporate influencer marketing or appeal more to emotions.

Blog posts are at the heart of most B2B content marketing strategies — and for good reason. They’re versatile and can be structured to cover a range of topics. But they’re not the only way to share your knowledge. If you’re looking for fresh B2B content ideas, consider expanding your marketing to include different formats. Publishing various content types makes your site more dynamic and appeals to different user preferences.

  • Case studies: Show the impact of your product or services and back it up with statistics.
  • FAQs: Make it easy for potential customers to find the answers to important questions.
  • Infographics: Present complex information visually to help customers understand topics and easily share content with their colleagues.
  • Augmented and virtual reality: Leverage technology to offer immersive and interactive experiences, such as product demos, virtual showrooms, and interactive 3D models.
  • White papers: Explore industry issues, and establish authority with in-depth analyses and thought leadership.
  • E-books: Share your expertise in a downloadable format that’s creative and visual.
  • Videos: Appeal to audiences who prefer to consume video content instead of reading.
  • Webinars and podcasts: Invite experts to discuss topics in an interactive format.
  • Glossaries: Define technical and industry terminology customers may not be familiar with. 

Finding B2B Content Ideas

To impress your audience with B2B topics for your niche, consider the information they need to do their jobs and how you can assist. For example, your content might:

  • Provide data to support decision-making
  • Summarize industry research or present your findings
  • Share information from presentations you made at conferences
  • Offer insight into industry trends and what you expect in the future
  • Provide tutorials, guides, and checklists to help them through a process
  • List tools to improve their productivity
  • Offer free templates to make their workflow easier
  • Give tips to enhance how they use your products or services
  • Provide tables and charts to compare products 

Your customers may also have specific questions; go to the source to see what they want to know. Conduct surveys, or ask your sales and customer care teams what questions and issues often arise. Visit online communities, such as Reddit, or listen in on social media conversations to discover what audiences are talking about. Analytics is an essential tool to see which marketing emails produce clicks and which pages on your website perform best. Round out your research with a content gap analysis to find missing key topics on your website that have the potential to generate traffic.

Where possible, leverage your firsthand knowledge, and provide real-world scenarios and examples in your content. This helps your website address Google’s E-E-A-T guidelines by demonstrating experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness. 

Successful B2B Marketing Begins With a Content Strategy

The right mix of content can drive traffic, build leads, and improve conversion rates, but it requires planning. The best way to brainstorm and harness ideas is through a content marketing strategy — it helps you create purposeful SEO content that satisfies your audience’s needs. Use the following tips to customize a B2B marketing strategy that guides your content production.

Identify your target audience and what matters to them

A successful content strategy is tailored to your core audience, so you need to understand your customers and produce content that caters to their problems. Before you nail down your B2B content ideas, reflect on your long-term goals, who you’re writing for, and the purpose of the content. Clearly understand what customers want to know at different stages of the buyer’s journey, and deliver exceptional content that answers those questions. 

Find out what competitors are doing

If you’re unsure how to make B2B content interesting, look into what your competitors are doing and how they’re ranking on the SERPs. Suppose you manufacture cloth made of pure cotton. Your direct competitors are companies that produce the same kind of cloth, and your indirect competitors sell other fabrics, such as silk or polyester blends. Essentially, these companies either sell identical products, variations, or replacements for your product. Chances are these competitors distribute content to rank for the same keywords and attract your target audiences. 

Competitive analysis is invaluable for planning your content. You can use tools such as Ahrefs and Semrush to understand what keywords your competitors are ranking for and the volume of traffic they’re getting. This gives you an idea of the content users are looking for and gaps in your competitors’ strategies. For example, if you have a SaaS product and competitors are talking about how to scale small businesses, you might go a step further to create content about common mistakes small businesses make when trying to scale. 

To draw in more customers, you also need a unique selling point. When creating content on common topics in your niche, highlight aspects of your business and topical authority that set you apart from your competitors. This helps you create an impression in your customers’ minds and gives them a reason to choose your company over others.

Incorporate cluster strategies 

A content cluster is a way of organizing content by theme. It uses a main pillar page as a gateway into the high-level topic, directing audiences to related, in-depth pieces. This strategy enables you to interlink your content to improve user experience and establish authority to boost your SEO.  

To create a content cluster, you need to conduct SEO and keyword research, determine your core pillar pieces, and decide on cluster articles that support those pillar topics. Once your content marketing ideas for B2B are in place, you can start writing high-quality blog posts and internally link them to each other.

Let’s look at an example of how this works.

Decide on a main idea related to your product or service. If you’re a content writing business, the customers who land on your page are likely looking for ways to upgrade their existing content strategy. So, let’s say your first pillar piece is about content strategy. You then create a list of overarching topics that cluster around this one. 

For example:

  • Does your content strategy make a difference?
  • 5 ways to create a solid content strategy
  • Common content strategy mistakes 
  • Should you hire a content writing team?

Once your topic cluster is ready, create a content brief for each article with subheadings to avoid repetition. Ideating content in this way helps you develop multiple ideas to cover specific overarching topics in more detailed chunks. AI platforms, such as ChatGPT, can assist with brief creation.

This clustering strategy also helps you push out more pieces of content that relate to each other and link back to a common, final destination — the conversion page of your website. 

Creating a cluster strategy

Developing compelling content clusters is simpler than you think. Follow this structure for an organized approach:

  • Pick a topic or a main idea.
  • Research keywords for that topic.
  • Audit existing content to see what you’ve already covered.
  • Chart out overarching blog ideas related to your topic and the high-ranking keywords.
  • Create content briefs and assign writers.
  • Link between articles in the cluster.

Emphasizing quality

Remember that a solid content strategy is only the first step. You also have to deliver quality content. Even if you identify relevant topics and use the right keywords, your content needs to provide value to the reader. Flesh it out with nuanced observations about your industry and back it up with statistics and research. 

If your strategy and content are in place and your customer clicks through your site, there shouldn’t be anything off-putting about your conversion page to cause friction. Make sure you have a good conversion offer, demo, or clear contact option. Minimize distractions or other links so visitors can maintain attention while buying your product or service.

In this way, content clustering can help you bring structure into your content marketing strategy and help you achieve your B2B content marketing goals.

Don’t forget brand marketing and positioning

Brand positioning is the impression people have of your business in comparison to your competitors. It’s what sets you apart and gives you a distinct place in your customers’ minds. But how can you position your brand using your content?

  1. Talk to your customers and find out their pain points. Find out what they’d like you to do differently, how you can offer more value, and why they chose you over a competitor. This gives you an idea of what you’re doing right and what you should improve. Your openness to feedback also creates a positive impression of your brand and shows you care about your customers’ needs.
  2. Promote your USP. Determine what sets your brand apart from others. Incorporate your USP into your content marketing and give your customers a reason to choose your brand over others in the market. Emphasize how you can help them and why they should trust your company over another.
  3. Let your brand voice shine. Is your company a startup that uses humor to appeal to audiences? Maybe it’s an established brand that conveys authority and expertise. Use tone and voice in your content to convey your brand’s message and shape how your customers perceive you.

Plan in advance

B2B companies that posted more than 11 times a month received 3.75 times more leads than those that posted a handful of times. That’s a lot of content to manage, but an editorial calendar can keep your strategy on track. Organize your B2B content marketing ideas, slot them into your schedule, and make sure nothing falls through the cracks.

We recommend planning content 6-8 months in advance, even if you only publish a few times a month. This creates a consistent output and enables you to align content with important occasions, such as product launches or seasonal events. Preparing your content in advance also allows time for research, writing, editing, and quality assurance, preventing sacrifices in quality due to rushed deadlines. 

Consider working with writers who understand SEO concepts. Outsourcing your blog can help you draw on fresh perspectives and quickly stock up your content inventory.

Revitalize Your B2B Content Marketing

If you’re trying to establish your company as a leader in the B2B space, a solid content strategy and high-quality content are essential. The focus should be on creating content that’s useful to your target audience and attracts organic leads to your business. At Crowd Content, we have the writers to set your content strategy in motion. Our talented B2B content marketing writers help you create blog posts, white papers, and SEO content that builds trust with decision-makers and boosts your business.

The post How to Create B2B Content Ideas for Your Blog appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
6 Tips to Scale Content for SEO https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/6-tips-to-scale-content-for-seo/ Thu, 29 Sep 2022 03:22:03 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=35023 Learn How to Scale Content Production to Blow Your SEO Traffic Through the Roof! Have you ever felt like you were stuck in a content rut? Delivering enough leads to create brand awareness and conversions regularly is your main priority. But you’re at wit’s end trying to maintain consistent blog output or keeping up with […]

The post 6 Tips to Scale Content for SEO appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Learn How to Scale Content Production to Blow Your SEO Traffic Through the Roof!

Have you ever felt like you were stuck in a content rut? Delivering enough leads to create brand awareness and conversions regularly is your main priority. But you’re at wit’s end trying to maintain consistent blog output or keeping up with the Joneses in ranking for certain keywords.

Sound familiar?

If you’re devoted to content marketing and SEO, you’ve experienced this conundrum. According to the Content Marketing Institute, 64% of marketers say their biggest knowledge gap is understanding the process of developing a scalable content strategy.

Okay, let’s be honest. You can never create enough content to stay 100% ahead of the never-ending buying stages of personas and their iterations or to keep up with the real-time changes in search-engine algorithms.

But that doesn’t mean it’s impossible to create great content to help you achieve your business goals—you have to get strategic about it. You can successfully scale content for SEO with a little elbow grease and the right approach while avoiding haphazard strategies or sacrificing quality.

First, understand why SEO should be a priority and how to make it work for your business. Second, you need a content strategy to scale as your business grows—without breaking the bank. Lastly, focus on creating quality content that attracts and engages your target audience.

We’ve got some answers to help you start making all that happen.

Before we jump in, let’s understand why scaling your content for SEO is crucial and how Google’s changing algorithms will impact your content strategy.

Why Is Scaling SEO Content Important?

Like most marketers, you probably create content for two reasons: to create awareness and generate quality leads. If you’re looking to scale your content for SEO, developing content that attracts more organic traffic from search engines should always be on your radar.

Why?

Because organic traffic is the lifeblood of any business; 51% of all visitors to B2B and B2C sites come from search engines and SEO-driven traffic SEO-driven traffic converts at 14.6% versus 1.7% for outbound advertising.

But Google’s algorithm updates in 2022 show that search engines are getting smarter. SEO is no longer about cramming in as many keywords as possible and hoping for the best. For instance, Google E-A-T (Expertise, Authority, Trust) assesses the quality of your site’s content in how well it demonstrates expertise, is written authoritatively and gains its audience’s trust. This means that marketers need to be more strategic in their approach to SEO to rank high on SERPs (search-engine results pages). 

Now that we’re up to speed, let’s explore some actionable SEO content scaling strategies you can use to make this happen.

The 6 Tips to Scale SEO Content to Crush Growth Goals

These six tips to help you scale content for your website will skyrocket organic traffic and help you hit your SEO goals.

  1. Keyword Research
  2. Create a Content Calendar
  3. Cluster Strategy With Content Pillars
  4. Set SEO-Content Goals
  5. Seek Out Subject-Matter Experts
  6. Outsource Your Content Production

1. Keyword Research

Before building a 12-month content calendar, take a step back and do your due diligence with keyword research. This is the first step in creating audience-centric and search-friendly content for the best topics to focus on.

Scaling scale content for SEO by aligning it with keyword research increases your SERP rankings, drives more traffic to your website and highlights your brand as authoritative in your industry.

Remember, search engines have evolved over the years to deliver the best results to searchers (search intent). And searchers are savvier and more articulate about what they’re looking for than ever before.

As a content marketer, focusing on context and search intents is essential to overall success. When growing your niche authority and scaling your SEO content, you’ll want to start by targeting longtail keywords. 

According to HubSpot research, 50% of search queries use longtail keywords. These are more specific keywords (usually lower search volume) than your main target keywords. For example, if you’re a travel website targeting the keyword “travel,” you might also want to target the following longtail keywords:

  • Travel tips
  • How to plan a trip
  • Best places to travel

In the long run, go after competitive keywords and phrases you can realistically rank for. Once you have a concrete list of target keywords, it’s time to start creating a content calendar.

2. Content Calendar

A content calendar is a roadmap for your content marketing strategy. It helps you plan, track and publish your content regularly, ensuring your content aligns with your business goals and objectives.

Let’s take a quick overview of how to create a content calendar for your SEO content scaling efforts.

The first step is to convert keywords into content topics. For each keyword on your list, come up with a few different content ideas that you could realistically rank for.

Next, create monthly topic segments or content campaigns around these ideas. These could be blog post series, ebooks, webinars, etc.

Once you have your topics and campaigns mapped out, start creating individual pieces of content. This is where you’ll need to get specific and fill in the details of your content calendar, like post titles, descriptions, target keywords and publish dates.

Delegate responsibilities to editors, writers and designers to help with the creation process. And don’t forget to include an SEO team member in the mix to ensure each piece of content is optimized for search.

When starting to scale content for SEO, having a schedule and process can avert content production bottlenecks and ensure each piece is of the highest quality.

3. Cluster Strategy With Content Pillars

To scale content for SEO, start by identifying your content pillars. These are the broad topics that you want to cover in depth. Once you have your pillars, creating a cluster strategy around each is doable.

A cluster strategy can be defined as creating a main piece of content (often called a pillar page) and then surrounding it with several supporting pieces of content (called cluster pages).  A cluster page on your website contains a wealth of information on a specific topic. It includes an overview of the topic, many blog posts and other resources that dive deeper into the subject.

Say you have a blog about travel. Your main content pillar might be “how to plan a trip.” The cluster strategy around this topic would be to create a pillar page on the same topic. You’ll then surround it with several blog posts covering specific aspects of trip planning, like budgeting, packing and choosing a destination.

Here’s a rundown of how to create a cluster strategy for your content:

  • Brainstorm a list of potential content pillars. You’ll want to cover these broad topics in-depth on your website.
  • For each content pillar, create a main piece of content (often called a pillar page). This could be an in-depth blog post, an e-book, or even a video series.
  • Create supporting content (called cluster pages) around each pillar page. These could be blog posts or social media posts that link to the pillar page.
  • Optimize each piece of content for your target keywords. This will help you rank higher in search results and get more traffic to your website. It’s always best to carry due diligence if you want to learn how to optimize content for SEO.
  • Increase exposure for your content by promoting it on your social media channels and other online platforms. This step drives even more traffic to your website.

The advantage of using a cluster strategy is that it allows you to cover many keywords with less content.  And because you’re linking between the different pieces of content, Google can easily understand the relationship between the topics. This can ultimately help improve your search engine ranking.

4. Set SEO-Content Goals

Your SEO content strategy is the backbone of your scaling efforts and will help determine what types of content to create, how to optimize it for search, and where to publish it. But SEO is an arduous and ever-changing process, and if you don’t have specific goals, it may not be easy to measure your success. 

Here are steps to set SEO content goals:

  • Define your target audience. Who are you reaching out to with your content? What are their needs and wants? What type of content do they prefer?
  • Research your target keywords. What terms and phrases are your target audience searching for? What are your competitors ranking for?
  • Set realistic goals. Don’t bite off more than you can chew. Start small and gradually increase your content output over time.
  • Track your progress. Use tools like Google Analytics to keep tabs on your traffic, conversions, and key metrics over time. 
  • Promote your content. Once you’ve published your content, promote it through social media, email marketing, and other channels.

The beauty of SEO is that it’s an ongoing process. As you continue to produce and promote high-quality content, you’ll see your traffic and conversions increase.

5. Seek Out Subject-Matter Experts

It’s crucial to ensure that each piece of content is of the highest quality if you’re looking to scale your content for SEO. That’s why it’s important to seek out subject-matter experts (SMEs) who can provide insights and perspectives that will add value to your content.

These topic-based specialists are well versed in their respective fields, such as marketing, design, or development.  When you involve them in your quest to scale content for SEO, you can achieve new levels of depth and insight that would otherwise be unattainable.

How Do You Find SMEs?

Start by looking within your organization. You might have a wealth of experts at your fingertips. You can also reach out to your network of contacts and see if they know anyone who would be a good fit.

Once you’ve found a few potential SMEs, reach out and ask if they’re interested in contributing to your content. If they are, work with them to develop a plan for their involvement. You could work with them to:

  • Write a guest post
  • Record a podcast episode
  • Give an interview
  • Create a video tutorial

Their depth of knowledge can make your brand more credible, authentic and trustworthy—all of which are essential for scaling your content for SEO and developing trust with your audience.

6. Outsource Your Content Production

As much as you’d like to keep the whole content marketing in-house, it’s not practical to do everything yourself. At some point, you’ll need to outsource certain aspects of your content production.

This could include hiring freelance writers and a full-fledged marketing agency. Finding partners you can trust to produce high-quality content that aligns with your brand voice and messaging is important.

While it all depends on your needs and marketing budget, here are factors to consider when outsourcing your content:

  • Quality: Can they produce content aligned with your current standards? Do they have a good understanding of your brand voice and messaging?
  • Quantity: Can they handle the volume of content you need to produce? Do they have the necessary resources in place?
  • Cost: What’s their price point? If you’re working with an agency, are they transparent about their pricing?
  • Communication: Do they respond to your emails and calls promptly? Communication can make or break an otherwise great working relationship, so it’s important to ensure that you’re on the same page.

Outsourcing can be a significant boon to your content marketing efforts, allowing you to scale your production without sacrificing quality.

Scaling SEO-Content With the Experts

Quality content may not be the easiest route to successful marketing, but it’s surefire. As more brands vie for attention online, the importance of quality content will only grow.

Scaling content for SEO is a chance to set your brand ahead of the pack by establishing yourself as a thought leader in your industry.

If you’re looking to take your business to new heights, consider outsourcing SEO content writing services that can help you produce high-quality, keyword-rich content assets you need to drive traffic and conversions.

The post 6 Tips to Scale Content for SEO appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Write a Great Social Media Post https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/how-to-write-a-great-social-media-post/ Mon, 29 Aug 2022 02:28:32 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=34831 For many people, engaging with brands on social media is a part of everyday life. This presents an opportunity for companies to position themselves in front of both current and potential customers. Whether you’re targeting other businesses or marketing directly to consumers, your social media posts can help your audience get to know your company […]

The post How to Write a Great Social Media Post appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
For many people, engaging with brands on social media is a part of everyday life. This presents an opportunity for companies to position themselves in front of both current and potential customers.

Whether you’re targeting other businesses or marketing directly to consumers, your social media posts can help your audience get to know your company in an informal, no-pressure environment. That’s why it’s crucial for online businesses — or any company that maintains an online presence — to understand how to write a social media post that catches and holds the attention of their target audience.

Why Writing Good Copy for Social Media Is So Important

Learning how to write a social media post for your business takes practice, but great content can be an integral part of an online marketing strategy — and for good reason. Social media platforms let you reach a large audience within seconds without breaking the bank.

By getting the right copy in front of your target demographic, you can potentially reap numerous benefits, including:

  • Lead generation
  • Increased brand loyalty
  • Higher conversion rates
  • Improved customer satisfaction
  • Enhanced brand and product visibility
  • Insight into customers’ likes, values and interests
  • More accurate metrics for marketing and advertising campaigns

Social Media and SEO

It’s also important not to underestimate the importance of social media in SEO. Although social media posts don’t directly impact search engine optimization, they can influence it in other ways. For example, social shares, likes and comments may signal to search engines that you’re providing useful content to your target audience, which can ultimately influence rankings. This can increase your brand’s visibility and help generate organic traffic to your website.

What Makes Social Media Copy Great

Although each company’s approach to creating content for social media may differ from others in the space, great social media posts typically have several key attributes:

  • They entertain
  • They inspire engagement
  • They’re attention-grabbing
  • They’re easy to digest

However, what defines great social media copy is likely to change depending on the platform, and what works for LinkedIn may not be ideal for Twitter. 

How to Make a Tweet Stand Out

The key to writing great tweets is keeping it short and conversational. Although Twitter permits up to 280 characters per tweet, the sweet spot is typically closer to 100 characters, including spaces.

Twitter is also a hotbed of hashtags, so give your tweet context and promote engagement by including relevant hashtag phrases. Just be sure to limit yourself to one or two, and keep them short. If you aren’t sure where to start, Twitter offers free tools for monitoring trending conversations and events, which can help you keep your brand current and relevant on this crowded platform.

Using Facebook to Your Advantage

Facebook remains popular across numerous age groups and demographics. However, because users’ feeds tend to be cluttered and change quickly, you won’t have much time to attract attention, so it’s important to keep posts short, sharp and clear. Many Facebook users access the platform from smartphones or other handheld devices, so optimizing your content for mobile is crucial.

When creating Facebook posts, avoid industry jargon and marketing speak, which can negatively impact content in the platform’s algorithm.

Facebook users have come to expect visuals, so include creative elements, such as eye-catching photos and videos, with your posts. Just be sure not to use overused stock images, which can be off-putting to customers.

Building Authority Through LinkedIn Posts

As a professional networking platform, LinkedIn is useful for positioning your business as an authority on a subject. Consequently, great LinkedIn posts often contain business or career advice, intellectual property or links to crucial press releases.

Many successful LinkedIn posts also use mentions (which begin with the @ symbol) to tag influential or notable connections. This can increase your reach if the mentioned person shares or comments on your content. And, if you’re interested in presenting long-form content, you can also benefit by learning how to write an article on LinkedIn.

How to Write Social Media Posts That Capture Your Target Audience

Because most social media platforms are crowded with content, you’ll have to compete for attention. By learning how to make social media posts pop, you can cut through the noise and help your brand stand out. Fortunately, writing catchy social media posts isn’t difficult. By following these basic social media content writing tips, you can write posts that stand out from the pack:

  • Know your audience. Understanding your target audience is a crucial step in creating relevant, attention-catching social media posts. Although knowing your target audience’s age, income range, and educational background is crucial, you should also understand their needs and likes. Fortunately, many social media platforms, such as Facebook and LinkedIn, provide free analytics to help you learn more about your audience’s online behavior.
  • Be intentional. Before you write a social media post, you should know what message you want to send or what result you hope to achieve. Great posts ultimately reflect your intent, whether that’s highlighting a product, improving your brand’s reputation, or driving traffic to your website.
  • Use a consistent voice. Your writer’s voice reflects your vocabulary, tone and syntax, and a strong voice can make you uniquely identifiable. By developing a clear, relatable voice that’s consistent across platforms, you’ll influence how your audience views your business.
  • Add personality. While being professional is important, using a casual tone that highlights your personality lets your audience see your business as friendly, relevant and approachable.
  • Don’t waste words. In today’s fast-paced world, time is a commodity. Keeping posts short, simple and catchy demonstrates an understanding and respect for your readers’ time.
  • Never create clickbait. Sensational headlines or hooks are great, but any linked content must live up to the hype. Otherwise, you’re creating clickbait, which is a major red flag for a potential customer.
  • Edit and proofread. Editing and proofreading to minimize errors and clarify your message should be a standard part of your writing process. Even a single typo can convey carelessness and diminish your credibility.

What Should a Social Media Post Include

Regardless of the platform, most effective social media posts contain some key components. If you want to create copy that draws and keeps a reader’s attention, incorporate these vital elements.

The Hook

Your post’s first sentence or phrase, known as the hook, is often your best chance of drawing in readers. A good hook should pique a casual browser’s interest so they stop scrolling. Fortunately, an eye-catching hook doesn’t have to be difficult to write if you incorporate one or more of these elements:

  • Headlines: A great headline creates promise, enticing potential readers to continue.
  • Fascinating facts: Lead with an interesting fact about your chosen topic. Besides catching a reader’s attention, an interesting fact can define you as a reliable source of information.
  • Strong statements: Set an authoritative tone for your post by hooking readers with a strong opening statement. Try statements that are intriguing, compelling or polarizing for added impact.
  • Great quotes: Inspiring, controversial or insightful quotes are a great way to introduce a post. They can evoke an emotional response and convince a follower to continue reading.
  • Metaphors and similes: Hook readers by inspiring them to look at a topic differently. Good metaphors and similes can surprise and delight an unsuspecting social media user.
  • Open-ended questions: Start with an open-ended question to get people thinking. Questions naturally keep followers reading because they want to discover the answer.

Valuable content

When you provide valuable content, your social media posts are more likely to be read, discussed and shared. However, what defines valuable content can vary by reader, industry, platform and whether you specialize in B2B or B2C products and services. 

Valuable content may be original or curated and can include:

  • Giveaways
  • Industry insights
  • Educational content
  • Career or business advice
  • Inspirational stories
  • Tips for product use
  • Links to unique articles
  • Inside information on your company
  • Solutions for pain points
  • Previews for forthcoming products or services

Links

Interesting links can drive traffic to your website and may even improve its SEO. You can increase the chance of click-through by using relevant anchor text and/or enticing, accompanying images.

Don’t just link to your homepage, though. Link deep to specific pages and posts on your site. By using deep links to direct readers to specific pages, you can draw attention to product information, exclusive offers and other value-added content.

If you aren’t using anchor text, make sure visible URLs are clean and concise. Long URLs take up space and can look suspicious, so it’s important to convert them to shortened or branded links. URL shorteners, such as Ow.ly or Bitly, compress or customize URLs, optimizing them for social media.

Hashtags

Hashtags, which begin with a # regardless of platform, are words and phrases that identify a post’s topic or theme. They help people follow online conversations and find interesting or relevant content, particularly from accounts they don’t follow.

To effectively incorporate hashtags in your social media posts, remember:

  • Hashtags don’t use spaces, symbols or punctuation marks, so if you need to include more than one word, just mash them together. 
  • Hashtags should be simple and easy to remember.
  • A blend of trending, branded, popular or industry-relevant hashtags can have more impact. 
  • Avoid choosing only overused hashtags, as your post may get lost in the sheer amount of traffic they generate.

White Space

Because white space is essentially the empty space around your content’s other elements, it may seem odd to consider it a crucial component of a social media post. However, long walls of unbroken text can be off-putting to even diehard followers. Posts that incorporate plenty of white space are usually more readable and easier to navigate. Plus, when used well, white space can draw attention to important aspects of your content, such as brand messaging or calls to action.

Creating white space can be easily accomplished by:

  • Shortening sentences
  • Aligning text
  • Incorporating bulleted or numbered lists
  • Using plenty of line breaks
  • Limiting paragraphs to two or three sentences

Visual Elements

Although not every social media post should or will contain visual elements, images are an effective tool for drawing attention. The right image can also provide context for your words, evoke emotions and ensure your brand stays in readers’ minds long after they’ve read your post. 

When choosing a visual element for your post, make sure to complement the tone, message and intent of your content. Options include:

  • Photos
  • Artwork
  • Video clips
  • Memes
  • Cartoons
  • GIFs
  • Animation

When including creative content in your posts, always use copyright-free images or material that you own, and make sure the resolution is compatible with the platform.

A Call to Action

A call to action is a prompt that invites the reader to take a recommended action. Although a CTA isn’t essential, or even relevant, for every social media post, in the right context it can cue a follower to take a crucial next step, such as:

  • Claiming an offer
  • Answering a question
  • Visiting a landing page
  • Subscribing to a newsletter
  • Requesting information
  • Ordering or preordering a product
  • Connecting with your business on other channels

Outsourcing Your Social Media Posts

Learning how to write for social media can help you broaden your business’s reach and connect with your customers, and it doesn’t have to be a chore. In fact, your audience can usually sense when you’re trying too hard, and the most engaging social posts are often written when you relax and let yourself have fun.

However, writing for social media isn’t for everyone, and that’s okay. If it’s time to refresh your content strategy, why not give professional content writing services a try? Connect with Crowd Content’s network of talented writers for compelling content that gets results.

The post How to Write a Great Social Media Post appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Create an Inbound Lead-Gen Machine With Content Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-create-an-inbound-lead-gen-machine-with-content-marketing/ Mon, 22 Aug 2022 06:41:51 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=34777 You’re trying to grow your business but your sales team can only scale so many new outbound calls and outreach emails per week. Or maybe you’ve hit a wall with your online ads. Or you’re pumping out content but it feels rudderless (“is anybody actually reading these?”). You know you have to diversify your different […]

The post How to Create an Inbound Lead-Gen Machine With Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
You’re trying to grow your business but your sales team can only scale so many new outbound calls and outreach emails per week.

Or maybe you’ve hit a wall with your online ads. Or you’re pumping out content but it feels rudderless (“is anybody actually reading these?”).

You know you have to diversify your different marketing channels and dive more into inbound marketing, but where to start?

How can I leverage my content marketing to hit all the right notes and start turning my marketing operations into a lead-generating machine?

Let’s dive into inbound lead generation and the best ways to optimize content for inbound marketing so you can hit your metrics out of the park—without overburdening your sales team.

How Inbound Leads and Content Marketing Work Together

First, let’s make sure we’re on the same page about what we mean by inbound leads.

An inbound lead is any lead who finds your business via your marketing collateral and then they come to you. An outbound lead, by contrast, is someone whom you approached.

Inbound leads typically show an interest in your business and want to learn more about your products or services.

Whether they fill out a contact form on your website or sign up for a free trial, they are extremely valuable—because they form the base of your prospective customers.

Therefore, if you want to grow your sales, generating more inbound leads is essential. But how does content marketing fit in?

Simply put, people must find you in the first place to reach out. And then you need to motivate them to reach out once they do find you by piquing their interest.

To make your business discoverable and your selling propositions intriguing, you need content.

Potential inbound leads want information—information about how you can resolve their pain points or provide them with a benefit.

And information is what content provides. Content is info that people can find and consume. This is how you turn visitors into leads, leads into prospects and prospects into customers.

If you sell software to other companies, for example, you’ll see results by investing in B2B content creation that will enable you to promote your value propositions to leads.

Maybe you want an ebook to explain the nuances of productivity software to demonstrate your expertise in using tools for saving time.

Or a blog post that shows off benefits of your sales software to better manage pipelines when potential inbound leads search “how to better manage my pipeline.”

When you leverage content marketing, you set yourself up to transform your operations into a lead-generating machine.

What Is Inbound Lead Generation?

Inbound lead generation is the process of attracting prospects to a business and nurturing their interest. It’s how you turn a lead into a paying customer.

Although every company uses unique lead-generation strategies, the process usually follows the same basic steps:

  1. Someone finds a business via its website, social media accounts or other marketing channels.
  2. They take a desired action, such as clicking a link to download a free ebook.
  3. The link leads to a landing page on the company’s website.
  4. The visitor provides their contact information in exchange for the ebook or some type of offer to turn into a lead.

To ensure people find you and to nurture them down this path, optimizing your content so that it provides value for their needs is invaluable.

Optimizing Your Content for Inbound Lead Generation

What is content optimization? Optimizing content means to write, format and update content to make it both as accessible and as valuable to your target audience as possible.

There are lots of content-optimization tools to make your content as strong as it can be, but you should also deploy your content as part of a holistic website strategy for lead generation. 

Rather than sticking a few links on a page and calling it a day, you need to be strategic about your content-optimization efforts.

With content optimization, you have more opportunities to attract inbound leads. Let’s look at the different aspects of content to pay attention to for more inbound leads.

Website Forms

You can tweak website forms to generate more leads. For example, place forms “above the fold” so website visitors see them before they scroll down.

Remember that potential customers have screens of all sizes, from smartphones to large monitors, so not everyone can see the same amount of content before they scroll.

And pay attention to messaging for best results.

Research keywords for the content on pages where forms live to attract search engines and use language that captures the attention of your target audience, especially in calls-to-action.

And some visitors hesitate to turn over their names and email addresses. Make it easy for them to part with their information by adding a statement like “Unsubscribe at any time” at the bottom.

Finally, leave plenty of white space around each form. If a form is surrounded by text and graphics, it can be difficult for a visitor to focus on the content and the offer.

White space makes it much easier to understand the text and decide about taking the desired action.

You could also add a signup form as an overlay that appears when users first arrive at your site. Just make sure it has a simple, hard-to-resist call to action and a visible way to exit.

Wherever you use forms, make sure they’re easy to find again if someone who previously opted out changes their mind later.

A/B-Testing

A/B-testing is a type of performance testing that presents two versions of a page to different visitors so you can gather data to see what version works better.

And improving content is a great benefit of A/B-testing. This will allow you to leverage content to generate more inbound leads as you split-test which page elements are more effective.

Titles, images and page layouts are examples of variables you can test.

The key is to focus on one variable each time you conduct this type of test. Testing multiple variables makes it difficult to isolate what increased conversion rates.

Most testing softwares allows you to run small tests. For example, if Option A gets better results than Option B, iterate on A to create a new variation, Option C.

When you test Option C against Option A, you’ll probably only show it to a small percentage of your potential leads, so you won’t lose the progress you’ve made.

The goal is to create small incremental changes to boost performance over time.

Website Metrics

Pay attention to website metrics that show how visitors interact with your site to identify areas of opportunity with your content for improved lead generation.

Here are a few metrics to check:

  • Bounce rate: If someone visits your website and leaves without looking at other pages, then they “bounced” away. Typically, people bounce when they look at the page and think it isn’t interesting or relevant. If you have a high bounce rate, tweak your content to make it more engaging and relevant to your target audience.
  • Average time on page: The average time visitors spend on your website pages helps determine the type of content they find most valuable. It can also signal potential  inadequacies in your site structure or page-naming conventions—people who quickly move from page to page are likely searching your site for something specific.
  • Traffic sources: To optimize your content for lead generation, it’s essential to understand where most of your traffic is coming from. Suppose you see hundreds of visitors coming to one of your pages from an educational resource. In that case, you can tweak your content to make it more educational or update it to answer questions that weren’t addressed on the referring page.

Landing Pages

Landing pages are standalone pages where people “land” when clicking on a link to your website.

For example, if you offer home-repair services in Florida, you might have landing pages known as location pages with content unique to home services in Florida cities.

You can optimize these landing pages for inbound lead generation with the following tips:

  • Improve the headline on each page. Make it more exciting or relevant to your target audience.
  • Edit landing pages to match the expectations of people looking for your products or services. Provide value by answering their queries, such as questions they would ask to solve their pain points. And where did they come from? Design landing-page content to tailor the stage of the buyer’s journey your website visitors are in.
  • Make sure your form length is appropriate for the size of your landing page and strikes a balance between the amount of information you need to collect and your potential leads not feeling overwhelmed or demotivated to fill out too many fields.
  • A/B-test to determine which version of each landing page is the most effective.
  • Overcome objections immediately with your content.

Calls-to-Action

A call-to-action is a request for a visitor to take a desired action. “Click to subscribe” and “Sign up for updates” are generic example CTAs.

You can optimize your CTAs for lead generation in the following ways:

  • Make the copy as straightforward as possible. Don’t make visitors wonder what you want them to do or what they’ll get if they do it. Spell out the offer and tell people precisely what action to take, whether it’s clicking, calling or downloading a free trial.
  • Don’t rely too much on overly descriptive text. “Start Your Free Trial” can work sometimes but isn’t particularly compelling. “Get More Sales Today” speaks to a benefit if, for example, you sell sales-enablement software.
  • Use design best practices to make it clear visitors are supposed to click the CTA. For example, you may want to have the text change color when the visitor hovers over it.
  • Don’t let your CTA get lost in the background. Put some white space around it to draw the visitor’s eye and make it clear you want them to take action.

Generating Leads with Content Marketing

Quality content is a critical aspect of your marketing strategy. Content attracts people to your website and convinces them to become leads.

You can produce content in house with the proper resources or optimize efficiency & scalability by outsourcing content marketing.

But whatever path you choose, know that turning your operations into a lead-generating machine to attract more inbound leads to grow your revenue is impossible without content.

These are some of the most common ways to generate leads with content marketing.

Case Studies

If you’re trying to generate leads for a B2B business, publishing a case study is a great way to get more people to visit your website.

A case study typically describes a business problem and explains how one of your customers used your company’s products or services to solve the problem.

One of the main benefits of a case study is that it subtly suggests to the reader that your company has the expertise needed to meet their needs.

You can also include a strong CTA at the end of the case study to encourage readers to set up a discovery call or get in touch with your sales team.

Ebooks

Ebooks work well for both B2B and B2C businesses. If you work with B2B customers, they help the reader solve a problem or learn a new skill related to your service.

For example, an accounting firm would benefit from publishing an ebook on how manufacturing firms can reduce labor costs.

Or if you target consumers—perhaps you sell jewelry—you might want to publish a guide to caring for precious metals and gemstones.

Templates

Offering free templates can convince visitors to give you their contact information, making it easier to turn them into leads.

If you’re targeting designers, for instance, you may want to provide a basic infographic template or give visitors access to a set of color palettes that can help them with their design projects.

Free Courses

Free courses are ideal for sharing your expertise with other people and making them more confident in your ability to solve their pain points.

For example, if you sell math tutoring, you could offer a free course on using specific methods for math problems.

People who sign up for your course would then be exposed to your other offerings, such as tutoring for the math portion of the SAT or video courses on passing core math exams.

Surveys

If you sell to B2B customers, offering access to survey data is a great way to convince website visitors to give you their contact information, turning them into leads.

The Society for Human Resource Management and other industry organizations do this regularly, positioning themselves as a helpful resource for potential customers.

Checklists

Checklists are easy to create and many visitors find them valuable. This type of content benefits those who can provide step-by-step instructions for completing tasks.

For example, a professional organizer could offer a checklist to clean out a pantry or organize a bedroom closet.

Start Getting More Inbound Leads With Better Content Marketing

Successful inbound-lead generation starts with high-quality content. If you don’t have the time or expertise to create articles, landing pages, blog posts and more, Crowd Content can help.Expert, vetted writers from content creation services develop content uniquely for your audience so you never have to write again while your inbound-lead metrics blast through the roof!

The post How to Create an Inbound Lead-Gen Machine With Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How Much Does a Ghostwriter Cost for Business Writing? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-much-does-a-ghostwriter-cost-for-business-writing/ Tue, 26 Jul 2022 08:06:20 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=34633 Content marketing drives your business. Companies leverage content to build their brand, generate sales and nurture leads. But producing content at scale takes time. According to data, it takes over four hours on average for businesses to write a blog post—an increase of 67% over a seven-year span! Ebooks can take twice as long as […]

The post How Much Does a Ghostwriter Cost for Business Writing? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content marketing drives your business. Companies leverage content to build their brand, generate sales and nurture leads.

But producing content at scale takes time. According to data, it takes over four hours on average for businesses to write a blog post—an increase of 67% over a seven-year span! Ebooks can take twice as long as they are usually more custom and in-depth.

And many business leaders publish books to establish authority in their field and boost their company brand. If a blog post takes four hours, imagine how long a whole book would take!

That’s why finding a business ghostwriter is key to scaling content marketing. Outsourcing content to a ghostwriter frees up time to focus on strategy, and business ghostwriting services enable marketing departments & executives to increase output.

You first need to figure out how much it costs to hire a business ghostwriter. With so many factors impacting ghostwriting costs for businesses, how do you sort all this out?

And what are the benefits of business ghostwriting to weigh against costs? Without understanding both sides of the equation, you can’t calculate investment returns.

In this post, we’ll overview what business ghostwriting is all about, what criteria influence costs and how to optimize the efficiency of ghostwriting.

Once you master the ins & outs of the costs of ghostwriting on your business and how to turn those costs into an investment, you can improve your content marketing to increase traffic and convert more leads.

Or maybe publish that industry book to (finally!).

What Is a Business Ghostwriter?

Business ghostwriting is when you hire an external writer to write blog posts, ebooks or business books while you retain writing credit.

Simply put, you’re paying an expert writer to write your content marketing for you. This helps you save time and create content at scale.

Ghostwriters create content of all types, from 300-page business books to short blog posts designed to promote a product or service.

Business ghostwriting services are ideal when determining how to grow your business using content marketing because content development is a core principle of content marketing.

Successful ghostwriters come from a variety of professional backgrounds, from software developers who write technical manuals to creative writers who can connect with customers.

In other words, with the right team of business ghostwriters, you can solidify content production processes to improve your overall content marketing, get more leads and increase sales.

How Much Does a Ghostwriter Cost on Average?

The cost for a ghostwriter depends on many factors, such as what type of content you need, how long each piece needs to be, and how much research the project requires. A ghostwriter may also charge more if you ask them to include images, hyperlinks, and other content elements.

For example, business ghostwriting starts at $5,000 per book, according to wWriting coach Lisa Tener. If a ghostwriter charges hourly, the cost of a book could be between $30 to $200 per hour, depending on the project’s scope. Per-word rates for this type of work typically range from $1 to $3.

Book ghostwriting can be costly because of the prestige associated with publishing a book people can buy at a bookstore and hold in their hands. Other types of projects cost much less.

According to the American Writers & Artists Institute, professional writers typically charge at least $450 to create the home page for a website and $250 to $750 for an information page, which may include how-to guides, buying guides, and product reviews. 

Case studies typically cost $1,200 to $2,000, according to the Professional Writers’ Alliance, while white papers cost anywhere from $2,000 to $10,000.

Of course, these are just averages. Ghostwriter costs across all types of projects fall into a few pricing structures:

  • Per-word pricing
  • Flat-rate pricing
  • Hourly rates
  • Per-project rates

Per-word pricing

Ghostwriting rates per word vary dramatically — from 1 cent to several dollars. These prices factor in both the writer’s experience and the specific project.

For example, it’s common for writers to charge more per word for projects that require a lot of research. You’ll also incur additional costs if you need your ghostwriter to interview people or watch lots of video content to get a feel for your brand.

While there’s no set rate across the board, you can expect to pay 5-10 cents per word for simple blogs and general web content written by entry-level ghostwriters. A writer with a few years of experience may charge upwards of 20 cents per word, and subject matter experts or technical writers command an even higher premium.

You’ll also pay more if you need an ebook or white paper. Creating an ebook can cost businesses at least 50 cents per word, depending on quality and research requirements, while a white paper requires a budget of up to $1 per word. Both types of content can easily cost you thousands of dollars, but they also showcase clear authority to cement your position within a niche.

Flat-rate pricing

Some ghostwriters use a flat-rate scale, where you’ll pay a specific amount for content up to a certain number of words or per page. This payment structure usually gets cheaper as the word requirement increases, so it’s better than straight per-word pricing for businesses needing long-form content.

While ghostwriting rates depend on the writer’s skill level, you should expect to pay about $50 to $75 for a 1,000-word blog post written by an entry-level professional. In comparison, expect to pay up to $250 for a blog of this length if you engage the services of more experienced ghostwriters.

Hourly rates

Like per-word rates, hourly ghostwriting prices vary considerably, depending on the type of content and the experience of the individual writer. For example, the median hourly rate of a copywriter is $28, but this rate ranges from $25 to $31. 

Copywriters handle various types of marketing writing and related content, which is often an ideal match for businesses. However, general content writers typically charge a few dollars less per hour and can handle blogs and the most basic forms of website copy. Again, expertise plays a significant role in these prices.

Unless you’re looking to hire an in-house ghostwriter, you generally won’t encounter hourly rates as often as per-word and per-project fees. 

However, accepting an hourly rate may be advantageous if you’ll need your ghostwriter to attend several meetings during the planning and publishing process. This way, you can cover the extra work without negotiating it into the project as a separate payment.

Per-project rates

Per-project ghostwriter fees make the most sense for anything that isn’t a simple blog post or web page because they allow your ghostwriter to factor in all the additional work required, such as SEO, image sourcing, and research.

This pricing structure is also ideal for social media posts and emails, since these types of content require extra planning and creativity that a per-word rate won’t cover. Social media content costs up to $10 per post, while emails may cost up to $50, jumping much higher for long lead-generation pieces.

Expect to pay about $400 for a 2,000-word blog post, $50 to $100 or more for product descriptions (depending on the length and complexity), and around $1,000 for a landing page. Additional requirements will add to these costs, but the benefit of a per-project rate is that you know how much you’ll need to pay upfront before you accept the contract.

How Successful Businesses Use Ghostwriting Services

You may be wondering how to use a ghostwriter.

Leveraging ghostwriters enables you to optimize cost-efficiency while scaling output and maintaining quality all at the same time.

And with bylines and writing credit, you retain your brand’s authority over your area of expertise. It’s a win-win!

While there are four main types of ghostwriting content: website copy, ebooks & business books, fiction and memoirs, businesses focus mostly on web content like landing pages, blog posts, ebooks, and business books.

Content for business ghostwriting services

  • Landing pages: Business ghostwriters can write keyword-rich landing pages with compelling calls to action, helping you generate leads or convert your existing leads into paying customers.
  • Blog posts: When you want to educate your target audience and demonstrate SEO authority, blog posts are a go-to. Ghostwriters deliver well-researched posts to engage audiences and increase your traffic and conversions.
  • Ebooks: Think of ebooks as middle-of-funnel collateral for your content marketing. Users can download these mini-books as part of the lead nurturing process to move through your sales funnel. Ebooks are usually longer than blog posts, so it’s vital for the writing to flow well. Professional ghostwriters can write ebooks from scratch or take existing blog content and repurpose it for you.
  • Business books: If you’re a growing business and want to establish a professional reputation in your industry, authoring a book is an excellent way to accomplish this goal. But writing a book can be incredibly time-consuming. A ghostwriter can alleviate the burden of researching and writing your book, giving you time to focus on the business.

Leveraging business ghostwriters where possible in your content marketing strategy can save you a lot of time.

Advantages of Hiring a Business Ghostwriter

Ghostwriters can help you achieve flexibility and reduce the cost of your content marketing efforts. They can also bring third-party knowledge and experience to the table to increase the quality of your content.

Time savings

As a business owner, you have to juggle everything from marketing and customer service to bookkeeping and inventory management. You may not have enough time to research and write the content necessary to help grow your business.

On the other hand, large companies may want their employees to focus on product development, customer service, and other roles, leaving little time available to create a content marketing plan and consistent production schedule. Outsourcing content production to ghostwriters can help you publish consistently without dedicating much time to content creation.

Cost savings

When you hire a full-time writer, their salary or hourly wage is only one of your costs. You may also need to offer benefits, pay extra taxes, and cover the cost of a new computer or other equipment the writer needs to do their job. These costs add up quickly, especially for small businesses. When you have a writer on your payroll, you have to cover these costs regardless of whether you need content.

Ghostwriter services are less expensive, since you only pay for the content you receive. You don’t have to cover the cost of their computer equipment or internet access, pay any extra taxes (since they’re responsible for their own taxes), or worry about finding space for them in your office. As a result, working with a ghostwriter can save you a significant amount of money.

Of course, you can also leverage both types of writers. Hiring a ghostwriter can maximize your in-house writing team’s performance by allowing them to focus on time-sensitive tasks and your most important pillar content.

Increased flexibility

If you hire a full-time writer, they may not have experience writing every type of content you need. You could get around this problem by employing part-time writers with different skill sets, but then you’d have to find space and purchase equipment for both of them.

A better alternative may be to hire different ghostwriters for each type of project. For example, you’d work with a business book ghostwriter if you wanted to publish a book. Then, you’d work with a second ghostwriter if you needed a case study or white paper. This gives you a tremendous amount of flexibility.

How to Hire a Ghostwriter

If you’re ready to take advantage of all the benefits of business ghostwriting, you have two options.

The first is advertising online, screening applications, reviewing work samples, and conducting interviews until you find the right ghostwriter for the job. If you go this route, set aside plenty of time for reviewing samples — you’ll want to find someone who can write in your preferred tone and keep your target audience engaged.

The second option is to seek an agency with many business ghostwriters available for immediate work. Working with an agency eliminates the need to advertise, screen applications, and conduct interviews, freeing up a lot of your time.

If you work with an agency, you can also request a business ghostwriter with experience writing about your industry. Writers with niche expertise will communicate the value of what you offer and match Google’s desire for topical authority.

Start Growing Your Business with Ghostwriting Services

If you’re ready to learn how to grow your business with content marketing, contact a business ghostwriter today. To make hiring a writer even easier, partner with a company that works with qualified ghostwriters who are ready to take on projects of any size. 

At Crowd Content, we make it simple to find freelance ghostwriters for hire. We also have a team of SMEs who can review your content to ensure it demonstrates the expertise and authority Google loves.

The post How Much Does a Ghostwriter Cost for Business Writing? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
6 Common Copywriting Mistakes That Hurt Content Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/copywriting/6-common-copywriting-mistakes-that-hurt-content-marketing/ Tue, 12 Jul 2022 11:11:05 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=34474 How Mistake-Free Copywriting Impacts Content Marketing and Which Copywriting Mistakes to Avoid Picture this. You’re writing a blog post, a social post or copy for a product page. You want it to perform well to scale website traffic and revenue, but how do you know your copy will hit the mark? Will people care or […]

The post 6 Common Copywriting Mistakes That Hurt Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How Mistake-Free Copywriting Impacts Content Marketing and Which Copywriting Mistakes to Avoid

Picture this. You’re writing a blog post, a social post or copy for a product page.

You want it to perform well to scale website traffic and revenue, but how do you know your copy will hit the mark? Will people care or will they indifferently move on?

You might think online attention spans are short and getting shorter, making it difficult to seize people’s attention with content copywriting.

Some studies say human attention spans have decreased by almost a third during the internet era, exacerbating the job of content marketers.

But it turns out that shorter attention spans is a myth. Attention spans are too task-dependent and too influenced by circumstantial expectations to be a reliable metric.

Why then do audiences pay so little attention to your content marketing? Copywriting for conversions is difficult, but not because of shorter attention spans. Successful conversion copywriting is challenging because of information overload and more competition.

If readers bounce from your content, you probably rambled, your brand messaging didn’t captivate or you committed a common copywriting mistake.

For content marketers who need to drive traffic, woo potential leads and boost conversions, the pressure is on! But stagnant copywriting will impede your content marketing goals.

Thankfully, with the right eye, you can spot the mistakes that turn content with potential into a waste of copywriting resources and the reader’s time.

We’ll outline the importance of copywriting for content marketing and six common copywriting mistakes to avoid so your content wows audiences and drives conversions through the roof!

The Importance of Copywriting for Content Marketing

There are few strategies as impactful on conversions, engagement and loyalty as content marketing. Content marketing builds trust by providing value without asking for compensation.

Great content creates memorable experiences for potential leads. If your articles or posts educate and enthrall leads, they’ll trust you and become more likely to convert into a customer.

Hence why strong copywriting is vital for content marketing. Words sway people, and all content requires copy. To scale content marketing, you need to become a content copywriter.

What Is a Content Copywriter?

A content copywriter applies copywriting best practices to content marketing to reinforce brand messaging and make audiences care about what they’re reading.

Let’s break this down! Content marketing is the strategy of creating and distributing content like articles and posts to attract and engage leads. Copywriting is the art of crafting written content to knock your audience’s socks off so they take action.

But don’t you want your content marketing to knock people’s socks off too?

People crave connection to what you’re saying. Does your content merely answer queries and promote your brand, or does it go further and move your audience?

You need to make your content “people-first content” with mistake-free copywriting. Tell stories that potential leads can relate to and use language that enraptures them.

A content copywriter leverages brand messaging, emotional language and product copy in their content marketing to improve traffic and conversions. It’s that simple.

If longform content doesn’t command attention the same way a billboard advertisement does, the strength of the writing otherwise and the research you put into the content won’t matter.

Therefore, you can’t afford to overlook common copywriting mistakes in content marketing! Let’s review six copywriting mistakes to avoid to benefit your bottom line.

Common-Content-Copywriting-Mistakes-Content-Banner

6 Common Content Copywriting Mistakes to Avoid

As a content marketer—or, more precisely, a content copywriter!—you want to make your content copywriting shine!

Here are common copywriting mistakes to avoid:

  1. Messaging that doesn’t move your audience.
  2. Using the passive voice.
  3. Non-conversational writing that’s all about “me.”
  4. Too much fluff.
  5. Bad or no formatting.
  6. A failure to test your content.

1. Messaging That Doesn’t Move Your Audience

The biggest mistake brands make in content marketing is not employing clear messaging as part of a story to establish connections with people.

Storytelling is an important aspect for both B2C content marketing and B2B content creation; no matter your audience, all potential customers are people first who just want to feel connected.

Check out the below blog-post intro from the B2B-software company Gong.

Common-Content-Copywriting-Mistakes-Bad-Messaging
Storytelling-based messaging is not just essential for B2C brands but B2B ones too. When you give readers a reason to care with your content copywriting, that’s how they’ll keep reading.

Even though they sell complex technology to business professionals, they set up a narrative (with a pop-culture reference no less!) to hook their readers.

This tactic exemplifies what makes a great copywriter: great communication skills with people.

But to connect with your target audience—to influence and entice them towards your products or services—you need to understand them.

In short, your content should demonstrate that you’ve identified the following about your target audience:

  • Emotional pushes (i.e., what causes them problems)
  • Emotional pulls (i.e., what attracts them to a solution)
  • Present habits (i.e., what they are currently doing or not doing)
  • Solution anxieties (i.e., what might worry them if they break their habits)

Let’s go through an example.

Take a web-design agency that caters to local-service businesses, like landscaping companies.

  • Push: They work hard so they don’t have time to market their business more.
  • Pull: They want more leads to increase revenue.
  • Habit: They’re floundering with an outdated website.
  • Anxiety: They know how their website works and besides, what if their investment goes down the drain?

Here’s a potential intro for an article on “marketing tips for a landscaping website”:

So you want to dominate the neighborhood and become the top landscaper in town?

But you work so much running your business, you worry your website isn’t pulling its weight to make this a reality and you don’t have the capacity to do anything about it. Your website has gotten you this far, but now you’ve hit a cap so it’s time to take things to the next level.

To grow your landscaping business, your website needs to work as hard as you do to become a lead-generating machine. Let’s look at some surefire tips to make this a reality!

By framing the website as working hard like them, you appeal to their entrepreneurial pride (hard work) that explains the push (not enough time), while implying the consequences of keeping their habit (they’re floundering if their current website isn’t working as hard as it could).

Plus, a “hard-working website” both alludes to the pull (if it works hard, it will generate more leads like a “machine” so they can “dominate” and “grow”) and alleviates anxiety (if it works hard, you won’t have to update it as much and it will pay for itself).

You now have a story, leading the reader on a journey where they identify as the audience with messaging that intersects their desires & pain points and your products or services.

Content copywriting with strong messaging is key to content marketing success.

2. Using the Passive Voice

Good copywriting energizes, engages and stirs people into action. It should be direct and to the point. Most importantly, good copy is crystal clear and never confuses readers.

The quickest way to undermine good copywriting is to write in the passive voice.

In the passive voice, the verb acts on the subject. It makes a phrase sound more odd and disconnected than necessary and it stutters your copy.

Take this sentence, for example: Our product is loved by our customers because of its simplicity.

The active voice flips things around so the subject performs the verb’s action. It’s more lively, energetic and clear, and it turns a passive sentence from clunky to spunky.

Like this: Our customers love our product for its simplicity.

A fast way to identify the passive voice is to look for to be and its variants (am, are, been, being, is, was and were). These verbs lack confidence and detract from more engaging verbs.

Remember in the introduction the sentence, “Why then do readers pay so little attention to your content marketing?”

In the first draft of this post, that sentence read, “So why then do audiences seem to spend so little attention to your content marketing?”

“Seem to…” devalues the stronger verb “spend” (later replaced by “pay”) and makes you sound hesitant. It also inflates your word count!

Fixing the passive voice quickly improves content marketing.

3. Non-Conversational Writing That’s All About “Me”

Brands take varying approaches with the tone and voice of their content, ranging from a knowledgeable voice and an even tone to a more casual vibe.

But all good content copywriting has one thing in common: it’s conversational.

To nurture lifelong customers and make them raving fans of your business, your copy should have the same cadence that a message from a friend would.

Read your content out loud to test for conversationalism. If it flows more like a friendly conversation and less like reading a microwave’s instruction manual, you’re on the right track.

But be wary of advice like “write like you talk,” which itself is a common copywriting mistake.

Why? Because people talk based on unedited thoughts from their head. Copywriting expert Erica Schneider says to think of conversational writing as “relaxed writing.”

A relaxed tone comes naturally when you stop talking at your readers and start conversing with them.

Want an example? Check out this above-the-fold messaging from an agency’s website:

Common-Content-Copywriting-Mistakes-Non-Conversational-Example
If your copywriting is all about yourself, why should readers care? This common copywriting mistake of not conversing with your audience leaves a lot of conversions on the table.

“We are” this. “An expert team” of that. “Get to know us”!? Yuck.

The “Me, Me, Me” tactic is a great example of a copywriting mistake because it underscores the value of focusing on what you can do for leads.

Conversational content copywriting is all about the “you”; making it about “me” is lazy and ineffective.

For instance, here copywriting expert Grace Baldwin hits the nail on the head about the importance of writing to customers about them instead of at them about you.

Trying to sell leads on your greatness will get you nowhere. (Unless of course, you’re selling the world’s best cup of coffee!)

Common-Content-Copywriting-Mistakes-Speaking-About-Me

4. Too Much Fluff

Ever read a paragraph and thought, “Well that was a lot of words”? I’ll bet dollars to donuts you didn’t even remember what the paragraph was about.

Crafting conversational copy that connects with your readers is foundational to good writing. And nothing stops the flow of a conversation quicker than fluff in writing.

All too often, writers hope to dazzle readers by filling their prose with industry jargon and complex language, only to alienate their audience with fluff. 

Wait, let me try that again.

Filling your prose with industry jargon and complex language to dazzle readers will alienate them instead.

That’s better. Let’s move on….

If you find your writing is stuffed with superfluous words that belabor the point or ones that don’t make sense, you’re likely covering for your own lack of clarity.

Simply slow down and make sure you understand what you’re talking about. This usually happens in the editing process.

What are some tips to avoid this common copywriting mistake of fluffy writing?

  • Watch out for extra verbs.
  • Avoid explanations that are implied.
  • Eliminate filler terms.

Let’s look at some concrete examples of each.

Watch Out for Extra Verbs

You must make a connection with your readers to increase conversion rates.

Are you trying to write about consumer debt for a fintech company but don’t know where to start?

Many business owners aren’t aware of new LinkedIn features or how to best use them, leaving them struggling to expand their reach to new customers by not exploring their options.

“Must.” “Trying.” “Leaving.” “Expand.” What’s going on here?

Some ideas are complicated, we get it. But you can boil all sentences down to three elements: Subject > Verb > Object. There’s no need for more than one verb per clause if you can help it.

Adding extra verbs to a sentence is an example of a common copywriting mistake because it lacks confidence, increases word counts and indicates you probably need an editor. Here are ways to fix these problems:

Connect with your readers to increase conversion rates.

Are you writing about consumer debt for a fintech company but don’t know where to start?

Many business owners aren’t aware of new LinkedIn features or how to best use them. Instead, they struggle to reach new customers by not exploring their options.

Avoid Implied Explanations

Delineation is extremely valuable when referencing industry buzzwords, but rarely welcome in all other circumstances.

If you’re padding your points with additional context that tells the reader something already obvious or that they already know, your content copywriting will tire them out.

This seems simple, but writers overlook this copywriting mistake frequently, because it even creeps into microcopy on a sentence-by-sentence basis when writing first drafts.

Consider the following example:

Can you imagine a competitor not in your space? What does that even mean?

Eliminate Filler Terms

What are filler terms?

Filler terms are words or turns-of-phrase in sentences when trying to get thoughts on paper but which don’t add any value to readers.

They bloat your writing, hurt your content marketing goals and make your readers more likely to bounce from your articles or blog posts.

Remember the sentence a couple subsections ago, “All too often, writers hope to dazzle…”?

Yeah, “All too often” was lazy filler. That’s why I cut it and rearranged the syntax to later lead with “Filling your prose….” Much better, no?

Some examples of filler words include adverbs, “in order to” and “the fact of the matter.” Instead, leverage action verbs, mitigate adjectives and avoid clichés.

Are there exceptions to these rules? Absolutely!

It all comes down to context. For instance, I used the word “absolutely” even though adverbs are usually a red flag, but not to qualify an adjective or verb. And even then, strategically placed adverbs to modify other words can sometimes be effective if they grab attention.

Use your discretion and always put yourself in the reader’s shoes.

5. Bad or No Formatting

Potential customers want copy that engages, entertains and informs. They don’t want to slog through monotonously formatted paragraphs that hurt their eyes.

Format content to reflect the nature of the medium. Did you know that the average person spends 37 seconds reading a blog post? That’s insanely disheartening for content marketers! Don’t chase readers away with walls of text.

Here’s how to make content scannable, easy to digest and pleasant to read:

  • Break up topics with headings and subheadings;
  • Include interesting points and facts as bullet points; and
  • Embed relevant images or video content to visually compel readers (and as a bonus, multimedia content adds authority to your article, showing you’ve done research to back up your points). 

And don’t forget to format paragraphs themselves. The flow of your writing is just as important to the visual and hierarchical structure.

Common-Content-Copywriting-Mistakes-Format-Copy
A demonstration of formatting your content copywriting with creative variety to grab readers’ attention.

Rhythm, syntax, vocabulary and more all comprise flow that helps define copy-formatting. Lacking diversity of these elements is a major copywriting mistake to avoid.

6. A Failure to Test Your Content

No matter how well you write, there’s still a subjective element to great copy.

You simply can’t know if a piece of content works until you put it out there. To succeed, you need great content copywriters with strong intuitions about what works and what doesn’t.

That and testing your content.

Creativity is an inherent part of copywriting, but there’s no reason to leave your marketing results to chance.

A/b-testing, readability testing and even studying analytics are all crucial to optimizing content copywriting and to mitigate mistakes.

Want to test two different headlines, introduction sections, taglines or more against each other? Check out a free tool like Google Optimize!

Want to double-check the grammar, flow, readability and more of your content copywriting? Try Grammarly (freemium) or Hemingway Editor (free)!

Want to cross-reference your content with traffic or conversions to see what content types work well and which pieces are most profitable to optimize? Google Analytics!

Leaving content stagnant, not analyzing it and not testing it are the low-hanging fruits of common copywriting mistakes. Pick those fruits and your content marketing will thank you!

How to Avoid Common Copywriting Mistakes to Blow Past Content Quotas

Writing, in general, is deceptively simple. Anyone can form words into sentences, sentences into paragraphs and so on. But crafting words that connect, engage and sell is another matter.

Remember, people don’t pay less attention to business content than they used to. Instead, it’s tougher to compete but also never more important.

Content marketing is vital to improving your marketing metrics, spreading your brand and delivering more qualified leads. But you can’t succeed without great copywriting that’s on-message, well-tested and written confidently, conversationally, jargon-free, succinctly and more.

That’s what content copywriting is all about!

But even when you know the rules of good copywriting, scaling your output and committing additional time you don’t have are new challenges altogether.

High-quality freelance copywriter services deliver on all these notes, without any of the mistakes that can hold your content down.

Supercharge your content with managed services and now your content strategy might be the envy of other marketers!

The post 6 Common Copywriting Mistakes That Hurt Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Write an Article on a LinkedIn Company Page https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/article-writing/how-to-write-an-article-on-a-linkedin-company-page/ Fri, 17 Jun 2022 05:16:09 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=34297 Want to grow your brand? Learn the ins & outs of how to write a good LinkedIn article to publish on your company page to win more leads!

The post How to Write an Article on a LinkedIn Company Page appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
The Benefits of Publishing an Article on LinkedIn May Surprise You

When Amanda Natividad, VP of Marketing at SparkToro, published content on LinkedIn and compared the data to Twitter, the results were a lot of “fun.”

Surely us fellow content marketers can have fun too!

What kind of fun did Natividad experience? Well, their LinkedIn publication earned over 913,000 impressions and almost 13,000 engagements in just five days.

That beat Twitter by almost 1,136% and 381%, respectively!

What happened? Is there a discrepancy between follower counts? Well, yes, but not in the obvious direction: over 94,000 on Twitter and less than 9,000 on Linkedin.

Natividad’s observation reinforces what a lot of content marketers have seen: LinkedIn is one of the most-trusted social media platforms for businesses.

With this foundation of trust, LinkedIn’s organic reach is more wide-ranging than other platforms—there’s a big demand for content that users don’t value on Facebook, Twitter, et al.

And articles on LinkedIn are unique as they allow you to write content similar to blog posts to help your business build its brand and establish expertise.

Yet many business owners aren’t aware of the article-publishing features on LinkedIn or how to best use them. Instead, they struggle to reach new customers and grow their audience.

But why should you write articles on LinkedIn? And how can you write a good LinkedIn article?

We’ll cover how to write an article on a LinkedIn page, the benefits of publishing on LinkedIn and tips for writing a good LinkedIn article so your content gets the attention it deserves!

Writing Articles on LinkedIn: An Overview

Before you learn how to write a good LinkedIn article, it’s important to understand the difference between an article and a post (also called a status or update).

LinkedIn posts are short messages that appear directly on LinkedIn feeds.

Articles are longer-form content shared as posts, where the post itself serves as a caption, but the article is available on its own page via LinkedIn’s publishing platform, LinkedIn Pulse.

Which Is Better: LinkedIn Articles or Posts?

Are LinkedIn articles better than posts? It’s a trick question because LinkedIn posts are completely different from LinkedIn articles.

First, the character counts for LinkedIn posts vs. articles differ. LinkedIn caps posts at 1,300 characters—or around 200–300 words on average if you include spaces (LinkedIn does). 

In contrast, articles get a max 125,000 characters. That’s more than 17,000 words on average.

We’re definitely not suggesting you use all that space for every article. Most people on LinkedIn don’t have time to binge-read novellas.

But you can definitely convey more—and more complex—information in an article on LinkedIn than you can in a post.

So LinkedIn articles are great in helping you demonstrate expertise and promote brand awareness.

When to Use LinkedIn Posts

  • Publish regular content to LinkedIn to increase awareness
  • Share links to your own posts or information you find interesting or want to comment on
  • Introduce a new staffer, business partnership or product
  • Share business news or accomplishments
  • Ask for client or consumer feedback
  • Highlight your company’s philanthropy or other efforts related to mission or corporate social responsibility

When to Publish LinkedIn Articles

  • Share expertise with other LinkedIn members via longer content
  • Drive awareness of your brand, services or products by creating content other people are likely to share
  • Educate your audience, such as with how-to articles
  • Create content likely to drive conversions to demonstrate your expertise or help people better understand the purpose & benefits of your products

What Are the Benefits of Publishing an Article on LinkedIn

Are LinkedIn articles a valuable use of time?

Yes.

LinkedIn articles complement blog posts because they offer another medium to revamp and repurpose your longform content.

You can also use LinkedIn articles as previews of what’s on your website.

Plus, with LinkedIn, you’ll get a great organic reach that isn’t guaranteed on your website.

What about the inherent effort?

It does take more time to write an in-depth article than to publish a short post. Is it really worth the extra effort? Absolutely. Here’s why:

  • LinkedIn displays content to users interested in the topics you write about. If readers already perceive your content as relevant to their needs, they’ll more likely read the full article, comment on it and share it with others.
  • Many users view LinkedIn articles as thought-leadership content. Publishing LinkedIn articles gives you instant credibility, trust and brand awareness.

LinkedIn articles provide more linking opportunities than LinkedIn posts do. Article links can drive traffic to your website and help you generate high-quality leads to achieve your B2B content marketing goals.

Do LinkedIn Articles Matter?

Articles provide a unique opportunity to establish expertise in your field and cement yourself or your company as a thought leader.

But whether you’re writing an article or a post on LinkedIn, they both appear on people’s feeds for followers—and their followers—to view and engage with the same way.

Articles show up as any other link with the link’s featured image above its Open Graph protocol (e.g., title, description), with the option to add organic text as a caption.

LinkedIn-Article-Example
An example of how a LinkedIn article would display on a user’s feed.

Posts display as organic text, with the option to add an accompanying image.

LinkedIn-Post-Example
An example of how a LinkedIn post would display on a user’s feed.

So LinkedIn articles matter a lot not just because they’re on an additional & reputable platform to complement your blog but also because publishing in general on LinkedIn is beneficial.

What then makes LinkedIn so unique as a publishing platform?

3 Benefits of Publishing an Article on LinkedIn

LinkedIn is one of the fastest-growing social platforms, recently seeing a 30% year-over-year increase in user sessions and a 60% increase in content creation over the same period.

These expanding metrics demonstrate the amazing opportunities available to brand managers and content marketers to scale their reach and attract more leads.

Let’s look at three specific benefits of publishing articles on LinkedIn validated by content-marketing consultant Dickie Bush:

  1. Insane reach
  2. Low competition
  3. Genuinely thoughtful community

1. Insane Reach

There exists no shortage of observational evidence that LinkedIn’s algorithms are very liberal in how they distribute content on the platform.

User feeds are less siloed than on other social platforms. Only a few likes or comments can snowball impressions of and engagement with LinkedIn articles very quickly.

And with consistent increases in user-volume and -session metrics on LinkedIn, that means more eyeballs on LinkedIn articles and more leads.

2. Low Competition

Even though, as hinted above, the higher growth rate of LinkedIn content creation is closing the gap with the volume of user sessions, there remains a huge demand for content.

In other words, there’s still no equilibrium in the supply:demand ratio of the amount of content available on LinkedIn to the amount of content that its users demand.

This mismatch is one reason why LinkedIn’s algorithms are so lax with circulating content.

At least until this gap narrows further, businesses can easily distribute LinkedIn articles without much competition—even if your competitors literally publish LinkedIn articles too!

3. Genuinely Thoughtful Community

LinkedIn might have its fair share of opportunists and people who overestimate the extent to which their ideas qualify as insightful thought leadership.

But there’s no denying that all active users are genuine business professionals there to legitimately network, study new ideas and master industry best practices.

Coupled with its ever-growing user base, LinkedIn is a prime platform to help your articles succeed!

Bonus Tips for Writing Articles on LinkedIn to Make Them Matter

One of the easiest ways to get more readers is to make your LinkedIn profile or company page public and your activity as shareable as possible.

To do this, open “Settings & Privacy” > “Visibility” to optimize visibility settings for your profile, network and activity.

Visibility-Settings-for-Writing-LinkedIn-Articles

You can also share other people’s articles on LinkedIn and add relevant commentary & hashtags to help more people find them.

The Share button is at the bottom of each article on your feed. Simply click on it and choose to “Repost” or “Share with your thoughts.”

Amplifying other content and engaging with others in general shows LinkedIn you’re active yourself, improving the reach from either your personal profile or your LinkedIn company page.

LinkedIn also enables sharing articles to Facebook and Twitter. Diversifying your reach across platforms grows your brand, showcases your expertise and attracts more leads

Ask others in your company and your network to share your articles from their own profiles too!

Lastly, if you’re thinking about outsourcing content marketing activities, you can scale the production of LinkedIn articles to post more frequently and help with discoverability even further.

Steps to Publishing an Article on LinkedIn

  1. Sign in to LinkedIn on desktop.
  2. Click “Write article” near the top of the homepage. If you run a company page, you can publish a LinkedIn article under the page or under your personal profile.
  3. Add a headline.
  4. Place your cursor in the “Write here” field to start writing your article. Use bold text, bulleted lists and other formatting elements to break up large text chunks and make it easier for readers to scan your article for key points.
  5. When you finish writing, proofread carefully. Then hit “Publish” and follow the on-screen instructions.
Writing-Dashboard-LinkedIn-Articles
This dashboard on LinkedIn Pulse is where you can create LinkedIn articles to publish on either under a personal profile or a company page.

How to Write an Article on a LinkedIn Company Page: A Step-by-Step Guide

Step 1: Write an Attention-Getting Headline

The headline must be relevant to readers and let them know what to expect from your article.

Think about what your audience wants to read. Do they need tips on completing a task? Information on a new development in your field?

If you have specific readers in mind, such as executives in the technology industry, tailor your headline accordingly.

For example, say you sell a calendar app and are targeting executives in the tech industry.

Perhaps consider a benefit-driven headline (“Scale Your Productivity 3x With a New Kind of Calendar App”) since tech execs can be drawn in by messaging about growth opportunities.

Listicles and how-to articles do well on LinkedIn, so you may start with “7 Ways to Save Money on Tech Outsourcing” or “How to Increase Your Employee Retention Rate in 3 Easy Steps.”

If you promise something in the headline, follow through on that promise in the article. You don’t want to mislead readers.

Step 2: Create an Interesting Introduction

A good intro draws the reader in so they give your article a closer look.

Depending on the article’s purpose, you may want to open with a question, make a controversial statement or tell a compelling story.

Don’t start an article about credit cards with “We all know paying off debt is hard.”

Instead, unravel Sarah’s journey: “Once 28-year-old journalist Sarah decided to control her debt, she didn’t guess it would lead her on a path towards a global ambassadorship in fintech.”

Step 3: Use Short Paragraphs

Huge blocks of text turn off most readers. They also aren’t scannable and don’t work well for mobile users. 

Try to limit most paragraphs to a few short sentences.

The first sentence, also known as the topic sentence, summarizes the main idea of the paragraph. Additional sentences support your main point.

Some paragraphs may just be one sentence. Writing for the internet means your prose shouldn’t exceed a high-school reading level, especially since LinkedIn articles are for top-of-funnel leads.

When you’re ready to share a new idea, move on to the next paragraph.

Step 4: Organize Your Thoughts

Don’t underestimate the importance of outlining so you can fully internalize the delineation of your argument.

It’s vital to use storytelling for articles because stories motivate more engagement from readers, leading to more conversions.

In many cases, writing with a classic “hamburger menu” style of thesis > supporting points > conclusion is a good way to make your point, or rely on rising action > conflict > falling action.

Use these storytelling techniques in blog posts when:

  • You’re giving step-by-step instructions to help readers accomplish a task.
  • Your article topic relates to historical events, such as the rise of industrial activity or development of new technology.
  • You want readers to visualize something in a certain order.

If all else fails, organize your thoughts by importance. This is helpful to rank items or persuade readers to adopt your viewpoint.

If you’re writing a list of the five best software packages for accounting firms, for example, it makes sense to rank them in order of importance because people will want to see the top five.

Never-Worry-About-Writing-Again-Banner

Step 5: Focus on Formatting

Good writing is only one aspect of creating an appealing article. Also consider how formatting affects the reader’s experience. 

Break content up with elements to help readers scan for information. Bulleted or numbered lists, data, images or subheadings make content more digestible and highlight key takeaways.

Give your article plenty of white space, the open space between design elements. White space focuses the reader’s attention and improves comprehension.

There’s less to immediately look at with white space, so people really engage with the content because it’s not intimidating.

Breaking up content and writing short paragraphs is the easiest way to add white space when writing a LinkedIn article for your company page.

Step 6: Cut the Fluff

Make your article exactly as long as it needs to be to get your point across. If you can explain a topic in 900 words, don’t add an extra hundred just to make the article longer.

LinkedIn content caters to executives, business owners and other professionals. They’re busy people with a limited amount of time.

As you proofread, cut out anything inessential to helping them understand what you’re saying.

Also remain vigilant in editing against the passive voice, repetition and run-on sentences, which all detract from succinct writing.

Step 7: Provide Expert Insight

The best way to build credibility and position yourself as an expert is to offer a completely new perspective, show you know your craft and cultivate your reputation.

If your article rehashes what’s out there, it won’t add much to the professional body of knowledge in your industry.

Can’t think of anything to write about? Here are some ideas to get the creative juices flowing:

  • Explain how you solved a big problem in your business
  • Discuss unusual solutions to common industry challenges
  • Highlight how you helped a customer grow their company
  • Write a rebuttal to a popular article by an industry colleague
  • Read industry publications to find out what people are interested in learning about

Professional content writers can also help you curate topics for your LinkedIn content calendar. For instance, what categories and keyword-research can we take from your blog?

Once you learn how to write unique articles, you’ll distinguish yourself from other professionals in your industry.

Step 8: Speak Directly to Your Audience

Just because you’re writing for a professional audience doesn’t mean you need to be overly formal.

Use second-person pronouns to make it clear that you’re addressing the reader. “If you’ve been struggling…” and “Here are three things you can do…” are examples of this approach.

A second-person point of view makes it easier to connect with the reader and reassure them of your expertise.

Most importantly, leverage brand messaging. If you implement language that speaks to your audience’s anxieties, aspirations, challenges or fears—you’ll never be unpopular on LinkedIn.

Getting Help With LinkedIn Article Writing

Do you see how fun it is now to write LinkedIn articles?

LinkedIn articles empower your company to spread your message, assert your expertise in your field and attract new leads to increase revenue.

With an insane reach, negligible competition and a genuine readership, LinkedIn articles are a no-brainer authority statement for your business.

But if you don’t have a lot of time or still aren’t sure how best to write an article for your company on LinkedIn, then a professional article writing service helps.

Outsourcing article writing means you can establish your company as thought leaders, scale up production and more effectively draw attention to your brand.

(You know, so you don’t have to write every day, which maybe isn’t that fun!)

The post How to Write an Article on a LinkedIn Company Page appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
7 Inbound Marketing Channels to Generate More Leads https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/7-inbound-marketing-channels-to-generate-more-leads/ Tue, 17 May 2022 07:32:36 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=33919 How to Grow Your Business With Inbound Marketing Channels Tell me if you’ve heard this one before. Your company’s lead volume is stagnant but your sales reps are capped. What do you mean simply call more leads? Are you hiring another SDR? Alas, a tale as old as time. This is where marketing comes in. […]

The post 7 Inbound Marketing Channels to Generate More Leads appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Grow Your Business With Inbound Marketing Channels

Tell me if you’ve heard this one before. Your company’s lead volume is stagnant but your sales reps are capped. What do you mean simply call more leads? Are you hiring another SDR?

Alas, a tale as old as time.

This is where marketing comes in. If you run mark-ops or are a content marketer tasked with feeding leads to sales, how’s it going?

Is inbound lead generation working for you or are you experiencing lots of sleepless nights?

If you want to expand your efforts or just focus on a core strategy without scatterbrain, you need to know inbound marketing, what are inbound marketing channels and how to leverage them.

So what is inbound marketing, how does it differ from outbound marketing and how can you refine tactics to make inbound marketing channels generate leads so you can hit your goals?

Outbound marketing reaches out to new leads by coming to them, whether it be through traditional advertising, outreach at tradeshows or even telemarketing.

Inbound marketing, on the other hand, attracts customers who’ve already started the buyer’s journey (even if they don’t know it yet) by drawing them in to you.

By creating different kinds of content with solutions potential leads are already looking for, you can attract and empower more people to give you more revenue.

Why is this important? Simply put, inbound marketing creates a dialogue with prospective leads. Providing valuable info via inbound marketing channels enables leads to find and evaluate you.

But how exactly does inbound marketing work? And how can you harness this powerful marketing strategy yourself?

We’ll dive into the benefits of inbound marketing, the returns you can expect and investigate the various channels of inbound marketing to take advantage of.

What Is Inbound Marketing?

At its most basic definition, inbound marketing is a strategy to help prospective customers or clients find your business.

Inbound marketing meets customers where they are and guides them towards your products or services, attracting and engaging buyers before they’re even considering making a purchase.

Customers generally start their journey by researching a query online to learn more about their given interest.

For instance, they may be researching new meal recipes, gardening tips or software solutions for their jobs but not necessarily shopping yet.

If you sell a product that aligns with their interest—say, gardening accessories or a productivity software—you can guide them towards your solution.

That’s where inbound marketing, SEO content come in. By providing meaningful and informative content to customers, you can build trust and educate leads.

With an inbound marketing strategy, you’re building visibility and rapport, bringing customers to you rather than seeking them out and selling to them directly, which is outbound marketing.

Through inbound marketing channels, including organic traffic, social media and events, businesses can create brand awareness and generate leads.

Therefore inbound marketing can be a great complement to outbound marketing to increase your revenue. So how exactly are inbound and outbound marketing channels different?

Inbound vs. Outbound Marketing

While outbound marketing also creates leads and builds revenue, it aligns with more conventional marketing practices like ads, bulk-email marketing or even cold-calling.

The goal for both inbound and outbound marketing is to convert leads, but the approach between the two differs.

Outbound marketing almost acts as an interruption by proactively presenting products or services to people, regardless of whether they’re likely to make a purchase or not.

Inbound marketing instead aims to attract customers with tailored and valuable content.

Inbound lead generation answers questions or provides solutions to problems potential customers want to solve, while outbound marketing pushes out messages to create interest.

In simplest terms, outbound marketing brings your business to customers while inbound marketing brings customers to your business.

While outbound marketing still has its place in a marketing strategy, inbound marketing benefits compared to outbound marketing include cost-efficiency and the opportunity to nurture leads.

Let’s review the benefits of inbound marketing so you know when and how to leverage it to grow your customer base.

What Are the Benefits of Inbound Marketing?

Inbound marketing is a long-term strategy. Instead of going right for a sale, it’s designed to attract a lead’s attention, pique their interest and nurture them on their journey to a conversion.

While the benefits are subtle in the short term, a good inbound marketing strategy creates more brand awareness, increased revenue, reduced expenses and better customer engagement.

3 Inbound Marketing Benefits

  1. More Brand Awareness
  2. Higher Quality Leads and Increased Engagement
  3. Efficient Marketing Budget

1. More Brand Awareness

Most consumers start their buyer’s journey by researching online.

With an effective SEO strategy and content that satisfies the queries of prospective customers, you can rank near the top of a search engine for instance and answer their question.

Or you attract their attention by educating them on something they didn’t know that would benefit them or solve a pain point.

This is an example of how inbound marketing generates online sales leads. When customers start their journey, your brand can show up and answer their questions first.

2. Higher Quality Leads and Increased Engagement

Customers expect tailored and individualized experiences. But only 60% of customers think companies provide good marketing personalization.

Inbound marketing can help connect to more potential customers in a personalized way.

When you understand where customers are in their journey and strategize your inbound marketing to their needs, leads are more likely to engage with your brand in meaningful ways.

Writing content with emotional messaging to exhibit empathy with your audience’s pain points is an example of how to grow your business using content marketing.

It connects with your audience on that personal level and translates to better inbound lead generation and higher customer conversion rates.

3. Efficient Marketing Budget

Since inbound marketing focuses on bringing qualified leads to your business, it’s less costly than outbound marketing.

With an effective inbound marketing effort, you can use a relatively small marketing team to make the most of your budget.

By pushing great content through various channels, the results of your efforts will compound rather than diminish over time.

With SEO practices and engaging content, your content will continue to grow and generate more leads, which means more revenue to feed back into your business and marketing budget.

How to Create an Inbound Marketing Strategy

Creating an inbound marketing strategy takes more than throwing money into various channels.

Pro marketing teams consider what channels they should prioritize and how to best facilitate lead generation according to their business needs.

Here are six tactics to create an inbound marketing strategy:

  1. Define Buyer Personas
  2. Identify Marketing Triggers
  3. Determine Keywords and SEO Strategy
  4. Establish Marketing Goals
  5. Outline Content Strategy and Structure
  6. Analyze, Revisit and Optimize Your Inbound Marketing Strategy

1. Define Buyer Personas

A buyer persona is a fictional representation of your brand’s ideal customers. A single brand might have numerous buyer personas, each with different interests, priorities and goals.

Some elements to include in a buyer persona to ensure your inbound marketing strategy is effective include interests, challenges, goals and frustrations.

Importantly—and this is key for your marketing collateral to hit the mark—map your solution’s benefits to your personas’ anxieties and pain points to attract more leads.

Understanding and defining your brand’s buyer personas helps you better understand whom you’re marketing to. The better you understand your buyer personas, the better equipped you are to create content that resonates with customers.

2. Identify Marketing Triggers

Events, circumstances or pain points that cause customers to search for information about your product or industry are known formally as marketing triggers.

An example would be an anxiety we referred to above when talking about defining buyer personas.

For instance, maybe you sell marketing software to business owners who’re anxious about their busy calendars. That’s a classic trigger for the selling point of “saving time.”

Trigger-based marketing also meets customers at their point in the buyer’s journey, responding to certain actions with specific solutions rather than broad and arbitrary advertising.

Other triggers could include website or email activity, letting you know if your lead is still learning about your solution or is further along, looking at product features.

3. Determine Keywords and SEO Strategy

Once you understand your buyer personas and what causes potential customers to engage with your content, you’ll need to know how you’ll get that content in front of them.

Keyword research is an integral part of an inbound marketing strategy because it enables you to identify the questions and pain points your target audience has when researching online.

Leverage this information to optimize your SEO strategy and design your content calendars to make your content discoverable so more leads can find you.

A good example of improving your inbound marketing with SEO is to investigate common topics your audience researches from keyword research and to create topic clusters.

By focusing on and linking between a few core, common topics, you demonstrate authority and expertise to people and search engines alike on info your target audience will find valuable.

4. Establish Marketing Goals

Set inbound marketing goals by identifying what you want to accomplish by a certain time. Consider traffic metrics, conversion rates and lead sources to start planning marketing goals.

Once you know what to focus on, you can scale up from there. For example, maybe it’s better to start driving brand awareness and improving SEO before tackling goals about customer loyalty.

But whether you’re creating short-term or building towards more long-term inbound marketing goals, you’ll need strong content. 

5. Outline Content Strategy and Structure

Impactful content in various formats enables you to accomplish your marketing goals because content is how leads find you and it’s what they engage with when you’re nurturing them.

So content marketing goals are a necessary subset of inbound marketing goals, but how do you create great content goals for inbound marketing?

Basic keyword research will help you design content topics that align with your audience’s interests to grab their attention and provide value.

You also need to understand your audience’s pain points, emotional triggers, needs and wants to compel them, nurture them properly and generate inbound conversions.

If you’re a B2B content marketer, for instance, a great tip for creating B2B content marketing goals is to map your content to the buyer’s journey.

That means optimizing different types of content for each of the stages your leads are in and distributing that content accordingly.

Inbound marketing leads typically fall into three stages:

  • Awareness. Leads look for general information about a topic and you’ll want them to discover your brand with content that they find valuable
  • Evaluation. Leads discover more about your brand & services and gradually engage with more content about benefits or features so you can move them closer to a sale.
  • Buying. Leads more strongly consider what your company can offer and interact with bottom-of-funnel content specifically about your product, services or buying process.

By creating content that responds to the separate lead stages, you can meet customers where they’re at in the buying journey and better personalize each experience.

ROI of Inbound Marketing

When designing a strategy to kickstart your inbound lead generation, you also need to focus on achieving and measuring a return-on-investment (ROI).

Not every inbound marketing channel is conducive to precise measurements and specific quantifiable metrics.

But creating a baseline, even if it’s based on estimates, is a great start to help with forecasting and finetuning your strategy decisions.

How Cost-Effective is Inbound Marketing?

Compared to outbound marketing, inbound marketing is cost-effective: small businesses see an average cost-per-lead savings of 64% and medium-sized companies enjoy a 68% reduction.

That’s partly because you’re not exhausting extra expenditure to deliver your message to potential customers, using content to instead let them find and evaluate you.

Therefore, it’s worth it to build an infrastructure to measure your inbound marketing ROI.

When you can bring tangible profitability estimates to your decision-makers that demonstrate this cost-effectiveness, you can access more resources you need to hit your goals.

What Is the ROI of Inbound Marketing?

It’ll take time to see how your content connects customers to your brand and generates leads.

Search engines gradually crawl and index content, rewarding high rankings to content that’s regularly optimized to  answer users’ questions.

Keep in mind that content can have a lasting impact. Performance often compounds over time as you build an authoritative domain through more strong content properly interlinked.

The bottom line for inbound marketing ROI comes down to how much you’re spending to convert leads into sales.

For example, say you spend $3,000 on content that results in six sales at $3,500 each. That’s $21,000 in revenue at an average cost of $500 per sale.

But this breakdown is often too simplistic. The formula is looking at total investments; content is one piece of a puzzle that leads to a sale.

So how do you build a system to take a properly holistic view at measuring inbound marketing ROI?

How to Measure Inbound Marketing ROI

Instead, build a system on an attribution model that weighs channels and content collateral by various touchpoints.

Strong inbound marketing measurement maps content to revenue-related conversion events.

For example, an analytics tool can connect a touchpoint on a blog post or an email campaign to an event like a demo signup, a trial request, a newsletter subscription and more.

Manual solutions could involve UTM parameters for inbound marketing ROI on conversion links and then tying the data in a spreadsheet to revenue metrics from a sales software.

With a comprehensive approach, you can cross-reference revenue with other metrics like social media engagement or email signups to get a full picture of your inbound marketing strategy.

So how does this all add up to generating more inbound marketing leads? We know what goes into a successful strategy and measuring ROI, but what are the channels of inbound marketing?

We’re going to shift into looking at the most common inbound marketing channels and how to use them so you can level up your content game and scale lead generation for your business.

What Are Inbound Marketing Channels?

An inbound marketing channel is a scoped set of resources and tools to deliver content from a company to your audience. In other words, how content goes from production to consumption.

Inbound marketing channels comprise the various ways businesses connect with their audience via content, from discoverability online to nurturing leads through emails or social media.

Knowing which inbound marketing channels to focus on and how to leverage them helps leverage ways to generate online sales leads with inbound marketing, so let’s dive in!

7 Important Inbound Marketing Channels

  1. Organic Traffic
  2. Social Media
  3. Paid Advertising
  4. Events
  5. Podcasts
  6. Referral Marketing
  7. Website Resources

1. Organic Traffic

Organic inbound marketing is the most common and generally the most important channel available. It refers to website traffic of users who find you “organically” via a search engine.

Your company’s website is the main hub connecting your services to customers. Blog posts and services pages can generate organic traffic with the right content marketing and SEO strategy.

When potential leads look for info, your brand can educate them about the topic to build trust or provide value by highlighting benefits related to their query.

This is what makes your website discoverable on search engines to generate organic traffic and more prospective customers to your website.

Tailor your website’s content to your buyer personas and study the keywords and phrases that can guide people to your website.

Generate content for all stages of the funnel too. For example, top-of-funnel pages specifically target leads in the awareness stage by discussing content similar to your business categories.

If you sell workout equipment online, for instance, building content topics around workout routines and bodybuilding advice is a great way to target top-of-funnel leads.

It’s also important to know how to optimize content for SEO. Common tactics include keyword research, focusing on quality and ensuring you demonstrate expertise, authority and trust (E-A-T).

If you don’t pay attention to keywords and an SEO strategy, it might not matter how much high-quality content you produce.

If content doesn’t match users’ search intentions, search engines won’t rank your content and your website might not get the traffic it deserves.

2. Social Media

Why is social media an important part of inbound marketing?

Social media is a fast-growing channel for inbound marketing, and for good reason. A unique benefit to social media for inbound marketing is the ability to foster relationships with customers.

Social media content establishes a meaningful relationship between customers and businesses and facilitates two-way conversations.

With platforms like Instagram, Facebook, Twitter, YouTube and more, you can engage directly with customers, gaining insights into what they need from products and services.

What are ways to use social media as an inbound marketing channel?

Provide valuable threads on LinkedIn and Twitter to show your expertise or create a Facebook community for customers to demonstrate your commitment to customer experience.

There are also ways for how social media helps SEO.

For example, you can gain backlinks through viral posts when you amplify your content to people who can share your links on their websites.

Search algorithms will view such shares as a sign of credibility, enhancing your search rankings. Your social profile pages themselves can also rank for relevant keywords.

3. Paid Advertising

Advertising is often considered an outbound tactic, but it can be useful for inbound marketing strategies too.

Pay-per-click (PPC) advertising on platforms like Google Ads allows you to target specific buyer personas by criteria like demographics, location and previous touchpoints on your website.

You can further customize your targeting by controlling when and where your content or ads appear.

This level of personalization enables you to hone in on potential leads already looking for info that you can provide. And ads are a proven tool to nurture inbound leads already in your funnel.

It’s also easy to attribute PPC inbound marketing to conversion events and revenue metrics. These analytics are handy for measuring and optimizing the success of your content strategy.

Although PPC can be costly, you only pay for each click you get.

Costs also differ per platform. LinkedIn tends to have higher click costs than Facebook or Google, but the lead quality tends to be stronger too since it targets business professionals.

And if you’re a local business that provides a home service, you can qualify for Google Local Services Ads.

One reason why this type of advertising is great for small business owners is that Local Services Ads charge per lead instead of per click, so you only pay for qualified leads, no junk. 

4. Events

Events are another example of a marketing channel that appear outbound, but they overlap with inbound techniques to a large degree.

Popup events associated with experiential marketing closely resemble outbound marketing, but participating in conferences and sponsoring events is all about attracting leads to your brand.

Why is event marketing an integral channel for inbound marketing? Because event marketing involves multiple touchpoints to educate and nurture leads like other inbound channels.

Setting up a booth at an event to entice passersby with a solution to their problem isn’t much different from blogging about that solution to entice search-engine users with the same problem.

And when booth attendees sign up for a demo or request more info, this should place them in a sequence with collateral like emails and ads, with unique landing pages about the event.

Once you get more digital assets involved, like QR codes, you can also initiate attribution tracking to measure event ROI too!

The key is how you are leveraging events to enable potential leads to find you and intrigue them with your hook. From there, educate them with materials also used for other inbound channels.

5. Podcasts

Podcasts are increasingly prevalent among even small- and medium-sized businesses as an inbound marketing channel.

Podcast inbound marketing is effective because it helps you cement your brand by giving your company an opportunity to develop and show off your personality.

Another positive for podcasts is that podcast listeners actively engage with brands. Podcasts compel people to listen attentively, so they’ll likely become a fan of your brand personality.

Also, podcasts are an additional avenue for you to establish your expertise.

For example, if you’re an SEO agency that sells digital marketing services, starting a podcast to share SEO tips would build trust with prospective customers, showing them you know your stuff.

And podcasts are hugely popular with consumers.

The most recent year-over-year data shows the percentage of adults who regularly listen to podcasts jumped from 37% to 41%.

If that increase looks unimpressive, consider it was at 32% the previous year and is expected to hit 47% within the next year. That’s a consistent annual growth rate of over 10%.

But starting a podcast can be intimidating and time-consuming for first-timers. Plus, with more podcasts constantly popping up, it can be difficult to stand out in a saturated market.

Make sure to research podcasting tips for beginners so you feel comfortable getting started.

For instance, find the right equipment and figure out how to plan the scope of your podcast episodes.

Returning to the SEO-agency example, the SEO-podcast space is a competitive market. Maybe you mostly cater to local businesses, so you can establish a niche around tips for “local SEO.”

6. Referral Marketing

Referral marketing can produce a high volume of quality leads for lower costs than other inbound marketing channels.

That’s because you’re leveraging the reputation of other brands potential customers already know and trust.

By tapping into businesses and social circles around you, you can broaden your reach, get leads recommended from partner companies and find influential people to vouch for you.

Broadly speaking, this is what referral marketing is: it encapsulates anything that involves other people or companies bringing prospective customers to you.

Examples include customer referrals, influencer marketing with social media heavyweights or partnership marketing with companies that aren’t competitors but target the same audience.

One of the easiest ways to begin a referral program is to harness your existing customer base.

Provide your existing customers with a unique coupon code to share with a friend. They’ll likely spread the word if there’s a benefit for them, like a discount for each new referral.

The beauty here is that you only need to pay out rewards once the new customer actually makes a purchase, so you’ll still see revenue growth that’s profitable.

Influencer marketing uses endorsements and mentions from social media users with large followings, otherwise known as influencers.

With established trust from their followers, influencers can generate traffic to your business by recommending your products and services to their followers.

While influencer marketing is a lucrative inbound marketing channel, managing the shifting trends and demographics can be challenging.

Different demographics have their own aesthetic preferences, meaning you might not reach your ideal buyer persona if you don’t partner with the right influencer.

It doesn’t need to be as complex as paying a celebrity a lot of money to publish an ingenuine tweet about your product.

Find people your target audience respect, perhaps experts in their field, and engage them in a dialogue to see how you could help each other out.

If you sell products online, for instance, a great way to work with influencers is with ecommerce influencer marketing.

Find influencers who are right for your brand. If you sell makeup online, why not partner with popular YouTubers who give makeup tutorials?

When you partner with another business to refer customers between each other, that’s called partnership marketing.

For example, Apple and Mastercard came together to integrate Mastercard into Apple Pay when it was first introduced.

This made the Apple Pay app viable but also boosted Mastercard’s image as a forward-thinking leader in the payments space.

You don’t even need to create an integrated product line with another company.

If you sell accounting software, you can simply build an interdependent referral program with another company that targets accountants with a different type of software.

If you choose to partner with another company, make sure you’ll be reaching new customers and the relationship is truly a win-win.

7. Website Resources

In addition to blog posts and social media content, for instance, it’s important to create other pieces of inbound marketing content to nurture leads at all stages of the funnel.

For instance, once leads find you, they’ll want to learn more about your specific product category. This is known as middle-of-funnel marketing.

Content optimized for the top of the funnel answers users’ queries about their pain points and needs before they even know about what your product is or does.

But then after they find your brand, they’ll then want to learn more about how a solution like yours works.

As we mentioned previously, blog posts can represent “top of the funnel” marketing, drawing users to your site from search engines.

Informational resources like podcasts and webinars target customers in the evaluation stage—the middle of the sales funnel.

Ebooks and white papers provide in-depth educational content beyond that of the average blog post. You should reserve these resources for your most sophisticated content.

They take more time and funds to produce, but they’re necessary to win sales when you have a more complex buying cycle.

And for leads who already know what they’re looking for at a high level, these resources can be perfect as an initial touchpoint.

Since potential customers often find them more valuable than top-of-funnel content, they’ll more likely give their contact information so you can follow up with—and close them—later on.

Harness Inbound Marketing Channels for More Leads

Inbound marketing is an impactful tool that strategically connects businesses and customers.

By using channels like blogs, social media and referral marketing, you can target customers at their individual stages in the buyer’s journey.

This results in improved brand awareness and preference, ultimately leading to greater lead generation and conversion rates over time.

To create an effective inbound marketing strategy, you’ll need more than a few blog posts. At the heart of every inbound marketing strategy is quality content.

With content writing services, you can cost-effectively generate the content needed to leverage inbound marketing at scale and attract more leads to your brand to grow your business.

The post 7 Inbound Marketing Channels to Generate More Leads appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Boost Engagement, Conversions and SEO With Video Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/boost-engagement-conversions-and-seo-with-video-marketing/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/boost-engagement-conversions-and-seo-with-video-marketing/#respond Thu, 07 Apr 2022 20:50:27 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=33601 Video is becoming an increasingly important component when it comes to online marketing. If you’re not yet using video as part of your marketing strategy, you’re missing out on a huge opportunity. This blog post will discuss the importance of video content and some tips for creating a successful video marketing strategy. Video has a […]

The post Boost Engagement, Conversions and SEO With Video Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Video is becoming an increasingly important component when it comes to online marketing. If you’re not yet using video as part of your marketing strategy, you’re missing out on a huge opportunity. This blog post will discuss the importance of video content and some tips for creating a successful video marketing strategy.

Video has a lot of options for conveying information to your consumers. Rather than relying on text-heavy instructions, product demos and process guides seem to work better in video format. Video marketing helps companies discover new customers while delivering entertainment that users can’t get anywhere else.

That makes it a win-win for all involved.

Why Prioritize Video in Your Marketing Strategy?

Some brands give too few resources to video marketing. Others may overlook video entirely, claiming it’s too expensive or ineffective. But these businesses are neglecting a crucial fact that’s impossible to ignore: Consumers are watching more videos online than ever before. Ignoring this is ignoring a massive chunk of potential customers.

Take a look at the numbers: Over 70% of customers say they’d prefer to learn about a product or service by watching a video. And in fact, 84% of them say watching a brand’s video was the determiner that convinced them to buy.

Video is potent in the digital product realm, too. Almost 80% of people said a video convinced them to buy or download a digital product.

But it goes much deeper than those numbers. Video lets you build a human connection with your audience that you sometimes can’t do with e-books and blog posts. A high-quality video establishes trust while giving you an engaging opportunity to demonstrate expertise and authenticity.

And when you hit the mark with video, people are more likely to share the connection. The reach of a single successful video can drive traffic, leads and revenues up far more effectively than other marketing strategies.

It’s probably why, over the last three years, the number of brands using video as a marketing tool has risen from 63% to 86%.

The Biggest Benefit of Video Marketing

There are many apparent reasons for investing in a sound video marketing strategy, but the most significant benefit you may not have considered is search engine optimization. SEO is the foundation of your entire digital marketing efforts. And while video content increases engagement and conversions, it also has a real impact on SEO.

Google’s search algorithms are looking for two things in content: quality and search relevance. To rank well, you need to create compelling content that meets the needs of the people searching for your targeted keywords.

These days, Google doesn’t only scan your website’s text content; it looks for other media types. If your website contains rich media and quality video content, it signals to Google’s algorithm that your site is robust and informative. And that means an immediate boost to SEO.

Another significant factor that Google’s algorithms pay attention to is the length of engagement — how long users stay on your site. If you’re pulling in traffic, but that traffic doesn’t stick around long, Google assumes your visitors don’t find your content valuable. And your search rankings suffer for it.

Video keeps people on your site longer than any other content type. They’re far more likely to check out a video clip than read your site’s blog post history. All the time your visitors spend watching videos delivers more SEO juice.

How To Create a Video Marketing Strategy

So, how does one get started with a video marketing strategy? It’s not easy, but it’s definitely worth your time and effort.

1. Determine Your Goals

Any new marketing effort begins with goals. Video is the same. It would help if you precisely determined your objective for your video marketing strategy.

Some brands put the majority of their advertising efforts into video. They might start with content for product pages and then expand their video production onto social platforms. Others may focus their efforts on social media alone. Figuring out where to start and what you want to focus on can help clarify your goals.

You also want to determine what part of your marketing funnel to focus on. In a perfect world, you’d want video content for every stage of your funnel. But you’ll want to determine which location is the most important to focus on in the early stages.

Here are a few example goals you might align your strategy toward:

  • Creating brand awareness
  • Increasing website traffic
  • Improving SEO
  • Improving online engagement
  • Driving conversions

Focus on one or two goals to start with. Don’t try to create content that accomplishes everything all at once, or you’ll spread your efforts too thin.

2. Define Your Target Audience

No less important than determining your goals is defining your target audience. If you take the time to create a high-quality video without understanding its intended audience, there’s a good chance it won’t land. The people who should see it won’t, and those who do won’t traverse your funnel.

If your business has a marketing team, there’s a good chance they’ve already set up buyer personas. The people you want to buy your products or services are the same ones you want to reach with your videos. These personas can help define your video strategy’s target audience.

3. Figure Out Which Platforms To Use

When it comes to video, the web is crowded these days. From older platforms such as Facebook to newer ones like TikTok, the opportunities to engage your audience with video are plentiful.

If you already have a presence on one of the big social media platforms that support video, starting there is a good idea. Users on Facebook and Instagram spend a lot of time watching videos. And YouTube, being the second-biggest search engine globally, is a good idea.

If you’re beginning to build your marketing strategy and don’t yet have a presence, consult your marketing personas from the previous step. Ask yourself which platforms your target audience uses most, and then research to find data that supports your assumptions.

It’s also good to look at specific platform features to see the available formats. Understanding what each one offers in terms of video dimensions, quality and length can help you determine where your messages will likely resonate most.

4. Create Your Story

Every successful video starts with a strong story.

Figuring out the story you want to tell is often one of the most fun parts of a video marketing strategy. But it’s also the most difficult. The art of storytelling would be impossible to cover here, but a basic framework usually includes some form of the following elements:

  • A protagonist, usually based on your target audience
  • Goals and conflicts aligned with one of your customer’s pain points
  • A journey or quest introducing your product or service
  • Resolution to the conflict provided by your product or service

As you’re crafting your story, think about the emotion you want to leave the viewer with. Do you want to entertain or inspire them? Perhaps you want to leave them feeling curious. As you’re writing your script, consider these carefully. And be sure the message and the feeling align with your brand’s overall voice and tone. Consistency is key.

It’s hard to overstate the importance of your story. If you don’t have a natural storyteller on your marketing team, enlisting a freelance writer to help craft your narrative is a good idea.

5. Create a Content Production Plan

A good content-production plan will save you time and money in the long run. Whether you plan it with a flowchart or pen and paper, you need to know how your videos will be made.

There are several alternatives you can consider for content production and post-production. You can employ an agency or production company to do the heavy lifting, but that can get expensive. If you have team members capable of certain aspects of video production, enhancing them with freelancers is a good option.

One option is to make your video online. If you have a limited budget, there are free video editors you can research to see what makes sense for you to create a killer marketing video to meet your content goals.

If you’re planning to produce your video in-house, you’ll need to consider all the different processes and equipment necessary. These include:

  • Acquiring props and other stage equipment
  • Writing and editing the script
  • Storyboarding the video
  • Planning the filming process
  • Editing the footage
  • Adding special effects or animations
  • Licensing music or images

Don’t let this list stop you from diving into video production if your resources are limited. Think about alternative video styles that are more efficient or affordable to produce. You could ask customers to send in user-generated content or testimonials. Or you could go the DIY route and ask your most passionate product expert to host a Q&A on Instagram Live. Record it and turn their responses into a promotional video. Users also love “behind the scenes” style footage, which works great if you can’t afford a dedicated studio space. As long as your storytelling is strong, your videos will resonate with viewers. Start small and build from there.

When your video is complete, don’t overlook the optimization process. Create compelling, keyword-rich titles and descriptions. You should also add closed captioning to every video. It’ll make your content more accessible for the hearing impaired, users scrolling with their phone in silent mode and search engine spiders alike.

6. Schedule and Promote Your Videos

Next, you’ll want to schedule and promote your videos. Share your new content prolifically. Use social media management tools to schedule releases during the best possible times. Get the word out on your shiny new content, so people start engaging and re-sharing.

7. Measure and Refine Your Strategy

The most essential part of any strategy is refinement. You won’t be able to determine how well a video performs until you look at the numbers. What are view counts, for example? How long have people been watching your videos? From the number of views, shares and likes and what people say in the comments, it’s crucial to take in this veiled feedback. From there, use it to refine your approach.

Native analytics, which tells you how each video fared, is available on all platforms. They’ll even tell you how many people watched the first three seconds of your video. The methods you used to evaluate success should be appropriate for the goals set in the beginning.

It’s also worth noting that older videos are sometimes consumed years later. With the right keywords and quality content, your audience can find value in your video content for many years down the road.

Best Practices for Video Marketing

It’s crucial to have a strong strategy before you start pumping time and money into producing costly video content.

Unfortunately, there’s an element of video marketing that doesn’t adhere to marketing personas and project management. The bottom line is that if you want a successful video marketing strategy, you need to make amazing videos.

It doesn’t matter if you’re whipping together videos in the back of your office or outsourcing production to a trendy agency. The focus should always be on quality. It should be big, bold and polished and tell a fantastic story.

The following best practices help you do precisely that.

Video Length: Short or Long?

Platforms like TikTok have a lot of marketers focused on creating short, enticing clips to grab viewers’ attention. And while this may work for some brands, you should always refer back to your original goals to lay the groundwork for your content.

For example, if the people you’re trying to reach are looking for in-depth content, you probably shouldn’t focus on 15-second videos, as your efforts will be wasted. But if you make rich, full-length videos that explain complex topics in rich detail, you’re making the right video for the right people.

Put simply, never let the platform dictate the content you create.

Keep It Simple

As a segue from complex and lengthy videos, it’s worth mentioning that keeping it simple whenever possible is the best bet. Unless you’re making investigative documentaries, opt for poppy and enticing over detailed and dense.

Even with in-depth explainers or how-to videos, the more you can simplify the content, the better. Remember, the idea is to engage. You can always fill out more complex topics with in-depth blog posts for people interested in the details.

A Call to Action

The call to action echoed across amateur and professional YouTube channels are the norm. As with written content, if you get your viewer to the end of the video, they like what you had to say. As such, they’re primed to take action.

But you need to nudge them a little.

A call to action can be as simple as a request to visit your website. Or you might offer a coupon code for one of your products and services. The gist here is that you always need one at the end of every video. Not doing so is a disservice to your brand and your viewers.

Boost Your Video Marketing With Crowd Content

Creating a winning video marketing strategy isn’t easy. It requires a lot of resources, multiple talented individuals and a good dose of creativity. But the benefits are well worth the time and effort of everyone involved.

As covered above, one of the most critical aspects of all video content is the script. If you want to create successful videos, you need an excellent storyteller on your team. If your brand is lacking in that department, Crowd Content can help. With access to thousands of professional and creative freelance writers, you can start building the next viral video campaign. Get in touch with us today to get started.

The post Boost Engagement, Conversions and SEO With Video Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/boost-engagement-conversions-and-seo-with-video-marketing/feed/ 0
How to Grow Your Business With Strategic Content Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-grow-your-business-with-content-marketing/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-grow-your-business-with-content-marketing/#respond Fri, 25 Mar 2022 20:34:16 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=33544 What Is Content Marketing? Content marketing is the practice of creating and distributing content that’s valuable and relevant to people in your target audience. It’s important to remember that what’s valuable to one person isn’t valuable to another. That’s why it’s so important to define your target audience carefully before you start developing your first piece of […]

The post How to Grow Your Business With Strategic Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What Is Content Marketing?

Content marketing is the practice of creating and distributing content that’s valuable and relevant to people in your target audience. It’s important to remember that what’s valuable to one person isn’t valuable to another. That’s why it’s so important to define your target audience carefully before you start developing your first piece of content.

Many business owners struggle with the idea of producing high-quality content and giving it away for free. After all, didn’t you go into business to turn a profit? Content marketing is highly effective because it helps bring new people into your sales funnel and gives you more opportunities to convert leads into paying customers. And while you may want to keep some of your “secret sauce” a secret, there’s still plenty of knowledge you can share with your audience. By giving away some of your knowledge in the form of content, you build your credibility and earn trust.

Even better, content marketing is much more cost-effective than many other marketing methods. Think about how much you’d spend to produce and air a 30-second television commercial or buy a half-page advertisement in a popular magazine. You’ll spend much less to produce a case study or write a series of blog posts, but you’ll still be able to connect with people in your target audience.

Benefits of Content Marketing

In addition to the opportunity to lower your marketing costs, content marketing has many benefits for businesses. It doesn’t matter if you’re a one-person shop or a marketing specialist at a Fortune 500 company; you can use high-quality content to increase revenue and keep customers engaged.

Improved Search Engine Rankings

A website full of useful content will rank higher in search engine results than a bare-bones site. Google and other search engines consider hundreds of factors when determining where each of your pages should rank when people search for relevant keywords. Some of those factors are more in your control than others, such as the length of the content, the use of relevant keywords and how often you publish new content. Content originality is also a major consideration for search engine algorithms.

Because content marketing involves the consistent production and distribution of content, it can help you show the search engines your site is updated regularly and contains content that’s highly relevant to your target audience. Additionally, more content creates more opportunities for other websites to link to your pages, giving you an additional SEO boost.

More Opportunities To Promote Your Business

If you only have a few pages of content, there isn’t much for visitors to do when they land on your website. You also miss out on opportunities to showcase your expertise and demonstrate that you understand the pain points of people in your target audience. Every time you publish a new blog post, article or other piece of content on your website, you create a new opportunity to promote your business.

When you have a large website filled with high-quality content, it’s also easier to attract inbound links, increasing awareness of your brand. Useful articles are also more likely to be shared on social media. Both web links and social shares will drive traffic to your site and build your audience of potential buyers.

Increased Conversion Rates

Conversion rate refers to the number of website visitors who take a desired action divided by the total number of visitors to the site. In many cases, the desired action is the purchase of a product, but it can also be something like downloading a free report or contacting the company to request more information. If you have 100 visitors and one of them takes the desired action, your conversion rate is 1%. Content can help you increase your conversion rate by building trust, increasing engagement and helping you convince potential customers you offer something worthwhile.

Better Relationships With Prospects and Customers

Think about how you use the internet to find information on topics of interest. If you land on a page riddled with typos or content that reads like it was put through a blender, you’re unlikely to trust that the website owner has any authority on the topic. You may even wonder if the site is owned by a scammer. That’s not a great way to start a relationship with a business.

High-quality content helps you demonstrate your expertise, show prospects you understand their needs and convince audience members you have their best interests in mind. When a business relationship starts this way, prospects are much more likely to believe you can solve their problems.

Types of Content Marketing

Blogging

Initially, blogs were used as personal websites or journals where people could share information with others. Over time, the purpose of the blog changed, and so did the format. Now a blog is any site or page that’s updated regularly. Although people still use their blogs as personal journals, smart marketers rely on blogging to connect with audience members, improve their search engine rankings and grow their brands.

No matter the size of your company, blogging has many benefits. By linking to other pages on your site, publishing blog posts can help you drive traffic to landing pages and other important content. Well-written content also establishes your company as an industry expert, which helps build trust and makes audience members more likely to buy from you than from one of your competitors. Finally, your blog is online 24/7, ensuring potential customers can learn more about your business no matter what day or time they come across your posts.

Infographics

Infographics are visual representations of information. Because they use eye-catching design elements and a minimal amount of text, they’re used to communicate key points to busy readers. A pie chart with a few bullet points below it, a colourful bar chart and a numbered list accompanied by carefully selected icons are all examples of infographics.

Infographics are ideal for providing topic overviews, distilling complex concepts into a few key points, displaying results from surveys or summarizing longer pieces of content. This makes them a valuable addition to any content marketing strategy.

Email Marketing

Email marketing is the use of email messages to connect with people in your target audience. This type of marketing is especially helpful because it allows you to personalize each message and make it more relevant to the reader. You can even segment your email list to target readers of different ages and interests, making your marketing efforts even more effective.

Content is key to any successful email marketing strategy. If your website is static, there’s no reason for your subscribers to open yet another email promoting it. But if you have a new article that’s timely and relevant to your audience’s needs, they’ll happily open your email and click through to your website to read it.

App Development

Many companies release free apps to generate revenue from advertising, but you can also use apps to attract people into your sales funnel and help them develop a positive relationship with your brand. For example, if you offer personal training, you could release a mobile app that guides people through a set of exercises designed to help them improve their balance or flexibility. As they use the app, people will get used to your training style and come to rely on you as an expert, which can help you grow your business.

Lead Magnets

A lead magnet is something of value you give people in exchange for their contact information. It may take a bit of time and money to develop a high-quality lead magnet, but the investment is well worth it when you think about what you get in return. Once you have someone’s email address, it’s much easier to send them targeted messages, creating extra opportunities to promote your business.

Remember that a lead magnet must be something of value to people in your target audience. A good lead magnet should also be relevant and follow through on what you promised when you made the offer. If you offer one thing and deliver something else, the recipient is likely to be disappointed, which isn’t a great way to start a relationship.

Here are just a few examples of items that can be used as lead magnets:

  • White papers
  • Special reports
  • E-books
  • Design templates
  • Case studies

Social Media

Social media marketing involves joining online communities and using them to create and share content with current and potential customers. Facebook, Instagram, Twitter and Snapchat are some of the most popular platforms. Social media can help you grow your business by making it easier to attract customers, conduct market research and establish your brand. Another benefit of using social media is that you can reach thousands of potential customers for a fraction of what you’d pay for traditional advertising.

Video Marketing

Video marketing is exactly what it sounds like — the use of videos to educate, inform, entertain or persuade. Many types of content marketing involve the use of written material, but not everyone enjoys reading or has the time to read long blog posts, case studies or white papers. Video marketing helps you deliver your message to these audience members, increasing your reach and creating more opportunities to generate revenue.

Online Courses

Udemy, Teachable and other websites make it easy to create and publish online courses. Teaching online is an effective form of content marketing because it establishes you as an expert in your field. Publishing an online course also gives you direct access to your students, allowing you to deliver personalized messages that are highly relevant to their needs. This type of content marketing is especially effective for businesses that offer services like tutoring, music lessons and standardized test preparation.

Presentations

As a marketer, delivering live presentations or publishing past presentations online is a great way to connect with people who can benefit from your expertise. This type of marketing works for almost any type of business, from a construction company that wants to show off its completed projects to a marketing firm that wants to share helpful tips with potential clients. Not only does giving a presentation establish you as an expert in your industry, but it can also help you drive traffic to your website or increase the number of subscribers to your social media channels.

How To Grow Your Business Through Content Marketing

Now that you understand what content marketing is and why it’s so beneficial for businesses, you can start using content to grow your company. To do this effectively, you must plan your content carefully, focus on quality and identify the right distribution channels for each type of content. Because the marketing industry is always changing, you should also review and update your content marketing plan regularly to account for new trends.

Planning Content

As noted earlier, the first thing you need to do is define your target audience. Content marketing isn’t about throwing something at the wall and seeing if it sticks; it’s about developing content for a specific group of people who have a need for the products or services your company offers. It doesn’t matter if two million people read one of your blog posts if none of those people is in the market for what your business sells.

Once you have a general market in mind, you can segment it to make your marketing efforts even more effective. Segmentation can be done according to where audience members live, how they behave and what they value. Customer demographics, including age, ethnicity and sex, are also an important consideration when identifying your target market.

The right market segments for your business depend on what you sell and where you’re located. If you have an e-commerce business, you can market to customers all over the country, but a brick-and-mortar business is better served by focusing on local customers. For example, a restaurant in San Francisco wouldn’t try to market to people in New York or Philadelphia.

Your product or service offering is an important consideration because it determines who’s most likely to buy from you. If you were promoting an assisted living facility, for example, you wouldn’t include teenagers in your target market. You’d develop content for older people and publish it where they’d be most likely to see it.

Developing Content

Now that you have a well-defined target audience, it’s time to develop content that’s relevant to its needs. A busy executive might want to read a white paper or case study on a piece of business software, while someone shopping for a new pair of shoes would probably be more interested in reading a blog post on how to choose the most comfortable pair of sneakers, for example.

Once you know what type of content you need, you can have your in-house marketing team develop it or hire a content marketing agency to help you. Crowd Content has experienced writers and subject matter experts available to craft blog posts, case studies, white papers, product descriptions and other types of content for your business.

Distributing Content

Content marketing is an ongoing process, not a one-and-done task, so it’s important to identify a mix of distribution channels you can use to make your marketing strategy more successful. Again, the needs of your target audience should be one of your top considerations. If your content is aimed at business executives, for example, you’re more likely to reach them on LinkedIn than on Snapchat.

In addition to your own website, you can distribute content on social networks, video platforms, online courseware and digital marketplaces. If you have high-quality content that’s likely to attract a sophisticated audience, you may even be able to publish a guest post on a site like Forbes or Inc. Just remember to focus on channels where members of your target audience are most likely to spend their time.

Updating Your Content Marketing Strategy

Industries evolve over time, replacing outdated practices with new ones that make it easier to meet the needs of customers while turning a profit. Just as your business needs to adapt to industry-specific changes, it also needs to adapt to changes in marketing best practices. That’s why it’s important to review your content marketing strategy regularly and update it as needed.

Take Your Business to the Next Level

If content isn’t already a major part of your marketing strategy, now’s your opportunity to apply the principles of content marketing in your business. High-quality content increases awareness of your brand, highlights your expertise and helps you convince potential customers that your product or service could be exactly what they need to solve a problem or make life easier in some way.

Crowd Content is here to help you with product descriptions, landing pages and whatever kind of content you need to reap the benefits of having a cohesive content marketing strategy.

The post How to Grow Your Business With Strategic Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-grow-your-business-with-content-marketing/feed/ 0
Strategies for Growing Your Business With Influencer Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/leveraging-influencers/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/leveraging-influencers/#respond Thu, 10 Mar 2022 16:38:38 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=33460 Influencer marketing has been buzzing through the industry for a while now. Even mainstream media commonly references the reach and impact of social media influencers. Yet the concept of brands leveraging these influencers to help grow their business is still murky for many. In short, influencer marketing is a form of social media marketing that […]

The post Strategies for Growing Your Business With Influencer Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Influencer marketing has been buzzing through the industry for a while now. Even mainstream media commonly references the reach and impact of social media influencers.

Yet the concept of brands leveraging these influencers to help grow their business is still murky for many.

In short, influencer marketing is a form of social media marketing that capitalizes on endorsements and mentions of products from experts — people with a social following who are regarded as authorities in their field. Influencer marketing works because influencers have developed a great deal of trust among their followers, and they offer them as a sort of social proof to potential customers.

A Closer Look at Influencers

Influencer marketing is actually a blend of old and new. It’s the timeless approach of celebrity endorsement placed in the digital age of content-driven marketing. But where the former depended on movie stars and personalities in popular culture, influencer marketing is based on individuals whose popularity comes through social media.

While many traditional celebrities also have a strong social media following, these things aren’t mutually exclusive. Plenty of successful influencers aren’t famous in the offline world. In short, an influencer is someone who has:

  • The reach and ability to impact purchasing decisions of their followers because of their knowledge and authority and the relationship with their audience
  • Following in a defined niche through which the influencer regularly engages

In fact, it’s a mistake to assume all influencers are necessarily celebrities. For brands with focused product or service offerings, leveraging an influencer with a smaller audience but more industry-specific appeal can produce better results than any given celebrity.

Most influencers have put a lot of work into building a loyal following. And it’s certainly no coincidence that their followers engage with them rather than any specific product or brand. These people look to the influencer for their knowledge, expertise and opinions. They trust them. Respecting this relationship is key to influencer marketing success.

Remember, the majority of influencers have developed a devoted and enthusiastic following. It isn’t by chance that these people follow influencers rather than corporations. Many consumers are far more interested in what influencers have to say over marketing campaigns of individual brands.

How Influencer Marketing Works

The practice of influencer marketing involves collaborating with one or more of the aforementioned influencers. Some brands take a structured approach, while others simply engage with influencers informally.

Of course, there wouldn’t be so much buzz around influencer marketing if it didn’t have broad appeal.

Unlike celebrities, you can find influencers anywhere and everywhere. Their large internet and social media followings are what distinguish them. An influencer may be a well-known Instagram fashion photographer, a well-read cybersecurity blogger who tweets or a renowned marketing executive on LinkedIn with a big presence on the web.

Within any sector, there are star influencers. Some have hundreds of thousands (if not millions) of followers. Many, on the other hand, might simply appear as average social media users. In some instances, they may only have a few thousand followers.

They will, however, have built a reputation for being industry leaders. They’re the ones who answer people’s inquiries. They’re the individuals who create the most interesting social media posts in their sector. They post the greatest photos, make the most engaging films and lead the most informative online debates based on their area of expertise.

How Influencer Marketing Grows Your Brand

For marketers seeking to boost their consumer trust, brand recognition, and various other advantages, a strong influencer marketing strategy may be exactly what they need. Considering more than half of all consumers prefer word of mouth and social media to inform their purchasing decisions, it’s easy to see why.

Influencers can help grow your brand in several ways. Among other things, a successful influencer campaign helps:

  • Improve brand awareness
  • Increase visibility and reach
  • Demonstrate trust and authority
  • Drive purchasing decisions

Influencer marketing allows you to grow your brand’s exposure and positioning in the market. Users on social media can learn more about your company, its history and the goods or services it offers. One of the most significant advantages of social media marketing is working with an influencer who has the ability to move the needle.

Put simply, influencer marketing helps companies navigate through the challenges other marketing methods face in today’s world. With ad blockers becoming widespread, as well as people’s general dislike for obtrusive advertising, influencer marketing is a fantastic way for organizations to connect with customers in a non-intrusive manner.

Marketers can reach millions of people they might not otherwise have access to by working with the right influencers. By carefully evaluating influencers based on both qualitative and quantitative criteria, brands can choose who they want for their campaigns.

So, how do you leverage influencers and influencer marketing to help grow your brand?

Influencer Marketing Strategies and Best Practices

Like any other marketing strategy, successful influencer campaigns require careful targeting and deliberate planning. You won’t help your brand much by tossing free products or services at anyone with a few followers and interest in your offerings.

Below are a few good strategies and best practices when courting influencers and formulating a sound strategy.

Start With a Plan

When you’re in the planning stages, you need to take a step back and think about which platforms your brand is likely to succeed on. For example, businesses in fashion and beauty tend to shine on YouTube and Instagram.

If you’re taking a formal approach, compensation varies considerably between influencers. Micro-influencers are typically more focused. If you find one that’s already passionate about your offerings, they’re often happy to take free products or services in exchange for promotion. But tread carefully, because offers of free products and no monetary compensation could turn off some influencers or sour them on your brand. Some influencers will refer you to talent agencies who represent them to work out a deal. Others work independently.

You’ll also need to consider the anticipated return on your investment. In other words, how will you evaluate the contributions of influencer posts to your overall marketing goals? One method might be to compare your expectations for influencers with those of other businesses.

Put simply, it’s crucial to do the necessary research upfront before diving into the world of influencer marketing. Working with individual influencers varies considerably from brand to brand and influencer to influencer. You should revisit your strategies regularly to refine and perfect them as you learn and adapt.

Create a Budget and Management Strategy

Unlike a more automated ad strategy, influencers are human and frequently have several partnerships, so some may fall behind in their duties to post on time or make mistakes in your requested tags or calls to action. You’ll need to be hands-on with these relationships in order to grow them and refine your technique through experience about what works and what doesn’t.

Consider establishing a formal ambassador program if you have the time and money. Many brands employ ambassadors in conjunction with their content, putting influencers on the ground floor of new product releases or service offerings. This is a powerful combination that can help drive potentially viral campaigns.

Hiring an influencer marketing firm to do the research and coordination for you is a smart option for businesses wanting to target a larger group of influencers.

Determine Your Goals and Messaging

The two most frequent uses of influencer marketing are to raise brand recognition and to boost sales. However, instead of aiming for big goals like this, it’s more effective to start by determining what your company’s needs are. Maybe you want to grow your customer base among a younger demographic. You might also want to develop a new product or enter a new vertical and need insights from potential customers.

Influencers have the capacity to reach highly specialized audiences. Instead of relying on hundreds or thousands of followers, influencers will assist you in targeting a very specific audience that’s likely to be interested in your product and interact with your material.

Content with a conversational tone and personalized narrative distinguishes successful influencer campaigns from the product- or sales-focused posts that a company may publish on its own feed.

Influencers who’ve worked hard to build their following won’t work with a business that makes their own brand seem inconsistent. As such, it’s important to consider the content your influencers share.

While many influencers consider themselves creators, there’s no guarantee their creative bent matches your brand’s messaging and objective. Put simply, you need to collaborate with your influencers to spread a message that’s consistent for both their following and your business. It’s also wise to consider tying content strategies into your influencer campaigns.

Even though influencers are individuals, you shouldn’t expect to manage them as an employee. Setting clear content guidelines is a good idea.

Find the Right Influencers

Finding the right influencers is no less important than planning and budgeting. If you’re fielding your options, the only challenge you’ll face is who to choose. Instagram alone has more than half a million active influencers.

The first place to look might surprise you — it’s not their follower count. Instead, focus on the kind and quality of content they’re producing. Get an idea of the kind of messages these influencers are sending by going through their feed (on all platforms, not just the one your company is researching) to understand how they communicate.

Next, consider their credibility. You can get a feel for this by looking through the comment threads on their content. Take note of their level of familiarity with your industry. Does their content sound well-informed and demonstrate expertise on the topics relevant to your industry?

Once you find the right influencer, nurturing the relationship is key to successful influencer campaigns. Like a rewarding personal relationship, the best possible influencer is one who truly admires your brand through good times and bad.

Frequently Asked Questions

If you’re thinking of jumping into the world of influencer marketing to help grow your brand, you undoubtedly have plenty of questions and concerns. Below are a few of the most common ones to help guide your influencer interest.

How much does an influencer marketing campaign cost?

Every influencer campaign is different, so it’s difficult to estimate costs. It varies across industries and fluctuates based on the number of influencers your brand uses, the reach of individual influencers and any additional marketing spend invested in promoting the campaign.

Can an influencer campaign be integrated as part of a larger campaign?

Absolutely. Many brands prefer to run influencer campaigns alongside other marketing activities. And in fact, a strong content strategy is often integral to a successful influencer campaign.

Why is influencer marketing important for my brand?

Influencer marketing isn’t perfect for every business, but for brands with potential mass appeal, a strong social media presence and existing industry influencers, it’s extremely effective. Some reasons brands might consider an influencer marketing strategy include:

  • Your business is losing customers to competitors with influencers
  • Consumers in your industry are swayed heavily by influencers
  • Your target market uses ad blockers, making traditional marketing less effective

What are the benefits of influencer marketing?

In addition to leveraging the trust and authenticity that influencer marketing inherently provides, there are a number of other benefits. Effective influencer marketing:

  • Bolsters your overall content strategy
  • Zeroes in on your target audience
  • Develops collaborative partnerships
  • Increases brand awareness

Where do I start with an influencer campaign?

If you’re thinking about influencer marketing, you have two choices: do it yourself or hire a third-party agency to handle the specifics for you. Both alternatives come with advantages and disadvantages, but many brands opt for an agency because it’s more cost-effective and time-efficient.

Improve Your Influencer Marketing With Great Content

Influencer marketing isn’t only about locating someone with a following and paying them to say nice things about you. That’s what viral celebrities are for. Influencers are individuals who’ve invested time in developing their own brand and cultivating their following. As such, they’re cautious about their reputation and the brands they endorse. But that level of investment is precisely what makes influencer marketing so valuable.

If you’re considering an influencer campaign for your brand, don’t neglect the content side of things. Influencers might be more excited to share a great piece of content on your site than a hard-sell sales pitch. Your messaging is no less important than the people spreading it. Crowd Content matches talented writers and editors to brands seeking high-quality content — at scale and in every industry. If you’re ready to push your marketing efforts into overdrive, get in touch with us today.

The post Strategies for Growing Your Business With Influencer Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/leveraging-influencers/feed/ 0
Here Are the 5 Best Social Media Management Tools for 2023 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/here-are-the-5-best-social-media-management-tools-for-2023/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/here-are-the-5-best-social-media-management-tools-for-2023/#respond Thu, 17 Feb 2022 06:00:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=33214 In 2023, social media is a mainstay. If you’re in marketing, you’re using it. Full stop. Businesses leverage social media because it’s effective. After all, hundreds of millions of people use sites like Facebook, Twitter, Pinterest and Instagram daily. That’s a lot of eyeballs scrolling through media feeds. And a lot of opportunities for new […]

The post Here Are the 5 Best Social Media Management Tools for 2023 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
In 2023, social media is a mainstay. If you’re in marketing, you’re using it. Full stop. Businesses leverage social media because it’s effective. After all, hundreds of millions of people use sites like Facebook, Twitter, Pinterest and Instagram daily. That’s a lot of eyeballs scrolling through media feeds. And a lot of opportunities for new customers.

But managing numerous social media profiles across a half-dozen platforms entails numerous activities. These might include writing and scheduling social media posts, replying to comments, monitoring the success of social campaigns and more.

In other words, social media management is a lot of work.

Successful social media management requires constant attention. For many, it’s a full-time job. Fortunately, there are several tools available that help with your business’s social media presence. A social media management tool can help you maximize your social presence while minimizing your efforts.

What Are Social Media Management Tools?

Social media management tools simplify your social media presence across platforms. They give you a single platform to manage all of your profiles from. And they provide some excellent tools for getting the most from your social efforts. For big businesses, they’re incredibly useful. And for small teams and freelancers, they’re lifesavers.

Some of the most popular social media management solutions feature a variety of user-friendly features to help you manage your social presence. A few of the things they offer are:

  • A central tool to manage profiles across social media networks
  • Planning and scheduling social media postings
  • Automated monitoring and moderation
  • Improved analytics

Sounds good, right? It gets better.

The Benefits of Using Social Media Management Tools

The ability to see all your social media feeds in one location is likely the biggest advantage of social media management software. Being able to monitor customer conversations and campaign performance from a single platform saves time. And probably your sanity.

You can also save time by generating social media postings in advance and scheduling them to go live at a specific time. You won’t have to stop what you’re doing throughout the day to post on multiple platforms. You’ll also be able to better plan your content releases according to optimal posting times.

Blog-Promo-2022-4-1

Stay Organized

Spreadsheets are popular among social media marketers for planning and managing their posts. But it’s far more effective to utilize a social media management tool. Most of them come with content planners to help you stay on top of things. They enable you to:

  • Balance different types of social messaging
  • Publish posts when they’re likely to receive the highest engagement
  • Curate compelling content to share with your followers
  • Plan for seasonal and release-specific messaging

These planners allow you to schedule posts when your target audience is most likely watching their feeds, ready to engage. In most cases, adjusting your schedule is as simple as dragging and dropping.

Analyze Social Performance

Another crucial component of successful social media management is analytics. Every major social platform offers analytics reporting that shows you how well your social marketing efforts are doing and where they need improving.

But the built-in analytics on individual platforms don’t show you the big picture of your broader social marketing efforts.

With a social media management tool, you can leverage cross-platform analytics to find out what content performs best across multiple networks. You can create custom reports based on the requirements you need rather than network-specific data.

Finally, maintaining consistency on every social network is a significant time sink. Social media management tools offer content libraries that can help keep things organized across networks. It also helps ensure your social presence is on-topic and brand consistent, regardless of the network.

Streamline Social Feeds and Messaging

Staying on top of the conversation is a cornerstone of effective social media marketing. It’s not just about engaging with your customers — you need to know what the conversation is surrounding your brand.

While many platforms allow you to filter conversations based on keywords, doing so across multiple platforms is a chore, to say the least. With a social management tool, you can listen for keywords across social networks, email lists and other channels, all from a single dashboard.

This kind of integration enables you to engage and do the following:

  • Monitor post interactions, such as likes, shares and comments
  • View and send messages
  • Examine profiles and monitor follows
  • Monitor and respond to conversations

All from a single platform. You’ll never find yourself bouncing through browser tabs again.

For bigger businesses, social management tools are invaluable. Not only do they consolidate messaging across platforms, but they also provide routing options to get each message to the appropriate person or department. All of which interface with your business’s CRM.

Blog-Promo-2022-5-1

The 5 Best Social Management Tools for 2023

There are countless social media management tools in the wild. As is the case with other business solutions, choosing the right one depends on your brand’s needs.

Perhaps you need a tool to manage multiple profiles. Or maybe you’re more interested in content scheduling. On the other hand, you might want something that integrates with your CRM and provides in-depth insights.

Whether you’re a freelancer, a small business with ambitious marketing plans or a thriving enterprise, you’re covered. These five social media management tools have what you need.

The Best Overall: Sprout Social

Sprout Social offers robust publishing features, detailed analytics and a wealth of scheduling options. The platform supports all major social networks, including Facebook, Twitter, Instagram, LinkedIn and Pinterest. All in an easy-to-use package that won’t break the budget.

Some of the biggest benefits that Sprout Social offers are:

  • An excellent dashboard for managing social media postings, feeds and schedules
  • Tools for social media optimization
  • Reports and analytics for measuring user engagement and returns on investment
  • Excellent scheduling tools for batching and posting content

Sprout Social also provides great social listening features, including tools for identifying influencers. There’s even CRM functionality focused on social media contacts. Impressive analytics capabilities and an easy-to-use interface round out Sprout Social’s offerings.

This makes it a fantastic all-in-one social media management program. With a commendable balance of cost, features and analytics, Sprout Social is a great choice for most small and medium-sized businesses.

Best for Freelancers and Small Businesses: SEMrush

SEMrush is best known as an SEO platform, but it also offers extremely capable social media management tools for all the major social networks. The social management tools cover posting across networks, including automated scheduling and content editing tools. There are also ad management features for Facebook and Instagram.

SEMrush’s social media tracker enables marketers to track user engagement across networks. It covers post reactions as well as mentions across each network. It also aggregates analytics data, so you can monitor performance from a single dashboard.

Being an SEO tool at heart, SEMrush is keen on competitive analysis. As such, its social media tools include features for monitoring your competitors to see what kind of posts they’re putting up and how often.

The biggest benefit of using SEMrush for social media management is its SEO integrations. You can manage your social media presence and your SEO efforts from a single tool. And integrations between the two are robust and seamless. Perfect for freelancers and small businesses with limited budgets and manpower.

Best for Analytics: Hootsuite

Hootsuite is a complete social media toolkit with some of the best analytics available. With support for over 20 social networks and an App Directory that provides even more, you’re never left wanting. The platform also provides integrations to other popular tools, such as Mailchimp, Zendesk and Canva.

The comprehensive analytics that Hootsuite offers are some of the best available, providing detailed tracking tools, customizable reports and performance metrics. They help paint a clear picture of your social marketing efforts by pulling from over 200 metrics. Once generated, you can export the reports to Excel, PowerPoint or PDF to share with colleagues.

It’s worth mentioning that adding analytics capabilities increases the platform’s price. But for businesses that depend on social media for most of their marketing efforts, the cost is worth it.

Best for Automation: HubSpot

HubSpot is an all-in-one solution geared toward enterprises. Along with its social media marketing offerings, it provides SEO management, a CRM platform and even email services.

The biggest selling point of HubSpot is its full line of marketing integration and automation tools. While you can certainly manage your social presence with ease, the platform also has tools for:

  • Editing and creating landing pages
  • Content management
  • Lead management
  • Automated content posting on your website

HubSpot’s bulk scheduling feature makes queuing up and posting to various networks a breeze. With a provided template, you can add your batched content, select a post schedule, choose which networks to post to and select your campaigns. The template even shows you the character count of each post. When you’re ready, you can drag it back over to HubSpot and you’re all done.

From social media to web conversions, HubSpot lets you optimize every step of your sales funnel. It’ll even help you create targeted CTAs to improve ROI. There’s also full Canva integration, which allows marketers to design attractive images with a few clicks. For full-scope marketing efficiency, HubSpot is difficult to beat.

Most Affordable: Buffer

If you’re looking for a tool that’s a little less complex and a little more affordable, Buffer might be the one for you. Since it’s one of the few tools that offers a free plan, it’s a great solution for freelancers. It’s also a great option for younger businesses just getting into social media marketing.

Despite its low cost, Buffer still provides a lot of value. It supports all the major networks, including Facebook, Twitter, Instagram, LinkedIn and Pinterest. In addition to accessing all your feeds from the platform, you can schedule all your social media posts using a full-featured content scheduler. There’s also an optimization tool for hashtags and mentions across platforms.

A standout feature of Buffer is its available browser extension for scheduling posts. With the extension installed, you can click a browser button, compose an update and add it to a queue.

Who Should Use Social Media Management Tools?

Blog-Promo-2022-6-1

If you spend more than a few hours per week managing social media, a social media management tool is a good idea. If you spend more than a few hours per day doing so, you need a social media management tool.

These tools are excellent for freelancers and one-person marketing teams — people who are accustomed to wearing multiple hats. When you’re juggling multiple tasks across numerous platforms, simplification and automation are essential. This gives you time to think about strategy rather than dealing with daily busy work such as posting and content creation.

For small businesses, social media management tools offer big benefits. If you have a marketing team, these tools help them collaborate better and more securely across platforms. They also give smaller businesses the power to run with the big dogs, so to speak. Even if you don’t have the staff hours to do so, you can run campaigns with daily posts.

Social media management enables secure cross-platform collaboration, CRM integration, message routing, and more for larger companies. They also provide permission controls so businesses with compliance concerns can keep PR incidents to a minimum.

The bottom line is that social media management tools provide more than just a single platform to manage your social profiles. All the tools listed here offer advanced scheduling features for managing posts. More importantly, they provide integrated analytics that can synergize your marketing efforts across networks.

In marketing, where even small improvements can equate to big returns, social media management tools are invaluable.

Conclusion

Your social media presence has a big impact on your brand. Social media management tools give you the power to manage, automate and optimize that presence without making it your full-time job. They’ll also provide you with insights to help amplify your brand’s impact and grow your business.

If you’re looking for other ways to free up your time so you can focus on the bigger picture, let Crowd Content help. Our team of professional freelance writers can provide you with in-depth articles, engaging blog posts, compelling web copy and more. We’ll even write your social media posts for you. In other words, we’ll supercharge your content strategy. Go ahead and take a look at what we offer or get in touch with us to find out more.

The post Here Are the 5 Best Social Media Management Tools for 2023 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/here-are-the-5-best-social-media-management-tools-for-2023/feed/ 0
Content Outsourcing: Ways to Avoid Common Quality Problems https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/outsourcing-content/content-outsourcing-ways-to-avoid-common-quality-problems/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/outsourcing-content/content-outsourcing-ways-to-avoid-common-quality-problems/#respond Thu, 27 Jan 2022 21:48:31 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=33061 Content marketing is the process of planning, creating and sharing content with the people in your target audience. Sharing content with others can help you drive organic traffic to your website, convert leads into customers and keep long-term customers engaged with your brand. Although content marketing has many benefits, it can be difficult to find […]

The post Content Outsourcing: Ways to Avoid Common Quality Problems appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content marketing is the process of planning, creating and sharing content with the people in your target audience. Sharing content with others can help you drive organic traffic to your website, convert leads into customers and keep long-term customers engaged with your brand.

Although content marketing has many benefits, it can be difficult to find the time to create as much content as you need to meet your goals. Content outsourcing is a great way to overcome this challenge. Outsourcing refers to hiring a team of freelancers to produce articles, blog posts, landing pages, case studies and other types of content.

We created this guide to help you understand the challenges that can arise when you hire freelancers without having a plan in place for monitoring their output and making sure they understand your brand’s approach to connecting with customers. The guide also includes tips for outsourcing your content production without sacrificing quality.

Benefits of Content Outsourcing

Before we dive into the challenges of outsourcing, it’s important to understand the benefits. Working with a team of freelancers can help your business in the following ways:

Time Savings

Creating your own content takes time away from developing new products, connecting with customers and managing your company’s finances. A team of freelancers can take research and writing tasks off your plate, giving you more time to focus on business growth.

Consistency

As a business owner, you’re responsible for supervising employees, resolving customer service issues and overseeing daily operations, among many other activities. Even if you plan to spend a few hours writing and editing content, you may have to change your schedule at the last minute based on what’s happening in your business.

As a result, it’s difficult to maintain a high level of consistency. You may publish a blog post one week and then not publish anything else for two or three weeks, making your content marketing strategy less effective than it could be if you published on a consistent basis. When you partner with a team of freelance professionals, they can work on your content no matter how busy you are.

Flexibility

You could hire a full-time writer to execute your content marketing strategy, but that isn’t always the best course of action. Not only does adding a team member increase your monthly payroll expenses, it also makes it more difficult to be flexible when needed. If you want to scale up your content production, a full-time writer might not be able to handle the increased workload. Conversely, if you want to slow down a little, your full-time writer won’t have enough work to do.

Working with freelancers solves this problem because you only have to pay for the content you receive. If you want to scale up, you can add another freelancer to your team; if you want to reduce your output, you can give fewer assignments.

Expertise

Working with freelancers exposes you to different points of view, which may help you create content that’s more relevant to the people in your target audience. If everyone on your team has the same life experiences, it’s easy to miss out on opportunities to connect with customers from different backgrounds. For example, if your employees all come from the same region of the country, they may not understand the pain points of customers in different regions. They may also lack an understanding of important cultural traditions, making it more difficult to connect with certain market segments.

Outsourcing Content Production: Common Problems

It’s clear that outsourcing your content production has many benefits. Unfortunately, many business owners jump into outsourcing without understanding what they need to do to make sure their freelancers produce high-quality content. These are just a few of the issues that can arise when you outsource your content production without planning ahead.

Difficulty Explaining Products and Services

Nobody knows your product or service better than you do, but you must be able to explain key features and benefits to freelancers. If you can’t explain your products effectively, your freelance team won’t have enough information to write in-depth content that’s relevant and useful to your audience. This can severely affect the overall quality of the content, making your content strategy much less effective.

Management Problems

Content marketing is about more than writing content and publishing it on your website. You need to create a content plan, monitor content quality and provide actionable feedback to ensure each writer has enough information to write in-depth content. You may think it’s easier to do everything in-house, but if you don’t have the time to oversee each project, the quality of your content is likely to suffer.

Fortunately, you can take advantage of the benefits of outsourcing without spending a lot of time managing a freelance team. At Crowd Content, clients have access to expert project managers who are responsible for monitoring content quality, updating project instructions and ensuring only the most talented writers are assigned to each project.

Lack of Investment in Brand Story

Storytelling isn’t just for fiction books; it’s also an important aspect of your marketing strategy as it can help you build trust and increase customer loyalty. Many business owners are concerned that freelance writers won’t be able to tell their story effectively. If you don’t take the time to find a writer who can communicate effectively with your prospects and customers, the quality of your content won’t be as good as it should be.

How to Outsource Effectively

Most of the challenges described above come up when a business owner rushes into working with a team of freelancers. If you don’t take the time to find the right people, set reasonable expectations and provide ongoing feedback, the quality of your content is likely to decline. Fortunately, there are several things you can do to prevent these problems and maintain a high level of quality without developing every piece of content by yourself.

Project Selection

If you’re concerned that a freelance writer won’t be able to tell your story as well as you could, reserve storytelling projects for staff members and outsource other types of content to trusted freelancers. Product descriptions, SEO city pages and educational articles don’t require as much storytelling, so you can hand them off to a freelancer without losing out on an opportunity to get customers interested in the story of your business.

Alternatively, you could spend a few hours educating freelancers on your products and services, giving them the information they need to tell your brand’s story effectively. If you decide to take this route, you may need to pay each freelancer an hourly rate for their time, even if you’ve already agreed on a per-word or per-piece rate for your content.

Content Metrics

Before you start a new project, have a clear idea of what you want to accomplish. If you don’t set goals early on, you won’t be able to determine if your content marketing efforts are successful. Metrics can also help you assess the quality of the content developed by your freelance team. Here are some of the metrics you can use:

  • Social shares: Determine how many times your posts have been shared on platforms like Facebook, Twitter and Instagram. The more shares you have, the more opportunities you have to attract new customers.
  • Visitors: Track how many visitors land on your pages each month and then compare that number to how many monthly visitors you had before you published the new content.
  • Search engine rankings: Google rewards website owners who focus on quality. If your page rankings improve after you start working with a team of freelancers, that’s a good sign they’re producing quality content.
  • Backlinks: When Website A links to Website B, that link is known as a backlink. Google sees each backlink as a sign of quality; after all, you wouldn’t want to send your audience members to a site with irrelevant or low-quality content. Before you start working with a team of freelancers, determine how many backlinks you already have. If you have many more backlinks after publishing the new content, that’s another sign your freelancers are focusing on quality and relevance.
  • Bounce rate: Bounce rate refers to the percentage of visitors who leave your site immediately after landing on one of your pages. A high bounce rate may indicate the content doesn’t meet the visitor’s needs. If your bounce rate decreases after you start outsourcing, it could indicate that visitors like the new content better than the older content.

Style and Branding Guidelines

If you plan to work with multiple freelancers, make sure you provide detailed style and branding guidelines. A style guide explains how your content should be written and formatted, ensuring consistency across all platforms. Branding guidelines are standards for representing your company; they may include logos, colour palettes and design elements specific to your business. Having every writer follow the same guidelines ensures your visitors won’t be confused when they read your content.

Clear Instructions

Eliminate confusion by providing clear instructions for each project. Detailed instructions make it easier for freelancers to meet your expectations, and they can also prevent delays caused by misunderstandings. When you launch a new project, consider including the following in your creative brief:

  • Minimum/maximum word counts
  • Guidelines for sentence and paragraph length (e.g. “Write short paragraphs” or “No more than four sentences per paragraph”)
  • Formatting requirements (bold, italics, HTML tags, bulleted lists, etc.)
  • Terms to avoid
  • Keywords to include in the content
  • Description of where the content will be published or how it will be used
  • Demographic information about your target audience
  • Reference requirements
  • Linking requirements (internal and external links)

Project Workflow

Before you start a project, set clear expectations regarding your delivery requirements. Some business owners prefer to receive each piece of content as it’s completed, while others prefer to receive batches of content each week or each month. If you want the content to go through several rounds of editing and quality assurance review, account for these extra stages when setting your expectations.

If possible, create a buffer between each deadline and the date you plan to publish the final content. For example, if you want to publish a blog post on March 10, you might want to set the deadline for March 1 so you have time to review it and request any needed changes.

Content Samples

One of the best ways to prevent misunderstandings is to give your freelancers at least one example to follow when they’re writing. If you find a blog post that does a great job of telling a brand’s story, include a link in your order brief. You can also provide samples of your past content and tell freelancers what you want them to repeat and what you want them to avoid.

Start Outsourcing Today

Crowd Content has a team of freelancers available to provide a wide range of writing services. We even offer managed content services, connecting you with an expert project manager who can oversee your entire project from beginning to end and helping you reap the benefits of outsourcing without having to do your own editing and content review.

The post Content Outsourcing: Ways to Avoid Common Quality Problems appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/outsourcing-content/content-outsourcing-ways-to-avoid-common-quality-problems/feed/ 0
Is Pinterest Good for SEO? How to Use Pinterest to Drive Traffic https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/is-pinterest-good-for-seo/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/is-pinterest-good-for-seo/#respond Thu, 13 Jan 2022 18:00:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=32785 When Pinterest launched in 2010, it quickly gained popularity as a place to share recipes, craft ideas and decorating tips. Since then, the site has been transformed from a digital bulletin board to a visual search engine, making it an important component of search engine optimization. With a few tweaks, your Pinterest profile can help […]

The post Is Pinterest Good for SEO? How to Use Pinterest to Drive Traffic appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
When Pinterest launched in 2010, it quickly gained popularity as a place to share recipes, craft ideas and decorating tips. Since then, the site has been transformed from a digital bulletin board to a visual search engine, making it an important component of search engine optimization. With a few tweaks, your Pinterest profile can help you drive organic traffic to your website, increasing sales and making it easier to spread the word about your business.

How Pinterest Affects SEO

Is Pinterest good for SEO? The short answer is yes. Because Pinterest has evolved into a digital search engine, it can be a great source of organic traffic if you understand how to use it. One of the biggest reasons Pinterest should be a component of your SEO strategy is because the site has more than 450 million active monthly users. If even a tiny percentage of these users see one of your pins, you have the opportunity to drive more traffic to your website than ever before.

Another reason Pinterest is good for SEO is that many users are already primed to buy something or request more information about a product or service. If these users see your pins, they’re more likely to visit your website than a search engine user who doesn’t want to buy anything or isn’t sure what they want to do. You can take advantage of their intent by incorporating buyer keywords into your pins and descriptions. A buyer keyword is a specific word or phrase that someone uses when they want to buy a product or service.

Finally, Pinterest provides an important opportunity that other social networks don’t: the ability to create product pins. When you write a Facebook post, you can mention your products and services, but there’s no way to create individual product pages and promote them to other Facebook users. Product pins allow merchants to highlight their products, making it easier to convert Pinterest views into sales. In some cases, it’s even possible for customers to purchase products without leaving the Pinterest website, eliminating an extra step in the purchase process and making it more likely the user will complete the transaction.

December-January-IG-FB-Posts-10

Improving SEO With Pinterest

Now that you understand how Pinterest affects SEO, it’s time to create an account. It’s best to register as a business so you can access Pinterest’s scheduling, advertising and analytics tools. When it’s time to choose a user name, the decision you make can have a big effect on your SEO results. It may be tempting to choose something clever or quirky, but you should create a user name based on the needs of your target audience.

If you’re promoting a cookbook, for example, you may want to include a keyword like “chicken recipes” or “slow cooker meals” to help people understand what your content is about. Including a relevant keyword can also help drive traffic to your profile, making your Pinterest SEO strategy even more effective.

Setting up a Pinterest Profile

After you create your account, it’s time to write an attention-getting profile optimized with relevant keywords. For best results, your company logo and any other images you use should have the same logo, colour scheme and other elements as the photos on your website and other social media profiles. Using the same design elements across all platforms ensures customers know what to expect from your brand.

The profile header should contain your formal business name, but there’s a trick you can use to make this headline more effective for SEO. After your company name, add a vertical bar (the | character) followed by a keyword related to what you do. If you operate a plus-size boutique, for example, your profile headline will be more effective for SEO if it reads “Daisy’s Boutique | Stylish Clothing for Plus-Size Women” instead of just “Daisy’s Boutique.”

Conducting Keyword Research

General keyword research software isn’t as effective for Pinterest optimization as it is for identifying relevant keywords for your website. Fortunately, Pinterest has built-in tools to help you understand what kind of information Pinterest users want to find. For example, the Guided Search tool is similar to Google’s autocomplete feature, which makes keyword suggestions based on what you type into the search bar. A search for “sofa” brings up suggestions like “sofa set designs,” “sofa table decor” and “sofa design living rooms.”

You can also use Pinterest topics to identify keywords that are relevant to your audience members. When you look at the category page, it lists more than 30 topics, from art to women’s fashion. Click your desired category to look at some of the most popular pins; you can get keyword ideas from the subtopics and pin titles. The wedding category, for example, has subtopics for wedding decorations, bridal party attire, wedding cakes and wedding flowers. Within the wedding decorations subtopic, you’ll find pins focused on gold wedding tablescapes, affordable wedding favors, wedding photo display ideas and rooftop wedding ideas, all of which make great keywords.

Verifying Your Website

Claiming your website can help you take advantage of additional SEO benefits. In addition to giving you access to Pinterest analytics, verifying your site also ensures your profile photo appears with the pins that come from your site. Once you’re a verified merchant, a blue checkmark will appear next to the website URL in your profile, increasing trust and making Pinterest users feel more comfortable clicking a link to your site or buying one of your products and services.

Pinterest Marketing Tips to Improve Your SEO

Once you set up your profile and determine which keywords to target, how you use Pinterest can make or break your SEO strategy. Following these tips can help you drive organic traffic to your website and bring positive attention to your business.

Pin Frequency

Pinterest isn’t a set-it-and-forget-it platform. For best results, you should be pinning several times per day, as every pin represents a new opportunity to connect with a potential customer. It’s natural to be concerned about pinning too much, but remember that Pinterest is very different from Facebook, Twitter and other platforms. You won’t be overwhelming potential customers by posting multiple pins per day. Try to space out your pins so you have a steady flow of new content, rather than a quick burst of content that users may forget about within a few hours.

December-January-IG-FB-Posts-11

Keywords in Descriptions

Pin Descriptions

When you create a pin, you have an opportunity to write a description that captures attention and helps optimize your content for the search engines. Fortunately, Pinterest allows you to write several sentences, making it easier to incorporate relevant keywords and help users understand what your pins are all about.

First and foremost, your description should be aimed at helping readers. Keywords are important, but they aren’t helpful if they make it difficult for people to understand what you’re trying to say. Your description should also be written in a positive tone. You don’t want potential customers to think you have a negative outlook or spend your time bashing people online. Every pin description should contain the following:

  • Your brand name, preferably in the first sentence
  • Keywords that relate to the pin or board content
  • Valuable information about the topic
  • A request for the reader to do something (click, read, learn, etc.)

As with any other type of content you write, your descriptions should be free of typos, spelling mistakes and grammar errors. If proofreading is one of your weak areas, have an employee or a trusted friend review each description before you publish it.

Board Descriptions

Pinterest also allows you to write a description for each board you create. These descriptions appear just below your profile picture when someone views one of your boards, so they’re prime real estate. Each board description should contain some of the same information as your pin descriptions: your brand name, relevant keywords and a clear explanation of the content.

You should also describe your target audience by explaining who’ll benefit from viewing the pins on your boards. If you run a budgeting website, for example, the description for your meal planning board might be aimed at busy moms who want to spend no more than $2 per serving on each family meal.

Content Quality

Keyword-rich pin and board descriptions are great, but they can only get you so far. You need to focus on writing high-quality content on Pinterest, on your website and on your other social media profiles. If a user clicks a Pinterest link and ends up on a page lacking substance, they may not trust you enough to buy from you. Publishing quality content can also help you reduce your bounce rate—the percentage of people who land on one of your pages and leave without viewing other pages on the site—improving your search engine rankings.

As always, it’s important to meet the needs of your audience members. Not all visitors prefer the same types of content, so try to publish a mix of blog posts, articles, videos, infographics, reports and e-books. If you don’t have a professional writer on staff, hire an experienced writer or editor to write content or review your drafts. Taking this extra step can help you position your brand as one that always puts its audience members first.

Is Pinterest Good for SEO? Best Practices to Follow

Like any other endeavour, Pinterest is most effective when you follow established best practices. These practices can help you improve your search engine rankings, position yourself as an expert in your industry and better meet the needs of your audience.

Image Orientation

Something as simple as image orientation can make a big difference in how people perceive your pins. That’s why you should use vertical images. Otherwise, the image may get cut off, making it difficult for Pinterest users to see what you were trying to share.

December-January-IG-FB-Posts-12

Business Logos

Pinterest is an essential component of your branding strategy, so don’t miss out on the opportunity to share your brand image with users. Add your business logo to every pin so audience members start to associate your brand with your content. Just be careful not to put it in the bottom right corner of a pin; this is where Pinterest puts its product icons.

Linking Practices

The purpose of using Pinterest for SEO is to drive organic traffic to your website. To do this, you must make sure the content on your linked pages matches the content on your website pages. Imagine if you were using Pinterest, clicked a link on a pin about the best shoes for flat feet and ended up on a page about holiday decorations. You’d probably be confused, and you might even get annoyed with the pin creator for sending you on a wild goose chase. Make sure the links you include in each pin are highly relevant to the reader’s intent.

Using Pinterest to Your Advantage

Pinterest has made it much easier for business owners to compete with large corporations when it comes to building their audiences and driving organic traffic to their websites. Pinterest can also help you build trust with audience members, making them more likely to buy from you.

If you have a small marketing team, it can be difficult to find time to create several new pins each day and update them as needed. The expert freelance writers at Crowd Content can help. We provide a variety of writing services, from creating social media posts to helping business owners improve their search engine rankings with quality content. Crowd Content also has subject matter experts to help you with keyword research or fact-check your content before you publish it.

The post Is Pinterest Good for SEO? How to Use Pinterest to Drive Traffic appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/is-pinterest-good-for-seo/feed/ 0
How Freelancers Support In-house Teams https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-freelancers-support-in-house-teams/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-freelancers-support-in-house-teams/#respond Thu, 09 Dec 2021 18:30:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=32467 When you work with freelance writers, you get the benefits of accurate, well-written content without having to hire a full-time writer or assign extra tasks to busy in-house team members. As for finding freelancers, it’s easier than ever. According to CNBC, the gig economy has grown over 15% from 2010 to 2020 as more Americans […]

The post How Freelancers Support In-house Teams appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
When you work with freelance writers, you get the benefits of accurate, well-written content without having to hire a full-time writer or assign extra tasks to busy in-house team members. As for finding freelancers, it’s easier than ever. According to CNBC, the gig economy has grown over 15% from 2010 to 2020 as more Americans enter the freelance workforce. This trend toward freelance work has continued to accelerate during the COVID-19 pandemic, with estimates from the World Economic Forum predicting a global growth rate of 17% per year for the gig economy.

The Benefits of Hiring Freelance Writers to Create Content

When you’re contemplating whether to rely on your in-house team or work with freelance writers to create content, there are plenty of reasons to choose freelancers. Some of the biggest benefits of hiring freelance writers for content creation include:

Cost Savings

Keeping a full-time writer on staff can put a big dent in your budget, especially if your content needs are inconsistent or change with the seasons. Hiring freelancers means you only pay for professional writing when you need it, and you don’t have to deal with the overhead costs of adding a new employee.

November-2021-IGFBLI-Social-Posts-3

Professional Quality

Bad grammar and poor word choice can turn off potential customers, costing you sales and hampering your ability to make a profit. According to CXL, poor grammar can affect your site’s credibility, particularly if typos and nonstandard phrasing occur on static business pages or product pages. Professional freelance writers have the experience necessary to create error-free content so your business makes a great first impression. Freelance writers also know how to craft content that captures attention. With expertise in marketing, search engine optimization and best practices for web writing, a freelancer helps ensure your content achieves your goals. 

Writer expertise isn’t just about grammar and keywording, though. It also involves building your brand identity. Freelance writers are experts at adding the right style and tone to your content so readers remain interested and engaged.

Specialized Knowledge

Freelancers bring specialized knowledge to your project that you might not otherwise be able to find. Some have niche expertise in specific fields, such as medical degrees or prior industry experience. Others might offer specializations in particular types of writing, such as product descriptions, social media posts or long-form content. Because freelancers come from diverse backgrounds and have expertise in a variety of fields, you can easily find a writer or team of writers perfect for your project.

Offsite Project Completion

With an in-house writer, you need to provide office space and equipment. Freelancers work remotely, and they’re used to working independently and meeting deadlines, so you can rest assured the content you need gets done on the timeline you require. Using freelancers typically doesn’t require you to restructure your existing teams, either. So there’s no downtime involved when you add a freelancer to your existing project structure. 

Fast Turnaround

Outsourcing your content writing to freelancers can speed up your overall timeline. Freelance writers deliver high-quality content quickly, and you can specify the deadline to make planning easier. Writing projects assigned to your in-house team could get sidelined as other tasks come up, but a professional freelance writer can prioritize your content and keep your editorial content calendar on track. Freelancers also work all through the day, so you might be able to get a quicker turnaround from a freelance team than you could from employees who are limited to working a 9-to-5 shift in the office. If you need content within an extremely short time frame, such as less than 24 hours, a freelancer may be your best option.

Agility and Trend Spotting

Freelancers tend to stay abreast of what’s happening in the world of content creation and SEO. While full-time employees might have too much on their plates to track the latest Google search engine algorithm adjustment or trending keywords, freelancers know the latest best practices to get your page to rise in the rankings and capture reader attention. According to Quick Sprout, 42% of companies lack the skills in-house for effective content marketing, which makes hiring a freelancer with that expertise the wise choice.

Providing Relief to Your In-House Team

Overburdening your in-house employees can lead to unwanted turnover and missed deadlines. Hiring a freelance writer frees up employees to do what they’re best at instead of concentrating on trying to produce the next blog post or product description for your site. Alleviating the workload of your internal employees also helps build morale and reduces burnout. 

November-2021-IGFBLI-Social-Posts-4

Leveraging Freelancers to Support Your In-House Team

Hiring freelancers to supplement the work your in-house team is already doing can help speed up production and ease the burden on busy employees. Leveraging the talents of freelance writers is different from managing your regular team of full-time employees, though, and you need to determine where each fits into your overall business structure. Some things to consider when using freelance writers to support a team of in-house employees include:

Establishing the Parameters of the Job

While hiring new employees typically means bringing them through an onboarding process, freelancers don’t require onboarding. Instead, working with freelancers involves defining the parameters of what you need them to do for you. Before hiring freelance workers to take on your long-form content creation or social media posts, establish the scope of the job. Determine the budget, timeline and specific requirements of each piece of content you intend to outsource. Have an end goal in mind, including what you want the written content to accomplish. For example, if you’re outsourcing blog post creation, do you want that content to bring new visitors to your site, convert casual readers to buyers or establish your company as an authority in the industry? The goals of your content help determine the type of content you need.

Assign a Dedicated Project Lead to Deal with Freelancers

Talk to your existing team to determine where freelancer-produced content fits into your existing structure, and assign someone to take charge of scheduling and posting the content once it’s in your hands. Having a single person as the point of contact for freelancers ensures you aren’t providing conflicting information to your writers and keeps everyone accountable. Your project lead can also communicate with in-house teams to make sure the content is adhering to overall company guidelines and meeting the needs of different internal departments.

Automate Content Distribution

Hiring a freelance writer to create great content is only part of the process. You also need to get it onto your site and post links on social media. Automated tools can help you move content from your inbox to your live webpage. You can also create content calendars that give your internal team and site visitors an idea of when new content goes live. Automation can help you maintain consistency so a blog post always goes up on the same day of the week or social media posts appear within a certain time frame after an article is posted. The project lead in charge of content can handle setting up when and how to post the content your freelancers provide. 

Use Freelancers Strategically

While it can be tempting to assign all your writing tasks to a freelancer, you and your team may be better served by taking a more strategic approach. Decide what content is essential for your current business needs and establish specific, measurable goals for that content before hiring a freelancer.

If you need to completely revamp your website or create one from scratch, decide what pages are necessary for your initial launch or rebranding and which can wait for a later update. You might want to start with the front-facing landing page and some pages describing your services and company history, or you might need 10 blog posts to start establishing a regular blog posting schedule right away. Established companies with an existing web presence may want to bolster their social media or update product category pages, which could necessitate a different type of content strategy. Planning out your content needs and timeline makes it easier to figure out when in the process to hire a freelance writer. 

Some types of projects work better with freelancers, so part of your company strategy should involve assessing projects and finding the right ones to turn over to a writing team. Things to consider when deciding whether to use a freelance writer include:

  • Whether the project has a measurable, well-defined objective
  • Whether the timeline and scope are appropriate for a freelance contract
  • Whether any regulatory guidelines or privacy concerns prohibit the use of freelance talent for the project
  • Whether you have the skills in-house and whether your employees with applicable skills have the time to complete the project on their own

How to Work With Freelance Writers to Optimize Your Success

Working with freelancers can maximize the effectiveness of your entire team, and there are ways to set up the freelance job to simplify the process. For a successful long-term relationship with a freelance writing team, check out these tips:

Make Your Content Guidelines Crystal Clear

The more detail you can include in your content guidelines, the more easily a freelancer can create the content you need. You may want to establish separate written documents as brand guidelines and specific guidelines for each writing task. Your brand guidelines include details such as your overall brand tone, information about your target audience and examples of content you want to emulate.  Content guidelines for a specific project lay out the details of that particular piece of content, such as a blog post or social media update. Here are some specifics you may need to include in your content guidelines:

  • Specific keywords you want to use and keyword placement
  • Linking requirements to internal pages or external expert content
  • Any metadata you want included
  • Whether you want a call to action and how you want it framed

Establish Routine Check-Ins

If you’re hiring freelancers to provide content on a specific schedule, set up regular check-ins to assess how well the content is working and whether you need to make changes to your content plans. For example, a company that needs weekly blog content might reevaluate its content needs after a few months once it becomes clear which posts are doing best in terms of reader engagement and conversions. Writers producing social media posts may want frequent updates of new products and services you offer so they can include those things in the posts they write. 

Consider Offering Bylines

While some types of content need to remain anonymous or give the impression it was created in-house, other content might be better served by having a writer’s name attached. Offering to attach the freelance writer’s name to the content can be a way to establish a relationship with that writer and keep them producing the kind of content you need. Hiring the same writer or a small team of writers every time helps establish a consistent tone for your website, press releases or blog.

Provide the Necessary Information for Freelancers to Get the Job Done

In addition to a well-defined content brief that outlines the details you need included in your project, you may also have to provide other information that helps your writer accomplish your objectives. Including links to similar ranked content by competitors can help your freelancer create content that outperforms others in your industry. Freelancers also need to know what you want out of your content. If you want specific links included, you should provide those. Sometimes content creation also involves knowing more about your company, so you may want to send details about your mission statement or how you’re positioned within the industry. 

Start with a Calibration Round or Test Project

If you plan to establish a long-term relationship with your freelance writing team, consider running a paid test project or calibration round before turning over the entire project for rapid content creation. During a test project, you provide the basic guidelines for your project and the freelancers create sample content for you to peruse. Together, you and the freelance team can make changes to the guidelines or format of the project before anything goes live. You might discover that your word count or keyword guidelines need some minor adjustments, or you may decide that an SEO suggestion by the freelance writing team would work well for your project. Test projects are typically paid and may involve a few rounds back and forth before you settle on the content requirements for your job. 

Trust Your Freelancers’ Expertise

When it comes down to it, you’re hiring freelance writers because they provide expertise, speed and flexibility your in-house team can’t currently match. Micromanaging your writers can hamper your long-term content goals, so aim for a working relationship that lets you turn over the task to your writers and get stellar content on or before your stated deadline. If the freelancer or manager of a team of freelancers makes suggestions about SEO best practices, you may want to consider incorporating those suggestions into your job to get better results. 

Learn About the Writing and Editing Process

If you’re working with a content agency, ask about the writing and editing process. Decide whether your freelance job should be sourced to a specific writer or given to a larger team that can produce content more quickly. Find out whether the work goes through a round of editing before being sent back to you. When you’re working with a team of freelancers, you may be able to request the same writers or specify writers of a particular quality level before you assign the job. 

Connect With Freelance Writers Using Crowd Content

Working with freelance writers can be an easy way to increase your work capacity and save money. The first step to outsourcing your company’s freelance writing is to find freelancers who can meet your needs. Visit Crowd Content to connect with over 5,000 professional freelance writers who can help craft content that draws attention, establishes authority and converts browsers to buyers.

The post How Freelancers Support In-house Teams appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-freelancers-support-in-house-teams/feed/ 0
Tactics to Scale Your Content Creation https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/tactics-to-scale-your-content-creation/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/tactics-to-scale-your-content-creation/#respond Fri, 12 Nov 2021 18:00:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=32386 Creative content is a big deal for online marketers. In 2021, the digital online advertising and marketing industry was worth nearly $180 billion. This market grows more than 15% a year, and there’s no sign of stopping or slowing down anytime soon. Thousands of marketers are competing for a share of this traffic, and your […]

The post Tactics to Scale Your Content Creation appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Creative content is a big deal for online marketers. In 2021, the digital online advertising and marketing industry was worth nearly $180 billion. This market grows more than 15% a year, and there’s no sign of stopping or slowing down anytime soon. Thousands of marketers are competing for a share of this traffic, and your ability to stand out from the rest is the key to your success in a very competitive field. If you develop a good plan to scale content creation for your clients, you’re halfway to where you need to be.

Scaling is the key to a successful content creation strategy. Creative campaigns come in all sizes, from one-and-done landing pages to low-volume recurring blog articles to massive product description orders with tens of thousands of pieces to write. Projects can also suddenly ramp up or down, such as when a blog triples its volume or a retailer opens a new product line. Being the marketer who can handle that for a client is the skill set that keeps you growing.

What Is Content Scaling, and Why Is It Awesome?

Scaling is the ability to expand or contract your work volume as needed, ideally without your office erupting into panic, unexplained fires in the parking lot or dinosaur-killing asteroids hitting the Earth when the client orders a 10x increase in output. With a good plan in place to scale your content creation, you have the ability to get ahead of unpredictable changes and respond to anything the client needs.

Scaling content creation is part of an overall marketing strategy, and it helps to know what you’re doing from the outset. Something like 80% of B2B and 81% of B2C brands say they have a content creation strategy mapped out in advance of launching a project. Amazingly, the same survey found that more than half (55%) of brands admit they don’t have any way of knowing what a successful creative campaign looks like.

32

What to Look for in a Scaling Strategy

Good strategies to scale your content all have a few things in common. The best strategies take very little time to implement, guarantee consistent quality and have the potential to expand to meet increased needs quickly and affordably.

Tips to Scale Content Creation

While scaling your content creation is, indeed, awesome, how do you do it? Because changes in scale affect every part of the process, from initial planning to delivery of the finished product, your plan to scale should ideally take in every level. Here are some tips for planning and executing a scalable content rollout.

Stage 1: Planning Your Projects

Designing a scalable workflow starts with good planning in the early stages. The workflow you design early on will either save you or sink you later, when your needs expand. If you’re working with multiple clients, each of them probably has unique needs that don’t necessarily fit into a one-size-fits-all approach to project management. Keeping your project management loose and flexible, however, should give you the leeway you need to scale up or down.

This is where investing in good project management software is a lifesaver. You have a lot of options here. Excel and Google Sheets are decent mainstream tools to help you organize content calendars and export your publishing schedule. Excel has the advantage of being pretty much universal and accessible for almost anyone who’s used an office computer in the last 20 years. Sheets is a productive collab tool that encourages teams to work well together and push multi-stage projects along in a cloud environment.

CoSchedule is another superb project management tool you can use to plot whole campaigns and manage multiple creative teams. Operating in a secure cloud format, CoSchedule allows content creators and project managers to interact at every stage of a project, coordinate easily across projects and schedule deliveries and uploads to virtually any platform your clients are using. There’s even an option in the CoSchedule sidebar for creative workers to leave passive-aggressive notes to each other complaining about recent edits.

Planning Tips

  • Settle on a project management tool and stick to it for nearly every client.
  • Gravitate toward cloud and remote tools, since they probably have more space and scalability than your own systems.
  • Develop a workflow that’s simple enough to explain to a child so educating multiple clients about your capabilities is easy enough to be a selling tool in itself.
33

Stage 2: Formatting and Such

It isn’t always possible to develop a standard format that your projects should take, but wherever you’re able to standardize, you should. Granted, a client with 150-word product descriptions is going to have different needs than a 1,200-word blogging client or a 10,000-word white paper client. Try to aim for a general format that assumes as little as possible about the specific needs of your clients and allows a maximum of later customization.

Formatting Tips

  • Adopt a simple, standard format that works for any kind of content, especially when it’s going live on social media.
  • If you have to specialize, go for multiple templates, one for each of your most common client orders.
  • Adopt a format that can be changed on the fly or expanded to scale up on short notice. You can also use a format already available from your content creation partner if you’re working with a platform.

Stage 3: Actually Writing

Writing is the hardest part of writing. Producing the content your clients need is the heart of any creative project, and it’s not as easy as it seems. Your targets here are for high quality and the ability to expand as your projects scale up. While this seems like a contradiction, you actually have several options for how you want to approach it.

Writing Your Stuff In-House

If you’re working in-house, you’re probably using your own employees as creative workers. Keeping writers on staff lets you train and develop content creators the way you need them to work, but volume is limited and expanding is almost always slow and difficult.

Outsourcing to Partners

Many digital marketing firms partner with content creators from outside. This can be a relationship with a single marketing firm, or it can include individual freelancers working under contract. If you’re partnered with an outside firm, you have the same scaling limitations as if you hired your own talent in-house, just displaced onto a different company for hiring and retention. If you’re working with freelancers, you have a lot of potential to rapidly expand, but managing a growing freelance workforce gets unwieldy above a certain level.

34

Professional Content Creation

One of the best options for scaling your digital marketing campaigns is to establish a long-term partnership with a professional content platform. This can be one of the most productive options for marketers of all sizes. Creation platforms work by recruiting and screening large numbers of writers and editors, building teams you can work with and then making them available to work on your projects.

Working With a Platform for Creative Content

The advantages of working with a platform are huge, and they appear at every stage of the development process. A good platform offers support from a project manager during the initial planning stages, when your campaign is still of indeterminate size and scope. Working together, you and your contact at the platform can plan the work throughput, devise the instructions and formatting requirements and craft a set of instructions for the workforce to follow when the writing starts.

When you’re happy with the design and flow of your project, you can upload your clients’ inputs to the platform. If you’re working with a manager, you don’t have much else to do here; the platform can deliver your finished product by the project deadline in whole or in parts, whichever you need. Some platforms have a feature that lets you manage your own campaigns and export the finished products to your CoSchedule or other publisher’s account.

The unique workforce platforms use allows you to build and retain teams of workers who are experienced with your projects, direct order individual tasks to favored writers or open your project to every writer on the platform. A standardized screening system controls quality and diligence with this option, so you get consistently high-quality results.

Perhaps best of all, you can scale content creation on a platform basically forever, easily shifting between one-off jobs and gigantic projects that move hundreds of thousands of workpieces from development to publishing. Even if your volume is changing on a daily basis, you always have the right number of workers for any given project, exactly when you need them and at the price you’ve agreed to pay.

Tips to Scale Content Creation on a Platform

Working with a platform to scale your content creation can be tricky to start, but it grows on you. Just remember some of the industry best practices for consolidating projects and scaling content through your platform:

  • Plan well: Platform staff are there to help you, and you probably need the most help during the initial planning stage for a creative campaign. Work with a platform manager to design the workflow and build your teams. You can also bring billing or quality assurance concerns to your contact for resolution. When you’re scaling up a project, don’t forget to let the platform know so you have the support you need throughout.
  • Set realistic goals: Some projects have quick turnaround times, while others take months of planning. Likewise, some short, simple workpieces take minutes to dash off and deliver, while others may take days and require associated social media uploads to coordinate at launch. Work with your project manager to set realistic goals about what can be delivered and on what sort of timescale.
  • Choose your teams: Working with a platform, you can choose who gets to see your project. Build a team with handpicked creators, or open your project to everyone with an acceptable level of skill who’s registered with the platform. If you suddenly need to scale up, you have your choice of adding more members to the team or putting out the call to all available hands.
  • Scale up: Scaling is a unique advantage you get with a platform over creating content in-house or with your own freelancers. Because the platform recruits, trains and manages its own external workforce of contract creators, you have basically all the tedious personnel work lifted and none of the management responsibilities attached to what should be a clean project. Expanding a project on-platform is genuinely as easy as loading more orders into the system and waiting for the final drafts to clear edit.
35

Crowd Content has the workforce you need to power your biggest projects. Find out about the services we offer digital marketing and content creation clients here. You can also reach out and contact us to talk about how our workforce of thousands of writers, editors and other professionals can help you scale content creation as much as your clients need.

The post Tactics to Scale Your Content Creation appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/tactics-to-scale-your-content-creation/feed/ 0
Content Optimization Tools: What They’re For and How to Choose One https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/a-look-at-content-optimization-tools/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/a-look-at-content-optimization-tools/#respond Thu, 04 Nov 2021 17:00:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=32350 Content marketing is a highly effective strategy for growing your business — it can boost your search rankings, improve website traffic, and keep the leads pouring in. But to truly power these results, consider adding a content optimization tool to your personal tech stack. These platforms help you create content that’s backed by solid SEO […]

The post Content Optimization Tools: What They’re For and How to Choose One appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content marketing is a highly effective strategy for growing your business — it can boost your search rankings, improve website traffic, and keep the leads pouring in. But to truly power these results, consider adding a content optimization tool to your personal tech stack. These platforms help you create content that’s backed by solid SEO research and audience insights, improving the quality, relevance, and performance of your content.

Can a piece of software really have this kind of impact? Absolutely. In this article, we’ll look at some of the features of content optimization tools and how they help accomplish your goals. You still need to lean on your creativity and expertise, but these platforms can fine-tune what you create for better search engine algorithms and content for your target audience.

Using Content Optimization Tools to Enhance Your Workflow

Consider what your content needs to accomplish to further your business goals. Your articles, landing pages, and white papers must:

  • Surface in front of your target audience
  • Encourage customers to visit your website
  • Provide helpful information that solves their problems
  • Persuade them to convert
  • Communicate clearly and engage readers from beginning to end

If you’re doing it well, producing great content requires effort. This can be time-consuming when trying to stick to a regular publishing schedule. Content optimization tools can help you pick up the pace, assisting with:

  • Keyword research. Find the keywords your audience uses and understand their search intent so you can create content that perfectly aligns with their needs.
  • SEO optimization. Make sure you follow best practices for keyword usage, meta titles and descriptions, internal linking, and backlinking.
  • Competitive analysis. Evaluate top-ranking pages to find opportunities to leapfrog competitors in the search engine results pages (SERPs).  
  • Content ideation. Learn what topics to cover in your content to address the subject matter in depth. AI-powered platforms suggest relevant topics and generate content outlines in seconds.
  • Content analysis. Most tools improve the readability of your content, pinpointing spelling and grammatical errors and suggesting ways to improve structure and flow.
  • Performance analytics. Track metrics such as traffic, engagement, and conversions to ensure your content achieves its goals. This data shows where your strategy needs adjusting so you can fine-tune your tactics and improve results.

Content Optimization Tools to the Rescue

You may be wondering which optimization tools are best suited for your workflow. Some tools are weighted toward SEO and keyword research, while others are strong in AI content generation. We’ve evaluated some of the most popular tools on the market to give you a sense of the functionalities available:

  • Semrush
  • INK
  • MarketMuse
  • Surfer SEO
  • Clearscope
  • Topic
  • Frase

Semrush

Semrush is widely recognized as one of the top search engine optimization tools on the market. It has over 55 tools and reports to help with keyword research, SEO, competitor analysis, and content marketing.

Key Features:

Semrush draws on its vast databases and SERP analysis to help with content optimization. The following tools are especially useful for shaping your content: 

  • SEO Content Template: This tool generates a template for your content based on the search terms you input. It analyzes the top 10 ranking pages and offers guidance about keywords, word count, readability, and potential backlinks. You can also get insight into how your competitors use keywords as part of their on-page SEO.
  • SEO Writing AssistantYou can connect this tool to Google Docs, Word, or WordPress to help you craft content in real-time. SEO Writing Assistant provides feedback on SEO optimization, tone, clarity, and originality. You can also turn to its AI features to help you compose or rewrite text.
  • Keyword Overview: Understanding user intent is necessary to create valuable content. The Keyword Overview tool shows you user questions relating to each keyword. Consider answering these in your content to make your writing more informative and helpful.
  • Backlink AnalyticsBacklinks are external links that bring visitors to your site. These links signal to Google that your site is credible and valuable. Use the backlink tool to analyze the quality of your links and those of your competitors to improve your site’s backlink profile and authority.

Semrush also has robust performance-tracking utilities, making it an all-in-one tool for supporting your content strategy from start to finish. You’ll get the most value from Semrush when you leverage its content planning, creation, optimization, and analytics tools together. 

Pros:

  • Extensive keyword and user intent data at your fingertips
  • SEO, PPC, and social media features in one package
  • Detailed yet user-friendly interface

Cons:

  • More expensive than other tools if you only need basic features
  • Limited data for search engines other than Google

INK

INK is an elegant yet mighty app that combines OpenAI’s generative AI with an SEO assistant. It’s focused primarily on content creation, analyzing search engine results in real-time to guide you in writing competitive content.

Key Features:

  • Content planning: INK suggests relevant keywords for your topic, grouping terms with similar search intent. Use these topic clusters as the basis for your content strategy.
  • Competitive analysis: Find out what topics your competitors cover in their articles and the ones you’re missing.
  • Search engine optimization: Get tips for bringing your page up to par for on-page SEO, including meta tags, headers, and image alt-text.
  • Content creation: Ask INK to create titles, lists, social media posts, calls to action, introductions, conclusions, and product descriptions. Be sure to refine the content to meet your particular goals and ensure it conveys your brand voice.
  • Visual asset creation: INK also creates AI images to enhance your written content, reducing the time it takes to get your content ready to publish.

As you write in INK, the app compares your content to top-ranking pages and gives you a score. Your score increases as you implement INK’s recommendations. The company claims that content with a 97% or higher score is four times more likely to rank in the top 10 on Google.

Overall, its extensive AI functionality sets INK apart from similar tools. While the app provides comparable utility to Semrush’s SEO Writing Assistant, it also gives you access to recipes, which create specific types of content from minimal input. 

Pros:

  • Content scoring to help you easily gauge whether optimizations are worthwhile
  • Detailed insight into what you should write about and how to target topics
  • AI-powered features to simplify content creation

Cons:

  • Suggested optimizations sometimes impact the flow and voice of content
  • Limited free features

MarketMuse

MarketMuse leverages artificial intelligence to streamline the research, creation, and content optimization process. The platform analyzes your content against the competition to reveal opportunities, and uses highly accurate topic models so you can write the best possible content.

Features:

The following MarketMuse applications help tailor your content for search engine rankings and audience engagement:

  • Questions: Use MarketMuse to generate a list of questions people often ask about a target keyword to shape your content to meet audience needs.
  • Research: Find topics related to your focus keyword to add depth to your content. You can also discover keyword variants to help build topic clusters.
  • Compete: Leverage a visual representation of keyword research to identify must-have topics and ways to differentiate your content.
  • Connect: Build an internal linking strategy using suggested anchor text and matching URLs to enhance user experience.
  • Optimize: Maximize the impact of your content by incorporating AI suggestions and aiming to achieve a target score.

MarketMuse is especially powerful if you want to gain an edge over rivals. The Competitive Content Analysis tool identifies topics and keywords missing in your competitors’ content, giving you the scoop on quick wins. The platform also has tools that can help you track the performance of your content against competitors and find gaps in the market.

Pros:

  • Comprehensive content analysis features
  • Competition analysis to find gaps in the market
  • Can run audits of entire websites

Cons:

  • More expensive than some other tools
  • AI-driven content recommendations require careful consideration

Surfer SEO

Surfer SEO is a suite of AI-driven tools that helps improve your website’s visibility in the SERPs. It analyzes on-page SEO factors and provides actionable recommendations for planning, writing, and verifying content.

Features:

Surfer helps get you from ideation to publication. The platform’s main tools include:

  • Outline Builder: This tool synthesizes information about your target audience and keyword topic, providing a detailed content outline, including headings and questions. You can use the output to plan content and write briefs.
  • SERP Analyzer: Learn about the characteristics of pages featured in the SERPs and the correlation to actual rankings. The analysis includes over 500 factors, including visibility, traffic, backlinks, word count, titles, image alt-text, page speed, and structured data. 
  • Content Editor: The content editor works in real-time as you write, offering suggestions about readability and flow. Most recommendations are based on currently ranking pages and SEO best practices. The tool scores content out of 100, which some users may find more intuitive than Semrush’s quadrant chart.
  • Content Audit: You can also use Surfer to review previously published content for improvement. It will determine if the content is up to date and relevant and detect SEO errors. This helps to improve your keyword position.

When you’re ready to publish, Surfer’s verification tools provide a final quality check and scans for plagiarism. If necessary, you can revert to previous drafts using version histories, which helps larger teams collaborate more effectively. 

Pros:

  • Comparison of content to top-performing articles
  • SEO audit capabilities
  • Easy to use

Cons:

  • Suggestions based on existing content, ignoring the role of off-page SEO
  • Limited off-page SEO utilities compared to other tools, such as Semrush

Clearscope

Clearscope helps marketers, SEO specialists, and content creators to publish high-quality, search-engine-optimized content. The platform provides more extensive keyword analysis than most tools. It also offers detailed reporting features that let you track content performance. Performance analysis is one of the most important — and often overlooked — aspects of content marketing.

Features:

Clearscope’s data-driven features support your workflow from the research to the content upload phase:

  • Content grade: Clearscope assigns a letter grade to your content based on SEO best practices and recommendations to improve your score. Suggestions are based on an analysis of high-ranking pages and help enhance the value and relevance of your content.
  • Competitor analysis: The tool collects data from top-performing content in search engines to give you competitive insight. You’ll get information about topics that aren’t being covered by your rivals to help identify opportunities.
  • Content briefs: When unsure how to approach a new topic, use Clearscope to generate a brief. AI automates most of this process, suggesting relevant keywords and linking opportunities to help get you started.
  • Readability analysis: Like other tools on our list, Clearscope assesses the readability of your content to enhance user experience. Its readability metric is based on the Flesch Reading Ease score and assesses how easily your content can be understood. You’ll get suggestions on sentence length, structure, and other elements that impact clarity.

This platform integrates directly with Google Docs and WordPress for added convenience. This makes it possible to handle most aspects of content creation in one place without copying and pasting.

Pros:

  • User-friendly interface
  • Keyword research and competitor analysis tools
  • Detailed content brief ideation

Cons:

  • Expensive compared to other SEO tools
  • Limited internal and external linking guidance
  • Few collaboration features

Topic

Topic is a content planning and drafting tool. It focuses on content ideation and offers robust SEO research capabilities.

Features:

Topic offers fewer optimizations than other platforms but shines in its research and analysis tools.

  • Research Consolidation: Starting with a focus keyword, Topic scours three pages of Google search results to help you determine what to cover in your content. It suggests relevant headings, valuable questions, and additional keywords to ensure your content surpasses the competition.
  • Gap Analysis: Topic’s AI technology identifies informational gaps within your existing content, providing recommendations on enhancing its value and authoritativeness.
  • NLP Analysis: The platform analyzes top-performing pages in Google using natural language processing, identifying related subjects and questions that can make your content more comprehensive.
  • Focus Keyword Analysis: The platform also suggests topics based on keywords, helping you determine user intent.

Once you have an outline, Topic grades your content during the writing process, providing instant feedback and actionable suggestions. This saves you from making extensive edits later.

Topic also prioritizes user intent throughout the content optimization process, ensuring your content aligns with audience needs. For example, if someone searches for “jaguar,” do they want to know about the animal or car? By analyzing what searchers want from a particular keyword, Topic helps you create a more satisfying user experience. 

Pros:

  • Easy to use
  • Research features help round out content outlines
  • Integrates into Google Docs and WordPress

Cons:

  • Dependent on AI-based optimization recommendations
  • Lacks off-page SEO capabilities

Frase

Frase describes its content optimization tool as a form of smart AI. It uses natural language processing and content templates to enhance your writing. This generative AI is paired with extensive research and fact-checking capabilities, making the output less prone to errors and hallucinations.

Features:

Along with its unique smart AI templates, Frase offers essential SEO features, including:

  • SERP research: The tool distills key data from the top search results for a particular keyword. It provides information on word count, domain ratings, search volume, and competition metrics to help you determine which keywords are worth targeting.
  • Outline Builder: Frase’s simple drag-and-drop Outline Builder lets you generate briefs from scratch or SERP data. The tool recommends headlines, topics, questions, and statistics that are useful to include.
  • AI writer: The AI writer tool creates content based on formulas that match the tone and requirements of various types of copy. This enables you to create high-converting copy, FAQs, and engaging introductions easily.
  • Content optimization: After completing your draft, adjust your copy to improve your Frase quality score. This score reflects user intent and value, indicating whether your content is helpful based on what Google prefers to rank.

Pros:

  • Unique Answer Engine tool helps you rank for snippets and other search features
  • Extensive SERP research and competition analysis capabilities
  • Relatively inexpensive for solo use and small projects

Cons:

  • Depth of features may carry a learning curve
  • Limited technical and off-page SEO toolset

Comparing SEO Content Optimization Tool Features

Combining AI and Human Oversight

AI-enabled optimization tools can help you target your audience, improve content quality, and speed up the writing process, but there’s another ingredient that can put you over the top: your unique brand voice, creativity, and knowledge.

As more marketers rely on AI to support content creation, there’s a risk that all content starts to sound the same. AI content can rank in Google in theory, but remember that search algorithms reward content that provides a superior user experience and demonstrates E-E-A-T. Focus on creating content that sparks curiosity, offers unique perspectives, and draws on real-life examples and expertise. This type of content will resonate naturally with your audience and perform well in search engines.

Create Content That Ranks

Whipping up effective content is no easy task, but content optimization tools can streamline the process. While using technology to accelerate your research, ideation, and writing is important, it is also essential to have a skilled writing team pulling the pieces together and making your unique content shine.

Crowd Content’s writing services are another great tool to have in your arsenal. With over 5,000 expert wordsmiths in our ranks, we can connect your business with the perfect freelancer to help grow your content marketing strategy and drive more traffic to your site. Contact us today to get started.

The post Content Optimization Tools: What They’re For and How to Choose One appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/a-look-at-content-optimization-tools/feed/ 0
Looking for Ways to Increase Your Site’s Authority? Try Working with Subject Matter Experts https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/subject-matter-experts/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/subject-matter-experts/#respond Thu, 30 Sep 2021 17:00:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=32167 No matter what you sell, you need content to educate people about your company and persuade them to call, click, email or buy. With so many firms publishing the same type of content, however, it’s easy to get lost in the shuffle. One way to stand out from the crowd is to hire subject matter […]

The post Looking for Ways to Increase Your Site’s Authority? Try Working with Subject Matter Experts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
No matter what you sell, you need content to educate people about your company and persuade them to call, click, email or buy. With so many firms publishing the same type of content, however, it’s easy to get lost in the shuffle.

One way to stand out from the crowd is to hire subject matter experts (SMEs) or interview them for your publications.

What are subject matter experts and why are they more important than ever for marketers? Keep reading to find out.

What Are Subject Matter Experts?

A subject matter expert is someone who has highly specialized knowledge in a particular industry or field of study. SMEs often work on large projects in the information technology, engineering, and legal fields, but you can find them in almost any professional setting.

October-2021-LI-IG-FB-Posts

Copywriters and journalists also consult SMEs when drafting articles, reports, case studies and technical or scientific content.

Here are just a few of the ways subject matter experts use their expertise:

•Doctors, nurses and other medical professionals often serve as expert witnesses in medical malpractice cases.

•Workplace safety experts use their knowledge of OSHA guidelines to protect employees against work-related accidents.

•Data analysts rely on SMEs to help them identify trends in large sets of data. SMEs can also help data analysts better understand the metrics that are most important in a particular industry.

•Manufacturing companies often hire outside engineers to optimize new product designs or turn manual assembly processes into automated ones.

•Many companies hire software developers to solve complex problems or help them choose new software packages based on custom business requirements.

Increasingly, SMEs are also playing a significant role in content creation and SEO.

Why Are SMEs Important for Content Creation and SEO?

To drive traffic to your website and convert visitors into paying customers, your content must be both interesting and accurate.

October-2021-LI-IG-FB-Posts-2

Google is increasingly valuing E-A-T (expertise, authority, trust) when determining search rankings, so having SMEs involved in your content creation can really boost SEO.

Readers can be even more discerning than search engines. If a reader catches you in a mistake, they’re less likely to buy from you. Working with subject matter experts can help you avoid costly errors and ensure your content is as relevant to readers as possible.

How Can SMEs Help With Content Creation?

SMEs can help you with the following types of content:

Articles: A subject matter expert can review your draft and make sure the content is accurate. You can also contact SMEs and ask them for quotes to incorporate into an article. Incorporating quotes from experts shows your readers you’re willing to go the extra mile to deliver high-quality, authoritative content.

Case studies: A case study is a great way to show prospects how your firm’s products or services have benefited your existing customers. Case studies usually describe a problem a customer was having and explain how a company’s product or service solved that problem.

They combine business facts with storytelling to create a compelling narrative that can be shared with potential customers. Working with a subject matter expert can help you make the case study as persuasive as possible without compromising quality.

White papers: A white paper can help you explain product features and benefits to prospective customers. Subject matter experts provide valuable input to ensure technical jargon doesn’t get in the way of helping prospects understand your value proposition.

Buying guides: If your company sells high-tech products, working with a subject matter expert can help you publish high-quality buying guides. These guides educate readers and help them understand why they should purchase one product over another.

These are the 4 most common content types that SMEs work on. But, SMEs add value to any type of content where E-A-T is important.

SMEs for SEO

Search engines prioritize unique content. A SME may be able to help you come up with an interesting angle for an article or alert you to a new trend in the field before everyone else starts covering it, helping you drive more visitors to your website.

A lot of content optimization tools guide SEOs to create content that covers topics and search terms that already appear in content ranking well in Google for a given search term. That can lead SEOs to create very similar content to their competitors. SMEs let you add truly original content by leveraging their unique knowledge and skillset. That can set you apart from the pack, and on its own may boost rankings.

SMEs are a valuable resource for companies that publish medical, legal, technical or scientific content. Even if you vet your freelancers carefully, a generalist may struggle to explain complex topics to a lay audience. SMEs can read through each article and make sure that every detail is accurate, enhancing your site’s authority.

Google (and other search engines) ultimately want to serve the best content to satisfy a searcher’s query. It makes sense that expert level content is more likely to do that, and Google uses various ways of measuring how effective your content is at helping its users.

Working with SMEs also creates opportunities to add expert bylines to your content. These expert bylines can help you attract backlinks from other sites. Because SMEs have expert insight, they can help you create truly unique content rather than rewriting what’s already out there. And, other marketers want to link to authoritative sources so having bylined, expert level content can be hugely beneficial in driving links.

All of this adds up to a much higher E-A-T score. In SEO, E-A-T stands for expertise, authoritativeness and trustworthiness. While not officially a ranking factor according to Google, empirical evidence suggests that higher E-A-T does help you rank better for competitive search terms.

October-2021-LI-IG-FB-Posts-1

How to Position Yourself as a Subject Matter Expert

Here are some tips for becoming a subject matter expert:

  1. Commit to continuous learning. No matter how much experience you have, there’s always something new to learn, especially if you’re in an industry characterized by frequent change. Sign up for professional associations, attend workshops and take online courses to keep your knowledge and skills as current as possible.

2. Start developing your own ideas. The more you experiment with new developments in your field, the more innovative you can be. You’ll also gain new knowledge and skills that you can share with others.

3. Build a strong social media presence. If you don’t already have accounts on LinkedIn, Twitter and Facebook, sign up as soon as possible and create profiles highlighting your credentials. Once your accounts are all set up, spend time sharing content and having discussions with other people in your industry.

4. Start sharing your expertise. Networking via social media is great, but it’s not the only way to share your knowledge and skills with others. Consider running a workshop, presenting at a professional conference or teaching a class in your area of interest. Starting a podcast or an educational YouTube channel is also an effective way to spread the word about your expertise.

5. Create a writer biography (bio). Not only does your bio explain your credentials, but it also provides a quick summary of your accomplishments. Your bio can be shared online, helping you promote your brand even when you’re busy doing other things.

What Crowd Content Is Doing to Connect with Subject Matter Experts

Crowd Content works with expert writers across a variety of subjects to produce high-quality content for businesses of all sizes. We regularly work with SMEs in specialized fields to ensure every piece of content gives readers a positive impression of our clients.

If you have a limited budget, we can incorporate quotes from experts or have SMEs review your drafts before you publish them. To find out how to work with one of our expert writers, visit the Crowd Content website.

The post Looking for Ways to Increase Your Site’s Authority? Try Working with Subject Matter Experts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/subject-matter-experts/feed/ 0
50 Popular Types of Web Content for Driving User Engagement https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/types-of-content/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/types-of-content/#respond Thu, 23 Sep 2021 16:00:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=32059 Having fresh, informative and interesting types of content remains the best way to attract readers and search engines to your website or social media page. Diversifying your content types can also set your business apart from the many other web pages vying for your customers’ attention. Content marketing done well can increase your brand awareness, boost your […]

The post 50 Popular Types of Web Content for Driving User Engagement appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Having fresh, informative and interesting types of content remains the best way to attract readers and search engines to your website or social media page. Diversifying your content types can also set your business apart from the many other web pages vying for your customers’ attention. Content marketing done well can increase your brand awareness, boost your reader engagement and help your pages to rank higher in search engine results.

Most popular types of content

The best websites create a mix of different content types to keep their readers interested. While there are hundreds of different types of web content, these 50 in-particular are our favorite types of digital content.

Content types

1. Articles

This type of web content develops an idea and incorporates interviews, quotes, and data to support the article’s hypothesis. Articles are usually long-form content, between 1,000 and 3,000 words.

2. Blog posts

Blog posts typically range between 500 and 750 words, focusing on a variety of topics. Some of these topics can include news in the industry, bios of industry leaders, reviews of new products, and more.

3. Surveys

Adding surveys to your content arsenal can gauge your readers’ interest and to increase reader engagement with your brand. Surveys are also fun for the reader and is one of the more interactive content types.

4. Quizzes

Quizzes are another way to engage your reader, by having a question on one page and the answer on the next, which adds extra potential for ad revenue and click-throughs.

5. Photos

Images help make your content more visually appealing, and contributes to the overall user experience. Additionally, optimizing your photos with alt-text and captions to your images can even help with your rankings on Google Images.

6. Videos

Using videos is a great way to diversify your content and add visual interest to your pages. These can be videos you take yourself or videos from sources like YouTube or Vimeo. (Just make sure to give credit where credit is due.)

7. Case studies

Case studies outline how a particular individual or company used a product or service. Seeing a real person use your product can help potential buyers see themselves using it and, thus, encouragement to purchase from you.

8. Website content

Website content encompasses many content types. This can include website pages detailing your individual services, products, people, locations, etc.

9. Guest blogs or posts

Find guest writers from notable people in your industry, writers of other blogs or websites that focus on your topic, or on social media pages or groups related to your topic. Adding a few posts by guest writers adds a new voice to your pages and helps to bring in new readers to your website.

10. Interviews

First person interviews with people actively involved in your topic is a way to share different points of view with your readers and expand their knowledge of your topic. You can ask readers to submit questions in advance to increase your user engagement.

11. FAQs

Everyone has questions. A FAQ (frequently asked questions) page is one of the best content types to help address common questions all in one place. This helps you better manage your time and not have to answer the same question over and over again.

12. Press releases

Press releases from companies in your field make good fodder for your blog or website. Just make sure that you don’t copy the release directly to avoid a duplicate content penalty from the search engines.

13. Announcements

Do you have a new employee, product, or even some new swag? Let your readers know about it in an announcement post. Market your site as the place readers can learn about news from your company before any other source.

14. Contests

Contests are a good content type for getting new readers and to keep your readers coming back to your site. Like quizzes, this repeat traffic is good for increasing your click-through rate.

15. E-books

Having an e-book that your readers can download, or read directly on your site, can expand on your regular content types with more in-depth information. Promoting an e-book is an excellent way to promote your company as an expert in your field.

16. Landing pages

Landing pages are designed as the first page that a site visitor sees when they take an action like clicking on an ad. It’s important that these remain your highest-quality pages, so they make a good first impression to the user.

17. Infographics

Out of all the other types of content, infographics remain one of the best at providing a visual representation of data or information to your reader. Plus, they also just look cool and can often illustrate a point much more clearly than if you explained the point with only text.

31

18. White Papers

white paper is a concise report that seeks to educate the reader about a complex issue, which you can post directly on your site or offered as a download. Like e-books, they help to establish your site as a leader in your industry.

19. “How to” posts

Readers like to learn how to use a product or accomplish a task. (Look at the proliferation of YouTube videos of this ilk.) “How to” posts can range from recipes to instructions on installing a hot water tank.

20. E-courses

E-courses are designed to teach your reader about your topic. Generally divided into several sections, the reader can complete one each day or week. This type of post is another good way to get readers to return to your site.

21. Lists

Lists are, arguably, the most popular type of web content. Whether it’s “9 ways to attract a new boyfriend”, “The 10 hottest guys on the PGA circuit” or “5 ways to cook acorn squash”, there’s just something compelling about a list. List headline are very clickable and a good way to introduce new readers to your site.

22. Reader questions

You probably get questions from readers. Rather than answering the same questions privately over and over again, it just makes sense to create a page or two of real questions you’ve received from readers. (Just make sure that you get permission from the reader if you use their question verbatim.)

23. Roundups

Roundups are compilations of links to other sources posted elsewhere on the internet. This can include things in the news related to your industry this week or something like the best places to shop online for a product related to your industry. Make sure not to copy text from the other site, just the link, to avoid having your SEO suffer.

24. Book reviews

Every topic has books written about it. Share with your readers the ones you’ve read and what you thought of them. (Just make sure not to spoil any plot twists or surprises.) You might even ask readers about their favorite books to increase engagement.

25. Product reviews

One of the perks of having a successful blog or website is that companies are often willing to send you a product to review at no cost to you. You can also purchase a product to review (with none of the potential ethical problems of accepting gifts.)

26. Predictions

Look for this web content type towards the end of the year, when everyone with a web address is offering their opinion about what will happen in the new year. Prediction posts are fun and, until January 1st, you can’t be wrong. This is another way to encourage readers to view you as an industry expert.

27. Demos

Similar to “How to” posts, demos show how to use a specific product and can be a useful way to market your wares.

28. Live streams

Live streams, such as Facebook Live broadcasts, let your readers attend events, board meetings, product unveiling, contest drawings and other happenings right from their homes or office. This is another good way to engage site visitors.

29. Awards

Awards are a fun way to get other businesses and individuals involved in your site. “Best of 2021”-type awards can start with nominations, move on to have readers vote on the top picks and end with an announcement of the winners. This type of content not only engages readers, but draws in fans of the nominated companies that may not have been familiar with your site before.

30. Guides

Guides are a comprehensive look at a topic or destination. For example, if you have a site about Ohio travel, you might create a “Travel Guide to the Lake Erie Islands”. With several of these pieces, you can market your website as a comprehensive resource about your topic.

31. Templates

Templates are examples for readers to use to create their own documents or crafts. This type of content might be a sample resume format or how to write a letter of recommendation.

32. Check lists

Checklists are useful lists that help readers prepare for something. For example, a checklist might be “things to pack when you hike the Appalachian Trail” or “Documents to take when you apply for Social Security benefits”.

33. Memes

Memes are just silly, funny content that combine images with jokes, sarcasm or political humor.

34. User-generated content

Why not have your readers create your content? These can be blog posts, videos, images or full articles. Just make sure that you post guidelines and that your readers understand that you have editorial control.

35. Research and data

Recent statistics and research can make for interesting content and help your site provide industry-leading resources for your readers.

36. Maps

Maps are useful to illustrate where a user can find an attraction, business or other sites.

37. Essays

If your website is like most sites, the bulk of your content is informational and written in the second or third person. Essays give you an opportunity to share your own, first-person experiences and create a rapport with your readers.

38. Event calendars

Event calendars list things that are happening during a particular time frame. For example, you might post “What to Do in Nashville in May” or “Stephen King Book Events in the Midwest”. These can be a useful resource and bring new visitors to your site.

39. Giveaways

Do you have some swag you’d like to offer your readers? You can ask them to take an action like signing up for your newsletter or liking your social media page in order to qualify for the freebie.

28

40. Social media posts

Posts on Facebook, Twitter, Instagram and LinkedIn are generally shorter versions of the content on your website. You can include a link to your longer content, so readers can learn more if they are interested in your topic.

41. Podcasts

Podcasts are increasingly popular. These might be interviews or instructional talks and work to support your other marketing efforts.

42. Testimonials

Share what your readers and/or customers are saying about you with a testimonial page. (Again, it’s important to ask permission before you use someone else’s words.) Testimonials are great from a marketing point of view because they come from (presumably) unbiased third parties.

43. Industry news

This might be a roundup, a recap of a press release or an article about a single happening in your field.

44. Glossary

This type of content page is especially useful if your industry or topic has a lot of jargon within your field. Prevent readers from becoming confused by creating a glossary page that defines these terms and then link back to it when you use those terms on other pages.

45. Comparisons

A type of product review, comparisons show a side-by-side look at two or more products. This might be a face-off between a Ford Mustang and a Chevy Camaro.

46. Best practices

This type of page gives readers advice on how they can make their life a little easier. It’s even better if you can include how your product or service can make a reader’s life easier.

47. Recipes

Who doesn’t like cooking? Just make sure that you only post original recipes. While ingredient lists aren’t subject to copyright restrictions, the instructions on how to cook a dish are.

48. Cheat sheets

Everyone likes to learn about an easier way to do something. Again, see if you can work this around one of your products or services.

49. Screenshots

Screenshots are images of what’s on your computer screen at a particular moment. These are useful when you’re trying to explain to readers how to do something on their computer.

50. Calculators

Calculators can be useful for things like figuring compound interest, paying off a mortgage early or estimating retirement income.

Creating Quality Content with Crowd Content

We understand that creating quality content can take you away from your other job responsibilities. That’s why Crowd Content matches quality writers to website and blog administrators like you. We have more than 5,000 professional writers waiting to create top quality content for your web pages.

To learn more about adding diverse types of content to your website, blog or social media pages, feel free to contact us today.

The post 50 Popular Types of Web Content for Driving User Engagement appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/types-of-content/feed/ 0
Thought Leadership Central: How to Write a White Paper https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/thought-leadership-central-how-to-write-a-white-paper/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/thought-leadership-central-how-to-write-a-white-paper/#respond Thu, 27 May 2021 19:10:55 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=31384 Comprehensive marketing strategies include many different types of optimized content. Sales funnels often begin with social media ads, pay-per-click ads and other types of microcontent. Advertorials — ads disguised as regular articles — drive traffic to landing pages; blog posts do the same thing. Then you have long-form editorials and white papers. But what are white […]

The post Thought Leadership Central: How to Write a White Paper appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Comprehensive marketing strategies include many different types of optimized content. Sales funnels often begin with social media ads, pay-per-click ads and other types of microcontent. Advertorials — ads disguised as regular articles — drive traffic to landing pages; blog posts do the same thing. Then you have long-form editorials and white papers.

But what are white papers, and why are they important — and are they better than orange papers? We’re kidding about that last part: orange papers aren’t really a thing.

In this post, we’ll talk about why white papers should be part of your SEO strategy. Then, we’ll teach you how to write a white paper. Let’s go.

What is a White Paper?

In a nutshell, white papers are special reports — they’re concise, authoritative guides about complicated topics. They’re meant to inform readers or help readers make decisions, and they provide the publishing organization’s unique viewpoint on the subject at hand.

Generally speaking, white papers are pretty short. Most contemporary white papers are between 3,000 and 5,000 words long — about the length of a regular editorial — with the most important information written on the first page.

“If you don’t get to the point on page one, you can forget about influencing any significant decisions.” ~ John Kilpatrick – Greenfield Advisors

John-Kilpatrick-Quote

Interestingly, the very first white papers definitely weren’t short. Coined in Britain about a century ago, the term “white paper” first appeared in 1922. The Churchill White Paper incorporated nine documents and a memorandum, so it read more like a book. Its name came, quite simply, from the color of the cover.

One common characteristic of white papers is they’re often packaged as PDFs complete with appealing visuals that help communicate key points. They can serve as powerful lead magnets that many marketers use for mid-funnel conversions.

Why White Papers Matter

Perhaps more than any other type of sales funnel content, white papers present opportunities for thought leadership. If you’ve done your own research, you can use it to prove the points you make; if possible, incorporate other data as well, to showcase widespread support for your idea.

In short, white papers are great mid-funnel content that let you help your customers while demonstrating your brand’s unique authority in your field.

Articles and blog posts live on your site, so they’re readily available to anyone. White papers are a little different: they’re essentially premium content. Most organizations turn them into downloadable PDFs — visitors have to provide email addresses and other information to receive download links.

When they’re put behind a “download wall” like this, white papers make a great email collection tool (AKA lead magnets).

Used as part of your sales funnel, collecting emails from people who download your white papers lets your grow your email list of mid-funnel prospects that you can market to.

In time, you can use that list to create a segmented email marketing campaign — and segmented campaigns generate a great click-through rate. These campaigns can help nudge your leads further down the funnel towards conversions.

White papers take a little more time to research and write than regular articles, so they often cost more per word. And, you’ll likely spend more time designing the final product. Having said that, these multi-purpose documents provide a great return on investment, so they’re worth the extra outlay.

“A good white paper helps decision makers make smarter decisions. A white paper should provide new knowledge and new insights that are not available anywhere else.” ~ Mark Kantrowitz, Savingforcollege.com

Copy-of-Stoney-deGeyter_Quote_FB-IG

How They Help Your Sales Team

Sales people ultimately want to help their leads make the best buying decision to solve the challenges they face. As marketers, creating white papers provides sales people with a powerful resource they can share with their leads to help them learn more about the challenges they face, and hopefully how your solution can help.

That’s called sales enablement and it’s very valuable for your company.

Types of White Paper

White papers are an essential part of any successful sales funnel. There are three main types of sales and marketing-centric white papers:

  • Backgrounder: These documents go behind the scenes to reveal the publishing organization’s methods for success — and they sometimes also include case studies. Background white papers work well in the awareness stage of a sales funnel.
  • Listicles: These white papers share exclusive tips and tricks for business success, or provide readers with a step-by-step list of instructions. Numbered list white papers work well in the interest and evaluation part of a sales funnel.
  • Improved solution: These guides define problems, describe typical solutions and then offer the publishing organization’s innovative new solutions. Improved solution white papers work well in the interest and evaluation part of a sales funnel, and also at the desire and action stages of a sales funnel.
Copy-of-Perfect-Freelance-Morning-Routine

When they’re well written and positioned, all three types of white paper generate leads. Some white papers use the numbered list and the improved solution format to create an all-in-one document.

How to Write a White Paper

“Think about who you’re going to write this document for. Are they physicians, lawyers, marketers, media professionals, artists? Know why they would want to read your white paper.” ~ Julien Raby, ThermoGears

Julien-Raby-THERMOGEARS-

White papers build trust and help to establish your company (or you) as a thought leader. If they find the information in your white paper helpful, people often come back for more. You can use the following formula to write your own white paper:

  1. Think about your narrative arc. Every good story has a beginning, a middle and an end — and characters that stay constant throughout — and the same applies to a white paper. Create an outline before you begin.
  2. Perform consumer research. Your white paper has to be compelling — people have to want to read it. Tools like SurveyMonkey can help you create consumer questionnaires to determine whether people find your white paper topic interesting.
  3. Find a content gap. Don’t write about ultra-popular subjects — instead, concentrate on a niche to insert your paper into a content gap.
  4. Define your readership. Are your readers industry professionals or are they regular consumers looking for a quick fix? Use relatable language and stay away from jargon — unless you’re speaking to the tech crowd.
  5. Write a great hook. Draw readers into your guide with a compelling first sentence, and then continue with a well-defined intro. Include a short summary of the paper’s content and tell your audience how they’ll benefit from reading it from start to finish.
  6. Make your paper valuable. Now’s the time to show off your unique insight. When white papers include lots of useful information, they get shared — and your brand gets noticed.
  7. Keep things interesting. Stay away from dry, formal language. Write in a relatable way and include anecdotes if you can.
  8. Wrap things up with a great conclusion. Reiterate some of the topics you covered and end with a call to action.
  9. Check your work. Never, ever upload a white paper — or any other type of content — without proofreading first.
Copy-of-Examples-of-Evergreen-Content

“Make your white paper as appealing as possible with the inclusion of visuals – charts, images and tables that provide proof of your central solution or problem. If you’ve undertaken primary research, these charts and graphs will be your main weaponry to sway your audience.” ~ Collin Matthews, Cookwared

Collin-Mathews

Boost Leads With a White Paper

White papers are an integral part of online success. You can use them to generate leads and position yourself as an industry authority. Three different types of white paper exist: behind-the-scenes documents, listicles and improved solutions — and they work well at various stages of the sales funnel.

If you’re interested in a white paper for your site but don’t have the time (or the inclination) to write one yourself, Crowd Content can help. Our thousands-strong team of dedicated writers create sales funnel and SEO-centric content seven days a week. To find out more, get in touch online or call us on 1-888-983-3103 today.

The post Thought Leadership Central: How to Write a White Paper appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/thought-leadership-central-how-to-write-a-white-paper/feed/ 0
How Long Should a Blog Post Really Be? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-long-should-a-blog-post-really-be/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-long-should-a-blog-post-really-be/#respond Thu, 29 Apr 2021 00:16:09 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=31033 How long should a blog post be? Well, as with many marketing questions, the classic “it depends” is a good answer. The experts behind content analysis tool Yoast say a standard page should be at least 300 words long and cornerstone content should start around 900 words. HubSpot looked at its data and puts the ideal blog […]

The post How Long Should a Blog Post Really Be? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How long should a blog post be? Well, as with many marketing questions, the classic “it depends” is a good answer.

The experts behind content analysis tool Yoast say a standard page should be at least 300 words long and cornerstone content should start around 900 words. HubSpot looked at its data and puts the ideal blog length at 2,100 to 2,400 words. Widely ranging expert numbers do little to help you understand the real answer to how long should a blog post be, but we’ve got actionable advice to help.

How Long Should a Blog Post Be?

The answer is: as long as it needs to be to meet your objectives. Understanding why you’re writing blog posts is the first step in determining the best word count.

One of the problems with numbers published by expert SEO and marketing firms is that they tend to arrive at those answers in the same way. They look at pages showing up in the top spot on Google, figure out the average word count of those pages and consider that a good place to start.

But word count doesn’t directly impact your SEO performance. You could write 2,000 words and never show up on the first search results page if you’re not attending to other factors. And SEO performance isn’t your only objective, so it’s important to take all your goals into account when determining word counts.

We reached out to marketers to find out what word counts are working best for them for different objectives. Find your main goal for content in the list below and see what word count ranges might help support it.

1. Ranking on Search Engine Results Pages: 2,000 to 2,500+ Words … Usually

Writing blog posts that rank on Google is very important for most businesses. When considering ranking content, it’s important to realize that you’re competing with other content that already ranks. With that in mind, you need to look at a number of different factors:

  1. Word Count
  2. Matching Search Intent
  3. Topic Comprehensiveness
  4. Visual Appeal
  5. Behavioral Metrics (bounce rate, time on page)
Factors-to-Consider-Ranking-on-SEO-Pages

You should always focus on writing for the user first, so matching their search intent and comprehensively covering the topic is key. But, there’s a lot of evidence that ensuring your content is longer than what’s already ranking can help you rank better.

Our advice is to know what word count the top search results clock in at and ensure you’re at least in the ballpark.

How Do You Benchmark Your Content?

The simplest way to find out how many words blog posts that rank well in Google are is to look at the top results for your targeted search term and note their word counts.

That’s also the most tedious way.

Fortunately there are many great tools available that automate benchmarking for you, suggest word counts, and also give you reports on what topics to cover to deliver comprehensive content.

All of these tools can help with your benchmarking:

They all work slightly differently and produce different output, so be sure to find the one that works best for your workflow.

But, How Many Words Should I Really Write?

The old “it depends” answer isn’t always satisfying, so we will mention some benchmarks we think are worthwhile.

When it comes to showing up in SERPs, Goldie says 2,000 to 2,500 is a sweet spot, saying studies have shown diminishing results as content drops below the 2,500 mark. But he was quick to point out that there are always numerous outliers here — that means content that performs well consistently falls outside this word count range. So, it’s important to note you don’t have to write 2,500 words to drive SEO performance for a blog.

Sunny-Ashley-Quote

That being said, Cannon gets even more specific. “The best-ranking articles on Google are most usually 2,450 words. If you want to place well on search engines and get thousands of novel readers per month, this is the most suitable length to write,” he says.

But Cannon also has caveats. “Make sure you write regarding a topic that audiences are actually searching for.”

2. Getting Social Shares: 1,000+ Words

Julian Goldie, CEO of the Goldie Agency, specializes in helping websites rank higher on Google. He says, “Studies have found an association between content that’s 1,000 words or more and the number of social media shares those posts collect.”

According to Goldie, content that gets a lot of social shares is engaging and draws the user in, but it’s not too long. People can read it in a short amount of time, increasing the number of people who get through the entire post and think to share it with their friends.

One thing to keep in mind here is that content with great visuals is more likely to be shared as well. Don’t just add 1,000 words of text and expect visitors to click your share button. Add interesting images, graphics and interactive elements to boost your shares.

Some of the most shared types of content on social are very visual heavy like listicles and quizzes. You can definitely learn from their example.

3. Building Links: 750-1,000 Words

Goldie said that research has found that, “blogs with approximately 1,000 words gained more backlinks than their much more pointed and much longer counterparts.”

He points out that word counts ranging right around the 1k mark are succinct while offering enough to be valuable. And value is what gets people to link to your pages. You’ve explained something they want to share with others, provided expert opinions that are unique or helpful or offered entertainment that can’t be found elsewhere.

Will Cannon, CEO of Signaturely, says you can go a little lower with word count and get the same results if your posts are high quality. He points out that around 750 words is the “standard length for professional journalism,” and says that he, “finds it’s rather good for obtaining links from different bloggers.”

4. Drive Comments and On-Page Engagement: 75-600 words

If you want to drive on-page engagement to create community or shepherd people down your funnel, shorter content may be better. Cannon says that very short posts are great for enticing discussions. These aren’t going to drive a lot of social shares and Cannon admits that they’re terrible for SEO. But when you leave things unsaid, your readers are likely to show up to pitch in.

As you get toward the higher word counts in this range, such as 300-600, you get content that drives comments as well as potential for social shares and SEO.

5. To Build Authority

If you want to build authority in your niche, you need to write content that’s long enough to cover the topic in a user-friendly and effective way but short enough to be as accessible as possible. Write as much as you need to comprehensively cover your topic and no more. Fluff can destroy user experience.

Jeff Proctor, the co-founder of DollarSprout, provides a concrete example to demonstrate that the piece with the most authority isn’t always the longest post. “At the time of this writing,” he says, “the number one result for ‘federal tax brackets’ is 755 words. The number seven result is 1,230 words. The number one result is more user-friendly and less confusing.”

It’s interesting to note that often times when you aim to build authority you’re sharing some unique knowledge and expertise you have. Often there won’t be a ton of existing content that also has this information, so you might not need to focus on word count as much.

6. For Sales Enablement

Sales enablement content is any content that helps your Sales team nudge prospects towards converting. That could include blog posts, case studies, videos, white papers, testimonials, and many others.

Good content that addresses customer challenges and pain points is like gold to your Sales team. By having blog posts for each of your target persona’s biggest pain points you can empower your sales team to help prospects understand how to solve these challenges (hopefully by leveraging your service!).

That can really help your team nudge prospects towards becoming customers.

When creating sales enablement content, word count tends to be less of a factor than with other objectives. Here, you really just want to ensure you’re writing enough to comprehensively tackle the pain point you’re addressing. That said, nine times out of ten you’re still going to want a reasonably long blog post and want to understand how it stacks up to competing content.

8. For Sharing News

One common type of blog post is when you share company news with your audience. This can often overlap with the other objectives we’ve listed here (you want social shares, people to comment on your post, etc) but more often than not you’re not competing with any other existing content out there.

The news is all about specifically happening at your company. So, just write as much as you need to convey that news while encouraging your audience to comment, share, and interact with it.

Word Count Isn’t the Only Factor That Matters

Proctor says, “It’s no longer an arms race among publishers for who can create the longest, most in-depth piece of content but rather who can create the best experience for a user’s search query. These are not always the same thing. People don’t like sifting through a 3,000-word post when their question can be answered in a well-constructed” shorter post.

To sum up his comments: User experience, comprehensiveness, and quality count more than the number of words you’re using.

Quality-Over-Length

How to Choose Word Counts for Your Post

Avoid choosing a one-size-fits-all length for your posts. Choose word counts for each post or each type of post. You might start by:

  • Looking at the top results for your target keywords. See if there’s a trend in how many words are being used.
  • Using an SEO or content optimization tool such as MarketMuse, Ink, Surfer SEO or SEMrush to get recommendations about how long your word count should be.
  • Choosing a word count range from this post that aligns with your main objectives for a post.
  • Understanding your budget and how much you have to pay per word for the quality you want.

But don’t tie yourself down to those answers. If you can cover your entire topic in a high-quality, user-friendly way with more or less words, start there. You can always come back and make changes to your content to add or remove word count in the future.

Am I Competing?

We’ve mentioned competitive benchmarking several times in this post, but it bears repeating. You should always ask yourself if your blog post will compete with other existing content.

If it is, like when you’re trying to rank for SEO, then you absolutely have to understand the competitive landscape for your content. That means understanding what word counts posts that are doing well feature, but you also need to look at other elements as well.

If you’re not competing, like in the case of writing a post about a company news item, then you don’t necessarily need to focus on word count as much.

Most Posts Have Multiple Objectives

We’ve listed out multiple reasons why you’d want to write a blog post here. Just remember – they’re not mutually exclusive. Most posts satisfy multiple objectives.

Focus on understanding what objectives are most important to you and prioritize writing an appropriate word count for those. For content where you’ll be competing with other content, understanding the competition should really guide your targeted word count.

Fill Your Word Count Goals With Quality

Whether you’re looking for 75-word pithy posts or 3,000-word thought leadership, Crowd Content can help. Reach out to find out how we can help or sign up and start placing blog post orders today.

The post How Long Should a Blog Post Really Be? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-long-should-a-blog-post-really-be/feed/ 0
Writer Spotlight: Bea Johnson — Thoughts on Words, Wizards and Wildlife https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/writer-spotlight-bea-johnson/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/writer-spotlight-bea-johnson/#respond Thu, 25 Mar 2021 20:03:10 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=30514 There have been many famous wizards over the centuries — Prospero, Merlin and Gandalf, to name a few. But we also have quite a few here at Crowd Content. They may not be sorcerers, but our wizards do possess that powerful magic that can conjure up great content. It’s this wizardry and skill that we […]

The post Writer Spotlight: Bea Johnson — Thoughts on Words, Wizards and Wildlife appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
There have been many famous wizards over the centuries — Prospero, Merlin and Gandalf, to name a few. But we also have quite a few here at Crowd Content. They may not be sorcerers, but our wizards do possess that powerful magic that can conjure up great content.

It’s this wizardry and skill that we celebrate in Writer Spotlight. After all, we know it’s formidable talent and not enchantment that pulls solid, sparkling copy out of thin air. And I trust that this month’s featured writer won’t mind the sorcery comparison, knowing the magical worlds that live on her bookshelf.

Meet Bea Johnson. Originally from a small town in middle Tennessee, Bea now calls north Fort Worth, Texas, home. She’s going onto nearly two decades of working as a professional writer, transitioning from web and graphic design. “While building sites, I discovered I liked writing the content for them more than I liked building them,” Bea explains. “So, BOOM! Here I am.”

Bea’s got a certain way of making prose shine, and I suspect it’s from her avid love of words. She bubbles with exuberance when responding to our question about her favorite books.

“I’m not sure I have a favorite-favorite so much as a favorite in various genres,” she begins. “Like with urban fantasy — my main fluffy squeeze. My favorites are Jim Butcher’s Dresden Files series and Kim Harrison’s The Hollows series.”

(The Dresden Files is about Chicago’s first and only wizard P.I. There’s wizardry everywhere. But, back to Bea’s bookshelf.)

“As far as standalone works go, I love Arturo Perez-Reverte’s The Club Dumas, of which half was the basis for the movie The Ninth Gate,” she continues. “I also enjoy older stuff like Robert Anton Wilson and Robert Shea’s Illuminatus! trilogy, which I quote excessively, and modern crime drama authors like Elmore Leonard.” Bea also slips in a “great big nod” to Neal Stephenson and graphic novels such as Grant Morrison’s The Invisibles and Neil Gaiman’s Sandman series.

“In all honesty, though, I’d read the back of a cereal box with gusto if that’s all I had on hand,” Bea concludes.

Bea is a mainstay on our platform as both a writer and editor, although she doesn’t remember how she found Crowd Content all those years ago. “I’m just glad that I did because I love working with y’all,” she comments. We’re glad, too, Bea!

She appreciates the platform’s open lines of communication. “The project managers are always quick to answer questions and address concerns, and most writing platforms could take a page from CC’s book in that regard,” she says.

Her favorite project was Darice, because of her love of crafting. “Also, all the research I did for it took me on some interesting tangents and aided me in improving my own personal projects…and even landing some other writing projects,” she adds.

And what about life beyond words? When Bea’s not reading about the wholesome grains in her cereal bowl or writing for Crowd Content, you can find her watching CatTV. No, it’s not a new streaming service. It’s right outside her window.

“My guy and I enjoy watching suburban wildlife,” she explains. “We started leaving food out for the feral cats in the cul-de-sac to help out and entertain our indoor cats, calling it CatTV. After a bit, we naturally started seeing foxes, raccoons and opossums pretty much every day.” I think Bea’s onto something. I can hear Sir David Attenborough narrating the series.

And now it’s time for Writer Spotlight to really dig deep. Harry Dresden, wizard detective, doesn’t let up on an investigation, and neither do we.

What’s your favorite restaurant or meal? “I love a perfectly seared medium-rare sirloin and baked potato when we go out…because I don’t have to fight with the cats for it.”

What’s your favorite TV show or movie? “I don’t really have a favorite. We’re just finishing up Justified. We binged on Banshee and The Boys earlier this year, and I think we’re doing Deadwood next, followed by Life, this really great show with Damien Lewis that only lasted two seasons.”

Where do you write? “I write on the sofa with my laptop, well, on my lap. It’s just easier for me than toting it all over the place.”

Have you been published by any notable sites or organizations? “No. I actually try to fly below the radar.”

What do you find most challenging about writing content? “Making outlines. I avoided long-form content for so long just because headings and subheadings make me nervous.”

If you could change one thing about our platform, what would it be? “I’d love it if you could fix the spell check issue on the new editor.”

Do you have any advice for new writers? “Don’t take feedback personally, but do use it to improve your writing. When you’re too attached to your writing and can’t take criticism, you’re setting yourself up for failure. Like most anything else in life, it’s about the effort you put in, and part of that is knowing where you lack and working to fix it.”

Complete this sentence: When I’m not working, I love to… “Hang out on social media and meme with my friends…and play with cats. Luckily, my guy is the same.”

What are the five worst words in the English language? “No words are bad, but usage and context might make them so, depending on who utters them. Some words sound better than others…but they all have their place in the tapestry.”

Poof! And just like that, another Writer Spotlight is in the books. My thanks go out to Bea for her time. And I hope you’ll join us again next time when we lift the curtain on another Crowd Content writing wizard. Maybe it’ll be you! 

The post Writer Spotlight: Bea Johnson — Thoughts on Words, Wizards and Wildlife appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/writer-spotlight-bea-johnson/feed/ 0
How to Optimize Content for SEO: A Quick Guide https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-optimize-content-for-seo/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-optimize-content-for-seo/#respond Thu, 18 Mar 2021 21:00:06 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=30352 White hat vs. black hat SEO, LSI keywords, SERPs — what do these terms mean, and more importantly, how do they interconnect within the vast universe of SEO? As we venture into 2024, the landscape of search engine optimization continues to evolve at a breakneck pace. But what does optimizing content for SEO entail in […]

The post How to Optimize Content for SEO: A Quick Guide appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
White hat vs. black hat SEO, LSI keywords, SERPs — what do these terms mean, and more importantly, how do they interconnect within the vast universe of SEO? As we venture into 2024, the landscape of search engine optimization continues to evolve at a breakneck pace. But what does optimizing content for SEO entail in this rapidly changing environment?

From unraveling the mysteries of SEO jargon and revealing the best practices to steering clear of the antiquated tactics that could tank your rankings, we’ve compiled everything you need to know to optimize your content for SEO.

SEO and Content Marketing

Search engine optimization (SEO for short) is intricately linked to content marketing. Quality content is essential for good SEO because it attracts search engines and readers alike. Without optimizing your content with the right keywords and SEO practices, you’ll likely end up in internet limbo. Optimized content reaches more people and establishes your site as a valuable resource, improving your rankings and visibility online.

What is Search Engine Optimization?

SEO is the art of making your site and content more discoverable on various search engines. Google Search is the most common, with all SEO pros pining for the top-ranked position. Generally, the higher your content ranks on the SERPs, the larger the share of search traffic you get.

what-is-seo_

Written content, such as blogs and general web copy, is the most common and recognizable home for optimized text. But you can apply SEO to almost any platform with a search function. YouTube, Amazon Marketplace, the App Store — you can use SEO on each one to help hoist your content to the top of search results.

Many tactics go into SEO (more than we can get into here), but there’s one central tenet: Well-optimized content is the most valuable ranking factor out there.

And it makes sense. Google wants to show searchers the best possible content to help them satisfy their search intent. It’s all part of Google’s quality rater guidelines; Google prioritizes content that showcases experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness. So, above all, people-first content is where it’s at, and Google keeps tabs on your application of E-E-A-T principles using search engine spiders (web crawlers).

Google thinks more and more like a website visitor with every core update. So, with that being said, your content needs to be thoughtful and helpful to actual readers. Don’t write for the algorithm; write for human beings.” 

Joshua Pelletier, Content Director, BarBend

What are search engine spiders?

There’s no need to start spinning out over the next iteration of Matrix Sentinels — search engine spiders are entirely benign. Also known as “web crawlers,” search engine spiders are bots that filter through website content. For example, Google predictably calls its web crawler Googlebot, while Bing chose to name its standard web crawler Bingbot.

These autonomous programs sift through endless content and use a massive list of criteria to determine the best content. To make them happy, create quality content that comprehensively covers the search intent you’re targeting. Crawlers are ultimately trying to determine what human readers find most valuable, so in simple terms, you need to give the people what they want.

Why Optimize for SEO?

In the 21st century, consumers use the internet and, more specifically, search engines to find and buy products and services. To compete in the online marketplace, your site has to appear in the SERPs when people type relevant keywords into the search engine.

Imagine you go to Disneyland. The park is packed, and you mistakenly told friends you’d meet them “by the kiosk selling mouse ears.” That doesn’t exactly narrow things down, does it? SEO is like dropping a giant pin with your location. But instead of giving the roadmap to friends, you’re giving consumers everything they need to find you ASAP — before they find other friends and forget about you entirely.

The top-ranked site on the SERPS receives almost 40% of all the clicks. The site in position No. 2 gets 18.7%, and the third-ranked site walks about with just over 10% of the SERP traffic. After that, numbers fall off considerably.

The more SEO-optimized pages on your site, the more opportunities you have to earn significant traffic. So, creating optimized SEO content covering all the topics and search terms your buyers use is incredibly valuable.

SEO Stat

SEO Best Practices

It’s time to dive into SEO content strategy. These are the legitimate techniques you can use to make your high-quality content stand out in the SERPs.

Start with a great SEO content strategy

Excellent SEO content doesn’t come out of nowhere. To optimize content for SEO, you have to start with a strong SEO strategy. Far too many otherwise talented people create articles and blog posts on the fly and try to optimize them afterward. More often than not, they end up with clumsy content.

You can avoid this inelegant scenario if you plan ahead, use proven keyword research tools, and weave SEO into your content as you go along.

  • Research your audience before you begin. You can use a survey provider such as SurveyMonkey or Typeform to find out what your target consumer base wants.
  • Conduct exhaustive keyword research. Once you know what your audience wants, determine their search terms. This can be as simple as using Google’s Keyword Planner or more advanced through SEO tools such as MozSemrush, or Ahrefs. You should know all the keywords your audience uses and what stage of the buyer’s journey they apply to. 
  • Focus on creating comprehensive content. Your keywords should help you develop a list of core topics to be covered, but take it a step further and look at latent semantic indexing (LSI) keywords to discover related topics that are almost, if not equally, as vital. Say your primary keyword is “Las Vegas.” Conceptually related semantic keywords might include “Sin City,” “casinos,” “hotels,” and “Super Bowl.” For a shortcut, check out tools like Ink and MarketMuse that provide all-in-one, AI-driven research, audit, and optimization interfaces.
  • Write long-form articles. Blog posts should ideally be between 1,500 and 2,500 words long. But that number can shift depending on search intent, the topic demands, and your content goals. Pieces that top 3,000 words get the most organic traffic, but that length isn’t always ideal for other formats. Use tools like Ink, MarketMuse, or Surfer SEO to determine the word count you need to hit to compete with existing search results.
  • Stay on task. Longer articles rank well, but only if they’re thorough and avoid fluff or filler. Writing for the sake of writing won’t win you an audience. Writing a shorter piece packed with value is better than fluffing your way to the maximum word count.
  • Create supporting visuals. Your content shouldn’t be a wall of text. That’s as daunting for readers as it is boring. In fact, content is reported to be 43% more persuasive when accompanied by visuals. Content with infographics or illustrations increases the overall appeal, legibility, and value. Images can even rank with Google Image Search if you optimize the file name and alt text.
  • Include a clear call to action. Readers need to know what to do next, so point them in the right direction with a prominent call to action. This can help drive leads and conversions, while keeping visitors on your site and indirectly boosting your SEO.

Use keywords effectively

Keywords are critical to SEO. Forget everything you learned in 2003, including the idea that keyword stuffing has any place in modern times. Instead, follow widely agreed-upon basics:

  • Use your primary keyword within the first 100 words and in one H2.
  • Repeat the primary keyword a few more times in your content, but don’t go overboard.
  • Include your primary keyword in your meta title, meta description, and page title.
  • Work in 1-2 mentions of secondary keywords and related terms as naturally as possible. (Using one of these in an H2, too, doesn’t hurt.)

NOTE – Remember your primary keyword is the one that best represents the topic and search intent for which you’re crafting your content.

Today’s Google algorithms recognize synonyms and ignore stop words (a, the, which, at, on, etc.), so you can modify your search terms to make them more readable.

  • “Piano lessons Philadelphia” becomes “piano lessons in Philadelphia.”

You can also change keywords in other subtle ways without losing Google points, like this:

  • “Shortest route New York to San Diego” becomes “shortest route between New York and San Diego.”

Effective keyword use extends to image text, including alt text and captions.

“Don’t forget about secondary keywords. Secondary keywords allow search engines to further categorize text. They provide additional semantic information that helps algorithms make judgements about relevancy and topic.”

Kim Smith, Digital Marketing Manager, Clarify Capital

When looking for LSI keywords and additional topics needed to make your content comprehensive, you’ll find more than you can realistically focus on. Many SEO tools simply check to see if you’ve included these keywords because there seems to be a correlation with improved rankings. But the smarter way to approach this is to identify the subtopics they represent and create content to address them.

This hub-and-spoke approach adds value for the reader and naturally gets your related keywords in. Content strategists map this out by creating master pillar pages linked to cluster content that supports the main idea. Your pillar page might be about DIY weddings, while cluster pages cover hiring entertainment, making our decorations, and sourcing flowers.

Create high-quality content

Readers stay engaged with high-quality content. You might call it “sticky” content — it’s unique, entertaining, inspiring, and educational enough to keep your target audience glued to the page.

High-quality content usually comes bearing a few trademarks. 

  • Relevant to your product or service
  • Comprehensive and trustworthy
  • Filled with practical advice
  • Error-free and easy to read

“Get specific with your content and the value it delivers to your specific audience.”

Marin = Perez, Director of Content Marketing, Kajabi

If that sounds like a callback to the E-E-A-T standards we discussed earlier, that’s no coincidence. Googlebot can tell the difference between churnalism and content created by a thought leader. To ensure you make the grade:

  • Pay attention to structure. Dynamic headers and subheads containing strategically placed keywords speak volumes.
  • Meet your audience on their level. Lose the industry jargon, and speak plainly to your readers.
  • Make your content shareable. Put social media buttons in a prominent place to make sharing easier.
  • Use bullets and numbered lists. Organize your content and make it snackable with bullets, numbered lists, and other typographical elements.
  • Compare your article with current SERP winners. Beat your competition by comparing your new content with Google and Bing rankings. Look for content gaps, and create content to fill them.

Use on-page content optimization 

High-quality content and SEO are decent on their own, but use them together and on-page content optimization can turn masterful prose into a true moneymaker.

  • Use keywords organically. Don’t overdo keywords. Instead, use them naturally within the body of your content and in H1s and H2s.
  • Know that location (and local SEO) is everything. Include location-specific phrases in H1s and your body content to optimize your site for local readers. Once Googlebot notices, your site will appear in geo-specific SERPs.
  • Create scannable content. Break your body copy into digestible chunks to keep readers interested. Avoid excessively long paragraphs, avoid complex language, and keep sentences under 25 words. Organizational assists, including bulleted lists and H3 subheaders, can help with scannability, too.
  • Don’t confuse the bot. Headings are essential, but you need to use them properly. You only need one H1 on your page, and headers should always follow the numerical hierarchy — H1, H2, and H3s when needed.
  • Apply schema markup. When you publish, take the time to add schema markup to your content. This structured data gives you a better shot at getting your content into Google’s featured snippets.
  • Interlink appropriately. Your content should be organized in topic clusters, and eventually, you should have content for every topic. Include keyword-rich internal links between these pages.

“Add structure. Use structured markup (schema) to ensure your classes and related product pages, as well as business information (name, address, phone number), is properly formatted for Google and other engines to index properly.”

Kent Lewis, President and Founder, Anvil Media

Outdo The Competition

Every piece of content you publish competes with a slew of content from other brands that are targeting the same search terms you are. You need to create the best possible content on a topic to stand out.

When looking at the competitive landscape, evaluate what the current top search results feature in terms of:

  • Word count
  • Topics covered
  • Content types (text, images, video, etc.)
  • Schema markup

Several tools can automate this research and score your content against your competitors so you know how you’re doing. The best ones to check out include MarketMuse, Ink, Content Harmony, and Surfer SEO.

The-competitive-SEO-landscape

E-E-A-T considerations

Google’s E-E-A-T update has been an industry-wide game-changer. For content to rank, it needs to showcase:

  • Experience: Highlight first-hand, real-world experience related to the topic at hand. If you’re writing about pet health, you should have a pet and have gone through some of the things you discuss on the page.
  • Expertise: Google will love your pet health page even more if the author has relevant expertise — perhaps a byline from an actual veterinarian or a well-known pet health guru.
  • Authoritativeness: Position yourself as the go-to source for pet health. How your page is put together and the content you share should feel reliable. In other words, do readers believe you’re legit?
  • Trustworthiness: Content can’t be purely editorial. Use proper attributions, source citations, and linked statistics to prove your site is informative, accurate, and safe. (Up-to-date site security certifications can help with the latter.)

You might demonstrate E-E-A-T by:

  • Writing a detailed writer bio that demonstrates why you’re an expert on the subject
  • Including links to authoritative sources in your content
  • Seeking out quotes from other experts 
  • Featuring data points from reputable sources
  • Having your content fact-checked by a subject matter expert to ensure 100% accuracy

Optimize for domain authority

Domain authority looks at the quantity and quality of links to a website to determine that site’s importance. Every site gets a score ranging from one to 100. The higher your score, the more likely you’ll rank at or near the top of the SERPs. 

To improve your DA score, you must integrate links as you create content and find ways to encourage people to link back to your pages.

  • Include internal links to web pages on your site, such as backlinks from cluster topics to pillar pages.
  • Embed social media posts with links to your site in your content, encouraging people to share them. Tools like Click to Tweet help with this.
  • Create graphics with embedded codes so people can easily add them to their site.
  • Encourage people to use your imagery as long as they link to your site.
  • Format your content to make it easy to reference. Tables, charts, and FAQs make your content easier to reference and link to.

By effectively interlinking all the pages on your site, you pass the authority from page to page, lifting all their search rankings.

Be accurate

Inaccurate and poorly written content can be a brand killer. Mistakes make you seem untrustworthy. To paraphrase Google Search Advocate John Mueller, Google won’t penalize you for sloppy writing, but your audience might.

Never publish content without:

  • Proofreading your work
  • Including outbound links to reputable sources
  • Double-checking your links are correct and lead to active pages

Running your article through a plagiarism checker like Copyscape

Go live SEO checklist

Technical SEO Optimization Tips

While we’re primarily focusing on how you can optimize content for SEO, it’s important to note a few technical SEO optimization tips you should address.

  • Check your site on a wide range of mobile devices. Responsive layouts tend to flow between gadgets, so check forms and links to ensure they stay clickable. Your content should be easy to digest and legible regardless of whether someone is scrolling on an Android tablet or flicking through on their iPhone.
  • Play around with images to decrease your site loading time. Large, high-resolution images look great, but they slow websites down. Use optimized JPGs to display photos, and go for lossless PNGs if you need to incorporate pictures with text or transparent backgrounds.

Periodic site maintenance can enhance your search engine ranks, too. Check that all pages appear on your site’s XML map and that internal and external links are current.

Finally, ensure your site pages have succinct and descriptive URLs for a possible lift in your rankings.

SEO Techniques to Avoid

Every dog has its day, and that applies to SEO content strategy. Stay far away from the following tactics in 2024:

  • Keyword stuffing: Often tied to keyword density, avoid cramming your targeted keywords in your content as often as possible. Keyword stuffing is ineffective, and if you do it anyway, you could get flagged by Google for having low-quality content.
  • Duplicate content: Google doesn’t officially penalize sites for duplicating content, but when the search engine finds multiple sites serving up the same text, it decides which to rank and which one to bury. Embracing original content — even when producing hundreds of local SEO city pages or product descriptions — can keep you from cannibalizing your site.
  • Spinning. Spun articles are the cheap designer handbags of content. They don’t rank well because they’re basically plagiarized and often read awkwardly. Google recognizes spun content as spam-like and subpar, so it’s best to skip it altogether.

SEO Content Optimization: Keeping It Real

To summarize that deep dive into all things content SEO optimization, here’s a summary of what we’ve discussed: 

  • SEO optimization tactics are smoke signals for search engine bots or spiders.
  • Search engine spiders crawl the web to index and evaluate content.
  • Effectively optimizing your content for specific search terms and topics could result in high search rankings and organic traffic.
  • SEO content creation best practices include on-page optimization techniques, careful keyword use, and informational accuracy.
  • Evaluate your content’s competitive landscape and outdo the competition.
  • Help boost domain authority by encouraging people to link to your content.
  • Steer clear of antiquated SEO content tactics such as keyword stuffing or article spinning.

Optimizing content for SEO has a learning curve, but if you stick with the tips in this guide, you could scale to the top of a SERP like a total pro. Too busy to write your SEO content? Crowd Content has a team of 6,000-plus writers waiting to help. Our freelancers know SEO and can tackle everything from blogs to web copy to category descriptions.For more information, contact our managed services team or sign up for a self-serve Marketplace account today.

The post How to Optimize Content for SEO: A Quick Guide appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-optimize-content-for-seo/feed/ 0
Online Marketing SOS: What is SEO Article Writing? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/seo-article-writing/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/seo-article-writing/#respond Wed, 24 Feb 2021 23:39:06 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29836 You’re an established business with a modern website, but you don’t get many visitors. Everything looks great, so why can’t people find you online? If you haven’t optimized your website, that lack of SEO might provide an answer. But what is SEO article writing, and how can it help you drive traffic? We’ll dive into […]

The post Online Marketing SOS: What is SEO Article Writing? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
You’re an established business with a modern website, but you don’t get many visitors. Everything looks great, so why can’t people find you online? If you haven’t optimized your website, that lack of SEO might provide an answer. But what is SEO article writing, and how can it help you drive traffic? We’ll dive into that in this guide.

What Exactly Does SEO Mean?

If you’re reading this, there’s a good chance you know what SEO means. Please feel free to skip to the next section if so.

SEO stands for search engine optimization. In short, SEO is an online marketing strategy — and like other marketing strategies, its main purpose is to drive traffic to your business. SEO does that by helping your content appear in search results of various search engines – Google, Bing, YouTube, etc.

There are a ton of ranking factors that these search engines use to determine what content to show searchers. Most search engines want to show the best possible content to answer a searcher’s question, so that’s your goal.

Broadly, what you need to know about SEO when it comes to article writing is that you need to create engaging, comprehensive content that thoroughly explores a topic. You also need to optimize for some keywords that reflect that topic.

The most effective SEO strategies act like filters, helping your audience to find relevant content at every stage of their journey. And ultimately, it summons visitors who really want to buy your products.

Online Marketing Tactics 101

SEO article writing is just one of many online marketing tactics you can use to boost your business. Others include:

  • SEO product descriptions, page content and blog posts
  • Collaborative marketing
  • Influencer marketing
  • Social media ads
  • Banner ads
  • Pay-per-click (PPC) ads

Some of those strategies are known as “organic,” while others are “paid.”

Business-Boosting-Marketing-Tactics

Organic Marketing

Organic marketing drives traffic naturally — and it also builds brand awareness. It includes any traffic generating efforts that happen naturally and without any paid promotion. That could include traffic from SEO, social sharing, word of mouth, etc.

Blog posts about your company contribute to organic marketing. SEO articles fall into this category, too. Both can organically draw in traffic over time without you spending to win that traffic.

Paid Marketing

Paid marketing includes PPC, display ads, programmatic ads, social media ads and influencer marketing. You pay for ads or pay an influencer to promote your product. Some types of paid marketing aren’t too pricey; others are very expensive.

So, which tactics work best? In a word, both. Most successful online businesses use a blend of paid and organic marketing strategies to maximize their reach.

How to Write SEO Articles

If you want to write great SEO articles, you need to follow a set of rules. Why? Because search engines like Google use web crawlers, or spiders, to find your site. These bots “fetch” web pages, which they categorize — or rank — according to specific criteria.

In other words, if you want Googlebot to notice your site, you need to create attention-grabbing content. That’s SEO in a nutshell.

#1: Find the Best SEO Queries – Keyword Research

You can’t write SEO articles without knowing what search terms you’re targeting and what topics your audience is interested in. Before you start writing, make sure your company has done exhaustive keyword research to identify all the search terms your audience uses, what topics they represent, and what stage of the buyer’s journey they’re at.

At most companies, once this is done you’ll develop a content plan that makes sure you create content that targets all the topics your audience is interested in.

Keyword research is an amazing tool to help you understand your customers. Just make sure you’re using keywords to learn what customers are trying to do and what their search intent is. Make sure that your content is written to satisfy it. That’s the most important part of SEO writing these days.

Finding The Best Keywords

We had a chat with SimpleTexting marketing manager Alfredo Salkeld, who gave us some tips about SEO best practices. According to Alfredo, “the most successful SEO writers are those who know how to find queries that have purchase intent.” In other words, you need to incorporate the search phrases people use when they really want to buy a particular product. These phrases are called buyer intent keywords — and they’re the gold standard for SEO.

“Alright, Alfredo,” you might say, “How do we find queries that have purchase intent?” The answer is simple — albeit somewhat time-consuming: detective work. Before you begin, consider your ideal customer’s:

  • Needs: What are their pain points? Why are they looking for your product in the first place?
  • Wants: How could they use your physical products or digital solutions to solve their problems?
  • Voice: Which words would your customers used to find answers?
How-to-find-the-best-keywords

Hint #1: most consumers don’t use overly technical language.

The Keyword Research Process

The next step is keyword research. You can perform keyword research yourself, or you can use a tool like Google’s Keyword Planner or SEMrush. Here’s what you do:

  1. Enter your seed keyword ideas into the search box
  2. Review your keyword search results
  3. Check out keyword metrics: search volume, SEO difficulty etc.
  4. Pinpoint relevant keywords with a lower SEO difficulty score
  5. Choose your short-tail (general) and long-tail (niche) keywords
cd0c46f4-994d-315b-8af5-c5bd384eba57
Screenshot showing SEMrush’s keyword magic tool used for keyword research.

Hint #2: Don’t pick misspelled keywords, because they’ll affect your article credibility.

Buyer intent keywords aren’t usually too ambiguous. Look for phrases like, “buy X,” “best X,” “price of X” or “coupon for X.” Stay away from lower buyer intent keywords — avoid “free” anything, for instance.

Some paid keyword research tools (SEMrush) actually let you filter for specific keywords types, so you can find buyer intent keywords more easily.

While search terms with buyer intent are most valuable, you’ll also want to create articles that target search terms used by buyers who are earlier in their buying journey. These search terms also have value as a source of top of funnel prospects. More on that later.

#2: Use Keywords Properly – Focus on Topics

Forget everything you’ve ever read about keyword stuffing. These days, Google and Bing penalize keyword-heavy pages, so keyword overuse might actually put you at the bottom of the stack. Instead, use your keywords carefully to ensure you get noticed without making a scene. Follow these tips for success:

  • Identify the topic that your target keyword represents, and focus on creating a piece that comprehensively covers that topic
  • Try to use your main keyword in your page title, in your first paragraph (or within the first 100 words) and again a couple of times in the body of your piece.
  • Use secondary keywords at least once in your article.
  • Identify complementary topics and LSI keywords that would help you create a more comprehensive article

Whatever you do, don’t force keywords into your piece. Google’s main mission is to identify quality pieces of content: if your content looks clunky, you can bet it’ll notice and knock you down a peg. Always focus on readers first and search bots second.

#3: Write Valuable Content

Let’s drill down into quality content a little more. Quality is a pretty subjective word, isn’t it?

What we mean when we say “quality content” is:

  • Content is error-free and reads well, engaging the reader
  • Well researched offering unique info
  • Comprehensively addresses the topic it covers

Within the context of SEO, that means you should focus on white hat SEO (which is much more focused on delivering value to readers) rather than black hat SEO (focused on manipulating search algorithms and keyword stuffing) when you write your content.

White hat content still focuses on a target keyword and topic, but it doesn’t shoehorn it in to reach target keyword densities, and it certainly doesn’t do so at the cost of readability.

Don’t write general content that doesn’t offer any value: write topic-focused content that revolves around your main topic and keyword.

For example, if your main keyword is “paint suppliers in Boston,” you wouldn’t want to write about DIY in Boston. Instead, you could create a top ten list of painters and decorators in Boston.

Part of offering your readers valuable information is ending with a call to action – what can they do next? Do you want them to buy a product? Refer them to a related article or resource?

#4 – Focus on Readability

Break your text into snackable, scannable chunks — no more than three or four sentences per paragraph — to make it easier to read. Listicles go down well, and so do how-to guides.

Hung-Nguyen-SmallPDF-Quote

“Most importantly, ensure that your content is readable—you want it to sound as natural as possible. Remember, the content is for your readers; search engines are merely the bridge to get your content across.” — Hung Nguyen, Smallpdf

Are your site visitors in a hurry, or do they have time to spare? Use your existing knowledge to craft quick reads or in-depth content to match your potential readership. If you’re not sure, create buyer personas — imaginary customers based on evidence — and use them as inspiration whenever you write SEO articles.

#5: Size Matters

When it comes to the inner workings of its search algorithm, Google doesn’t give anything away. SEO experts make educated guesses about what Google searches for and how page rank works. Short blog posts — maybe 300-350 words — used to be de rigueur; now longer blog posts — over 1,500 words — are “in.”

In the end, you need to let your subject dictate the length of your SEO article. You can wax lyrical about curtain rods, but will your readers really trawl through 2,500 words on the merits of steel vs wood? Probably not. In reality, most websites use a mixture of short and long articles to build readership and drive traffic.

Pro Tip – Evaluate the Competition

One of the most effective ways of crafting SEO articles that rank is to look at what already ranks. By looking at the top of Google results for your targeted search terms, you can evaluate what topics they cover and how long they are. This lets you understand what Google thinks is valuable to searchers, and guides you on what to cover and how long your piece should be to outdo the competition.

Numerous tools can help with this including MarketMuse, Ink, Surfer SEO, SEMrush’s Content Template and more.

#6: Think About Your Buyer’s Journey

You can use SEO articles to pull people into any stage of your buyer’s journey. Buyer’s journeys have four main stages:

  1. Awareness: People first become aware of your product or service via social media, word of mouth, ads or SEO marketing
  2. Interest: Prospects evaluate your business to see what your brand is all about
  3. Decision: Interested consumers want to know more about your prices and shipping options are
  4. Action: Visitors either become customers or they exit the sales funnel
Understanding-the-buyers-journey

“SEO article writing needs to serve your underlying business goals: increasing leads or revenue, either directly or by filling your remarketing funnel.” — Owen Mansfield, Majux Marketing

You can hone your keyword choices to match any of these four stages, like this:

  • Awareness keywords: “best espresso coffee” or “how to lose belly fat”
  • Interest keywords: “why X is the best coffee” or “how X can help you lose belly fat”
  • Decision keywords: “how to get X for less” or “free shipping on X”
  • Action keywords: “get free shipping on X for a limited time” or “save up to 50% in the X winter sale”

If you’re doing keywords research, you should sort your keywords according to what stage of the buyer’s journey they represent. Alternately, make sure your SEO team provides you with that info if they’re doing the keyword research.

For best results, write articles aimed at each part of the funnel — and make sure you’re creating content that speaks to what your reader is trying to accomplish at that point.

Articles Aren’t Always The Right Choice For Your Sales Funnel

While articles do help rank for keywords representing all stages of the buyer’s journey / sales funnel, for some businesses (especially eCommerce), the decision and action stage keywords usually don’t make sense to target with an article.

For example, if someone searches for “buy Nintendo Switch” that shows a ton of purchase intent and you’d want to direct them to a product page where they could take action. In this case, creating an SEO optimized product page will be way more successful and likely to rank as it better matches search intent.

What is SEO Article Writing: The Wrap

Let’s take a moment to recap SEO article writing. Like other types of organic marketing, SEO builds awareness, drives website traffic and — hopefully — draws each visitor into your funnel.

Leverage keyword research to identify search terms and topics important to your buyers, and then map those out to the stages of the buyer’s journey.

Then, map out what types of content you need to create to cover each topic. Articles work for most topics, especially ones higher in the funnel.

Remember you need to understand the search intent of the keywords you’re targeting and write to satisfy that. That’s your primary goal. But, you still need to do some keyword optimization.

Include your main keyword in your article title, in the first paragraph (or first 100 words), and a couple of times in the body of your piece. Make sure your content provides value, is comprehensive, and don’t go overboard on article length if you don’t need to. Benchmark your content as your top SEO competitors for the targeted search term and outdo them.

If you’re looking for stellar-quality SEO articles, optimized product descriptions and advertorials, get in touch with us here at Crowd Content. We work with entrepreneurs, SMBs and enterprise-level organizations: simply tell us what you need, and we’ll come up with a custom content plan.

The post Online Marketing SOS: What is SEO Article Writing? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/seo-article-writing/feed/ 0
Writer Spotlight: Rachel Elle — A Peek Into the Life of a Crowd Content Pro https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/writer-spotlight-rachel-elle/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/writer-spotlight-rachel-elle/#respond Thu, 21 Jan 2021 19:00:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29758 When life gets a little unpredictable (2020, we’re looking at you), it’s good to have things you can count on: the sun rising each day, the ocean tides rolling onto shore, and the arrival of spring after a long winter. At Crowd Content, it’s our writers we count on when things get hectic. This month’s […]

The post Writer Spotlight: Rachel Elle — A Peek Into the Life of a Crowd Content Pro appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
When life gets a little unpredictable (2020, we’re looking at you), it’s good to have things you can count on: the sun rising each day, the ocean tides rolling onto shore, and the arrival of spring after a long winter.

At Crowd Content, it’s our writers we count on when things get hectic. This month’s Writer Spotlight shines on one of our most steadfast freelancers, a seasoned pro who’s been helping us tackle overflowing work queues and looming deadlines since our earliest days. Meet Rachel Elle — a four-star writer, foodie, and treasure trove of information about the New York subway.

ALSO – Hire Freelance Writers Today

Originally from Ohio, Rachel began jotting down stories at the wise old age of four. Eventually turning her passion for prose into a marketable job skill, she started collecting paychecks for writing when she was a junior in college. Rachel graduated with a Bachelor of Arts in English/Creative Writing and a Master of Accounting; two vastly different degrees that she’s put to good use.

Today, she lives in Manhattan and works full-time in finance for a media company. When Rachel’s not at her day job, she fits in as many Crowd Content orders as she can. “When I commuted, I used to occasionally write from my phone on the train or while walking,” she says.

Wait. Did she just say writing while walking?

She did, but doesn’t recommend this approach. This is a good thing. We don’t want our writers to step off a curb or walk into a lamp post while working keywords into their blog posts. End of public service announcement.

Our story now turns to Mark Zuckerberg, or at least his social media empire, for helping Rachel find Crowd Content. In 2013, she discovered our platform through a Facebook group that shared work-from-home resources. This means she’s been writing blog posts, articles and product descriptions for us for nearly eight years. She’s certainly earned her spot in the Crowd Content hall of fame with other veteran writers and editors like Sapphire Knight.

Rachel’s ability to tackle almost any writing job makes her indispensable to clients and project managers. “I consider myself a generalist,” she says. “As long as an article topic fits into my general knowledge base and isn’t something I’m personally/morally/ethically opposed to, I’ll write it. I’ve written about everything from cremation jewelry to tankless water heaters.”

As much as we rely on Rachel’s finely crafted prose, we appreciate that there are times when she’s not crunching numbers or writing copy. What does she do when she’s not working? “Real answer? Sit on the couch and do nothing,” she confesses. “Idealistic answer? Explore the city — no matter how long you’ve lived here, there’s always something new to see.” She adds, “My husband and I are foodies, so we’re always trying new restaurants. An enormous portion of our disposable income goes to dining out…or ordering in, in these fun COVID times.”

All right. I think that’s a pretty good warm-up. Now let’s get to the meat and potatoes of it all. It’s time to learn Rachel’s honest opinions about books, movies, and, gasp, Crowd Content.

Do you have any hobbies or unusual interests? “I’m really into elite gymnastics and follow U.S. gymnasts closely. I also love mass transit and am a veritable fount of useless information about the New York City Subway.” (Oh, do we have a treat for you, Rachel. Stay tuned till the end.)

Who is your favorite author? What’s your favorite book? “My favorite author has long been Tamora Pierce, possibly now from more of a nostalgic place. My favorite book is A Tree Grows in Brooklyn.”

What’s your favorite restaurant or meal? “If I’m cooking myself, I’m a big fan of fresh pasta with homemade pesto.”

What’s your favorite TV show or movie? “I hate movies. I find them equal parts too short and too long: too long for me to sit through without multitasking and yet too short to tell a well-rounded story. I’m a big fan of crime dramas, true crimes stories and female-focused dramas. I’ve seen every episode of Law & Order: SVU and Criminal Minds at least once.”

Have you been published by any notable sites or organizations (digital or traditional)? “Not that I’m aware, but I’m not always sure who my clients are.”

Which project has been your favorite? Why? “FHE Health. The orders are both easy and interesting.”

What do you think sets Crowd Content apart from other content platforms? “Ease of use, pay (much higher than most competitors), transparency into internal practices, and ease of communication with management. I’ve tried many others over the years, and Crowd Content is hands down the best.”

If you could change one thing about our platform, what would it be? “I dislike the new content editor.”

What do you find most challenging about writing content? “I guess I’d say research if I had to pick, but I’ve always found writing easy.”

Do you have any advice for new writers? “Be patient; writing doesn’t come naturally to everyone and developing the skills necessary to succeed can take time. Stay in contact with clients, especially when starting out. I built my early client base by thanking clients who gave me good reviews and letting them know I was available for more work.”

What are the five worst words in the English language? “All words have a place. They’re only bad when used improperly or by someone who doesn’t know what they’re doing.”

Rachel, thank you for giving us a peek into your world. To express our appreciation, we have a tidbit to add to your New York City Subway knowledge. Did you know the longest ride on the system without changing trains is on the A train? It’s 31 miles from 207 Street in Manhattan to Far Rockaway in Queens. But, you probably knew that already.

It’s been a pleasure as always, readers. Please join us again next time, when another Crowd Content writer steps into the spotlight. Maybe it’ll be you!

ALSO – Writer Spotlight: Jenn MacDonald — Yes, It Started With a Bough of Holly

The post Writer Spotlight: Rachel Elle — A Peek Into the Life of a Crowd Content Pro appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/writer-spotlight-rachel-elle/feed/ 0
What Are the Principles of Communication? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/principles-of-communication/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/principles-of-communication/#respond Thu, 14 Jan 2021 20:00:20 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29728 Great marketing depends upon great communication. Some might say, in fact, that marketing is a type of communication. Conversions happen when consumers feel inspired by emails, advertorials, product descriptions and other marketing endeavors. But what are the principles of communication, and how can you use them to improve your marketing content? In this blog post, we’ll explore seven […]

The post What Are the Principles of Communication? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Great marketing depends upon great communication. Some might say, in fact, that marketing is a type of communication. Conversions happen when consumers feel inspired by emails, advertorials, product descriptions and other marketing endeavors. But what are the principles of communication, and how can you use them to improve your marketing content?

In this blog post, we’ll explore seven principles of communication and teach you how to incorporate them into your delivery strategy. Ready to morph into a marketing maven? Excellent: read on.

What Makes Communication Effective?

When one person successfully conveys an idea to another person — or a group of people — that’s effective communication. Going further, effective communication in marketing is always persuasive. Conversions depend on your ability to persuade customers that your products or services are essential — or at the very least, extremely beneficial to them.

Let’s think about the characteristics of persuasive content for a moment. Effective communication must be:

  • Clear
  • Accurate
  • Complete
  • Precise
  • Reliable
  • Considerate
  • Polite

Effective communicators don’t just broadcast a message: they listen, too. We’ll explore this in detail later on, but effective communication is a dance between sender and recipient. You’re the sender; consumers are the recipients.

What-Makes-Communication-Effective

What Are the Seven Principles of Communication?

Some people are undoubtedly better natural communicators than others. With that said, any of us can learn the seven principles of effective communication.

#1: Listen Carefully

Communication is a two-way street. Experienced negotiators and diplomats know that to achieve results, they need to listen as well as speak. You can use this principle to create truly compelling marketing content. To find out what your consumer base wants, use a service like SurveyMonkey to create a questionnaire; then, use social media and email to distribute your survey.

#2: Create a Goal

What do you want your audience to do after they read your marketing content? Let’s look at a few examples:

  • Marketing emails: Ideally, recipients follow a link to a landing page on your website and make a purchase.
  • Advertorials: Advertorial text must compel readers to enter your sales channel and purchase your product.
  • Product descriptions: Descriptions have to answer visitor questions about function, price, size, shipping costs etc. to create conversions.

Think about goals for your marketing content and then pinpoint a few trackable key performance indicators (KPIs) to help you review your progress. Great content marketing KPIs for websites include:

  • Page or social media post shares
  • Unique page visitors
  • Time spent on pages
  • Inbound links to pages on your site
  • Social media interactions or comments
  • Cost per lead (CPL)
Content-Marketing-KPIs-for-Websites

Organize Your Thoughts: Winners keep score, so create a well-organized outline for your marketing plan and stick to it.

#3: Think About Your Medium

You might need to adjust your message for each medium you use. Social media demands a different marketing approach than an advertorial, for example. Twitter and Facebook posts are short and to the point; advertorials can be thousands of words long. To generate a decent click-through rate (CTR) on social media, your message must be both compelling and succinct.

#4: Clear, Persuasive Writing

Let’s get one thing straight: jargon doesn’t add credibility to marketing content. Leave jargon behind — and make sure you check your content for spelling mistakes and unnecessarily wordy sentences. Long-winded declarations don’t lead to conversions; short, precise statements do, though.

To write persuasively, you have to appeal to consumers’ emotions. In his 2011 book entitled Thinking, Fast and Slow, psychologist and economist Daniel Kahneman explores two separate thought processes. Readers react intuitively and emotionally first — logic gets second dibs. Think of emotional triggers and rational facts as ingredients in persuasive writing, and combine them equally for best results.

Less is More: Stay on point and avoid repetition to ensure busy readers receive your message.

#5: Tell Stories

Early humans came together around communal campfires to cook, create tools and tell stories. Leading anthropologists agree that we’re hardwired to learn from storytelling — and that’s something you can use to your advantage whenever you create marketing content. Well-crafted stories convey information in an entertaining and engaging way; stories also humanize your product and your company.

#6: Get Visual

People learn in a lot of different ways. When educator Neil Fleming unveiled his VARK model design in 1987, he proposed four sensory modalities — more commonly known as learning styles:

  • Visual
  • Auditory
  • Physical
  • Social
Four-Learning-Styles

Most of us use all four modalities to learn new information. Many people are primarily visual learners, however, which is why it’s so important to use images in your marketing. Photographs, illustrations — even cartoons — pique the reader’s interest, while diagrams and infographics translate text into digestible pictures.

Images Rule: Are your readers in a hurry?A 2014 MIT neuroscience study found that people were able to absorb information from images in as few as 13 microseconds.

#7: Stay Curious

As your business evolves, your customers will also evolve. If you decide to concentrate on a niche market, you’ll need to target a specific consumer subset. If you expand your range, you might decide to market your products via a greater number of channels. In either case, keep your ear to the ground to make sure you continue to communicate effectively with your customers.

Effective Communication in Marketing

We know the seven principles of communication; now we’ll talk about how they apply in your day-to-day marketing strategy. Let’s look at marketing emails, advertorials and product descriptions.

Marketing Emails

Marketing emails need an eye-catching subject line, or they risk being tossed in the trash — or even worse, being relegated to your recipient’s spam folder. Marketing emails also benefit from concise, compelling content and a bold call to action (CTA) link or a clickable button. You’ll also need to create a sales funnel for your marketing email — a custom landing page, for example.

Advertorials

Advertorials use the power of storytelling to promote and sell products. They’re the marketing equivalent of a really great salesperson on a shop floor. Laced with emotional hooks and carefully selected information, advertorials turn mundane items into must-haves. Genuinely great advertorials don’t even sound like adverts — they sound more like blog posts, or enthusiastic (but genuine) endorsements.

Product Descriptions

The best product descriptions (PDs) use a combination of hard fact and entertaining prose to convince visitors of an item’s value. Most shorter PDs begin with one or two descriptive paragraphs and continue with a relevant list of product features. Customers need to be able to see key facts at a glance. To avoid losing consumers at the checkout phase, make sure you display shipping charges clearly on each product page.

It’s a Marketing Wrap

Product descriptions, press releases, emails, advertorials and other marketing content are all built on the principles of effective communication. Let’s end with a quick recap of each point:

  • Listen: Communication flows both ways, so listen to what your customers want.
  • Goals: Create marketing targets and identify and monitor KPIs to stay on the ball.
  • Medium: Adjust your content to match your publishing medium.
  • Clarity: Stay focused and make your writing persuasive.
  • Stories: Tell stories to draw your readership in.
  • Visuals: Use infographics, photographs and illustrations to reach your visitors.
  • Curiosity: Stay curious about your customers — and modify your marketing methods if your base changes.
How-to-Communicate-Effectively

Want to improve your website with top-notch marketing content? Make Crowd Content your go-to provider for engaging blog posts, enticing product descriptions and excellent advertorials.

ALSO – How to Create Original Content and Why It’s More Important Than Ever

The post What Are the Principles of Communication? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/principles-of-communication/feed/ 0
What is Active Voice in Writing? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-active-voice-in-writing/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-active-voice-in-writing/#respond Thu, 10 Dec 2020 20:00:21 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29617 What is active voice in writing? What is passive voice? More importantly, why should you care? The cat ate food. The food was eaten by the cat. First impressions: which sentence flows best? Which sentence do you like the most? The first sentence uses active voice, while the second uses passive voice. In this guide, […]

The post What is Active Voice in Writing? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What is active voice in writing? What is passive voice? More importantly, why should you care?

The cat ate food.

The food was eaten by the cat.

First impressions: which sentence flows best? Which sentence do you like the most? The first sentence uses active voice, while the second uses passive voice.

In this guide, we’ll dive into the dynamics of active vs. passive voice. Then, we’ll explore exactly why most content writing platforms recommend the former over the latter.

Let’s get to it.

What is Passive Voice in Writing?

Passive voice is the literary equivalent of a limp noodle. In a passive sentence, the subject of the sentence — the person, animal, inanimate object etc. — is acted upon by the verb.

🚧Passive Sentence Construction in a Nutshell

To construct a passive sentence, you need:

  • A subject (Sarah)
  • An object (the chicken coop)
  • A conjugated version of “to be” (was)
  • Your verb’s past participle (was cleaned vs. cleaned, for example)

Nearly all passive sentences also include a preposition (byafter or since, for instance).

The chicken coop was cleaned by Sarah.

That sentence reads like a cobblestone street, doesn’t it. You feel yourself stumbling over the various parts of speech. Not so good from a content writing perspective.

Let’s break our previous sentence down:

The chicken coop (object) was (conjugated form of “to be”) cleaned (past tense verb) by (preposition) Sarah (subject).

Passive-Sentence-Construction-in-a-Nutshell

More Passive Sentence Examples

The car was covered in rust.

Directions will be given to you by the organizer.

A dozen cupcakes were baked by mom.

The kittens were hidden by the mother cat.

What is Active Voice in Writing?

Active voice brings your story to life. Forget overcooked pasta: active voice is a dish made from hatch chili peppers and sun-ripened tomatoes. In an active sentence, the subject acts autonomously.

🚧Active Sentence Construction in a Nutshell

To construct an active sentence, you need:

  • A subject (Sarah)
  • An object (the chicken coop)
  • A verb (cleans)

You’ll find the subject right at the beginning of an active sentence — ahead of the verb.

Sarah cleans the chicken coop.

Active-Sentence-Construction-in-a-Nutshell

That sentence is much shorter — and it goes straight to the point. It’s much easier to digest. You lose the preposition (by) and gain a smoother reading experience.

Now let’s pull our active sentence apart:

Sarah (subject) cleans (verb) the chicken coop (object).

More Active Sentence Examples

Rust covered the car.

The organizer will give you directions.

Mom baked a dozen cupcakes.

The mother cat hid her kittens.

Why Should I Avoid Passive Voice?

What if other people use passive voice? Is it ever okay to use passive voice in content marketing?

In short, not really.

One of the biggest problems with passive voice is its lack of immediacy. Successful marketing content uses an engaging tone to draw the reader in, and passive voice just isn’t very engaging.

Disengaged readers leave websites very quickly. You can optimize your content to reduce your bounce rate and hold reader attention. That’s where active voice comes in.

Why is Active Voice Important?

People (your audience) end up on your site because they’re on a quest for answers. They’re not looking for anything complex: they just want to know about your product or service.

Here are three more reasons why active voice is a vital part of content marketing:

It’s Much Easier to Read

Active voice is much easier to read than passive voice. Website content in active voice flows easily and feels more natural.

Active voice: Our family saw the June 2020 lunar eclipse.

Passive voice: The lunar eclipse in June 2020 was seen by our family.

Passive voice is clunky. Imagine how exhausting it would be to read an entire page full of content like that.

It’s More Concise

If you’re writing marketing content, less is more. You need to get to the point — and you need to get there quickly. The end goal is to get people to go down your sales funnel, and you won’t get there if you choose passive sentence construction.

Active voice: The Earth’s shadow covered the moon.

Passive voice: The moon was covered by the shadow of the Earth.

There are six words in the active sentence, and ten in the passive sentence. That’s almost double the amount of text.

In short, active voice can help you cut your page content in half, volume wise, and still make the grade.

It Conveys Authority

To turn visitors into customers (and hopefully into repeat customers), you need to create a feeling of authority on your site. Punchy content written in the active voice can help you get there.

Ultimately, active content speaks directly to the reader. Active voice takes responsibility — it’s credible, straightforward and efficient.

Active voice: We ship all orders within 24 hours, and we fully guarantee our products for two years.

Passive voice: All orders are shipped within 24 hours and products are fully guaranteed for two years.

why-active-voice-is-a-vital-part-of-content-marketing

Which version of the statement sounds more believable to you? Which one sounds more immediate? Which one sounds less pretentious? Active voice is convincing; passive voice creates a barrier between you and your customer.

Winding Up

Passive voice is noncommittal. It skirts every issue, it feels indecisive and it looks clumsy on the page. In contrast, active voice takes control, conveys authority and reads smoothly. The winner for web content? Active voice — hands down.

ALSO – The Complete Guide to Using Formal Titles in AP Style

The post What is Active Voice in Writing? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-active-voice-in-writing/feed/ 0
How Using Message Maps Can Boost Your Content Creation https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/message-maps/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/message-maps/#respond Thu, 03 Dec 2020 19:00:24 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29584 Sales letters, retargeting ads and email campaigns — let’s face it, businesses generate a lot of content to drive customers toward a specific action. But, when so many threads of communication are unspooling, there’s a risk messages are getting tangled along the way. Make sure your content hits the right targets by using message maps […]

The post How Using Message Maps Can Boost Your Content Creation appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Sales letters, retargeting ads and email campaigns — let’s face it, businesses generate a lot of content to drive customers toward a specific action. But, when so many threads of communication are unspooling, there’s a risk messages are getting tangled along the way. Make sure your content hits the right targets by using message maps as your guide.

A message map is a content creation tool that distills all the great things about your brand into bite-sized selling points. It’s used as a framework when crafting content to ensure your company’s core message always shines through.

What is a Message Map?

Ian Kelly, VP of Operations at wellness brand NuLeaf Naturals, describes message maps as the “lifeblood” of their product launch campaigns. “Message maps help in having a clear cut understanding of what a piece of content should revolve around,” he says.

Ian-Kelly-NuLeaf-Quote

A message map clarifies your brand’s unique selling points based on target audience. It’s built on:

  • One core message
  • Three related themes
  • Three supporting examples for each theme

Your message map template might look something like this:

  • Core Message or Headline
  • Key Theme #1
  • Key Theme #2
  • Key Theme #3
  • Supporting information
  • Supporting information
  • Supporting information
  • Supporting information
  • Supporting information
  • Supporting information
  • Supporting information
  • Supporting information
  • Supporting information

Remember to Keep Your Message Map Brief

A message map should be concise enough so the main points are understood immediately. There’s no need for long explanations — if you can’t synthesize your essential message into a few words, your core message is too diluted.

Gintaras Steponkus, SEO Expert at Solid Guides, designs message maps using a principle of crisis communication. “You need to follow the 3-3-30 rule of Chandler for effective message mapping,” he explains. “Three points with three short sentences and content, not more than 30 words.”

Gintaras-Steponkus-Quote

Need an example? Have a look at the real-life message map used by the marketing department of Northwest College.

5 Reasons Message Maps Are Important to Your Success

Your messaging influences how customers perceive your company, so make sure it’s consistent and repeated to best inspire a positive response. Each piece of copy should be focused on your core message, and all content should work together as a whole to create your brand.

Here’s how a message map keeps your ultimate goal in focus.

1. Reminds You Why You’re Creating Content

Content can be engaging and well-written, but if it strays too far from a company’s essential message, it’s not doing its job.

“Many times, writers, in their pursuit of being creative, tend to not stress on the main USP of a product,” says Kelly. “The message map is a great reminder to root every content to its core message.”

2. Ensures Content is Consistent

When you’ve got multiple people collaborating, whether in one department or across units, a cohesive message can be hard to deliver. A message map ensures content is consistent, which is especially critical when you have a team of content creators.

“Different writers end up focusing on slightly different aspects. This can weaken the campaign and reduce conversion levels,” Kelly says.

3. Sharpens Your Messaging

Carl Neumann, founder and CEO of Blu Dot Media, finds that a message map helps ensure their content is always on-point.

“We have to craft ideal messages that can start conversations with prospects, as well as the right follow-up messages to convert those conversations into business opportunities,” he explains. “This has empowered our marketing and sales teams to communicate much more effectively, by conveying the right benefits to the right target audience.”

4. Drives Your Content

Content becomes much easier to create with a message map leading the way. Whether a writer is putting together a sales script, article or product demo, the map provides the foundation of the content. The rest of the story should easily fall into place around these essential building blocks.

5. Puts Your Content to Work For You

When your content represents your brand, it’s easier for customers to understand why they should do business with you. This can translate into your ultimate goal: customer engagement and sales.

Blu Dot Media has seen first-hand how well-executed message maps can help a brand persuade customers to take action. “Since we started using message maps, the response rate of our lead generation campaigns has gone up by 31% on average. And, the conversion rate went up by 51%,” says Neumann.

How to Create a Message Map

You can create message maps for product launches, marketing campaigns and your overall brand.

1. Determine Your Audience

Start the process by defining your target audience. Depending on your business, you may have several audiences. You might find developing buyer personas helpful.

Neumann suggests being as detailed as possible in defining your target audience. “This is critical, because you can then put yourself in their shoes, and describe the benefits they can get from you,” he explains.

2. Identify Messages for Each Audience

Think about what’s important to your audience and why your company or product can solve their problems. Use this to inform your three key themes.

“If you have a wide variety of audience, segment them into separate groups and understand each of their pain points and goals,” suggests Kelly. “This intel will help you craft important talking points.”

3. Map Message to Audience

As you move further into the message map, use examples, case studies and stats to support your argument. Draw out different threads to highlight in your content depending on the audience you’re targeting.

If you’re trying to attract new customers or raise awareness, for example, you might start at the top of the message map with the core theme. As customers proceed further into the shopping journey, call out more detailed features to help them make their purchasing decision.

How-to-Create-a-Message-Map

Create Effective Content With Message Maps

Use a message map to ensure the content you create is driving your audience to take action. It takes time to develop a thorough message map, but once it’s in place, content creation is much more streamlined and effective. To learn more about how Crowd Content can deliver professional content for your business, contact us today.

ALSO – What Is Evergreen Content and Why Do You Need It?

The post How Using Message Maps Can Boost Your Content Creation appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/message-maps/feed/ 0
Sales Funnel Magic: Supercharge Your Advertorials https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/writing-advertorials/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/writing-advertorials/#respond Tue, 24 Nov 2020 18:30:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29542 What is an advertorial? To answer that question properly, we have to learn more about the ancient art of storytelling. Everyone loves a good yarn. For thousands of years before the internet, traveling storytellers spread news, illuminating urban and rural communities by firelight. People waited excitedly for them to arrive, and then huddled together to […]

The post Sales Funnel Magic: Supercharge Your Advertorials appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What is an advertorial? To answer that question properly, we have to learn more about the ancient art of storytelling.

Everyone loves a good yarn. For thousands of years before the internet, traveling storytellers spread news, illuminating urban and rural communities by firelight. People waited excitedly for them to arrive, and then huddled together to learn about the wider world.

Advertorials draw on the same storytelling magic to tell consumers about a product or service. They tug at the curious inner child in each of us, beckoning us closer and then whispering into our ears. In short, advertorials are modern tales from outside the town walls.

In this guide, we’re going to tell you exactly how skilled copywriters use human instinct to weave magic into their native ads. Ready? Let’s begin.

What is an Advertorial?

Advertorials are native ads that use editorial content — articles and blog posts — to sell products or services. They disguise themselves to match their surroundings, and draw readers in with the promise of information. By the time they’re done reading, site visitors feel well-informed, excited about the product or service, and ready to make a purchase.

Matt-Scott-Advertorial-Quote

“What is an advertorial? Advertorials, or ads published in the form of editorials or documents, enable advertisers to communicate credibly alongside trustworthy material from publishers.” Matt Scott, owner, Termite Survey.

The best stories have a message buried within them, and essentially, that’s how advertorials work. They take readers on a “hero’s journey” and turn products into protagonists.

How to Write a Breakthrough Advertorial

Simply put, advertorials are marketing chameleons. They blend in with their surroundings and deliver messages on the down low. You can write compelling native ads in just six steps — and we’re about to show you how.

Find Your Voice

Before you begin to create an advertorial, you need to find the right disguise. To do this, read through the rest of your content. Your advertorial must sound like your brand voice: if it doesn’t, consumers will notice the difference immediately and move on.

Some publishers use levity (The New Yorker), while others stick to the facts (The Economist). Effective advertorials sound exactly like the rest of the content on their host sites, so readers don’t know they’re reading ads at all. What is an advertorial? Your readers need never find out.

Writing-Advertorials

Good native ads read like any other piece of content your audience might expect from you. They should deliver similar value despite also nudging people towards a purchase.

Choose a Format

To keep customers on the hook, make sure you use a format they’re familiar with. If they enjoy reading how-to guides, create a guide-based advertorial; if they prefer a question-and-answer format, include a Q and A section. If you get a strong consumer response to Facebook ads, make a social media-centric advertorial part of your marketing plan.

Whatever you do, don’t include fluff. Your advertorial must be based on real, helpful information rather than hot air.

Write a Great Headline

Headlines are everything in marketing, so make your advertorial header as irresistible as possible. You can write your headline after you finish creating your advertorial, or you can write it in advance to give yourself an inspiration boost. Whatever you do, make sure your advertorial headline matches your brand voice.

If you’re stuck, try headline analysis on for size. Tools like CoSchedule help marketers come up with potent headers for free.

Don’t forget meta information: Include a meta title and a meta description to create a good first impression and improve your Google ranking.

Tell Your Story

Throw away that over-hyped sales pitch and forget about QVC: advertorials are not the place for hard sales tactics. Native ads use a far softer approach: engaging narrative. To write a really stellar advertorial, you have to channel that traveling storyteller we spoke about earlier.

Ian-Kelly-Advertorials-Quote

“Advertorials are not salesy ads — they are great stories that provide value.” Ian Kelly, VP, NuLeaf

Think about your favorite story. Why do you enjoy it so much? The answer probably has to do with emotion. As you write your advertorial, don’t be scared to use feelings like amusement, fear, anger, frustration and surprise to your advantage.

Think about what makes your reader tick: are they likely to respond to humor or do they favor outrage? Are they driven by excitement, or do they prefer a quiet life?

A Word About Customers: If you haven’t yet done so, create a customer profile for your company (or a buyer persona for your product). Advertorials are far easier to write when you “know” your audience.

Provide Value

To build credibility with your target audience, you have to promote the human impact of your product or service. Focus on benefits rather than features.

David-Morneau-80_20-Rule-Quote

“The rule of thumb is that an effective advertorial should have 80% of valuable content and 20% product promotion.” David Morneau, co-founder, inBeat

If you’re not sure about what you’ve written, try removing all mentions of your brand name from the content. Is it still helpful? Does your story stay intact? If your native ad revolves only around a sales pitch, it needs a little more work.

Close with a CTA

Always close your advertorial with a call to action. Great headlines draw readers into an article; great CTAs encourage them to learn more about a product — or to make a purchase. Some CTAs invite readers to visit product pages, while others push consumers into sales funnels with special offers.

Robust CTAs create urgency and inspire confidence by restating a product’s value. Here are a few CTA examples to get you started:

“Sign up now to get 10% off your first order!”

“Feel more energetic in just two weeks with X Wonder Supplement — 15% off for the next 15 minutes!”

“Get your free guide to X today with our super bonus special offer!”

If someone has taken the time to read to the end of your advertorial, chances are they’re engaged. That CTA could help them make a purchase decision right away.

Where to Promote Your Advertorial

So, you’ve crafted a perfect advertorial that leans on human emotion and compels readers to buy. Great!

What next?

You need to get it in front of your target audience in a way that looks natural to them. For instance, if your advertorial looks like an article, promote it where your readers are seeing articles.

Here are some great channels to promote your advertorials in:

1. Facebook / Instagram

Facebook offers great advertising tools for targeting very specific audiences. Be sure to create a post on Facebook containing your advertorial and then pay to promote it to your target audience.

2. Twitter

Similar to Facebook, Twitter lets you promote your tweets to well-defined audiences. Take some time to define your audience in their platform. Then, craft enticing tweets that you can promote to get eyeballs on your advertorial.

3. Content Promotion Networks

Services like Outbrain and Taboola let you pay to have your articles featured on major websites while making the content look like native articles. This is powerful and you should definitely explore this channel.

4. Reddit

Reddit is notorious for users suspicious of advertisements. But, their targeting tools are powerful and let you reach members of very specific sub-Reddits. Paying to promote your advertorial to these audiences can pay huge dividends. Because it looks like native content, you’re more likely to get good engagement.

5. Quora

Another smaller but powerful channel is Quora. It lets you advertise to specific themes and questions that have already been answered on its site. Take some time to explore some important questions related to your advertorial and then promote your content on the question page. People visiting this question page clearly need the info your advertorial provides.

You might even post your advertorial right on Quora’s question page, but you have to be tactful when doing this.

Content-Promotion-Checklist

In Conclusion

What is an advertorial? In a nutshell, it’s a rich story that blends valuable information with product promotion. Some advertorials are long, while others are short: regardless, all of them provide value and end with a strong call to action.

The best native advertising builds a connection between a brand and its consumer base. You can use the six steps in this guide to create advertorials that drive up your AOV and create lasting relationships with customers, too.

ALSO – Is Long-Form Content the Way to Go?

The post Sales Funnel Magic: Supercharge Your Advertorials appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/writing-advertorials/feed/ 0
The Complete Guide to Using Formal Titles in AP Style https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/formal-titles-in-ap-style/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/formal-titles-in-ap-style/#respond Thu, 12 Nov 2020 18:30:22 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29494 Learning to write is a lot like learning to drive. You have to internalize many rules, some of which seem arbitrary or hard to remember. Formal titles, for example, are like left turns at large intersections: they’re tricky, but you need to get them right or you risk embarrassment. If you accidentally leave a formal […]

The post The Complete Guide to Using Formal Titles in AP Style appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Learning to write is a lot like learning to drive. You have to internalize many rules, some of which seem arbitrary or hard to remember. Formal titles, for example, are like left turns at large intersections: they’re tricky, but you need to get them right or you risk embarrassment. If you accidentally leave a formal title lowercase, you might offend someone. If you capitalize an occupational title by mistake, you end up looking like a novice.

Bewildering? At first, sure — but prep and practice makes perfect. Let’s dive into what the Associated Press (AP) Stylebook has to say about formal titles.

ALSOFind Great Freelance Writing Jobs

Occupational Titles vs. Formal Titles: What’s the Difference?

Capitalization has absolutely nothing to do with the importance of someone’s job. Astronauts, dentists, farmers and athletes all make vital contributions to society, but you don’t capitalize occupational descriptions because they’re not formal titles.

Here are some examples:

  • Legendary athlete Jesse Owens won four gold medals at the 1936 Olympic games.
  • Russian astronaut Valentina Tereshkova flew a solo space mission in 1963.
  • Erstwhile dentist Doc Holliday first met Wyatt Earp in 1878.
Copy-of-AP-Stylebook-Title-Guidelines-1

So, what are formal titles? Simply put, they’re titles given to specific people with formal authority. Government officials, people in the military, royal family members and religious leaders all have formal titles. So do doctors, lawyers and certain other academic professionals.

Interestingly, the AP Stylebook doesn’t recognize professor as a formal title. It does, however, define Professor Emeritus as a formal title. Go figure.

Here’s an example:

  • Archeology professor Indiana Jones had a phobia of snakes.

If you get stuck on whether to capitalize, refer to a title’s issuing authority (also known as its conferring institution).

Always Capitalize Formal Titles Before Names

When a formal title comes directly before someone’s name, always capitalize it, like these examples:

  • Chancellor Angela Merkel’s favorite foods include Hungarian vegetable stew.
  • President Emmanuel Macron is the youngest French head of state since Napoleon.
  • Vice President Dan Quayle met journalist Sam Donaldson for an interview.

If the formal title stands by itself, or if commas separate the title and the titleholder, capitalization isn’t necessary as these examples show:

  • The current Italian president, Sergio Mattarella, was born in Palermo in 1941.
  • The general walked quickly away from the gathering crowd.

You can use the same formal title rules for people who don’t permanently hold positions of authority — but don’t capitalize any adjectives that describe the formal title’s status.

Here are some examples:

  • Bolivian cocalero activist and former President Evo Morales left office in November 2019.
  • A former presidential hopeful, retired Gen. Wesley Clark now sits on the Atlantic Council’s board of directors.

Formal Titles and Commas

If you’re still not sure if you should capitalize someone’s title, a comma (or commas) can save your bacon. Simply use a comma sentence construction and separate the person from their title, like these examples:

  • Paul Greenwood, principal of Lakeside Elementary, still hadn’t answered Jane’s email.
  • The accident happened when Sheila Gibson, biology professor at Kirk College, spun out of control.

If you need to write about a person with a unique title, put a comma after the individual’s name and begin the title with “the,” like these examples:

  • Marie Nelson, the marketing coach, made history on Tuesday.
  • Forty-five-year-old Gerard Wilson, the deputy sheriff of Pearlview, began to speak.

Occasionally, you’ll probably have to deal with an extra-long and convoluted title. Commas make rambling monikers easier to read. For example:

  • Henry Rogers, acting head of general services and recruitment, made his views clear.
  • Slurring his words, Chuck Penderghast, interim vice president of ecommerce marketing, took to the podium.

When to Abbreviate Formal Titles

AP Stylebook guidelines generally recommend spelling out all formal titles. There are a few notable exceptions to this rule, though. They include:

  • Governor becomes Gov.
  • Lieutenant Governor becomes Lt. Gov.
  • Doctor becomes Dr.
  • Senator becomes Sen.
  • Representative becomes Rep.
AP-Stylebook-Title-Guidelines

Military AP style titles follow similar rules, like this:

  • Major becomes Maj.
  • Captain becomes Capt.
  • First Lieutenant becomes 1st Lt.
  • Second Lieutenant becomes 2nd lt.
  • General becomes Gen.
  • Lieutenant General becomes Lt. Gen.
  • Major General becomes Maj. Gen.
  • Brigadier General becomes Brig. Gen.
  • Colonel becomes Col.
  • Lieutenant Colonel becomes Lt. Col.

The second time you refer to the titled person (and going forward), refer to the individual by their last name only.

Interestingly, rules vary for enlisted military personnel. Sergeant Major of the Army, for example, gets abbreviated to Sgt. maj. of the Army. Conversely, Master Chief Petty Officer of the Navy doesn’t get abbreviated. If you get in a muddle, check out the AP Stylebook Military Titles section.

Title-Related Things to Remember

AP rules on things like the inclusion of “U.S.” in advance of a title vary depending on where you intend to publish your story. If you’re running your article in America, you can safely leave U.S. off the beginning of a formal title — unless it causes confusion. One example might be this:

  • U.S. President Obama spoke to Ford Motor Company President Mark Fields on the phone.

If you plan to run your editorial in Europe, make sure you do attach U.S., like this example:

  • U.S. Vice President Mike Pence attended a formal dinner on Saturday evening.

Lastly, noble titles sometimes quite often get used without any other accompanying names. Here’s an example:

  • The Duke and Duchess of Sussex had lunch with Queen Elizabeth last Monday.

Why Understanding AP Style Titles Is Important

Style guides are important because they help keep a brand’s content consistent no matter how much they produce. And, it guides all their writers to format their content consistently.

Any organization that wants to scale their content creation needs to follow a style guide.

And, the AP Stylebook is the de facto standard among digital marketers. Even if clients don’t specify they want you to follow AP Style, they probably expect you will.

AP-Title-Styles

Other Style Guides

It’s important to note that the rules we’ve outlined here apply only to AP Style. Be sure to review the rules for the style guide you need to follow for each assignment.

Other common style guides include:

  • Modern Language Association (MLA) – mostly used in academic writing, occasionally clients may opt to use this in their orders.
  • Chicago Manual of Style – another style guide mostly focused on academic writing. Similarly, it may come up in client requests from time to time.
  • The Elements of Style – designed to complement the AP Stylebook, this is a condensed guide that is helpful for beginners or quick reference.
  • The New York Times Manual of Style and Usage – as its name implies, this is a guide published by The New York Times. It’s widely used amongst journalists and clients looking for journalistic style content may reference it.
  • The BuzzFeed Style Guide – a more recent entry to this list. This guide is geared towards sites and publishers mostly focused on publishing content on the internet and social media. This is a completely free style guide, whereas others need to be purchased.

Keep in mind that most clients will default to using AP Style, but you might see some of these other guides occasionally.

Some clients also build their own internal style guides, especially if they produce large volumes of content. Often these will refer to a major guide (like AP) but highlight unique differences they want followed.

The Wrap – Why AP Style Titles Are Important

If you don’t write formal titles properly in AP style, no decent publisher will take you seriously. Don’t let that freak you out, though — the capitalization rules aren’t hard to learn. If you’re unsure about a title, consult the AP Stylebook for advice, and if you’re still unsure, use commas to separate a person from their title. With a little practice, you’ll soon be a formal title expert.

ALSOHow to Become a Content Writer – The Complete Guide

The post The Complete Guide to Using Formal Titles in AP Style appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/formal-titles-in-ap-style/feed/ 0
How to Optimize Product Listings With an Amazon SEO Strategy https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/amazon-seo-strategy/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/amazon-seo-strategy/#respond Thu, 29 Oct 2020 18:00:24 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29392 Amazon can be a highly lucrative marketplace — as long as customers can find your products among its massive inventories. As luck has it, it’s possible to create an impactful Amazon SEO strategy that pulls your listings out of the crowd and puts them in front of an audience. You just need to understand how […]

The post How to Optimize Product Listings With an Amazon SEO Strategy appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Amazon can be a highly lucrative marketplace — as long as customers can find your products among its massive inventories. As luck has it, it’s possible to create an impactful Amazon SEO strategy that pulls your listings out of the crowd and puts them in front of an audience. You just need to understand how the platform’s algorithm approaches rankings. By aligning your product descriptions with Amazon’s goals, you can boost your visibility and even persuade audiences that they need your products.

8749d18e-68f9-180b-1e2a-09e377f99402

What’s Amazon’s A9 Algorithm All About?

Amazon’s A9 algorithm is always working hard behind the scenes, analyzing product listings and determining where they should appear in search results. You might hear the algorithm referred to as Amazon A10, as there have been updates. But no matter what you call it, the system’s ultimate goal is to keep consumers happy by matching them to the products they’re most likely to buy.

Indexing

The first step in any Amazon SEO strategy is to ensure your listing is properly indexed. Amazon organizes listings by keywords so it can serve up relevant items when users perform a search. 

Invest time in comprehensive keyword research to learn which phrases customers use to find your product and include those search terms in your copy. We delve into some Amazon keyword tips later in the article.  

Organic ranking

Organic ranking refers to where you’re placed in any given Amazon search as a result of the algorithm. The system considers factors such as keywords, sales, conversion rates, customer reviews, pricing, and availability. It also leverages artificial intelligence to recommend products based on behavior and browsing history, with machine learning improving results over time.

**Also, https://twitter.com/HimanshiRaj5721/status/1716514138262839781

A strong product page with an engaging product description is critical to gaining traction in the rankings. The more people who are swayed by your listing and buy your product after doing a specific search, the higher your organic ranking for that keyword.

“Satisfy the consumer by providing a great digital shelf experience, top to bottom,” explained Mike Black, CMO of Profitero. “This means maximizing product availability, traffic, and conversion.”

Having a compelling product page with product descriptions that engage is critical to ranking organically on Amazon. Click to Tweet

Best seller ranking (BSR)

Amazon also highlights top-selling products for specific search terms to help boost sales. This is a form of social proof — if you see thousands of other customers snatching up a certain product, you’ll probably take a closer look at the item. 

You only appear in BSR results based on your sales, which is another reason to invest time in creating killer product descriptions that help convert. While your overall sales numbers are considered, recent transactions carry more weight — and sales from organic searches carry more weight than those generated through paid ads. Note that page views and reviews aren’t included in BSR rankings — this ranking is all about successful purchases.

Researching Amazon Keywords

Most Amazon journeys start with a search, so let’s make sure your listing can be discovered. Play detective and dig up the keywords customers type into the search bar.

Keyword research tools are the Watson to your Sherlock, pulling up keyword ideas in seconds. Some platforms, such as SECockpit, draw suggestions from a variety of search engines, including Amazon, and can be useful for a broader digital marketing strategy. You can also use Amazon-specific tools, such as Semrush’s Instant Keyword Research for Amazon or AMZScout.

For example, to get insight into the keywords other products are targeting, head over to AMZScout’s Reverse ASIN lookup tool. Enter the product’s 10-digit Amazon Standard Identification Number (ASIN). The tool will serve up a list of indexed search terms for that product, along with the search volume and relevance score.

You can also research popular keywords for your niche using another AMZScout tool, Amazon Keyword Search. For example, if you’re selling books on Amazon, plug in “books for kids” to find relevant keywords and monthly search volumes:

e8f45924-7aef-67f0-82e0-bc215f9c694f

Finally, AMZScout’s Keyword Tracker helps you monitor how your listings and competing listings rank for certain keywords. This helps you track your performance and focus on improving listings that are missing the mark.

Amazon keyword tips

During your keyword research, you’ll run across short-tail and long-tail keywords:

  • A short-tail keyword is a broad search term consisting of a single word or a few words, such as “ice pack”
  • A long-tail keyword is more than a few words long and has precise search intent, such as “ice pack for injuries”

Use a mix of short- and long-tail keywords so your product is indexed for both types of searches. Relevant long-tail keywords are used less often by searchers, but they can sometimes be easier to rank for, and they can help you attract buyers with a clear idea of the type of item they want. 

A well-established product on Amazon can be ranked with thousands or even tens of thousands of keywords. Because you have limited space in your listing, you can’t be expected to include every possible search term. Pick the keywords most relevant to your product and those with a reasonable monthly search volume to generate traffic. Use a higher volume keyword as your primary keyword and include it in the all-important product title. Place secondary keywords in your listing copy.

Product Listing Optimization

SEO for Amazon is only partly about the algorithm. Customers aren’t interested in keywords, but they do want to know whether a product suits their needs. Help them make their decision with a rich product listing that’s lively, descriptive, informative, and crafted for human readers.

If you can craft a strong, compelling product listing, it won’t take long for users to be drawn to the magic “add to cart” button. Nearly 30% of Amazon purchases are completed in 3 minutes or less.

Product title

The product title is one of the main ways Amazon determines the relevance of your product for indexing. When you write your title, include your most important high-search-volume keywords, and ensure they’re arranged in a somewhat understandable order. Most Amazon product titles don’t really make sense in terms of syntax or grammar, but they effortlessly convey what the product is.

Although you can write longer titles, Amazon recommends 60 to 80 characters — after that, they can be difficult to read. Avoid writing in all caps, abbreviate measurements, and use numerals instead of writing out numbers.

Bullet points

Bullet points give readers a quick overview of key product features. You can include up to five bullet points totaling 1,000 characters. This provides ample room to naturally fit keywords, but remember to strike a balance and make sure the copy is inviting.

Write a short phrase summarizing each feature at the start of the bullet using capital letters, lines, or brackets to draw attention to them. Follow this with a sentence or two providing detail or elaborating on the benefit.  

e88c826b-87cd-3261-4c56-b8460086bb96

Product description

The product description is the spot for additional details that aren’t included in your bullets but are important for the customer to know. It could be a list of product specs or aspirational copy that persuades a customer their life isn’t complete without your item. A well-crafted product description can help drive sales, which boosts your organic ranking in the long run. 

The product description is limited to 2,000 characters and must be written in HTML. You can enter all your markup manually with tags for bold, bullets, and paragraphs, or you can paste your copy into a free online text to HTML translator.

Optimized sizing charts

One of the biggest challenges for online consumers is determining whether the clothing or shoes they’re eyeing will fit. Fortunately, Amazon is always looking for ways to make it easier for customers to shop.

In early 2024, the marketplace announced it’s leveraging AI and machine learning to provide personalized sizing guidance to customers. By analyzing brand size charts, reviews, purchases, and returns, the marketplace can now recommend the best-fitting size for a particular customer.

Sellers can benefit by using Amazon’s new Fit Insights Tool to improve product listings. Available through the Seller Central dashboard, this tool provides:

  • Feedback on your size charts based on customer expectations
  • Analysis of your product return rate compared to similar products
  • A summary of customer insights, both positive and negative

You can use this information to see which of your listings need improvement and better address customer concerns. This can enhance user experience, reduce your product return rate, and lift your overall sales.

Backend keywords

At this point, you should have search terms from your keyword research that you haven’t used — after all, your product listing should be sleek and engaging and not stuffed with keywords. These additional search terms might include abbreviations, spelling variations, and alternate product names. You can input these keywords into the backend for indexing purposes. The backend is only for the algorithm and isn’t visible to readers.

Previously, backend keywords were limited to 250 bytes of text. In 2024, Amazon increased backend keywords to 500 characters, giving you more space to highlight keywords. There’s no need to worry about grammar or punctuation. Simply copy in keywords you weren’t able to include in the rest of the listing.

Maximizing Your Amazon SEO Strategy

We’ve covered the basic elements of an effective listing, but with so much competition for customers, every advantage helps. Ramp up your efforts and explore additional Amazon SEO tips below to maximize your online presence. 

Provide great visuals

Visuals help customers get a better sense of your product. Amazon recommends including six images and one video in a listing to fully leverage the media. Show the item from different angles, provide close-ups of details or features, and wrap up with some images of happy customers using the product.

Make sure photos are well-lit and clearly focused on the product. Backgrounds should be simple or plain white so they don’t distract from the item. Use descriptive image file names and alt-text to help Amazon and Google understand and index the page.

Leverage A+ content

Some sellers and vendors have access to A+ Content, previously known as Enhanced Brand Content. Use this Amazon tool to create rich and visually appealing listings. You can provide in-depth content or charts to engage users, upload photos to play with mood and tone, and edit layout. This customization can elevate your product, setting it apart from regular listings and increasing sales by up to 8%.

Encourage reviews

Follow up with your customers and encourage them to leave reviews to help build credibility and establish your seller authority. Respond to reviews and work to resolve problems so customers are assured that your business is trustworthy and you deliver quality service.

Use your brand name

It might seem counterintuitive to include a brand name in your listing if your business isn’t well known. However, it’s good practice to include it at the beginning of your title. You’ll avoid a situation where someone searches for your product by brand name but can’t find it — or worse, finds competing listings instead.

Don’t forget about Google

So far, our focus has been on optimizing your listings for Amazon’s search engine, but let’s not forget the other internet giant. Google crawls the Amazon website as if it’s any other site. Follow SEO best practices for high-quality content to help your product listings gain exposure on Google and send more traffic to your Amazon pages.

  1. Perform keyword research, although most of the search terms you’ll dig up are likely similar to Amazon’s
  2. Place keywords prominently in the page title, bulleted list, and image alt-text
  3. Evaluate the top-ranking pages for the Google search terms you want to rank for and make sure your listing is better

Drive Results on Amazon With Optimized Product Descriptions

If you sell products on Amazon, a well-crafted product listing — fueled by the right keywords — helps your brand shine and gives users the confidence to purchase. To make an impact, your listings should be visually appealing, informative, and aligned with the customer’s needs. Learn how Crowd Content’s product description writers can bring your Amazon SEO strategy to life, creating exceptional copy that impresses your reader and helping you crush your sales goals.

The post How to Optimize Product Listings With an Amazon SEO Strategy appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/amazon-seo-strategy/feed/ 0
Tips for Creating Original Content to Grow Your Audience https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/how-to-create-original-content/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/how-to-create-original-content/#respond Thu, 15 Oct 2020 18:30:37 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29272 How to Create Original Content and Why It’s More Important Than Ever With so much information available online, it’s easy to get overwhelmed, especially if what you see isn’t useful or relevant to your needs. That’s where content marketing comes into play. Content marketing is the process of creating and publishing original content that helps […]

The post Tips for Creating Original Content to Grow Your Audience appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How to Create Original Content and Why It’s More Important Than Ever

With so much information available online, it’s easy to get overwhelmed, especially if what you see isn’t useful or relevant to your needs. That’s where content marketing comes into play.

Content marketing is the process of creating and publishing original content that helps people in your target audience solve problems or learn more about the topics that interest them. Done right, content marketing can help you stand out from the crowd and attract more customers to your business.

But what is original content? And how do you create content that appeals to members of your target audience? We put together this guide to help you understand the importance of content marketing and learn how to develop content that gets results.

What Is Original Content?

Original content is content that’s never been published before. “Never published” doesn’t mean you took a piece of existing content, rewrote it in your own words and published it on your website. It means the content contains new ideas. 

Audience members are smarter than ever. They know when a company uses the same content over and over again or copies content from other businesses in the same industry. It’s especially obvious when publishers use spinning software or hire inexperienced freelancers to rewrite existing content. In many cases, the spun content is riddled with errors and doesn’t make any sense to a human reader.

If you want to use original content to attract new audience members and retain loyal customers, you need to be strategic. Think about how you can make your content different from what everyone else is publishing. If you achieve the right balance of originality, relevance and usefulness, you’ll be able to grow your brand and set yourself apart from your competitors.

December-January-IG-FB-Posts-1

Types of Original Content

Blog Posts

WordPress.org defines a blog as a website that maintains an “ongoing chronicle of information.” Blog posts are typically displayed in reverse chronological order, ensuring visitors see the newest posts first. When used for marketing purposes, a blog post should relate to your business in some way, whether you publish product reviews, interviews with industry experts or company updates.

White Papers

According to Michael Stelzner, the author of Writing White Papers: How to Capture Readers and Keep Them, a white paper is a persuasive essay that promotes a product, service or viewpoint. A white paper should provide useful information to help the reader make a decision, solve a problem or understand more about a complex issue. This type of original content is often used in business-to-business (B2B) marketing.

Case Studies

Case studies tell a story about a company and its products or services. In marketing, case studies are used to highlight how a company helped one of its customers achieve a goal or solve a problem. Like white papers, case studies are often used for promoting B2B products and services.

Emails

Companies use email marketing to connect with audience members and promote their products, services and events. Each email you send is a piece of original content that can be used to help your business increase customer engagement or reach your sales goals.

Videos

The Content Marketing Institute defines content as “relevant and relatable” information shared with prospects, customers and other stakeholders. Using this definition, videos definitely qualify as a form of original content. Video interviews, tutorials, Q&A sessions and product reviews can all be used to promote your business online.

Podcasts

A podcast is a series of audio episodes focusing on a specific theme or topic. As long as the audio is relevant and relatable, it counts as a form of content for marketing purposes. Podcasts can help you grow your business by making it easier to connect with audience members.

Website Copy

Website copy is text that tells site visitors what they need to know about a company or brand. Every page of your website, from the Home page to the About Us page, has some type of website copy on it. For best results, your website copy should contain multiple calls to action.

Infographics

An infographic is a visual representation of data. In other words, an infographic combines text and images to provide an easy-to-understand overview of a complex topic. Infographics are especially helpful if you’re writing about a technical topic and want to highlight relevant statistics for your audience members.

Social Media Posts

Social media posts are short pieces of content shared on platforms like Facebook, Instagram and Twitter. These posts typically contain text, photos and videos, all of which can be used to engage your audience and help you achieve your marketing goals.

Content Repurposing

Just because your content has to be original doesn’t mean you have to create something new from scratch every day. Content repurposing refers to taking a piece of existing content and turning it into a different type of content. Repurposing saves you time while helping you reap the many benefits of content marketing.

You can repurpose your content in a few different ways.

  • Podcast episodes: Some people love listening to podcasts, but others prefer to read blog posts and reports. If you have a podcast, you can repurpose the content by publishing transcripts or turning the information from each episode into a series of articles or blog posts. You can also record your podcast sessions on video and then publish those videos on YouTube, giving you access to a whole new audience.
  • Blog posts: Just as some people prefer to read, others prefer to listen to podcasts or watch videos. You can repurpose your blog content by turning each post into a short podcast episode or creating a video to add to your website or YouTube channel.
  • Videos: If you’re involved in business-to-business marketing, you can repurpose your videos by turning them into presentation slides with audio narration. 
  • Articles: Repurpose your articles by pulling out interesting facts or statistics and incorporating them into an infographic that can be shared on social media. Another option is to take a series of articles and compile them into an e-book or case study that can be shared with audience members.
December-January-IG-FB-Posts-2

The SEO Benefits of Content Marketing

Search engine optimization is essential for growing your business. If you’re not familiar with the term, search engine optimization—often shortened to “SEO”—is the process of making your site more visible to potential customers. Done right, SEO can help you improve your site’s search engine rankings, making it easier for people to find your business online.

Search engine algorithms consider hundreds of factors when determining how to rank web pages. Many of these factors relate to the quality of the content you publish. 

  • Readability: Your content should be easy for the majority of readers to understand, so Google uses readability as one of the factors it considers when determining how a web page ranks for a specific keyword. You don’t need to write content on par with “See Spot run,” but you should strive to make your writing as accessible as possible for people with different educational backgrounds and life experiences.
  • Length: Content length is another quality signal that can affect your SEO. Top-ranked pages usually have more than 1,000 words of text. If you decide to write long blog posts or articles, make sure you use short paragraphs, bulleted lists, bold text and other formatting elements to make the content easy to read. 
  • Keywords: Keywords are words and phrases that help readers and search engines understand what your content is about. Incorporating keywords into your online content can help you improve your search engine rankings, but don’t get carried away and start inserting keywords into every sentence.

Site Authority

When people visit your website, they want to know they’re reading accurate content written by a real person with some experience on the topic. Original content not only helps you establish your website as an authority in your industry, but it also has a significant impact on your overall rankings in search engines. There are a few ways to increase your site authority with content marketing:

  • Stay focused. Remember that your content needs to be relevant to your target audience. If you visited a recipe website that also had blog posts about shoes, books and quilting, you’d probably wonder if the site’s owner really had any experience with cooking or recipe development. Your content should focus on a single topic or theme to show your expertise.
  • Choose your platforms wisely. Your website isn’t the only place to publish content. If you decide to use other platforms, make sure you choose sites where your audience members are most likely to hang out. It does you no good to publish high-quality content on LinkedIn if most of your audience members spend their time on Instagram and Facebook, for example.
  • Put your audience first. Content is for your audience, not for you. Focus on providing value with every piece of content you publish. You can add value by helping people solve their problems, teaching audience members a new skill or requesting feedback from customers.
  • Keep it consistent. If your opinion changes every time the wind blows, your audience members will have a tough time believing you’re an authority in your industry. When you create new content, try to be as consistent as possible—don’t write one thing on Monday and something completely different on Thursday.
  • Make connections with community members. Ultimately, you want to grow a community of people who love your brand. The best way to do this is to build genuine relationships with audience members. You can do this by answering questions, soliciting feedback and engaging in other forms of interaction.

Building Links

Backlinks are essential for establishing your site’s authority and showing the search engines your content is useful and relevant. In this context, links are like votes. With millions of pages online, the fact that someone would take the time to link to one of your pages shows Google and Bing that you’re publishing valuable information. This is like a “vote” for your page over the thousands of other pages on the same topic.

Backlinking also helps you establish your authority in a specific niche. The more links that point at your web pages, the more opportunities you have to attract new visitors and encourage them to join your community.

Social Signals

According to Google employees, social media usage isn’t one of the factors that go into determining how well a page ranks. But that doesn’t mean you should ignore social media completely. Using Facebook, Instagram, Twitter, LinkedIn and other platforms can help you position your company as an authority in your industry. It may also help you build backlinks and drive more traffic to your site as social media users share your content.

Increased Engagement

When you publish original content that adds value, people are more likely to visit your website, share the content with their contacts and interact with your brand on social media. This creates a domino effect. The more engaged people are, the more they’ll share your content, drawing in new audience members. Here are some tips for creating shareable content:

  • Tell a story. Instead of pushing people to buy your products or focusing on your company’s operations, your content should tell a story. Start out with an introduction that hooks the reader and makes them want to keep reading. Then make the story as relevant as possible to your audience members. 
  • Feature one of your customers. People are more likely to share content if it mentions them by name. To take advantage of this instinct, publish case studies or other materials to highlight what your customers are doing.
  • Incorporate something controversial. Every industry has at least one heated debate raging at any given time. The GIF format was developed in 1987, and people are still arguing over how it’s pronounced. Pick a side and write a blog post or email defending your position—people who agree with you are likely to share the content.
  • Solve a problem. The more useful your content is, the more people are likely to share it. One of the best ways to make your content useful is to tell readers how to solve a problem. For best results, the problem should be something that’s really annoying or would cost a lot of money to fix if they had to hire a professional. If your solution works, the people who benefited from it are likely to share the content with their friends and family members.

Building Thought Leadership

Thought leadership shows people you have a certain level of expertise in a particular industry or topic. Original content can help you build thought leadership by giving you ongoing opportunities to demonstrate your knowledge and skills. This approach has several benefits:

  • Increases credibility
  • Establishes you as a reliable source of information on a topic
  • Inspires people in your audience
  • Encourages people to be innovative
  • Creates opportunities to specialize in a narrow niche

Creating Useful Content

What’s useful to you may not be useful to your audience members. Before you start creating new content, it’s important to connect with people in your audience and find out what they want you to cover. If your business is new and you don’t have an established community, there are a few simple ways to find out what kind of content people want.

Keyword Research

When people search for information online, they use specific words and phrases (keywords) related to their topic of interest. Keyword research tools help you find out exactly what keywords people are using, making it easier to choose a topic for your next blog post or video.

To use one of these tools, you typically enter a broad keyword that relates to your business. For example, someone who runs a shoe company might enter “shoes” as the broad keyword. After you enter a keyword, the software gives you a list of related keywords entered by search engine users. In the shoe example, the software might tell you that people have been searching for “best shoes to wear in cold weather” or “best shoes for hiking on a flat trail.”

Once you know what search terms people are using, you’ll have a better understanding of what kind of information your audience needs.

Forum Posts

Many forums allow users to create anonymous accounts, giving them the freedom they need to discuss sensitive topics and share personal information. These forums are a great source of information for anyone tasked with creating original content. Next time you need ideas, visit Reddit or another forum, enter your topic into the search bar and read through relevant posts to find out what kind of content you can create to provide value.

Social Media

People love to share their opinions on social networks, even if those opinions sometimes ruffle feathers. If you’re in a content rut, take a look at your Twitter feed or scroll through Facebook to see what people are talking about.

Industry Surveys

If you work for a B2B business, industry surveys are a great source of information. Many surveys ask respondents to indicate what problems they’re having or what tools they need to make their jobs easier. You can use the responses to outline white papers, articles, e-books and other types of content.

Q&A Websites

Like forums, Q&A websites can give you valuable insight into what kind of information people need to improve their lives. Users often share a little bit about their background and then ask specific questions about their circumstances. You can use these Q&A posts to create content outlines or come up with ideas for an FAQ page related to your topic.

Top Tips for Creating Original Content

Before you start writing, podcasting or shooting videos, take time to do some research. Your content won’t help you much if it’s outdated or irrelevant to the people in your target audience. First, make sure you understand your audience members. You need to know exactly who they are. Are they men or women? Teenagers or adults nearing retirement age? Wealthy individuals or people who need financial guidance?

Next, research your competitors to find out what they’re doing. It’s extremely important not to copy content from a competitor’s website or follow the exact same marketing plan as your closest competitors. You’re just looking for ideas to help you develop your own content marketing plan. Read through the content and figure out what’s good about it and what could be improved. Think about how you can fill in gaps and add value for your readers.

If you have an established audience, send out a survey or publish a poll on your social media accounts. Ask people what they want to see from you in the coming months.

December-January-IG-FB-Posts-3

Stay Focused

It’s easy to get bogged down with research and trying to figure out exactly how each platform works. Instead of trying to be everywhere at once, pick one platform and stick with it for a while. Experiment with your content to find out what gets the most comments, likes and shares. Do some split testing to see if one approach is more effective than another. Once you have one platform under control, you can move on to the next one and start experimenting there.

Collaborate With Others

Creating content can be a lonely endeavour, but it doesn’t have to be. Reach out to other people in your industry and suggest cohosting a webinar, sharing each other’s content or contributing to a long article. When you collaborate with others, you both benefit, making collaboration a great way to grow your audience.

Wrapping Up

It’s clear that original content is essential for success in today’s business landscape. If you don’t have experience creating and distributing content, the thought of using content marketing to grow your business can be a little daunting. At Crowd Content, we have teams of experienced freelance writers available to create articles, e-books, white papers and other content to help you attract new audience members and position yourself as an authority.

The post Tips for Creating Original Content to Grow Your Audience appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/how-to-create-original-content/feed/ 0
How to Write a Business Case Study https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-write-a-case-study/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-write-a-case-study/#respond Thu, 01 Oct 2020 18:28:17 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29197 When deciding on an important purchase, it’s not just about finding a great product with cool features that make you want to buy it. You also need to see how it fits into your plans and helps you reach your goals. This is where a business case study comes in. Business case studies are unique. […]

The post How to Write a Business Case Study appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
When deciding on an important purchase, it’s not just about finding a great product with cool features that make you want to buy it. You also need to see how it fits into your plans and helps you reach your goals. This is where a business case study comes in.

Business case studies are unique. They exist right at the point where valuable content and compelling social proof overlap. They have the potential to establish trust in a product or company while engaging audiences with a compelling narrative.

But like most endeavors, getting the full value from a case study is easier said than done. Having the ability to tell an engaging story and use data as a narrative device without losing your audience or obscuring the message is key.

ALSO – Hire a freelance writer to help you craft your case study

To help you get started, here’s a guide focused on how to write a case study, including who to talk to, how to approach the format, and what you need to make the final product resonate with your target audience.

Here’s a guide focused on how to write a case study, including who to talk to, how to approach the format, and what you need to make the final product resonate with your target audience. Click to Tweet

What Is a Business Case Study, and What Makes It Powerful?

A business case study is an account (usually written but sometimes visual) of how a business or individual business person benefited from using a particular product, service, or company.

It’s a marketing tool created and deployed on behalf of the company responsible for marketing the product or service. The subject — the business or individual sharing their experience — provides information about their experience to give prospective clients an idea of how they would benefit from using the same product or service.

Case studies are compelling ways to get through to a target audience because they:

  • Back up company claims about a product or service with valuable social proof
  • Inspire consumers to vividly imagine what could be possible for their company if they bought into a specific product or service
  • Provide uniquely valuable insights into how a company solves problems
  • Win trust and reinforce a company’s professional credibility
  • Help generate qualified leads and kickstart valuable customer-brand relationships

What Are the Best Ways to Use Case Studies in Marketing?

Willie Greer, founder of The Product Analyst, says that “82% of marketers use case studies because it gains the trust of your customers when you can show them real numbers and data about your certain topic or field.”

If you can execute a well-crafted business case study, this should be a cornerstone of your content marketing strategy. Case studies can be shown via email, paid promotion, or social media. Because of their value, case studies are often used for gated content, which can be leveraged in pay-per-click campaigns to try to attract more qualified leads.

A strong case study pulls in leads from campaigns while appearing high in Google searches for target keywords, bringing high-value organic traffic and adding credibility to your company’s or your client’s website. Case studies also help leads close to their buying decision take the plunge and buy because of the trust and social proof they offer readers.

What Are the Benefits of Adding Case Studies to Your Marketing Strategy?

According to Jenni Pratt, content marketing manager at Portent, “When it comes to promoting your products or services, case studies should be a staple in every marketer’s toolkit. They are a great opportunity to position your brand as an authority in a specific industry or marketplace, demonstrate success with tangible results, and tell a story that celebrates your customers and how they achieved their goals. They are a surefire way to prove you can walk the walk — if done correctly.”

Case studies should be a staple in every marketer’s toolkit. Click to Tweet

Case studies are fantastic tools for giving your audience an idea of the practical benefits of using a product or service.

They can also be great tools for your sales team as they  convince leads by showing them how a similar company succeeded with your service.

The Process: Your Guide to Crafting a Business Case Study That Converts

Many case studies get their start organically. If a client reaches out with positive feedback, for example, the seeds of a business case study have been planted. In this case, the process of writing the case study is marginally easier than one you would create from scratch.

But if you’re not seeing much feedback, you should still leverage case studies, if possible. So, where do you start?

Set clear goals

Every case study — without exception — should start with a goal. There’s no way to map out content or craft a message if there are no goals. 

So, what’s the goal? At the highest level, your goal is to show that your product or service works as advertised for at least one person who has used it. Every subsequent step in the process is irrelevant without an initial goal.

Select an ideal subject

B2C and B2B subjects for social proof are not created equal. B2B audiences typically judge peers’ reviews and recommendations with more scrutiny. This may be because many business buying decisions are more meaningful than those the average consumer makes. Therefore, the subject of your case study is critical.

This is why your choice of a focal subject for your case study should be relatable to your audience — the reader should be able to picture themselves using and benefiting from using the product or service in question.

Subjects from well-known companies with good reputations in your industry are ideal.

Choose the right format for your case study

Business case studies can exist in various formats, including PDFs, blog posts, videos, infographics, podcasts, and more. You can think of them as highly detailed testimonials.

Even though the writing, headlines, and data of a case study make it compelling, that doesn’t mean the way it looks can’t also play an important role and draw eyes to what you have to say.

Willie Greer remarks, “The appearance of your case study is crucial, but don’t overdo it because it might distract their attention from the content of your study. Use palettes that are pleasant and engaging to look at, with minimal designs and colors.”

For example, case study infographics are popular because they allow the creator to present information in a stylized, eye-catching way. 

But no matter what format you end up using, it is good practice to keep the presentation of the information  generally in the same format:

No matter what format you end up using, it is good practice to keep the presentation of the information generally in the same format. Click to Tweet

Introduce your subject

The introduction is where you provide context and introduce key characters. This helps the reader understand what’s going on in the situation and builds credibility for the case.

For example, if your business case study is about a tool used by marketers, you should present a few lines talking about the accomplishments of your subject or their company.

It’s important to note that a case study should be written chronologically and in simple language for your audience to understand. Your introduction will establish the voice for the rest of the piece.

Present a problem to be solved

First, tell the story of where the subject was before they started working with your company. The subject solves this central challenge by using the focal product or service. The benefit of establishing this clearly is that it shows the viability of your company to prospective customers.

Show how your brand is the solution

Next, introduce your company as the source of a product that, at long last, solves the subject’s main problem. Tell how the subject found the product and why they decided to try it out.

Close with data-backed results

The results section should wrap up the case with compelling leverage points, backed by hard data, and finish with a strong call to action.

Effective calls to action concisely but clearly state what you want the reader to do next. Do you want them to schedule a consultation, sign up for your mailing list, purchase the product, or something else entirely?

Ensure your study is thorough and complete

After you’ve completed each section, here’s what your finished case study might look like:

  • Introduction: Meet Bob, a salesperson at Company A.
  • Problem: Bob is tired of waiting to use his office’s only phone to call his prospects
  • Solution: We sold Bob his own phone, and he started using it exclusively
  • Results: Bob was able to increase his number of sales calls per day by 400%

How to Write a Business Case Study: Key Questions to Ask and Common Mistakes to Avoid

When it’s time to interview your selected subject, you should come prepared. But what does it really mean to be prepared?

There are two major mistakes that some marketers make in preparing for and conducting interviews for case studies.

There are two major mistakes that some marketers make in preparing for and conducting interviews for case studies. Click to Tweet

Mistake #1: Falling back on generic questions

Some companies produce a lot of case studies. But case studies that are the result of mass production aren’t likely to be effective.

Once you set the goal for your case study, formulate questions that will prompt the subject to make statements that support that goal.

Mistake #2: Passing up opportunities to dig deeper

To make the subject of a case study relatable to your audience, you must go beyond simply presenting their experience with your client or company.

A case study made with high-level questions asked in rigid order will force you to end up with a product that doesn’t dig into the most intriguing aspects of the subject, things that you may not know going into it.

Mistake #3: Ignoring the power of storytelling

While it’s true that business case studies are about using facts to build a strong case for choosing your brand, it’s important not to lose sight of the fact that they’re also stories. Approaching them accordingly can bring some real magic to the table.

Lay out your information in chronological order so it’s easy to follow. Use features like headings, subheadings, and bullet lists to organize your study and make it easy to skim for key tidbits of information.

Back up your points with facts

When you’re asking questions, try to dig deeper than subjective statements about your subject’s experience with the product.

We previously mentioned that B2B audiences demand a higher standard of social proof than the average B2C audience. Be ready to present proven data.

A reader may or may not respond to one of their colleagues saying, “I really like this product.” But if the subject says something like, “This product helped me double my sales in a week,” it’s hard to ignore.

Key interview questions to get you started in the right direction

When it’s time to set a strategy to interview your subject, you need to be focused on the goal.

Let’s say you’re representing an email software client who has made one of their unique selling points the fact that their software tracks customer behavior and analytics better than competitors. With this knowledge, your goal might be to show how a better understanding of customer behavior has helped improve their email strategy.

When you sit down with a user of the software, here are some questions you might ask:

  • When did you start using this software? Why did you choose to start using it?
  • What other types of software have you tried in the past?
  • What are the main changes you saw after  using this software?
  • How does using this software affect your email opens and click rates?
  • In what specific ways does this software help your ability to reach customers?
  • Is there a specific story you can expand on that illustrates the benefits this software has added to your business?
  • Would you recommend this software to your peers?

Once you have the information you need, you can organize it into your case study.

Crafting Effective Case Studies: Essential Elements to Include

As we mentioned previously, a good case study has a few essential elements you should include:

Use a mixture of text and graphic elements

A case study must be digestible for optimal results. An exclusively text-based case study may not hold your readers’ attention. An effective case study has a good mix of text and graphics, such as  Content Marketing Case Study: How 4 Infographics Generated Over 10,000 Social Shares by Neil Patel, for example.

Craft a compelling title

Imagine you’re a professional looking for a new desk chair, and you come across two case studies. One is called “Case Study: Company A,” and the other is called “How Company B Upgraded Their Office Chairs and Increased Productivity.” Which one do you think you’d be more likely to click on? The title of your business case study should include the central challenge experienced by the subject and how your product served as the solution. For example: How One eCommerce Business Solved the Omnichannel Challenge with Bitly Campaigns.

Make your headings pop

Be sure to craft headings and subheadings that will immediately grab your readers’ attention. Treat each one as a short preview of what the reader can expect within that section, and use dynamic language to keep the reader’s interest.

As mentioned previously, this has to be done in a way that tells a clear story, with a relatable subject, written in a way that can be understood by the target audience from start to finish.

Find Writers Who Can Rise to the Occasion

Understanding how to write a business case study can be a worthwhile endeavor for your business. However, it takes a talented writer to bring the facts together effectively and use them to tell a story your audience can’t resist. Adding one (or several) to your team could be the X-factor your case study needs to get results.

Visit Crowd Content  to explore your options and get the help you need with creating productive case studies and more.

The post How to Write a Business Case Study appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-write-a-case-study/feed/ 0
What Is Evergreen Content and Why Do You Need It? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-evergreen-content/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-evergreen-content/#respond Thu, 24 Sep 2020 20:08:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=29155 There’s content, and then there’s evergreen content. You might be thinking… “What is evergreen content, and why do I need it?” Hint: Evergreen content attracts continuous organic traffic and loyal readers. How does that sound? In this post, you’ll learn what evergreen content is, why it’s important, and how to create it. Let’s get started! […]

The post What Is Evergreen Content and Why Do You Need It? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
There’s content, and then there’s evergreen content.

You might be thinking… “What is evergreen content, and why do I need it?”

Hint: Evergreen content attracts continuous organic traffic and loyal readers.

How does that sound?

In this post, you’ll learn what evergreen content is, why it’s important, and how to create it.

Let’s get started!

What is Evergreen Content?

You’re probably wondering, “Why is evergreen content, ‘evergreen’?”

The name, evergreen content, was inspired by evergreen trees. Unlike most trees, evergreen trees don’t lose their leaves. In fact, their leaves stay green and healthy all year round.

ALSOFind the best content writers to craft evergreen content for your website

Like an evergreen tree, evergreen content is long-lasting and fresh. This type of content is useful for years to come.

What Evergreen Content Is Not

Before I talk about what evergreen content is, let’s go over what it isn’t:

  • The latest statistics – “The Top 20 Pop Music Statistics of 2020”
  • The most popular trends – “Content Marketing Trends to Look Out for in 2021’
  • Breaking news – “New Evidence of Life on Mars”

The topics above are time-sensitive—it covers short-term trends and the latest news. Evergreen content, on the other hand, covers long-lasting content:

  • How-to posts – “How to Build an Online Business”
  • Checklists – “10 Ways to Teach 3rd Graders Math”
  • Resources – “How to Cite Your Research Paper in APA Format”
Examples-of-Evergreen-Content

On that note, evergreen content is relevant, optimized, and authoritative. I’ll go over each description below.

Relevant

Think of evergreen content as a dictionary. Sure, dictionaries aren’t used every day, but you’ll always refer back to it.

Scott Johnson, the owner of Pitt Home Buyers, explains this further, “When creating evergreen content for your website, be sure that you’re speaking on a topic that will continue to be relevant in the future.”

With that said, evergreen content doesn’t have an expiration date. Your readers should always find it useful.

It covers topics with long-term value for the present and future.

Optimized

Evergreen blog posts are revisited, shared, and searched on Google. They attract links from outside sources and drive traffic.

Simon, the founder of CatchWorks, touches on this, “Evergreen content often forms the core foundations of an SEO content strategy.”

Evergreen content gets high rankings because it covers ongoing trends and search terms. Your readers are constantly searching for these topics—it never goes out of style.

With that said, your topic must be covered comprehensively. Your readers should leave your evergreen content with all of their questions answered.

In SEO, you can do this with:

  • Consistent high search-volume topics
  • Targeted keywords and semantic keywords
  • On-page SEO optimization (i.e. keywords, linking, format)

Step 2 of this post goes over evergreen SEO in more detail.

Authoritative

Imagine going into an auto shop to buy a new car.

When you talk to a sales person, would you rather them…

A) Only know a few details about the cars they’re selling

B) Use their knowledge to answer all of your questions and help you find the perfect car

You’d probably go with B, right?

Authoritative figures attract the most customers because they’re credible, knowledgeable, and helpful. Evergreen content always covers a topic extensively. When you do this, the reader will think of you as an authoritative source.

Scott adds another insightful comment about authority, “Evergreen content builds your credibility and helps your customers see you as an expert in your field.”

Evergreen content is the key to building trust and credibility with your business. And when a user trusts your business, they’re more likely to become a long-lasting customer.

Why is Evergreen Content Important?

Along with the traits above, evergreen content is timeless—as in, it lasts forever.

“Evergreen content that will stay timely for years to come will likely give you the most legs and ‘bang for your buck’ in terms of your marketing strategy,” says Samantha Russell from Twenty Over Ten.

Samantha-Russell-Twenty-Over-Ten-Quote

Timeless content gives you infinite possibilities to skyrocket your organic search and become an authority in your space.

So… how do you make this happen? How do you create evergreen content?

How Do You Create Evergreen Content?

You can create evergreen content in 6 steps. Examples of evergreen content will also be included in this section.

1. Consider Your Audience

When you create content, you should always think about your reader first. If your readers aren’t interested in your content, it won’t deliver long-term value.

Tricia Harte from Digital Third Coast recommends asking yourself questions like, “What pages are they visiting on your website? What questions does your internal sales team receive from potential clients? What do you do (differently) than your competitors?”

Along with the questions above, here are a 4 ways to gather customer data and feedback:

Analyze Your Website

Your website gathers a ton of useful customer information.

Figure out what your readers find interesting with Google Analytics. Google Analytics determines your most popular content with the following metrics:

  • Bounce rate – How long do users stay on your page?
  • Page visits – How many users visit your page?
  • Engagement – What content does your readers like most? The least? How can you turn them into evergreen content?

Execute Social Listening

Like your website, social media can tell you a lot about your readers. Social listening monitors both your social media channels and conversations within your industry.

You can monitor your own channels and analyze your most popular social media posts—which posts receive the most engagement? The least?

You should also consider your likes and comments. Who’s interested in your content? Do they have any feedback or questions for you?

Along with monitoring your posts, keep track industry trends:

  • Follow hashtags within your industry – what topics are your audience talking about?
  • Track your competitor’s social channels – What pain points are your competitors not reaching?

These insights help you dig deeper into your audience’s pain points and build relevant and authoritative content.

Ask Your Readers Directly

When in doubt, ask your readers what they want to see.

Build a survey and send it to your readers via email, or hold a Q&A session on Twitter. Your readers will appreciate you asking for feedback and recommendations.

All in all, your audience always comes first. Their feedback will steer you on the right path to evergreen content.

Implement Keyword Search

There’s a good chance you already use keyword search for all of your content.

Evergreen content, in particular, needs keyword search to find continuous trends. Remember, evergreen content never goes out of date.

Use the following metrics during a keyword search:

  • Search volume

Make sure online users are searching for your keywords. The higher the volume, the better.

  • Traffic

Assess how much traffic other top sites get with your keyword. High traffic usually means your topic is evergreen.

  • Other keyword ideas

Similar keywords will help you brainstorm evergreen content ideas.

For example, “Wooden house,” may have a similar keyword like, “Paint a wooden house.” From here, you could write an evergreen post on how to paint a wooden house.

You can use a free tool like Keyword Generator to help you out. Plus, you can check out other ways to optimize your keyword search here.

2. Research Evergreen Trends

Evergreen content isn’t focused on current trends, but continuous trends. Remember, evergreen content is relevant—relevant content stays on top for both the present and future.

On that note, you can find long-term evergreen content ideas with Google Trends. Google Trends measure long-term online trends. We’ll use the term, “evergreen content” as an example.

Screen-Shot-2020-09-25-at-10.16.22-AM

The graph above shows you the search popularity of “evergreen content” over a span of 12 months.

At the top, you can customize the country, search type, category, and time length of your topic. You’ll get the most out of this tool when you tailor its features for your audience.

Plus, Google Trends will recommend other topics and keywords to use at the bottom of the page.

You can use both keyword search from step 1 along with Google Trends to gather long-term trends.

3. Write Cornerstone Content

Evergreen content is educational and engaging.

With that said, don’t expect to write a 500-word post and be done with it. Instead, create cornerstone content.

Also known as topic clusters, cornerstone content uses interlinked web pages to improve user-navigation and SEO crawling.

So… how does it work?

Imagine cornerstone content as a tree trunk. Cornerstone content covers one broad topic and interlinks to its branches, which cover related-topics.

Together, the tree trunk and its branches create relevant, optimized, and authoritative content—it’s evergreen.

You can check out this cornerstone article by Twenty Over Ten to understand how they work.

Along with internal links, cornerstone content includes the following features:

Credible statistics

Well-researched stats are up-to-date and relevant. Avoid using statistics from questionable sites—you want to build trust with your readers.

Search for white papers and research journals within your industry for valid research. You can also create your own research with a personal study.

Quotes

Using quotes from other authoritative sources does two things:

One, they add different perspectives on your evergreen topic. The most informative pieces of content educate readers with different POVs.

Two, they build relationships with other professionals. When you quote a professional within your industry, they’ll take notice. You might even get a few shares.

Images

Images visualize your topic for your readers.

With that said, every photo should have a reason to be there. Random stock photos aren’t useful. Instead, insert screenshots to explain a step or sum up your article with an infographic.

As you write evergreen content, keep your audience in mind the entire time. Use cornerstone content to answer their questions and show them actionable steps to achieve their goals.

Plus, cornerstone content can be written in a variety of formats, as you’ll see in the next step.

4. Format Your Evergreen Content

Think back to the last time you read a textbook. You probably didn’t enjoy reading endless pages of small font, right?

Textbooks are intimidating—they created a belief that reading is hard and not fun. Luckily, you can format your content for your audience and Google.

Formatting your content benefits you in 3 of ways:

  • It provides a welcoming environment for readers
  • It helps Google crawl your site
  • It can rank your content as a featured snippet on Google (you must also use schema markup, which you can learn more about here)
Why-Format-Your-Evergreen-Content_

When you format your post, use headings, subheadings, and short paragraphs to separate blocks of text.

Along with formatting, you should create easy-to-navigate content.

John Matyasovsky, Digital Marketing Specialist at Roofing Webmasters, suggests adding a table of contents, “Readers can quickly access the portion of the document that most interests them.”

Here are 4 different types of evergreen content you can use to format your page. Click on each example to see each one in practice.

List Post

A list post is…well… a list. This type of content usually lists reasons, trends, tips, etc. about their topic.

Example: The Top Content Writing Skills Content Writers Need to Know

How-to Post

This type of post teaches your readers how to do something. They usually include a list of actionable steps.

Example: How to Write a Great Listicle for 2020

Guides

Guides cover everything you need to know about a general topic. They’re in-depth and answer any question your readers may have.

Example: Roofing SEO: The Definitive Guide

FAQs

Also known as, “Frequently Asked Questions,” a FAQ page covers common questions users have.

Example: Questions to consider when selling your house

Some formats will work better for you than others. Test out which ones are best for your audience and evergreen topic.

5. Promote Your Evergreen Content

You can write the best evergreen content ever, but it won’t be any use if nobody reads it. Optimized and relevant content is seen by current and future readers.

On that note, you can promote your post on and off of your site.

On Your Site

There are 4 ways to promote evergreen content on your site:

  • Interlinking

Insert your new post’s link into other blog content. Better yet, add it to a cornerstone article.

I also suggest featuring your evergreen content to a service page. For example, if you provide SEO services, promote a blog post about SEO.

  • Implement a side toolbar

Create a side toolbar on your site with a list of your most popular blog posts. Add your evergreen content to increase its visibility.

  • Pop-up ads

You can also promote your posts with pop-up ads. An example is adding a top banner to your site. Insert a call to action with a link to your new post.

(insert a photo of a top banner example here?)

Off Your Site

Use time-sensitive content to promote your evergreen post.

For example, you could create an infographic and post it to your social media. The infographic will attract readers to learn more about your content.

Speaking of social media, this is the time to tag anyone you mentioned in your posts. Most likely, they’ll share your content and spread the word.

Other types of time-sensitive content include:

  • Social media post
  • An email newsletter
  • Short blog post
  • Video

As you promote your evergreen content, take note of where your blog post receives the most traffic.

Let’s say your post’s highest traffic was from Twitter. Now you know to promote more of your content there.

You can track this with any analytics tool, like Google Analytics.

6. Update Your Evergreen Content

The most important part about evergreen content is to update it. Updating your content keeps it relevant and maintains its organic ranking.

Tricia Harte from Digital Third Coast agrees with this, “Provide updates as they provide benefits to your audience. Meaningful updates give you a reason to promote them via social media and newsletters and re-engage your audience with your content.”

Tricia-Harte-Digital-Third-Coast-Quote

With that said, don’t let your content get old. Out-of-date content is no longer relevant, optimized, nor authoritative.

Here are a few ways to update your content:

Check Statistics

Statistics can be 1 or 2 years old, but any longer is outdated. Your readers are looking for the most current information out there.

Revisit SEO

Look at your meta description and keywords. Are they still relevant to search?

For example, you might find a new keyword to use within your content. Make sure to update your meta description as you make changes.

Repurpose Your Evergreen Content

You can use time-sensitive content to both promote and update your content. In this case, you can repurpose your evergreen post into another piece of content. This will target new readers and keep your content alive.

An example is repurposing your blog post into a video. You could embed your video within your post to attract visual learners.

You might be wondering how often you should update your content.

This answer depends on your content marketing strategy and analytics. On that note, measure your evergreen content results.

Analyzing your content helps build the most effective evergreen content for your business and readers. You can use the same metrics from step one:

  • Bounce rate
  • Page visits
  • User sessions

Along with these metrics, you should analyze your SEO performance. If your rankings aren’t improving or begin to decline, you need to find out why.

Track your keyword competitors and use tools from Step 1, like social listening, to stay up to date with your audience.

When you track your results, you’ll figure out the best way to update your content and keep it timeless.

To Wrap Up

If you’re going to take anything away from this post, it should be this:

Evergreen content lasts forever.

Every step in this post will help you create timeless evergreen content in your industry.

Sure, writing evergreen content isn’t easy, but the long-term results are absolutely worth it. If you don’t have the time to build evergreen content, we’re happy to help you out.

ALSO – White Paper Examples & How to Advice to Drive Amazing Results

The post What Is Evergreen Content and Why Do You Need It? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-evergreen-content/feed/ 0
What Is the Total Cost of Creating an Ebook? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/cost-of-creating-an-ebook/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/cost-of-creating-an-ebook/#respond Fri, 07 Aug 2020 20:00:50 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28726 The decision to create and publish an eBook can be driven by several factors that have to be weighed against the cost of creating an eBook. Maybe you want to create something valuable to offer your existing audience. Maybe you want to use an eBook as a lead magnet that you promote via social media, […]

The post What Is the Total Cost of Creating an Ebook? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
The decision to create and publish an eBook can be driven by several factors that have to be weighed against the cost of creating an eBook.

Maybe you want to create something valuable to offer your existing audience. Maybe you want to use an eBook as a lead magnet that you promote via social media, paid promotions or SEO.

No matter why you want to create an eBook, there’s a question you have to ask yourself: will it generate a high enough return on your investment to make it worth the investment involved in creating it?

You can’t answer that question without having a full understanding of all the labor (and associated costs) that goes into conceptualizing, producing, and distributing an eBook.

ALSOCheck out our eBook writing services

Here’s a breakdown of all these elements, and how they affect total cost of creating an eBook.

First, What IS an eBook?

Technically, “eBook” is a term used to describe any document (typically a non-editable one) that you can read from an electronic device, like a computer, smartphone, or tablet. The more practical definition of an eBook is that it’s a long-form composition leveraged in a digital format in exchange for money, a lead submission, or something else that serves an objective of the creator.

What is an ebook? This image shares a definition of an ebook.

Note – Most content marketers use eBooks as lead magnets to capture contact info from potential buyers. Most buyers are towards the middle of the funnel around the Interest stage of their journey.

Before we start breaking down the costs of creating an eBook, let’s make something clear. Yes, anyone can create an eBook — if you write two pages in a word document and export it into a PDF, technically, you’ve done it. But, what we’re talking about here is creating something of value — an eBook that delivers.

Typically, that means that your eBook that:

  1. Is at least 5,000 words
  2. Comprehensively covers the topic at hand
  3. Features an attractive, on-brand design
  4. Use hyperlinks in a table of contents for easy navigation
  5. Includes graphics, charts, illustrations and other visual cues
What goes into an eBook that delivers? Use enough word, visual cues, and attractive design to deliver value in your eBook.

As we’ll describe below, this is a larger ask, and one that may involve costs that you aren’t thinking about right now.

Do it Yourself or Outsource?

Many digital marketers see eBooks as a worthwhile effort because they are a valuable piece of content that you can use to support multiple business goals. The main challenge often comes down to the time it takes to do it right.

You can spend hours working on the concept and the message of your eBook, and still not have anything that resembles the outline of a fully fleshed-out composition. And that doesn’t include researching, writing, editing, and designing your eBook which can take dozens of hours.

This is why many marketers choose to outsource their eBooks. They either outsource the smaller parts that they would struggle to handle on their own, or sometimes larger portions, serving to streamline the entire process. As we go step-by-step, we’ll talk about the cost of creating an eBook using outsourced talent.

Step 1: Developing the Concept

Before you start crafting your masterpiece, you have to build the framework for the entire exercise. What’s the topic? How will it be used to meet your goals? What audience does it speak to? Where are they at in the funnel when they read this?

This step doesn’t cost anything — there’s no charge for your own creativity.

Once you have a concept and loose outline, it’s time to start the creation of your eBook.

Step 2: Writing the Content

Step 2 comprises two parts: research and writing. They’re part of the same step because you’re probably going to want the person doing the research to also write the content that their research covers. And, you want that writing to be at a quality level that doesn’t need much editing after it’s written.

Alex Azoury, Founder and CEO of Home Grounds says the cost of creating an eBook depends on the writers you have access to.

“If you don’t have a writer on staff, then you’ll probably hire a freelance content writer or agency,” says Azoury. “Freelance writers differ in their experience, subject preferences, and costs. Think about whether you need a native English speaker or a competent writer whose English is at near-native level.”

In this quote, Alex Azoury shares that freelancers vary in expertise and cost to create an eBook.

If you’re hiring an “intermediate” writer, according to Azoury, they’ll typically charge between 5 and 20 cents per word. The average eBook is 2,500 to 5,000 words. That means that costs range between $125 to $250 on the lower end and $500 to $1000 on the high end.

When your topic is research-intensive, or you want to hire a writer with an expert knowledge of the subject, you’ll end up paying more. Budget as much 50 cents to 1 dollar per word, which will run you between $1250 to $2500 for a 2,500 word product.

Note – At Crowd Content, we always recommend clients use at least our 4-star writers which are priced at 12 cents per word. At that rate, you’ll need to provide a good amount of research and data to your writer. For more complex or research intensive projects we can set up a custom project.

A Cost Effective Alternative Method

If you want to save costs on content creation, you can use content you’ve already written and published in your eBook. If you’re writing a long form piece about a topic, chances are it’s a topic you’ve already explored before. During your planning steps, look for previously produced content that can be used to reduce the burden of researching, writing, and editing brand-new content.

Many marketers actually create a series of blog posts that could be considered episodic content, meaning that collectively they make up one larger story. Collecting these resources into an eBook is a very cost effective way of finding content for an eBook.

The reverse is also true – consider carving up sections of your completed eBooks into blog posts you publish (content repurposing). You can even include a link to the full eBook in the post which can generate a lot of leads.

Step 3 – Editing Your Content

The cost of editing, according to the Editorial Freelancers Association, varies based on the type of work you need. Basic copy editing is usually billed at around $30-$40 per hour, and if the copy needs a more intensive editor, that will increase to around $40-$60. If the average copy editor can get through an average of 5 manuscript pages per hour, a 2,500 word eBook (10 pages) will run you between $60 to $120 and a 5,000 word composition could cost an average of $240 at the high end.

Note – At crowd Content you can hire freelance editors for 3 cents per word. For more substantial editing requirements we can also set up a custom project.

Again, keep in mind that these numbers are for basic editing. If you want a copy editor to make multiple rounds of revisions and look deeply at changes that could improve the content, you may need to budget more.

If you decide you just need a proofread you might also be able to budget less, but we wouldn’t advise that.

Step 4: Designing the Assets

The design cost depends on the level of commitment you want to put into the aesthetics of your eBook. Do you want every page to be expertly laid out with full-color graphics, or will an eye-catching cover page suffice?

Alex Azoury again: “Your design includes your eBook cover, various elements within the book, and the final page. Someone will need to decide on the fonts and color used. All the headlines, paragraphs and text need to be formatted so that your book appears professionally produced.”

Azoury estimates that a complete design takes about five hours. If a freelance designer charges $30.00 per hour, that comes out to $150.00 for the project.

Keep in mind, that is a bare bone estimate and would likely result in a very basic looking eBook.

According to James Pollard, Founder of TheAdvisorCoach.com, “Some people will recommend going to a cheap site like Fiverr, but I’ve found that you get what you pay for. I suggest hiring a professional designer either directly or through a freelancing site.”

In this James Pollard quote, he explains that going to a freelancing site or directly to the freelancer is the best bet when creating an eBook.

This level of premium design may cost you a lot more. Pollard estimates that for a fully produced, graphically rich cover design, it may cost as much as $500 for a final product that makes your eBook stand out.

That’s just for the basics, though. If you want to take time to create graphics, tables, charts and other visual elements, that will require more design time. An eBook with robust visuals can cost significantly more and may even creep into the thousands.

Whatever level of design quality and depth you choose, you’ll want to ensure the final package follows your brand guidelines and is appealing to readers.

Do It Yourself?

This all assumes that you opt to have a designer create your eBook. While usually that’s quicker and can produce a better result, there are a number of tools that can help you create your own eBook design for free.

  1. Microsoft Word – there are great templates available to pop your content into. While it can be tricky at times, it does let you add important elements like table of contents, cover pages, graphics and charts fairly easily.
  2. Online tools – Canva, LucidPress and FlipMaker all offer easy to use tools to create visually appealing eBooks. While there can be a small cost to using these tools, they might be a good fit for you.

Keep in mind that you should have a good eye for design if you go the DIY route.

Step 5: Repurposing and Distributing Your eBook

The most common eBook format is the PDF. And, that may be all you need to do.

But, you might also choose to put it in different formats and distribute it additional channels to increase its reach. Here are a few ideas:

  1. Create an audiobook version and make it available on services that offer listening like Spotify, iTunes, Google Play, Scribd, and others.
  2. Format it for Amazon Kindle Direct Publishing (KDP) and make it available on Amazon. You can make it available for free here, but many published authors earn significant revenue by charging for their eBooks
  3. Format your eBook in the ePub format for wider accessibility. This is the standard format used by eBook readers such as Kindle, Kobo, iBook, etc. There are many free and paid tools that can help you do this. This will also allow you to sell your eBook on marketplaces like Google Play and iBook.
  4. Break it up into several blog posts and post it on your blog

These are all relatively low cost ways to get your content to more of your audience, and you can even generate sales if you choose.

Step 6: Calculating Your Final Cost of Creating an Ebook and ROI

So, what’s the final cost of creating an eBook? As mentioned, the total investment depends on what you have available to as well as the level of depth and quality you’re aiming for.

A good ballpark for an average eBook would be around $3,000 dollars if you hire freelancers for everything. But, if you have access to some resources needed like existing content, design support, editing support, etc, the total cost can be a lot lower. Similarly, if you need an exceptional level of quality, tons of research, and need to hire an expert to write it, you could be looking at significantly more.

The amount you actually budget creating your finished product should depend on what you expect to gain from it when you leverage it to your selected market. According to James Pollard, “I tie it directly to a revenue metric in my business because I view it as an investment. I have no problem spending $3,000 to create an eBook that will generate $30,000 in sales over the next year.”

To understand and track the ROI of your eBook, the best way is to determine what the value of each lead who downloads your eBook is. To do this you can work backwards through your funnel. Here’s an example:

  1. Each new paying customer has a lifetime value of $100
  2. Of leads who download the eBook, 10% become paying customers
  3. Each eBook lead is therefore worth $10
  4. Since we spent $3,000 to produce this eBook, we need 300 eBook downloads for it to break even

This is just an example to illustrate this calculation. If you can track your ROI with actual numbers, you’ll be way better off.

Wrapping It Up

Quality eBooks can have a hugely positive ROI when used as lead magnets to support your other marketing efforts. Since the content they contain is so extensive and valuable, your audience is much more likely to offer their contact information in exchange for them. And, that’s not even counting other benefits such as increasing your perceived authority or boosting SEO.

But, they can be a big investment.

One way you can reduce the cost of creating an eBook and maximize ROI is by working with a reliable source of eBook writers. Crowd Content can help you find cost effective solutions for eBook creation and any other content needs, no matter how specialized or extensive.

Be sure to reach out if you could use a hand with your next eBook writing project.

The post What Is the Total Cost of Creating an Ebook? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/cost-of-creating-an-ebook/feed/ 0
White Paper Examples & How to Advice to Drive Amazing Results https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/white-paper-examples/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/white-paper-examples/#respond Thu, 30 Jul 2020 19:10:04 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28657 We created this post to answer many of the questions our clients had about white paper creation and provide some good white paper examples. Please get in touch if you have any other questions.  Marketers that understand how to create content for every stage of the buyer journey know that leveraging different types of content […]

The post White Paper Examples & How to Advice to Drive Amazing Results appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
We created this post to answer many of the questions our clients had about white paper creation and provide some good white paper examples. Please get in touch if you have any other questions. 

Marketers that understand how to create content for every stage of the buyer journey know that leveraging different types of content is critical.

One of the most valuable mid-funnel content types you can leverage is the white paper. These are incredibly valuable resources for buyers who are looking to learn more, evaluate options, and ultimately help nudge them towards the decision stage of their journey.

But, white papers need to be amazing to accomplish this goal in a world where readers expect more and more of the content they consume.

In this post, we’ll go over what makes a good white paper and then highlight some great white paper examples you can emulate. 

White Papers at a Glance

White papers are in-depth explorations of a topic, written to provide a targeted audience with valuable, actionable content. A white paper differs from a blog post because it’s longer and more thoroughly researched, with a formal tone and usually packaged in a PDF file. 

This is a text-based image. White Papers is highlighted in yellow, and the definition of a white paper is written below that.

This doesn’t mean it shouldn’t be engaging — it means the priority is giving readers authoritative information they can use to solve a particular problem.

Initially, a white paper was solely a government technical document that helped to gauge public reactions to legislative changes. Organizations and businesses now use them as part of their content marketing strategies to influence decision-makers. 

White papers can help you in the following ways:

  1. Act as lead magnets that leads download in exchange for their contact information
  2. Drive SEO results if published and indexed on your site (not in a PDF)
  3. Establish you as an authority in your space

Why Are White Papers Effective?

A white paper is effective primarily because it communicates your expertise to other businesses and potential buyers and is a valuable asset that these people can use. 

Because your audience values them, you can write white papers with the aim of influencing b2b marketers or put them behind a sign up form on a landing page to generate leads or grow your subscriber base.

A good white paper contains unique, valuable information that your target audience of potential contacts would find difficult to find elsewhere. When you understand what your target market is looking for — you can preempt and exceed expectations by producing content the reader needs.

Good white papers address a common problem or challenge your audience is facing and provides a comprehensive solution. Spending time to understand what these challenges are and what questions your audience has is critical.

SIDENOTE – If you choose to publish your white paper, or a portion of it, ungated then your white paper can also help to drive SEO traffic. When you’re researching what topics you should cover, you should also find search terms that your audience uses in Google when trying to address the challenges you’ll cover. Be sure to build that into your content to capture valuable organic traffic. 

In the Inc. blog, Victor Ijidola points out two studies that back up how white papers improve marketing success. According to one by Eccolo Media, out of 10 types of content, white papers were ranked as the most helpful form to use in the initial sales phase. Furthermore, a survey by TechTarget reported that 91% of IT buyers consider a white paper to be the second most effective type of content to use in the first stage of buying — with product literature ranked first.

White-Paper-Stat

Harness the Broad Reach of Content Marketing

Blogs, case studies, eBooks, e-newsletters and infographics are just a few content types useful in content marketing. The acceleration of digital marketing and the growing influence and reach of technology means having a well-defined content marketing strategy is more crucial than ever. Its effectiveness lies in the indirect approach of becoming more than just a brand to consumers by adding value to their lives through content.

Social media and email marketing are particularly useful due to their prevalence in consumers’ everyday existence. Since it became the standard for people in our society to carry a smartphone, the reach of these channels has increased. These are great channels to distribute and promote your content.

Most people spend a significant portion of their day checking emails and scrolling through their various social media feeds for updates. If you’ve had a blog and noticed how effective it is as a means of engaging potential customers, creating a white paper would likely enhance your content strategy even further.

Ultimately content marketing needs great content to fuel it. You need content to promote and hook visitors in, who you can then nudge down your funnel by progessively showing them content that makes them more interested in your products or services. 

When it comes to mid-funnel and bottom of funnel content, white papers are amongst the best tools at your disposal. As you map out your funnel, be sure to identify what white papers you can create at these later stages to convert more of your traffic. 

Best Uses for White Papers

The modern buyer is savvy, and they understand that research is critical when they’re choosing which product or service to use. A well-written white paper feeds this thirst for knowledge while subtly positioning your solution as the definitive answer to their need. This is part of the reason why they’re so popular with workers and operators within the tech industry.

Often times these buyers will be researching products or services to solve a problem or challenge they’re facing. White papers that solve these problems are incredibly useful to potential buyers. 

White papers are also excellent tools for B2B marketers who are establishing themselves as thought leaders in their niche. You can expand your network and build awareness by inspiring fellow businesses with insightful and authoritative content which can lead to them contacting you when they need help that only you can provide. 

Your sales team will thank you if you have great white papers they can leverage. White papers perform a variety of useful functions throughout the sales process:

  • White papers establish thought leadership and attract sought-after affiliates and partners.
  • They teach potential customers and current clients relevant and valuable information.
  • The content in a white paper is educational and not at all sales-focused.
  • A business benefits white paper informs the reader about a product without using sales pitches.
  • Technology benefits white papers are more technical and detailed about specific features.
  • Product comparisons are popular types of white paper that give the audience impartial information to help them make a choice.
  • You can generate leads if you put them behind a paywall or contact form — this can be especially effective if you already have a blog or provide content that people read regularly.
This image describes three reasons why you should use white papers in your content marketing.

Know Your Target Audience

Before you start writing, you must develop a clear understanding of your audience. For example, if your subject matter is aimed at expert engineers, your content should be appropriately technical. On the other hand, if your audience is content writers — they’ll enjoy slightly more elaborate adjectives and fewer statistics. You should also reflect these preferences in the white paper design and layout.

Who Is Your Audience?

Firstly, ask yourself who you want to target. Build a profile of an individual representative (a persona) of your target audience and find out what they need. Search engine data gives business owners a uniquely honest and direct insight into the queries your audience has. You can also interview people in this audience, or ask your sales team what questions they often hear during negotiations. 

To write the best white papers, you’ll need to find out the questions your audience needs answering.

How Do Their Needs Align With Your Business Offering?

Now you’ve established the audience’s question; you must find a way of providing them with factual information that compels them to use your product or service to fulfill that need. Remember — it’s not a direct sell. You need to frame the solution as your brand, as opposed to explicitly pointing the reader towards it.

What Are the Main Elements of White Papers?

A captivating and effective white paper relies upon six essential elements:

  • Captivating title and headlines: The title is the first opportunity to have to entice readers in. Clear and compelling titles and headlines keep the audience interested and provide markers to help them navigate your content.
  • Executive summary: This helps decision-makers whose time is precious to make a quick decision about whether you’re delivering a solution they require. It’s a summary of the key points, with a succinct conclusion that doesn’t leave any questions unanswered.
  • A clear introduction or abstract: An introduction should clearly outline your main points and tell the reader what to expect.
  • Thoroughly researched and actionable content: This is the main body of your content and the area where the value lies. You must conduct thorough research to provide information that’s easily digestible but goes into enough depth to be a complete resource.
  • Snackable layout: Don’t underestimate how crucial layout and design are. Readers quickly lose interest in monotonous content with unbroken blocks of writing. So, make sure you use blocks of color, diagrams, pictures, headings, subheadings and lists to break up the content and keep the audience engaged.
  • Implement a clear distribution strategy: Now you’ve written your white paper, you need to release it into the world as part of your content marketing strategy. You’ll need a clear plan in place about whether you release it for free on social media or build a broader strategy around a paywall or sign up form.

How to Promote White Papers

There are myriad ways to ensure maximum exposure for your content, and it’s a time-consuming piece of writing to create — so make sure it gets the reach it deserves. In particular, you’ll need a well-structured promotion plan to make sure your B2B white papers reach a wider audience. Here are several ideas to help you distribute your content :

  • Create a landing page on your website with a short opt-in form to download the white paper
  • Create a blog post promoting the white paper or post a portion of your white paper and ensure it’s SEO optimized to rank and drive organic traffic
  • Promote your white paper by publishing it with hashtags on LinkedIn, Twitter, Facebook, YouTube, Quora, Instagram and Pinterest
  • Submit a guest post to an influencer’s blog with a backlink to your landing page for your white paper
  • Use email to promote your white paper to your existing mail list, or pay to send a sponsored email to a relevant partner’s list
  • Host a conference, podcast or webinar about your white paper and interview industry experts
  • Develop relationships with fellow influencers in your vertical and encourage them to share your white paper
  • Email the owners of resources lists and ask them to feature your content
  • Share your white paper with your partners and affiliates
  • Create an infographic based around the info in your white paper

Where Does a White Paper Fit Into the Buyers Journey?

As mentioned earlier, statistics suggest that white papers are most useful at the consideration stage of the customer journey. This is when a consumer is most likely to conduct extensive research regarding their purchase. They understand what their problem is, and they’re looking for a solution. Encouraging downloads and getting contact details at this stage can be the most effective way of finding leads and converting them. The three steps on the sales journey are:

  1. Awareness stage, where you capture the audience’s interest
  2. Consideration stage, when they’re gathering information
  3. Decision stage, when they decide which product of service to use

At the consideration stage, you have the opportunity to give them information about how you intend to solve their problem. Once you’ve obtained their contact details, you can follow up with targeted content to further encourage a conversion.

White Paper Examples and Resources

You can find an array of helpful resources and excellent white paper examples from some of the biggest companies in the world. Here’s a selection of useful tools and resources for white paper writing.

Sample White Paper Templates

The American Marketing Association has a handy white paper template.

B2B

HubSpot produces a slew of great content resources including a range of white papers. Their white paper on How to Use Instagram for Business is a great example of a piece that offers solutions to a common challenge many of its audience face – how are B2B companies supposed to leverage Instagram? 

This is an example of a white paper from HubSpot.

An outstanding example of a B2B white paper is Networking and Your Competitive Edge from Cisco. It uses a futuristic and sleek design to communicate the benefits of its services to decision makers.

This is an example of a white paper from Cisco.

LinkedIn is highly adept at using content to build a relationship with its users. The Sophisticated Marketer’s Guide to Content Marketing helps content marketers to succeed with valuable insights from industry leaders.

This is an example of a white paper from LinkedIn.

B2C

While most white papers are aimed at B2B audiences, they’re often just as valuable for B2C audiences.

Google wrote a detailed piece entitled the Google Cloud Security and Compliance Whitepaper, targeted at the public as much as it’s aimed at organizations. It aims to communicate the brand’s dedication to security and privacy, encouraging trust and affirming Google’s commitment to its users online safety.

This is an example of a B2C white paper from Google.

Increase Conversions at Each Stage of Your Sales Funnel

White papers are useful for many reasons, but their primary advantages are that they establish you as a thought leader in your field while improving your website’s search engine ranking. No matter what your area of expertise is, a well-constructed white paper instills confidence in consumers and partners that you can provide the solution to their problem.

To find out more about content marketing strategies, sign up to Crowd Content’s blog, and get actionable SEO and digital marketing advice delivered straight to your inbox.

ALSO  Do you Need a Content Writer or a Copywriter?

The post White Paper Examples & How to Advice to Drive Amazing Results appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/white-paper-examples/feed/ 0
The Top Content Writing Skills Writers Need to Know https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/top-content-writing-skills/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/top-content-writing-skills/#respond Fri, 17 Jul 2020 20:15:23 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28588 In many ways, content writing is as much of an art as a skill. Yes, writers with natural talent can succeed, but it’s also possible to learn the ins and outs of content writing and apply skills and knowledge in a way that works. This is especially true as best practices continue to change and […]

The post The Top Content Writing Skills Writers Need to Know appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
In many ways, content writing is as much of an art as a skill. Yes, writers with natural talent can succeed, but it’s also possible to learn the ins and outs of content writing and apply skills and knowledge in a way that works. This is especially true as best practices continue to change and evolve with the ever-fluctuating state of the industry.

These content writing skills can keep writers at the top of their game, offering the tools necessary to produce quality content every single time.

Keen Research Skills

No one knows everything, and that makes research the name of the game for many content writers. All companies know the extent to which Google prioritizes quality, so a fluffy piece full of generalizations won’t be winning anyone awards. A great writer needs to know how to comb through sources, find statistics to back up points, and draw clear, concise, and correct conclusions.

In some cases, a niche writer with extensive experience — professional, academic, or otherwise — is needed, but in many cases, a generalist can tackle most subjects in a way that meets SEO standards while expertly addressing the topic at hand. With the ability to closely follow instructions and put research skills to the test, a good writer can produce a piece that satisfies both clients and Google’s algorithms.

As Derek of Floating Authority puts it, “What makes the top content writers stand out is that they take the time necessary to make sure that they follow the instructions they are provided and to thoroughly research the topic at hand, even if it takes them past a specific deadline.”

Content-Writing-Skills-Quote

SEO Expertise

SEO always matters. Content that is published online is intended to be read by many, but it’s also going to be crawled by Google’s bots for the purpose of indexing. And while content that sounds good and makes an impact with readers is a benefit, so is content that ranks.

Google is always fine-tuning its approach, which means that content needs to keep up. A little familiarity isn’t enough; an effective writer needs to stay on top of how the industry is evolving in addition to what it takes to rank well as the systems consistently grows and changes. While knowing every single little detail of each and every update isn’t necessarily imperative, understanding the key points of what works – and what doesn’t! – can make or break success in the SERPs.

Want to know what IS working? Check out our guide to becoming an SEO content writer. 

B2B and SaaS Content Writer and SEO Strategist Alexandra Cote feels that few skills are as important as an in-depth understanding of SEO. “And I’m not talking here about keyword optimization alone but about everything that has to do with on-page SEO at least,” she clarifies. “From SERP research to nail the reader intent, to choosing the right main and secondary keywords, writing amazing meta descriptions, and getting internal links right.”

Social Media Mastery

Social media is no longer a choice; it’s an absolute must for content of all kinds. Consumers use social media to connect with brands and browse local options; 54% of Facebook users even use the site to do product research.

Social Media Content Tip

Not all content writers will need to create content for social media, like Facebook posts or Tweets, but knowing what kinds of posts resonate as well as what kinds of headlines get the most clicks can be extremely valuable. Many brands rely on social outlets to distribute content, so writers who are tasked with these kinds of assignments need to know how and why some articles succeed on social, and why others fall flat.

“Content writers must have a good grasp and knowledge on how to maximize such platforms to their advantage. Furthermore, they should also be able to create content that best suits the taste of the social media community”, says Sonya Schwartz, the founder of Her Norm. No one is expecting writers to have the same level of expertise as social media marketing professionals, but a solid knowledge in what will make a difference and what won’t is a skill every great content writer needs.

Sonya Schwartz Quote

What can writers do to help their content do well on social? There are many things including:

  1. Focus on crafting engaging headlines that drive clicks. Tools like Coschedule’s Headline Analyzer can help with this. 
  2. Use content formats that do well on specific social platforms. For example, listicles, slideshows and quiz content all get great engagement on social
  3. Make the content easily digestible and focus on writing sections that translate well to social messages if a reader wants to share. You can even use services like Click to Tweet to let users share these message with just a click.

An Understanding of the Buyer Journey

How companies speak to their potential customers is at the cornerstone of how business is conducted. Everything, from how products are marketed to how transactions are completed, speaks to the needs of the customer rather than the preferences of the company. As a writer, it’s easy to understand what a company wants out of an order, but seeing the customer side of the equation can be a little harder.

In spite of the divide between buyer and business, an understanding of the buyer journey is a critical part of creating content that resonates. Consumers want to read content that makes them feel as if their concerns are heard and solutions are designed with them in mind – not a company speaking into an echo chamber.

According to Saurabh Jindal of travel-based app startup Talk Travel, being able to understand and speak to the customer experience is paramount to using content to drive conversions. “A good content writer creates content, which pushes the consumer to the next phase of the customer journey, and in a manner which is subtle and does not explicitly try to push the customer,” he explains. By knowing how a piece of writing fits into the over customer journey and what is needed to inspire steps forward, writers are better positioned to inspire purchases and foster customer loyalty.

Want to learn more about writing for every stage of the customer journey? Check out our guide here. 

Adaptability

Rarely does a writer write about one topic for one client indefinitely. Instead, many talented content writers write for many clients about any number of subjects. For those focused on one niche over others, it’s likely that clients, tone, and point of view will all vary sooner or later, as will the specific nature of themes about which to write.

As a writer, it’s often necessary to be able to speak confidently about areas outside of your expertise, and explore new fields. It’s also important to be able to confidently switch from a humorous tone to academic to informative and back again. A big part of success in writing is being adaptable and being able to meet client needs rather than simply doing the same thing, day in and day out, for every single client.

As stated by Randy of Soderman Marketing, “oftentimes, especially in an agency environment, content writers have to write about a variety of different topics as well as adjusting their tone and style for each client. This is why it’s so important for writers to be able to adapt. They should be a chameleon.” While every writer has their own distinct voice, content writing isn’t usually the time to show it off. Instead, it’s a time to customize content and tone to provide a client with a satisfying end result.

Randy Soderman Content Writer Quote

Editing Ability

No piece of writing is perfect on the first pass. Instead, most writing takes multiple reviews to get it to the point where a piece is passable. While outside editors certainly add value later in the game, the ability to read one’s own work and determine areas that can be improved is a key step in the creative process. Ultimately, the first and most important steps in quality control are a writer’s responsibility.

“Understand that once you’re done writing, your job has only begun. Learn the best tools to edit and proofread your work such as the Hemingway App, Grammarly, and Copyscape for plagiarism,” suggests Tim, an Operations Strategist for People Managing People.

He also emphasizes the ability to take criticism and use it to improve current pieces as well as to inform future projects. “Feedback is your friend, so use it as a ‘growth hormone,'” he says. A great writer cares about the quality of the work they produce from a holistic sense, not just whether or not it passes a customer’s baseline level of acceptability.

Process can be your friend when it comes to self-editing. Many writers find that immediately reviewing content after they finish writing it isn’t nearly as effective as stepping away from the project for a while, focusing on something else, and then coming back with a fresh set of eye for the content when they’re ready to edit. 

Creativity

Writing as a job can become stressful and tedious in time, no matter how nice the clients or how interesting the topics. After a certain point, some jobs start to blend together, leading to repetitive and uninspired content. Many times, this isn’t intentional, but rather a product of doing the same thing, day after day.

While it’s quite common for writers to start phoning in articles due to a lack of interest or waning time and attention, a great content writer knows how to keep content fresh and exciting. “Writers might eventually run out of creative juices and subconsciously use concepts and sentence construction similar to past outputs. When that happens, produced content feels pretty identical to each other. However, highly creative content writers always manage to find a new perspective on old topics, which helps keep outputs fresh,” explains Jeremy Owens, the CMO of Seriously Smoked.

To stay creative, writers need to be passionate about the written word as a whole, not just the content they produce for others. Reading books, keeping up to date on industry blogs, and even reading similar articles written by other writers can be a great way to keep skills sharp and provide additional inspiration.

Flexibility in a Changing Marketplace

The wide world of content marketing never sits still for long. From changes in Google’s algorithms to changes in the kind of content people like to consume, the industry is always moving. What worked yesterday won’t necessarily work tomorrow – and it’s up to writers to know this and adapt accordingly.

Content Marketing Tip

“As nothing is constant in business and society, being adaptable and flexible is a core skill in content writing. You must be able to mold your writing based on what’s current, trending, and acceptable in the industry, says Her Norm‘s Sonya Schwartz.

For example, voice search is a continually-growing trend now utilized in more areas than ever before. Creating content that resonates with voice searches rather than traditional search engines isn’t necessarily natural, so content writers need to have an idea of what will work best for voice search, normal web search, or, more likely, both. In order to please customers and create content that achieves goals, writers need to know how to stay flexible and adaptable as the content world changes around them.

The art of putting words on a page can be a rewarding and profitable pastime, but content writers with the right skills are those most likely to succeed. With a talent for writing and a knowledge of the most beneficial content writing skills, writers are well positioned to get ahead – one article at a time.

ALSO – Who’s on Your Business Content Writing Team and How Do You Manage Them?

The post The Top Content Writing Skills Writers Need to Know appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/top-content-writing-skills/feed/ 0
Do You Need a Content Writer or a Copywriter? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/copywriting/content-writer-or-copywriter/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/copywriting/content-writer-or-copywriter/#respond Thu, 09 Jul 2020 20:00:13 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28534 Content writing and copywriting sound like interchangeable terms, and while their domains may overlap on occasion, they’re two different things that serve two distinct functions. Put simply, good content writing engages the reader by providing informative and educational content about your industry and brand. Good copywriting compels the reader to take a specific action, such […]

The post Do You Need a Content Writer or a Copywriter? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content writing and copywriting sound like interchangeable terms, and while their domains may overlap on occasion, they’re two different things that serve two distinct functions. Put simply, good content writing engages the reader by providing informative and educational content about your industry and brand. Good copywriting compels the reader to take a specific action, such as buying a product, signing up for an email list, or subscribing to a blog.

So which one do you need when clients come to you to boost their business online: a content writer for your website or a web copywriter? The answer depends on the goals and objectives of the client’s campaign.

Nearly 100 percent of the time, though, you need both a content writer and a web copywriter. Here’s why:

Why You Need a Content Writer

Customers love buying things, but they hate the feeling of being sold. Navigating this dichotomy is one of the most challenging things in marketing. The most successful campaigns don’t push products and services on customers. Rather, they give customers a reason to buy and make them feel like it’s their idea.

Do you need a content writer or copywriter?

That’s where content writing comes in. Rather than always trying to sell, sell, sell, content writing provides value to the reader.

Let’s pretend your client runs a mortgage brokerage. The client wants to increase their online presence and capture leads from people searching the internet for information about mortgages. You help the client set up their website. Now it’s time to populate it with content.

Purely sales content doesn’t give the customer what they’re looking for, and it doesn’t inspire their confidence. There’s a time and place to switch into sales mode. But that comes after your client has built a rapport with the customer and earned the customer’s trust.

The way to build rapport and trust with a website or blog is through content marketing — using a well-defined content strategy to get a customer visit a page or fill out a lead form. It gives the customer something of use to them — such as detailed explanations of different mortgage types – without requiring anything of the customer in return.

It also establishes your client as an authority in their niche. It’s easier to sell to clients after you’ve demonstrated the depth of your knowledge and competence. According to Caleb Chen, Founder at The Highest Critic, “content writers are usually/ideally subject matter experts in the industry for which they’re going to be writing content. This allows them to bring context and expert opinion to their content when compared with a copywriter. Generally, a content writer will be more costly than a copywriter.”

Why You Need a Web Copywriter

Anyone who has ever watched a sales movie understands the importance of closing. Remember the iconic scene with Alec Baldwin in Glengarry Glen Ross, where he delivers the ABCs of sales: Always Be Closing?

ALSO What is Copywriting?

It’s true. If your client doesn’t use their content to compel a specific action, then they’re essentially just a free source of information.

That’s why good copywriting goes hand in hand with good content writing. Your client’s content writing establishes trust and provides value to the reader. Their copywriting calls the reader to action and closes the sale. Says Chen, “copywriters are generally people who have a solid writing and editing skill base and can be trusted to write grammatically correct copy for any purpose — but don’t often have experience in the industry for which their copy is being generated.”

While the two types of writer vary in their expertise, their skill set, and often, their cost, the interplay between content writing and copywriting forms the crux of a winning online marketing campaign.

A Place for Both in the Customer Journey

By now you understand the difference between copywriting and content writing in a theoretical, goal-oriented sense: content provides educational, valuable, and relevant information about a brand, while copy is used to convince audience members to take an action. But what does it look like in practice?

Sunny Ashley, CEO of Autoshopinvoice, helps put the concepts on more accessible ground: “The difference between the two boils down to their end goals and deliverables. The end goal for content writers is to enhance SEO and build a following. Their content is targeted more towards the top-of-the-funnel. Their performance is ultimately judged on things like page visits and keyword rankings.

Sunny Ashley Autoshopinvoice Quote

Conversely, a copywriter’s is to convert leads into sales. Their content should be less about brand awareness and more about persuasion and calls-to-action. Conversion metrics, form submissions, and new signups are better indicators for success for copywriters.”

Content: First Steps Toward Your Marketing Goals

Content writing serves a few different purposes, including audience awareness, brand recognition, and lead generation. It comes in a wide variety of different packages, from emails and social media posts to blog posts, press releases, well-researched white papers, and e-books.

Imagine you’re building a campaign for a new brand. You don’t have an audience that you can send sales letters or conversion-optimized emails to, so you have to start at square one with a content marketing campaign. You hire a writer to write content related to your brand, something with mass appeal to your audience; preferably, something that brings to light a problem that can be solved by the products or services you’re selling.

Once you have a strong, engaging piece of content, you can strategically deploy it in ways that will best reach a cold “top-of-funnel” audience.

Whether it’s via paid traffic on Google or Facebook, organic social media, an email campaign, or successfully ranking for your target keywords, the next step is driving traffic to your content. When a prospect clicks on a link in any of these channels, they might be taken to a landing page that advertises what they’ll be able to read or download in exchange for submitting some simple information, like their name and email address or phone number — this is called gated content.

Side note: the writing on landing pages tends to be a mix of content and copy; it continues to engage the audience while using the value of the content to persuade them to take the desired action.

Now, you’ve put together a list of leads and you’re starting to grow an audience that has engaged with your brand and is looking forward to what you’ll give them next. That’s when it’s time for marketing copy to take the stage.

Copy: The Hitter That Cleans Up the Leads

Writing copy is all about understanding what the audience wants to hear in order to take the next step in the buyer journey. Luckily, having all clicked on the same piece of content, your audience is filled with prospects that have similar priorities to each other.

What Copywriting Can Do for Your Business

Conversion-based sales copy is then deployed through email, direct mail, and other channels that directly advertise the products or services of the brand. It also fills the pages of your website so that anyone who visits is automatically engaged by compelling writing. In this case, copywriting follows up on the awareness of the customer’s problem, strongly positioning your brand as the solution.

Christian Antonoff, a content writer at Independent Fashion Bloggers, says, “the copywriter’s role is to sell products and services by appealing to your senses and emotions. They write persuasive copy targeting brands, selling the notion of needing them in your life.”

But What About Writing that Serves Neither Purpose?

This is actually a trick question: writing that is neither copy nor content has no place in today’s digital marketplace. Some marketing managers will look at certain types of writing and see it as filler; placeholder text to take up space on a page. But, this is a counterintuitive way to think about writing. After all, if any text on your website, blog, or emails isn’t being written to accomplish a goal, what’s the point?

Are Copy and Content Becoming Less Distinguishable?

At the same time, as the world of digital marketing continues to evolve, finding a writer with skills in copywriting and content writing becomes increasingly valuable. Google’s search engine algorithm gets more sophisticated with every new update, becoming better equipped to find and elevate valuable content of all kinds up the list of search results. As the burden shifts away from the rigid guidelines of SEO, the lines between copywriting and content creation will blur even more.

And, there’s mounting evidence that Google values pages and content that have strong engagement metrics. People engage with good content if it provides value to them, but they’re more likely to visit other pages on your site and convert if you also employ strong copywriting. Using both types of writing together can help you boost your overall engagement.

As Isaac Hammelburger, Owner & Founder at SearchPros.co, puts it, there’s no better time for a diversified skill set as a writer: “As the marketing world continues to evolve, the roles of content and copywriters are blurred, but this is exactly what people need now. Writers have to learn a little bit of the other side to take full advantage of their talents.”

What is the role of a content writer?

Some feel that the difference between the two is nearly obsolete. Adriana Tica is the Founder and Owner of Idunn, and having worked with writers for a long time, is beginning to see them as indistinguishable. “Both of them actually need to write copy and content that sells and converts”, she says. “A blog post with a cleverly placed CTA can convert as much as a long-form sales page. An insightful white paper can bring a lot of sales if written and marketed correctly -— we’ve seen this happen for a lot of our clients. Our point of difference has always been that we create both copy and content that aligns [with] our clients’ financial goals. And we know that both content writing and copywriting can bring sales and conversions.

So, Do You Need a Content Writer or Copywriter For Your Project?

As we’ve discussed, both types of writer have a role in moving your audience through the customer journey. But, what type of content should you assign to each type of writer?

Here’s a quick summary.

Content Writers

You’ll want to send content that is meant inform and engage to content writers. Common content types to send them include articles, blog posts, ebooks, guides, white papers and social media posts. You may also need to find a subset of content writers – technical writers – if you have complex documents to create like how to manuals, reference documents, etc.

Copywriters

Writing that is meant to compel action should be sent to copywriters. Common content types include advertisements, brochures, city pages, landing pages, print ads and collateral, website copy, social media updates, and more.

Mentioned earlier, but one example of the line between content writing and copywriting getting blurry is advertorials. These are short content pieces that look like blog posts or personal stories, inform them reader, but then also compel them to take action. These are very common on Facebook now.

Do you need a content writer or a copywriter?

The Takeaway

The easiest way to determine if your client needs a content writer or a web copywriter is to ask this question:

Is my client looking to build their brand and become an authority in their industry, or are they trying to close the sale and compel customers to take a particular action?

Chances are, they want to do both. And for that reason, having a winning content writer and a winning web copywriter on the job is vital for producing a successful campaign. The outlook for the future suggests that finding a writer who can master both skills will give your client the agility to accomplish their marketing goals even more easily.

Need help with your web copy or blogs? Fill out our contact form or call us at (888) 983-3103 to learn about our engaging content solutions.

ALSO Who’s on Your Business Content Writing Team and How Do You Manage Them?

The post Do You Need a Content Writer or a Copywriter? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/copywriting/content-writer-or-copywriter/feed/ 0
How to Write Service Descriptions https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-write-service-descriptions/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-write-service-descriptions/#respond Thu, 25 Jun 2020 17:00:47 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28462 According to SEMrush, product content is one of the top three most important factors for winning online sales. It’s second only to price and delivery time. Product content is the information on your site that explains what you sell and how it benefits consumers — when your product is a service, this content comes in the […]

The post How to Write Service Descriptions appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
According to SEMrush, product content is one of the top three most important factors for winning online sales. It’s second only to price and delivery time. Product content is the information on your site that explains what you sell and how it benefits consumers — when your product is a service, this content comes in the form of service descriptions.

What Are Service Descriptions?

Service descriptions are like product descriptions. But instead of describing tangible goods, you’re describing the services that you provide, including what you do, some basics about how you do it and why people should care about the service.

How many service pages you have on your site depends on what you offer and how you want to market it. It also might depend on your content marketing budget. You definitely want to highlight your main services with their own description pages. Check out the table below for examples of the types of service pages you might see on various business websites.

Type of BusinessPotential Service Pages
DentistRoutine dental care, teeth cleanings, crowns or fillings, dental bridges
PlumberToilet repair, sink repair, pipe replacement, new construction plumbing
HVAC CompanyHVAC repair, HVAC service and maintenance, new HVAC installations
Tutorelementary tutoring, math, language arts, chemistry, biology
Divorce LawyerNo-contest divorce, contested divorce, child custody, mediation

How to Write a Service Description: 7 Tips

Once you decide how many service pages you need and what services you should highlight, it’s time to create the service description content. Check out some tips below for creating service description pages that are likely to perform in SERPs and convert consumers who arrive to your pages.

1. Scope Out the Competition in SERPs

Start by checking out the competition. Search your keywords and look at the pages in the top three spots. What are they doing and how can you do it better?

(Okay, technically you start with keyword research so you know what your keywords are. TBH, we’re assuming if you know you need service descriptions, you know you need keywords and keyword research.)

Matthew Rogers, a search analyst and senior editor at Mango Matter, says he analyzes service descriptions that are ranking in SERPs before creating his own. “I work on the premise that every page Google promotes on page one is there for a reason,” says Rogers, “and success can often be reverse engineered.”

How to Write Service Descriptions - Scope Out the Competition

2. Focus on Your Customer

But you can’t let analytics reign over your content at the expense of the consumer. Rogers notes,”The most difficult part of writing service descriptions is balancing the need to please the user while pleasing Googlebot.”

It’s not enough to shove the ranking keywords into your service description and show up high in the page rankings. Your content must also:

  • Align with searcher intent
  • Provide relevant, helpful information to the user
  • Persuade the user to take the next action in the sales funnel

In addition to doing your keyword research, make sure you have a target consumer and that you understand their needs and preferences. That way, you can create content for your service description that speaks specifically to the target audience.

3. Use Feature/Benefit Writing

One of the best ways to speak to the consumer’s needs and desires is via feature/benefit writing. This is common in product descriptions, and you should employ it in writing about services too.

Feature/benefit doesn’t just tell the consumer what you do. It tells them what you do for them (the feature) and why they should care (the benefit). Check out some example feature benefit pairs below to better understand this type of content.

Potential service page on:Might include this feature:Which pairs with this benefit:
Toilet repairs24-hour service optionsNo need to wait or deal with emergency water or inconvenience
Child custody legal servicesFree consultationAbility to understand options to make an educated choice before hiring an attorney
Math tutorSAT prepCreates confidence going in to important standardized testing
Teeth cleaningsFriendly staff experienced with nervous patientsMakes cleanings less anxiety-inducing and helps ensure pain-free experience

4. Make Service Descriptions Scannable

No matter how great your feature/benefit copy is, most people will skip the entire page if you present your service description as a big block of text. It’s daunting and annoying—especially on mobile.

Instead, break your content up into scannable chunks by using subheadings, small paragraphs, bulleted and numbered lists, block quotes, call outs and images. Check out our service page on article writing for an example of friendly scannable content with plenty of white space.

Writing Tip for Service Descriptions

5. Include Various Content and Media Formats

Remember that not everyone prefers text-based messaging, and some people engage much better with images or video. That means they’re more likely to remember your message later when it’s time to make a purchase. Incorporate various media formats by:

  • Explaining services using videos and infographics
  • Showing services in action in photos
  • Integrating consumer reviews and testimonials to back up your claims

6. Don’t Try to Do Too Much With One Service Page

To perform in SERPs and with users, your service pages have to answer pretty specific intents and questions.

For example, someone looking for toilet repair might be interested in some basic information about new toilet installation—especially if it’s information to help them decide between a new item or repairing the existing one. But they probably aren’t going to want to read an entire page devoted to sinks.

Ensure your service page comprehensively answers the intent of the search regarding a service, but leave tangential information to its own page. You can certainly mention that you also install sinks, but instead of going into detail, link to your sink installation service page.

Plan out your service description pages ahead of time so you can ensure you cover all the most important services and that they each go on their own page.

7. Include a Relevant, Clear Call to Action

Finally, don’t leave the consumer hanging. Be specific about the action you want them to take to engage your services.

Include buy now, get a quote or contact us buttons—and do so where the consumer can see them. If they’re buried somewhere seven scrolls below the fold, they won’t do you any good.

You should also give a concise explanation of what the consumer can expect when they act. For example: They’ll call to schedule a free consultation or drop their email in a form and someone will contact them within 24 hours.

Website Call to Action Ideas

Get Professional Help Writing Service Descriptions

Service descriptions can be hard to write well as they rely on a balance of SEO and strong marketing copy. Contact Crowd Content to find out how our experienced copywriters can help you create service descriptions that perform in the search engines and convert consumers into customers.

ALSO – How to Scale Your Agency By White Labeling Content Writing

The post How to Write Service Descriptions appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-write-service-descriptions/feed/ 0
7 Shopify Product Description Writing Tips https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/writing-product-descriptions-for-shopify-7-tips-for-creating-copy-that-sells/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/writing-product-descriptions-for-shopify-7-tips-for-creating-copy-that-sells/#respond Fri, 05 Jun 2020 19:00:14 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28384 In mid-2019, more than 800,000 merchants across the globe were using Shopify. With COVID-19 pushing online shopping to even new heights, Shopify saw more growth in early 2020. Whether you’re launching your first ecommerce shop or you’ve been a Shopify mainstay for some time, you may be looking to differentiate yourself from the growing crowd […]

The post 7 Shopify Product Description Writing Tips appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
In mid-2019, more than 800,000 merchants across the globe were using Shopify. With COVID-19 pushing online shopping to even new heights, Shopify saw more growth in early 2020. Whether you’re launching your first ecommerce shop or you’ve been a Shopify mainstay for some time, you may be looking to differentiate yourself from the growing crowd of online retailers. One way to do that is via high-quality, unique Shopify product descriptions.

Benefits of Quality, Compelling Shopify Product Descriptions

Compelling product descriptions entice readers to move from consideration or early decision stages through to the final purchase. They help convince visitors that your product is the one they’re looking for.

Just as important, quality descriptions help improve the SEO of your product pages. That makes it more likely they show up in Google searches, which is where the bulk of people start when they’re looking to make an online purchase.

By improving your Shopify store’s product descriptions, you can drive increased sales. According to Guillem Hernandez, a key account manager with Crisp Studio, simply making positive changes to product descriptions has helped his clients increase conversions by up to 10% or more.

Calloway Cook, President of Illuminate Labs, says his team has seen similar results. “Taking actions such as improving product description copy and creating an interlinking strategy resulted in a 10% month-over-month increase in traffic without any additional blog content added,” says Cook. He attributes the growth solely to the improvements in product page copy.

Calloway Cook Shopify Product Description Quote

How Do You Write Compelling Shopify Product Descriptions?

If a 10% increase in conversion rates or traffic sounds like something you want to get in line for, here’s a quick crash course on how you can create compelling Shopify product descriptions that also improve your SEO.

1. Be Concise

“Copywriting for product pages has to be concise,” says Cook. “Consumers don’t want to read huge blocks of text. The shorter you can distill the important information that separates your products from competitors, the better.”

But what’s the right content length for a perfect product description? As with all content, the answer is: It depends.

The more complex your product — typically meaning it has more features and benefits — the longer your copy might be. You might also need longer copy for certain luxury items, because you may be making a case for lifestyle benefits for them.

Ultimately, your Shopify description must be long enough to convey the important features and benefits to the reader in a concise, scannable way. If that’s 50 words, great. If it’s 500, also great, but remember to break it up with subheadings and bulleted lists to make it easier to read.

Also note that your target word count will depend on your SEO competition. Use a tool like MarketMuse, Inked, or SEMrush to determine the average word counts for the pages that are currently ranked in the top 10 results of Google for your target keyword. If your competition averages 500 words for example, you probably want to be inline with that. 

2. Don’t Leave Out Important Details

“As per my observation, around 50% of the shoppers are learned enough and have already done enough research to know the specs they need for themselves. So, saying ‘This battery is awesome and lasts for the longest time’ doesn’t serve the purpose,” says Hernandez. “I would rather replace it with something like ‘This battery lasts for 60 hours’ to incite more impression.”

Writing Product Descriptions for Shopify

He also notes that around 20% of conversions fail because the product information is missing or unclear.

Include all relevant information in your product descriptions by starting with the Voice of the Customer (VOC). Ask yourself: Who are your customers, and what do they need and want? How familiar are they with these products? How do your products provide solutions to the customer’s challenges? The answers to these questions help you determine the most important factors for your Shopify product descriptions.

3.  Highlight the Value Proposition

“A potential customer is looking for a product that satisfies his requirements. That’s why an ideal product description should focus on HOW your product is solving your audience’s needs. This is what a potential buyer is interested in,” says Hernandez.

“We find it most effective to use simple language and short sentences with descriptive language that recreates the experience of using the product in your customer’s mind,” says Jessica Rose, CEO of Copper H20. “The copy should make the customer excited about the product without over-promising.”

Jessica Rose Copper H20 Quote

In short, your product description should never just be a description. You don’t need to spend the words to explain that this is a round widget with a tapered top that’s painted in a dual tone of red and black with three stripes. Pictures really are worth a thousand words, so some of that explanation is made obsolete if you include good product pictures (and you should be doing this!). Plus, a lot of basic spec information is included in your spec list; if you include that information again in a narrative format, there has to be a reason.

Focus on feature-benefit copy. Mention a feature and then explain why it’s beneficial or how the customer might use it. In the example of the round widget, you might say, “A tapered top makes this widget easy to install into your existing system, and the three black stripes provide a guide for how far the widget should be inserted for each use type.” Suddenly the color and shape of the widget aren’t just description — they’re compelling reasons someone might buy this widget instead of others.

4. Use Your Brand Voice

Even if you’re reselling products from manufacturers, your product descriptions should be in your brand voice. In fact, it’s even more important in that case, because your brand is what sets you apart from other resellers. Whether it’s funny, friendly, professional or some combination of various traits, make sure your voice shines through without diminishing the information provided in the copy.

5. Create Unique Content

Many people simply copy product descriptions from the manufacturer’s page or use the same copy on multiple pages. But this isn’t the best way to create strong optimization and performance in search results.

“We have to be careful to avoid duplicate content red flags from Google when we have the same product shared across our three sites,” says Brian Lim, the CEO and founder of iHeartRaves.

Take the time and effort to create unique copy for all your products and pages to help improve SEO. This tactic also lets you test your copy to find what works best for your audience.

6. Use the Right Keywords

“Adding in keywords to help with SEO is critical to being found in search,” says Lim.

Conduct keyword research for various products and groups of products. Then, try to work one primary keyword and at least one long-tail or secondary keyword into each product description. For best results, try to get your primary keyword into the first sentence of the description. But don’t sacrifice clarity for the sake of keywords; you can also include it in the first paragraph.

On top of that, make sure that your product images are keyword optimized. Both the file name and the alt text of each image should contain targeted keywords. It’s important that your alt text reads naturally though as it’s primarily used by visually impaired people who rely on screen readers to dictate the text of sites to them. 

Alt Text Definition

If you have a lot of products to write copy for doing keyword research can be a tall task. In those cases, consider using keyword formulae. Our ebook, “The Complete Guide to Creating eCommerce Contnent at Scale” goes over this in detail. 

7. Tweak Product Descriptions Regularly

“Every site is different,” says Hernandez, “and every product requires its own approach. The best way to figure out is to do A/B testing on the product pages and gather the results to understand what works better for each store type.”

But it’s not just about what works best for each product page today. SEO and online shopping trends are constantly changing, so your product descriptions can’t be forever stagnant. “We suggest continuously revising product copy based on data to see what works best,” says Rose.

Leveraging Technology to Make Content Management Easier

One of the biggest challenges in creating content for an entire store is scaling. Most stores have large numbers of products, and doing the work to craft compelling product copy for all of them is a tall order. 

Each product likely needs:

  1. Keyword research
  2. Writing
  3. Editing
  4. SEO optimizations
  5. Publishing

Your store might even need more than these steps.

Every step takes time, and the more you can leverage technology to save you time allows you to get more done and be more competitive with your store.

At Crowd Content, we’ve built a Shopify app that helps with a great deal of this process. Once installed, the app lets you connect your Shopify catalog to your Crowd Content account so you can order custom written product descriptions for any number of your products with just a few clicks. With many skilled product copywriters, you can get content back in a matter of days, have it edited, and then even publish it back to your store with just a few clicks.

To get setup, all you need to do is create your Crowd Content account.

Then, visit Shopify’s App Store to install the app in your store. 

You’ll be prompted to connect your store to your Crowd Content account.

Then, you can login to your Crowd Content account and visit the Order Product Descriptions page.

A screenshot of a social media post

Description automatically generated

You’ll see an option to do a Shopify Import. This brings up a list of all your products, and you simply check the ones you want copy written for. Then, you can provide instructions for how the writers should tackle your project.

Within a few days you’ll start getting copy back. Once that happens, you’ll be asked if you want to publish the completed content on your store. Confirm, and the content will be posted instantly.

This can save you a lot of time in terms of writing, editing, and publishing which will let you spend more time on other areas of your business and scale up quicker. 

Scaling Shopify Product Descriptions Without Losing Quality

These seven tips are just the beginning of creating and maintaining high-quality product descriptions in your Shopify store. And if you have a lot of unique items, you might be balking at how much work you’re looking at.

But it’s work well worth doing. And you don’t have to do it all yourself!

Brian Lim Shopify Product Descriptions

“We have found it’s worth the investment and have hired professional copywriters,” says Lim. If you’re ready to hire professional copywriters who know how to spin compelling, concise Shopify product descriptions that convert, you can find thousands of freelance writers via Crowd Content. And if you’re not sure where to start and want help managing the entire process — from keyword research to building writing teams to editing for publish-ready content — find out more about our Enterprise content solutions.

ALSO – Using eCommerce Influencer Marketing to Drive your Brand Forward

The post 7 Shopify Product Description Writing Tips appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/writing-product-descriptions-for-shopify-7-tips-for-creating-copy-that-sells/feed/ 0
Who’s on Your Business Content Writing Team and How Do You Manage Them? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/whos-on-your-business-content-writing-team-and-how-do-you-manage-them/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/whos-on-your-business-content-writing-team-and-how-do-you-manage-them/#respond Wed, 27 May 2020 17:00:54 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28321 According to Econsultancy, content marketing and writing skills are second only to data analysis when it comes to importance for marketers. And while many people can learn to craft grammatically correct, optimized copy, the fact is that writing is somewhat of a talent. Not everyone can infuse marketing copy with enticing voice or create an informational […]

The post Who’s on Your Business Content Writing Team and How Do You Manage Them? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
According to Econsultancy, content marketing and writing skills are second only to data analysis when it comes to importance for marketers. And while many people can learn to craft grammatically correct, optimized copy, the fact is that writing is somewhat of a talent. Not everyone can infuse marketing copy with enticing voice or create an informational (and interesting) narrative for a heavy technical topic.

Econsultancy-Most-Impt-Future-Skill-for-Marketers-Feb2019
Source: MarketingCharts.com

Luckily, brands and marketing teams can easily add these critical skills to their projects by investing in business content writing teams. Here’s a look at why you should ensure you have the right people on your content writing team and how to create winning teams for any content project.

The Importance of a Writing Team

A writing team is like the engine that powers your content marketing vehicle. If you don’t have an engine, it doesn’t matter how great the exterior of the vehicle looks. It’s not going anywhere unless you put it on a trailer and pull it with someone else’s engine. And if your engine is too small (i.e., you don’t have the right writers or enough writers), your marketing vehicle can’t move quickly enough or burns itself up.

A writing team lets you shift gears quickly and easily move between all the critical aspects of marketing, including:

  • Content strategy
  • SEO
  • Social media
  • Website content creation

Benefits of Working With a Team of Writers for Your Business Content

Databox polled marketers to discover what areas the experts see people failing at when it comes to online marketing. When asked what areas brands and marketing teams were most likely to under-invest in, content quality and research was the clear winner (er…or loser, actually).

pasted-image-0
Source: Databox

Around 40% of respondents said companies didn’t invest enough in writing and content quality, often because they were chasing the latest SEO gimmick or technology they believe might vault them to the top of the SERPs. And while trends such as the featured snippet can help you gain organic search traction, SEO is a long game that requires authority, quality, engaging content.

The biggest benefit of working with a team of writers is that you’re better positioned to provide the type of content that wins SEO long games. Other benefits include:

  • You can rely on the creativity and brain power of more people to ensure your content is unique and relevant
  • Each writer has different skills, ensuring each type of content is highest quality
  • You don’t hitch your wagon to a single content creator, so if someone gets sick, has an emergency or becomes overburdened by the work, others can help out
Benefits of Working with a Writing Team

How Do You Build the Right Writing Team for Each Project?

Gintaras Steponkus is the marketing manager at Solidguides and points out that the right writers for one job aren’t necessarily the right people for another project. “We work on two major domains: business and tech,” says Steponkus. “We have 10 writing team members in total—half for the business domain and the other half for the tech. Roles are assigned based on their interests and academics.”

How Do You Build the Right Writing Team for Each Project?

But Steponkus doesn’t stop there. Writers for Solidguides content also specialize in the type of writing they do. “Different writers are dedicated to blogs, pitching, guest blogs, video creation content and podcasts scripts. Two managers handle the two teams and have expertise in their relevant domain.”

Who you put on your business content writing team depends on your needs and goals. At minimum, you might want:

  • Different writers who are qualified and experienced in writing for the types of content you require, including sales copywriters to handle conversion-focused pages, general writers for basic blog posts and social media writers who have the skills required to engage audiences in those specialty formats
  • One or more detail-oriented editors with experience in marketing and business content to tweak drafts
  • SEO experts to help identify what topics should be covered, how content should be formatted and what keywords to include
  • Project or content managers to oversee the flow of all the work and ensure each of these areas is communicating

Steponkus’s point is valid, though: Someone who can write witty, engaging social posts might not be as adept at writing informative, deeply researched white papers — and vice versa. You can definitely find writers that cover all those bases, but those are what Larry Kim of Mobile Monkey would call the unicorns. Which is to say: They’re rare.

Plus, even if your writer can pen everything from compelling, creative product descriptions to professional letters full of legal speak, you might not want to use them that way. Many writers prefer certain types of work and shine brightest when they’re allowed to do it, for example.

Ultimately, building your ideal business content writing team comes down to common sense measures and some trial and error. Use the steps below to get started.

  1. Identify your business content marketing goals.
  2. Determine what types of content you need to support those goals.
  3. Divide the content into major types and ask yourself: Do you want different writers for each category.
  4. Make a list of skills and experience writers might need to produce each type of content with excellence.
  5. Start adding writers who match those qualifications to your team.
Writing Team Hiring Checklist

Pro tip: You can use the Crowd Content self-serve marketplace search functions to find writers who have backgrounds in certain niches or who have written certain types of content before. You can also reach out to our customer support reps for help finding the ideal writers for any project — whether you need topic experts or generalists who can tackle a wide array of projects.

How to Drive a Successful Collaborative Writing Process

Once you build a business content writing team, don’t forget you have to manage them.

Danielle Clevy says her team is composed of in-house and freelance members including sales copywriters, substantive writers (for articles, longer blog posts and case studies) and junior and social media writers for shorter copy and social posts.

To manage all those writers, Clevy uses a variety of tools. “We use a combination of project management tools (Asana, mainly, though formerly Basecamp), Zoom for calls, Slack to keep us all in touch and build culture and sometimes Voxer. Each week, everyone is required to use our status template and report on their projects and hours worked.”

Project Management Tools for Writing Teams

However you manage your writing teams, the critical factor is communication. Checking in regularly with writers and other people on the team helps ensure people make deadlines and create content that works well for your campaigns.

Here’s a brief sneak peak of how our enterprise process works to provide a jumping off point in defining your own content process.

  1. We start by helping the client define what they need if they don’t already know. Before you can create a content process, you must know what type of content you need.
  2. We determine the steps each piece of content needs to go through and who is responsible for each steps. Steps might include:
    1. SEO and keyword research
    2. Fact and content research
    3. Creating instructions or briefs for the content
    4. Creating an editorial calendar with deadlines for each content creation step and publication
    5. Assigning content to writers
    6. Editing content
    7. Providing a final QA pass on content
    8. Formatting content
    9. Adding any last touches, such as images
    10. Pressing publish
  3. Once we know what steps are required and who is handling each one, we set everything up via our platform. In this third step, you might need to set up your project management tool so you can keep track of all the moving parts and communicate appropriately with everyone involved.
  4. We send out the work with all applicable instructions and deadline notifications.
  5. We receive the work back and review it, providing ample feedback as needed for revisions or just to ensure future work moves ever closer to the mark you’ve set.
  6. We finalize and publish content (or send it to our clients for this purpose).

You don’t have to handle writing team management on your own, though. If this sounds like a lot of work, consider Crowd Content Enterprise solutions, which include project management.

ALSO – How to Scale Your Agency By White Labeling Content Writing

The post Who’s on Your Business Content Writing Team and How Do You Manage Them? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/whos-on-your-business-content-writing-team-and-how-do-you-manage-them/feed/ 0
How to Optimize SEO for Bing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-optimize-for-bing/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-optimize-for-bing/#respond Wed, 13 May 2020 17:00:06 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28180 When it comes to optimizing content for search, any discussion is typically focused on Google. No surprise—Google not only transformed search, it remains the 800-pound gorilla.  But there are other search engines that many people use instead of Google. Among those, Microsoft’s Bing is a real factor. It also presents an opportunity to gain traction […]

The post How to Optimize SEO for Bing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
When it comes to optimizing content for search, any discussion is typically focused on Google. No surprise—Google not only transformed search, it remains the 800-pound gorilla. 

But there are other search engines that many people use instead of Google. Among those, Microsoft’s Bing is a real factor. It also presents an opportunity to gain traction quickly, as long as you take some steps to optimize for Bing. 

ALSOHire SEO Content Writers

Why should I care? The traffic potential of Bing

It’s fair to wonder if investing time and resources in Bing is worth it. After all, Google dominates every conversation about search. When people say they are doing SEO, it is generally assumed they are talking about optimizing their content for Google. 

If you look deeper, however, you’ll see that Google may not have the stranglehold you imagine. Yes, they are dominant—about 75% of all internet searches are done through Google.

But 75% isn’t 100%. Let’s talk about that other 25%—it’s significant market share and Bing has the biggest portion of it. 

As Morgan Taylor, CMO at LetMeBank, notes, “So many people are focused on Google SEO that they don’t even think about the fact that between 25% and 35% of users are going to use Bing as a search engine. The fact that most people are considering Google and not Bing indicates that Bing is going to be less competitive which means you have a better chance of having a higher ranking.”

Morgan Taylor LetMeBank Bing SEO Quote

For starters, Mozilla, the popular open-source browser, recently ended its relationship with Google. It has turned to Yahoo as its default search engine. Yes, that Yahoo. 

Why does Yahoo matter when we’re talking about Bing? Well, since October of 2019, Yahoo search has been powered by the Bing search engine. Optimize for Bing and you are basically doing the same for Yahoo—the Yahoo Webmaster Tools have been replaced by Bing Webmaster Tools. Many people have started to refer to it as the YBN—the Yahoo/Bing Network.

Together, Bing and Yahoo account for a serious chunk of search activity in the United States. The demographics of its users also make Bing attractive—roughly ⅓ of Bing users have annual incomes of $100,000 USD or more. What’s more, because many companies underestimate the value of Bing, it’s easier to rank well in search queries than it can be on Google since the competition is not as fierce. 

Bing SEO Stat

And what about the B2B audience? 57% of B2B marketers say search is their best lead source, and Bing has outsized numbers when it comes to reaching this audience. It makes sense—so many companies still work in Windows environments.  On these systems, Microsoft Edge is typically the default browser, and employees are often required. That means their default search engine whenever they’re at work is Bing. 

Here are eight ways to improve your search results on Bing. 

1. Learn Bing Webmaster Tools

Part of optimizing for Bing is using and understanding Bing Webmaster Tools. If you rely on the tools that Google provides—and you should—make sure you’re getting the most out of them on Bing as well. 

For starters, it’s powerful. There’s a great dashboard, a tech diagnostics panel, a keyword research tool, a controller for managing outbound links, a reporting tool, and more. 

Bing Webmaster Tools

Together, these features make it easy to track overall search performance, the Click-Through Rates from each search, pages that were crawled and indexed, and the top organic search keywords. You’ll need a Microsoft account to use Bing Webmaster Tools, but if you want to rank well on this search engine, you really need to use it. 

For instance, if you’re finding it’s taking a while for Bing to find your site and do a crawl, Bing Webmaster Tools has a feature called Crawl Control. Use it to set a crawl rate and specify the time of day when you want your site to be crawled. Before you do that, however, make sure your site map is sparkly clean. Just like in Google, Bing has little patience for “dirt” in a site map—too many 404 redirects, for instance, will result in your site being penalized in search rankings. You also need to manage your 301 and 302 redirects well—remember that a 301 redirect will be treated as permanent while a 302 redirect is viewed as a temporary change by search engines. The best practice is to make sure that all your permanent redirects are written as 301s. 

Finally, as much as we believe Bing has real value, you do want to ensure that your efforts to optimize for it don’t damage or hinder your SERP on Google. Use the panel in Bing Webmaster Tools to diagnose and analyze results—and compare them to Google. If you see your SERP on Google dip because of your work with Bing, you may need to make some adjustments. 

2. Take Care of Bing Ranking Factor Basics

Some of the first steps you take to optimize for Bing are similar to tasks you need to complete with Google. 

In Bing Webmaster Tools, submit your site and provide the URL with your site’s XML site map. Then make sure your site is tagged and categorized, if you haven’t already done that. Ensure robots.txt allows indexing and Bing should find it, but it doesn’t hurt to submit it as well. Once these details are handled, you should begin to see rankings improve. 

It’s also valuable to use Bing Places for Business—create a new listing or claim ownership of an existing one. This is especially important for local search. 

3. Insist on Quality Content

Like Google, optimizing content for Bing means ensuring quality. Both search engines serve their customers by providing quick access to content that matches their needs and answers the questions they’re asking. 

First, it needs to be relevant. But it also needs to be complete—both Google and Bing seem to be rewarding content of greater length than in the past, believing that it indicates more thoroughly researched material and greater comprehensiveness. 

Make sure your content is information-rich and valuable to the reader. While Bing may have a more old-fashioned take on keywords than Google does, it still rejects content from its rankings when it believes there is keyword stuffing. Images with text, video, infographics—use these to enhance the experience for the user and improve the rank of your site in Bing.

Remember to factor in these elements when creating quality content for Bing: 

  • Be comprehensive and satisfy search intent.
  • Write in a style that is appropriate for your target audience.
  • Source the information and credit the author whenever possible.
  • Format and present content in a way that is easy to follow. 
  • Maintain a clear distinction between sponsored and owned content.   

4. Use Keywords Correctly

Target keywords are just as critical with Bing as they are with Google, but there are subtle differences. 

Bing, for instance, places more importance on exact match keywords, in a way that is a bit more like the way Google did in its early days. Topic completeness also matters—every search engine wants to point users to results that answer as many questions as possible. 

Semantic keywords are less valuable. This can be challenging when you’re trying to rank on both search engines since Google can view that as keyword stuffing, especially if your content doesn’t flow naturally or fails to completely address the topic. 

That said, Bing is still looking for quality content. Just try to find a balance—get your exact match keywords in without stuffing. 

Overall, Bing can be considered slightly less advanced because it relies more on some legacy search factors when it comes to ranking. Exact match domains, the use of specific keywords in headings, title tags—all of these appear to carry more weight as the ranking factors. 

While Google may now incorporate other elements in its algorithm, these elements still carry clout in its rankings, too. In other words, you’re unlikely to hurt your results on Google by making sure these details score well with Bing. In the long run, the work will yield positive results. 

5. Push User Engagement

According to Tonya Davis, Marketing Manager at ThoughtLab, “One of Bing’s largest ranking factors is user engagement. So ensuring you have a low bounce rate is going to play a critical role in your rankings. This means monitoring your Bing Webmaster tools and using various tactics to improve user engagement is key.”

Tonya Davis Bing SEO Quote

Whether you’re trying to rank for Bing or not, it’s a good practice to monitor this anyway. Google may not place quite the same premium on bounce rate as Bing does, but the two search engines have begun to converge around many of the same factors. For instance, both are beginning to rely more on RankBrain, a machine learning artificial intelligence system, to drive search results. 

Finally, and again this is true for any search engine, backlinks matter. But they do seem to carry more weight on Bing than Google. Marcu Tober, CTO and Founder of Searchmetrics, notes that, “The number of backlinks seems to be the most relevant metric for Bing.”

Here’s how Bing explains their approach to backlinks. 

“The site linking to your content is essentially telling Bing they trust your content…Bing rewards links that have grown organically…links that have been added over time by content creators on other trusted, relevant websites made to drive real users from their site to your site…links buying, participating in link schemes (link farms, link spamming and excessive link manipulation) can lead to your site being delisted from the Bing index.”

6. Use Social Media to Drive Bing Search

Bing makes no secret of the importance it places on social media. It may see this as a way to differentiate itself from Google, and it’s definitely a key ranking factor. 

Bing places more importance on user engagement. The search engine values connections to social media influencers and a consistent presence in social media channels. 

According to Bing’s own webmaster guidelines, “Social media plays a role in today’s effort to rank well in search results.  The most obvious part it plays is via influence.  If you are a social influencer, your followers tend to share your information widely, which in turn results in Bing seeing these positive signals.  These positive signals can have an impact on how your site ranks organically in the long run.”

In addition to social influencers, Bing places a premium on things like Shares, Likes, and Comments, since it indicates the level of engagement it values. Encourage your customers to be active on your site, and use your social media brand to build your audience.

Make sure your main ranking pages are ones that perform well on social media. If Bing sees traffic move from social to your site, and that is followed through with a low Bounce Rate, you will eventually be rewarded with higher rankings on Bing. 

7. Turn to Bing as a Tool for B2B

Were you surprised about the size of the group that uses Bing for search? Well, you should also consider some of the specific industries that rely on Bing more than Google. 

Bing can be a valuable tool for B2B, especially in categories such retail, finance, and technology. In these sectors, perhaps owing to the popularity of platforms such as Yahoo Finance, Bing has traction. And remember—the Windows operating system still powers desktops in the corporate world, and many companies require their employees to use Edge as their browser. And using Edge is going to mean they will most likely use Bing.

If you’re trying to reach a B2B audience, don’t ignore Bing—both organically and with Bing Ads. This platform can be especially valuable for smaller companies up against larger competitors or startups that with bootstrapping budgets. As with organic search, the competition is less intense, so the Cost-Per-Click is lower than it is when you use Google Ads. 

8. Try Bing Places

Geographic targeting has real value when you’re working to rank in Bing. While you can focus on audiences this way through the structure of your website, Bing lets you indicate the location of your audience by using Bing Places.

Image showing Bing Places for Business

Free to join, simple and straightforward, using Bing Places also helps you optimize for Bing search rankings. Within Bing Webmaster Tools, you’ll find the instructions you need to list your business—they’re easy to follow. Bing Places is an important tool for local SEO, and works in a way that is very similar to My Business from Google. 

Is this the Big Bing?

Well, that might be a stretch. No SEO expert sees the importance and dominance of Google diminishing anytime soon.

But Bing is a channel that far too many companies ignore. There are clear benefits to optimizing quality content for Bing—less competition, an opportunity to leverage social media, a demographic that skews slightly higher, a B2B slant. Make sure your site is Bing-ready, compare the results to Google, and you will eventually see the value of your efforts.

ALSO – Black Hat SEO Tactics That Work in 2020, But Might Not For Long

The post How to Optimize SEO for Bing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-optimize-for-bing/feed/ 0
Creating Content For Every Step of The Buyer’s Journey https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/creating-content-for-every-step-of-the-buyers-journey/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/creating-content-for-every-step-of-the-buyers-journey/#respond Wed, 06 May 2020 17:00:13 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=28054 If you’re not creating content for every step of the buyer’s journey, you’re literally leaking conversions and profits. Let’s look at how to support buyers’ through their journeys to maximize conversion rates and marketing ROI. Need a hand creating content? Connect with the best content writers on the web. What Is the Buyer’s Journey? The […]

The post Creating Content For Every Step of The Buyer’s Journey appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
If you’re not creating content for every step of the buyer’s journey, you’re literally leaking conversions and profits. Let’s look at how to support buyers’ through their journeys to maximize conversion rates and marketing ROI.

Need a hand creating content? Connect with the best content writers on the web.

What Is the Buyer’s Journey?

The buyer’s journey is the process by which someone decides they need to buy something and then goes about making that purchase. The journey typically involves three stages.

  • Awareness, when the person becomes aware of a need, problem or want.
  • Consideration, when that problem or need is defined and the consumer starts to look for solutions
  • Decision, when a solution is chosen and a purchase made

The buyer journey exists for every purchase, albeit at different scale. Consider the three scenarios below to understand how varied buying journeys can be.

Image showing Buyer Journey Scenarios 1

Why Do You Need Content for Every Stage of the Buyer’s Journey?

You can see from the table above that buyers’ journeys can be very short or extremely long. But you can capture consumer interest (and the chance at a conversion) at any stage of the journey. Unfortunately, so can your competition.

That means you can’t aim content at a single stage. If you concentrate solely on the awareness stage, for example, you might educate a lot of consumers about why a certain solution is important. But if competitors are doing a good job at creating content for the consideration stage and you’re not addressing it, all you’re doing is priming consumers to fall into the funnel for other companies.

To capture consumer attention and keep them coming back all the way to the decision stage, you must create content that’s relevant throughout the journey.

What Topics Should Be Covered for Each Stage of the Journey?

But what topics should you cover to ensure you’re connecting with consumers at every stage? It depends on your audience, products and niche. 

Polly Kay, senior marketing manager at English Blinds, says, “Driving conversions involves putting yourself in the prospect’s position and learning what their motivations, pain points and incentives are and preempting them by supporting them with informative content.”

Content for the Buyer Journey

Kay’s advice holds true for every stage of the funnel. Here are three ways to learn what those motivations and pain points are for your target audience.

1. SEO and Keyword Research

Jacon Edwards-Bytom, director of ecommerce for Made4Fighters, says, “Targeting long-tail keywords…helps you expand the top of the funnel. Long-tail keywords are not terms that usually have purchase intent, but they can help build awareness for your brand.”

In short, Edwards-Bytom is pointing out that content for the awareness and consideration stages must align with the keywords used by and the intent of consumers looking for more information about these problems and solutions. According to Forrester research, more than 70% of consumers start their buying journeys with search engines; almost three-quarters consult search engines during consideration and decision stages. 

Content for the Buyer Journey Stat

If you’re not doing the keyword research to understand what people are searching for in various stages of the funnel, you’re potentially missing connections with 75% of the market.

2. Customer Interviews

Don’t leave any source unturned in your search to find out what the customer needs or wants to know. 

Linda Emma is the head of content at ESM Digital and says knowing your audience is key. “Whether you build out personas or rely on your sales database, gather as much information as you can about who your current customers are. You can’t build effective content without knowing who will consume it.”

Knowing Your Buyer Persona is Key

Many brands overlook one of the best ways to get to know who their customers are: Simply ask them. Take time to engage clients when you’re talking to them and ask questions that might inform your content. You can also conduct customer interviews or use survey and market research tools to learn more about your audience. You might try Survey Monkey, which is a free online tool, if you don’t have a CRM solution or other software with survey or customer feedback functionality.

3. Sales Team Feedback

“The best tip for creating content for all stages of the buyer journey is to align your content marketing team with your sales team,” says Carsten Schaefer, CEO of crowdy.ai “A lot of times, the content you create is completely unaligned with what the customers really need to make decisions. The sales team is at the frontlines, and they interact with customers all day long. They know exactly how you can connect with your ideal target audience, what content format you should use and which topics you should cover.”

Schaefer said once his marketing team started involving the sales team in content creation talks and processes, the brand’s conversion rates related to content rose from 1.9% to 3.1%. That’s an increase of more than 60% just by communicating between departments to align with customer needs.

Distribute Content Effectively Throughout the Buyer’s Journey Using Multiple Channels

Talk of content marketing often has people thinking of their website, and you definitely need something for every stage of the journey on your site. Informative blog posts can be great for awareness and consideration stages, buying guides can help shepherd people through consideration, and product descriptions and landing pages may be the push someone needs to finalize the decision stage.

But effective distribution of content requires reaching your audience in other ways too. You can’t rely solely on consumers arriving on the right website page at the right time during their journey. Integrate some or all of the following channels to widen your net and drive more leads and conversions.

Emails

Newsletters let you inform existing subscribers of new products and services and continue to connect with people during consideration stages. Drip campaigns are useful for engaging buyers as they move from consider to decision stages, and cart abandonment messages can help remind someone they were ready to make a decision and why you have the right product for them.

Best for: Consideration and decision stages, but can also be used to capture leads during awareness stages.

Social Media

Many people actually use social as a search engine these days. More than half of social media users research products and brands via social networks, and many actually start there by looking up a brand’s profile page or asking for recommendations from others.

Keeping your social profiles fresh by posting your own content, sharing posts from others and interacting via likes and comments engages your audience. It also keeps your brand in consumer minds as people go through the buyer journey — and makes it more likely you’ll show up from the start for those who start their journey on social.

Best for: Engaging people during consideration stages or connecting for the first time before or during awareness stages. Social posts and ads can also work well in decision stages for certain types of products, such as apps or impulse-buy products.

Online Ads

When targeted correctly, quality online ads can drive high conversion rates. Data analytics company Heap found that Google ads drove an average conversion rate of more than 8%, for example. Online ads also let you connect with consumers in all stages of the buyer’s journey.

Best for: Showing up on consumer’s radar during awareness stages via targeted advertising and ensuring an ongoing connection during consideration and early decision stages via retargeting.

Tips for Nudging People Through the Funnel

It’s not enough simply to reach a consumer during the buying journey, though. Your content must connect with them and shepherd them through the rest of the journey so they’re more likely to buy your product. Here are four tips for doing so.

1. Don’t leave the consumer in doubt.

Saj Devshi, a digital lead for EasyMerchant.co.uk, says it’s important to ensure landing pages don’t leave prospects in doubt about whether your product is right for them. 

“What we try to do is remove as many barriers or obstacles as possible by creating a FAQ for each of our products with the most commonly searched queries related to that product,” says Devshi. “This gives them more confidence in what they are buying and that it is right for them and also reduces our costs, particularly in terms of having to deal with returns and refunds.”

The proof of this strategy is in the numbers. According to Devshi, Easy Merchant improved its conversion rate from 1% to 4% by using it.

How to Inspire Buyer Confidence

2. Provide step-by-step instruction without boring the audience. 

Your content should guide the reader, not leave them hanging and wondering what to do. Rhea Henry, a content strategist with EnergyRates.ca, says content should inform readers about how to accomplish the next step.

“It helps to go into as much detail as you can to help them do each step without becoming dull and dry,” says Henry. She says to tell consumers, “where they can go, what do they do, how do they do it, [because] each time they have to click out of your article to find the solution is a chance you lost the opportunity to convert.”

3. Make use of retargeting technology.

But do assume that some consumers will click away or not complete the buying journey on their first session on your site. Invest in retargeting ads to bring them back to your product.

Morgan Taylor is the CMO for LetMeBank and highly recommends tapping into Google Site Analytics. “This will allow you to assess how long a person spends on each page, where they exit your site and [other information],” says Taylor. “Then you can retarget with ads that address only the topics they care about. Or, call them out for exiting a particular page.”

4. Perfect your internal links.

You work hard to get someone to your site. Make sure your internal linking strategy is on point. Taylor says, “Your internal linking strategy must be perfect. You need to be sure you’re funneling readers further down your sale funnel and not into dead ends.”

Need Help Creating Content for Every Stage of Your Buyers’ Journeys?

Whether you’re looking for whimsical product descriptions to entice your target audience or hard-hitting sales landing pages that leave nothing on the table, Crowd Content can help. Check out our self-serve marketplace, where you can connect with thousands of high-quality writers, or reach out for more information about how our enterprise solutions can support your online marketing campaigns.

ALSO – 5 Ways To Make Your Content Budget Go Further

The post Creating Content For Every Step of The Buyer’s Journey appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/creating-content-for-every-step-of-the-buyers-journey/feed/ 0
The Long-Term Value of Content and Why You Shouldn’t Put Off Creating It in the Short -Term https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-long-term-value-of-content-and-why-you-shouldnt-put-off-creating-it-in-the-short-term/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-long-term-value-of-content-and-why-you-shouldnt-put-off-creating-it-in-the-short-term/#respond Wed, 29 Apr 2020 17:00:44 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27991 Albert Einstein said, “In the middle of difficulty lies opportunity.” He was encouraging others to face problems with the knowledge that they might find a way to resolve them or learn from the experience. Many businesses — online and off — are facing serious challenges in 2020, particularly given the impact that COVID-19 is having […]

The post The Long-Term Value of Content and Why You Shouldn’t Put Off Creating It in the Short -Term appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Albert Einstein said, “In the middle of difficulty lies opportunity.” He was encouraging others to face problems with the knowledge that they might find a way to resolve them or learn from the experience.

Many businesses — online and off — are facing serious challenges in 2020, particularly given the impact that COVID-19 is having on bottom lines. But some companies are finding a way to resolve some current business issues — or, at least, create a more solid foundation for the future — by using this time to work on content marketing.

ALSO – Need a hand creating evergreen content? Try our content writing services

Yes, in the current environment, many businesses are understandably scaling back on content budgets. But at the same time, other businesses are actually increasing budgets — and it’s not just those that are enjoying a traffic bump during this period.

Businesses Are Still Investing Because Content Is Valuable

For example, Kevin Miller, the founder and CEO of The Word Counter, says he’s doubled his monthly content budget during this time. “I am increasing content spend because many others are slowing down,” says Miller. “Also, writers have a greater capacity to get new topics completed. It helps me plan out the entire years’ worth of content and get it at a cheaper rate.”

Why Kevin Miller of The Word Counter is increasing content marketing spend

But Miller’s not just looking out for his own bottom line. “It feels great to give work to people who are really in need right now and allows me to feed money back into the freelance writing economy that can use it.”

Meg Marrs, the founder and CEO of K9 of Mine, is also increasing content spend in April 2020. “With more folks stuck at home and spending more time online, we expect to see an increase in traffic and want to take advantage of that with as much content as possible.”

Why K9 of Mine is Increasing Content Spend in April 2020

5 Reasons to Keep Creating — or Even Create More — Content Now

  1. The competition can outpace you. If you’re not creating content now and the competition is, you may never catch up. They will have weeks or months of content where you have none, which can help them perform better than you in SERPs and engage with consumers at a time when people are looking for entertainment, support or guidance from brands.
  2. You have time to invest in quality. Changes to projects or business priorities might mean you have time to invest in quality. And, as Miller pointed out, if you don’t personally have an opening your schedule, you may find qualified, experienced freelancers happy to provide high-quality content right now. It’s a time to stock up on editorial for the future.
  3. Content has long-term value and builds authority. When choosing what to spend marketing budget on in this season, consider what will provide long-term value. Advertising is short-term. Morgan Taylor, the CMO for LetMeBank, points out that, “nobody wants to feel marketed to at this time. It can come off as tasteless if you directly market at a time like this, but that doesn’t mean we have stopped producing and using content.” Taylor recommends switching focus to content that’s informative and drives SEO and brand awareness.
  4. SEO takes time, and creating content ensures you don’t waste it. Since SEO takes time to build, Taylor’s recommendation is sound. Investing in more content during this time — when advertising might not be an option — puts you in a strong SEO position in the future.
  5. You can use it again later. Plus, all the content you create during this time can be reused in the future. You can pull components out for social media posts and repurpose content for future posts, ebooks or white papers, providing additional value down the road (and reducing the cost and time associated with future content creation).

Measuring the Long-Term Value of Content

Staying the course with your content budget during a time of uncertainty can be bold, and investing more in content even bolder. Whether you’re trying to ease your own concerns or get buy-in from clients, bosses or other stakeholders, you need a way to measure the value of content.

How to Measure the Value of Content

How you advocate for content depends on your business model. We reached out to business owners, marketing managers and others who are confident enough in their plans to hold steady or increase content right now. Here’s how they’re calculating the value of content.

  • Kevin Miller of The Word Counter uses Google Adsense revenue per post. It’s simple, available on his dashboard and lets him create projections of what his content is likely to earn in the future.
  • Morgan Taylor advises tracking the value of the customer over their life with you. A solid CRM system lets you gather this type of data; once you know what the average customer brings to your bottom line, you can calculate content value by how many customers it brings into your fold. And since content can keep bringing in new customers for months or years, that value can be big.
  • Jesse Nieminen of Viima provides a formula for calculating the lifetime value of content: “Total number of inbound leads * conversion to paying customers * average lifetime value of customer – cost to convert traffic and deliver service.”
  • Meg Marrs also provides a formula, stating, “We try to calculate a value per visitor amount by dividing the revenue the page generated by monthly traffic to get a revenue per user number. So for example: $400 of revenue / 5,000 page views per month = .08 cents per user.” Marrs says this calculation lets them compare the revenue generation of various articles.

Time to Make a Decision. . .

Are you going to invest in the long-term value of content during this season like many of the businesses above? Steps for doing so include:

  • Figuring out how you calculate the value of your content
  • Understanding what your customers need during this time and how to serve that need with content that also provides long-term value (based on the metric above)
  • Getting buy-in from other stakeholders by showing them how much today’s content can do for the business in the future
  • Reaching out to internal teams or qualified freelance writers to create the kind of content that will have a lasting impact
How to Invest in the Long-Term Value of Content

ALSO – 5 Ways To Make Your Content Budget Go Further

The post The Long-Term Value of Content and Why You Shouldn’t Put Off Creating It in the Short -Term appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-long-term-value-of-content-and-why-you-shouldnt-put-off-creating-it-in-the-short-term/feed/ 0
5 Ways To Make Your Content Budget Go Further https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/make-your-content-budget-go-further/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/make-your-content-budget-go-further/#respond Wed, 22 Apr 2020 17:00:57 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27922 In the current environment of economic hardship caused by COVID-19, many businesses are scaling back on content budgets. While we’ve made some arguments for the value of staying the course or increasing content during this time, we also know that financial facts are just that: Facts you can’t always ignore or sway. But scaling back […]

The post 5 Ways To Make Your Content Budget Go Further appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
In the current environment of economic hardship caused by COVID-19, many businesses are scaling back on content budgets. While we’ve made some arguments for the value of staying the course or increasing content during this time, we also know that financial facts are just that: Facts you can’t always ignore or sway.

But scaling back on your budget doesn’t necessarily mean substantially reducing (or stopping) your content production. And that’s a good thing, because content can be critical for communicating with and providing assurance to your customers and audience during a time of crisis.

Check out these five tips for stretching your content budget further without sacrificing quality.

1. Prioritize Content According to Business Value

If your budget is limited or you’re cutting back, make sure you know what content is most valuable to your business. Look for ways to use your content budget for long-lasting value when possible, but understand the immediate needs of your audience too.

For example, during the 2020 COVID-19 crisis, companies that offer food subscription boxes might find paid advertising to be a valuable way to connect with people who are searching online for meat or other items that are in short supply locally. For these companies, the business value of content for ads is two-fold. First, it can lead to an immediate conversion. Second, it can lead to long-term value if the subscriber remains with the business.

But for many companies, ads won’t provide the most long-term value in this type of situation. Instead, SEO content that increases performance in search results in the future might provide more long-term value. Thought leadership may also be important for businesses attempting to assuage consumers and create trust and authority.

Content to Leverage During a Crisis

2. Consider Outsourcing Your Content Writing

“If you really want to reach a lot of target audience, your content production has to be massive,” Esther Meyer, the marketing manager at Grooms Shop, says. “Think social media posts, blog posts, email marketing content, website and landing pages. It’s okay to outsource your content marketing to other people. But you must maintain quality when you outsource. The most important thing to keep in mind when outsourcing content is to have a content marketing tone and style guide. You also need to communicate your needs and desires in a clear and concise manner.”

Esther Meyer of Grooms Shop Quote

Outsourcing content can be a way to maintain scale without blowing your budget, but you do have to be smart about how you go about it. Working with the cheapest writers available typically results in sub-par content quality. That leaves you scrambling to rework content before you publish it, which increases expense.

For best results, you want to hire high-quality freelance writers at reasonable rates.

Working directly with freelancers can be more expensive than you plan as well. If you’re considering outsourcing content to stretch your budget and save yourself time, consider keeping a content creation company on standby.

3. Repurpose Existing Content

“Another way to stretch your budget,” says Katie from Digitally Enhanced, “is to optimize and repurpose content. If you’re going to put the time and effort into creating a piece of content, transition into the mindset of creating a content experience. Ways that I’ve created multi-purpose content include taking one interview and creating an expose or mini-series, a Q&A, a how-to or checklist, a video and associated social media and email accompaniments.”

Katie says she’s created up to 15 content assets from one content idea and provides these tips for others who want to do the same:

  • Take your 5-10 top performing content pieces and turn them an ebook, PDF or other long-form content with a compelling and relevant headline
  • Aggregate similar content pieces into a deeper whitepaper
  • Pull out audio from existing video/video series into a podcast
Ways to Repurpose Content

“One of the best things you can do is build out a strong content tracking system,” says Katie. “I would guess that any brand’s content program will be divided by overarching themes, so in this system, be very clear about which theme content falls into, when it was written, if it leverages any outside sources and other pertinent information. From this, I recommend an annual audit and refresh so that no content is ever more than two years old and all sources are up to date and still in good standing.”

4. Start With Content From Your Team

Not all content needs to be in the form of the written word. In fact, 88% of marketers note that video marketing provides a positive ROI (up from 33% in just 2015). Start with different types of content your team can put together such as videos, webinars, podcasts or interviews. Even better, see if you already have some of this content in your archives.

Video Marketing ROI Stat

Creating content using your existing team’s expertise and knowledge can reduce the cost. Then you can provide those videos or interviews to in-house or freelance writers and have them generate articles, blog posts and other text-based content from them without the need to do additional research. That helps support faster turn-around times on content writing and can potentially reduce the cost of written content.

5. Seek Guest Posts From Experts

Finally, reach out to business partners, influencers or other non-competitors who might be willing to provide a guest post for your blog. In many cases, experts or business partners are willing to provide a post for free because it provides them with additional exposure for their own brand. You might also swap guest-posting favors and provide something for their blog. You each get fresh content but can easily write about topics you’re familiar with.

Content doesn’t have to be expensive. But cutting your content budget altogether, even during a time of crisis, can be a costly mistake that impacts your company’s future. Instead, work within your resources and get the most out of the content budget you’re able to keep.

ALSO – How to Leverage Content in a Crisis Situation

The post 5 Ways To Make Your Content Budget Go Further appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/make-your-content-budget-go-further/feed/ 0
How to Find and Leverage Authoritative Sources https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/authoritative-sources/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/authoritative-sources/#respond Wed, 08 Apr 2020 14:00:08 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27697 Authority is a big deal for SEO. In a list of Google ranking factors published by Backlinko, trustworthiness and authority play important roles. Here are just some of the ranking factors listed that are related to or involve authority: A solid domain history Domain authority Content that covers the topic in-depth Recent content, especially for […]

The post How to Find and Leverage Authoritative Sources appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Authority is a big deal for SEO. In a list of Google ranking factors published by Backlinko, trustworthiness and authority play important roles.

Here are just some of the ranking factors listed that are related to or involve authority:

  • A solid domain history
  • Domain authority
  • Content that covers the topic in-depth
  • Recent content, especially for time-sensitive queries
  • Correct grammar and spelling
  • Number of — and quality — of outbound and inbound links
  • References and sources

But how do you make your content authoritative? One way is to include information and quotes from — and links to — authority sources.

ALSO – Need to create authoritative content? Try our SEO content writing services.

What Are Authoritative Sources?

Authority sources are generally recognized as reliable because they demonstrate authority or are recognized by other experts in the industry as being so. 

What Are Authoritative Sources?

For example, if you’re writing about a medical topic, most people would accept that the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention or the World Health Organization were reliable sources. And if you’re writing a general-purpose article for consumers, sources such as WebMD might also be considered appropriate. A personal blog from someone with no discernible credentials — or even an unknown physician’s blog that gets no peer review — would likely not be considered authoritative in this case.

Need to create authoritative content? Hire the web’s best content writers today!

What you can consider authority depends in part on your audience, your topic and the level at which you’re writing. But the following table lays out some good general rules for a starting point.

What Are Authoritative Sources?

Why Are Authoritative Sources Important?

  • Authoritative sources help you create content that meets Google’s E-A-T guidelines.
  • Authority content is important for SEO performance, which helps you drive more traffic to your pages.
  • Trustworthy, expert content provides value for your reader, which can increase your conversion rates or keep people coming back to your site.

How to Find Authoritative Sources for Your Content

Finding authority sources can increase the amount of time it takes to create your content. But it doesn’t have to take forever or be an exercise in frustration. Here are nine tips for using authority sources to inform your content.

1. Don’t believe the repeat.

Daniel Ray, the editor-in-chief at LawnStarter.com, says, “I see young content writers make this mistake all the time. They believe if something has been repeated a few times on the web, it must be authoritative and can be repeated again.”

You can’t afford to rest on the content of others when trust is so important. Don’t assume something is correct — and therefore safe to repeat or link to — simply because you saw it repeated a number of times on social media or in unknown blog posts.

2. Do find the original source whenever possible.

“If you want quality, authoritative sources,” says Ray, “the best practice is to take the time to find the original source. Quote it and cite it directly rather than cite a second- or third-hand version. By going to the original source, you find the greatest amount of data as well as nuances lost in later pastiches.”

A pro tip is to follow the link trail to find out where information came from. If you find an article with a fact you want to use, click on the link the article uses to back up its claim. Sometimes, you have to click through a number of links — all on pages that have repeated the information from someone else — before you get to the original source.

Before you link, evaluate the original source. Is it a solid, expert source? And does the original source even say what the first article you found claimed? Consider the game of grapevine you might have played as a child: The message from the first person usually changes by the time the last person hears it. That can happen online too.

3. Don’t cite random blogs or Wikipedia, but do use them.

“Wikipedia is not reliable,” says Tim Grinsdale, owner of TOAD Diaries — “even if you see other sites referencing it.”

How to Find Authoritative Sources Quote

But Anh Trinh, managing editor of GeekWithLaptop, says that doesn’t mean you can’t use Wikipedia at all. Trinh also says you shouldn’t use Wikipedia as a source or link to it, but you can look at the source list on relevant Wikipedia articles. “You’ll often see books, websites and articles linked there that could be used as an authoritative source,” says Trinh.

4. Do conduct a targeted site: search.

Sorting through pages of Google results that relate to competitors or aren’t considered authority can be a real drag. Research fatigue can even lead you to take the first decent-looking source at face value without looking deeper.

Save yourself some major research woe by perfecting the site: search to find authority sources. These searches limit the types of pages Google returns.

Conduct a site: search by typing: search term site:limiting factor. Here are some examples:

  • “blood pressure medication site:.gov” returns pages about blood pressure medication from .gov sites only
  • “blood pressure medication site:cdc.gov” returns pages about blood pressure medication only from the United States’ Centers for Disease Control and Prevention site
  • “nursing degree plans site:.edu” returns pages about the search term from .edu sites
  • “patient infection statistics site:beckershospitalreview.com” returns pages only from the industry site Becker’s Hospital Review

Limiting your search to the type of site or to a known authority site can help you quickly find the information you need on a page you’re confident in sourcing.

5. Don’t rely solely on “experts” on Quora or Reddit

Grinsdale says one way to get authoritative information “is to do outreach to people within the niche/industry you’re preparing to write about.” Anh Trinh advises using questions and answers on sites like Quora. “Quora has tons of authoritative sources, since most of the people answering this have the credential to back it up,” he says.

Kenny Trihn, the editor of Netbooknews, seconds the recommendation. “I find Quora and Reddit helpful. They have many knowledgeable people with different kinds of expertise.” But Kenny Trihn says you do need to do the work to backup what you find out via these types of user-based resources. Conduct “personal research that backs up the information you get,” he says.

How to Find Authoritative Sources for Your Content

6. Do @ people on Twitter for comments.

R.J. Weiss, a Certified Financial Planner and founder of The Ways to Wealth, recommends turning to Twitter. “I’ve had success using Twitter to include authoritative sources in content. Specifically, using the @ feature on Twitter to ask them a question directly. The response rate is fairly high with this method.”

Weiss also notes that if you get a reply on Twitter, you can use it as a visual break in your own content. Collecting quotes via Twitter lets you embed images of the actual tweets for scannable content that appeals to many readers.

How to Connect with Authority Sources for Quotes

7. Don’t forget that authority sources can be outdated.

When doing web research, remember that timeliness and relevance are important. No matter how authority your source seems, if the information is from a decade ago and you’re writing in a fast-moving industry, you can probably do better.

Limit your searches to information published the past two years when possible. And if you find a report that has the exact type of information you want but it’s out of date, see if the publisher or agency has issued an updated version.

8. Do sign up for paid and free research tools.

Anh Trinh says, “Another thing is to look for free or paid peer-review publications. Examples of open access journal sites I use are MDPI and JournalFinder.”

Chloe Brittain seconds Trinh’s recommendation to use online research tools. She owns Opal Transcription Services, which works with numerous academic clients, and says, “Two of my favorite sources for research are Infoplease and The New York Times Newsroom Navigator.”

You can also search scholarly articles and journals via Google Scholar.

9. Don’t forget that SEO tools can give you some clues for sources with authority.

Malte Scholz, cofounder of Airfocus, says he uses SEO tools to find authority sources. “In other words, I pull up the first result in Google and use Ahrefs to find external links that the article is pointing to,” says Scholz. “That way, I can find 5-10 sources per single page, and within 30 minutes, I can have 50-100 sources for a topic that I want to research and write about.”

Best Practices for Including Quotes and Sources in Content

Obviously, you can’t copy and paste information from a source and call it a day. These tips help you cite sources without reducing the quality or originality of your own content.

Avoid Plagiarism by Citing Correctly

Never use someone else’s ideas or information without giving them credit. Here are some ways to do so online.

  • Use an inline citation that credits the source for the information. 
    • According to the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, more than 1.6 million Americans receive a cancer diagnosis annually. 
  • Use anchor text to lead back to the source, making it clear where you got the information.
  • Often, it’s even better to use both inline citation and anchor text.
  • Use footnotes or a source list at the bottom of the page to indicate all the sources you pulled information from.

Incorporating Quotes Into Your Content 

Don’t just copy and paste enormous blocks of text into your content — even when you’ve sourced original quotes. Frame those quotes with your own content or thoughts to tell a unique story with backup from the experts. Think about how news articles are written — the high-quality ones don’t introduce a topic and then dump five paragraphs of a quote in to tell the story. 

Tips for Making Quotes Easy to Read

When you do use quotes, use different formats and options to break up your text and make things easier to read. Use indents to offset slightly longer quotes, or break out important quotes into graphics. That makes them easier for people to share on social media and also draws attention to them. 

Bonus Tip: Put Expert Writers to Work for You

Starting to feel like finding authority sources is a lot of work? You’re not completely wrong. Which is why you might want to hire expert freelance writers who know exactly where to find the facts to make your content sing. Check out our article writing and other services for more information.

The post How to Find and Leverage Authoritative Sources appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/authoritative-sources/feed/ 0
The Complete B2B Content Creation Guide https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-complete-b2b-content-creation-guide/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-complete-b2b-content-creation-guide/#respond Tue, 31 Mar 2020 13:00:43 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27610 With more and more business revenue driven by leads that are generated online, the focus on B2B content creation has intensified. Smart companies realize that relevant, useful information draws potential customers into the sales funnel. While content creation for consumers—B2C—might garner more attention in the marketplace, a strong B2B content creation strategy can produce quantifiable, […]

The post The Complete B2B Content Creation Guide appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
With more and more business revenue driven by leads that are generated online, the focus on B2B content creation has intensified. Smart companies realize that relevant, useful information draws potential customers into the sales funnel.

While content creation for consumers—B2C—might garner more attention in the marketplace, a strong B2B content creation strategy can produce quantifiable, bottom-line results for B2B businesses as well. More than just snackable content designed to engage for a few minutes and drive a quick consumer purchase, B2B content is based on strategic initiatives. It needs to attract, engage, and most importantly, generate quality leads. By building trust and helping prospects, great B2B content moves potential buyers further along the sales funnel.  

ALSOCheck out our B2B Content Writing Service

Differences Between B2B Content and B2C Content

Before we dive into B2B content, let’s talk about three ways it’s different from typical  B2C content. 

B2C purchase decisions are typically driven by emotion. When it’s B2C content, you want to connect with buyers on an emotional level—make them feel good about your brand and the qualities it imbues. With B2B content, you need to start by developing content that establishes trust with potential customers. The stakes are higher in B2B—purchase decisions typically involve multiple people, and are often long-term contracts.

B2B buyers want to see the ROI of your product or service. When a consumer chooses one brand of toothpaste over another, they probably don’t view it as an investment they plan to evaluate. So B2C content can have an informal voice. In contrast, B2B content needs to start the process of convincing a potential customer that the product or service will create cost savings or efficiencies that will help them grow revenue. A solid B2B content strategy will use logic and data to sway the decision-makers.

B2B content needs detail. Most of the daily decisions we make as consumers are not based on deep, investigative research. But details matter when a business is considering a product or service—they increase the confidence of the buyer. Quality content should establish you as an authority, so information needs to be valuable, pertinent, and useful. Use relevant statistics and draw on real-world examples. Engaging content isn’t focused on creating basic awareness or prompting someone to do something as simple as clicking to make a purchase—it’s building confidence in you, your services, or your products that will lead to outreach and a sale. Getting this right is a special skill set. Remember many of your readers will be experts in their own right, so your content needs to speak to them. 

Differences Between B2B and B2C Content

Benefits of a B2B Content Strategy

Maybe you’re not convinced that a B2B content strategy will really move the sales needle for your company. Wondering how an investment in high quality content will make a difference is a valid concern.

The reality is that all kinds of companies are currently using B2B content successfully. Done well, it provides quantifiable ROI. Whether it’s through blog posts, social media, white papers, user-generated content, or any of the other avenues that are available to B2B marketers, the right content marketing strategy delivers results. A critical piece is providing intelligent, well-researched material. Remember that people who are deeply involved in an industry, especially those who are empowered to make purchase decisions, have a great deal of knowledge already. They are experts already, and they’ll have little patience for B2B content that is thin or just scratches the surface of a topic. 

What are the main benefits of a B2B content strategy?

More qualified leads. Content creation for B2B brands can drive customers to your website at the key moment in their decision-making process. Specifically, they’ll land there after an internet search, where they have entered a specific query, provided your content is optimized for search. When your products or services match up with their needs, and you have B2B content that establishes your authority, you have a customer who is far more likely to buy from you. 

A premium spot in a competitive marketplace. With effective B2B content that establishes thought leadership, you can create a presence outline that outstrips even larger competitors. Work with writers who understand the principles of SEO, and your content will rank higher in search queries. Which, of course, means that a potential customer is more likely to reach out to you first. 

Enhanced brand image. It no longer requires a multi-million dollar traditional advertising campaign to create good feelings about a brand, and you don’t need to allocate a big chunk of your marketing budget for paid search to build awareness. Detail-oriented, educational B2B content that reaches your target audience at the moment they’re searching for your products or services imbues your company with positive attributes. When you produce valuable B2B content on a consistent basis, current and potential customers are more likely to only work with you but also tell their friends and colleagues about your company.

Enables the sales team. When the right content is created for a B2B brand, it also helps educate and empower salespeople. It provides them with material they can use to navigate a potential buyer through the process and turn them into a customer, and reinforces the pain points that are likely for the prospect.

Content marketing is affordable, and when done well, more effective—according to some studies, B2B content marketing generates three times as many leads as paid search. 

How B2B Content Generates Leads

Quality content matters for B2B marketers

Still not convinced that investing time and resources in B2B content creation is worth it?

Well, a quick browse of the internet will show you just how much is out there—blog posts, visual content, landing pages, webinars, and more. And that endless supply has raised expectations, so your customers and potential customers now expect high quality content. If your target audience visits your website and doesn’t see fresh, informative material, it sets off alarms. You never get a second chance to make a first impression, and you’ll appear less capable than your competitors. It’s important to deliver factual, well-researched content that will establish you as an authority. 

In fact, 47% of the people making B2B purchases will look at three to five pieces of content before they engage with a salesperson for the first time. 

How Content Marketing Affects B2B Sales

What’s more, the same purchase patterns that have emerged for consumers are relevant in B2B—just like the person figuring out which flat screen TV to buy, the team that is buying for a company will conduct extensive online research before making a decision. According to the Content Marketing Institute, this happens nearly 50% of the time. In the year ahead, it’s likely that content marketing statistics will reveal that number is growing, as millennials and Gen Z  move up the ranks and become the key decision-makers at more and more companies. 

Tips for Creating B2B Content 

Once you commit to creating content for a B2B audience, how do you ensure that it’s a valuable part of your overall marketing strategy? How do you create content that delivers ROI? What kinds of content will drive lead generation?

Whether you’re a small business or a large corporation, developing quality content takes creativity, attention to detail, and consistency. For every company that does it well, there are scores that flounder or just muddle along without seeing an impact. If you want to be a part of the former group and develop B2B content that really works, here are some tips:

Tell good stories. Not fibs or half-truths, but relevant information delivered in a human way. When embarking on a B2B content marketing strategy, it’s easy to fall into the trap of filling everything with industry jargon or buzzwords in an attempt to sound like your idea of an industry professional. Don’t go overboard on the lingo—keep your content clear and easy to understand. Think about the best storytellers you’ve met in your life. Have they been the people who seem intent on demonstrating how intelligent they are? Or the ones who engaged you throughout a tale with wit, relevance, or imagination? 

Target buyer personas. As much as possible, think about B2B content like a one-on-one conversation instead of a presentation in a massive lecture hall. Before you create a piece of content—whether it’s a blog article, a webinar, a LinkedIn post, a video—decide who you’re hoping to reach. Your buyer persona shouldn’t be an audience so narrow that it’s not useful, but recognizing different kinds of customers will help you craft B2B content that connects with purchasers at the key point in their decision-making process. To help define your target audiences,  account-based marketing can be an effective way to create messages that resonate with the people receiving them. 

Don’t just write it. Use your words is good advice for your preschooler, but quality B2B content builds on great copy with other attention-grabbing elements. Use infographics to reinforce key points, build a subscriber list and use email marketing to let people know when new content is available, and foster user-generated content to augment your own material.  If you have a great article, don’t be afraid to promote it months later with a press release, an attention-getting LinkedIn post, or a message on another social media platform.  You can also take quality content and repurpose it for other channels. Ben Culpin, Content Marketer at Wakeupdata, says, “The strategy that has worked best for us is clustering content for SEO and then repurposing certain content for different formats and channels. As an example, a client case in which we increased Google Shopping conversions worked pretty well as a blog article. However, once we used the same case in a YouTube video, an infographic, a newsletter, and a podcast discussion,, we saw traffic to the original article increase by 160% in a month, while signups to a downloadable ebook from the page rose by 83%. Since then, organic traffic to the article has increased by around 7% month-over-month, so it’s a strategy that yields results in the long-term too.

The right content at the right time. What kind of content will resonate with a prospect at different phases of the sales funnel? A first-time visitor to your site is likely to examine the features of your product or service, and engage with some of the articles—your tone and voice need to establish both personality and authority. But few B2B decision-makers are going to make a decision based on a quick scan of your site. Can you capture their email and follow up with a white paper that may be especially relevant to them? After a salesperson takes them through a demo, can you share some visual content? Consider filming testimonials of some current customers and creating short videos you can share—these can help your buyer communicate your value to other key constituents in the company. Reach out to the prospect through your social media channels attention to those will ensure they see bite-sized reminders about your company. Andrew DeBell, co-founder of Water Bear Learning, relies on LinkedIn, “…because that is where most of our best B2B leads are and is the best opportunity for us to get eyes on our brand.”

Build the right team. If you run a small to mid-sized business and have an entrepreneurial mindset, it’s easy to think that you can handle B2B content creation on your own. The reality is that running your operation will always take precedent, and your content marketing efforts will be pushed lower on the priority list. Whether you staff a group yourself or rely on a content marketing services company, it’s a mistake to take on the task of creating B2B content without any help.

Put yourself on a path to better B2B content creation. 

There’s not one, clear path to creating quality content that works for your company. It’s an ongoing process—companies need to consistently provide information that clients and prospects find valuable and moves them closer to a purchase decision.  

Use data-driven marketing research to help you measure the effectiveness of your content. Use SEO tools like Google Analytics to find out what content performs well and what fails to gain traction. Google Search Console will help you find keywords that can drive quality content. Olga Mykhoparkinam, Chief Marketing Officer at Chanty, notes, “The majority of the content we create is for B2B audience and it has a strong focus on SEO. Before creating a piece of content, we do keyword research to see what the content needs to be optimized for. For example, our top-performing post is one about Slack alternatives, which targets this very keyword. This article alone brings us more than 100 new users every month. The purpose of the article is to present the reader with an overview of Slack alternatives and present us as the best choice. It works incredibly well and articles like these are the main reason we now have over 10,000 active users and more than 50,000 website visitors every month.”

B2B Content Marketing Tip

Remain open to fresh thinking—you just might find your target audience reacts really well to long-form articles when you figured they would be more likely to embrace webinars and visual content. Reach out to your customers and have conversations to help you identify areas that interest them. Connect with your sales team to find out what prospects consistently identify as pain points. Keep up with the topics covered in your trade journals to see if there is material you can build upon and make especially relevant to your products or services. 

Yes, B2B content creation is an investment of valuable time and resources. But done well and consistently, it pays off. 

ALSO – What Makes Good B2B Copywriters, and How Can You Find Them?

The post The Complete B2B Content Creation Guide appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-complete-b2b-content-creation-guide/feed/ 0
How to Leverage Content in a Crisis Situation https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-leverage-content-in-a-crisis-situation/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-leverage-content-in-a-crisis-situation/#respond Tue, 24 Mar 2020 17:00:04 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27559 The dictionary defines crisis as “a time of intense difficulty, trouble or danger”. It also says that a crisis can be a time when important decisions must be made. Business crises can range in scale from PR nightmares to national disasters. In extreme cases, the crisis can even impact the entire globe. Goals during a […]

The post How to Leverage Content in a Crisis Situation appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
The dictionary defines crisis as “a time of intense difficulty, trouble or danger”. It also says that a crisis can be a time when important decisions must be made. Business crises can range in scale from PR nightmares to national disasters. In extreme cases, the crisis can even impact the entire globe.

Goals during a crisis tend to include maintaining business continuity, protecting the future of the business and providing customers with the right types of services in the best manner possible. And while businesses of all sizes realize these goals are important, it can be difficult to know where to start — especially when you’re facing many other stressors and uncertainties.

Content creation is an effort that can help your business with many of these goals during a crisis. Discover how you can leverage content in positive ways when dealing with a crisis.

What Types of Crises Can Businesses Face?

Business crisis management or disaster planning isn’t a new concept. The Chamber of Commerce of Metropolitan Montreal provides a list of crises that can impact businesses, including:

  • Natural disasters
  • Fire or flood
  • Loss of power for any reason
  • Failures of IT systems, security or supply chain
  • Terrorist attacks
  • Events that impact a company’s reputation
  • An outbreak of disease

Right now, many businesses are dealing with a crisis related to the outbreak of COVID-19. 

Where can you get tips and guidelines for business disaster planning?
Ready.gov provides a variety of downloads and advice about disaster planning and crisis response, including a Business Emergency Preparedness Social Media Toolkit.The U.S. Small Business Administration offers some resources for disaster planning. SCORE.org provides a page of disaster preparedness and recovery resources, which was specifically updated to offer small business guidance during the coronavirus outbreak.The Business Development Bank of Canada provides a step-by-step guide to creating a disaster plan. 

Why You Shouldn’t Scale Back Content During a Crisis

Many businesses scale back on a number of things during a crisis, including content creation. Some reasons organizations might generate less content during and immediately after a crisis include:

  • Perceptions that resources must go to efforts that are deemed more important than content
  • Lack of resources to create content because of new demands on staff time or shortages in staffing
  • Belief that some other messaging channels might be better than content

Obviously, at Crowd Content, we believe content is important. It’s more than our bread and butter — it’s kind of our passion. We want you to know content can play an important role in your business’s response to a crisis and understand how to use it.

What We Know From Public Relations About Crisis Management

Crisis management is an integral part of public relations. PR pros know that it’s critical to acknowledge issues, own them and be proactive in communicating with stakeholders about your response and how you’ll move forward.

Content marketing lets you do exactly this, leveraging various channels to get the word out while also delivering more short- and long-term value than with PR alone. 

Content Has Enduring Value — for You and Your Customers

If you’re going to spend time and resources on communication during a crisis time, doesn’t it make sense to choose an option with long-term value? 

Content provides relevant, helpful information to your target audience, and the information that’s helpful during a crisis doesn’t necessarily become obsolete once the crisis has passed. Thus, content has enduring value for the people you serve.

Content marketing also provides long-term value for your business, especially when compared to other channels. It can help you rank for search terms and drive organic traffic now and in the future, and you can revisit and update content later to fit more specific needs. Plus, you can continue to promote content and future updates via other channels like email and social media, driving even more traffic to important pages. 

Content in a Crisis Situation

In other words, what you do in one particular crisis can become a building block to make things easier in a future situation.

Compare these advantages with the benefits you might get from paid advertising. Paid advertising tends to provide short-term returns; to ensure the word is widely spread and keep returns churning, you have to continuously pour effort and money into advertising. That’s not to say every business should shut down ads during a crisis and turn solely to content — in general, a well-balanced, integrated approach Is best.

Our advice – content first, and then promote it however you can to help you address the crisis appropriately. That definitely includes advertising your content

Content Lets You Appropriately Fill an Authority Role

Content also lets you speak directly into need during a crisis. If you have an existing content program, chances are your audience sees you as an authority within your space (at least that’s the goal). In a crisis, they might crave your guidance. 

At the very least, people want to know that the brands and businesses they care about and rely on are doing something to weather the storm. They also may need reassurance that you’re still there, ready to meet their needs, even if it’s in a modified way.

Responding to crisis and helping your clients navigate during that time can further build your authority, potentially helping you create foundations for the future. 

Chances are you know more about space than your clients do – that’s why they hire you or use your services. Your insights in a crisis can be incredibly valuable to them. 

Look for Opportunities to Provide Solutions Via Content 

The best content marketing is never 100% about you and your business. It should be about what your customers need or want and how you can help. Some of the most effective components of a content marketing campaign are often those that provide value to the reader without demanding anything in return. 

Consider, for example, our post on Tips for Working Remotely. The target audience it’s aimed at is the freelance writers that power our platform, but it offers valuable advice without demanding anything in return. It also helps position us as an authority — someone freelance writers and editors can turn to for guidance and work.  

This type of content is important any time, but it becomes critical during a crisis. Look for opportunities to provide answers or support as people seek solutions. Some ways of finding these opportunities include:

  • Paying attention to new trends in search terms, which indicate large numbers of people are trying to find information about something. A handy tool for checking this is Exploding Topics
  • Following relevant and trending hashtags on social media, which can tell you what types of things people are talking about and interested in at the moment. Social listening tools like BuzzSumo can be a huge help here. 
  • Check out Google Trends to see what issues are trending at large – you may be able to tap into this
  • Asking your existing customers or audience; send out an email or post on social inviting them to share their concerns and questions and look for topics that come up repeatedly.
  • Spending time talking to existing clients to find out what their needs, questions or concerns are during the crisis; chances are that other customers are experiencing similar issues, so you can create content around those discussions and share them with others.
Content Opportunities During a Crisis

Types of Content You Can Leverage

The type of content you create and how you distribute it depends on the crisis you’re facing and the needs of both your business and your stakeholders/customers. Most of the time, digital channels are the best way to get content out in an efficient and timely manner, but some situations might require print distribution. For example, in the United States, certain types of data breaches must be communicated to impacted consumers in writing.

But generally, if you want to leverage content marketing during a crisis, here are three of the best channels to include in your efforts.

1. Email Content

Email content is a great way to communicate with existing customers or audiences during a time of crisis. In fact,  unless you’re living under a digital rock, you probably received a dozen or more “Here’s our response to COVID-19” emails. Here are some reasons email is one of the first places companies turn when they’re dealing with a crisis or disaster.

  • Email reaches to the person rather than waiting for them to come to you. It helps ensure people can get the message even if they didn’t yet realize there was an issue or need.
  • You own your email list and can control who receives the message. With all other forms of content, you’re at the mercy of algorithms, social shares and search trends.
  • Email feels more personal, which can help you connect with your audience during a crisis.
  • Email is accessible via a wide number of devices and free services, which can make it easier to reach people when resources are generally lower during certain types of crises.

2. Social Media Content

Social is the first place many people turn when a crisis begins to unfold. Users flock to platforms such as Twitter, Instagram, Facebook and even LinkedIn to find out information, double check information, see what their friends are saying and commiserate with others. But they also look to brands and industry leaders to set the tone or provide trusted information via these forums. 

This is especially true if you’re dealing with a crisis that’s related mostly to your company, such as a PR issue or breach of security. You’re likely to see a spike in activity on your pages as people come to ask questions or troll. And if you don’t do the content marketing work to take control of the story, the trolls will be happy to do it for you.

3. Blog Content

Blog content can help you create a powerful, authoritative presence online, which is helpful whether or not a crisis is occurring. During a crisis, blog content lets you:

  • Address certain concerns, questions or needs with in-depth content that provides answers and solutions
  • Alleviate worries or fears with honest content that helps build increased trust with your audience
  • Provide information in a variety of formats to meet the widest needs, including text, images and video
  • Meet in-the-moment needs while creating something that can be used later for other marketing or content purposes
Types of Content You Can Leverage During a Crisis

The Bottom Line on Content in a Crisis

Communication is critical. It’s a basic premise of business disaster planning and crisis management. And one of the most effective ways you can invest in communication is through content marketing. When the stakes are high, it’s often time to double down with this type of effort.

ALSO – Tips For Working Remotely + Powerful Insights From 6 Experts

The post How to Leverage Content in a Crisis Situation appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-leverage-content-in-a-crisis-situation/feed/ 0
Questions to Determine the Right Content Writing Service https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/questions-to-determine-the-right-content-writing-service/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/questions-to-determine-the-right-content-writing-service/#respond Thu, 12 Mar 2020 14:50:15 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27253 Content writing is an extremely important part of an effective digital marketing strategy. From a website focused on SEO to product descriptions that encourage sales, content can be the cornerstone of moving your business forward. However, creating great content can take a talent and time commitment that not everyone can invest in making, particularly for […]

The post Questions to Determine the Right Content Writing Service appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content writing is an extremely important part of an effective digital marketing strategy. From a website focused on SEO to product descriptions that encourage sales, content can be the cornerstone of moving your business forward.

However, creating great content can take a talent and time commitment that not everyone can invest in making, particularly for small companies with limited staff or startups with lofty growth goals. This is why hiring freelance writers can be a big benefit – they let companies add capacity and expertise with little investment and commitment. 

And while there are many ways to hire writers for your site, working with a content writing service gives you access to a vetted list of pros and powerful tools to boost productivity and improve quality. But, how do you know which service is the right one for you? This is what you need to know to find the perfect content writing service.

ALSOOutsourcing Content Writing: Tips for Finding and Working With Writers for Excellent Content Marketing Results

What Is a Content Writing Service?

A content writing service is a professional resource that pairs writers and clients to let a company create content in various ways. Content writing services are intended to fill in the gaps for companies that don’t have in-house writers, companies who have more content needs than employees can fulfill, and companies who lack expertise at creating certain types of content. This provides clients with access to professional, experienced writers with a wealth of expertise to find the ideal fit for every purpose.

Writing services often handle management services when needed, like helping select writers for a project, creating briefs and project guidelines, and managing submissions and editing when needed. They also often include platforms that help you create content more easily, publish directly, manage workflow, build teams, and other aspects of management to simplify the process. Writing services facilitate varying needs, including scaling and growth opportunities a single writer can’t, putting significant advantages at clients’ fingertips.

Projects outsourced using a content writing service can be one-offs, like content for a new website or a description for a new product, while others are ongoing, like weekly blog posts. In essence, a content writing service is intended to fill an important need in an effective way.

Content Writing Services vs. Content Mills

A low-cost alternative to a content writing service is a content mill. While similar in theory – both resources provide a way to place orders with writers and receive content in return – a content mill is often dedicated to churning out content at rapid rates in exchange for very low costs. Many mills employ writers who aren’t native speakers, leading to poor quality and content that may not meet needs.

Think quality is negligible? Think again. Courtney Keene, the Director of Operations of MyRoofingPal, explains, “Initially, we did what I think most people do when searching out content: We looked for the lowest rates that still met our brand standards. Unfortunately, it seemed like 80% of the proposals we received were from people who hadn’t read the job posting […] and the rest were consistently low quality. Now we contact freelancers privately or through an agency, and we’re definitely more willing to pay a premium for good, targeted content. Since changing tactics and soliciting content that’s detailed, well-researched, and specific to our brand, we’ve seen roughly a 30% uptick in the number of good links that are pointing toward our articles.”

As they say, you get what you pay for. A content writing service can offer a high-quality experience that ensures a great outcome that aligns with your goals and objectives for content.

Picking The Right Service Provider

Content writing services are available in countless shapes and sizes, but finding the right one for you can play an integral role in the success of your project. Keep these tips in mind when weighing your options.

Determine Your Goals

The kind of content writing service you need will require primarily based on your content needs. Some services have specialties, like blog posts or product descriptions, so if you have a niche need, it’s important to find a good fit for your needs. Not all options will specialize in all areas, so be sure you take time to assess the abilities of services in relation to what you need.

For example, some companies may require one writer to accomplish all of their objectives, while others may need a whole team. As Scott Krieger, a Creative Director and Web Developer at Studio 54, puts it, “The most important thing about the content writing service that we liked was they had a team of writers who specialized in certain topics, meaning we could get the right fit for almost every client we had, as they would have someone who has experience in that niche.”

ALSOHow Can You Find a Great Content Writer Who Has Niche Expertise?

It’s important to note that goals can fluctuate – but the right content writing service can help this natural progression, not hinder it. With the ability to provide additional writers when needed, craft campaigns, offer editing services, and take over management of projects, a great service can accommodate you, no matter how objectives may shift in the future.

Why Hire Content Writing Service

Choose a Price Point

Content comes at a cost. While many services offer affordable rates that can accommodate individual needs, good content isn’t free.

Consider, for a moment, what you have to spend each month. Is it $1,000? $10,000? More? Most content services charge by the word, or use a flat membership fee in addition to a per-word cost. Some services offer editing at a flat rate, while others add a per-word fee on top of what writing is charged.

Prior to vetting agencies, determine how much you are willing to spend and the services that matter most. For example, if you have an in-house writer who can assist with editing and need access to a writing service to manage the overflow, paying for editing may not be necessary.

On the other hand, if you have extensive content needs but no time or inclination to manage the process yourself, many platforms offer managed services that encompass placing orders, writing, editing, and curating content on your behalf. This will usually come at an additional cost, but the benefits can far outweigh additional expenses.

Do Your Due Diligence

There is a lot more that goes into content than simply putting fingers to keys. All content writing services offer options that can vary greatly from one service to another, so investigating all aspects of operations can be extremely important. In particular, keep these elements in mind:

  • Quality Options: Most services have a way of ranking quality in a way that corresponds with pricing, with better writers demanding higher price points. Ask to see samples of different quality levels. Take time to review pricing policies before moving forward.
  • Content Specialization: The best content writing services are often jacks-of-all-trades, but this isn’t true for all. Before signing up, be sure that the service you’ve chosen isn’t a social media powerhouse when all you need is blog posts.
  • Workforce: Some services universally employ generalists, while others have experts in particular niches. Know what you need before you commit.
  • Capacity: Most writers work on a freelance basis and aren’t always available for a full-time load. If you have a bulk project or rapid turnaround times, check with services to see what kind of timing and capacity writers can accommodate.
  • Available Tools: If you have specialized content, like Tweets that must meet a certain word count, be sure services have tools available, from templates to grammar checkers, that meet your expectations.
  • Assistance: Some services are hands-off. Others provide a fully managed experience. Know what you need before you make a choice.
  • Publishing Options: Do you want your content emailed in Word? Posted right to WordPress? Emailed to you? Evaluate delivery options to ensure what you are paying for is in line with expectations.
  • Revisions: Not every piece of content is right the first time. Learn more about revision opportunities to make sure you can fine-tune pieces as needed, when necessary.

Regardless of other criteria, a team you can communicate with openly and honestly is important. Mike Miller, the Editor-in-Chief of Wilderness Times offers this tip: “The best way to judge this before hiring the agency is to see how they treat you before you buy. A high-quality content provider will take the time to talk with you, listen to you, and understand what you’re looking for. They’ll ask for much more than the article topic and length. Top-notch writing services will ask what tone, voice, style, and prose you want for your articles.”

Mike Miller Quote

Assess Quality

A content marketing service can say all of the right things and offer all of the advantages in the world, but the end result of your project ultimately depends on the writer. Some services pair writers with projects behind the scenes, while others allow clients to assess quality themselves prior to making a choice. Regardless, a great service needs to offer a way to vouch for the quality of what is available.

For many marketers, reading reviews can be extremely valuable. “I have found reviews of existing writers on the platform to be the most important part of content writing services,” says Stacy Caprio, the Founder of Growth Marketing. “A content service is made up of many individual writers, but the specific writer you receive will determine the quality of the content you receive. It is important to make sure you are using and receiving the highest quality content and writers possible.”

Writing samples can also be an important part of the assessment process. Most professional content writing services maintain a vast sample library to help clients evaluate everything from areas of expertise to tone and style.

The right content writing service can put your business on the fast track to success, providing you with access to high-quality content that will rank well and serve your customers. By choosing the perfect partner, you can rest easy knowing that your content is always in good hands.

Need a content partner? Want to write for amazing clients? Get in touch with us today and see what we can do.

The post Questions to Determine the Right Content Writing Service appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/questions-to-determine-the-right-content-writing-service/feed/ 0
How Optimizing to Rank For The Featured Snippet Can Go Wrong https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-optimizing-to-rank-for-the-featured-snippet-can-go-wrong/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-optimizing-to-rank-for-the-featured-snippet-can-go-wrong/#respond Thu, 05 Mar 2020 14:00:01 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27247 The featured snippet is the coveted zero position on Google. This isn’t one of those times where zero is a bad thing; it means your page and content are featured above almost anything else in the search results. That’s high-value real estate in the instant-gratification, first-clicks-go-to-top-spots culture of the internet. So, it’s no wonder everyone […]

The post How Optimizing to Rank For The Featured Snippet Can Go Wrong appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
The featured snippet is the coveted zero position on Google. This isn’t one of those times where zero is a bad thing; it means your page and content are featured above almost anything else in the search results. That’s high-value real estate in the instant-gratification, first-clicks-go-to-top-spots culture of the internet.

So, it’s no wonder everyone wants in on this featured snippet game. Over the past year at Crowd Content, we’ve had increasing numbers of clients asking for writers to craft snippet-rich content. Snippet-rich content answers search queries in a concise, organized fashion; it’s also the type of content most likely to win the featured snippet (also called the Google Answer Box).

ALSO Hire Skilled SEO Content Writers Here

What is the featured snippet? The featured snippet is the coveted zero position on Google.

Why Do You Want the Featured Snippet?

Who doesn’t want to be the first result in the search engine? The benefits of the spot can include:

  • Increased traffic, as people often click the first result that pops up for their query.
  • Better brand authority, because your content shows up prominently at the top of the search engine, making it more likely people will remember your site or company.
  • You potentially steal traffic from the top organic search result, which is helpful if you haven’t landed the top spot.
  • Some sites find that winning the snippet leads to increased organic conversion rates.
  • Snippet-rich content performs well in voice search because it’s short, concise and customer targeted to searcher intent.

The Danger of Blindly Chasing the Snippet

Yes, there’s a lot of value in the featured snippet. And clients who are chasing it are clearly paying attention to SEO trends and best practices, which we applaud.

But we’ve noticed another trend developing over the past year: Some people are chasing the featured snippet at the expense of content quality or other SEO efforts. Or, they don’t realize that the featured snippet isn’t a magic box that solves all your SEO problems; winning the snippet the wrong way can actually diminish your organic traffic.

Check out these times when optimizing for the featured snippet can go wrong and how to avoid them.

You Give the Cow Away for Free

Perhaps the biggest risk is that you do such a good job of answering searcher intent in your snippet that the click never happens. If you answer the query and leave nothing on the table, there’s no reason for the searcher to click any result; they found their answer on Google’s page and that was the end of their activity for that query.

Will Craig, the managing director of LeaseFetcher, says that obtaining the zero position on Google is often one of their top priorities. But it doesn’t always go as planned. He recounts a time when winning the featured snippet dropped their click-through rate substantially.

“We’ve seen our click-through rate drop up to 24% on our featured snippet for the keyword write off lease since the launch of our in-depth pillar guide. So, although we are providing users with the instant, concise answers they need and want, a lot of the users get all the information they need from the featured snippet and, as a result, don’t click through to our website.”

How to avoid the issue? Kim Streich, a technical marketer at Sovereign Man, says, “The most important part is to make sure the snippet answers the query but at the same time evokes curiosity and sells the reader on wanting to read the full article. Otherwise, you risk a low click-through-rate.”

Feature Snippet Performance Can Be Fickle

Colin Ma is a digital marketing entrepreneur and founder of Makujin Media. He provided analytics from his own data that help demonstrate how the featured snippet can drive both wins and losses. According to Ma’s experience and data:

  • Around 10% of the time, businesses see a 20% (or more) increase in traffic
  • Around 35% of the time, pages get between a 5% and 20% increase
  • Around 35% of the time, the impact is nothing or negligible
  • Around 20% of the time, attempts at the featured snippet result in a 5% to 20% traffic decrease
  • A very small percent of the time (around 1% or less), attempts can drop your traffic more than 20%
Feature Snippet Performance Can Be Fickle

The too long; didn’t math story here is that if you optimize for featured snippets, you might hurt SEO performance one time out of every five.

How to avoid the issue? You shouldn’t avoid chasing the snippet completely. Ma doesn’t, even though he’s seen the 1% described above. He tells of working with a client with a page that received 3,500 hits per day that drove a four-figure income daily. Ma made some changes on the page to capture the featured snippet and checked back a week later to see how they were performing.

The results were not positive. Traffic was down 40% and revenue down around 60%. Ma didn’t panic or eschew featured snippets altogether. Instead, he worked on the page, and within three weeks, he had captured the snippet. The results were 4,500 daily hits and an increase of 50% in revenue over the original numbers.

The lesson here is pretty standard: If at first you don’t succeed (at winning the feature snippet), consider trying again.

You Chase Featured Snippets That Don’t Exist or Make Sense

But don’t keep trying for featured snippets that don’t exist or make any sense for your brand or audience.

Not every query has a featured snippet. According to Ahrefs’ data from 2017, around 12.29% of queries could pop a featured snippet. That’s likely increased slightly over the years, but it’s far from the majority at this point. Trying to optimize your content for snippets when Google hasn’t gotten around to adding them yet definitely puts the cart in front of the horse and could result in wasted marketing effort and spend.

And even if a featured snippet does exist, it may not make sense for you to win it. Streich gives an example of this, saying, “Make sure the query matches the goal of your website. For example, our website won the snippet for Norway taxes, and taxes are a core topic for our company. While this result drives a lot of traffic to our site, the intent of the searcher doesn’t match our content, and so it doesn’t generate a lot of value in terms of leads and revenue.”

How to avoid the issue? Instead of concentrating solely on the idea of a featured snippet, focus on holistic SEO and semantic completeness. If you’re creating comprehensive, high-quality content that answers the intent of the search, you’re positioning yourself to potentially win the featured snippet at the same time.

Katie Kuchta, the marketing manager for LawnStarter Lawn Care, provides some advice for covering all your bases, including the featured snippet. “Always do your research,” she says. “Ahrefs is super helpful for looking at who currently owns the featured snippet for a certain keyword. You can also use the same tool to see what pages of your website are featured as a snippet. Using this tool can help you identify, first and foremost, what the competition is like on the first page of the results and the type of content that is ranking. Use that as a guide to help you optimize your content.”

Featured-Snippet-Quote

Kuchta also advises:

  • Answer questions that others didn’t and add unique information that others didn’t cover.
  • Make it easy for anyone (and any search engine) to read. Add in headers, bullet points and summaries.
  • Try to create comprehensive content that a skimmer can quickly look through and get all the important information within a minute of scrolling through the page.

You Compromise Your Content Quality for the Snippet

Finally, don’t give in to the temptation to use shortcuts. We’re seeing clients simply grabbing the list of People Who Also Ask questions and creating pages that ask and answer each one. That might seem comprehensive, but not every question asked by people browsing the internet is relevant to your page or target audience.

Featured snippets should be part of the quality content you create. They shouldn’t be the foundation of it.

If you’re struggling to create comprehensive content that performs in SERPs, consider partnering with Crowd Content. Our enterprise project teams and experienced writers know how to incorporate SEO elements in ways that improve your page performance and user experience, not derail it.

ALSO – Black Hat SEO Tactics That Work in 2020, But Might Not For Long

The post How Optimizing to Rank For The Featured Snippet Can Go Wrong appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-optimizing-to-rank-for-the-featured-snippet-can-go-wrong/feed/ 0
How to Write Engaging SEO Buyers’ Guides for Your Website https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/how-to-write-engaging-seo-buyers-guides-for-your-website/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/how-to-write-engaging-seo-buyers-guides-for-your-website/#respond Thu, 27 Feb 2020 16:30:22 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27334 Close to 90% of shoppers start their buying journey on digital channels. Before they even step into a storefront — potentially before they step out of their front door — consumers are consulting search engines to find out more about what product they might need or want. And that’s obviously even more true for purchases […]

The post How to Write Engaging SEO Buyers’ Guides for Your Website appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Close to 90% of shoppers start their buying journey on digital channels. Before they even step into a storefront — potentially before they step out of their front door — consumers are consulting search engines to find out more about what product they might need or want. And that’s obviously even more true for purchases made online.

Whether consumers are querying Siri or typing into a desktop browser, one thing is consistent: If you’re not engaging in digital marketing and ensuring your site is search-engine optimized for every stage of the buyer’s journey by creating relevant ecommerce content, you could be missing out on these opportunities.

One way to create SEO content that helps you show up for consumers online is by publishing high-quality buying guides. Plus, this content can increase user experience on your site and help persuade someone in the middle or later parts of the funnel to click and make a purchase (or visit your local store to do so). High-quality buying guides can be planted with mid-funnel search terms that draw in consumers at that stage of their journey and help set the stage for harvesting conversions later.

Read on to find out how to write engaging SEO buyers’ guides that help land you on the first page of SERPs and guide your customers through appropriate buying decisions once they discover your brand.

What Are SEO Buyers’ Guides?

An SEO buyers’ guide is exactly what it sounds like. It’s a piece of search-engine optimized content that also guides the buyer through various aspects of shopping or making a purchase.

The concept of an SEO buying guide is based on the fact that modern shoppers tend to follow a path to purchasing that aligns with the roadmap below.

  • The buying journey begins with the search engine.
  • The consumer clicks your link (if you’ve done the SEO work to show up).
  • Your interesting, relevant content informs the consumer’s decision.
  • At this point, the consumer makes a purchase decision or continues to ponder and research, depending on where they are in the funnel. A good buying guide informs that next action, whatever it might be.

Top of the funnel: An introductory buying guide provides high-level options and helps the consumer see the brand as an expert. This increases the chance the consumer will return to the site or brand once they’re ready to take the next step.

Middle of the funnel: Typically, this is where buying guides shine the brightest. The consumer is aware of their need and may know what type of solution they want. The buying guide sets the brand or its products up as a high-quality solution, prompting the consumer to click through, sign up or call to find out more.

Bottom of the funnel: The consumer is ready to make a purchase now or nearly immediately. Some buying guides concentrate more on specific products to help the consumer make a final decision between items. But it’s important to realize that buying guides should work in conjunction with your other content. For example, product descriptions are usually the bottom of the funnel content that ultimately drives the conversion, so using your buying guides to push site visitors toward those pages is a good idea.

Need help with product copy? Connect with a skilled product description writer.

ALSO5 Secrets From Successful Product Copy Teams

What Are the Benefits of Publishing SEO Buying Guides?

Buying guides provide a number of simultaneous benefits, including:

  • Increasing on-page SEO and rankings for valuable middle of the funnel keywords
  • Providing high-quality, comprehensive content that helps increase the E-A-T value of your pages
  • Delivering something of value to the consumer to increase brand loyalty, trust, and authority
  • Creating a potential path via which a consumer finds the product or service they need and helps nudge them toward a purchase decision
  • Providing valuable long-form content for your site

All those benefits combine to help your page perform better in SERPs and increase your conversion rate and revenue.

Buying Guide Benefits

Josh Bluman, Co-founder of JJ Suspenders, notes that buying guides “make your site an authority on a subject, which is also good for SEO and can improve your overall website’s ranking.” That’s because buying guides are an example of comprehensive content. They naturally provide complete coverage of a topic, answering a lot of questions searchers have about products or types or solutions and incorporating a wide range of semantic keywords.

“We recently started adding a bunch of buying guides on our off-site blog MajestyCoffeeSchool.com,” says Nunzio Ross, the co-owner and ops manager of Majesty Coffee. “The results have been fantastic. We’ve noticed a pretty substantial increase in traffic and sales since we started doing it…It’s pretty safe to say our sales have increased by about 1/4 since the buyer’s guides started getting traffic.”

Common Types of Buying Guides

Buying guides actually come in a wide range of content types, and how you create yours depends on factors such as best practices for your industry, the needs and wants of your audience, and which part of the sales funnel you’re targeting. If you’re not sure where to start, consider five common types of buying guides below.

5 Common Types of Buying Guides

As you can see, a lot of these types of buying guides can overlap. You can have an introductory shopping guide or a technical comparison guide, for example. It’s up to you to mix and match these elements to create content that resonates with your audience.

Top Tips for Creating Compelling Buying Guides

Put some of the tips below to work to create buyers’ guide content that sets you apart from others both in the search engines and with your readers.

7 Tips for Buying Guides

1. Conduct research before you write.

Don’t assume that because you’re an expert on your products that you’re also an expert on what people want to know. Ross says the entire point of a buying guide is to answer the questions customers might be asking. Do keyword research to find out what people are turning to search engines to find out, then answer those queries in your buying guides.

Why? Keyword research aligns your content with what’s performing in search results, increasing your chance of landing a top spot. Content that answers specific consumer queries gets more engagement and keeps people coming back to your page.

ALSOQualitative Keyword Research: How to Invest 10 Minutes into Your Content Marketing Process & See Your Content Rise to the Top of Google

2. Use conversational language that aligns with your audience.

Write as if you’re an expert speaking to a friend about the topic—but think about how you communicate with different subsets of friends. A gamer who is explaining his computer choice to a non-gaming friend uses different language than he would when explaining to another gamer. Use the right communication style for your target audience.

Why? People turn to buyers’ guides for help making a purchasing decision, but no one wants to be talked down to (or talked over).

3. Pay attention to formatting.

“Huge blocks of text,” says Ross, “are a no-no.” Break up your content with plenty of headers, bulleted lists, tables and other scannable content. Don’t skimp on design. Buying guides are typically long-form content, but the best examples are visually appealing and draw the reader in with more than a wall of text. 

Why? It helps the reader digest the information and makes content easier to glance through when seeking fast answers to a specific question.

4. Always ensure content is optimized for mobile.

Use responsive designs and write shorter paragraphs that won’t create a wall of text on mobile devices whenever possible.

Why? A huge portion of people who start their buying journey on digital channels do so via mobile devices. And users don’t just conduct research from a single device; 60% or more move from device to device as they go through the buyer journey.

Buying Guides Mobile Optimized

5. Write with authority.

Bluman says brands should ask, “Does this content help us become an authority on the subject and build our brand?” You shouldn’t publish buying guides for the sake of taking up more pages on your website. They should come from a desire to truly assist consumers and share what you know about the products you create or sell.

Ask yourself: What will make my guide the most comprehensive content for this subject, and how do I make sure the search engines agree?

Why? First, it’s more authentic. Pages and pages of buying guides that simply try to hit an SEO keyword are lackluster, boring and, in some cases, seen as inauthentic. A few high-quality buying guides that provide expert advice and answers are valuable to your readers, which increases the value of your brand in their eyes. Second, it’s good for SEO. Google likes expert, authoritative pages readers can trust.

6. Include images and other media.

Break your buying guide text up with pictures, videos and other media.

Why? People want to see the products you’re recommending, including how to use them. Images and video also make it more likely someone will share your content on social media.

7. Include links and calls to action.

Don’t turn your informative buyers’ guide into a sales free-for-all, but do include relevant product links, buy buttons or CTAs to get a quote or schedule an appointment.

Why? Ultimately, at the end of the day, conversion is what you’re after. The best way to foster that in high-quality content is to provide specific and helpful next steps.

Where Should Buyers’ Guides Go on Your Site?

No one rule exists for the best on-site location for your buyers’ guides. You may need to test various locations to find what works for you. However, here are some starting guidelines that work for many sites.

  • Buying guides aren’t landing pages. Don’t use them in place of presell, sales and landing pages to try to make conversions after funneling interested readers via ads.
  • Buying guides are definitely not home page copy.
  • You might publish product buying guides on category pages. Category pages list all of a similar type of product (such as women’s jeans or coffee makers), and a relevant buying guide on the bottom of the page can support SEO.
  • You might publish buying guides on your blog, using those pages to drive organic traffic and link into your eCommerce pages.
  • You can create a specific area of your site for consumer resources, placing buying guides there and linking to them from relevant category, brand and product pages.

What Types of Keywords Should Your Buying Guides Target?

Short version? The types of keywords that people are searching for. Do your research with tools such as SEMrush to find out what phrases consumers are using to find this type of information. 

Slightly longer version? Since most buying guides are mid-funnel content, they should incorporate mid-funnel keywords. Typically, these keywords indicate the consumer is headed toward a decision but they still need a bit of guidance. Examples of mid-funnel keywords include:

  • What’s the most cost-effective phone?
  • Best smart TVs
  • How to choose roman blinds for my window
  • Reviews for plumbers in Austin

Buying guides might also incorporate some keywords with commercial intent. These are often targeted with product descriptions, but it makes sense to pepper a few in buying guides to better support the bridge that allows mid-funnel visitors to convert to bottom-funnel customers as they engage with your content.

Commercial intent keywords are those that indicate the person has a serious plan to make a purchase immediately or soon. Phrases that include words such as buy, deal, discount, price, cost, coupon, free shipping, affordable, best, comparison and review all indicate potential commercial intent. 

Get Help Creating Buying Guides That Perform

Sold on the concept of buyers’ guides, but not sure how to string all that content together? No worries. Our team of professional copywriters bring product knowledge, SEO savvy, and wordsmithing to the table to craft buying guide copy that can wow the wariest of readers.

The post How to Write Engaging SEO Buyers’ Guides for Your Website appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/how-to-write-engaging-seo-buyers-guides-for-your-website/feed/ 0
Have Bulk Content Writing Projects? 6 Key Things You Need To Know https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/have-bulk-content-writing-projects-6-key-things-you-need-to-know/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/have-bulk-content-writing-projects-6-key-things-you-need-to-know/#respond Thu, 20 Feb 2020 18:38:29 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27187 Content marketers and SEO experts know that content is critical to the success of their campaigns. Even the best strategies need amazing content to fuel their results. However, some circumstances may require content in far larger batches, ranging from hundreds to tens of thousands of words per day. Think of eCommerce stores that need to […]

The post Have Bulk Content Writing Projects? 6 Key Things You Need To Know appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content marketers and SEO experts know that content is critical to the success of their campaigns. Even the best strategies need amazing content to fuel their results.

However, some circumstances may require content in far larger batches, ranging from hundreds to tens of thousands of words per day. Think of eCommerce stores that need to rewrite an entire store’s worth of product descriptions, a service business that needs to write content for hundreds of location pages, or an agency that needs to create monthly blog posts for dozens of clients. 

Creating quality content in bulk presents some unique challenges. 

If you have a bulk content writing project on the horizon, this is what you need to know about ensuring your project goes off without a hitch.

What Constitutes a Bulk Project?

A bulk project refers to any content writing demand that requires a large amount of content in a short period of time. It follows that it often refers to projects that involve large numbers of content writers.

What constitutes bulk can vary from one company or project or another but generally, the requirements include:

  • A large amount of content on a short turnaround time
  • Content that requires a team of writers rather than a single content writer
  • Consistency in tone and voice between pieces
  • Consistent quality between pieces
  • Affordable pricing to accommodate large-scale orders
  • A way to store and publish large amounts of content
  • Usually done with SEO in mind
A definition and explanation of bulk content with image of content elements

Types of Bulk Content

Bulk content can come in a number of forms but generally involves similar content that needs to be reproduced across a variety of items with fresh, unique content specific to each item. It also usually has to fit into a defined template. 

We typically see bulk projects from companies that are seeking to revamp their product descriptions, provide reviews on services that encompass many geographical areas, or who require landing or summary pages on a large array of topics. 

ALSOWant Success With Local Landing Pages? Learn How to Avoid These Pitfalls

A retirement community review site that covers the whole country, for example, will likely require a large amount of content in a short time span to cover thousands of communities – that can’t be accommodated by a single writer completing a few pieces a week. Other companies may require city pages, content to build a glossary of terms or an index of resources, or blog posts for agency clients. 

The most common categories of bulk content include:

  • Blog posts
  • City or location-specific pages
  • Category page descriptions
  • Product descriptions
  • App descriptions
  • Review pages
  • Social media posts
A list of common bulk content types with person working on laptop in the background

Bulk content may also be ordered by agencies with diverse needs, like companies that build simple websites and have a large number of clients.

6 Key Tips For Creating a Bulk Content Game Plan

So you know you need bulk content and you have an idea of what you want – but how you get there takes time and planning. These six key tips can help you nail even the largest bulk content writing projects.

6 key tips for creating bulk content writing projects

Determine the Size and Scale of Projects

As the word bulk isn’t exactly quantifiable, it’s important to determine what exactly you need. No two bulk projects will be exactly the same, so knowing you need a lot of content is not the same as putting together a game plan you can use to guide your process. This can include:

  • A rough estimate of word count
  • The number of writers needed to accommodate your expectations
  • A map of deadlines, like how many words you need completed each week or when the project needs to be completed
  • A plan to hire writers if in-house teams cannot meet the demands of an expansive project
  • An average quota of articles per writer in order to determine the appropriate team size

ALSOOutsourcing Content Writing: Tips for Finding and Working With Writers for Excellent Content Marketing Results

Define Quality Expectations

Quality is an important element of any kind of content creation. Google has been explicit about its expectations for quality content that it will rank well, so failing to adhere to best practices can be a dangerous game. Before you get started on your project, you need to have a basic idea of what caliber you are looking for with your work. If your pages or product descriptions are basic or simple, the best of the best may not be necessary. However, complex or technical information may mean searching for experts to ensure your needs are met.

Quality can be a sizable challenge, as Ron Stefanski, the owner and founder of PrisonInsight.com, knows well. He states, “the biggest challenge we have [in creating bulk content] is maintaining quality content standards. We’ve done our best to put a team in place that includes high-quality writers and an editor to approve everything, but there is always room for improvement.”

At the end of the day, quality requires a process. You need to know the level of quality you want to achieve and how you’re going to get there, from the guidelines you put in place to the writers you recruit, right through to who is going to edit the work and ultimately publish it.

Put Together a Style Guide

No two writers are exactly the same. From JK Rowling to Dostoevsky, all writers have a unique voice. However, in a bulk project, this isn’t always a good thing. In general, a bulk content project should read more like a unified presentation than a mishmash of different styles and preferences.

A style guide can help ensure all writers understand expectations, preferences, keyword use, formatting, word count, and virtually anything else necessary to the success of a project. A good style guide also provides context about the purpose of content and the target audience.

Image showing 6 things to include in a style guide

Andrew Barrett, Director of Content at Seniorly, explains the detailed information he makes available to the content team supporting his ongoing projects: “We provide important keywords, an outline for the content, important industry knowledge and facts that would inform their writing, and appropriate links to sources.” Ultimately, the more information is available, the better-prepared writers will be to meet expectations.

Assemble the Right Team

The team of writers you choose can make or break your project, so it’s important to choose wisely. Writers should be flexible, skilled, adaptable, and able to meet deadlines, regardless of the caliber of projects.

Writers can be hired on full-time, outsourced through freelance marketplaces, or onboarded through writing-specific platforms, like Crowd Content. Companies can manage teams themselves or go through a third party to oversee projects and handle editing, taking the burden off of a small marketing department. Regardless of methodology, choosing the right team is critically important to turning around quality work on tight deadlines.

Says Ron Stefanski, “if you want to be successful, you need a team to help. Don’t try to do all of this yourself for a long time. While I encourage people to start by doing this themselves so they understand exactly what’s needed and how difficult it is, outsourcing is crucial to scaling and having success.”

Quote from Ron Stefanski on bulk content creation

Keep in mind that a good team goes beyond writers. For those who don’t have in-house resources to serve in a support function, editors and QA pros are also highly valuable. Editors can make sure content meets style guides and best practices, while QAs can oversee formatting and publishing to ensure a perfect outcome.

ALSOChallenges of Managing Freelance Writers Directly and How to Overcome Them

Process, Process, Process

You’ve probably picked up on this based on the tips preceding this highlighting that you need multiple different types of team members, but making sure you develop a controlled content creation process is critical to the success of any bulk content writing project.

At Crowd Content, we often define several steps that every piece of content must go through before it’s delivered to a client and published:

  1. Research
  2. SEO research
  3. Writing
  4. Editing
  5. Quality Assurance
  6. Delivery
  7. Publishing

This varies a bit from project to project, but the key here is that you have focused team members responsible for each step. This helps ensure you get a consistent result and that your project delivers the results you expect. 

Provide Consistent and Timely Feedback

Every team is only as good as its weakest link. When working with writers, clear, coherent feedback and regular communication are musts. This is particularly true in the early days of a project: as writers are getting used to your preferences and the tone and style of a project, they’ll need guidance to get as comfortable as possible with your expectations.

This means providing writing samples, offering editing to highlight where writers are succeeding and where they’re going wrong, and consistently providing refresher training to keep everyone on the same page. As metrics become available, it’s also helpful to provide samples of pieces that ranked well versus less effective content. By setting up Slack rooms or forums, it’s possible to stay in constant connection with writers, field questions, provide context, and offer updates in a timely manner.

Communication goes both ways, too. “As writers asked us follow up questions, we revised the creative briefs and informed the team of writers to review the revisions,” says Andrew Barrett about his team’s process of creating guidelines that got writers up and running.

Coordinating bulk writing projects isn’t easy, but the right strategy can go a long way. With these six key tips to ensure increased output, consistent quality, and ongoing improvement opportunities, you can prepare for even your biggest content writing aspirations.


The post Have Bulk Content Writing Projects? 6 Key Things You Need To Know appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/have-bulk-content-writing-projects-6-key-things-you-need-to-know/feed/ 0
How to Leverage Expert Content Writers https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/do-you-need-expert-writers-what-type-of-expert-do-you-need/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/do-you-need-expert-writers-what-type-of-expert-do-you-need/#respond Wed, 12 Feb 2020 18:50:23 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27106 If brands want to establish trust and authority in their field and rank on Google, they need high-quality content crafted by experts. But there’s more to the story. As search engine competition heats up, brands are increasingly relying on expert contributors to boost their rankings. There’s nothing Google loves more than high-quality content written by […]

The post How to Leverage Expert Content Writers appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
If brands want to establish trust and authority in their field and rank on Google, they need high-quality content crafted by experts. But there’s more to the story.

As search engine competition heats up, brands are increasingly relying on expert contributors to boost their rankings. There’s nothing Google loves more than high-quality content written by domain experts and industry authorities. And when you give Google what it loves, it rewards you with trust, authority and a steady stream of new leads.

But this increased demand for expert content means those same experts cost more and more. Someone with a law degree or Ph.D. next to their name probably won’t write your content for a few cents per word. If you want to establish trust and authority in Google’s ranks, it’s going to cost you a premium, right?

Right! Well, it depends, actually.

Why Brands Leverage Experts for Content

Readers can tell when an article was authored by someone with experience and a deep interest in the subject. The originality shines and the ideas are crystal clear. The content stands apart from the competition and instills confidence. But wowing readers is only half the battle.

Content also has to wow Google.

In its quest to provide the most relevant and highest quality content available, Google continuously refines its algorithms. And make no mistake: These are highly sophisticated algorithms capable of discerning great from not-so-great. Thankfully, the search giant isn’t without its benevolent streak, telling content producers exactly what it’s looking for through its E-A-T guidelines.

We’ve covered in detail what Google’s E-A-T guidelines mean for brands and how they impact content production and search engine performance. The long and short of it is this: Google wants to see high-quality, authoritative content written by trusted experts with deep insights.

For this reason, marketers are turning to expert writers to produce reviews, buying guides and thought leadership pieces. After all, in a world full of fake news and questionable recommendations, when you can establish trust and authority in your domain, you’re much more likely to make the conversion.

Defining an Expert Writer

Despite Google’s biases toward content written by experts, there’s an important distinction to make on what constitutes expertise. The guidelines aren’t implying that your content writers should hold doctorates in your field. The search giant recognizes that people develop expertise through all kinds of life experiences — formal or otherwise.

Take this paragraph, for example, pulled from Google’s Search Quality Evaluator Guidelines:

“Some topics require less formal expertise. Many people write extremely detailed, helpful reviews of products or restaurants. Many people share tips and life experiences on forums, blogs, etc. These ordinary people may be considered experts in topics where they have life experience. If it seems as if the person creating the content has the type and amount of life experience to make him or her an ‘expert’ on the topic, we will value this ‘everyday expertise’ and not penalize the person/webpage/website for not having ‘formal’ education or training in the field.”

In other words, how Google classifies expertise depends on the niche. Informal experience is perfectly valid, even for more advanced topics such as finance or health. It gives the example of a forum where caregivers share tips with each other regarding caring for chronically ill family members. These folks are living the experience, and that makes them qualified to share it.

“When I look for an expert, I am definitely interested in credentials. However, this doesn’t have to be a formal designation. All I really want is someone who has demonstrated his or her expertise. If they run a blog about a particular topic, this helps a lot,” says James Pollard, founder of The Advisor Coach, a marketing consultancy firm that works with financial advisors.

Google’s requirements do tighten on topics surrounding “your money, your life.” Referred to as YMYL, these could potentially impact a person’s finances, health or overall well-being, so the search engine gets a little more discerning about credentials. That said, the overall message remains the same: The expertise of the writing must match the level of the subject.

The Types of Expert Writers

There are a few key ways to identify experts, according to Google. The traditional credentialed experts are the people with initials behind their names. They’re the doctors writing about cancer, the nurses writing about patient triage and the CPAs writing about taxes.

Next are experts with resume experience. These are writers with real-world experience in the field they write about. A retail salesman who authors buying guides, a software developer who writes about start-ups or a bookkeeper creating personal finance content are good examples.

“When hiring experts, I look for certifications and experience. It is also beneficial if they have an established online presence so we can link to their work on other credible websites,” says Darin Evangelista, a freelance content marketing consultant and content strategist at ChatterSource.

Finally, authors with publishing authority are people with bylines in major publications. For example, a journalist who’s written extensively about mental health is certainly qualified to write about the subject.

“One way that we’re doing this is by hiring authors who have a great reputation in their industry. We do research on writers to see where they’ve been published in the past. We also check their writing quality and their level of expertise,” says Jacob Landis-Eigsti, owner at the marketing consulting company Jacob LE.

Types of expert writers

The Cost of Expertise

As with health care, specialists command a higher rate than generalists. You wouldn’t expect to pay a surgeon the same rate you pay your family physician. Content writing is no different: Authority costs more.

But just how much more depends on the industry, the content and the kind of expertise needed. While expert content prices vary wildly, you can expect to pay at least double what you’d pay a generalist. Landis-Eigsti says the price multiplier on experts is even higher. “As a small business, it’s tempting to spend $30-50 on an inexpensive writer, but we’ve had better luck by finding someone who is an expert and paying 5-10 times as much.”

But that extra up-front expense does offer some benefits, says Landis-Eigsti. “When you hire an expert writer, you’ll get a better finished article. It’s more likely to rank with Google and we don’t spend our valuable resources on revisions and rewrites.”

But there’s another distinction to make, and that’s between an expert and an expert writer. An expert has authority attached to their name in the form of a degree or job title, but they may not be a great writer. They’re almost certainly not well-versed in SEO practices. It’s likely that content produced by a pure expert will require some heavy editing before it’s ready to be published.

Fortunately, you don’t necessarily need a doctor to write your content. In addition to knowing how to write for online audiences and create content that aligns with SEO strategies, an expert writer can establish authority in other ways. These include:

  • Implementing quotes from credentialed experts
  • Including current, authoritative research and links to back up facts and stats
  • Having a credentialed pro review the content before it’s published and listing them as the reviewer in the byline area

A Team Approach to Content Writing

When it comes to producing great content that aligns with your brand’s goals, messaging and style, you need quality writers. But that doesn’t mean all your content requires a writer with domain expertise. There are several types of content often produced by nonexperts with great results, including:

  • Product descriptions
  • Basic blog posts on general topics
  • City and local pages
  • Meta tags and descriptions

With this kind of content, the quality rests on different metrics. You need great marketing writers who know how to write with relevant keywords and a larger SEO strategy in mind. You typically wouldn’t include bylines for these pages. Instead, your brand, about us page and the overall site serve as the authority in these areas.

Building a well-rounded writing team can provide your brand with the benefits of specialized niche writers while leveraging more cost-effective generalists for other kinds of writing. This is one of the biggest benefits of the Crowd Content platform: You gain access to a wide variety of professionals that include domain specialists and general marketing writers alike.

Evangelista agrees, saying, “I like to utilize a mix of expert writers and more general writers, depending on the subject matter.”

Hiring experts

Frequently Asked Questions

What is an expert content writer?

An expert writer is one who’s skilled in writing web content on a domain- or industry-specific topics. They’re capable of producing high-quality content within their niche that’s engaging and thoughtful while still being set up to rank well in search engines.

Is content written by an industry expert guaranteed to rank well?

Not necessarily, though it depends on the expert. It’s important to keep in mind that someone with expert knowledge in a particular field may not know the ins and outs of producing search-optimized content. This is why it’s important to find an expert content writer, not just simply an expert.

Why should I hire an expert writer?

Hiring an expert writer ensures your content establishes trust through expertise. This is especially important in specialized industries, such as finance or technology, where your readers are likely to be much more knowledgeable about the given topics.

How much does it cost to hire an expert content writer?

Rates vary wildly depending on the writer and their niche, but most expert writers charge anywhere from 10 cents to a dollar or more per word.

Where can I hire expert writers?

You can find expert writers right here on Crowd Content! We have thousands of qualified writers with a range of industry experience. You can create casting calls to find writers with specific domain knowledge or let our project managers build a team for you.

Another good way to find expert writers is by simply scouring the web. Industry-specific forums and groups are good for locating freelancers, as is searching on social media sites such as LinkedIn.

Benefits of hiring expert writers

Leveraging Crowd Content’s Expert Writers

Looking for an expert writer to help with your content marketing strategy? We can help. At Crowd Content, we source thousands of expert writers with a range of industry experience to help our clients produce top-tier content at affordable prices. We even depend on our writers to help produce our content, so you can rest assured they know their stuff.

Using our platform, you can search through our writers to find the perfect fit or open a casting call and build your own expert writing team. No time for building and managing a team? No problem. Our customer service experts and content managers can do it for you.

Go ahead and get started today.

The post How to Leverage Expert Content Writers appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/do-you-need-expert-writers-what-type-of-expert-do-you-need/feed/ 0
Black Hat SEO Tactics That Work in 2020, But Might Not For Long https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/black-hat-seo-tactics-that-work-in-2020-but-might-not-for-long/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/black-hat-seo-tactics-that-work-in-2020-but-might-not-for-long/#respond Thu, 06 Feb 2020 18:40:42 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=27043 Search engine optimization is a priority for marketing teams of all shapes and sizes. Higher rankings mean more traffic, visibility and conversions – so the incentive is quite clear.  However, SEO isn’t a one-size-fits-all endeavor. There are many different ways to approach SEO, and what works for one company may not work for another. In […]

The post Black Hat SEO Tactics That Work in 2020, But Might Not For Long appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Search engine optimization is a priority for marketing teams of all shapes and sizes. Higher rankings mean more traffic, visibility and conversions – so the incentive is quite clear. 

However, SEO isn’t a one-size-fits-all endeavor. There are many different ways to approach SEO, and what works for one company may not work for another. In spite of this, some tactics are better than others and are more likely to work for a longer period of time. 

When choosing an SEO strategy for your business, it’s important to understand best practices as well as the most effective ways to succeed while still following Google’s rules and preferences (like writing high-quality SEO content). 

This post covers what you need to know about black hat SEO, including how it works, when it works, what the future may hold, and why sticking with white hat techniques is the best way to approach SEO in the long-term.

Black Hat vs. White Hat SEO

In general, SEO practices can be divided into two categories: white hat and black hat. White hat practices are considered those done in good faith that play by the rules of Google’s search guidelines. Things like the legitimate use of keywords and high-quality content are considered white hat strategies as these are the kinds of activities that Google encourages.

Black hat SEO techniques, on the other hand, skirt Google’s rules in order to see an immediate boost in traffic. These options are considered less legitimate and are seen as a way to break rules (or bend them, at best) in order to get ahead. While Google often penalizes sites caught using blatant black hat techniques, there are too many tactics and too many players out there for Google to catch all of them. 

A chart listing the differences between black hat and white hat seo tactics

And, while many of the more basic strategies, like keyword stuffing, are known and actively discouraged, even automatically penalized in Google’s algorithm, there are still some more advanced black hat techniques that still slip past Google’s ever-evolving algorithms and thus avoid SEO penalties. That is, unless a Google employee finds it and issues a manual penalty to a site. 

These are the black hat SEO options that Google may not notice today – but is certainly aware of and looking to crack down on in the future. 

AlsoGoogle’s Webmaster Guidelines: What Can You Learn to Help Future-Proof Your Content for Algorithm Updates

Doorway Pages

Want to drive traffic to your site? Of course you do! So, doesn’t it make sense to have as many pages as possible ranking that lead back to your contact or purchase pages? That’s where doorway pages come in – highly templated pages with thin, duplicated content that exist solely to rank for niche, long-tail keywords.

In theory, this makes sense. After all, peppering your site with keyword-rich doorway pages provides more content across the web that belongs to your company. And since these pages are often optimized for niche long-tail keywords, they often rank very well. This can lead to an increase in organic traffic as searchers click on these doorway pages. 

However, visitors are often greeted by a really poor experience on these pages, and immediately directed to actually important pages on the site. While some will make it to these pages, others will click away within a few seconds to find another resource that actually has something valuable to offer. 

The problems with doorway pages are clear – but wouldn’t giving up on doorway pages mean less traffic? Savannah Little, a Senior SEO Specialist at WRAL Digital Solutions, explains that the switch from unqualified traffic to qualified traffic can look like a decline year over year – but the metrics often tell a different story. As she puts it, “part of the transition from black hat techniques to white hat techniques includes imparting on the client the knowledge that not all traffic is good traffic and having less organic traffic is okay, especially when they’re converting at a higher rate and the year-over-year conversions are up.”

Quote from Savannah Little on Black Hat SEO Techniques

It’s important to distinguish between doorway pages established for the sake of being doorway pages and legitimate landing pages that differentiate between things like service areas. These kinds of pages, like city pages, can function in a similar way to doorway pages but as they provide quality user experiences, the end result is quite different.

For many businesses, putting more effort into what are effectively doorway pages and building valuable landing pages with great content could yield greater results and mean they don’t have to take down their existing pages. 

Expired Domains

Maintaining a website is a critical part of ongoing operations for pretty much any company. From time to time, domains expire, either as companies go under or choose to go in another direction online. However, domains aren’t just destroyed when they expire: they go up for sale to other buyers.

A common black hat strategy involves purchasing expired domains that previously ranked well and had backlinks from the kind of reputable sites Google likes to see. Then, fresh content can be created under the old URLs to include anything the buyer wants while still preserving the backlinks already in place. While this works superficially, Google is getting smarter at evaluating relevance, which puts this strategy on unsteady ground moving into 2020.

“This is a black hat tactic because it’s taking advantage of Google’s preference to rank highly authoritative websites in search,” explains Nikola Roza, the CEO and Owner of Nikola Roza – SEO for the Poor and Determined. “This tactic is on its way out in 2020 and beyond, because Google is getting smarter at determining relevance, and they will soon be able to figure out algorithmically this glaring lack of relevance, and devalue links pointing to these domains. And this will tank those black hat sites for good.”

Scholarship Link-Building

Scholarship link-building isn’t a terribly popular strategy but it’s still considered viable by some who are focused on getting valuable .edu links at all costs. These .edu links are valuable, often because the institutions behind them have huge domain authority, but the context of why you’re getting the backlink matters here. 

In essence, a company creates and advertises a scholarship for students in hopes that different schools and scholarship sites will feature their scholarship and include links to the company’s site. 

In many cases, the scholarship never pays out, and if it does, the amount is small and the purpose isn’t to reward students – it’s to game Google’s system.

“Even IF a webmaster pays out the scholarship, there’s misaligned intent and clear desire to ‘game’ the system, which is against Google’s Terms of Service. While Google hasn’t released a specific update targeting these profiles, scholarship link building is a clear footprint. Google COULD easily crackdown if (or when) they want to,” states Ewen Finser, a digital marketer and the Founder of TheDigitalMerchant.com.

Private Blog Networks

Private blog networks, or PBNs, have long been a fallback for companies of all sizes. This strategy involves the creation of a network of seemingly authoritative sites simply for the purpose of building links to a primary website. 

Note – sites created for PBNs often use expired domains with existing quality backlinks. 

While now largely out of vogue as Google is getting better at detecting this strategy, some businesses still believe that using PBNs is the best way to enhance domain authority.

However, Google now values page authority over domain authority, immediately decreasing the value in this once-trusted strategy. Google is also specifically targeting PBNs and has actually been de-indexing these pages if a network is suspected.

Link Swapping and Buying

Most marketers are aware that building backlinks is critical to search rankings and building authority, but not all are sure how to create an effective linking strategy organically. As such, link buying and link swapping have become a popular option for those who understand the principles behind linking as an SEO strategy but aren’t sure how to get started.

Link swapping is often managed through closed Facebook pages catering to niche industries that exist solely as a way to swap links. This essentially creates a large web of reciprocal linking. While this is in the grey area of SEO, it’s not an overly valuable tactic.

Andy Chadwick of Digital Quokka explains how this concept works, and why it’s not a great idea, calling a site that relies on the existence of link swapping, “a site whose link profile is almost entirely made up from domains who they too have linked to. You’ll see this most commonly on “mummy” and “recipe” type blogs where users will write a recipe and then link to their friend’s similar recipe and vice versa. We know Google’s actively targeting these sites,” he warns, citing an unnamed Google update from November.

Link buying, on the other hand, is considered questionable SEO from an ethical standpoint and Google strongly advises against it. For those in small or difficult niches, developing the content necessary to build quality backlinks can be a challenge. 

To get around this, many SEOs make use of services that explicitly sell links from websites that meet certain criteria. There are different ways this is achieved including getting links added to existing posts, publishing new guest posts, and even getting links added to directories. 

This lets the SEO choose the exact site placement he wants, what page of his it will link to, and also the anchor text he wants included in the backlink. In theory, it’s a really powerful tactic.

How to Build Quality Backlinks

Andy Chadwick explains why this idea is less effective than taking the necessary steps to do things right: “You need to ‘link build.’ Again, normally you’d pay for someone to do this. Here is where the subtle difference is – ‘link building’ should be done by building up relationships and making the right people aware that your content exists. ‘Buying’ is simply exchanging cash in place for a link. Normally the latter yields very poor results, especially in the long run, because if the site is selling links to you, they’re probably selling it to loads of other sites to and, eventually, the site will become spammy.”

What Can Go Wrong?

These tactics can and do work for many SEOs. SEOs, if nothing else, are great at finding new tactics that will drive results. They’re also quick to abandon tactics that no longer offer any value. 

Most of the tactics we’ve discussed have at least been discouraged by Google, which means they’ll likely try to reduce the tactics’ influence in Google’s search algorithm in upcoming updates. Or, they’ll build penalties into the algorithm. Either way – it will likely mean a drop in rankings and traffic for businesses that relied on these tactics.

A bigger threat to be aware of though comes in the form of manual penalties. This happens when someone from Google’s search team identifies unnatural SEO tactics on a site or group of sites and applies a manual penalty to the domain. This can result in a site being entirely removed from Google, and these penalties are notoriously hard to recover from. 

A graphic listing all of the Google Manual Penalties

ALSOThe Complete Guide to Google E-A-T: What Is It, Why Is It, and How Do You Create It?

White Hat Options

So if these black hat SEO tactics aren’t the best way forward for your SEO, what should you focus on?

There are actually a lot of ways to boost your SEO in a white hat way:

  1. Create high-quality and comprehensive content. On-page factors are hugely important, so having the best quality content on the web can do wonders for your SEO. An upside to this is that you’re likely to earn backlinks to your site if other marketers view your resources as valuable.
  2. Build link magnets – things like original research, surveys, tools, etc. – they’re all things that other marketers might consider linking to when attempting to add value to their audiences.
  3. Link outreach – there’s nothing wrong with reaching out directly to publishers in related fields and asking them to link to your resources. If it adds value to their readers, they might do it.
  4. Public relations – what’s old is new again, as they say. Public relations has evolved into a way for marketers to get major publications, bloggers, and influencers to cover newsworthy stories. If you can get this kind of coverage, the links are usually from high domain authority sites and carry a ton of weight.
A list of white hate SEO techniques to try in 2020

ALSO7 Tips for How to Write SEO Content

These are just a few approaches to try, but it’s important to keep in mind that they’re all likely to hold up over time and won’t run you much risk of being penalized by Google. That’s better for your business long-term.

And although doing things the white hat way may not be as quick or easy to generate large numbers of backlinks, the results are often better. 

As Reece Mack, an SEO Manager at Trek Marketing explains, “Consider Public Relations outreach, opinion articles, and guest posting to improve your authority and authentically build your public profile. These days, the quantity of backlinks doesn’t hold as much weight as the quality.”

Choosing Black Hat Options

For those who want to go from A to Z while skipping the rest of the alphabet, black hat techniques can seem enticing. However, it’s important to realize that Google’s approach to determining search results gets more sophisticated every day. The black hat strategies that work today, regardless to what extent, likely won’t work for long. As such, it’s very important that those considering these strategies understand the limitations – including the fact that any perceived growth is unlikely to generate real results in the long-term.

By staying on the up and up and perfecting skills in the white hat tactics Google encourages, it’s much easier to see sustainable and real growth that can benefit your business at a base level – not just on the surface.

The post Black Hat SEO Tactics That Work in 2020, But Might Not For Long appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/black-hat-seo-tactics-that-work-in-2020-but-might-not-for-long/feed/ 0
Using eCommerce Influencer Marketing to Drive your Brand Forward https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/using-ecommerce-influencer-marketing-to-drive-your-brand-forward/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/using-ecommerce-influencer-marketing-to-drive-your-brand-forward/#respond Tue, 28 Jan 2020 19:30:52 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=26989 Why eCommerce influencer marketing makes sense. To say that marketing and advertising have been through dramatic changes during the last ten years would be a serious understatement. The fact is, the old rule book hasn’t just been revised—the pages have been torn out and tossed into the fire pit. Audiences are fragmented like never before, […]

The post Using eCommerce Influencer Marketing to Drive your Brand Forward appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Why eCommerce influencer marketing makes sense.

To say that marketing and advertising have been through dramatic changes during the last ten years would be a serious understatement. The fact is, the old rule book hasn’t just been revised—the pages have been torn out and tossed into the fire pit. Audiences are fragmented like never before, attention spans are shorter, and brand loyalty is tenuous. 

While we mostly create eCommerce content for our clients and connect them with product description writers for larger projects, we do get asked about different marketing tactics that work well for eCommerce companies.

One solution that many eCommerce companies have turned to as they struggle to attract and hold consumer attention: eCommerce influencer marketing.

Influencer marketing is hot. Like, Arizona desert in July hot. Quite simply, it is transforming how successful eCommerce brands and stores sell online.

So what’s behind the move to influencer marketing? For starters, millennials and the generations following them have a deeply ingrained dislike of traditional advertising. In fact, 84% of them don’t trust the messages they encounter in old school media outlets like television, radio, print, and outdoor.

Image showing millennials influencer blog

When they are that reluctant to believe, they are even more likely to ignore messages altogether. But by leveraging the voice of a powerful influencer with a legitimate following in the right niche for your brand, you can reach even the most advertising-resistant group. 

It makes sense. Influencers forge special connections with their audiences in ways that traditional media vehicles never have. Influencers don’t just offer viewers or listeners or readers—they deliver ardent fans.

That said, it can be daunting to anyone wading into eCommerce influencer marketing for the first time. Traditional media is a far more straightforward process—spend dollars, establish as much frequency as possible, build awareness that you hope turns into sales. 

Social media, by its very nature, is more challenging.

Choosing placement is about getting the audience numbers and the demographics you want or can afford. But the effort to secure eyeballs or clicks can seem like a never-ending chase, and finding loyal customers feels more elusive than ever before.

Enter social media. And, more specifically, social media rock stars. Influencers. 

There are influencers of all kinds, from people with mass appeal to those who have followings in very specific niches. The ones with the most clout, however, have developed passionate, dedicated audiences. These fans value the opinions of the influencers they follow and will pay close attention when brands are endorsed or reviewed.

When an eCommerce company uses influencer marketing, the metrics are different. Most importantly, frequency is less important than authority. An influencer typically won’t tout your brand hundreds of times each week. Instead, an influencer may talk about it as little as one time, but their message can carry far more weight with your audience than any 30-second commercial ever did.

Great, you think. Influencer marketing sounds like it will be amazing. I’ll connect with some Instagram or YouTube stars, get the most important ones to recommend or use my brand and, boom, my products will be flying off the shelves. I won’t be spending millions of dollars on TV ads the way brands were once forced to do, and I’ll see results faster than I do with long-term efforts like SEO.

ALSO12 Content Distribution Tips to Ensure Maximum Exposure in 2020

Not so fast. Yes, influencer marketing for eCommerce brands can be incredibly powerful and make an impact very quickly. The ROI can be impressive. The stories about a YouTube star endorsing a brand or an Instagram influencer posing with a product, followed by a ridiculous burst in sales and media attention are real. 

But for every eCommerce brand that has experienced that kind of success—Casper, Bonobos, Lynda—there are countless others whose efforts to leverage influencer marketing fell flat. And well-publicized colossal failures have occurred.

Let’s talk about the process of using influencer marketing for eCommerce. How does a company go about finding the people who can be most valuable for their brand? How is the ROI measured? And how can a brand have more hits than misses when it ventures in influencer marketing?

Find influencers that are right for your brand.

Step one when you start to use influencer marketing: finding the right ones for your brand. It’s harder than it might seem. The most famous—or infamous—influencers, are likely to be outside the budgets of emerging eCommerce brands. 

Step 1 of the influencer marketing process with people on their cell phones in the background

If you have the kind of budget that puts a famous influencer within reach, swing for the fences—the rewards can be worth the risk. But big names like the Kardashians, Cristiano Rinaldo, and Nash Grier aren’t cheap. 

The good news? Pricey influencers probably aren’t right for your brand anyway. 

What’s more, when it comes to finding influencers that move the needle, success will vary. You’ll need to be persistent and willing to endure a few duds along the way.

Steve Wimmer, brand manager at TriNova, notes, “We’ve had varying degrees of success—from total flop to home run. Our best effort to date was a collaboration with YouTube influencer Pan the Organizer. We caught him towards the middle of his growth curve so a sponsored post was very affordable, and because he kept growing and the video he produced for us had evergreen content it paid off in a major way. We had him link back to our product on Amazon, and we estimate that it continues to drive $100-$500 a day in sales.”

Wimmer advises that, with influencer marketing, it’s generally better to, “…place several smaller bets on emerging influencers, rather than one big play on someone established. This increases your chances of success—and your ROI.”

Approach your search for valuable influencers like any other media research. Which ones line up well with your market niche? Who is connecting with audiences that are likely to buy your products? Are you comfortable with the content the influencer puts out?

If your brand has its own social media channel—and it should—look for posts from your followers that tag influencers or link to the content. Research the social media channels of your audience to find influencers they follow. You can even be direct and ask in a post for suggestions to start building a list of influencers. It’s organic research, but it can be incredibly useful.

FREE EBOOK: How to Create eCommerce Content at Scale

Qualify influencers to protect your investment.

Once you start to find influencers, it’s time to separate the good and very good from the mediocre. We all know the internet still has a bit of the Wild West in it—verification isn’t always easy. But if you’re going to be allocating a chunk of your marketing budget to an influencer marketing campaign, you need to take steps to make sure you’re using it as effectively as possible.

Ellie Shedden is the owner of digital marketing agency THE-OOP.COM who has used influencer marketing with great success, but she says it’s important to approach the audience metrics with a healthy dose of skepticism.

Shedden says, “The biggest piece of advice I can offer to businesses looking to run an influencer campaign is to check that the following is genuine. Nowadays, you can buy 10,000 likes for less than $50, and these influencers are not going to help your campaign in any way. When choosing your influencer, it’s important to deep-dive into their previous posts and check what type of engagement they are getting. Ideally, you should select an influencer with an engagement rate of around 4%.”

Quote from Ellie Shedden on eCommerce influencer marketing

How do you calculate the engagement rate? Divide the number of followers by the number of Likes on an average post, and divide by 100. More likes mean more followers who really care about the influencer and help you determine if the numbers they’re touting are real.

Wimmer, based on his experiences with TriNova and Gold Eagle brands, suggests that marketers, “…avoid influencers with feeds that seem like non-stop commercials. They have inflated stats and probably aren’t helping sell anything. If they were – they’d just sell their own products!”

Finally, you’ll want to make sure the influencers you choose are right for your brand. As Nick Shackelford, Co-Founder of Structured Social notes, “…it has to be the right influencer for the right product or service. If you’re using Kylie Jenner to sell life insurance, that’s just a huge mistake. Lastly, everyone should be considering micro-influencers who have smaller groups of followers but those followers are easier to verify and target. If I know exactly who your 50k followers are, I know what I’m getting for my money.”

Different types of social media influencers with image of influencer making a video on a camera in the background

For many eCommerce stores or brands, the ideal follower count of an influencer will probably land somewhere between 10,000 and 100,000. That means the influencer you’re working with has an audience large enough to generate results but not so massive that working with them is beyond your budget restraints. This group is often called micro-influencers, and they’ve become more valued because they often have followers that are more devoted with higher levels of engagement. 

Whatever you do, remember to approach your influencer campaign as analytically as possible. Separate how you might feel personally about an influencer and focus on evaluating their numbers, their reach, and the demographics of their followers. Don’t be swayed by emotion.

Collaborate on content creation and messaging.

A successful influencer marketing campaign involves a healthy amount of back-and-forth between the brand and the personality. Don’t expect to simply mail some free product samples to a star of YouTube videos, go to their channel, watch them talk about your brand, and then wait for the sales to pour in.

The best campaigns involve collaboration between brand managers and influencers. They should both have a stake in creating awareness and, ultimately, purchase decisions. Marketers want results and influencers want to demonstrate the value of their channels—it’s a give-and-take. Leading influencers will want a certain amount of creative freedom, but you’re going to need to protect your investment by putting your products out there in a way that generates results. 

Aim to make any content—YouTube, blog article, Instagram post—as evergreen as possible. That means working with the influencer to optimize for search—suggest a How-To, a Seven-Reasons-Why, a Guide-For, etc. A blunt, obviously purchased product review won’t gain the traction in search that you want and may turn off potential customers. It doesn’t even have to be the epic fail of Scott Disick and BooTea to be ineffective—or worse.

When Scott Disick and BooTea collaborated on a protein shake, Scott simply copied the email from the brand manager directly, including directions on when to publish the post.

Work together on ideas to encourage engagement with followers. How can you get the audience to share a post or a video? Will a trackable discount code help? Is there fresh content the influencer can create just for your brand? Keep all options open and encourage the people you work with to bring ideas to the table.

Remember—leading influencers have found a way to connect with people. Not utilizing their talent and creativity to help leverage your brand would be a serious mistake.

ALSO4 Ways to Get Compelling eCommerce Content for Your Brand

How to measure the success and ROI of eCommerce influencer marketing.

The major reason why so many eCommerce stores turn to influencer marketing is simple: the results are outstripping other tactics. According to a study by Tomoson, a seller of software that helps automate influencer marketing efforts, these campaigns typically yield a return of $6.50 for every dollar spent. Those numbers are backed up by other studies. The fact is, influencer campaigns can produce a return any brand manager will love.

Image showing influence campaigns fact

But how can you measure the success of your own outreach? First, start with goals. Do you want to build your follower base? Are you going to measure engagement through Likes or other mechanisms like contest entries and the use of discount codes? Codes can be especially useful because they allow you to track the source of purchase decisions and compare your influencer marketing campaign to email efforts, paid search, and other communications you do to build your eCommerce store or brand. 

Back to Nick Shackleford, Co-Founder of Structured Social, with some words of caution. He says, “You can’t just throw money at an influencer campaign and hope it brings in revenue. Every client I talk to, every client whose campaign I’ve managed, gets the exact same advice from me. Start with revenue and work backward. Throwing money at someone with a million Instagram followers is pointless if those dollars don’t provide real value for your product.”

When you first try influencer marketing, it can feel like a roll of the dice. Make sure you have a plan in place to properly analyze and measure results so you’ll know the true ROI of your efforts.

What to expect from influencer marketing.

“Influencers are great when used properly, but they aren’t a cure-all,” adds Shackelford of Structure Social.

Don’t view your influencer marketing efforts as a replacement for everything else you’re doing to engage with potential customers of your eCommerce store or brand. For many, it will be a tactic that produces better results than anything else. For others, it will be an effective way to bolster other campaigns. But the research is clear: influencer marketing for eCommerce is effective, and engaging in it can produce brand awareness and better long-term sales results than traditional offline and online advertising.

The post Using eCommerce Influencer Marketing to Drive your Brand Forward appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/using-ecommerce-influencer-marketing-to-drive-your-brand-forward/feed/ 0
Tips For Working Remotely + Powerful Insights From 6 Experts https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-master-working-remotely/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-master-working-remotely/#respond Thu, 16 Jan 2020 15:40:56 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=26920 To many, working remotely is living the dream. Being able to roll out of bed, make a cup of coffee, and sit down at the computer to start work without sitting in traffic, waiting for trains, or cramming onto buses sounds like heaven for those with taxing commutes – but the reality can be a […]

The post Tips For Working Remotely + Powerful Insights From 6 Experts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
To many, working remotely is living the dream. Being able to roll out of bed, make a cup of coffee, and sit down at the computer to start work without sitting in traffic, waiting for trains, or cramming onto buses sounds like heaven for those with taxing commutes – but the reality can be a little different.

Working remotely can be a challenge unto itself, requiring an extra level of attention and focus that isn’t always necessary in a traditional office environment. From the draw to take care of that load of laundry to the temptation of turning on the TV for a few minutes, it’s easy to let work fall by the wayside in a residential environment. It’s also easier to feel disconnected from team members. Without a smile and a wave every morning or the ability to swing by and ask a simple question, working remotely can be a little isolating and frustrating.

However, working remotely can be a big perk for many people, and it can be a very effective way to accomplish goals and get ahead in the workplace. These tips can help you master working remotely, increasing focus and productivity along the way.

Interested in working remotely? Check out our freelance content writing jobs!

Create a Dedicated Workspace

Distractions are common in a workspace of any kind, but working from home adds an extra burden. Housekeeping tasks, like making meals and doing laundry, can creep into your mind, while the temptation of the television is always lurking. While this isn’t always a big deal – some days, there will be plenty of time to cook a nice lunch in between conference calls – in many cases, the distractions of home can be a serious detriment. Research indicates that in 82% of cases, tasks that are interrupted by distractions are continued the same day, but on average, it takes over 23 minutes to get back to business. That’s a problem when deadlines are looming.

ALSOHow Missing Content Deadlines Impacts Marketing Agencies in a Big Way (and What You Can Do About It)

To avoid the allure of lounging on the couch, create a dedicated workspace, preferably in a quiet, clean room with a door that closes and a computer setup. If there are potential complications in the house, like children home with a nanny or a spouse who also works from home, invest in noise-canceling headphones or soundproofing to keep your workspace just that: a space for work.

As Chloe Brittain, the owner of Opal Transcription Services suggests, “Be upfront with your family and friends about your working hours and that you’re unavailable to take messages during that time. And if your friends don’t respect that and continue to bombard you with texts, there’s only one solution left: ignore them!”

Set Working Hours

In an office, you’re generally on the clock for a set amount of time, often from 9 AM to 5 PM. At home, however, nothing is tethering you to your desk, save perhaps scheduled meetings. When hours are up to your discretion, it’s far easier to allow distractions to creep in. Starting late to get a workout in, stopping early to make dinner, or leaving mid-day to run errands may be okay every now and then, but it’s best to set hours for your work day so you can prevent these kinds of activities from distracting you.

Further, when you have set work hours, your bosses can confirm you’re doing what you need to be doing. Failing to answer emails in a timely manner or pushing back on early meetings, for example, implies that you’re not working as effectively as you should be. States the co-owner and COO of Slumber Yard, Matthew Ross, “If you’re going to work remotely, I expect you to respond to questions and emails immediately. When I don’t hear back from a remote worker within 20 minutes, I start to think they aren’t actually working.” As such, it’s important to come up with set working hours based on your preferences, work requirements, and best practices to make sure you’re getting done what you need to get done.

For those in an industry not predicated by maintaining hours, setting goals is a good alternative. Adam Hempenstall, the CEO and Founder of Better Proposals, offers this advice: “The way we increased productivity as remote workers was simple. We focused on goals. Each week, everyone would get a set of goals that they needed to achieve. They could work whenever they want and for as long as they want, as long as the goals were met. That way, we got rid of the pressure and we made sure that everyone did their part. So far, it’s working out fairly well.”

Setting a designated work schedule also helps you to manage your time in a good way: when you have a set end time, you can ensure work doesn’t spill into your personal life and disrupt your work life balance.. “Give yourself a stop time, too. When you tell yourself you can work all night, you’ll be less motivated to work efficiently than if you know you have to stop at 6:00,” says Jennifer Johnson, a communications and public relations consultant.

Utilize the Right Tools

Technology is a wonderful thing, making remote work possible. The internet keeps everyone connected, allowing communication and productivity from anywhere, any time. However, sitting at your desk and relying solely on emails means leaving a lot of valuable tools on the table. From video chatting capabilities to project management software that caters to joint workflow, companies now employ significant infrastructure designed to support remote staff.

Many successful remote workers employ significant amounts of technology to stay face to face, even when oceans away. As Haley Anhut, a marketing manager at Clean Origin, suggests, “Get face time in with your team. It’s almost 2020! We have the technology to be present with a remote team. Call someone instead of emailing or video call instead of messaging. It can help to make you feel present.”

Not sure what you need? Try a few out and see what works for you. “Experiment with some digital tools and learn how to make them work for you. I use Asana to plan out my daily, weekly, and long term goals, as well as collaborate with my remote team. Some remote workers might also find value from a time tracking tool, additional collaboration tools like Slack and Zoom, and a system for sharing important documents such as Dropbox, Google Suite, or Box.” And, if you find something that works for you, don’t be afraid to speak up. Getting a whole team on the same system can increase efficiency, so your suggestions can benefit your entire department.

ALSOIs Multitasking Killing Your Freelance Career?

Keep in Touch

When you work remotely, it’s easy to feel a little alienated from the other people you work with. In many cases, remote workers hone in on themselves and their objectives, working on the things they need to accomplish to meet expectations without speaking with other team members.

In an office, information flows freely: it’s not uncommon for team members to share gossip, stop by one another’s desks to share tidbits, or pick up an idle conversation before and after meetings. As such, working away from the office means it’s harder to stay up to date on details that are important to the course of business. Rather than sitting around waiting for information to come your way, reach out to your peers and managers to make sure you’re always in the loop. Ask for developments on projects, request feedback on projects, and message your coworkers just to chat from time to time. This kind of conversation and info swapping is a big part of normal employment, so the absence of this element when working from home can be a big disadvantage.

Many companies that offer flexible work conditions invite remote employees to pop into the office from time to time if they’re in the same area, or even fly remote workers into head office for regular catch ups. If your company offers this, be sure to take advantage.

Slumber Yard‘s Matthew Ross believes that it’s the onus of the remote worker to make sure information isn’t missing. “As a remote worker, you have to take it upon yourself to talk with co-workers and managers to stay up to date on the latest company initiatives and strategies. Another pet peeve of mine is when remote workers say “well, I didn’t know” or “no one told me”. If you work remotely, part of your responsibility is to stay up to date with what’s being discussed in the office.”

Step Into Your (Home) Office

Working remotely certainly has its advantages, but being productive at home isn’t as easy as it sounds. With these tips for working remotely, it’s possible to create a workspace, productivity plan, and virtual team connections that work for you.

The post Tips For Working Remotely + Powerful Insights From 6 Experts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-master-working-remotely/feed/ 0
12 Content Distribution Tips to Ensure Maximum Exposure in 2020 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/12-content-distribution-tips-to-ensure-maximum-exposure-in-2020/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/12-content-distribution-tips-to-ensure-maximum-exposure-in-2020/#respond Thu, 09 Jan 2020 19:30:51 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=26821 It’s 2020 – and the content distribution game is changing fast.  Creating original, engaging content is not easy (though a good content writing service can certainly help). Yet, it is the least that’s expected of you as a content marketer today. The real content marketing challenge of 2020 is getting your content in front of […]

The post 12 Content Distribution Tips to Ensure Maximum Exposure in 2020 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
It’s 2020 – and the content distribution game is changing fast. 

Creating original, engaging content is not easy (though a good content writing service can certainly help). Yet, it is the least that’s expected of you as a content marketer today. The real content marketing challenge of 2020 is getting your content in front of the right audience. As Ross Simmonds often preaches, “distribution rules everything around me.”

As more businesses realize the importance of content marketing, the competition for content promotion is getting tougher. So, how do you rise to the top of your space? Keep reading to learn about the top content distribution tips for 2020.

Image showing content marketing challenge

1. Find Your Target Audience

Who is interested in what you have to say? Ideally, this question should be answered before your content is created.

Identifying your niche audience is one of the key steps in creating and distributing content. Sadly, it is also one of the most overlooked! Too often an article, a video or a blog post are created without well-defined audiences in mind. So, here is your chance to stand out.

Creating targeted content also means identifying and using keywords and key phrases that your potential customers are using in their search engine queries.

Many keyword research tools are available to make the task easier for content marketers. The most widely used are Google’s Keyword Planner, Google Trends, Moz Keyword Explorer, Ubersuggest and Answer The Public.

Image showing importance of keywords research
Keyword research is important when exploring what interests your audience.

By understanding how your audience describes the topics you want to cover, and understanding the intent behind their searches, you can tailor content that speaks directly to them.

ALSOQualitative Keyword Research: How to Invest 10 Minutes into Your Content Marketing Process & See Your Content Rise to the Top of Google

2. Create and Promote Blog Posts

Everyone seems to run a blog these days – so, is it still worth it? The answer is definitely “yes” – if you do it right. A recent study by Content Marketing Institute confirmed what many of us have intuitively known for ages – that 7 out of 10 customers prefer promotion through articles rather than ads.

So, what makes an effective blog? You need to:

  • Publish original content that is genuinely useful, insightful and/or entertaining
  • Maintain high standards – create comprehensive, best-in-industry content
  • Post regularly
  • Stay true to the topic and purpose of your blog
  • Engage with your audience and build community
  • Keep the information up to date
  • Promote widely – there’s no point in publishing great content if nobody sees it!

Well researched and written blog posts help establish and support your brand’s reputation and expertise – building trust, making your audience more receptive to your messages, and creating lasting customer relationships.

When your blog post is combined with a logical, well-defined call to action, it is also invaluable in building highly targeted email lists. For example, if readers of your blog find your content useful, they will be more inclined to provide their active email address to access a comprehensive guide on the topic – and to stay subscribed to receive further messages from you.

The blog format allows for a more informal, personal tone than your main company site. That makes blog posts great for sharing on social networks, and for using such opportunities for cross-promotion as guest posting.

Image showing 4 benefits of blogging

ALSO13 Types of Blog Posts to Fire Up Your Readers (And Your Editorial Calendar)

Guest Posting Might Be Harder to Get – But It Still Works

Guest posts remain a great way to get more exposure for your content.

Marketers today may be more wary of allowing guest posts on their site because the practice has been abused by spammers. Still, the collaboration between bloggers can be very effective – if done right. If you can enrich each other’s content, you instantly increase exposure and provide more value for your audience.

For example, BackLinko’s Brian Dean has recently teamed up with PitchBox, an outreach and content marketing platform, for an impressive study on the effectiveness of outreach emails. Backlinko benefited by acquiring some cutting-edge data-driven content, while PitchBox got significant exposure for their product.

Guest posting can also be a great way to promote your existing content. Including links to other relevant topics in your blog ensures that your evergreen or updated content keeps being discovered by new audiences.

3. Keep Search Engines Happy – Never Neglect Your SEO

On-page SEO remains as important as ever. The tedious bit – optimizing your posts for their target keywords using the latest SEO best practices – should never be skipped.

One well-targeted, informative blog post that makes it to the first page of Google results for a given keyword can drive substantial organic traffic for years. So, the time and effort invested in SEO are well worth it when considered against the long-term gains.

As the competition among content creators heats up, it is particularly important to understand search intent – the reason why users look for information – behind queries that are likely to bring traffic to your site. Your primary keywords should always be chosen with search intent in mind.

When you have decided on your primary keyword, make sure to use it:

  • in the page title
  • in the H1 heading
  • early in the body of your content

Every post should have a custom meta description that includes your keywords and accurately summarizes your content. If your description matches your audience’s search intent closely, it will drive up the organic CTR (click-through rate) on your listing in Google search results.

The quality of your content is the most important ranking factor with Google now. That means it needs to read well, offer valuable information, satisfy search intent, and perhaps most importantly – it needs to be comprehensive. Additionally, you’ll want to spend time ensuring your content is surrounded by good design so that it’s more appealing to visitors.

All of this impacts how visitors interact with your site. If your site has a low bounce rate – meaning that your visitors spend time on your site consuming your content – it will help your content rank even higher as a result of Google’s RankBrain, which looks at behavioral metrics like this, bringing in more visitors from search engines.

Sharing your content widely and building backlinks from authority sites in your niche are also solid off-page SEO techniques that you should use.

ALSO7 Tips for How to Write SEO Content

4. Know Your Content Distribution Channels

What channels can you use to distribute your content in 2020? All content distribution and sharing channels can be grouped into the following categories:

1. Channels that are under your complete control (often referred to as “owned” distribution channels). These include:

  • Your website
  • Your blog
  • Your email newsletter
  • Your brand profiles on social media
  • eBooks, PDF guides, infographics, etc. (downloadable from your site or emailed by you)
  • Video content (posted on your YouTube channel or your blog, included in your emails, etc.)
  • Audio content (your own podcasts, audiobooks, guides, etc.)

2. Channels that you have limited control over (“earned” or “shared” content distribution channels):

  • Strong organic search engine rankings
  • Social shares and mentions
  • Reposts on other social networks
  • Citations on other websites and blogs
  • Reviews that link back to your site

3. Channels for paid distribution:

  • Paid advertising – Display Ads and Pay-Per-Click (PPC)
  • Sponsored content on social networks (like LinkedIn Sponsored Updates, promoted posts on Facebook or Pinterest’s Promoted Pins)
  • Native advertising and content discovery platforms (like Taboola and Outbrain)
  • Paid influencer campaigns
  • Social media advertisements

Your budget, as well as your overall brand strategy, will determine which owned and paid distribution channels you use the most.

Earned channels have the potential to provide the biggest return on your investment in content. At the same time, content sharing carries some risks, as the spin that can be put on shared content is largely out of your hands.

The effectiveness of earned channels has been steadily declining over the last few years. On Facebook, for example, the decline in organic traffic has been particularly noticeable since the 2018 algorithm update, which changed the way content appears on users’ timelines to prioritize, in Mark Zuckerberg’s words, “friends, family, and groups” over “businesses, brands, and media.”

As a result, the competition for earned channels in 2020 is set to be tougher than ever. In this situation, your paid distribution efforts should be used to try and increase your earned reach.

For example, promoting a post on Facebook or LinkedIn can help generate some organic shares. You can also invite the people who like your promoted posts to follow you, increasing the audience for your future content. Having a network of people that will like and share your post also ensures that it gets picked up and promoted by social network algorithms.

Image showing promoted social media post
Promoted social media posts put your content in front of the target audience.

ALSOContent Advertising: How to Leverage Paid Ads in Your Content Marketing

5. Pick the Right Content Distribution Channels for Your Target Audience

Once you know your channels, it’s just a matter of matching them with your potential audiences. If you’ve done your homework researching your niche audience, then the task of finding the right channel for distributing your content becomes easier.

Are you trying to reach busy professionals that are likely to use LinkedIn daily? The fashion-conscious crowd on Instagram and Pinterest? Is your audience more likely to use Facebook – or Twitter? If you know your target audience, the above questions should not be hard to answer.

Then you need to put a sound content distribution strategy in place. Alexander Porter, Head of Copy at  Search It Local, explains:

“Successful content marketing heading into 2020 must exist within an integrated framework. You can’t release it in a handful of channels and expect to keep up with your competition if they are casting a wider net. At Search It Local, we build the foundations of our results like we were building a pyramid.”

For example, if your goal is to create brand awareness and build trust by running a business blog, then your content distribution strategy for new posts could include:

  • Publishing an SEO-optimized blog post on your company site.
  • Posting the key quotes from your post to Twitter.
  • Emailing the summary of your blog post with a link to the full post to your mailing list subscribers.
  • Posting summary/infographics/video promoting the post to your Facebook and LinkedIn profiles.
  • Sharing the post through Facebook and LinkedIn Groups.
  • Using sponsored listings on social media feeds to promote the post.
  • Contacting influencers that might be interested in sharing your post.
  • Using remarketing to promote the post to the audiences that have shown interest in similar content or have recently visited your site.
  • Using Google Ads to drive paid traffic directly to your blog post.

Finding the right channels to connect with your audience will initially require some experimentation. Once you are confident that you are reaching your crowd, you can play with the formats and topics of your posts, fine-tuning your messages so that they are tailored to your chosen channels and platforms.

6. Maximize Your Social Shares

Each content sharing platform has strengths that should be used to maximum advantage. For example, short video content is perfect for sharing on Facebook and Instagram, while some eye-catching infographics can be created for ease of share on LinkedIn or Twitter.

Always look for usage patterns of the content sharing platforms – then, look for ways to stand out.

Jason Thibault, the owner of the content marketing agency Massive Kontent, shares some insights on the optimal use of LinkedIn:

“LinkedIn now has just over 300 million active monthly users, 40% of which visit the site daily. Only 3 million of those users share content every week – so creating and sharing content on the platform automatically puts you in the “one percent”. This year I started including short PDFs with my LinkedIn posts. Just 6-7 pagers that summarize my main points. The posts with PDFs generate anywhere from 250% to 600% more views (4,000-12,000 views) in the LinkedIn newsfeed.”

It is crucial to create your content with the distribution platform in mind. For example, the optimal length of a Facebook post for ease of sharing is between 40 and 80 characters, while the ideal content length on Twitter is often reported to be 70 – 100 characters. At the same time, some brands have discovered that much longer Facebook posts work for them, while others swear by multi-tweet messages on Twitter. Ultimately, you are the best judge of what works best in your space – and figuring that out does take quite a bit of experimentation!

ALSOSocial Media: How Does it Impact Your SEO?

Paid promotion may be a good tactic to use to start things off. The initial traction that your post gets from paid placements start leading to organic shares.  

Samantha Milner, the food blogger at RecipeThis.com, has been able to grow her blog to 8 million pageviews a year using the following strategy:

“When a new recipe is published, we will share it first to our Facebook page and Twitter account. It will also have every image featured in it shared to a relevant Pinterest board. It is then distributed across Pinterest with Tailwind until it has gone through all relevant Pinterest groups, shared with relevant Tailwind Tribes, and then shared throughout social bookmarking channels – as well as to recipe sharing sites and link parties. Then each Friday it will be shared with our newsletter subscribers.”

Image showing how to maximize social media shares

So, to maximize social shares:

  • Consistently share quality content on the platforms that your target audience uses
  • Use the best formats for sharing on your chosen platforms
  • Use paid promotion to initiate organic shares of your top content
  • Always study the competition – then look for ways to stand out!

7. Email Is Still HUGE

It has been around forever, but, year after year, numerous studies agree that email remains a powerful content distribution and marketing channel – even for younger generations. As many as 68% of millennials report that promotional emails have influenced their purchasing decisions.

Build a quality email list

Building targeted email lists is more important than ever. One successful tactic is to offer some actionable, in-demand content – like an eBook or an instructional video – for free in exchange for mailing list subscriptions. The pieces of content that you offer as subscription incentives should:

  1. Add immediate value to your audience – teach them a strategy, show them a technique, etc.
  2. Be as targeted as possible.
  3. Promise to deliver more – soon. (Make sure you deliver on that promise!)

If you provide immediate value, your readers are more likely to stay subscribed. They will also be more motivated to open your subsequent emails and be receptive to your messages.

Keep your email formatting clean and simple

While it is tempting to experiment with formats of your email messages, it is important to remember about the overwhelming number of emails your readers open daily.

People are becoming tired of the visually bulky “traditional” newsletter formats.

Simple, brief, to the point, letter-style emails are easier to skim through and are more likely to get attention and initiate immediate action.

In fact, emails sent by some of the most prominent content marketers of today are concise to the point of using an almost bullet-point format.

Your email promotion success also greatly depends on your attention to detail and persistence. To get better response rates, personalize the subject and body of your messages as much as possible, and be prepared to send multiple emails to the same contacts.

ALSOEmail Copywriting: Tips for Mastering a Profitable Niche

8. Share in Social Network Groups (and Create Your Own!)

Your top content deserves extra distribution effort. Both Facebook and LinkedIn have the Groups feature that is great for reaching out to people that are actively looking for information on very specific topics.

Oksana Chyketa, a B2B marketer at Albacross.com, has the following tips on distributing content via Facebook Groups:

“A great way to promote your content on Facebook is through Facebook Groups. In this case, you have two options: 1) You can join Facebook groups and boost your reach by sharing your content once you’re a member. Or 2) You can create your own Facebook Group and invite users to join and promote your brand. Both options are excellent in an organic increase of page ‘likes.’ It’s important to mention that only high-quality, problem-solving and engaging content will attract and retain your prospects.”

As a content marketer, it is important to make sure that you are present on all major social platforms that your audience frequents. Be it Quora, Reddit, YouTube, or smaller niche forums – before you start promoting your content in any way, you need to learn the rules of the group, and add value by answering questions and genuinely contributing to discussions. Do not post any content that can be perceived as spammy. Reddit, in particular, has zero spam tolerance and can be more valuable as an audience research platform than a content distribution one.

9. Always Look for Emerging Channels (and for New Opportunities to Use Existing Ones!)

Who heard of TikTok two years ago? Very few people would’ve predicted its amazing rise. The same could’ve been said about YouTube just a few years earlier.

The new channels for publishing your content emerge every day, and, as overwhelming as it all might feel – it’s crucial to keep up with them.

At the same time, new uses of established platforms should never be overlooked.

YouTube Community Feature Can Be Used for Content Sharing

If you have access to a YouTube channel that has over 1,000 subscribers, you can use the Community feature to share your content.

When a piece of content is shared with the community, the post will appear to all of your subscribers.

“We tripled our referral traffic from YouTube since we started posting to our community,” says Antti Alatalo, Marketing Director at CashCow.

Use Audio to Establish a Deeper Connection with Your Audience

Audio is another traditional content distribution channel that appears evergreen.

Simon Elkjær of Nutimo believes that the audio format has given him a deeper connection to his audience:

“I have been doing blogging, YouTube, book launches, events and public speaking amongst other things. But through my podcast, I feel the listeners are getting a deeper connection. When I meet people who are podcast-subscribers, they feel like they know me, they listen to me on evening walks, while commuting, going to the gym or just in a quiet place, in a nice chair. In this way audio is unique. It requires nothing of you, and no screen time to consume. It’s a way of disconnecting from a stressful smartphone or tv screen, and just listening.”

According to Simon, with audio, it is best to go in-depth:

“We changed our format from 15 minutes to about an hour and our listeners loved it. Our format is 20% on topic, and 80% anecdotes, stories, and small talk. Those who listen now really care, and listen because of us, not because of the information.”

Look for New Ways to Use Your Channels

Always be on the lookout for new features of your main distribution channels. Identify and follow the experts in the field. And don’t forget to always experiment yourself – it’s little, subtle touches and tweaks that often help you stay ahead of the content distribution game.

10. Use Paid Promotion Channels for Retargeting

Paid channel targeting is becoming more sophisticated every day. One of the most valuable tactics is retargeting – keeping your brand and content in front of the customers that have already visited your site, or showing ads based on the history of their interaction with some of your content. Content marketers need to make full use of this trend in their social media marketing efforts.

You can build your retargeting lists based on the type of content that your target audiences have already interacted with. Then, you can use these audiences to promote your new content. For example, when promoting a new instructional video, you would target people that have already watched some of your videos.

Once you have a good understanding of your main audience, you can start to experiment with the Lookalike Audiences feature (offered by both Facebook and LinkedIn), targeting audiences with similar characteristics and expanding your reach.

Here is how some content marketers do it.

Oksana Chyketa of Albacross shares some of her Facebook ads strategy insights:

“…One more way to boost your content is by using Facebook ads. The tip here is that you don’t need to target the unknown people, but those who have already been to your site, let’s say during the last 60 days. In this way, you’ll manage to drive only quality leads to your blog and the bonus is that your CPC will be much cheaper.”

Jason Thibault of Massive Kontent has been successful in distributing content on Twitter and Quora:

“Currently, I’m finding that the Twitter ads platform and Quora for Business are offering the best return on ad spend. With Twitter, I upload custom-tailored audiences and continuously build a second ‘website visitors’ audience via the Twitter conversion pixel. If I’ve set everything up correctly I can send 2-400 visitors to a new piece of content for 20-40 cents per click (sometimes less).”

11. Influencer Marketing Tip: Don’t Overlook Micro-Influencers!

According to a recent study by MediaKix, 80% of marketers find that influencer marketing is effective. The good news is that your influencer marketing campaign does not have to come with a hefty price tag. Emerging influencers and micro-influencers often have more genuine engagement with their followers than established ones. While marketers can find themselves working harder initially to identify and contact micro-influencers, it is usually worth the time and effort if you want to reach your niche audiences.

Image showing types of social mMedia influencers

Micro-influencers are also more likely to be interested in collaborations that involve distributing content for free in exchange for the exposure they get.

One great practice is to contact micro-influencers with relevant expertise and ask them to contribute to your pieces of content. “They’ll be your content marketing advocates,” Alexander Porter of Search It Local explains. “Show them the finished content and thank them for their contribution. Avoid overtly asking them to share it, by developing authentic relationships you’ll find these micro-influencers naturally share your content which increases its reach and exposure.”

12. 80/20 Rule: Your Main Focus Should Not Be on Creating Content

Gone are the days when content marketers could just distribute quality content blindly and expect results.

The 80/20 rule of content marketing for 2020 is that only 20% of your time should be spent creating content, while 80% should be devoted to content strategy, distribution and promotion.

Spend More Time Sharing

Outsourcing your content creation to experts with content writing services such as Crowd Content allows you to direct your main efforts to where they matter most – developing an effective strategy and putting your content in front of the right eyes.

The post 12 Content Distribution Tips to Ensure Maximum Exposure in 2020 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/12-content-distribution-tips-to-ensure-maximum-exposure-in-2020/feed/ 0
How Does Ghostwriting Work? The Complete Guide to Hiring the Voice Behind Your Message https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-does-ghostwriting-work-the-complete-guide-to-hiring-the-voice-behind-your-message/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-does-ghostwriting-work-the-complete-guide-to-hiring-the-voice-behind-your-message/#respond Thu, 02 Jan 2020 21:15:08 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=26767 Ghostwriting is a tried-and-true profession and a powerful way to get content written when you don’t have the time, talent or desire to do it yourself. Whether you’re interested in publishing a book or just want more high-quality content for your website, hiring a ghostwriter puts you in some pretty good company. Did you know […]

The post How Does Ghostwriting Work? The Complete Guide to Hiring the Voice Behind Your Message appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Ghostwriting is a tried-and-true profession and a powerful way to get content written when you don’t have the time, talent or desire to do it yourself. Whether you’re interested in publishing a book or just want more high-quality content for your website, hiring a ghostwriter puts you in some pretty good company.

Did you know some of these works were ghostwritten?

  • Iacocca: An Autobiography was mostly penned by author William Novak on behalf of, and using stories and information from, Lee Iacocca.
  • Profiles in Courage wasn’t written by JFK; the wordsmithing actually came from Kennedy’s speechwriter Ted Sorenson.
  • The many stories featuring Nancy Drew, which have been published over almost nine decades, were written by numerous ghostwriters under the name Carolyn Keene.
  • All but 35 of The Babysitters Club books were ghostwritten by Peter Lerangis and others, not by author Ann M. Martin.

Publishers have put the power of ghostwriting to work to churn profits and meet voracious fan demands for centuries. And in today’s competitive marketing world, you can put good ghostwriters to work to scale content creation and publishing processes, improve authority and SEO, and better connect with your target audience.

Circle chart listing skills of a good ghostwriter

But before you can do those things, you must answer the question, “how does ghostwriting work?” The comprehensive guide below provides everything you need to get started — whether you’re new to hiring ghostwriters or just want to develop a better process for it.

What Is Ghostwriting?

Ghostwriting occurs when someone contributes to creating content without credit for doing so. They don’t get a byline or author credit; in fact, many times someone else’s name appears as the author of the content. In exchange for credit, the person doing the writing typically receives monetary compensation.

ALSOGhostwriting Jobs 101: How They Work, Where to Find Them and How to Thrive

Reasons Marketers and Companies Use Ghostwriting

Ghostwriters can offer a number of benefits for yourself or your organization. Here are just a few reasons someone might choose to use a ghostwriter.

  • Sharing your expertise when you don’t write well. If you’re an expert or professional in a niche with knowledge to share, ghostwriters can help you do that if you’re not great with the written word. You might create extensive notes and outlines for the writer to work from. The writer might also interview you to get your story or message before committing it to paper.
  • You already have a name but don’t have enough time to write. Someone who already has a recognized name in the niche may need help keeping up with demands for content. Many online marketing pros, including Rand Fishkin and Neil Patel, for example, have used ghostwriters to help keep their content production at scale when they’re busy with other tasks.
  • Creating lots of content for your brand. Not all ghostwritten work gets an author byline stamped on it. Many companies publish blogs, articles and other content from the brand as a whole and not a single person. Ghostwriters are ideal for online content marketing and branding, which may require that you publish dozens or even hundreds of pieces a week or month. Being able to keep up with that pace while providing high-quality content that resonates with your audience is impossible.
  • You don’t have the exact expertise. In some cases, the ghostwriter is actually the one with the knowledge. For example, someone who is a chef may want to launch a coaching business for rising restauranteurs. They come up with an idea to provide a white paper on legal issues for restaurants as a lead generation tool, but they themselves aren’t a legal expert. They might hire a ghostwriter who has both restaurant and legal expertise to draft the white paper.

ALSOWhat Is a Ghostwriter Best Able to Help With?

A list of reasons why marketers and companies use ghostwriters

Reasons Writers Agree to Ghostwrite Content

So, using ghostwriters lets you expand your writing team, gain access to writing skills and potentially draw on other people’s knowledge and experience. But why would a ghostwriter agree to create content for you without having their name attached to it?

Mostly, the answer is that they get paid to write the content. Obviously, with money as the motivator, typically the better you pay, the more professional and skilled a ghostwriter you can hire. You do have to be careful when hiring someone for freelance writing, and we’ll cover how to find qualified pros that will do an excellent job in just a bit.

Other reasons people choose to work ghostwriting gigs rather than publish content under their own names include:

  • They have another business or personal brand and they don’t want to interfere with that. For example, someone who is attempting to make a name as a science fiction author may still need to pay the bills. Ghostwriting lets them put their other expertise to work without impacting their author name.
  • They don’t want any recognition. Some writers are exceptionally shy. Others have personal reasons they don’t want their name splashed across the internet. Whatever the reasons, the fact that a qualified writer doesn’t want the attention of a byline can work in your favor.
  • They enjoy writing for hire on a number of topics. Some writers simply enjoy doing work for other people that lets them research and write about different things all the time. They don’t want to be tied down to a specific niche or responsible to their own platform, and they may have learned they can make a good living by providing A+ service and content to clients.

When Is Ghostwriting Not a Good Method to Generate Content?

Ghostwriting sounds amazing, right? But before you start handing your content off to a freelance writer, make sure ghostwriting is the right move.

It’s generally known that everything that appears on your website probably wasn’t written by you. Most people even realize that your full-time staff might not be responsible for every word. But some content comes with expectations that you either wrote it yourself or had a very hefty hand in the process —examples include letters from the CEO or very personal posts that include your own testimonial about something.

In deciding whether to hire a ghostwriter for a project, ask yourself these questions:

  • Do you have an extremely personal tie to this story that would benefit from an authentic first-person account?
  • Will your readership feel betrayed if they ever find out you didn’t write the content yourself?
  • Will you have to disclose extremely sensitive details to ensure the ghostwriter has the right understanding to write the piece, even though those details won’t make it into the published piece?

In these cases, you may want to write the content yourself. If you’re worried about how the finished piece might look because you’re not a strong writer, you might hire an editor to fix it all up while maintaining the authenticity of your style and voice.

What Are Some Common Legal Concerns With Ghostwriting?

Ghostwriting is completely legal. Technically, it’s an exchange of goods or services. You pay someone, and they give you words they have written (along with the copyright for the content).

But there are some legalities to contend with to ensure you don’t end up on the losing end of a ghostwriting arrangement. Here are a few legal concerns to pay attention to when using ghostwriters to create any type of content.

Copyright: Who Owns the Content?

This is probably the most common concern and is the most important thing to ensure you cover in ghostwriting contracts. Universal Copyright Convention states that copyright for a creative work, including writing, automatically goes to the creator at the time of creation. Contrary to popular belief, you don’t have to register copyright to enjoy the benefits of owning your own work.

In the case of ghostwriting, you definitely don’t want the writer to maintain this default ownership. The contract must clearly state that the writer is giving up copyright of the work in exchange for the payment you’re offering.

Consider including language in your contract that states:

  • The writer agrees that the works created under the contract are “works for hire.”
  • The writer agrees that the works belong to the client.
  • The writer agrees that copyrights associated with the work also belong to the client.
  • In cases where the work might not be considered “works for hire” under any law, the writer agrees to “sell, assign and transfer” rights, title and interest in the work to the client.

Disclosures: Who Can Talk About Authoring the Content?

If you pay someone to write a book or article and then put your own name on it, you may not want the person taking credit for the work in other ways. It’s a good idea to put a nondisclosure agreement in your contract that states the writer agrees to hold his or her participation in the project confidential.

How tight you want to make the NDA depends on your brand and what you’re having someone write. In most cases, clients typically don’t want someone advertising the fact that they wrote the content. They might not mind if someone tells close family or friends what they’re working on. And in some cases, the writer may request permission to share information about the project or snippets of the work with other potential clients to demonstrate their experience and expertise. Work with your writer to ensure the NDA in any contract serves both your needs.

Pay: What Are the Terms of the Transaction?

How you pay, what you pay and when you will pay it should all be covered in detail in any contract. Being as specific as possible when you contract a ghostwriting service protects your interests and helps stave off disagreements later in the process.

The contract should include:

  • How much you’ll pay. This can be a flat fee for the work, an hourly payment or payment by the word or page. The easiest way to ensure you’re on the same page with a potential writer is to pay by the word. Make sure you define how the words will be tallied. You might specify that you’ll use the word count from a specific program or that you’ll use an industry benchmark such as 250 words per typed, double-spaced pages.
  • How you’ll make payment. Will you pay via a service such as PayPal (and if so, who is responsible for the resulting fees), via an electronic funds transfer into the writer’s bank account or via a mailed check?
  • When you will pay. Do you pay upon acceptance of the work? Are you planning to pay within 30 days of acceptance? The ghostwriter or service may have their own terms. Common options are Net 15 or 30 days or full or partial payment upfront. If the project is large, you may set up milestones to make partial payments as the writer delivers various parts of the work.

ALSOHow Much Should I Pay a Freelance Writer?

Ghostwriting Contract Checklist

If you’re drafting a ghostwriting contract, consider working with a legal professional to ensure it has all the clauses and details required to protect you and your company. Make sure it includes everything in this checklist; it’s also a good idea to look for these things in any contract offered by the ghostwriting service.

  • Clauses that state the copyright belongs to you (as stated in the section above)
  • Confidentiality agreement or NDA (as stated in the section above)
  • Payment details (as covered in the section above)
  • Clauses that define this as a contract agreement and note the writer or service is responsible for any taxes or other obligations (ensuring this can’t be perceived as a W2 or traditional employment situation)
  • Details about expectations for the work, including
    • Quantity — the number of blog posts, articles, product descriptions, social media posts or book chapters, for example
    • Length — a range for the number of words for each piece, such as 800-1000 words for a blog post
    • Timeline — when you expect various parts of the work to begin and when they should be submitted
    • Revision requirements — how many revision rounds you expect to be included in the price; it’s a good idea to always include at least one round
    • Research requirements — how much research do you expect the writer to do for your project; note that more research takes more time and may increase the cost of your project

How Do You Find Qualified Ghostwriters?

Before you can enter into contract negotiations, you need someone to negotiate with. Here are some steps for finding ghostwriters for just about any project or topic.

A diagram listing where you can find ghostwriters
  • Search for and recruit an expert writer. You’ll need to spend some time on LinkedIn, browsing the web and popping into relevant social media groups to connect with writers who might work out. The benefit of this method of finding a ghostwriter is that you connect directly with the writer. The disadvantage is that you might spend a great deal of time sorting through writers until you find the right one, and you still don’t have any guarantees the work will get done and be exactly what you need.
  • Put a ghostwriting job out on a freelance bidding site or job board. When you use this method, you wait for the writers to come to you. That reduces the work you have to do in seeking out writers, but it also means that you may get a lot of applications that aren’t even close to what you need. Depending on which site you use, you may have to wade through sub-par writers to find the one diamond in the rough.
  • Work with a content company. Content companies like Crowd Content maintain a vast database of writers and can match clients with the freelancers that are best for the work at hand. They can also do the work of recruiting and validating new writers if necessary to meet specific niche needs. Other benefits of working with Crowd Content when you need a ghostwriter is that project managers and customer service pros can work alongside you throughout various stages of your project to ensure you get the content you need.

ALSOGhostwriters: The Secret to Maximizing Your In-House Writing Team

Some Other Best Practices for Working With Ghostwriters

Once you find the ideal writer and get the contract details worked out, it’s time to get down to the business of creating content. You might think you can drop the ball fully into the ghostwriter’s side of the court at this point, but be wary of taking your eyes completely off the process.

If you have a long-term relationship with a freelance writer who knows your business and has created content you loved in the past, you might be able to back away and let them do their thing. But instructions are still important, and if you’re working with new-to-you writers or a ghostwriting team, then you may want to follow some of these best practices to ensure optimal results.

1. Account for added time in your process.

If you’ve been creating content yourself or having in-house employees do it, you shouldn’t expect the same turn around times when you switch to ghostwriters — especially at first. And you shouldn’t assume that because you’ve passed the buck on wordsmithing to someone else that content creation no longer takes up any time on your schedule. You’re planning to put your name (or your brand’s name) on this content, so you still have to manage it.

“The biggest challenge we face when hiring ghostwriters is time,” says Zac Harding, Director or Marketing at Sense Chat Labs. “It takes time to manage ghostwriters and to reach out. If your process for managing your ghostwriters is not prepped and easy to follow you may lose their interest right away or, even if you hire them, they’ll not be used to their full potential which means money wasted.”

When working with ghostwriters, plan extra time for:

  • Onboarding new writers
  • Working out details of projects with writers
  • Returning pieces for rounds of revisions
  • Providing feedback on content to help ensure ghostwriters get increasingly closer to your ideal
  • Updating ghostwritten content with any personal preferences before you publish it

2. Look for people who are knowledgeable about your field.

A common mistake that clients make when seeking ghostwriters is assuming they just need someone who can write, and that any skilled writer will do. After all, if you’re providing all the research and talking points, can’t any writer worth their salt turn it into a high-quality blog post, ebook or article?

Qualities to look for in a ghostwriter

The answer is no. Writers have unique skill sets, and you want one that:

  • Writes the type of content you need. Marketing content, technical copy, journalistic articles and conversational blog posts all require different writing skills. Some writers can move between these formats and some can only do one or a few.
  • Can match your voice. Many writers can adopt a client’s voice with a little practice and some samples. But some writers work best with certain types of voices, and others have such a strong voice themselves that they can’t successfully mimic yours.
  • Understands — or is capable of understanding — your topic. This is especially true of highly technical or unique fields. Eric Even Haim, the cofounder and CEO of StilyoApps, says “You want to find people that are already in the field you’re in — the more specific the match is, the better. Try asking your candidate as many questions as you can to make sure you and he are on the same page and that you speak and think in the same wave.”

ALSOHow Can You Find a Great Content Writer Who Has Niche Expertise?

3. Make sure there’s a body of work your ghostwriter can reference.

The easiest way to ensure a writer can match the style, voice and content you’re looking for is to already have some of that content to show them. It’s much easier for a writer to understand what you mean by “funny and engaging” or “formal and professional” when they can read some pages you already like.

“A ghostwriter will be infinitely more effective if there’s already a body of content in place for them to use as reference material,” says Matt Diggity of Diggity Marketing and LeadSpring LLC. “As my business was growing, I wrote constantly to establish my authority as an expert in my industry. That body of work has been a huge asset that helps our ghostwriters maintain my tone and consistency as they take on responsibility.”

If you don’t already have published content under your own name or on your own site, share content from other sites and tell the ghostwriter what you like about it. That helps them hone in on what you’re looking to create.

4. Provide detailed briefs and instructions.

Writers aren’t mind readers. Even if they’ve worked with you for a while, they need instructions to create the content you want. How much instruction you provide depends on your preferences, needs and trust in the writer you’re working with.

Someone who has a long-term relationship with a single writer may be able to say “We’d like a blog post about how to paint your living room,” and let the writer run with it. But in any other case, you typically get better results and less hassle if you spell it out a bit more.

“I’ve found that creating a watertight brief with clearly laid out bullet points and examples, as well as providing a tone of voice document, has dramatically improved the quality of ghostwritten copy that I’ve received,” says Nathan Thompson, digital marketing lead at Pavilion Broadway. “This also avoids any disagreements or ambiguity about exactly what the output should be.”

Quote from Nathan Thompson on working with ghostwriters

When you’re creating a brief for ghostwriters, consider including, at minimum:

  • Word count ranges
  • Keyword requirements
  • An outline of what you want included in the piece
  • Style and voice instructions with examples or links to examples
  • Whether content should be in first, second or third person
  • Grammar requirements, such as if you want the Oxford comma used or which style guide you follow
  • Topics and phrases to avoid
  • Linking requirements for both internal and external linking
  • Research requirements, including the types of sources you want used and competitors that should be avoided
  • Who the audience is, as this helps the writer better target the piece

5. Run a calibration round — or two.

When the Enterprise team at Crowd Content works with any new client, they always run at least one calibration round. That’s a small batch of content created to the client’s specs to ensure that we actually understand those specs and are hitting them correctly.

Our Director of Enterprise Content, Lisa, always tells clients that we expect to make mistakes during the calibration round. Our project managers and writers aren’t you. We can’t know every single writing choice you would make, and so we have writers complete a handful of tasks so we can get feedback to tweak the process going forward.

We’re not the only ones who champion a calibration round. “I find it’s far more productive to have an early feedback session,” says Thompson. “If you are getting 100 pieces of product copy written, ask to receive the first 3 or 4 initially, provide constructive and annotated feedback and go from there.”

Taking the time to hold one or more calibration rounds with new ghostwriters (or new projects with existing writers) saves you a lot of potential hassle and money in the long-run.

Start Working With Professional Ghostwriting Teams Today

If you’re ready to take the plunge and reap the benefits of working with ghostwriters, contact Crowd Content or sign up for a self-serve account. We can help you find the ideal writer for your project, and our customized content solutions let you hand over as much control of the process as you’re comfortable with while ensuring the utmost quality.

Crowd Content Ghostwriters

Benefits of Working With Ghostwriters Through Crowd Content

You can find ghostwriters via LinkedIn, internet searches or job posts on freelancing boards, but you can also turn to professional services such as Crowd Content to make the entire process easier. Here are some reasons to work with ghostwriters via Crowd Content:

  • You don’t have to worry about copyright. Our terms of service ensure clients receive copyright to the work upon payment.
  • Payment methods are standardized, and you can find options to fit your budget.
  • Revision requests are automatically built into the process.
  • Our gamified writing system includes perks to entice writers to meet your deadlines, and since turn around times are between a few hours and a few days on average, you’re never left hanging.
  • Crowd Content writers have already agreed to terms of service that cover NDAs, tax liabilities and other critical details.
  • You’ll have access to thousands of writers, supporting your ability to find an experienced, expert authority regardless of what niche you’re covering at any given time.

The post How Does Ghostwriting Work? The Complete Guide to Hiring the Voice Behind Your Message appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-does-ghostwriting-work-the-complete-guide-to-hiring-the-voice-behind-your-message/feed/ 0
4 Ways to Manage Your Online Store Without Losing Your Sanity https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/4-ways-to-manage-your-online-store-without-losing-your-sanity/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/4-ways-to-manage-your-online-store-without-losing-your-sanity/#respond Thu, 12 Dec 2019 18:30:24 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=26650 Great news: your online store is thriving. Traffic is up, and so are conversion rates. You’re selling more products every month. But it’s not easy. The challenges of running an online store are like tentacles, expanding as your success increases. If you’re like most entrepreneurs, you’re likely to want to manage it all yourself. That […]

The post 4 Ways to Manage Your Online Store Without Losing Your Sanity appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Great news: your online store is thriving. Traffic is up, and so are conversion rates. You’re selling more products every month.

But it’s not easy. The challenges of running an online store are like tentacles, expanding as your success increases. If you’re like most entrepreneurs, you’re likely to want to manage it all yourself. That independent streak, after all, is a big part of your success.

But when your business is growing in all directions, it’s important to take a step back and examine how other tools can help you manage it more efficiently. Trust us—even if you take special pride in your 70-hour workweeks, it’s not admitting defeat to get some help. 

Let’s look at some ways you can make managing a successful eCommerce business and your online presence a whole lot easier. Not to mention more profitable.

Make sure the copy is doing the heavy lifting.

There are few things more disappointing than pouring effort into your products, building a visually enticing and functional site, and then finding you have a lot of visitors who leave without making a purchase. You launched your online store to produce sales, and you’re not getting as many as you imagined.

What’s to blame for this problem? Well, it could be your sales team. After all, your eCommerce site has a salesperson on every page—the product copy.

Download our Free eBook on Creating eCommerce Content Today!

Informing, enticing, convincing—your copy needs to be all of these and more. Your potential buyers want to be convinced that your products are not only great but can add value to their lives. That doesn’t matter if it’s a 100% cashmere throw or a pair of hedge clippers—luxury, utility, and everything in between still need an emotional connection.

Product Copy Should Be

You might find that you’re great at crafting copy. After all, you’re fully invested in your products. But be brutally honest about your talents in this area. It’s easy for product copy to veer off course, often because the people writing it have spent so long obsessing over the details of a product that they lose touch with what will actually motivate someone to buy it.

Once again, there’s also a time element here. Evaluate how much time you can devote to crafting great product copy and whether other aspects of your business need more attention. If you have the time and the talent, go for it. If you don’t, hire freelancers and develop effective relationships with them. If they are more plugged into your company and its products, the copy they produce will reflect that. When your company enjoys major growth, you should consider full-time hires or contracting with an outside agency.

ALSOProduct Copywriting for SEO: How to Be Sure Your eCommerce Copy Converts and Ranks

Manage social media well. Or get a pro to do it.

Whether you sell everyday consumer products—Instagram! Twitter! TikTok!—or you have a business-to-business— hello there, LinkedIn—social media can power the growth of your online store. If this is a task you enjoy and want to take on yourself, then go for it—social media efforts can benefit when someone like a company founder takes it on. 

But this isn’t posting a few vacation photos on Facebook, and it requires consistent work. Ask yourself if you really have the time to write posts, manage comments, and court influencers – among a host of other things that are involved in effective social media marketing. Chances are, you simply don’t have the bandwidth to do it yourself.

If you believe in the
power of social media to bolster your e-commerce store
, consider hiring someone to manage it for you. This can be a full or part-time staffer, or an outside consultant or agency. Track the ROI by regularly reviewing the source of your site traffic—you should do this constantly anyway—to see if social moves the needle for your sales numbers.

Social Media eCommerce

ALSOSocial Media: How Does it Impact Your SEO in 2019?

Invest in collaboration tools.

When you’re developing a large eCommerce site, you’ll be connecting lots of different talents. UI designers, strategy professionals, developers—it takes a team if you’re building a comprehensive, product-rich online presence.

To help manage your team and keep everyone on track, invest in a collaboration tool that allows them to share ideas, work-in-progress, see changes, and seamlessly hand off design work. There are a number of different solutions available—choosing the best one is going to come down to finding software that suits the type and the scale of your projects.

The bottom line is that the best ones require some investment. But don’t forget that time is, indeed, money. Every day that your site remains in development is a day you’re not recording online sales. If a potential customer pores over the offerings on your eCommerce stores but fails to make a purchase because the experience is too slow or confusing, you need to make revisions—fast. Collaboration tools can speed up both the initial launch and ongoing improvement.

Work with an order management provider.

You’ve built a great online store. You have invested to bring in visitors. And you’re getting all kinds of orders.

Orders are the lifeblood of your business. No orders, no business. But when you start getting a lot of them, you’ll need a process to manage and fulfill them. If you’re spending all your time just getting products out the door, you’re not devoting any hours to future growth.

When orders are overwhelming—a good problem to have—look at cloud-based, SaaS software that can make managing them a seamless part of your business. If you’re already working with a provider but finding it’s still soaking up a ton of your time, it’s probably time to start looking for one that will deliver what you need.  

The best providers can handle both online orders and Electronic Data Interchange (EDI) transactions. Even if you’re currently handling nothing but orders that come directly from your online store, there’s a good chance your business will grow and you’ll find yourself selling to major retailers. And those clients will not only ask that you use EDI—they demand it. EDI remains the most popular data exchange format for large-scale retail.

As you can see from this screenshot, eZCom Software offers important features that will improve the efficiency of your eCommerce business.

But seamless EDI and online order management aren’t the only challenges the right software provider can help you resolve. You should also be able to integrate orders into the system that powers your business, whether it’s an ERP like NetSuite or accounting software like QuickBooks.

It’s even better if they offer additional time-saving features such as connections to shipping providers—it makes labels so much easier—and, if you use a 3PL, it should be able to integrate with them, too. Do you also sell through online marketplaces like Amazon or eBay? Great, but make sure you can bring those orders into your system without a hitch.

Finally, get the customer support you need. The best providers will have an expert team to back you up when things get tricky. Ask about their hours and if they’re contracted or in-house. When a company invests in its own support team, it indicates they want to provide a great customer experience for you.

Ready for a more efficient online store?

The internet and eCommerce have opened marketplace opportunities that have never existed before. You can have customers from all corners of the globe, people can shop in their pajamas, and a brand can grow faster than ever before without the major investment that it took in the past. But it’s work—and success can often breed more work. Make sure your eCommerce store is working as hard as you are but also find solutions that will carve out more time for you.

The post 4 Ways to Manage Your Online Store Without Losing Your Sanity appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/4-ways-to-manage-your-online-store-without-losing-your-sanity/feed/ 0
The Complete Guide to Google E-E-A-T: How to Improve SEO https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/the-complete-guide-to-google-e-a-t-what-is-it-why-is-it-and-how-do-you-create-it/ Thu, 05 Dec 2019 15:20:58 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=26413 What is E-E-A-T in SEO and why should anybody care? The answer to that first question is easy. E-E-A-T stands for experience, expertise, authoritativeness and trustworthiness. The answer to the second question is that we all care because Google cares, and if we want our sites to rank, E-E-A-T is the acronym of the day, […]

The post The Complete Guide to Google E-E-A-T: How to Improve SEO appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What is E-E-A-T in SEO and why should anybody care?

The answer to that first question is easy. E-E-A-T stands for experience, expertise, authoritativeness and trustworthiness. The answer to the second question is that we all care because Google cares, and if we want our sites to rank, E-E-A-T is the acronym of the day, every day.

Whether you’re generating all your content in-house or easing your load by contracting with top content creation services, here’s everything you need to know about E-E-A-T, Google’s algorithm updates and lots of fun tidbits in between.

E-A-T Content

A is for Algorithm

Google is constantly updating its algorithm — and that statement is not an exaggeration. In 2020 alone, Google made a whopping 4,500 changes to search. That works out to about 12 tweaks per day, all of which impact how sights rank on the search engine results pages (SERPs). And here’s the kicker: Google never shares what exactly they’ve changed.

While most laypeople and even some experts may not see the immediate side effects of those daily changes, even the smallest update is important. And sometimes, there’s an overhaul that makes everyone from SEO experts to copywriters sit up and take notice.

Take Google’s May 2022 core update, for instance. This update was so hefty it took two weeks to fully roll out, and it made a correspondingly significant impression on site rankings. Google’s intent was to reassess how they analyzed sites, likely fine-tuning the algorithm to further the search giant’s mission to reward content that’s accurate, user friendly and relevant.

But why the big change in mid-2022? And more importantly, did it work as intended?

Aftershocks From the May 2022 Core Update

After the May 2022 core update rolled out, Google saw volatility in rankings across the board, though some industries were affected more than others.

On desktop, real estate saw the biggest jump in rank volatility, followed by books and literature, hobbies and leisure, and travel, with pets and animals snagging the fifth-highest spot. The list was similar on mobile, with one notable exception: health replaced travel in the top five.

Even more significantly, research showed that 6.7% of the search results making up the top 10 post-update were previously ranked in the 20th spot or lower.

Whatever Google changed, it clearly affected some verticals more than others. So how can site owners prep for updates and protect themselves from that volatility?

Google has never deviated from its quest for content that provides superior user experience. The past half decade or so has seen updates that fueled mobile optimization, targeted spam, and boosted helpful content. None of these changes should come as a surprise. Really, Google is putting its tech where its mouth is and changing its algorithm to reward sites that are doing what Google has asked for all along.Pssst… curious what Google has up their sleeve next? Here’s a look at the Google algorithm predictions for 2023.

E-E-A-T: Google Spells Out Their Vision (Literally)

While Google technically abstains from sharing the nitty-gritty details of their updates, those details are, in many ways, totally irrelevant. It’s not important how Google analyzes sites. What’s important is that people understand what that analysis is meant to do. In other words, site and content creation should speak to the mission, not the methodology.

And the mission, should site owners choose to accept it, is to E-E-A-T.

Google E-E-A-T is the newest iteration of the concept formerly known as E-A-T, or “expertise, authoritativeness and trustworthiness.” The recently introduced extra E stands for “experience,” of course.

Picture4
  • Experience: Google believes searchers are interested in reaching content created by people who have actually lived the topic. It may not be coincidental that Google added Experience as artificial intelligence-generated content gained traction. This “E” also looks at technical aspects like load speed, visual stability and interactivity (all emphasized in Google’s May 2021 update aimed at page experience).
  • Expertise: Expertise goes behind experience to look at the credentials and overall track record of the person and/or publisher behind a piece of content. Having an MD attached to medical content or using a gold-medal athlete to talk about the Olympics demonstrates expertise.
  • Authoritativeness: Authority builds on expertise by finding ways for the content itself to feel important, accurate and reliable. Well-written content that contains links to other authoritative and high-ranking pages can help legitimize a site. It also helps if the content is referenced by other professionals with their own proven track records.
  • Trustworthiness: Trust is a fickle thing in the SEO world. For a site to be trustworthy, it has to tick a lot of boxes ranking from up-to-date, factual content to off-site links that are properly anchored (using relevant text) and lead to similarly credible content. Sites that have most of the trustworthiness boxes ticked but screw up on one or two significant aspects — keyword stuffing, for instance, or fudging the facts to suit an agenda — can lose trust and traction quickly.

Keep in mind, these critical components are not weighted equally. Google looks at “trust” as a primary factor, “because untrustworthy pages have low E-E-A-T no matter how Experienced, Expert, or Authoritative they may seem.”And transparency is improving. Google now shares documents outlining their search quality rater guidelines. And yes, there are actual people involved in the evaluation process. While AI plays a vital role in ranking, so apparently do the people tasked with reading content to see whether it’s really answering search queries or just pretending to. Real, live people can be especially helpful when looking at that first “E” — bots can scan and analyze content, but they can’t get a gut feeling about how slow load times or a stagnant site make them feel (yet).

Content isn’t Evaluated in a Vacuum

There are blueprints to help site owners and content creators build content that meets E-E-A-T expectations. But it’s almost impossible to chase ranking by reworking faulty content and trying to make it more worthy.

This is partly because SEO takes time to gain traction and show results. But it’s also because sites aren’t evaluated in a vacuum, they’re analyzed in comparison with other sites fighting for the same SERPs. When site owners took to social media to complain about a shakeup in organic traffic numbers in March 2018, Google offered up some valuable advice:

Picture2

It’s still worth pursuing the E-E-A-T ideals, though, because sites that publish content that shows high levels of experience, expertise, authority and trustworthiness stand to benefit beyond higher search rankings.

  • Boosted behavioral metrics: Positive behavioral metrics on things like time on page and click-throughs to other pages can lead to a positive RankBrain score, which can then boost your performance in search results.
  • Increased links and social shares: If your content is perceived as authoritative, people are more likely to share it with others. Social shares and links can boost SEO performance, but they also lead to general organic traffic outside of SERPs. Plus, since someone sharing your site is akin to a recommendation of your content, people who click through are arriving with some pre-trust built in, which can be of benefit to your conversion rate.
  • Inclusion as a featured snippet: Being featured in the very top spot on Google search results is akin to claiming the SERP throne — and yes, these snippets can even steal the spotlight from paid pads (and you don’t have to fork over a single dime).

The Ultimate Checklist for Creating E-E-A-T Content

Time for a quick recap. So far, we’ve learned:

  • Google makes lots of updates, and it makes them often
  • Some more sweeping updates, like the one from May 2022, can cause some interesting swings in search result rankings
  • We don’t know the exact changes Google makes, but we do know why they’re making them
  • E-E-A-T is always the both the mission and the measuring stick

Here’s our E-E-A-T SEO checklist to help you craft content that answer’s Google’s call.

Be Comprehensive

There are several noticeable differences between sites that rank high on SERPs and those that only appear a few pages into scrolling, but the biggest is that high-ranking sites offer content that is more than a simple regurgitation.

Anyone can list the top three reasons to sell your home.  But it takes an expert to expound on those three reasons, offer real-life examples, and include information that goes above and beyond the initial ask.

To make your content more comprehensive:

  • Conduct keyword research to see what people are looking for
  • Think about your target audience and searcher intent
  • Utilize tools like MarketMuse and SEMrush SEO content templates to analyze existing content and search queries before forming your own plan
  • Play with Google’s autocomplete tool and review People Also Ask questions for ideas on how to expand your outline
  • Leverage alternative content formats to appeal to different types of learners and boost engagement (Pro tip: Not everything needs to be a blog! Podcasts, infographics and call-out boxes are just a few of the ways you can shake things up)

Build Authority in Your Chosen Niche

In this arguably awful era of #fakenews, how often do we take people at their word? Does that number drop when you’re evaluating someone (or some site) that’s completely new to you?

Of course it does.

Humans are not naturally prone to blind trust. Fewer than half of all Americans say they trust mainstream media. People want proof something is true, and that requires going above and beyond a simple “trust me, I’m a writer” kind of statement.

In addition to creating comprehensive content that proves your knowledge, you can build authority (and therefore trust) by:

Tips for Building Authority in Your Niche Using EAT Content
  • Encourage links from related and authority sites. Publish high-quality content that people will want to share and link to and watch your network build naturally. Guest posting opportunities can also help (they’ll link to you if you link to them), as can acting as an expert and lending a quote to someone else’s authoritative content.
  • Build reputable citations. Citations occur when your business is mentioned on another site. These mentions are especially powerful when they contain full NAP data (business name, address and phone number). Get involved with local and industry events, join industry organizations and claim your profiles on review sites to increase your online mentions.
  • Generate social shares with content that helps or entertains. Amuse or amaze people and they’re more likely to share. Drive that engagement further by being active on your own social profiles and responding to comments.
  • Include links to authority sites. It’s one thing to state a fact. It’s another to provide a source. We can shout about algorithm changes until we’re as blue as the Crowd Content logo is, but nothing drives home the point better than linking to an explanation by Google or Search Engine Journal.

Authorship Matters: Who Wrote This and Why Should Anybody Care?

Google cares about the who of content just as much as it cares about the what. This is especially true for certain types of pages. So why, then, are so many web pages, blogs and articles written by “staff” or with no name attached at all?

The answer is that authorship hasn’t always been as important as it is now, and some sites are still trying to catch up. This is where you have an opportunity to get ahead.

By all means outsource your content, but add a byline that highlights an expert from your company before you publish. This helps add authority and anchors the content as something that’s important enough for a person on your team to take ownership of.

You can further amplify authority by:

  • Creating and linking to author profiles for your in-house team that highlight relevant credentials and experience
  • Using Googlespeak (aka author markup best practices) to communicate authorship to search engines
  • Encouraging those who contribute content to your site (freelance writers, for example) to write their own detailed, authoritative bios

To see these tips in action, mosey on over to NerdWallet’s site. This behemoth of financial industry news and insights lists not only the writer on each piece, but the editor, too. Each name is linked to a bio page that includes the individual’s title, their areas of focus, a bio highlighting credentials and experience, and the person’s top pics for other authoritative titles. You can also see what that person has written or edited previously, laying out a road map of their expertise for the public to follow.

This isn’t just a Jane Doe, put-a-name-to-AI situation, it’s a real person with real insight. Google loves that, and other real people should love it too.

Recruit Expert Contributors

In-house content creators are nice to have, but with the benefits of outsourcing content consistently mounting, it’s important to know how to make the most of freelance contributions, too.

First, let’s look at what “expert” really means in ContentLand:

  • A literal expert with the credentials and accreditation to back it up, like a Culinary Institute of America graduate writing up recipes or a CPA writing personal finance advice
  • Someone who has written enough online content in a particular niche to have Google authority

The first option is better for projects that demand a high level of verifiable authority, like interpreting medical studies. The second is typically better suited for niches where credentials aren’t as plentiful or necessary, such as gardening tips or parenting blogs.

To ensure your team of contractors is bringing enough to the table:

  • Hire freelancer writers who have either Google authority or credentials in your field and are willing to use their own names and bios
  • Contact industry experts who would be willing to participate in guest blogging for your site.
  • Pepper content created by non-credentialed writers with quotes from experts (you can give them a shout out and a link as a thanks) sourced from:

Another pro tip: Try a content roundup (one way to repurpose content) that includes quotes and tips from experts to master both the “comprehensive” and “authoritative” aspects of Google’s ask.

E-E-A-T More Than Just Your Blog

Gordon Ramsay wouldn’t have his Michelin stars if he ponied up a mouthwatering main course but totally biffed it on the appetizer, sides and dessert. The entire meal matters, which is why you have to evaluate your entire site through an E-E-A-T lens if you want to win the SERPs.

Ace your About Us page

If we had a dime for every time we happened across a weak and emaciated About Us page, we’d be swimming in Franklin D. Roosevelt profiles. For some reason, companies tend to phone it in when it comes to their own people and accomplishments, but that’s the exact wrong approach.

Instead, craft an About Us page that’s packed with:

  • Company history
  • Names, titles and backgrounds of your team
  • Awards and accolades

Among the sites that won biggest after the May 2022 Google core update were mega brands Etsy, Instagram, Apple and Wikipedia. All have robust About Us pages — or in the case of Apple, a group of seven pages under the About Apple umbrella that address everything from company news to ethics and compliance info. Etsy’s About Us is the warm and artsy welcome you’d expect from a global marketplace focused on handmade and vintage goods. The brand discusses its mission, describes how the marketplace works and clearly illustrates what they have to offer versus the competition. There are even links to investor relations info and product announcements.

Humanize your company with team bios

Team bios are important enough to mention twice. Faceless corporate entities don’t command the same loyalty as brands that showcase team members, putting faces with the names of the powers that be.

Would you be more likely to buy baby blankets from Blankets R Us, which has no About Us page and no clear ownership, or Mama’s Baby Blankets, which shares Mama’s real name and bio along with pics of her knitting those fuzzy covers with her own two hands?

Etsy understands the assignment. Their team page kicks off with a sweeping vision statement: “The people who work at Etsy share the vision and values of community.” We’re already prepped to like these people. Then comes headshots and names, linked to bio pages, for each person on the leadership team. And then, Etsy knocks humanization out of the park by sharing a collage of hundreds of Etsy employees tasked with building and maintaining the site.

It’s practically impossible not to feel connected, because it’s just so easy to believe that all these fine humans are on the same wavelength as the people they’re serving. Apple’s leadership page is less cozy knits and garden chats, which is what you’d expect from a tech company. The focus is instead on the titles and credentials of the executive team and those on the board, illustrating how bios and proof of authority can change from niche to niche.

Construct a site-wide content strategy using content clusters

We sound like a bit of a broken record yammering on about the need for comprehensive content, but that’s how important it is to avoid regurgitation and offer a distinct POV. But covering all your bases can quickly turn into content cannibalization if you don’t have a content plan and stick to it.

Start by considering the different content types — and even sub types, like multiple ways to create and structure blogs — to help vary your approach to each topic. Then map out your topics, using topic clusters to give readers an overall view of a subject as well as an opportunity to deep dive into specifics.

Hubspot has a great example of a topic cluster centered on content marketing. A list of relevant topics might include:

  • Content marketing strategy
  • Types of posts
  • Content planning tips
  • Blogging mistakes
  • Buyer personas
  • Buyer’s journal
  • Approaches to brainstorming
  • Writing tips
  • Common grammar errors
  • Gated content
  • Benefits of outsourcing
  • Distribution channels
  • How to scale

The main/pillar page briefly touches on all of those topics/keywords, while the spoke pages would go more in depth on each topic or keyword, tackling the ins and outs one blog at a time.

This creates a comprehensive content web that’s packed with opportunities for expert contributions and backlinks galore.

To do this yourself:

  • Use keyword and topic research tools such as SEMrush and the teams recruited by SEO content writing services to ideate potential topics
  • Choose a topic for your pillar page that’s relevant to your brand and interesting enough for your audience to want to follow
  • Write a pillar post that paints a broad picture of your chosen topic — and remember that this is long-form content, so no need to try to cram everything into a 500-word blog
  • Follow up with shorter, more in-depth posts that refer back to and build on the pillar content
  • Link from the pillar posts to the supporting posts and back again, then link from spoke to spoke (or supporting content to supporting content)

Do all of the above, and your topic cluster will act like a road-side flare, alerting Google that you’re churning out high-quality, E-E-A-T supportive articles that prove you’re an authority worthy of an appropriately high SERP ranking.

ALSO – 7 Tips for How to Write SEO Content

How to Audit Your Site to Ensure Content is Google E-E-A-T Compliant

Chances are you’re not reading this guide to Google E-E-A-T and SEO as you’re about to make your very first website. No, it’s more likely that you already have a website up and running with a decent amount of content published and available for public consumption. So, is it time to go on a deleting rampage and scrap it all?

Thankfully, there’s no need to take the nuclear option here. That’s just a waste of time, money, content and SEO traction. You don’t want to lose whatever organic traffic and site authority you already have, you want to build on it.

Put on your E-E-A-T hat and audit all your existing content (that means web pages too, not just your blogs), flagging the following:

  • Content with no author name/byline attached
  • Author bios that are lackluster or missing altogether
  • Content that lacks appropriate backlinks, which is a sign that your content is either not visible enough or not viewed as authoritative by others in your niche
  • Content that isn’t linking out to other authoritative sites and/or authoritative content on your own site (you should have at least a few of each type)
  • Pages that aren’t ranking for the right keywords
  • Accuracy and timeliness — content that isn’t evergreen may need to be updated or replaced

Let’s Get Specific: E-E-A-T Tips for Specific Industries

Because this is the ultimate guide to understanding and acting on the intricacies of Google E-E-A-T, we can’t just throw out an answer to “What is E-E-A-T in SEO?” and call it a day.

While the tips above will certainly help you kick start your content audit and site refresh in a meaningful way, there are also some insights that can help brands in specific industries tailor their content and overall content marketing strategies even further.

To save you time and tons of clicks, we’ve pored over the Google Search Quality Evaluator Guidelines and put together this must-read cheat sheet, industry by industry.

Health and Wellness

Health and wellness is a very broad industry that encompasses everything from yoga poses and personal care products to preventative medicine and public health policy. The market was valued at a whopping $4.8 billion in 2022, a number expected to increase by $3 billion by 2030, so it’s no surprise the industry is as crowded as it is competitive.

This might feel daunting, especially if you make the mistake of assuming that all content in this niche has to be written by someone with clinical credentials, like an RN or MD. Luckily, that’s not the case.

Google has spoken up about E-E-A-T adherent medical content, stating: “It should be written or produced by people or organizations with appropriate medical expertise or accreditation. High E-A-T [now E-E-A-T] medical advice or information should be written or produced in a professional style and should be edited, reviewed and updated on a regular basis.”

In practice, “appropriate medical expertise or accreditation” is relative. A blog titled “Top 10 Yoga Poses for Stress Relief” may be best when written by a trained yogi with a decade of teaching experience, while an article discussing research into stem cells is probably better bylined by a research biologist or someone with similar credentials.

Here are some other takeaways for brands in the health and wellness space:

  • Use bylines and bios for all content creators and contributors (editors and subject matter experts SMEs) included) to create layers of indisputable authority
  • Prioritize accuracy by requiring proper citations/sourcing and employing fact checkers to verify research and writer/editor interpretations of that research
  • Update regularly to ensure content remains E-E-A-T compliant

If you can’t access (or afford) credentialed writers for every piece, try pairing up talented writers who are adept at research and can produce polished content with SMEs that can add authority and check accuracy. It’s often easier and less costly to find an SME who can check content versus one who can produce that content from scratch.

Finance/Legal

Money and legal issues are two things that the average person takes pretty seriously. Google gets this and has laid out guidelines accordingly.

According to E-E-A-T, financial and legal content must:

  • Come from credible sources, with proof in the form of fleshed-out About Us pages and clear authorship
  • Be trustworthy, requiring lots of research and fact checking
  • Be updated regularly, especially if there’s a major change in regulations or another newsworthy event related to the industry

Remember Nerd Wallet? They own a lot of the prime real estate for finance-related topics (especially in the personal finance realm). Click on one of their featured snippets or top-ranking articles, like this one on how to raise your credit score fast, and you’ll quickly see why they’re winning the SERPs.

  • The content has bylines for the writer and editor, and both names are linked to bio pages that list the contributors’ credentials, education and other published work
  • As of our publish date for this guide, the NW article is listed as “Updated Nov 1, 2022,” meaning it was written earlier and has been updated at least once to ensure accuracy and timeliness
  • There are tons of links and even a quote from the senior direct of public education and advocacy at Experian to help drive home key points and increase authority/ trustworthiness.

Home, Garden, Real Estate, Hobbies and Parenting

Before we dig into this industry, this is a good time to introduce another fun Google acronym: YMYL.

YMYL stands for “your money or your life,” which sounds like a bad line from a movie about a mugging but is really just what Google calls “pages or topics that could potentially impact a person’s future happiness, health, financial stability, or safety.”

YMYL topics like crocheting or pruning tomato plants might seem “soft,” but they’re still subject to E-E-A-T guidelines. After all, if content is meant to impact future happiness and safety, among other things, expertise definitely matters. But the type of expertise and/or credentials required change a bit depending on the subject matter.

Google absolutely recognizes informal experience when it’s relevant and appropriate to the topic:

Some topics require less formal expertise. . . Many people share tips and life experiences on forums, blogs, etc. These ordinary people may be considered experts in topics where they have life experience. If it seems as if the person creating the content has the type and amount of life experience to make him or her an “expert” on the topic, we will value this “everyday expertise” and not penalize the person/webpage/website for not having “formal” education or training in the field.

Here’s an example of credentialed expertise versus less-formal expertise around the same general topic:

  • Tips for remodeling a home or installing a toilet should probably come from someone with demonstrated expertise in building, plumbing or other relevant trades
  • Tips for maximalist bathroom décor may rely more on personal experience

STEM

Google doesn’t typically extend its everyday expertise free pass to science and tech articles, especially when the content claims to present new information or theories. Instead, Google expects these articles to represent and include well-established facts and expert consensus.

To publish STEM content that’s in line with E-E-A-T:

  • Use expert content creators
  • Source facts and other info from highly credible sites
  • Go straight to the primary source for those facts, such as studies published in scientific journals

Food, Beverage and General Retail Products

Everybody eats and everybody has an opinion on food, so it’s not exactly shocking that everyday expertise often comes into play for content in this niche. There’s a lot of common knowledge surrounding cooking, for instance, and content surrounding retail products relies heavily on reviews.

There are some exceptions here. While a layperson could write a blog on favorite Cabernet and cheese pairings, you might want a trained sommelier to weigh in on deep-dive wine topics like vinification techniques. A frequent shopper could offer up tips on extreme couponing, but it would take an expert to confidently espouse on the psychology of retail product pricing.

To know whether you should recruit an expert or if you’re okay with “everyday expertise,” think about the topic at hand and whether someone would need to study to fully understand and explain the nuances of that topic or if a hobbyist has the chops to cater to search expectations.

The Final Word on E-E-A-T

There’s no secret handshake or magic potion that will earn you a shortcut to the top of Google’s search results. It’s a level playing field, and the top spot is open to anyone willing to put in the time and effort to meet E-E-A-T expectations.

But the road isn’t always well-paved and hurdles aren’t exactly uncommon — especially when Google’s averaging over a dozen updates per day. Keeping up with trends and investing in E-E-A-T friendly content is a solid, winning strategy that benefits rankings and readers alike.

Incorporate the tips above and you may soon see:

  • Better SEO performance
  • Higher conversion rates
  • Increased strength in the face of Google’ scrutiny — no matter what updates are in the offing

ALSO – Expert Checklist: SEO for Blog PostsIf you know you need to do something to improve your SEO and just don’t have the time, knowledge or in-house resources to get it done, we can help. Find out more about Crowd Content’s professional writing services and how they can help you create E-E-A-T content.

The post The Complete Guide to Google E-E-A-T: How to Improve SEO appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content Advertising: How to Leverage Paid Ads in Your Content Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-advertising-how-to-leverage-paid-ads-in-your-content-marketing/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-advertising-how-to-leverage-paid-ads-in-your-content-marketing/#respond Thu, 31 Oct 2019 14:28:54 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=26236 In communities of marketers and SEOs, it’s a constant debate: do you grow a business using PPC or content marketing? The instinct is to choose one or the other — you can either pay to aim offers at a chosen audience, or optimize relevant content to reach your target demographic through unpaid channels. But, we’re […]

The post Content Advertising: How to Leverage Paid Ads in Your Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

In communities of marketers and SEOs, it’s a constant debate: do you grow a business using PPC or content marketing? The instinct is to choose one or the other — you can either pay to aim offers at a chosen audience, or optimize relevant content to reach your target demographic through unpaid channels.

But, we’re finding more and more that these don’t have to be two distinct strategies. Content marketing and paid channels like Facebook and Google Ads CAN be melded together, and what’s more, it may be more effective than using one or the other.

This is a discussion about how content and advertising can be used together in a cost-effective, high-ROI campaign.

What Is Content Marketing?

The first step to understanding how to mix content and advertising is to understand exactly what content marketing truly means. Many business leaders think that if they have a blog and post content regularly, it’s a content marketing strategy.

If you want your content marketing to not be a complete waste of time, though, you have to think hard about the goal of any given piece of content you create. Let’s say you write a blog. How can you get the work you’ve done in front of the right sets of eyes?

Valuable content can be truly invaluable when used with a variety of strategies, according to the Content Marketing Institute:

Content is non-negotiable in an SEO strategy; a blog post optimized for keywords, backlinks, and on and off-page best practices has the potential to multiply the number of views on a piece of content.

Email marketing: No matter the type of email list you have access to, thin content that isn’t relevant to your readers won’t get the clicks to justify continued use of the channel.

It’s crucial in social media; even loyal customers aren’t quick to engage with weak content.

ALSOSocial Media: How Does it Impact Your SEO in 2019?

Content Marketing and Ads: Addressing the Limitations of Unpaid Media

But, what happens when your organic and “unpaid” channels aren’t getting the results you need to promote your products and services effectively? If you’re a marketer for a smaller brand without the authority to compete on a level playing field with the big boys, SEO, email, and organic social media alone may fall short.

For example, email campaigns are generally high-ROI activities, but only if you have the email addresses to make it worthwhile. Social media is great for nurturing a warmer group, but organic posts are unlikely to reach colder parts of your target audience.

This is when it’s time to start pursuing paid channels. But, there’s a mistake that many marketers make when switching from content marketing to paid advertising: they de-emphasize valuable, high-performing content, with the expectation that adding money to the equation will make up for it.

Why Is Content So Important in Paid Advertising (and Vice Versa)?

Imagine you’re running a Facebook ads campaign. You optimize the targeting and reach perfectly. You do everything right, except build your ads on the back of a great piece of content that provides a solution to a relevant issue faced by your audience (psst… here are some examples of content that inspires and excites).

What’s going to happen? Most likely, your cost-per-click (CPC) will be high and your engagement rate low. In short, your ads will be a waste of money.

The same goes for something like Google PPC. Without valuable content to direct people who click, your opportunities to get new leads without offering discounts or special promotions will be limited.

So, we’ve established that content can be limited without paid channels, but also, that paid channels can be limited without great content. Leveraging them both can be the answer.

How to Mix Paid Ads and Content Marketing

We understand that leveraging paid traffic with valuable, relevant content can address common roadblocks that can arise when you run a campaign using just one or the other. But, getting started can be tough. How do you know what to do first?

Most marketers agree: content comes first. You need to identify your strongest content and work backward. But, how do you decide which content to use? Here are a few examples of how to identify valuable content and use it effectively in content advertising.

Identify the Best Content for Your Chosen Paid Channels

The harmony between your content and the way it gets distributed should be top of mind.

Andy Mura, Head of Marketing at Userlane: “when it comes to paid promotion for top-of-the-funnel content, the first — and highly important — step is to identify the kind of content that will yield the best results.”

The goal of this practice is to find something that marketing guru Larry Kim calls “unicorn content”. This is content that ranks high, gets tons of engagement on social channels, and outperforms relevant KPIs. But, how do you single out this rare type of piece?

Look to the Past

This is where having a breadth of content-focused campaigns in the past can give you the advantage. Based on past results (traffic, click-through rates, and other data), you can identify high-performing content to promote through paid channels.

Don’t make the mistake of assuming something that performed well in the past will simply work in the future, however. Here are some tips to refresh old content for a new purpose (or in this case, paid promotion).

Consider the “How”, Not Just the “What”

What’s the risk of choosing the wrong content for a given channel? Low engagement and poor ROI. Imagine you’re using a Google ads campaign to break into a new market, and research has uncovered the potential to reach new leads. If you build your ads on the back of content that’s more relevant to current customers than cold leads, you won’t get the response you’re looking for and that spend will go to waste.

But what happens if you don’t have the data on past content to inform future strategy?

Facebook Ads Content Marketing: You Can Use Paid Ads to Test Content

If you don’t have good data to use when choosing content to build a paid strategy on it, you don’t have to guess — you can build your own data.

For example: Facebook’s advertising algorithm gives marketers the ability to test content across a variety of different audiences, as well as test two pieces of content against each other to the same audience. This is the strategy used by Quincy Smith, a marketer at Ampjarwhen conceptualizing a paid content marketing campaign.

Says Smith, “we have audience segmentation in Facebook that corresponds to our user-profiles and so we will promote pieces of content to these groups and see who responds favorably.”

Marketers who just use paid ads to boost content they already know to be “high-performing” may be missing out on using these channels as a way to identify new, strong content that may perform even better.

Content + Retargeting = Conversions

Most people are familiar with the concept of “funnel”. Top-of-funnel customers are those who know almost nothing about your brand. Bottom-of-funnel customers are those making a purchase.

You can use paid content marketing to push prospects along the funnel — simply promote broadly relevant content and track the hand-raisers. These are the people who will be more receptive to receiving narrower, “mid-funnel” content in the near future.

Facebook and Google ad channels provide an easy way to track this timeline: just build a Facebook ad promoting content to the coldest leads — those who have never even heard of your brand before. With the installation of a Facebook pixel on your landing page, you can build a list of users who are farther down in the funnel and thus, more likely to convert.

Paid Ads and Content Can Be Mutually Beneficial

By backing your paid advertising with great content, you can drive leads to your business, but that’s not the only potential benefit:

According to Abel Hegyes, Marketing Director at eBacon, “website visitors who are just looking for information have turned into customers along the line. So our PPC strategy helps to drive traffic to our informational content sites and targets customers who are in the educational stage of our sales funnel.”

This is a great example of the symbiotic relationship between content marketing and PPC advertising. In the best case, an ad campaign built on a particular piece of content will drive new leads to your business, but even if it doesn’t, traffic to the page from users looking to relevant answers will boost your SEO, even if your content isn’t destined to end up on at the top of a results page.

The Best Channels for Promoting Content

We’ve mentioned a few of the channels that will provide the highest ROI for content promotion: Google Ads is among the most commonly used, and for good reason — when leveraged with top-of-funnel keywords and match phrases and paired with unique, relevant landing pages, Google Ads can provide cost-effective promotion of a wide range of content. Facebook, too, has been successful in this purpose.

Some channels you may not have considered offer cost-effective native advertising on a wide variety of sites, meaning that you can see your content placed on domains that are relevant to your audience. Among the most widely used are Taboola and Outbrain.

Your Next Steps

As we mentioned, the content comes before you can think about injecting ad spend into the equation. This starts with figuring out what your audience needs, and identifying relevant posts, white papers, case studies and more that helps meet those needs.

This can take place using a content audit, an intensive process of indexing all the content you’ve created (and deployed) in the past. You may not have the type of content you need, however. Before you can start blending content marketing and advertising, you need to have a content creation process that yields valuable assets.

The post Content Advertising: How to Leverage Paid Ads in Your Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-advertising-how-to-leverage-paid-ads-in-your-content-marketing/feed/ 0
The Complete Guide to Using Hashtags to Boost Your Content Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/the-complete-guide-to-using-hashtags-to-boost-your-content-marketing/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/the-complete-guide-to-using-hashtags-to-boost-your-content-marketing/#respond Thu, 24 Oct 2019 14:25:08 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=26173 Content creation and hashtags — when you’re talking about social media strategy, these terms need to be on the top of your mind. You already know that in order to be successful, social posts need to be built around high-quality, valuable content that gets people talking, but you can’t rely on social shares alone to […]

The post The Complete Guide to Using Hashtags to Boost Your Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Content creation and hashtags — when you’re talking about social media strategy, these terms need to be on the top of your mind. You already know that in order to be successful, social posts need to be built around high-quality, valuable content that gets people talking, but you can’t rely on social shares alone to get your content in front of new audiences. That’s where hashtags come in.

Now, many marketers understand why you’d use hashtags to boost your content marketing, but understanding how is a different story.

In this piece, we’ll breakdown the basics of using hashtags and content marketing in perfect harmony: why it’s important and how to maximize their effectiveness.

ALSOSocial Media: How Does it Impact Your SEO in 2019?

Content Marketing Hashtags: Why and How?

Most people understand what hashtags are — words and phrases marked by a # sign that group together posts and conversations about common topics. For the less socially-inclined marketers, the reasons why brands need to use them may not come as naturally.

Think of a social media site like a search engine and hashtags like keywords. What happens if you produce an organic blog post or web page without keyword optimization? It flops in the search rankings, and fewer prospective leads and customers will see your content. The same goes for social media. No matter the platform, posts without hashtags will be limited in their effectiveness if your goal is to maximize reach.

Imagine you run an optical retailer and you want to advertise that you have the largest selection of glasses in the industry, so you post on your Instagram about it. The problem here? This post will likely only be seen by your followers and these people may already be aware of this leverage point. With hashtags, on the other hand, you could see your engagement skyrocket. Even the addition of #glasses at the end of your post copy could put your content in front of thousands of new eyes.

Hashtags Definition

Getting Your Content Seen By Your Target Audience

Let’s take the analogy a step further and talk about using hashtags to target your content to the right audience. This is where hashtagging tends to confuse people — is it more important to use common hashtags, or uncommon ones? As it turns out, a mix of the two types may work best, depending on the platform in question.

“Choosing more “niche” Instagram hashtags (ones that aren’t used by as many people) than popular tags might feel like you’re going to appeal to fewer people. However, the truth is that you’re simply making sure that you’re attracting the right people.”

That’s Jill Potasnik, a Social Media Marketing Strategist and Visibility Consultant for her own company, SocialElevator, LLC. She specializes in helping content reach the eyes of a brand’s audience, which she says is harder than it seems, and takes a deep understanding of your audience:

“Instagram hashtags help your posts to appear in front of your target audience, but only if you know what they are searching for.”

And, the results tend to speak for themselves:

Sneh Ratna Choudhary, Senior Content Marketer at Beaconstac, executed a test with one of their posts. Measured before and after optimizing a piece of content creation with hashtags, they observed a 351% boost in reach and a 1000% increase in engagement.

ALSO6 Expert Secrets to Make Your Social Media Posts Pop

Not All Social Platforms Use Hashtags the Same Way

Here’s why you won’t find us telling you the optimal number of hashtags to use on different platforms: like Google’s algorithm as it pertains to SEO, small changes in these platforms and the way they elevate certain posts means that things — like hashtagging best practices — change fast. Just like how a Google update made keyword stuffing harm a page’s SEO ranking, Instagram changed its algorithm to detect posts that use too many hashtags and penalize them for being “spammy”.

It would be easy to read this article and immediately start jamming hashtags in with your content on every platform. A reasoned, strategic approach means understanding the shortcomings of some social media platforms.

For example, Facebook doesn’t support hashtags like Instagram, Twitter, and Linkedin do.

According to Taras Prystatsky, Content Marketing Strategist at Respect.Studio, “Facebook’s hashtag search is merged with the general keyword search… I find it a bit ineffective to use hashtags on this platform. That is why I use no more than 3 niche hashtags.”

Social media Screenshot
When you search for a topic on Facebook, you can filter and sort your results in many ways. Facebook will automatically pull relevant content, even if there isn’t a hashtag associated.

Instagram is a different story — Prystatsky recommends using around 15 keywords to optimize content in the post itself, and more in the comments.

Instagram Post
As you can see here, adding relevant hashtags to an Instagram post can increase exposure.

Here are some of the most important sites for using hashtags as early as possible to grow your reach:

  • Pinterest: Pinterest marketing is not as widely applicable for brands, but the platform’s reliance on categories makes hashtags an important ingredient for marketers.
  • Twitter: On Twitter, the latest trends and news are hidden behind hashtags — find the latest trending topics, and you have a world’s worth of engagement at your fingertips.
  • Instagram: Instagram, like Pinterest, relies on finding your audience in their preferred category or community. When you’re just starting out, putting your posts in front of as many eyes as possible is key, and hashtags help you do that.

ALSOThese Social Media Fails Really Happened

How to Find the Right Hashtags for Your Audience

Strategies to find the best hashtags to use in posts do vary from platform to platform, but not too much:

  • Twitter, Instagram, LinkedIn and other platforms have lists of the top (or “trending”) hashtags being used. Once you find a top hashtag, look at posts for that hashtag and identify how it’s being used
  • Finding leading influencers and authorities in your industry and look at the hashtags they’re using to drive engagement
  • Follow competitors in your industry and do the same thing
  • Study your customer avatars to try and predict their interests on social media
  • Survey customers and clients to see what types of hashtags they pay attention to
  • Simply learn via trial and error — social media is cost-effective enough that you can afford to make a few mistakes, as long as you’re learning and optimizing your content as a result

Hashtag-Strategies

Use Tools to Find the Best Hashtags

There are countless tools out there to help you find top-performing —meaning they allow you to maximize engagement — hashtags. Here are a few examples:

These are databases that use software to generate thousands of hashtags for any brand in any industry.

RiteTag Platform
When searching for hashtags on the RiteTag platform, users are provided with metrics such as Unique Tweets Per Hour, Retweets Per Hour and Hashtag Exposure Per Hour.

The Bottom Line

If you’re looking for ways to increase your ROI on social media — especially without using paid ads — hashtagging is a great way to start. But content marketing hashtags is a lot like anything else in the content marketing sphere: without valuable, high-performing content to start off with, your social posts will fall flat.

The post The Complete Guide to Using Hashtags to Boost Your Content Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/social-media/the-complete-guide-to-using-hashtags-to-boost-your-content-marketing/feed/ 0
How to Find and Succeed With Freelance Copywriting Jobs https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/how-to-find-and-succeed-with-freelance-copywriting-jobs/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/how-to-find-and-succeed-with-freelance-copywriting-jobs/#respond Thu, 17 Oct 2019 14:44:48 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25894 With industry giants and mom-and-pop shops alike generating larger and larger percentages of their sales online, more opportunities are opening up for freelance copywriters. For many writers, freelancing is the dream: creating your own schedule, writing in your pajamas, ditching that awful rush-hour commute. Still, jumping into the freelance waters can be like plunging headfirst into […]

The post How to Find and Succeed With Freelance Copywriting Jobs appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

With industry giants and mom-and-pop shops alike generating larger and larger percentages of their sales online, more opportunities are opening up for freelance copywriters. For many writers, freelancing is the dream: creating your own schedule, writing in your pajamas, ditching that awful rush-hour commute. Still, jumping into the freelance waters can be like plunging headfirst into the unknown.

If you’re considering a career as a freelance copywriter, keep reading for a primer on how to make yourself more marketable so you land the best assignments and position yourself for long-term success.

Copywriting Vs. Content Writing

A common misconception is that copywriting and content writing are different words for the same thing. They aren’t. The difference lies in the intent.

Content writing is meant to inform and entertain, engaging visitors so they spend more time interacting with a website and a brand in general. Copywriting, on the other hand, is designed for one reason – to sell – and may encompass a variety of projects.

ALSOAre You a Content Writer or a Copywriter?

Types of Copywriting Projects include:

  • Advertisements
  • Website Landing pages
  • Marketing emails and other correspondence
  • Product descriptions
  • Blog Posts
  • Social media Posts

ALSOThe Top Freelance Writing Jobs For 2019
ALSO7 Expert Tips for Advertising Copywriting

Why Companies Hire Freelance Copywriters

There are many reasons why companies hire freelance copywriters. Sometimes, they simply don’t generate enough work to sustain a full-time position, or high demand may have caused temporary overflow work, and often, in-house employees lack the necessary skills to create copy that can drive sales. Hiring a freelance copywriter can also be a more cost-effective option, and more and more, marketing teams are realizing the value a professional writer can bring to a business.

Professionalism

Websites that are littered with typos, misspellings, and poor grammar radiate unprofessionalism. Worse, are posts or product descriptions filled with jargon and confusing information, which can be a turnoff for a potential customer, and make even a loyal buyer lose trust in a brand. An experienced freelance copywriter brings professionalism to the delivery of a brand’s message.

Clarity

In digital marketing, particularly for web-based brands, clarity is everything. Potential buyers don’t see the product in person. They can’t touch it or try it out. They aren’t talking face-to-face with a representative about a service. These companies rely completely on words and images to convey the value of their product or service. Freelance copywriters are wordsmiths who have the expertise to deliver a clear verbal picture of the brand, product, or service.

Results

Ultimately, companies want results. Senior copywriters have years of experience behind them and can effectively and efficiently create engaging, error-free copy that’s designed to get results.

A freelance writer typing on a laptop

Making Yourself Marketable as a Freelance Copywriter

While prior copywriting experience is always desirable, there’s no must-have training for freelance copywriters. There are, however, certain things you can do to make yourself more marketable and increase your odds of receiving prime copywriting assignments:

  • Hone your writing skills. First and foremost, freelance copywriters should be great writers. You should not only know the basics of spelling, grammar, and word usage, but be able to write high-quality copy that’s engaging, effective, and requires minimal editing.

  • Develop the ability to work independently. Freelancers need to be self-starters. To meet the sometimes-strict deadlines required for the job, you’ll have to manage your time with minimal oversight.

  • Learn to mimic style. Companies want consistency. A good copywriter can match a brand’s style to create seamless additions to preexisting content. For BJ Enoch, Director of Demand Generation at opendorse, the ability to mimic brand voice is one of three core needs he considers when hiring freelancers. Enoch explains, “I evaluate how well they were able to blend their writing into the overall brand voice and tone of the client.”

  • Keep an online portfolio. Companies looking for freelancers like to see writing samples. By setting up a digital portfolio at a site such as Clippings.Me or Journo Portfolio you can give potential clients easy access to your work.

  • Do your homework. Copywriting is a marketing tool and you should understand the concepts and terminology of the industry, including conversion, calls to action (CTA), and branding. A course in marketing may be a good investment in your own marketability.

  • Know your SEO. Professional copywriters know how to optimize content for SEO, finding the right keywords – or working with keywords provided — and skillfully weaving them into the copy so that they sound natural. LogoMaker, an English-speaking company that hires freelancers to translate copy into 10 languages, only takes on writers with SEO experience. Audrey Strasenburgh, the company’s SEO Strategist, notes, “Our freelancers are all well-versed in search engine optimization, so they know not to translate verbatim. Doing so results in awkward non-English sentences.” After all, awkward is about the last thing companies want in their sales copy.

  • Understand the relationship between copy and design. Design is an important part of digital marketing, and as a freelance copywriter, you’ll need to tailor your copy to work effectively with graphics, videos, and other design elements. It’s also important to consider how your content will be used. Copy designed for a company’s landing page, for instance, will look considerably different than copy meant for a blog post or marketing email.

  • Know your process. You should be able to articulate your approach to content creation. BJ Enoch of opendorse comments, “I want to know what the writer’s process is for research, creation, approval, and edits. All of the successful engagements I’ve had with copywriters have shared one common theme; they all had a documented process for how they would approach research, initial drafts, rewrites, etc.”

  • Be professional. Companies want to do business with professionals. Professionalism includes communicating clearly and often, meeting all deadlines, and always being courteous.

  • Demonstrate your ability to get results. One thing Adam Hempenstall, the founder and CEO of Better Proposals, looks for is a writer’s track record. He explains, “We want landing page copy that converts so we are on the lookout for writers with solid track records. If a writer can show us the copy they’ve written and the results it achieved (conversion rates, how it beat someone else’s control), we are ready to hire them.”

The combination of these skills makes a copywriter marketable. Reuben Yonatan, Founder and CEO of GetVOIP, elaborates, “There is more to being a professional copywriter than simply a way with words. You need to deliver on time or ahead of schedule, and the copy should be flawless (at least error-wise).”

Finding Freelance Copywriting Jobs

Many companies, including major brands, hire freelance copywriters directly or through a freelance writing platform, and there are several ways to find jobs.

  • Networking Sites. Business networking sites, such as LinkedIn, can be a fantastic resource for writers seeking freelance copywriting jobs. While your searchable profile page lets you include everything you need to demonstrate your experience to companies who may be looking for freelancers, you can also collect recommendations from companies you’ve worked with to build your reputation. You can also join relevant LinkedIn groups, which let you connect with other freelancers to share tips and tricks for finding the best jobs.
  • Job Banks. Job listing sites, such as Indeed, include searchable lists of available assignments, including freelance, part time and contract positions, making it easy to find the types of positions you want. They also let you post resumes, to let potential employers find you.
  • The Direct Approach. If you’ve done your research and have found clients you think are a potential fit for the services you’re offering, you can reach out to them directly with proposals. This can be particularly effective for small, local businesses that may not even know how they could benefit from hiring a freelance copywriter.
  • Crowd Content. Through Crowd Content’s unique platform, writers have access to a variety of copywriting jobs. Unlike many freelance writing platforms, Crowd Content writers may advance to higher-paying assignments as they demonstrate their skills and reliability.

Beginning Your Career

Many freelance writers will tell you that copywriting is a challenging, competitive, and rewarding field. If you’re ready to embark on this exciting career, visit Crowd Content’s freelance writing jobs page to begin.

The post How to Find and Succeed With Freelance Copywriting Jobs appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/how-to-find-and-succeed-with-freelance-copywriting-jobs/feed/ 0
What Are the Key Benefits to Long-Form Content for SEO? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/is-long-form-content-the-way-to-go/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/is-long-form-content-the-way-to-go/#respond Thu, 10 Oct 2019 15:40:15 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25810 Most web marketers will tell you that these days, long-form content for SEO is king. Long gone are the days when agencies cranked out threadbare, 500-word posts crammed with keywords designed to increase their clients’ search engine rankings. Today, it’s all about information-rich, keyword-savvy copy that fully satisfies searcher intent. According to Orbit Media’s 2021 […]

The post What Are the Key Benefits to Long-Form Content for SEO? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Most web marketers will tell you that these days, long-form content for SEO is king. Long gone are the days when agencies cranked out threadbare, 500-word posts crammed with keywords designed to increase their clients’ search engine rankings. Today, it’s all about information-rich, keyword-savvy copy that fully satisfies searcher intent.

According to Orbit Media’s 2021 study on blogging, post lengths have been climbing year-over-year. Today’s posts average 1,151 words compared to 800 words in 2014, a word count increase of 42%. Perhaps more telling is that 50% of bloggers writing long-form content report strong results for their efforts.

ALSO – Find skilled content writers to craft long-form content for your website

But is it best to use long-form content for SEO? While you should never write fluff to meet an arbitrary word-count goal, long-form content may make the most sense for digital marketing campaigns. Keep reading to learn more about long-form content and why it can be a true value-add for your website or blog.

22

What Is Long-Form Content?

Before you can understand the pros and cons of content length, it’s important to define what we mean by long-form content. While there isn’t a universally recognized number of words that characterize long-form content, according to Forbes, experts generally agree that the low end of word count lies somewhere between 1,200 and 2,000 words.

Tony DeGennaro, Director of Marketing for Dragon Social Limited, offers a different perspective on defining long-form content. He believes it’s more about providing an in-depth look at the covered topic and less about word count. DeGennaro explains that at Dragon Social, “We aim to answer nearly every question a potential reader could have in that one piece of content. It’s due to this we don’t really have an optimal content length. We write as much as necessary to achieve this goal.”

By this definition, you can distinguish long-form as content designed to comprehensively cover a topic, including semantically related subjects. Exploring these logical ‘next steps’ connected to the main topic can ensure the piece’s completeness, even promoting a higher search engine ranking.

Casey Hill of Bonjoro defines long-form content by a different measure: dwell time. Essentially, dwell time considers how long a viewer spends consuming web page content returned by a search query before clicking back to the results page.

Although Bonjoro generally classifies anything over 1,500 words as long-form, Hill, the company’s growth manager, notes, “The more important factor than length, however, is ‘dwell time’ and here we want to shoot for 120 seconds or greater.”

23

Long-Form Content Types

Regardless of actual length, long-form content can take several different shapes, including:

  • White papers. These authoritative reports are meant to inform a brand’s audience about a particular topic or issue.
  • Case studies. Used to analyze a principle or subject, case studies detail the development of a particular individual, business or unique situation.
  • Long blog posts: Often informal, blog posts generally explore a topic related to the overarching subject of the blog.
  • Guides. As instructional material, guides are meant to inform and direct the reader along a particular path.
  • Essay-style listicles. These trendy articles take the form of lists and can be considered long-form or short-form content, depending on the approach. Long-form listicles generally include brief essays on each item.

Why Opt for Long-Form Content?

While there may be no hard and fast rule governing the word count of long-form content, online marketers know these meaty articles can be a real value-add for businesses, bloggers and websites.

The benefits of long-form content include:

1. Better Search Engine Rankings

The numbers don’t lie — long-form content ranks well. In fact, Bonjoro’s Casey Hill points out that in 2019, Google’s algorithms adapted to prioritize long-form content. Hill notes, “For many organizations, well-formatted long-form content began to see a 5-10% placement prioritization for SEO versus comparable short-form content on the same blogs.”

One reason for this bump in performance is that well-crafted longer pieces may utilize more long-tail keywords, which are multi-word keyword phrases that hit on your site whenever someone searches for those exact phrases. These long-tail keyword match-ups also let search engines know that your content is high-quality and on target for your topic.

In addition, most long-form content pays attention to semantic completeness, addressing, if only briefly, related topics that give the audience a full picture of the topic at hand. This effort to create comprehensive content is often rewarded by search engines designed to rank these longer, comprehensive articles higher than content of lesser quality.

24

2. Longer Visitor Engagement

If you post information-rich content that’s worth reading, chances are good that visitors to your site will linger longer and come back more often. This is particularly important when readers reach your site through Google search results because the time spent on your page essentially tells Google that you’ve given searchers what they were looking for, letting Google adjust search rankings for future searches.

3. Improved Conversion

Forbes notes that companies, such as Crazy Egg, were able to improve their conversion rates significantly by using long-form content. In the case of Crazy Egg, conversion rates increased by more than 30%.

4. Establishing Your Site as an Authority

By providing high-quality long-form content on your blog or website, you bring credibility to your brand. Eventually, this credibility establishes your site or brand as an authority in your industry or subject matter, which can ultimately lead to better name recognition and more online sales.

5. More Social Media Shares

According to Search Engine Land, long-form has historically outperformed short-form content when it comes to social media shareability. According to a study conducted by Quick Sprout, posts greater than 1,500 words receive significantly more social shares and likes than shorter posts. The upshot of enhanced social media engagement is new readers and site growth.

ALSO – Social Media: How Does it Impact Your SEO in 2019?

6. More Backlinks

Another benefit of longer content is a higher percentage of backlinks, which can provide more organic traffic. To encourage backlinking, your content should entice link creators to view it as valuable enough to link to or even to use as background information for their own articles.

Since shorter content, by its nature, provides less information, it’s often considered less valuable, resulting in few, if any, backlinks. Content that takes a deep dive into its subject matter is almost guaranteed to generate more backlinks, which in turn contribute to better search engine rankings.

Tips for Creating Long-Form Content

While the benefits of long-form content are undeniable, it’s important not to lose focus on quality. Keyword stuffing and other black-hat SEO tactics have no place in modern content and can actually harm your search rankings. 

There are several ways you can ensure that readers make it all the way through even your longest pieces:

Be Informative

According to Audrey Strasenburgh, SEO Strategist at FreeLogoServices, it’s important to be informative when creating long-form content. “Your users are probably looking for advice, examples, a How-To, or a history lesson of some degree,” she explains. “Always look to answer the What, Where, Why, and How questions of your industry — and never hesitate to cover a topic that hasn’t been covered before.”

Be Thorough

Jerryll Noordern, a real estate investor and digital marketer with SEO Real Estate Investors, believes that content marketers should worry less about content length and concentrate more on pleasing their audience. Rather than aiming for a specific word count, Noordern suggests trying to produce an article that includes all the information your audience needs. He advises, “Cut the fluff. Make it as short or as long as it needs to be.”

One thing to consider in an effort to be thorough is semantic completeness. To cover a topic thoroughly, a writer should consider related subjects. Even touching on these connections as a sidebar can go a long way toward creating the most comprehensive piece of content possible.

Keep It Readable

Another suggestion from Strasenburgh is to check your content’s readability score. She suggests that an 8th-grade level is ideal. The Flesch-Kincaid Readability Test can help determine the grade level and reading ease of your content by generating a score. The higher the score, the lower the complexity of the article. According to the site, most business writing should aim for a score of around 65.

There are several additional tools available to check your readability score and help you benchmark against similar content generated by your competitors, including Yoast SEO and SEMrush’s online writing assistant.

To keep your material readable, you should follow a few basic rules:

  • Keep paragraphs short.
  • Limit long sentences.
  • Avoid words that have too many syllables.
  • Minimize the use of industry jargon.

Include Actionable Tips

Readers like takeaways, particularly when they include easily executable steps designed to generate results. Bulleted lists with action items for users give your audience a road map to guide them toward what to do next.

Stay Evergreen

Don’t limit the shelf life of your post, if you can help it. Whenever possible, avoid language that dates an article, and write about topics that are evergreen to ensure the longevity of your content and keep visitors coming back.

Formatting Is Critical

Casey Hill of Bonjorno notes that in long-form content, formatting is particularly critical. “Have clear headings, anchor links to different sections when possible and make it easy to navigate,” Hill suggests, “A wall of poorly laid out text with high keyword concentrations is not a guarantee for good rank and certainly not something that will hold a reader’s attention.”

A well-organized table of contents can be especially helpful in constructing long articles, giving your audience an at-a-glance view of what’s included in your text. Smart use of visual elements, such as text boxes, diagrams, featured images, PDF downloads and white space, can also make an article less overwhelming to readers.

Audrey Strasenburgh also suggests using title tags to break down subsets of ideas and incorporating bullet points or numbered lists to keep information more digestible. “Don’t forget images!” she says. “Images that accurately describe the content will keep users scrolling down the page.”

If words are the bread of your long-form content, formatting is the butter that makes it go down smoothly. Savvy formatting can keep visitors on the site longer, which is vital to optimizing for Google’s RankBrain and increasing your search ranking.

Avoid Fluff and Filler

Kyle Douglas, the SEO Manager of Revium, believes that there is such a thing as too many words. As he explains, “Overdoing content can increase bounce rates just as much as content that is too short. If I’m trying to find a ‘plumber near me,’ I want the contact details and information on their services. Not a 2,000-word article on their plumbing history and capabilities.”

A good rule of thumb is to never use fluff or filler to pad content simply to increase your word count.

Managing Long-Form Content

If you think your website or blog would benefit from the addition of long-form content, there are tools that can make the process of content creation and management less cumbersome. Here are a few resources to help optimize longer articles:

Content Optimization Tools

There are several tools available to promote content optimization. SEMrush offers a template to help content creators craft and optimize SEO-friendly articles. This tool lets you compare your content to pages holding the top ranks for your primary keyword(s). A second option, MarketMuse’s creative brief tool, lets you streamline the process of content creation, illuminating opportunities and gaps in your content.

Proofreading-vs.-Editing-Blog-Graphics-1

Keyword Research Tools

Whether you’re writing long or short content, keywords are essential. Keywords are determined, in large part, by the terms that searchers type into search engines, and finding the right target keyword can set the tone for your whole article. Although it’s no longer essential to match keywords exactly to potential search terms, matching the searcher’s intent is vital.

Finding the right keywords can be daunting, but there are tools available to help. Whether it’s finding out what keywords your competitors are using or discovering semantically related keywords, the right tool can take you far. Some tools to start with are:

ALSO – Qualitative Keyword Research: How to Invest 10 Minutes into Your Content Marketing Process & See Your Content Rise to the Top of Google

Google’s Webmaster Tools

What better way is there to understand search engine rankings than the search engine leader itself? Google’s Webmaster Guidelines help content creators better understand Google’s search algorithms and how the search engine views websites.

You can find out more about how these guidelines can help webmasters and marketers navigate the sometimes-challenging ins and outs of Google in our recent post.

How Long Is Too Long?

There may be such a thing as too long, however. According to Mark Webster, the co-founder of Authority Hacker, an industry-leading online marketing education company, the optimal length for long-form content may be lower than you think. Authority Hacker recently performed a study on the topic, looking at various ranking factors for over 1 million SERP results, including content length. What they found was surprising.

Webster says, “We previously believed long-form content was king. We would invest thousands of dollars into huge 8,000-word guides assuming it must be good, right? However, upon analyzing the top #1 positions in Google, the optimal number was much lower — in fact, the average word count of the top one to three SERP results are just 1,500-2,000 words.”

In light of its study, Authority Hacker began to divide its longer posts into shorter chunks. Webster notes, “Both user feedback and rankings have shown us that this style is much more favorable than ultra long-form content and we will certainly continue to pursue this style in the future!”

So what does all this mean when you’re trying to decide on content length? Ultimately, what it all comes down to is outdoing your content competitors, rather than shooting for an arbitrary number.

ALSO – How to Determine Optimal Content Lengths

The Long and Short of It

Long-form content may indeed be king, but there are benefits to short-form posts as well. Ultimately, an engaging mix of longer and shorter pieces may be the best way to keep visitors coming back to your site.

26

ALSO – Are Short Blog Posts Worth It in a Long-Form World? Visit Crowd Content to learn how we can help your website gain traffic and increase conversions through targeted, professional long-form content.

The post What Are the Key Benefits to Long-Form Content for SEO? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/is-long-form-content-the-way-to-go/feed/ 0
7 Tips for How to Write SEO Content https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/7-tips-for-how-to-write-seo-content/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/7-tips-for-how-to-write-seo-content/#respond Thu, 03 Oct 2019 17:31:07 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25741 The early days of SEO might be called the Wild West days of SEO. The fastest guns might have ruled the towns of the old west, but the fastest and most prolific keyword stuffers ruled digital marketing once upon a time. But those days are gone, and while there’s no new sheriff in town, Google […]

The post 7 Tips for How to Write SEO Content appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

The early days of SEO might be called the Wild West days of SEO. The fastest guns might have ruled the towns of the old west, but the fastest and most prolific keyword stuffers ruled digital marketing once upon a time.

But those days are gone, and while there’s no new sheriff in town, Google has increasingly adopted the white hat approach to SEO and ranking. And other search engines have followed suit. Today, they reward high-quality SEO content. More importantly, readers demand valuable, engaging content.

Check out these seven tips from SEO experts on how to create engaging content that boosts your placement in SERPs.

1. Do Your Research: On Keywords and Searcher Intent

Always begin with keyword research. John Matyasovsky is a content marketer for Roofing Webmasters and says, “Start by finding a keyword people are searching for. You can use tools like MOZ Keyword Explorer, SEMRush, or AHRefs to analyze the volume, competition and opportunity. Once you have a keyword that fits your topic, you can then research semantic terms on LSIGraph. These are words to include within the content of the post rather than just using the target keyword over and over.”

Target, or primary keywords: The main search term you’re targeting with your content.

Secondary keywords: Search terms you’re also targeting, but they aren’t as high priority within your content as the primary phrase.

Semantic keywords: Related terms or keyword synonyms that can boost your performance in the search engines and may be able to fit into your content organically. Semantic keywords help boost SEO while supporting engagement, because no one wants to read 1,000 words that include the primary keyword repeated 10, 20 or 50 times. That’s keyword stuffing — no one, including Google, appreciates it.

3 Types of SEO Keywords

It’s not enough to know what keywords are performing right now. You have to understand why, because that lets you uncover searcher intent. If you don’t know why someone is searching for a term, you can’t create content that appropriately serves and converts them.

Consider the keyword term “softball bat.” Searcher intent could be to find a bat to purchase (softball bats for sale), but other possible intents include researching bats for future needs (best softball bat for), finding out about a specific bat (fastpitch softball bat), getting tips on caring for a bat (how to clean a softball bat) or just wondering what a softball bat actually is (what is a softball bat). The content for each of these intents would be unique.

Chris Love, a web developer and SEO expert with more than 25 years in the business, says, “For us, a factor driving anything we produce is researching what is currently ranking, identifying why and [determining ] what they may be missing. Analyzing the top 5-20 results for a target keyword tells us what type of content to create. It could be a list, how to or general research article. But you always need to determine what problem the searcher is trying to solve and [whether you can] provide a great answer and make your presentation better than what is currently ranked.”

Love also says, “Make sure your content aligns with the search intent. This is where analyzing the structure of the top results pays dividends. Don’t waste time producing content that is not structured in a similar fashion as the pages you are trying to beat. There’s a reason you see all those ‘Top X Reasons Why Y’ type articles: consumers find those articles the most appropriate [for the intent of their searches].”

To Love’s point, it’s important to group keywords with similar intents so you can align the content of a page with them. The old days of creating a page for every keyword are long gone; content marketing needs to speak to a solution for specific intents, which means you need multiple pages.

ALSOQualitative Keyword Research: How to Invest 10 Minutes into Your Content Marketing Process & See Your Content Rise to the Top of Google

2. Aim for Semantic Completeness When It Comes to Content and Keywords

It’s not enough to catch a few of the keywords in your research and go from there. In addition to searcher intent, the best SEO concentrates on semantic completeness. Not only are you answering the user’s question on the matter, you’re also answering as many of the questions as possible without going overboard.

And that requires a comprehensive approach to keyword research. Joe Goldstein, Director of SEO and Operations for Contractor Calls, gives an in-depth explanation for how to go about finding all the potential keywords and intents you might want to address.

“Start by taking your keyword and simply checking out the other search results. Literally just go through everything on the first page of results and take down notes about which kinds of supporting sections, talking points or supplemental content can be found on each page. Then, check the autocomplete options at the top of the search and the ‘searches related to’ section at the bottom. These searches and keywords are all relevant to your target keyword, since Google bothered to put them anywhere near the search results. So use them liberally in your content.

Next, I usually head over to SEObility’s free TF*IDF tool. This tool takes any target keyword and breaks down the on-page supporting keywords for top search results. What’s even better is that it shows the average usage per result as well as the max number of users among any of those results, which can help you spot outliers and branded terms.

While some experts insist that all TF-IDF tools are useless because Google uses a more sophisticated form of document modeling in its search algorithm, it’s important to realize that one of TF-IDF’s big limitations is that it simply ignores semantics while returning correlation. When you search for “buy cheap pumas” using that tool, you might see keywords like “cats” and “jungle” in the mix if that kind of content has snuck into the search results. Since Google’s actual document modeling is based on entity analysis (it can tell the difference between a cat and a shoe based on context), just ignore the keywords that are irrelevant to your version of the target keywords.

Re-seeding those underrepresented supporting keywords into your content is one of the best ways to quickly move up the rankings for your target keyword while also casting a larger net for related searches. You can also repeat the process with those related searches — such as “buy pumas online free shipping” — to uncover a larger set of relevant supporting keywords.”

Luke, an SEO Manager at Adzooma, points out a statistic that brings the need for this type of semantic completeness into focus. “According to Ahrefs,” he says, “The average number of keywords in top 20 pages also rank for over 200 other keywords. Using LSI terms and synonyms can help and avoid keyword stuffing.”

But it’s important to remember that the game isn’t to stuff as many keywords in as possible. You should be writing content that naturally employs these terms as you explain them or use them in relation to the topic at hand. Tools such as LSIGraph and Marketmuse can help you discover what these keywords might be.

3. Aim for the Featured Snippet

The featured snippet — or Google Answer box — is becoming an increasingly hotter topic in SEO circles, with more brands chasing this prime real estate on SERPs. According to Ahrefs, around 12% of searches trigger a featured snippet, and that number is growing.

While the answer box isn’t stealing all the thunder from other organic search results (such as the top spot, which still gets the most clicks), it does serve a very valuable branding purpose. The featured snippet gets a bit more than 9% of the clicks on average — but not all searches result in clicks. Sometimes, the featured snippet answers the question or intent of the search and the user is done, which means the page that landed that powerful spot earned a boost when it comes to future recognition or brand awareness.

Love provides these tips for those chasing the Google answer box.

  • Find ways to make your content better than the existing snippet answer.
  • Make your featured snippet content prominent on your page by:
    • Placing it right after the keyword question.
    • Highlighting it with a block quote, list, table or better styling.
    • Include an image or photo to support your snippet content. “Diagrams can be a great choice here, says Love, as “search engines are looking for imagery to quickly explain a concept.”

ALSOExpert Checklist: SEO for Blog Posts

4. Create Quality Content

Michelle Levine is an SEO Manager for Vistaprint. She says, “The most important tactic for writing high-performing SEO content will always be writing outstanding content. The more people that find your content useful, the higher that content will rank.”

Michelle Levine Vistaprint Quote

Quality content is:

  • Well written. Consider working with qualified and proven SEO freelance writers or our expert enterprise team to create high-quality SEO content that drives results.
  • Grammatical and clear. There’s a reason we offer clients the ability to add editing steps to their orders. While the average person won’t necessarily care about a minor grammar faux pas, the misplacement of a comma or the wrong version of a word can actually change the entire meaning of your message.
  • The right length. Find out how to choose the right word count for your topic.
  • Highly relevant to the audience. Don’t just ask yourself what you have to say on this topic. Ask what your audience wants to hear.

5. Use Tactics that Spawn Engagement

It’s not enough to score a high rank in the search engines and draw people into your site. Once they’re on-page, you must be able to engage them. Behavioral metrics, such as time visitors spend on page, how often they click to read more of your content and bounce rates all factor into your future placement in SERPs.

Zach Hendrix, Co-Founder of GreenPal, says, “If average time spent on [your] site is 3 or 4 minutes versus your competitor’s less than 1 minute, Google will reward your page by pushing [it] higher up in on search engine results pages.”

To this end, your content has to be more than high quality. It must be designed to engage the reader — whether that’s through the writing style, format or interactive options.

Hendrix recommends what he calls Bucket Brigades, which are small sections of content on the page that are designed to carry the reader through to the end. “With the bucket brigade tactic, you can keep your visitors on-page longer by breaking up the copy every two or three sentences with bolded or subhead phrases,” he says. The point is to “captivate your reader and psychologically drive them down the page [so they are] reading more of your copy and [staying] on your site longer.”

Hendrix recommends phrases such as:

  • Here’s the deal
  • Why does this matter?
  • What’s the catch?
  • How can this help you?
  • The best part

You can also use tools to drive engagement such as Click to Tweet or social share buttons, which naturally encourage users to get involved with your content and even share it with others.

6. Incorporate Visuals or Think Visually as You Create Content

Alice Gerwat is the Content Editor and Social Media Manager at Magic Freebies. She says that visual content is no longer an option for brands investing in content marketing and SEO efforts.

“When writing content with SEO in mind,” she says, “It’s essential to include images to complement your written words, as we are living in a visual age. A study by Jakob Nielsen back in 1997 revealed that internet users never even read — they scan. This means your audience picks out information in bite-sized chunks, using visual markers on the page [to do so]. Images are as important visual markers as bullet points, H1s and H2s, as they help guide the reader to get the most value out of what they’re reading as quickly as possible. It’s also worth making the alt tags for your images as descriptive as possible so search engines can interpret your image as relevant to your written content.”

Remember that image SEO is almost as important as text SEO. Google Images is the #2 search engine for a reason — pictures are still worth a thousand words and many users still default to visual searches to find what they need quickly.

Content Marketing Visuals

Other ways you can optimize the scannability of your page while improving SEO?

  • Incorporate diagrams and infographics that summarize the content or answer
  • Embed videos and multimedia
  • Design content with visual scanning in mind, telling a story with the help of headers, bullet points, bold and italics, and other formatting tools

7. Learn How to Write SEO Content for the Big Picture

Finally, remember that one blog post, landing page or product description does not make an online marketing strategy or SEO plan. Every piece you write should fit into the big picture of your overall SEO plan. That means choosing content topics that support each other and your overall message and linking between them.

Topic clusters are critical here, because they help draw people further into your pages, increasing behavioral metrics and driving someone closer to the conversion. Plus, they help position your brand as a true authority. For example, if you’re a personal finance brand, it’s no longer enough to write a stellar blog post about saving money. Instead, you should create an entire topic cluster of posts on the topic to serve various searcher intent and entice consumers in different stages of the funnel. For example:

  • A general post about saving money attracts people at the top of the funnel who are just looking into this topic. You might make this a pillar post with links to more in-depth content on a variety of topics, such as getting out of debt, saving at the grocery store or putting money away for a big purchase or retirement
  • A more specific landing page or post might draw attention specifically to your workshop on personal budgeting for success with a specific financial goal. This type of content is still part of the overall cluster, but it’s geared more toward people further down the funnel who are ready to make a decision or purchase.

It’s critical to link all these things together in logical ways that help the buyer discover you via organic search and then stick with you through the rest of the journey. Luke says, “Make sure to have at least 3-4 internal links… linking to relevant pages you want to rank higher is good for SEO as it helps when Google crawls your site and reduces crawl depth per page.”

ALSOCrash Course: How to Become an SEO Content Writer
ALSOWhat Can You Learn to Help Future-Proof Your Content for Algorithm Updates

Make a Plan, Check Your Plan and Tweak Your Plan

Good SEO is not something you’re going to stumble upon one day and then never have to worry about again. It’s a constantly evolving online marketing discipline. Start today by making a plan following some of the tips above. Put it into action writing SEO content that engages. Then, check your metrics, analyze the results and make small changes to try to improve them. Search engines are always making tiny tweaks to their algorithms, so you have to do the same with your content.

The post 7 Tips for How to Write SEO Content appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/7-tips-for-how-to-write-seo-content/feed/ 0
Ghostwriting Jobs 101: How They Work, Where to Find Them and How to Thrive https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/resource-center/ghostwriting-jobs-101-how-they-work-where-to-find-them-and-how-to-thrive/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/resource-center/ghostwriting-jobs-101-how-they-work-where-to-find-them-and-how-to-thrive/#respond Wed, 25 Sep 2019 14:37:57 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25675 If you’ve seen celebrity tell-alls on the shelves at your local bookstore, you’ve probably seen the results of ghostwriting jobs firsthand. In fact, according to Joe Queenan’s essay, which was published by The New York Times, public figures such as Nancy Reagan, Charles Barkley, Lee Iacocca, and the Mayflower Madam have all hired professional ghostwriters to […]

The post Ghostwriting Jobs 101: How They Work, Where to Find Them and How to Thrive appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

If you’ve seen celebrity tell-alls on the shelves at your local bookstore, you’ve probably seen the results of ghostwriting jobs firsthand. In fact, according to Joe Queenan’s essay, which was published by The New York Times, public figures such as Nancy Reagan, Charles Barkley, Lee Iacocca, and the Mayflower Madam have all hired professional ghostwriters to pen their memoirs and autobiographies. Some of their books even became bestsellers.

But the purview of a skilled ghostwriter isn’t limited to life as an A-lister’s assistant. Freelance writers also lend their talents to all kinds of web content, novels, marketing copy, and even social media posts — they’re tasked with creating content someone else will officially take credit for.

If life as the wizard behind the words sounds enticing, this could be the career for you. Here’s everything you need to know about finding ghostwriting jobs and turning your creative writing abilities into professional opportunities that could change your life for good.

What Is a Ghostwriter?

Everyone has a story to tell, but not everyone has the tools to tell their story effectively. Even those who are equipped may not have the time or inclination to put words to paper. That’s where a ghostwriter comes in.

Ghostwriters are professional writers who craft material for others, taking a client’s vision, story, or idea and creating a polished, publication-quality product that the client can attach their name to and call their own. These writers for hire are generally invisible to readers — hence the spook-inspired moniker — and write for financial gain rather than a byline.

Our post, What Is a Ghostwriter Best Able to Help With? takes a deeper dive into the world of ghostwriting and how it can benefit your clients. But before you take that leap, here’s a look at the essentials.

Is Ghostwriting Just for Books?

While many writers picture juicy celebrity confessions when thinking about ghostwritten material, Britney Spears and Prince Harry aren’t the only people who hire ghostwriters. Ghostwriting jobs come in many forms, ranging from tasks requiring full-length fiction to orders for social media snippets. In addition to traditional “as-told-to” memoirs and autobiographies, some examples of ghostwriting services include:

  • Nonfiction books: Ghostwriters often assist experts who are knowledgeable and respected in their field but might not be skilled writers.
  • Novels: Ghostwriters might oversee books that are part of a series or continue the work of prominent authors who have passed away — Carolyn Keene, “author” of the Nancy Drew mysteries, wasn’t an actual person but a whole team of ghostwriters!
  • Articles: It’s not uncommon for a prominent business person, such as the CEO of a company, to hire a ghostwriter to pen an article that will eventually be published in a newspaper or magazine.
  • Blog posts: Brands rely on ghostwriters to keep up with the high volume of content needed to populate a company blog.
  • Website content: About Us pages, landing pages, and general copy might sound like they come from the company, but they’re usually written by a ghostwriter.
  • Newsletters and emails: Letter from the owner? Maybe, but it’s more likely a letter created by a ghostwriter and approved by the owner.
  • Social media posts: Ghostwriters are often the voices behind those pithy posts you see on platforms such as Facebook, X, and LinkedIn.
  • Speeches and video scripts: Sometimes, ghostwriters put words into people’s mouths by generating scripts for speeches, promo videos, webinars, and other presentations.
  • Song lyrics, short stories, and other types of creative writing: If you have a flare for the fantastic, you may find work as a ghostwriter who specializes in creative content that’s less about marketing and more about storytelling.

What Does a Ghostwriting Job Involve?

The nuts and bolts of each ghostwriting job can differ depending on the project and the client. Your instructions could include:

  • Rewriting: Sometimes, ghostwriters rework preexisting content rather than writing content from scratch. The goal could be to improve the quality of an earlier draft or alter the perspective of the piece to better speak to a new audience. There might also be a need for updated search engine optimization — this is especially true with web pages or marketing copy designed to help a site rank.
  • Expanding: Sometimes, a client needs help turning a rough draft or even a pile of scribbled notes into publish-ready content. This happens most often with specialty content in a fact-driven niche, such as fintech or health care. Your job is to transform disjointed ideas and statistics into a well-written piece that maintains the integrity and accuracy of the original information.
  • Writing from a general topic, idea, or title: The most common type of ghostwriting job involves the client giving you a general subject or title and asking you to create new content from the ground up. You’ll probably be given a content brief that includes an overview of the appropriate style, word count, target audience, and crucial points to touch on. The rest is up to you.

ALSOHow to Get a Ghostwriter to Craft an Ebook That Drives Results
ALSOGhostwriters – the Secret to Maximizing Your In-House Content Team

What Qualifications Does a Ghostwriter Need?

Part of learning how to get ghostwriting jobs is ensuring you have everything you need to catch a potential client’s eye. Freelance writers who want to pursue a career in ghostwriting can benefit from meeting basic educational requirements, such as a bachelor’s degree in English, communications, journalism, or a related field.

That said, many clients consider hands-on experience in lieu of a degree, meaning talented ghostwriters can still enjoy a fruitful career, even if they don’t have a college diploma hanging on the wall of their home office.

What Skills Make a Good Ghostwriter?

While the skills required to ghostwrite a novel may differ significantly from those required to write clever advertising copy, there are some basic skills that are almost universal.

  • Expert-level writing skills: First and foremost, ghostwriting is about words, and ghostwriters should be able to deliver polished prose. All content submitted should be clean and require minimal editing.
  • Flexibility and adaptability: While many writers have their own recognizable style, ghostwriters need to effectively capture the voice of their clients so the writing feels on target to the listed author or brand.
  • Ability to follow directions: Clients may have specific dos and don’ts for projects, and a good ghostwriter should be capable of adhering to any guidelines presented.
  • Research competence: While many clients will provide information and resources, ghostwriter will sometimes need to embark on research of their own. A good ghostwriter understands how to source and cite appropriate material and fit it seamlessly into the content they’re writing.
  • Focus and discernment: While clients are responsible for coming up with the basic skeleton of an idea, a good ghostwriter should be able to finesse, refine, and nurture that idea into something truly compelling.

Circle chart listing skills of a good ghostwriter

How Can You Build Your Reputation as a Ghostwriter?

There are several smart ways you can build your reputation as a writer and demonstrate to potential clients you’re the right person for the job.

  • Create your own blog, or offer your services as a guest blogger in your area(s) of expertise: Whether it’s fiction or nuclear physics, blogging is an excellent way to make a name for yourself in your niche and show the world your writing chops. This approach also showcases your authority in a given niche and can attract clients looking for writers who can double as subject matter experts.
  • Set up a digital portfolio: Several sites, such as Clippings.me and Journo Portfolio, offer free or low-cost online portfolios for writers. These sites let you easily share your clippings with potential clients in a polished, professional manner.
  • Reach out to local businesses: Network with other SMBs, particularly nonprofits or those you have personal connections to, and offer your services at discounted rates in exchange for the right to use the finished content in your portfolio. Bonus points if they agree to a written testimonial you can use on your website.
  • Join an association: Joining a professional association, such as the Association of Ghostwriters, can provide you with vital resources, opportunities for networking and learning, and even job leads. Many professional organizations offer lower-cost associate memberships that include benefits geared toward newer writers.

How to Find Ghostwriting Jobs

Are you revved up about a future in ghostwriting yet? If you’re itching to make a career switch or change up the types of writing projects you’re tackling, a lot hinges on finding ghostwriting jobs. 

  1. Freelance job boards: If you’re ready to dive into your first assignment or just want to check out what’s available, you can find listings for ghostwriting jobs on some of the Internet’s many freelance job boards. Sites such as Freelancer generally offer search functionality and filters, making it easier to find the positions you’re looking for.
  2. Advertise your services: Sites such as Fiverr let freelance writers post small advertisements with services offered. While these small-scale ghostwriting jobs may not be enough to pay your bills, they give you opportunities to test the waters and make vital connections.
  3. Classified sites: Sites such as Craigslist, especially in bigger cities, often have postings in the Writing Gigs section from companies looking to hire ghostwriters. Be careful — no one verifies clients on these sites, and scammers are plentiful.
  4. Cold outreach: Most companies with robust digital marketing programs need a lot of content, so it follows suit that they need a good team of writers. Cold emailing the director of marketing or someone in a senior content position could net you an ongoing gig. This approach is especially effective if you’ve positioned yourself as an expert in a given niche and approach companies in that space.
  5. Crowd Content: Crowd Content’s unique platform offers writers a place to find work based on a quality star rating. One distinguishing feature of Crowd Content is that it provides ample opportunity for talented, reliable writers to demonstrate their ability and move up in the ranks, accessing higher-paying jobs. The platform vets both writers and clients before jobs are posted — there’s no chance you’ll be stiffed on pay or have to chase down a client to get work approved.

ALSO9 Benefits of Freelance Writing as Told By Top Content Writers

Applying to Be a Ghostwriter

If you plan to work as a ghostwriter through a freelancing platform, you’ll have to go through an application and approval process before you can access actual ghostwriting jobs. At Crowd Content, the sign-up process for freelancers starts when you create a dedicated account. Then, you’ll be asked to share some basic information, including your name, geographic location, and general work experience.

Create Crowd Content account

The most important part of the application is the writing test. Follow the directions given to create a high-quality, task-specific sample that showcases your ability to:

  • Write well
  • Follow directions
  • Review content and refine as needed

If you’re approved, you’ll have access to work either through the Marketplace (jobs created and reviewed directly by clients) or Managed Services (high-volume projects run by Crowd Content’s experienced content managers). From there on out, every job counts! Only take on tasks you feel confident writing, and reach out to the client or the content manager if you have any questions.

Image showing access to the Marketplace app

How to Thrive as a Ghostwriter

You’ve applied for a ghostwriting job, and you’re hired! Now what? Sometimes, the hardest part of being a ghostwriter isn’t finding a gig but keeping it. These tips can help you find long-term success in a highly competitive field.

  • Deliver your best work every time: Time is money when it comes to freelancing, and it can be tempting to cut corners. But always remember someone will be publishing this project with their name attached. If you’re not 100% proud of what you’re submitting, the content isn’t ready to be submitted.
  • Meet every deadline: Deadlines aren’t suggestions. They’re commitments you make as a professional writer, and your ability to keep those commitments could make or break your reputation and your relationship with your clients. While there are valid reasons to miss a deadline such as medical emergencies, delays should be the exception, not the rule.
  • Communicate with the client: If you have a problem with meeting a deadline or something isn’t going as planned, make sure to let the client know as soon as possible. This is ultimately their project, and keeping a client in the loop can keep the process running smoothly for all involved.
  • Ask questions: If something about the job isn’t clear or doesn’t make sense, ask for clarification. Most clients are more than happy to provide additional guidance to ensure they receive the quality writing and focused content they’re paying for.
  • Be professional: This is a business relationship, and it’s important to treat it as such. Be polite, and always treat clients with respect.

ALSO10 Things to Know Before You Start Writing

Are Ghostwriting Jobs Right for You?

While writing without a byline may be a turnoff for many writers, it can be a lucrative career choice for others. It can also be immensely rewarding to be the driving force in helping people get their stories out into the world. If you’re interested in pursuing a career in ghostwriting, visit Crowd Content’s freelance writing job page, and take the first step toward success.

The post Ghostwriting Jobs 101: How They Work, Where to Find Them and How to Thrive appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/resource-center/ghostwriting-jobs-101-how-they-work-where-to-find-them-and-how-to-thrive/feed/ 0
Tips for Getting Amazing Results with Content Outsourcing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/outsourcing-content-writing-tips-for-finding-and-working-with-writers-for-excellent-content-marketing-results/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/outsourcing-content-writing-tips-for-finding-and-working-with-writers-for-excellent-content-marketing-results/#respond Thu, 19 Sep 2019 14:41:11 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25435 Producing great content is a necessary part of digital marketing, but staying competitive takes a lot of work. Here’s how outsourcing can help. Content marketing is constantly evolving, and it’s not going away. It’s now one of the pillars of a business’s overall digital marketing efforts. If you want to be found online, you need […]

The post Tips for Getting Amazing Results with Content Outsourcing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Producing great content is a necessary part of digital marketing, but staying competitive takes a lot of work. Here’s how outsourcing can help.

Content marketing is constantly evolving, and it’s not going away. It’s now one of the pillars of a business’s overall digital marketing efforts. If you want to be found online, you need engaging, thoughtful content — and lots of it.

Yet even businesses with in-house marketing teams often don’t have the resources to produce the high volume of quality content required for good results. With SEO, link building and social media marketing all on the list, marketers already have their hands full.

With so much riding on producing quality content on a consistent schedule, what are businesses to do? Outsourcing your content writing might be the solution.

A Closer Look at Content Outsourcing

If you want to have any chance at competing with the big businesses and their monster marketing budgets, your content strategy needs a never-ending supply of top-notch content. Even for a small business, producing the quality and quantity of content Google expects is a full-time job for any one person. If you’re a small business owner handling everything yourself, your hands are pretty much tied.

Even for larger businesses with in-house marketing teams, the budget required to rival the content output of the competition might be too constraining. Or maybe your team’s efforts aren’t getting the results you need to rank well enough on Google. After all, not every marketer is a proficient content writer. Creating content that generates leads is the biggest challenge for over half of all marketers.

In these instances, you need a helping hand. Content outsourcing is essentially hiring a skilled freelancer or a trusted team outside your business to help produce high-quality content at scale. It’s a flexible, cost-effective method of creating blog posts, white papers, articles and every other kind of written content. By outsourcing your writing work, you’re free to focus on the bigger picture, such as refining your overall marketing strategy and growing your business.

There are a few different methods of outsourcing your content writing. Most businesses go with one of the following:

  • Hiring a freelancer to write your content
  • Partnering with a content writing service, such as Crowd Content
  • Partnering with an agency that specializes in content production

There are, of course, pros and cons to each of these. A freelance writer may not be able to deliver the results you need. An agency may be too cost-prohibitive for those results. And you may be altogether skeptical of a content writing service.

We’ll get into the details of choosing the right partner, but first, let’s look at the many benefits that content outsourcing provides.

The Many Benefits of Content Outsourcing

Content outsourcing is highly effective. The benefits seem almost too good to be true, from improved flexibility, volume, and quality in your content strategy to lower cost. But there’s a reason that 84% of all B2B marketers outsource their content creation.

Many reasons.

Questions to ask while hiring content writers

1. Improves Flexibility

Having a dedicated writer on your marketing team has its benefits. But given the rapid shifts in digital marketing, it can also be a disadvantage. You may need more or less content at any given time. Or you might need an entirely new type of content to stay competitive. It’s tough to adapt to evolving requirements with a single voice and perspective.

Outsourcing gives you the ability to adapt to these changes. You’re free to hire more writers when you need more content. You can peruse different writers when you need a shift in tone or perspective. And you can even experiment with new writers to try things that your competition may not have thought of yet.

The versatility of voice and the ability to scale up and down as needed means content outsourcing provides the flexibility necessary to stay competitive.

2. Gives You Time

Ernest Hemingway said, “Time is the least thing we have of.” He was no doubt familiar with how good extended writing took. Researching, drafting, editing and publishing content is time-consuming.

And while it may seem like writing your content is a cheaper option, you need to put a dollar value on the hours you spend doing it. Would your time be better spent on core business tasks? Probably so.

Outsourcing your content production gives you your time back. The best part is that when you choose the right partner, you get content at a much higher quality that’s still guided by your marketing vision.

3. Is Cost-Effective

In the U.S., the average salary of a content writer is $48,702. That’s not including all the added expenses, such as equipment, training and the rest of the overhead that comes with keeping a full-time employee. And as we talked about previously, this only gives you a single perspective for your content. Expensive and inflexible.

With content outsourcing, you’re only paying for the content you need. Whether it’s produced by a freelancer, a content writing service or an agency, you’re paying for content and content alone. No equipment, no holiday pay and no headaches. It’s an infinitely more affordable option.

4. Means More Volume

Even if your business has a full-time writer on staff, there’s a hard limit to how much quality content a single person can produce. Sure, you could have your writer churn out two or three low-quality blog posts every day, but this will do more harm than good for your content marketing strategy.

If you want a large volume of comprehensive articles and high-quality blog posts that engage your audience and convert leads, content outsourcing is the way to go. For consistency and fast turnaround, there’s no better way to scale your content marketing affordably.

5. Complements Your Team

Outsourced writers have often worked for several different clients. Because of this, their knowledge and experience are much broader. Additionally, these writers and content producers often have their fingers on the pulse of marketing and industry trends. All of this gives them the ability to come up with fresh new ideas to invigorate your content with.

These fresh perspectives and innovative ideas are complementary to your existing marketing team. Even for businesses with dedicated writers, it’s challenging to keep your wordsmiths enthused when they’re writing about the same thing day after day. Bringing in outside help ensures your content never loses its zeal.

Finding the Right Partner for Your Content

Despite the many benefits of content outsourcing, there are some challenges associated with outsourcing your content. Whether it’s a freelancer, a content writing service, a marketing agency, or even your in-house writer, overseeing your content’s production and ensuring it adheres to your overall content strategy takes a bit of work.

Some of the challenges with content outsourcing include:

  • Ensuring the content creator understands your vision of the blog post or other piece and is able to produce something that matches it
  • Protecting uniformity with a style guide and other measures, including editing, so your content has a consistent brand voice and doesn’t sound like it was written by a group of disparate writers
  • Integrating the outsourcing process within your existing content marketing strategy, which includes getting buy-in from the entire marketing team to ensure a streamlined workflow

The good news is that these challenges are easily overcome with diligence and some thoughtful planning. Whether you’re outsourcing Facebook posts, landing pages or highly researched articles, there are proven methods for building relationships with a partner that can get the job done.

What to include in a creative brief

Freelancers, Agencies and Content Writing Services

Success in outsourcing your content begins with the kind of outsourcer you choose to work with. And that boils down to your content marketing budget and what type of content you need in terms of volume and quality.

But when you’re perusing possible outsourcers, it’s essential to keep in mind that it’s not always cut and dried. There are great freelancers, agencies and writing services that can spin up your content production with little supervision and deliver results quickly. But there are content outsourcers that will do more harm than good, too.

Take freelance writers, for example. They can run the gamut in terms of quality and price. You might get lucky and find an affordable freelancer who produces sparkling blog posts that place your site at the top of Google search results. On the other hand, you might find someone who’s not so affordable, requires constant feedback and revisions and ends up producing poor content anyway.

Agencies are usually more consistent in terms of quality. In most cases, writers at agencies are guided by a creative director, so you may not need to do much guidance. And since these businesses are built to provide innovative services to other companies, they can almost certainly produce volume.

But leveraging an agency — even a boutique firm — often comes with a hefty price tag. For some businesses, the results are worth paying for. But for others, agencies are too cost-prohibitive.

When choosing a partner, keep these things in mind:

  • Ask the right questions: Understand what kind of content you need and why you need it. Then ask questions about how the outsourcer can help.
  • Vet their work: Read up on testimonials and case studies to make sure they can deliver on their promises.
  • Find out about their process: Ask questions about the processes they use to get successful results.

For many businesses, content writing services are a happy and effective middle ground. Some marketers are wary of these services, often buying into the myth that they sacrifice quality for convenience. Others believe these services exist to profit from high-volume, generic content written by poorly paid writers.

While these services do exist, it’s not a measure of content writing service out there. The fact of the matter is that you can leverage them for high-quality content at affordable prices.

Take what we do here at Crowd Content, for example. We operate a content writing service and incentivize our freelance partners to create high-quality content that produces results. We treat them well, pay fairly and take measures to ensure our clients are always happy with the completed work.

We also go the extra mile to help clients find writers who are ideal for their specific projects. Whether you search our robust workforce yourself with our self-serve options or work with our sales, customer service or project management teams to launch your campaign, you can find freelancers with a wide range of knowledge and experience.

Best Practices for Outsourcing Content Writing

Ultimately, if you want high-quality content, it’s not just about where you outsource your content creation. By understanding how best to partner with content writers and other freelancers, you can streamline communication and increase the chance of receiving a publish-ready piece of content that performs.

Here are some best practices for outsourcing your content and working with writers:

  • Provide detailed briefs: Whether you’re leaving things open to writer creativity or mandating where the keywords, headers and bullet points go, don’t leave your writer hanging with vague instructions.
  • Samples are one of the best tools you have: Briefs are invaluable, but samples can remove ambiguity and help writers home in on the tone you’re looking for.
  • Make sure writers know your audience: Be sure the writer knows who your target audience is. Include customer personas and style guides to help them understand your brand’s voice.
  • Writers are more than words on a page: While guidance is necessary, you can also better leverage a writer’s expertise and creativity by giving them ample space to create. Set guidelines for the type of content they need and let the writer do what they do best.
  • Foster a partnership over time: Writers who’ve written blog posts for you over the years often need less direction than those who aren’t as familiar with your brand. Putting the time in to educate and coach writers about what you want can pay off big in the end.

When to Outsource Your Content Writing

Outsourcing research, writing, editing, social media posts management and even video scripts goes a long way if you’ve just started a business and you’re building it from the ground up. In these early stages, leveraging an outsourcer for the time-consuming content production process allows you to focus on acquiring new clients and growing your business.

Outsourcing your content is also a good bet if you don’t see results with your existing strategies. Effective content marketing isn’t easy, and producing the content required is even more challenging. Taking a step back from the busy work and focusing your efforts on the marketing nuances will free you to refine your approach. Content marketing is much more effective with a visionary guiding a team of content producers.

Effective content marketing

Supercharge Your Content Strategy With Crowd Content

For anyone doing business online, an effective content strategy is necessary. But it takes some serious time and effort to produce great content for that strategy. Outsourcing the work is a winning strategy if your business doesn’t have the resources to create excellent content.

At Crowd Content, we have some of the best tools available to help you supercharge your content strategy. With thousands of talented writers to choose from and detailed order forms to craft effective briefs, our platform was built to help businesses like yours get effective content quickly and easily.

Sign up today to get started.

The post Tips for Getting Amazing Results with Content Outsourcing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/outsourcing-content-writing-tips-for-finding-and-working-with-writers-for-excellent-content-marketing-results/feed/ 0
Google’s Webmaster Guidelines: What Can You Learn to Help Future-Proof Your Content for Algorithm Updates https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/googles-webmaster-guidelines-what-can-you-learn-to-help-future-proof-your-content-for-algorithm-updates/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/googles-webmaster-guidelines-what-can-you-learn-to-help-future-proof-your-content-for-algorithm-updates/#respond Fri, 06 Sep 2019 14:08:12 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25573 Updates intended to improve the engine’s search results are implemented daily, although they’re often small enough to go unnoticed. Several times a year, however, Google makes more significant changes to its search algorithms and systems in its efforts to deliver relevant content in billions of daily searches.  Our post on Google’s June algorithm update dives […]

The post Google’s Webmaster Guidelines: What Can You Learn to Help Future-Proof Your Content for Algorithm Updates appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Updates intended to improve the engine’s search results are implemented daily, although they’re often small enough to go unnoticed. Several times a year, however, Google makes more significant changes to its search algorithms and systems in its efforts to deliver relevant content in billions of daily searches

Our post on Google’s June algorithm update dives deeper into one of the more recent changes.

These large-scale Google algorithm updates are known as core updates, and while they’re generally seamless to searchers, they can have major consequences for website search rankings. That’s why it’s so important for webmasters and marketers to understand these changes and what they mean for content creation. In fact, deciphering the principles behind these algorithm updates can not only help you course-correct to reverse associated drops in website traffic but may actually enable you to future-proof content in anticipation of upcoming core updates.

Google recently addressed its core updates, discussing how these changes impact website search rankings and providing insight into how the algorithm views content. If you’re looking for ways to improve your search rankings and adapt your website to meet Google’s standards, the key is content, content, content. And, if you’re an SEO content writer, knowing ow to write to satisfy these guidelines is critical.

Here’s what you need to know about Google’s core updates so you can future-proof your content against future algorithm changes.

The Benefits of a Google Algorithm Update

Every Google algorithm update is launched with one primary goal: to better assess the way the search engine evaluates websites in order to deliver relevant content that satisfies search intent to searchers. In practical terms, Google aims to reward quality, relevant content with higher search rankings.

While some webmasters view these changes with trepidation, Nachum Balofsky of 1SEO I.T. Support & Digital Marketing believes the algorithm updates can ultimately make the job of a content strategist easier. Balofsky, the company’s in-house SEO & Content Strategist, explains, “The smarter Google gets at figuring out your intentions, the more we as digital marketers can focus on things like UX and useful content.” Balofsky also postulates that as Google’s algorithms continue to increase in sophistication, web professionals can leverage Google’s understanding of language and topical themes to their advantage.

What that means for you is that as Google reassesses the way its search engine views content, you should reassess the content you’re providing, using the roadmap Google has conveniently laid out.

Reevaluating Website Content with the Google Algorithm in Mind

Periodically reevaluating your website content is always a good practice (freshness is a significant ranking factor), but it’s essential if you want to future-proof your content for Google’s algorithm updates. While Google has made it clear that quality and relevance top its list of what it looks for in a high-ranking website, you need to understand how Google defines quality and how you can apply that to content creation.

As Marcus Miller, head of SEO & Digital Marketing at the UK Agency Bowler Hat, explains, “Google is and pretty much always has been perfectly clear that quality content is that which helps the end-user achieve their goals.” Miller expresses the importance of reading Google’s various webmaster help pages, including its webmaster guidelines to get a real feel for what the search engine is shooting for.

In its recent post, Google shared a list of helpful questions to ask during a self-assessment of your content, but conducting a thorough evaluation boils down to several key points.

Embrace originality

Valuable content will likely include original information. While the topic may be familiar, your content shouldn’t be. Even if your page builds on preexisting information or data, it should offer a fresh take, a new perspective, or an insightful analysis of the subject.

Some great ways to create original content include:

  • Presenting existing data that may be buried in a more accessible way
  • Getting quotes and contributions from industry experts
  • Conduct your own primary research through questionnaires and surveys
  • Sharing your own company’s experience by sharing internal data or creating case studies

It’s also important to avoid mass-produced and distributed content, which may be repeated over and over on websites throughout the internet. Stick with high-quality, SEO-rich content that’s been created specifically for your site.

New to content writing? Check out Crash Course: How to Become an SEO Content Writer

Provide substance

Substantial, complete information is a must if you want to obtain a high spot on Google’s search results. Marcus Miller, who has worked in the SEO industry since 1999, says, “Given that Google now understands things rather than just simplistic text-based analysis then we can assume that Google understands what is important in a given area. So, to create high ranking content we have to look at first creating content that is comprehensive and is truly the best answer to a given question.”

To do this, consider using tools like SEMrush, MarketMuse, or LSIgraph to evaluate what topics are expected to be covered in your content to make it semantically complete. This is one major way that Google evaluates content completeness, so it’s important you get it right. 

Demonstrate expertise

It’s important to establish the authenticity of informational content in a way that makes a visitor confident in trusting it. If your site aims to be the authoritative source for a particular topic, establish that, and when possible, use content written by a topic expert or enthusiast.

Some of the key takeaways from Google’s move to favor E-A-T content include:

  • Adding detailed bios for your contributors that demonstrate their expertise
  • Making sure your about us page shows why your company is an expert in the space
  • Getting backlinks from other authority sites

Building expertise requires a sitewide effort, but it’s important that each individual post pulls its weight. 

Attribute what isn’t yours

It may go without saying, but if information or data is sourced from other sites, printed materials, or area experts, those sources should be clearly attributed. Links to an author’s bio or a website’s About page should always be provided if they’re available.

Presentation matters

Something that’s often overlooked in content creation is the power of presentation, but the reality is that poor presentation can impact how visitors perceive a site’s quality. Typos and grammatical errors can make a website appear unprofessional. You should never post sloppy work. And while ads can bring in necessary revenue to sustain a site, they should not be distracting or interfere with the readability of your main content.

Similarly, you’ll want to invest in a good user interface and making your content visually appealing. That can include creating custom graphics that highlight things from your content, adding infographics, and even adding video. 

All of these factors will influence your user interaction metrics like time on site and bounce rate. Google is believed to be looking at these factors through their RankBrain tool, so it’s important you ensure your performance is good.

Optimize for mobile

With more and more people viewing content on smartphones and tablets, it’s vital to optimize your content for mobile viewing. Since most sites have now been switched to mobile-first indexing, your mobile experience is really how Google evaluates your site’s content.

A few things you’ll want to keep in mind include:

  • Make sure your site is responsive and easy to use on mobile
  • Avoid having paragraphs that are too long to read on mobile
  • Add lists, FAQs, and how-to sections to break up longer content
  • Allow visitors to read the first section, and then expand to read your full content
  • Ensure all images are displayed properly on mobile

ALSO9 Things You Need To Do To Improve Content For Your Blog To Give a Better Mobile Experience

Venturing Beyond Content Assessment

Search results are relative, and while it’s important to assess your content based on its individual merit, it’s also helpful to view your site in relation to others that appear along with it in search results. Determining whether your page provides enough value to match or outweigh similar pages will go a long way toward understanding its place in search rankings.

Several tools exist that let you benchmark your content against the top-ranked pages for your keyword. These include SEMrush’s Content Template and MarketMuse’s creative brief tool. 

Getting a second opinion can also be valuable in your quest to future-proof for Google algorithm updates. A new set of eyes can provide a fresh, unbiased look at content that you may have combed over multiple times.

The E-A-T Perspective

Another way to understand Google’s algorithm and what it evaluates as it attempts to deliver relevant search results is to review Google’s quality rater guidelines. Quality raters are everyday folks who help the company assess how well its algorithm is performing by viewing the websites that result from a search and providing feedback about their quality. Understanding these guidelines can provide valuable insight into Google’s algorithm and how you can put it to use when developing content.

Google’s raters are trained to use the E-A-T perspective in evaluating websites. 

According to Chris Turner, the Digital Strategy Director for Golden Spiral Marketing, E-A-T — which stands for Expertise, Authoritativeness, and Trustworthiness — has likely become one of Google’s top considerations for page quality.

Turner, who has over 10 years of experience in marketing leadership, advises webmasters to demonstrate these principles either formally — through credentials, for example — or by personal experience. “For starters,” Turner advises, “ensure statements, claims, and declarations are substantiated with verified references, research, or credible first-hand data. Next, pursue and cultivate third-party locations and references to the content that show other industry resources value the content and support the domain authority.”

Marcus Miller adds that it’s important to help Google understand that your page is a good result for a particular search term. He explains, “You have to understand what is important to your potential customers. What questions do they have? Can you create better answers than what is out there? How do you demonstrate to Google that you are an Expert and Authority that they can Trust? How do you help to build signals that this content is useful for those users?”

Our post on creating content with E-A-T in mind offers additional thoughts on future-proofing content using the E-A-T perspective.

Breaking it Down

At the risk of oversimplifying, content is king when it comes to Google’s algorithm updates. While Google offers several tools to help webmasters understand its algorithm updates and how its search defines a quality website, probably the best thing you can do to future-proof your site is to offer high-quality content that’s relevant to your target audience, or, as Marcus Miller says, “In a nutshell: Create the best answer to any given question and then tell the world about it.”

The post Google’s Webmaster Guidelines: What Can You Learn to Help Future-Proof Your Content for Algorithm Updates appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/googles-webmaster-guidelines-what-can-you-learn-to-help-future-proof-your-content-for-algorithm-updates/feed/ 0
Moving the Needle: How to Make A Press Release Newsworthy https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/moving-the-needle-how-to-make-a-press-release-newsworthy/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/moving-the-needle-how-to-make-a-press-release-newsworthy/#respond Fri, 30 Aug 2019 14:39:15 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25498 Whether your business is a single-person startup or a multinational conglomerate, at some point you will need a quality press release. From a maxed-out crowdfunding goal to new must-have product or service, press releases are a simple, cost-effective way to get the word out about your good news. Press releases date back to the ancient […]

The post Moving the Needle: How to Make A Press Release Newsworthy appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Whether your business is a single-person startup or a multinational conglomerate, at some point you will need a quality press release. From a maxed-out crowdfunding goal to new must-have product or service, press releases are a simple, cost-effective way to get the word out about your good news.

Press releases date back to the ancient times before the Internet but they’ve remained a vital tool for getting your message out in the digital age. While print magazines and newspapers were once the main targets for press releases, these days bloggers, journalists and digital outlets can help transform your story into a newsworthy headline. And unlike the old analog days, one great piece of coverage not only drives awareness, but it can also provide an SEO ripple effect that brings your brand to a whole new audience.

Crafting a newsworthy press release and pitching it to the right outlets can open a new level of PR success, but it takes the right approach. So, we’ve gone direct to some our most experienced press release writers to get their insights on what the best approach is. In this article, we’ll cover some do’s and don’ts to help you write fun, professional press releases that can make an impact for your brand.

Press Release Primer: How to Make A Newsworthy Story Stand Out

Before you start writing a press release you should ask yourself this simple question: “Is this actually a newsworthy story?” Of course, you’re doing big things, but remember that people outside of your organization may not find every new development important enough to read about. This is especially true for media outlets.

Is this a newsworthy story?

For example, fashion blogger Melanie DiSalvo of Virtue + Vice explains that jumping into an ongoing trend isn’t enough to catch her attention:

” … At this point, I ignore press releases that highlight a brand’s buy one give one model, or if they are making swim or yoga clothes out of recycled water bottles. Everyone is doing that these days. It has to be a unique idea. For me, it’s not so much the press release, but learning about something new and exciting that is not currently being done.”

It can be hard to tell if your story is truly newsworthy, but luckily there are a few simple methods you can use to ensure that your press release has the traction it needs to become a news article.

ALSO5 Tips for Optimizing Your Press Release

Play It (Mostly) Cool

Getting media coverage for your news story is largely about credibility. Good thing your brand is oozing with street cred! But how can you be sure that writers, editors, bloggers and industry tastemakers will find your brand worthy of exposure? One of the fastest ways to blow it is by constantly blasting out press releases about every little event that happens within your organization.

Nobody likes spam emails, and media outlets are constantly inundated with requests for coverage. So if you’ve been issuing many press releases hoping to “stay on the radar” of press outlets but haven’t had any coverage, consider reducing your frequency and only issuing a release about the biggest, most important news items.

Keep the “New” in Newsworthy

Drafting a press release may feel like a lesser priority when you’re ramping up for a newsworthy event, but don’t put it off for too long. Any event could have the potential to bring new exposure to your business, but not if it happened 18 months ago.

Media outlets work on tight schedules and require a constant flow of new content to keep their readers engaged. It’s critical, therefore, that you only issue a press release about current stories or those coming in the very near future. Don’t jump too far down the road though or the public may forget about your event before it even happens. 

When in doubt, reach out to your target media outlets and ask them how much lead time they need and set your release date accordingly.

Think Outside the Office Walls

Within the culture of an organization, any little shakeup can feel like a seismic shift. It’s important to remember that most outsiders won’t pick up every nuance of your business the way that you do. To help decide if your event is truly newsworthy, keep an eye on news articles about your industry and community at large.

If you’re unsure whether your story is worthy of a news release, ask yourself if it will have implications for your industry outside of your office space. Could your story even transcend your industry on a cultural level? If you can confidently say yes to either of these questions, then it’s a safe bet your story is newsworthy and deserves a solid press release.

Craft Your Press Release for Maximum Impact

If your company has news like a game-changing new product, a venerated CEO retiring or a new mega-merger then you’ll need to tell the world. But having a newsworthy story isn’t enough. You also need to have a well-written press release.

A press release ultimately serves to make a journalist’s life easier by offering them a compelling story in a bite-sized chunk that they can run with. So if your press release is a long-winded, confusing mess then tear it up and start again. Because after all, your press release can only be newsworthy if writers are willing to make it into news.

The 5 Ws- Press Releases

Short, Fun and to the Point

One of the easiest ways to make your press release shine is by keeping things brief. A PR industry standard is that a press release should never be longer than one page. It should also follow a fairly specific template that’s common across industries. If your story is newsworthy, its impact will be self-evident and you won’t need thousands of words to get your point across.

To help keep things brief, avoid presenting too much background information about you and your firm outside of the standard boilerplate section. Include contact information like your website and phone number, but trust that readers will seek out more info about you if they need it. Also, avoid using too much technical language or industry jargon to tell your story. Most media outlets aim for at least some degree of diversity in their readership and they may be hesitant to pick up a story that’s too technical.

Brevity is not only important for your overall word length, but also for your writing style. Keep your sentence structures simple and easy to read by avoiding excessive superlatives and adjectives. Your company’s new product may be “amazing” and “groundbreaking” but if so, you only need to say it once. This kind of language can quickly expand your word count and make your news story feel oversold.

Instead of leaning on fluffy language to tell your story, consider including original data. There’s little that can prove how awesome you are like cold, hard numbers. If your business works with measurable metrics then get creative and look about how your impressive numbers tie in with a broader cultural story.

While it’s important to keep your press release tight and fast-reading, don’t be afraid to give it some character. Your story is unique and so is your organization, so let your singular voice shine through in your writing. Editors receive stacks of bone dry, cookie-cutter press releases every day and a dash of whit and genuine passion may push your release to the top of the pile. So have fun with it and enjoy the process of turning your passion into a newsworthy story.

Structure of a Press Release

Keep Your Headlines Above Water

The headlines in your press release are the first point of contact and it’s critical that you make them count. Headlines have an outsized responsibility because they have to convey critical information in your story and also hook the reader in the shortest length possible. The key here is to keep things simple.

If you can tell your entire story in a single line that’s also imbued with wit and personality, then, by all means, go ahead, but it’s more important to convey the critical information in a tidy package. That’s because Google search headings are limited to 70 characters and a partial heading can seem misleading or confusing to potential readers looking for your story. Keeping your titles short and sweet not only helps with search results but also brings the reader right to your point with immediate impact.

Find Your Target Audience

Once you have a well-crafted press release about a newsworthy story you’ll need to get it into the right hands. While your press release should ideally have relevance beyond your specific industry, it’s critically important that you contact media outlets that cover your specific niche.

Think Like A Journalist

When you start to send your press releases to news outlets, remember that they are businesses relying on top-shelf content to keep their readership engaged. Start by seeking out the publications that only tell stories like yours or create content about your industry. If your news has broader appeal then bigger outlets may pick up your story after it gets coverage on a smaller scale.

Bottom line – you want to craft a press release that a journalist or blogger could easily pick up and present to his or her audience.

ALSOThe Secret of Writing a Press Release that Actually Gets Read

It’s All About That Niche

Blogs, social media and digital magazines have a major influence on today’s media climate. Many of these smaller outlets have risen above the cacophony by narrowing their focus to a single niche. No matter the news you hope to share, there’s a good chance that a social media influencer or blogger could lend a trusted, credible voice to your story.

Dig deep to find the experts in your field who are active bloggers or social media users. If you can’t find any, contact outlets in adjacent niches and see if they can recommend anyone. Once you find the right niche outlets for your story, tailor your press release to each recipient and highlight the ways in which your story is relevant to their interests. Specificity is king and if you can find the right niche outlet to cover your story you may find a media ally that will stick with your brand for years to come.

Break Through the Noise

If you’ve got a great story to tell then a well-crafted press release could be the perfect tool to help bring that story to the world. With today’s frictionless media, it’s easier than ever to take a newsworthy story from a basement workshop to the global stage with the help of just a few passionate bloggers.

If you can honestly say that your story is newsworthy and you’re willing to keep your writing simple and compelling, then you may have all that you need to claim headlines within your niche and beyond. So roll up your sleeves, fire up your laptop, and crank out a press release that’s worthy of your unique story!

The post Moving the Needle: How to Make A Press Release Newsworthy appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/moving-the-needle-how-to-make-a-press-release-newsworthy/feed/ 0
Content Repurposing: How to Make the Old New to Drive SEO https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-repurposing-how-to-make-the-old-new-to-drive-seo/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-repurposing-how-to-make-the-old-new-to-drive-seo/#respond Fri, 23 Aug 2019 18:10:03 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25399 Reinventing the wheel is a waste of time, and most people agree with that sentiment. But what about improving the wheel? There’s a reason the owners of show cars and collectible vehicles put the time and elbow grease into making wheels shine. That little bit of sparkle can mean the difference between a blue ribbon or an […]

The post Content Repurposing: How to Make the Old New to Drive SEO appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Reinventing the wheel is a waste of time, and most people agree with that sentiment. But what about improving the wheel? There’s a reason the owners of show cars and collectible vehicles put the time and elbow grease into making wheels shine. That little bit of sparkle can mean the difference between a blue ribbon or an honorable mention at a car show.

The same sentiment holds true when it comes to content marketing. Yes, Google and everyone else loves unique, creative and relevant content. But if you’re reinventing the wheel with every word by starting with a from-scratch editorial calendar, then you’re probably wasting time, burning out creative resources and falling behind the competition when it comes to publishing content.

Because here’s the not-at-all-secret tip that successful content marketers use to capture audience attention and drive SEO: You can reuse your old content to support new wins in SERPs and new traffic to your site or social profiles.

The Benefits of Content Repurposing

Regardless of the type of content you plan on reusing, this tactic has some benefits for SEO and your bottom line. Some reasons to repurpose your blog posts and other content include:

  • Saving time and money. It’s often faster and easier to repurpose what you already have than it is to come up with something completely original. Plus, chances are if you’re reusing a landing page or article, you won’t have to rewrite the entire thing. That can save you money if you’re paying someone by the word.
  • Expand your reach. You can take a blog post and split it up into dozens of different social posts, create an infographic or slide decks from it, use it to fill out content for email subscribers, or turn it into a short script for video content. The same idea now lets you engage target audiences across numerous channels.
  • Get more ROI out of high-quality content. It takes a lot of effort to create high-value marketing collateral in the first place, and repurposing content lets you get more out of each piece.
  • Keep up with a robust publishing schedule. Whether you’re trying to get out six Tweets a day or want content on your company blog three times a week, keeping up with the demands of an editorial calendar isn’t easy. Sliding your old content into the mix — albeit with a slight facelift — can help you keep content churning consistently without diminishing quality.

ALSO6 Content Marketing Tips That Ensure You’re Following Best Practices for 2019

How to Repurpose Content

When it comes to reusing content, you can do so in a number of ways. Here are some of the most popular methods for turning existing content into something new.

  • Refresh an old post. This is akin to a minor renovation on a room. You’re not taking anything down to the studs, and a lot of the writing is going to remain intact. Instead, you replace all the stats and facts with the most updated information and add anything that’s relevant to today. You then republish the post with a more current date. This is a good method when you have content from years past that’s simply a bit out-of-date.
  • Rewrite an old post. This is a bring-it-down-to-the-studs effort. Plumbing is getting ripped out, bathtubs replaced. Or, in the case of a post or article, you’re scrapping all the words and starting from fresh with only the topic and some of the talking points. Choose this method when you’re sure the concept of the content was on point, but it failed to drive SEO for some reason.
  • Reuse existing content in different formats. You can take content you created in the past or today and expand its reach by converting it into different formats. Pull out quotes for social media, turn data into visuals or simply publish a shorter form of the content on a site like Medium to get more viewers. Use this method when you have strong content but your site isn’t yet getting the traffic you need on its own or you want to delve into multichannel marketing.

A table listing long, short and visual forms for repurposing content

5 More Tips from Content Marketers About Content Repurposing

1. Plan Seasonal Content with the Future in Mind

Although BestCompany.com Content Manager Alice Stevens typically aims for evergreen content that stands the test of time, she knows that in-the-moment blog posts also perform well. But one-and-done work can be a form of waste in the content world, which is why she plans each piece of content with the future in mind.

“I do some seasonal content to capitalize on trends or events,” says Stevens. “There are some articles that are seasonal, like articles about health insurance open enrollment. When I write these articles, I plan to update and repurpose them as necessary for the following year.”

2. Use Analytics to Choose Which Content You Repurpose

Popular posts from the past can be made fresh again, but when you’re creating content, remember that the blog content that’s performing right now can also be repurposed to drive more traffic or engage different audience sectors.

Andrew Maff, Director of Marketing and Operations for Seller’s Choice, says his company doesn’t tend to consider whether existing content will be valuable again in the future. But they do look at their past content to see if they can use it again as different things trend.

“For example, when Rakuten, the largest eCommerce site in Japan, first started gaining popularity, we wrote about it on our blog,” says Maff. “A year or so later, when Rakuten was trending more and more on Google, we optimized that blog article for current SEO trends and are now a top listing for the topic.”

Hamna Amjad, a Content Marketing Executive with Gig Worker, adds, “You should consider recycling those pieces of content that have already done well with your audience. Those pieces of content that became very popular are likely high-quality and relevant to your audience and can be repurposed. Your focus should be on adding value to the original content.”

3. Present the Content in New Forms with Added Information

Amjad provides a few tips on how to add value to your existing content when you repurpose it. Some ideas Amjad provides for content repurposing include:

  • Create infographics. “It’s been proven that audiences are attracted more by visual content rather than plain textual format,” says Amjad. “This format works really well if you have a lot of data in your content.”
  • Develop podcasts around the content or content around podcasts. Amjad points out that “podcasts are the only passive way to consume information, so more people are hopping onto this trend. Podcast transcripts can easily be converted into blog posts and vice versa.”
  • Create videos based on content. Video is highly engaging and often favored by younger audiences. Amjad notes that you can easily convert a blog post or article into a video script.

4. Combine Blog Content into Longer-Form Content

Go through popular blog posts and turn them into an eBook, or gather customer testimonials and data to create a case study. You can also convert information from popular posts into large Slideshare presentations that position you as a leader in the niche.

5. Rescue Mediocre Content and Give it New Life

“In my experience, content can be split into two categories when it comes to repurposing,” says Reece Cambron, search specialist at Lucid Agency. “The first is content that has been live on the site for a while but has never quite achieved the results you had hoped for. The second is new content that is designed to serve a specific short-term purpose. In both cases, a strategic repurposing of the content can yield an improvement in rankings and organic traffic.”

So, how does Cambron give unsuccessful existing content new life?

“As a best practice, I try to repurpose a few unsuccessful content pieces each month,” says Cambron. “These are typically blogs with useful information (not just internal news or press releases) that didn’t have the success I expected.” Cambron provides a step-by-step approach for positioning this lackluster content for better SEO success.

  • Start by conducting additional keyword research around the topic to see how search volume or intent may have changed since the piece was originally written
  • Rework the content to optimize for these phrases.
  • Adjust the metadata, H tags, and even the URL if necessary to ensure the blog is transformed into a new, better version of itself.

ALSO6 Situations Where Content Rewriting Can Help Your Marketing

Need Help Repurposing Your Content?

Whether you simply can’t keep up with the publishing schedule that works for your company or you need a fresh pair of eyes to figure out how to make your content shine, freelancer writers can be an invaluable resource. Check out all the ways Crowd Content freelance content writers can help you get more out of existing content.

The post Content Repurposing: How to Make the Old New to Drive SEO appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-repurposing-how-to-make-the-old-new-to-drive-seo/feed/ 0
Email Copywriting: Tips for Mastering a Profitable Niche https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/email-writing/email-copywriting-tips-for-mastering-a-profitable-niche/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/email-writing/email-copywriting-tips-for-mastering-a-profitable-niche/#respond Thu, 08 Aug 2019 18:45:12 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25249 The next time someone tells you email marketing is on the way out, remind them that people said the same thing about avocado toast and bacon-wrapped everything, and my breakfast plans haven’t changed one bit. Email copywriting may not be the newest niche on the block, but there’s a reason the practice is still thriving, […]

The post Email Copywriting: Tips for Mastering a Profitable Niche appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

The next time someone tells you email marketing is on the way out, remind them that people said the same thing about avocado toast and bacon-wrapped everything, and my breakfast plans haven’t changed one bit. Email copywriting may not be the newest niche on the block, but there’s a reason the practice is still thriving, evolving and winning over new and existing customers alike. And, there’s a reason that skilled freelance copywriters continue to be in high demand. 

For every dollar the average brand spends on email, they get a whopping $38 in return. That translates into a 3,800% ROI — can your client’s direct mailers and PPC banners do that?

Email is not only here to stay, it’s a platform for exciting new ideas and twists on tried-and-true content marketing strategies that could help launch your business to the next level. Here’s what you need to know about email copywriting and a few tips to help you master best practices, write effective emails and become the very best email copywriter you can be. Avocado toast sold separately.

Types of Email Copy

Email marketing is so much more than those rambling missives from brand ambassadors and social media interns that land in your inbox on their way to the trash pile. Personal messages can be an important part of your brand story, but there’s a way to go about that so you can keep your audience’s attention and still get your point across. But more on that later.

ALSO What is Copywriting?

For now, it’s crucial you understand how diverse email copywriting can be and the many use cases that turn a simple electronic letter into a marketing powerhouse.

  • Announce New Content. If a new blog post goes up but no one’s scrolling your blog to see it, the content almost doesn’t count. Yes, there’s SEO to help attract interest, but letting your warm leads (those on your email list) know there’s something new to read or otherwise act on is a smart move. Sound the virtual trumpets whenever your client launches an ebook, has a sale, conducts a webinar or has a few case studies that serve as a lead magnet.

  • Newsletters. Almost every brand can benefit from a newsletter-style email that helps potential and current customers understand your brand relevancy and how you’re different from your competitors. Use it to highlight important news from across your industry, curate interesting and relevant content from a variety of sources, emphasize the people and processes behind a product or do some combination of all the above.

  • Product Updates: Let subscribers know when an app is upgraded or a site has new functionality. A monthly digest is better if there are a lot of little updates unworthy of separate emails, but occasional revamps should be shared to remind customers the service is available and there’s even more value on tap.

  • Prospecting Campaigns: When a company wants to get their product or service in front of a new buyer persona, they often start with a large list of contacts they can make the first contact with by sending emails. This prospecting campaign relies on smart, strategic content that speaks to common pain points and challenges that buyer persona often experiences. Content has to have wide appeal to the different types of contacts under the buyer persona, but still be engaging, empowering and compelling, with a strong call-to-action to respond.
  • Onboarding Sequences: These email series help usher engaged users — subscribers, for instance — into paying customers. The idea is to build suspense and authority over several emails, delivering value and driving interest before eventually encouraging readers to take action.
  • Post-Purchase Drips: Once somebody buys a product or service, it’s time to follow up with emails that welcome them on board, tell them how to make the most of their purchase, offer optional add-ons and otherwise nurture the relationship. This is a great tool to help nudge new customers into the advocacy stage of the buyer’s journey.
  • Cart Abandonment Campaigns: As of 2018, cart abandonment rates sit at 79.17%. That’s a lot of consumers adding things to their virtual basket and then leaving without an actual buy. Cart abandonment campaigns can remind shoppers of what they left behind and make it easy to return and complete their purchase.
  • Promotional Campaigns: This type of email marketing series builds with each successive message, provoking emotion, stoking curiosity and building suspense before announcing an offer and using imagery and other hooks to direct readers to a well-written landing page and cements a sale.

This is far from a comprehensive list — everything from form submission confirmations to event invitations could also conceivably be included — but it gives you an idea of how diverse and powerful email marketing campaigns can be.

ALSOWhat Types Of Email Newsletters Are Most Effective in 2019?

Tips for Writing Emails That Connect and Convert

Know Your Audience — and Capitalize on that Knowledge

Every piece of content you send should have a purpose, and that purpose is to create a connection with the recipient. The emails you write need to resonate with your audience and be relevant not only to their lives and interests but also to where they’re at in their buyer journey. Consumers have different needs during the awareness stage than they do when they’re about to make a decision; tailor your words to match the timing and you’ll be far more persuasive.

Graphic showing various stages of a buyer's journey
Source: Moz

To create content for your audience, you have to get to know them. Buyer personas, face-to-face conversations, competitor research, social studies, monitoring online activity and sending out surveys are all legitimate ways to form an accurate, detailed picture of your consumer base. Then it’s time to put that data to work.

Alex Membrillo, CEO of Cardinal Digital Marketing, brings it all together: “The trick to successful email marketing is delivering engaging content, relevant to your audience. The easiest way to ensure your content is relevant is to segment your email campaigns based on your target markets and audiences.”

“I was recently working with a client who wanted to feature a blog post in an upcoming e-newsletter that was geared to a Business-to-Consumer market. However, we determined that the target market and email list was for a Business-to-Business market. Therefore, the content didn’t make sense for the audience, and strategically the decision was made to change the focus of the email to a more relevant topic.”

ALSOEmail Marketing: Still Business’ Best Marketing Tool

Focus More on the Reader Than On Yourself

It’s amazing how hard it is to break away from marketing emails that lead with “I” or “we”. Yes, you’re advertising a business, but you should be advertising subtly and crafting consumer-centric content that doesn’t feel so self-centered and single-minded.

“This may seem like a basic statement, but many B2B-marketers (and B2C-marketers) still focus their content around telling people about how good they are,” says Operation Manager Ola Rask of Match2One. “The simple truth is this; people care a lot more about themselves than they do about you. In fact, they probably don’t care about you at all — so try to personalize your content and make them feel special.”

Tweak Your Writing

Spruce up your content and create copy that sells using a feature-benefit structure that helps consumers understand not only what you’re selling but why they should want it. Instead of boasting that a food processor has five speeds and a safety button, say it has five speeds to help you do everything from dicing to pureeing and a safety button to prevent accidents. If a customer reads a brand boast in your email and says, “So what?”, you haven’t clearly outlined the benefit.

Action words are helpful tools, too, in that action drives action. If you want your audience to get excited, use words that have power, such as:

List of action words for email copywriting
Print this out – it’ll come in handy when you’re writing your next email.

  • Discover
  • Act
  • Learn
  • Explore
  • Listen
  • Win
  • Make
  • Create
  • Develop
  • Achieve

Aim For an Emotional Response

Famous examples of advertising such as soda companies showing people having fun and being sociable highlight an important (albeit sometimes misused) marketing principle – if you can help your audience connect emotionally with your brand and offering, they’re more likely to convert.

What they’re doing is in effect visually telling a story. You can also focus on storytelling in your email copy to elicit an emotional response. This could come in many forms including:

  1. Fear of missing out
  2. Warmth toward your brand or offering
  3. Desire to associate with successful people
  4. Curiosity to learn more

What emotional appeal you target will depend on the purpose of your communication and the target audience, but keep in mind choosing the right emotional appeal can drastically increase your success rates. 

Stick to One Clear Call to Action

The average open rate across all industries is just under 17%. The average click-through rate is 7.43%. That means 17% of the people on the average email list will even bother to open your emails and about 7.5 out of every 100 will click your CTA to see what’s on the other side. There are lots of reasons that number is on the low side, but asking too much of your email subscribers is a great way tank conversions.

Riah Solomon, Content Marketing Manager at SaaSOptics, feels strongly about the power of a solitary CTA. “Every email should have one main goal with a clear purpose, which means you should only have one main call to action. Write everything to point toward that call to action, and you’ll see click-through rates jump. Your readers need clarity and direction. When you give it to them, they will follow your lead.”

Don’t Underestimate the Power of a Great Email Subject Line

People are scanners by nature, and if your subject line doesn’t make them sit up and take notice, there won’t be anybody reading your email. To get more clicks, Charles Floate, Owner of DFY Links, offers these six expert suggestions:

  1. Put the offer/information upfront – the further back in the subject line your offer is, the less chance it has of being read
  2. Keep your subject line short – people have short attention spans
  3. Give it a sense of urgency – give them a reason to open it now
  4. Make it personal – make them think they know you
  5. Triple-check your spelling and grammar – no need for explanation here
  6. Bonus tip: Be clever – bland and grey never see the light of day

Be consistent, too. Whatever you promise in your subject line should actually exist in the body of your email. Nothing ruins a customer’s trust in a brand faster than feeling tricked. Bait-and-switch marketing may get clicks, but it’s a lot harder to increase conversions when inconsistency, whether intentional or accidental, is putting a dent into your authenticity and authority.

Find Ways to Personalize Every Message

The power of personalization is big to warrant a more in-depth look. Personalized subject lines boost email open rates by 26%, but that’s just the beginning. You can also personalize by targeting emails using information from customer surveys, recommendation purchases based on past buying behavior, highlighting mutual connections (referencing an industry-leading decision-maker, for instance) or simply making an email feel personal by addressing common consumer hurdles or including praise. Specifics are paramount, so use all the information at your disposal to zero in on personal factors that will help your message resonate.

Email marketing statistic

Need help with your email marketing? We can help.

Before You Hit Send…

One of the most important things you can do as a marketer to drive conversions is to A/B test the heck out of your emails to understand exactly what will drive conversions the highest. Digital marketing guru Neil Patel gives some great advice on what you should test and how you should do it.

Although everything from the colors and imagery to the body text and personalization are game for testing, there are a few key things that you must get right to ensure a high conversion rate:

  • Subject line (“Free Shipping Ends Tonight” vs “Enjoy Free Shipping”)
  • Call to action (“See What’s Inside” vs “Learn Insider Secrets”)
  • The offer itself (“Deep Discounts” vs “BOGO”)

Think about what you’re trying to achieve. If you’re seeing dismal open rates, then begin by testing your subject line. To get your conversion rates up, start by testing your calls to action.

Those who use MailChimp or another similar email marketing platforms may find built-in testing tools to help get the job done. If you’re looking for another solution, Hubspot has a great list of A/B testing tools to try. No matter what tool you use, keep in mind that email marketing without testing first is about as effective as throwing spaghetti at a wall and hoping something sticks.

When you set up your tests, keep things as subjective as possible. Patel says that you should always use the same list for a test, and if you can’t run the test on the whole list, any subset should be chosen randomly. It’s also imperative that you shouldn’t stagger your test, as you may run up against time-based factors that impact the results.

If you’ve never done any A/B or split testing before, you might want to consider hiring a pro to do it for you if you have the budget. But whatever you do — include testing in your project plan.

Wrapping it Up

At its very heart, a good email boosts results and conversions by addressing your target audience’s pain points and connecting with them. Do that and you’ll achieve the success you crave. I call that a solid day’s work.

The post Email Copywriting: Tips for Mastering a Profitable Niche appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/email-writing/email-copywriting-tips-for-mastering-a-profitable-niche/feed/ 0
A Detailed Look At What Makes Web Content Well-Optimized for Voice Search https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/a-detailed-look-at-what-makes-web-content-well-optimized-for-voice-search/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/a-detailed-look-at-what-makes-web-content-well-optimized-for-voice-search/#respond Thu, 25 Jul 2019 18:38:57 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25009 “Alexa, why is voice search so important for online marketing today?” Ask her this, and she’ll probably return a featured snippet answer including at least one statistic about voice search and local SEO. The two are becoming integral to each other as more people turn to voice assistants to find the best burger in town, […]

The post A Detailed Look At What Makes Web Content Well-Optimized for Voice Search appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

“Alexa, why is voice search so important for online marketing today?”

Ask her this, and she’ll probably return a featured snippet answer including at least one statistic about voice search and local SEO. The two are becoming integral to each other as more people turn to voice assistants to find the best burger in town, make a dentist appointment or discover new retail outlets.

Brands that aren’t optimizing web content for voice search are poised to lose big in both the near and long terms. And that’s especially true for local companies. Find out more about voice search below and get some tips for optimizing your content for this up-and-coming technology.

What Is Voice Search?

Voice search is any internet search launched by the spoken word. Individuals can query various search engines via voice assistants on mobile devices, computers, smart speakers and other devices. When you ask Google, Alexa, Cortana, Siri or Bixby a question, you’re conducting a voice search.

The AI software that powers the voice assistant turns to the internet, conducts a search based on your question and returns the most relevant results to you.

Why Is Voice Search So Important?

Experts predict that 50% of all internet searches will be conducted via voice by 2020. Lest you think voice search is a young person’s technology, consider this: 65% of people age 25 to 49 use voice-enabled devices one or more times per day, and 57% of people age 50 and over said the same. More than 60% of adults age 25 to 64 said they see themselves using voice devices even more in the future.

Smart speaker stats also speak to the importance of voice search. The market for these devices grew 200% from Q3 2017 to Q3 2018. And by 2022, more than half of all households are expected to have these devices, with consumers spending $40 billion via voice shopping by that milestone.

Voice Search and Local SEO: A Marriage of Convenience

The numbers above demonstrate the growing importance of voice search in all types of online interactions. But the relationship between voice search and local SEO is especially strong due to the convenience voice offers consumers. On mobile devices especially, consumers are highly likely to ask Siri or Google “Where can I get a pizza nearby” or “How do I get to the children’s science museum?”

Tips for Optimizing Content for Voice Search

1. Create Location Pages to Serve Local Searches

Creating local pages helps you perform better for local voice searches. But it also provides other benefits, including:

  • Helping customers find pertinent local information they need to buy
  • Ensuring local branches can publish content relevant to them and their consumers that might not be relevant for all your stores
  • Providing a landing page option for your local GMB or directory profiles

Tom Buckland, Managing Director for HQ SEO provides a five-step list for optimizing voice search and local SEO that has resulted in a 20 to 275% increase in visibility for his clients:

  1. Get listed online with tools such as GMB and Yahoo Local
  2. Reduce page loading time — snippets and rich results won’t be shown for high loading times
  3. Use long-tail SEO — if you optimize for longer questions, you’re more likely to be in results than if you just optimize for head terms
  4. Write more local content — include information about local areas and landmarks if you can
  5. Use structured data markup — schema on site is prevalent in 90% of rich snippets and this will be the case for voice searches

ALSO: Want Success With Local Landing Pages? Learn How to Avoid These Pitfalls

2. Aim for the Featured Snippet

Ben Taylor, founder of WriteBlogEarn.com, says he’s started to make efforts to structure all his content for voice search.

“I incorporate concise questions and answers into all of my reviews and articles,” says Taylor. “The questions that Google shows with ‘featured snippets’ near the top of the search results are usually a good guide to the kind of things to include. My results have been solid but not always completely predictable. As with any kind of SEO work, nobody knows exactly what Google’s algorithm is concentrating on. In some cases, I’ve taken the answer box from a competitor, in others I haven’t, but it’s still worth attempting it with each piece of content.”

Some tips for creating content for this purpose include:

  • Asking questions relevant to your content and audience within your content. Taylor gives suggestions such as “What is X?” or “How much does X cost?” You can see examples of questions in the first two headers of this article.
  • Provide a 25-40(ish) word concise answer immediately following the question. Google and other search engines like short answers they can display in the answer box, and voice assistants like concise answers they can read to the user. You can follow up with additional paragraphs to expand on information following that.
  • Use schema markup to indicate a question and answer, especially in Q&A sections of content. This clues the search engines in and helps increase the chances your content is served up as a featured snippet or in voice search results.
  • Create “People Also Ask” sections to extend your content, create more feature snippet opportunities and cater to voice searches.

3. Include Long-Tail Keywords and Conversational Language

Gregory Golinski is the head of digital marketing at  YourParkingSpace.co.uk. He says they realized content needed to be adapted to take into account how smartphone users talk to their devices when conducting voice searches.

“We tried to make the content on our website sound more like conversational English. We asked ourselves: what would a smartphone user say to find our platform? What kind of keywords would they use? How would they phrase their question?”

That means doing some new keyword research and including long-tail keywords in your content. Someone searching via desktop or typing a mobile query may only include a few words. For example, “Pizza in Raliegh” is a potential typed search term. But most people don’t launch Siri and start firing off lists of keywords for searches. Instead, they speak in a natural way. “Siri, where can I get pizza in Raliegh?” or “Siri, what are the top-rated pizza places in town?”

Not sure where to start with these types of keywords? Luckily, resources such as SEMRush’s keyword research tool let you search only for questions related to your primary keywords. That’s a great place to get started when you’re optimizing for voice search.

“One thing that remains the same for content writers, whether they’re writing for voice search or regular web search,” says Keri Lindenmuth, Marketing Manager for KDG, “is to continue getting in the mindset of their users. While before you were thinking of key phrases they were searching, now you’re thinking of key questions they are asking.”

Lindenmuth also reminds content marketers to keep the voice format in mind when structuring content. “Eliminate long paragraphs and break content into bullet points or lists, something easier for a voice device to recite.”

Work With Teams That Keep Up With Trends

Convinced about the critical nature of voice search, but still not sure how to implement this type of content? Consider working with enterprise content teams who keep up with trends and know how to produce content that performs, or hire a freelance writer with voice search experience from the Crowd Content marketplace.

The post A Detailed Look At What Makes Web Content Well-Optimized for Voice Search appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/a-detailed-look-at-what-makes-web-content-well-optimized-for-voice-search/feed/ 0
Writing Product Reviews to Engage and Convert Shoppers: Examples, Tips and Best Practices https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/writing-product-reviews-to-engage-and-convert-shoppers-examples-tips-and-best-practices/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/writing-product-reviews-to-engage-and-convert-shoppers-examples-tips-and-best-practices/#respond Tue, 23 Jul 2019 15:00:46 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=25042 Reviewed products are more likely to sell. That’s because 92% of Americans now read reviews online, and they see reviews as being just like recommendations from friends and family. Customer reviews are a great way for brands to cut through consumer cynicism and make the conversion. Review posts and articles are also a great way for bloggers, […]

The post Writing Product Reviews to Engage and Convert Shoppers: Examples, Tips and Best Practices appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Reviewed products are more likely to sell. That’s because 92% of Americans now read reviews online, and they see reviews as being just like recommendations from friends and family. Customer reviews are a great way for brands to cut through consumer cynicism and make the conversion.

Review posts and articles are also a great way for bloggers, marketers and businesses of all types to increase site traffic and revenue. Knowing how to write a product review is essential to success in those efforts, though. Discover more about types of reviews, reasons why you should write a product review and how to do it below.

We’ll also cover some times for finding skilled product review writers who can do the job for you.

ALSO: Content Marketing for eCommerce: 6 Types of Copy You Need to Succeed

What Are Product Review Posts, and Who Should Write Them?

Numerous types of product reviews exist, including:

  • Consumer reviews, such as those posted on Amazon, wherein people who own or bought the product leave a short review and star rating
  • Expert reviews, such as those written by CNET, wherein writers with knowledge of a certain type of topic review them as a third-party for the purpose of educating consumers
  • Round up or list reviews, such as those provided by Capterra, wherein writers compare a number of similar products to help buyers make a choice
  • Blogger or affiliate marketing reviews, which are written by people who received the product for free or who get some type of commission if you buy the product off of their links

Expert, round up, blogger and affiliate marketer reviews are all ways to monetize content on your site when you aren’t the manufacturer, producer or direct seller of products or services.

Steve Kurniawan, a content and growth strategist at Nine Peaks Media, explains when review posts work and when they may not:

“In my opinion using this approach is only effective when the business is not the producer of the product/service and this is not the only product they sell. For example, if you’re an eCommerce site covering a niche, you can review a lot of related products. You can get revenue either by selling these products yourself or through affiliate marketing.

If you’re the producer of the product/service, people won’t believe your own reviews because they’ll consider them biased, so this can be very counterproductive.”

Examples and Tips for How to Write a Product Review

Before you set up affiliate links or stalk brands on social media in the hopes of becoming an influencer for them, take a look at the examples of review posts below and what you can learn from them.

1. CNET: Expertise and an Easy-to-Read Format

CNET is a go-to resource for many consumers on the prowl for electronics and other technology devices. What sets CNET reviews apart from the crowd is that they are written by people who understand the technology deeply — if not by actual industry insiders. At the same time, CNET marries expertise with a conversational tone and explanations of specs, so anyone reading the reviews can make an informed decision about the products.

Let’s take a look at this CNET review of the Google Nest Hub to get some tips for writing a review.

Product Review

  • Even before the review article starts, CNET provides a quick summary that consumers can scan for high-level details.
  • CNET never gushes over a product without offering a look at the disadvantages. Remember that no product is perfect, and hyping something without writing a realistic review won’t inspire trust (and thus, conversions). Including the pros and cons of a product or service is important.
  • CNET provides easy-to-access links to reviews of similar products, ensuring consumers can compare options and stay on CNET’s page. That increases the chance that, whatever the consumer ultimately buys, the affiliate link comes from CNET.

2. Capterra: Comprehensive and Convenient

Capterra takes a similar approach with its reviews, providing expert and comprehensive content for the software niche. But Capterra is also known for its lists; if you’re looking for a type of software, you can usually find lists of 10 or even hundreds on Capterra along with reviews, comparison tables and links to the product site.

Consider this page of reviews on applicant tracking software.

tracking-software

The top lesson review writers and publishers should learn from Capterra is that presentation matters. Check out how easy the interface is to use. If people can’t find the product information on your site, they’re not going to fumble around on it forever for the pleasure. Even bloggers should create categories, tags and menus that make it simple to navigate information.

Capterra also provides high-level content with the opportunity for readers to dig deeper as desired. Note that users can see the star ratings and a small blurb for each type of software on the list. They can then choose to:

  • Click on the link to read the full Capterra review for that product
  • Click on the link to go to the product website to make a purchase
  • Add the product to a comparison table to see how it stacks up to other options on the list

It’s always important to present the reader with a great article about the product or service and then get out of the way so they can make a decision about buying. But before you step off stage, follow the Capterra example and leave a link for that purpose, whether it’s to the product on your own site or an affiliate link.

3. Golf Influence: Niche-Based Product Reviews

You don’t have to be a tech or software guru to use this type of content to your advantage. It works with almost any product; Golf Influence does it with golf-related goods.

Check out this article on irons, for example. The site takes a more magazine-style approach, creating a gorgeous review piece that’s full of visuals to support scanning and inspire sharing.

golf-product-review

Right away, you get an information-rich graphic that demonstrates the authority and accuracy of the content below it.

Golf Influence presents a comprehensive article, but for consumers with little time or short attention spans, it first calls out a top three of sorts. The table provides some quick tidbits and the all-important affiliate buy link.

Recommendations-Product-review

Once you get into the meat of the review article, each section is broken up with handy infographics that provide the top talking points, including the pros and cons for each product. Readers can make a decision from that information or click to read more about every option.

Like CNET and Capterra, Golf Influence provides expert, comprehensive product reviews. But it does it with additional graphical style, which increases the opportunities for social shares. This is a great tip for anyone writing product reviews for niches that perform well on Pinterest or Instagram.

4. Bloggers: Personalized Reviews and Recommendations

When bloggers share their personal journeys or use of products, it creates an incredibly authentic product review. While consumers appreciate input from the experts, especially with complex or niche goods, they also like to see how a person like them is able to put the item to use.

Consider a post from Make it with Missy about a NECTAR mattress. It’s a very personable post, including images of her family interacting with the product. Missy also provides a detailed look at how the mattress comes, why it comes packaged the way it does and how you open and set it up. That might seem like a lot of weird pictures for no reason, but if you’re a consumer shopping for this type of mattress, you may wonder exactly how a rolled-up tube becomes a posh memory foam product on your bed. Missy answers those questions to alleviate buyer fears.

product-review-missy

Missy also includes a pros list in her review. She tells other consumers exactly how the mattress has helped her.

5. Integrating Video Reviews

Product Review Mom shares her lifestyle in the form of product reviews. As with Make it With Missy, this blog provides super personalized reviews that often give readers a look at how this mom and her family put goods and services to work.

Product Review Mom also does something any reviewer can do: she enhances her content with video in addition to images.

Check out this review for RevAir, for example.

product-review-mom

Product Review Mom doesn’t just address the product. She reviews it from the perspective of her needs, which likely resonate with the needs of her target audience. She specifically answers the question whether RevAir works for black kinky/curly hair, which automatically adds value to her review for that target audience. Then, she shows her readers how the product works for that niche by including a video.

ALSO4 Ways to Get Compelling eCommerce Content for Your Brand

Start Writing Product Reviews Today

Product reviews are a great way to increase conversions and revenue for all types of sites. Start writing your own reviews today or connect with freelancers who can get the job done for you.

The post Writing Product Reviews to Engage and Convert Shoppers: Examples, Tips and Best Practices appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/writing-product-reviews-to-engage-and-convert-shoppers-examples-tips-and-best-practices/feed/ 0
13 Types of Blog Posts to Fire Up Your Readers (And Your Editorial Calendar) https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/13-types-of-blog-posts-to-fire-up-your-readers-and-your-editorial-calendar/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/13-types-of-blog-posts-to-fire-up-your-readers-and-your-editorial-calendar/#respond Tue, 16 Jul 2019 17:30:51 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=24943 The secrets to winning with blog post marketing aren’t really secret. The keys to the conversion kingdom tend to be quality content at a consistent publishing schedule. But after weeks, months or years of publishing, simply keeping pace with your posting schedule can be daunting. One reason for that is blogger burnout. Whether you’re an […]

The post 13 Types of Blog Posts to Fire Up Your Readers (And Your Editorial Calendar) appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

The secrets to winning with blog post marketing aren’t really secret. The keys to the conversion kingdom tend to be quality content at a consistent publishing schedule. But after weeks, months or years of publishing, simply keeping pace with your posting schedule can be daunting. One reason for that is blogger burnout.

Whether you’re an individual or a corporation, the blog content writers in charge of your blog posts can run into a creative wall that makes it more difficult to come up with ideas and create high-quality content that performs in the search engines and resonates with readers. Luckily, we’ve put together a list of 13 winning types of blog posts that make it easy to craft content that drives social shares, backlinks, conversions and other important metrics.

ALSO: Hiring Blog Writers? 7 Common Mistakes You Need To Avoid

1. Posts that Answer Questions (Featured Snippets FTW!)

Ben Zeisloft from Qlicket says, “Blog posts and other content written by businesses are most effective when they answer questions in the minds of customers.”

When you ask a popular question (one that users are commonly searching online) and answer it immediately in a short list or paragraph of 25 to 40 words, you position yourself to potentially win the Featured Snippet position. Google displays the featured snippet on top of other organic search results, and often the page that earns the Featured Snippet spot also appears in the top three results, doubling the chance that someone will click on the link.

Example of a Featured Snippet

Zeisloft notes that this type of blog post isn’t just good for winning the Featured Snippet. “When a potential customer encounters a blog post answering their specific query,” he says, “the beginning of a value-creation relationship has already begun. Additionally, when a company creates a blog post that solves dilemmas or answers questions for potential customers, the company’s legitimacy among its customer base is built.”

How do you go about generating these types of posts? Zeisloft advises content marketers to “use free tools such as AnswerThePublic to find your customers’ questions and answer them with simple, brief, and effective blog posts. Then, use Google Trends to select optimal keywords so the blog post appears as a top result on search engines.”

Laptop with blog showing on screen and hands on keyboard

2. High-Quality Mega Posts Based on Content Pruning

Kulwant Nagi shares a practice called content pruning that the team at BloggingCage.com uses.

“One thing which worked for us in 2019 is content pruning,” says Nagi. “In October 2018, we started the process and found 300+ articles that were either of very low quality or ranking nowhere in Google. In the first phase, we grouped similar articles and combined them into one mega post. We keep the best-ranking URL and redirected (301 redirect) other similar links to that mega post.”

So far, it may not sound like pruning, but here’s where the second phase comes in. According to Nagi, the team identified all the posts that were still not ranking in Google and removed them. They took down 319 total articles from the blog.

“In January,” says Nagi, “we started seeing traffic going up, and now we’re seeing more than 200% growth in traffic.”

3. Single Refreshes of Old Blog Posts

You don’t have to reorganize the entire content garden to see results, though. Sometimes, it’s about giving individual plants (aka, existing blog posts) some extra love to generate more fruit (aka, traffic).

Shelby Liu, an SEO analyst for Brand Buddha, says, “Don’t forget about your older articles. Give them a second chance to shine. The truth could be that those older posts used to rank well but were taken down by new articles that better answer people’s search queries. Tweaking your older articles is more likely to improve rankings than creating content from scratch, and this tactic also gives the search engine some time to crawl and rank.”

Shelby Liu Quote with image of laptop on desk in background

Crowd Content secret: the article you’re reading right now is a refresh of a page we posted in 2016. We’re just adding all-new data and quotes to be current and expanding the content to cover more types of posts. This is a tactic you can easily use on your own site.

4. Episodic Blog Content

Episodic content continues to be a winner, especially if you have a good hook to retain readership over the course of a series. When you’re working with high-quality blog content writers, you can create cliff-hangers that leave the reader looking eagerly for the next installment, which makes episodic blog content a great partner for email marketing newsletters.

5. How-to Blog Posts

The past few Google algorithm updates have put searcher intent at the forefront of ranking considerations, and optimizing content for that intent is critical to success in the SERPs.

Most searches can be categorized into three major intent groups:

  • Informational: the searcher wants to know something
  • Transactional: the searcher wants to do something
  • Navigational: the searcher wants to go somewhere

How-to searchers are a huge percentage of informational queries. From “how to cook a roast” to “how to buy a tennis racket,” people look for step-by-step guides every day. Conduct keyword research to find out what people want to know how to do in your niche and create content that answers those questions.

6. Q&A with the Experts

Speaking of Google algorithms, 2018’s Medic update and June 2019’s core update both illustrated the need for more expert content on sites, especially for brands that serve finance, health or safety niches.

You can demonstrate expertise with authorship through bios and bylines, but you can also create Q&A interview posts. Your staff or freelance writers can interview experts and turn those conversations into engaging question-and-answer blog posts.

This is one of the best types of blog posts for adding expert content on topics when you don’t have in-house SMEs. While it’s always a good idea to post the thoughts and answers of your own staff, it’s also fine to interview an expert outside of your organization for your blog; some individuals may be happy to contribute in return for a shout-out or backlink to their website.

Hands typing on laptop with WordPress blog draft showing on screen

7. Behind-the-Scenes Posts

Expertise is only one piece of the quality pie for Google. E-A-T content (expertise, authority, trustworthiness) requires building trust with your readership. One way to do that is to create blog posts that provide a behind-the-scenes look at your operation. When possible, be candid about how you make or do things, or let loyal readers in on some of the details —obviously without giving away brand secrets.

In addition to building trust, behind-the-scenes videos and blog posts creates an exclusivity that helps your readers feel like part of a community culture surrounding your brand.

8. Epic Lists (We’re Not Talking a Top 10)

While those top five and top ten lists are losing ground in terms of online marketing, epic blog posts are still a great way to drive backlinks and position yourself for potential viral sharing.

An epic list is exactly that . . . EPIC. Consider writing lists with 50 to 100 points of curated content for readers to consider. Jeff Bullas’ list of 72 resources for writers is a great example.

Insider tip: If you don’t have the time or resources to find 99 items for a list, do something to differentiate your shorter lists. Top Tens went out with Letterman, but a shorter list with an odd number of points can still fare well when it comes to SEO and conversions.

ALSO: Are Short Blog Posts Worth It in a Long-Form World?

9. Curated Expert Advice

Combine tips six and eight by curating a list of points backed by expert advice. This is a great way to add authority if you don’t have a single expert willing to sit for a 30-minute interview. You can ask experts to share success stories about certain topics or give their top piece of advice.

Services like Help a Reporter Out connect publishers with experts willing to provide quotes, but you do have to meet some minimum publisher requirements. If you don’t meet those requirements, consider reaching out to the owners of websites in your industry (who are not direct competitors). They’re often happy to provide a quote in exchange for a link.

10. Infographics Turned Into Blog Posts

If pictures are worth a thousand words, a good infographic could be worth millions. Put together a comprehensive graphic and share it (with a high-res option for download). Then break off portions of the larger visual, sharing smaller glimpses into it alongside in-depth text analysis of the data.

Pro tip: Canva is a great tool for marketers who need to create social media graphics, infographics and more branded visual content.

Tablet with blog showing on screen and finger touching screen

11. Blog Posts that Are Lists of Social Media Posts

Need some visual bang, but don’t have much buck to buy it with? Whether you’re stretched on time or don’t have the resources to create visual content this week, consider clipping social media posts. Many brands create viral content by sharing screen grabs of or embedding relevant Twitter posts and using them to tell a story (or writing clever captions between them).

You can use your own social media posts — effectively doubling the return on investment in that particular content — or swipe content from others. Just remember if you use posts from other individuals, best practice is to embed it so it’s clickable or include a credit link.

12. Posts that Share Your Own Data or Original Research

We don’t mean to harp on E-A-T. . . actually, we do. It really is that important. And another way to demonstrate expertise and authority is by putting your own data and research on display. You can do that in the form of blog posts that include references to your own data, as we did in this article on reading levels.

You can also blog about your own case studies — sometimes one case study or long-form piece of research you commissioned can become multiple blog posts. Power Inbox worked with Mantis Research on a study about email marketing and then turned it into half a dozen or more blog posts on the subject.

13. Posts for Someone Else’s Site

Finally, remember that every type of blog post you write doesn’t have to be for your own site. Consider breaking free from your own pages to guest post on someone else’s site. You might do this as part of an exchange, having someone from the other site write a piece of content for you. It’s a great way to build authority by getting your name on other pages and get fresh ideas on your own site.

Stuck for Types of Blog Posts to Write?

Consider working with professional writers who can come up with new ideas for your content marketing efforts. And if you’re burned out on the entire process of keeping content calendars and blog posts current, consider working with a professional team.

The post 13 Types of Blog Posts to Fire Up Your Readers (And Your Editorial Calendar) appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/13-types-of-blog-posts-to-fire-up-your-readers-and-your-editorial-calendar/feed/ 0
6 Content Marketing Tips That Ensure You’re Following Best Practices for 2019 https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/6-content-marketing-tips-that-ensure-youre-following-best-practices-for-2019/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/6-content-marketing-tips-that-ensure-youre-following-best-practices-for-2019/#respond Thu, 11 Jul 2019 17:00:48 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=24886 Connecting with your audience is hard. Building relationships is even harder. Converting those readers into loyal customers can seem so daunting it makes a career change or at least an indefinite sabbatical in the Antarctic look downright reasonable.  Running is for the weak, though, and you’re the kind of ambitious and determined go-getter that’s ready […]

The post 6 Content Marketing Tips That Ensure You’re Following Best Practices for 2019 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Connecting with your audience is hard. Building relationships is even harder. Converting those readers into loyal customers can seem so daunting it makes a career change or at least an indefinite sabbatical in the Antarctic look downright reasonable. 

Running is for the weak, though, and you’re the kind of ambitious and determined go-getter that’s ready to win — you just need a few expert content marketing tips to help you back away from your exit strategy and get back to business.

These suggestions for best practice content marketing should do the trick.

ALSO: Find a professional content writer to power your content marketing 

1. Information as a Conversion Tactic

The public is tiring of blatantly self-serving content. When 71% of buyers turn their nose up at content that doubles as a sales pitch, you know there’s a problem. 

Audiences are smart, and they know when they’re being manipulated. If your Facebook feed is nothing but pats on the back and company-centric blurbs that only share your content, there aren’t many reasons for consumers to continue following. On the other hand, a feed that balances branded content with curated pieces offering tips, how-tos and other valuable tidbits offers value in each and every post.

Still, no business can afford to be completely altruistic, but neither can we give in to the pull of betterment through bragging (unintentional or otherwise). The trick is in finding balance.

“Educational content is definitely favored over promotional nowadays,” says Rachel Cottam, content manager at ZipBooks, “but that doesn’t mean you should give up on conversions. The whole point of a business blog is to acquire new customers. Strategically positioning calls-to-action (CTAs) within blog posts can help to drive sales from content.”

Focus on creating high-quality content in your editorial calendar that informs first, and try to work in CTAs for your products or services in a natural way.

2. Gain Traction by Being Different

Some 60% of marketers generate at least one new piece of content each and every day. That’s an unbelievable amount of collateral floating around the internet and flooding consumers’ bubble, and that makes it increasingly difficult to come up with something interesting and unique.

Ali Schwanke, CEO and Chief Marketing Strategist at Simple Strat, offers a solution that’s helped her company grow traffic from 300 visits per month to over 6,000 monthly visits in less than two years. “Be smart about the content gaps in your industry and how you can leverage them for potential traffic. Use tools like Ahrefs or SEMRush to identify those gaps, along with keyword research to create the content with the right angle that matches what people are looking for online.”

It’s a smart yet efficient approach to content creation that ticks multiple boxes with one stroke. You’re addressing search engine optimization (SEO), which remains an important piece of the puzzle, and you’re going above and beyond the competition’s status-quo content to offer something above and beyond the rest of the noise cluttering everyone’s inbox.

ALSO: Expert Checklist: SEO for Blog Posts

3. Tweak Your Title Tags

While many tips focus on the big picture, sometimes it’s the seemingly small adjustments that have a major impact. For Rochelle Burnside, Content Marketing Specialist at BestCompany.com, there’s power in the humble title tag.

Title tags are bite-sized webpage descriptions that usually total roughly 70 characters (they can be shorter or longer, but Google and other search engines show around 70 characters). There’s just one per page, and it appears in the HTML looking something like this,  “<title>This is the Title Tag</title>”, but also pops up as the headline in your browser tab, in search results, as the placeholder in your bookmarks folder when you save a page and in other places like previews on social media when someone shares a link. It’s easy to see that the right tag can help with visibility and also enhance user experience.

“Experiment with your title tags,” suggests Burnside. “Use a previewer like the Moz title tag viewer to see how your title and meta description will look in the SERP. Use a tool like ClickFlow to measure changes in CTR, clicks, and ranking when you change the title tag. Writing titles in headline style with quantitative data (2019 Update, 4.3 Stars, etc.) and characters like brackets and parentheses are more likely to draw the eye.”

Focusing on your title tags offers a number of benefits:

  1. Title tags are an important SEO ranking factor, so working your target keyword into the title can help boost your search rankings
  2. Having more compelling titles can boost your clickthrough rate in both search results and in social posts. That means more traffic for your content
  3. There’s some evidence that Google’s RankBrain is looking at behavioral metrics including your content’s organic clickthrough rate in its search results and ranking content with higher rates higher in results. 

These are just a few reasons why taking time to optimize your titles is a key part of successful content marketing in 2019. 

Also: Is SEO for Metadata Important to You?

4. Play the Long Game

Content marketing takes time. Looking for immediate results will only lead to disappointment and frustration, so be prepared to think long-term and wait with all the patience you don’t really have (I know, it’s crazy hard). Most experts agree it takes between 6 to 12 months to see a return from a new content marketing campaign. Results come in waves, too; while you may see spikes in traffic and number of backlinks early on, boosted search ranking and more sustainable increases don’t typically emerge until later on.

Use the SMART framework to set goals that are:

  • Specific
  • Measurable
  • Attainable/Actionable
  • Relevant
  • Timely

Schwanke has another tip: “Publish consistently. This seems like a no-nonsense tip, but many companies give up before they see results simply because they didn’t stick with it.”

You’ve taken the time to design a solid content marketing strategy that will connect with your audience; make sure you give it enough time to succeed and continue publishing content regularly.

5. Create Content That Can Multitask

One-trick ponies are a waste of resources. It really is that simple. Pouring time and money into a white paper that’s only useful for one client or one month is akin to running in place and wondering why you’re not getting anywhere. Unless you can turn exhaustion into a currency, you’re going to lose.

Fight financial fatigue and make the most of your freelancers and your marketing budget by creating content that makes sense today, tomorrow and a year from now and that can be modified for use on more than one channel.

Ryan Turner founded The Email Funnels Agency (an agency that helps eCommerce companies get the most out of their email lists) and he knows more than a little about harnessing the power of search, email marketing and Facebook to grow sales. He’s a big believer in adaptable evergreen content as a means to “help you build out a comprehensive content calendar that covers all channels by getting the most out of every piece you create.” That’s huge.

“If the content is evergreen in nature it can also be utilized again later in the year or be placed inside automated marketing sequences which indoctrinate new leads and prospects coming into the business,” continues Turner. “The latter is particularly true in the email channel, and very effective for building strong relationships with potential customers using content pieces which performed well in previous campaigns.

It’s marketing best practices at work, really. You could potentially hire a freelance writer to create a pillar page about travel nursing, then transform that near-encyclopedic guide into a series of shorter blog posts, an infographic, an email campaign, a webinar and a whole host of other microcontent. Those pieces can then be distributed everywhere from LinkedIn to Instagram to your own branded app. 

Transforming or repurposing a pillar piece of content to give you multiple types of content is a great way to maximize your marketing spend, and also lets your naturally cross-promote between channels.

Andrew Clark, Marketing Strategist at Duckpin, uses monthly marketing calendars and a clear-cut template to keep that cornucopia of content organized. “Without some type of brand and content guidelines, a company runs the risk of taking a ‘shoot from the hip’ approach, which may drive away traffic and business opportunities.”

Good digital marketing relies on careful planning. Make sure your calendar specifies not only what pieces of content you’ll create and promote, but also what types of content and where you’ll promote them.

ALSO: Top 6 Challenges in Content Writing for Agencies

6. Use Data to Fuel Every Part of Your Best Practice Content Marketing

Building on Clark’s warning against shooting from the hip, it’s vital to understand how dangerous acts of random marketing can be. Spontaneity is great if you want to surprise your date with a trip to the drive-in or get a pixie cut instead of a blunt bob (actually, you may want to give that one some extra though too), but marketing is a strategy for a reason. Use data to create, monitor and measure your plan and you’ll be better positioned for success.

“Two things truly drive my work in content marketing,” says certified social media marketer and strategist and public relations consultant Sierra Marling of Semper Public Relations, “analytics & user personas. Whenever I utilize platform analytics, I try to align whatever I am posting with what is performing well.”

“For example, videos typically get more results with clients with a Millennial (or younger) following. However I have a specific client whose target audience prefers informational articles and simple photography… That’s why you have to concentrate not only on your post-performance, but you have to also use your analytics data to create detailed user personas that will inform your decisions online.”

There’s one content marketing tip that reigns supreme over all others, and that’s authenticity. You won’t ever win over your audience by trying to be someone else. Consumers have built-in lie detectors that wail at 150 decibels when a brand goes off the rails. If you’re a clothing company that constantly yammers on and on about sustainability and your CEO is caught racking up a couple hundred trips per year on his private jet, you’ve got a messaging problem.

So, make like Dove and “Be Real”. Take all of these tips on board and figure out how you can craft a killer marketing strategy while still honoring everything that makes your brand special. This is how you get ahead in 2019 and stay there.

Have any other content marketing tips you think we should cover? Let us know in the comments.

The post 6 Content Marketing Tips That Ensure You’re Following Best Practices for 2019 appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/6-content-marketing-tips-that-ensure-youre-following-best-practices-for-2019/feed/ 0
Expert Checklist: SEO for Blog Posts https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/expert-checklist-seo-for-blog-posts/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/expert-checklist-seo-for-blog-posts/#respond Tue, 02 Jul 2019 17:00:30 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=24619 Blog posts should never sound like you wrote them solely with SEO in mind. Which is to say, they shouldn’t read like a robotic regurgitation of formulaic keywords and information you garnered from a 90-second internet search. That type of content does nothing to convert consumers, drive up revenue or foster positive behavioral metrics for […]

The post Expert Checklist: SEO for Blog Posts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Blog posts should never sound like you wrote them solely with SEO in mind. Which is to say, they shouldn’t read like a robotic regurgitation of formulaic keywords and information you garnered from a 90-second internet search. That type of content does nothing to convert consumers, drive up revenue or foster positive behavioral metrics for better performance on Google.

But that doesn’t mean SEO for blog posts is something you can ignore. Check out what the experts are doing to ensure viable SEO while also engaging target audiences and driving conversions.

ALSO Hire Blog Post Writers to Craft SEO Friendly Content

1. Blog Content Answers User Questions

Brooks Manley, an SEO Lead for Engenius, says that comprehensive content is a key to good blog post rankings in 2019.

“This doesn’t mean just touching on the subject you write on, but answering every question a user may have on it,” says Manley. “For instance, if you write a blog on how to kill roaches, you need to cover the different kinds of roaches, what products to use, where to buy the products, etc. Google wants to see queries answered with a single click, and posts that do that will be rewarded in 2019.”

You might start with one focus keyword that you want to rank for after doing your keyword research, but that should inform you as you learn more about the search intent behind that keyword.  You’ll discover what questions and related topics are semantically linked to your targeted search queries, which will help guide you when you start writing.

Questions for Hiring Writers

2. Complete Content that Covers Numerous Subtopics

Ryan Underwood, an SEO Specialist & Digital Marketing Executive at YourParkingSpace.co.uk also points to complete content as a critical factor in landing at the top of the search engine results page.

According to Underwood, it’s not just about answering all the right questions. You also have to do the keyword research to understand the various subtopics individuals are interested in when it comes to your main subject.

“Google wants to see that your content is covering a topic in-depth,” says Underwood. “We make sure we show Google this by including subtopic terms. These are terms that are slightly different but are associated with the main topic. For example, if we were writing an article about Harry Potter, subtopic terms could include Hogwarts, Snape, Quidditch, etc. The more of these terms you include, the more Google recognizes that your content covers as many points of interest as possible, and you rise in the rankings.”

Underwood adds, “An easy way to find Subtopic Terms is to type your target keyword into Google Images. A list of words and phrases will appear between the search bar and images. Pick a few of these and scatter them throughout your content.”

Just don’t get too heavy in peppering your page with these types of terms without ensuring they fit in an organic way into content. Keyword stuffing is never a good idea, and you’ll see in some of the expert tips below that user experience is important for SEO. Keywords are still important, but you should aim at creating complete content, not aiming for specific keyword density.

3. Use of Multiple Types of Media to Tell the Story

When talking about search engine optimization, many content marketers often think solely in terms of text on page. But that’s a mistake in the modern market, where people expect to see narratives conveyed via a variety of media.

Luke Wester, Digital Marketing Analyst at eCommerce company Miva, Inc., says, “What’s working for SEO in 2019 are visuals that help tell the story of your blog post. A large portion of users are skim-readers, and visuals make the content easily digestible. In addition to understanding the point of your post quicker, users also tend to stay longer, which increases key metrics like time on site. Basically, when you’re going over your SEO checklist for your next blog, make sure you include visuals that help tell the story of your blog.”

Content Marketing Visuals

4. Video On Pages to Rank Higher

David Sanchez of Mammoth Web Solutions also picks up on the need to encourage more time on your pages. After all, behavioral stats such as time on page, bounce rates and whether someone clicks deeper into your site can all impact your RankBrain score. Which in turn impacts your position in the SERPs — Google wants to provide links to pages consumers find helpful and engaging, and a past history of that type of behavior looks good for your site.

“Use video,” says Sanchez. “Video increases length of time on page, which in turn causes increased rankings.”

5. Authentic Content

You know what else keeps readers on the page? Authenticity they feel like they can connect with.

Sanchez says, “Be intensely honest and personal. To quote Seth Godin, this is the Connection Economy. If people feel connected to you, they’ll trust you, engage more, share your content more, and, in turn, your rankings will increase.”

6. Optimized for Mobile and User Experience

You shouldn’t need an SEO expert to create this box for you, but here it is. Sanchez points out, “Your site cannot take more than two seconds to load anymore, even on cell phones. This is no longer optional.”

The truth is that internet users have many other options, and they won’t hesitate to tap or click their way to them. And with more people accessing the internet on mobile devices than on desktop devices today, you can’t afford not to invest in responsive website design and providing a mobile-friendly experience. Plus, Google’s mobile-first initiative that launched in 2018 means that sites that don’t perform well on mobile get ranked down in the SERPs regardless of other factors.

7. Authoritative Content

Sarah Blocksidge, Web Producer at Sixth City Marketing, reminds content marketers that SEO for blog posts and other content in 2019 relies heavily on authority. “In 2019, for our agency, it’s all about establishing authority. So we are writing informative blog posts on topics that potential clients might be searching for.”

Blocksidge and her agency aren’t alone in chasing authority for online marketing. Google has signaled repeatedly that authority content is important, going so far as to publish its own E-A-T guidelines aimed at helping marketers create more authoritative content.

For a more detailed look at this, check out our article on creating E-A-T content.

Google is rewarding pages that do well according to their E-A-T guidelines with higher placement in the SERPs.  This usually means your site’s posts have expert bylines, bios, links from expert sources, and high-quality content. This is especially true if you’re writing blog posts in certain niches, such as medical, financial or legal. Google (and users) expect to see content that offers in-depth answers and comes from people with the professional experience to back up their words.

8. Content Aligns with Business Goals

The SEO Manager at Brand Buddha reminds content marketers that we’re never writing solely for the search engines. Yes, on-page SEO elements are critical to finding your audience and attracting them to your page, but there’s always a danger in chasing metrics for the sake of those metrics. Make sure you’re putting SEO tips to use in ways that align with business goals. Brand Buddha’s SEO Manager advises “communication with the sales team to come up with content that serves them better.”

If your content doesn’t align with business goals, it’s also possible that it might feel out of place to your visitors in context with the rest of your site. If this happens, your behavioral metrics like time on site and bounce rate might suffer, which could also end up impacting your rankings.

9. Link Internally a Few Times

Don’t forget about the content you’ve already generated. Just because you wrote it two months or even a year ago doesn’t mean there’s no SEO value for those blog posts. Doing some internal linking from new posts to old ones can help older posts get more eyes on them and boost its rankings. Consider:

  • Linking internally to a couple of relevant pages or blog posts to keep readers on your website (and increase those critical behavioral metrics)
  • Make your internal links contextual with the article it’s in and keyword rich with the targeted keywords of the destination post. This can help pass link equity to the destination page, which can boost its rankings.
  • Updating older blog posts with keywords that are performing today to drive more new traffic to your content “backlist”
  • Finding ways to repurpose older content; for example, if you’ve answered a lot of questions about a specific topic in older posts, create a pillar post that addresses the overarching topic, includes relevant keywords and links out to your other posts

Links

Jeremy Harrison of Hustle Life believes internal linking is critical for every blog post’s SEO. “I’ve seen several sites boost rankings and average time on site by refreshing their internal links. I can’t stress enough – when you publish a new post – make sure you’re internal linking is on point.”

10. Link Externally a Few Times

While it’s really important to sculpt your site’s internal links, don’t neglect to link to authority sites in your blog posts. You’ll want to do this for a few reasons:

  • Links to authority sites where readers can dive deeper into topics you cover quickly adds value to your readers
  • Having links to sites considered authorities in your space can associate your site and blog post with those sites in search engines. There’s some evidence this can help your content rank after you publish
  • When linking to authority sources, let them know you did. Often they’ll promote your post and their contribution there, which helps you get some visitors, social shares, and possibly even some backlinks.

It’s important not to go crazy with outbound links in your posts, but when done properly, they can add real value to your posts.

11. Meta Description and Other Tags are SEO-Friendly

Keywords aren’t just for the text content that readers see. Remember to include your keywords in title tags, image alt tags and meta descriptions. When possible, incorporate secondary or long-tail keywords into these locations too — search engine bots crawl all of this information, and when you include keywords here, it points to increased relevance. Title tags and alt image tags are direct ranking factors, so it’s critical you do this.

Including focus keywords in your meta descriptions has an indirect impact on search rankings as well, since search engines highlight keywords in the descriptions that they show in search results. This can boost your organic clickthrough rate, which not only gets you more clicks, it also serves as an indirect ranking factor through Google’s RankBrain. If you want to rank in Google search results, doing well with RankBrain is key.

For a full look at this, check out our article on SEO for metadata.

12. Schema Markup and Structured Data

It’s always advisable to look at your post to see which schema markups and structured data formats you can include on your content for a variety of reasons. While there’s no conclusive evidence that schema and structured data has a direct impact on rankings or getting featured in Google’s featured snippets (position 0 as its often called), many SEO experts have found that to be the case.

At very least, schema helps search engines better understand what your content is and that has a number of benefits including improving how your link appears in search engines.

By setting markup like the one for articles, Google may be able to pull additional fields such as adding the “last updated” field or including an image when displaying your post in their search results. That can make your post more attractive to searchers, which can boost your organic clickthrough rate and help your rankings.

For a full list of marking up your blog posts, check out Google’s guide to article markup here.

Similarly, consider using the FAQ or how-to structured data types when creating your next blog posts. At the very least, Google looks to content formatted like this when pulling content for their FAQ and How-to featured snippets, so even if structured data itself doesn’t help you get placement in the snippet, following their formatting guidelines might help.

13. CTA or Encouragement to Engage

Finally, encourage your audience to like, share, link to or engage with your blog posts. This type of engagement can be a boon to SEO for blog posts in numerous ways. First, linking to or sharing your blog posts on social media creates more backlinks and referring domains to your content. That’s a major factor that can increase your performance in the SERPs. Next, the more time someone spends engaging with your content, the better your behavioral metrics are. Again, that’s good for search engine placement.

Call to Action

To see how social media affects SEO, read Social Media: How Does it Impact Your SEO in 2019?

Get Content that Enhances SEO for Blog Posts Today

If you’re ready to publish blog content that serves you well on both the sales and SEO fronts, consider working with the teams at Crowd Content. Whether you want someone to manage the entire process or you just want to find a writer or two who can craft blog content that helps you move toward success with business goals, we can help.

The post Expert Checklist: SEO for Blog Posts appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/expert-checklist-seo-for-blog-posts/feed/ 0
What is Copywriting and What Are Its Best Practices for 2023? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-copywriting-in-2023/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-copywriting-in-2023/#respond Tue, 25 Jun 2019 17:00:07 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=24394 Technically, copywriting occurs whenever you create content for promotional, advertising or marketing materials. Your blog posts, social media posts and Google text ads are all copy. So is the content in marketing emails, case studies, catalogs and website landing pages, because these are all tools meant to market or sell your products or brand. But […]

The post What is Copywriting and What Are Its Best Practices for 2023? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Technically, copywriting occurs whenever you create content for promotional, advertising or marketing materials. Your blog posts, social media posts and Google text ads are all copy. So is the content in marketing emails, case studies, catalogs and website landing pages, because these are all tools meant to market or sell your products or brand.

But good copywriters know that there’s a lot more going on than words on the page. Here’s what you need to know about copywriting for modern marketing purposes.

So, What Is Copywriting in 2023?

It’s exactly what good copywriting has always been: Engaging content that focuses on the needs and desires of the consumer and connecting those with your business goals. But to succeed in marketing today, you need to produce excellent copy that accomplishes numerous things — or hire freelance copywriters who can do it for you.

Some things copywriting in 2019 and beyond must accomplish and include:

  • Connecting with consumers in an authentic and authoritative manner
  • Presenting your brand as a trustworthy expert
  • Jumping through SEO hoops to enhance your site’s performance in the search engines
  • Providing the right type of information for consumers in specific parts of the buying journey
  • Persuading consumers to take the next step (signing up, clicking through or making a purchase)

ALSO: Do You Need a Content Writer or a Copywriter?

Photo of a copywriter writing copy for a landing page

7 Traits of Professional Copywriting

So, how do you write copy that does all those things? Whether you’re crafting a clever call to action or paying a freelancer to create content marketing materials, understanding what good copy looks like and does is important. These seven traits of successful, professional copywriting epitomize what copywriting is in 2019.

1. Consumer-Facing

Here’s the deal: Consumers want content that meets their needs. Obviously, right? But Google wants content that meets consumer needs too. So this one is a double-edged sword — how well your content performs for a specific person doesn’t just impact whether you make that sale. It could affect whether you get a chance at a future opportunity.

Good copywriters identify consumer motivations and create content that speaks directly to those motivations. Rather than avoiding consumer questions, good copywriting addresses them upfront. If you bury the information, you force consumers to leave your site to find what they seek. When that happens, you lose the sale and your behavioral metrics (such as time on page and bounce rate) are negatively impacted. That can lead to poorer performance in the search engines.

2. Authentic to Brand

Authenticity is increasingly important in today’s marketplace. Consumers are wary of fake information online and savvy about avoiding phishing schemes or click bait. The gig is up, and many people understand that not all content on the internet is coming from a place of expertise and authenticity.

That makes it critical for you to uphold your brand voice — and mission, vision and values — in all copywriting and marketing efforts. If you or one of your writers strays from those foundations, consumers may not believe the content is coming from you or they may begin to question your message.

3. Social

Web pages certainly don’t exist in a vacuum, and it’s important to understand that all your copy is connected. Whether you mean to or not, your channels will overlap, and being proactive about this helps you make the most of your content marketing and copywriting efforts.

In 2019, copywriting is social; you must approach it with the concept of likes, shares, comments and other engagement in mind. Consider how you can:

  • Integrate short answers into content that can be picked up as featured snippets
  • Create one-liners that are Tweetable
  • Ask questions to invite consumers to join the conversation
  • Weave an overarching culture through all of your copy so that it works as a whole

How to Attract New Clients on Social Media

4. Visual

Technological advances have led to more visual capability in the form of images and video. Online copywriters have always had to be sensitive to the way their words appear on the screen, but now they must find ways to incorporate visuals to remain competitive and hold the user’s interest. A good copywriter understands which text elements should be incorporated into graphic elements and how to translate a blog post into an engaging video.

5. Mobile-Ready

As of 2015, mobile phone access to the internet exceeded desktop access. By 2019, more than 63% of individuals were accessing the web on smartphones or tablets, and that number is going to continue to trend up. You can’t afford not to write for mobile users.

Mobile-ready copywriting includes:

  • Short paragraphs to avoid walls of text on mobile devices
  • Bullet points and subheadings to break up text further
  • White space that makes the content easier to read on any screen

6. Always Optimized

No element of your digital content should ever be published without being optimized for search engines. If it exists on your webpage, social profiles, Google My Business page or a guest post you write for someone else, then it is copywriting that has the power to draw organic traffic — which means it needs to include the right keywords in the right places.

Make sure you or your writers are conducting keyword research and placing those phrases:

  • In page titles and meta descriptions
  • In H1 headers
  • In H2 and H3 subheadings
  • In the first paragraph of content, if possible
  • A few times throughout the rest of the content on the page
  • In alt image tags

ALSO: Copywriting for SEO

7. Aligns With Business Goals

Finally, make sure that copywriting aligns with your short-term and long-term business goals. Content marketing is complex in this digital age, and it’s easy to get lost in analyzing the metrics and reach for the wrong star. For example, many brands get caught up in the chase for organic search traffic and end up targeting keywords that get them thousands of views. But if those are the wrong views, you’re not going to drive sales or revenue.

It’s better to have 100 views with 50 that convert than 1,000 views with only 10 that convert. Always keep the bottom line in mind.

What Are Some Common Types of Copywriting Jobs or Projects?

The traits of good copywriting can be applied to all types of content marketing projects. Here are just a few types of copywriting your brand may require.

  • Product descriptions use strong marketing language to educate consumers about the features and benefits of a product, often painting a picture so the person sees themselves using or enjoying the product. The goal is to persuade the consumer to make a purchase.
  • Landing pages are the first port for consumers who journey in from ad links or organic search results. Content on these pages should address the likely needs and questions of the consumer in whatever portion of the buying journey you’re targeting and include a call to action for the next step.
  • Sales letters or emails are often targeted to specific audience segments or those who have taken some previous action, such as signing up for a newsletter. These messages can be informative, entertaining or even a hard sell, but they should all attempt to enhance the consumer relationship with your brand and include a call to action of some type (to click a link, respond, make an appointment or call).
  • Blog posts are typically less hard sell and more brand development; the copy on these pages tends to be educational or entertaining and is meant to create your brand culture, position you as a leader in the industry or provide something of value readers are likely to share.
  • Social media posts are similar to blog posts, except much shorter.
  • Long-form marketing collateral can include white papers, case studies and even eBooks. The point of these pieces is to position your company as a thought leader or to operate as a lead generating tool. For example, you may offer a free ebook answering common questions about a topic in your niche for anyone who signs up for your email newsletter.

ALSO: Can You Outsource Landing Page Copywriting?

Find Copywriters for All Your Content Marketing Needs

Whether you need cleverly worded product descriptions or eBooks that position you as an expert, discover copywriters at Crowd Content who know what it takes to get the job done in 2019.

The post What is Copywriting and What Are Its Best Practices for 2023? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-copywriting-in-2023/feed/ 0
Google’s June 2019 Core Update: What You Need to Know https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/news/googles-june-2019-core-update-what-you-need-to-know/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/news/googles-june-2019-core-update-what-you-need-to-know/#respond Fri, 21 Jun 2019 15:15:18 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=24523 Google’s broad core updates in early June have left some brands staggering in the wake of lost traffic. Some of the ramifications of the update weren’t a surprise for those following trends in the wake up the previous Medic update, but a shake-up in the SERPs is always a game of Russian roulette for companies […]

The post Google’s June 2019 Core Update: What You Need to Know appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Google’s broad core updates in early June have left some brands staggering in the wake of lost traffic. Some of the ramifications of the update weren’t a surprise for those following trends in the wake up the previous Medic update, but a shake-up in the SERPs is always a game of Russian roulette for companies that rely heavily on organic traffic to fill the coffers.

Here’s what you need to know about Google’s June 2019 Core update.

What Is a Core Update?

Core updates are an overall optimization of Google’s algorithm based on broad principles instead of a targeted update on any one particular element or ranking factor. They’re not “maintenance” work meant to fix a specific, identified problem.

Updates such as Panda or Penguin were targeted — specifically meant to target issues such as the quality of backlinks or content. The June core update may include some changes related to quality, but it wasn’t specifically geared toward that.

When releasing core updates Google always advises there isn’t anything you need to “fix” to recover lost rankings. Moreover, you just need to do all the essential SEO things well including writing great SEO content, providing great user experience, being mobile friendly, having fast page speeds, building healthy backlinks, and updating your site often.

Takeaways and Talking Points for Google’s June 2019 Core Update

Let’s start by looking over some of the expert talking points of this broad core algorithm update and what they mean for brands and content marketers.

1. Google Announced the Update

Google announced the update via Twitter a day ahead of time to give the SEO community a heads up. This is the first time news about an update was broken by Google and ahead of the game.

The benefit of the announcement is that brands could monitor their SEO performance and traffic immediately to understand how they were impacted instead of second guessing after traffic changed.

The takeaway is that, whether or not Google continues to notify the community of updates in the future, it’s important for content marketers to follow industry leaders and keep up with trends and news.

2. The Core Update Overlapped With the Diversity Update

The core update rolled out from June 3 through June 8. The diversity update(which aimed to show links from different domains in search results instead of showing many links from one domain) rolled out from June 4 through June 6.

The takeaway for brands is that paying attention to when traffic changes began is critical to understand which update might be impacting you. That lets you know what types of changes may be needed in the future.

3. The June Update Reverted Some of the March Update

Some of the March core updates seem to have been reverted with the June update, based on losers in March becoming winners in June.

The takeaway is that you can’t ride or die based on Google updates that occur a few times per year. You have to find what works for your audience and concentrate on delivering high-quality content that serves consumer needs.

4. Video Carousels Get More Action

The June 2019 update did more than shake up search traffic. It also caused some changes to the SERPs themselves, with more video carousels appearing on desktop following the update.

The takeaway here isn’t very specific. This does point to Google signaling the continued value increase for video, which is something all content marketers should consider in the image-and-media-based market today.

Winners and Losers From June’s Update

SEO data companies, including Search Engine Land, are able to provide specific lists of winners and losers of the Google June 2019 core update. But the consensus seems to be that:

  • E-A-T content is still important to success in the SERPs
  • Google continues to look for authority and authorship, especially in YMYL (your money, your life) arenas
  • The June update did seem to target news sites with low-quality content or low-quality topics

ALSOHow Creating Content With E-A-T In Mind Can Help Future-Proof Your Site Against Algorithm Changes

Some Advice From the SEO Community in the Wake of June’s Core Update

1. Concentrate on E-A-T Content

Arren Wilkinson, the SEO Manager at 52fridays says, “It’s clear to me that the June 2019 update heavily penalized sites that are lacking in E-A-T. Of most of our client sites that seemed to suffer the most, all were lacking in expertise in their editorial content. These sites also suffered during the Medic update of 2019.”

In the wake of these broad core updates, Wilkinson says, “My best piece of advice would be to work solely on improving your E-A-T; get experts to contribute to your editorial content, get cited from experts in your niche, and be transparent with your users (explain how your site makes money, its business model, etc.).”

Marissa Ryan, a Managing Partner at VisualFizz, goes even further, stating that author bios for your blog posts should read like resumes. She notes that bios should prove “the writer’s expertise in your industry by linking to other projects, other writings and other brands.”

Ryan also says companies should avoid using one author for all content. “You should have multiple writers on your blog.”

This advice about authority and E-A-T content is important for all companies, but it’s especially critical for YMYL brands as Google is paying increasing attention to the quality and authority of that content.

2. Remember That Search Algorithms Constantly Evolve

Audrey Strasenburgh, SEO Strategist at FreeLogoServices, points out that brands gain and lose traffic based on different algorithm tweaks. Strasenburgh says, “The general consensus is that websites that were severely impacted during the March algorithm update saw marked increases in site visibility after the June update. FreeLogoServices, in particular, saw an increase in SERPs after the June update where we did not fare as well in March.”

The takeaway for online brands and marketers is that lost rankings can be found again, and sometimes it’s about consistently churning good content while the dust settles in the SERPs.

ALSOCrash Course: How to Become an SEO Content Writer

3. Update Content to Reflect Search Intent and User Need

Victor Pan, the Principle Technical SEO at HubSpot, agrees that Google algorithm changes come and go and there’s no magic fix for companies that lose ranking when the search engine tweaks its processes.

“There’s no magic bullet for dealing with these core algorithm updates,” says Pan, “but what everyone can do is look at their content that lost visibility and traffic, look at the SERPS of those pages, empathize with the user’s need, based on device time, location, time of day or need state, what search features are showing up… and then update the content to address those gaps. Time and time again, the best content wins. One-and-done evergreen content is dead. Periodically updated evergreen content is the new norm.”

Victor Quote Google

Ryan agrees, saying, “if your website hasn’t had any updates in a while (more than 6 months), you may have noticed a steep decline in organic traffic. Update your static pages, and make sure to contribute to your site at least once a week.”

The take-aways here are:

  • Web pages can’t be left on the shelf to rot; you have to take them down and dust them off periodically
  • Google is about serving the intent and need of the user, and it’s going to continue placing pages that meet those demands in the top ranks
  • You can’t avoid analyzing the performance of your pages; if you don’t know which of your pages are performing well and which aren’t, you’re missing out on valuable knowledge that can help you create higher-ranking content going forward

4. Differentiate Your Pages

According to Ryan, pages on your site with similar content won’t all stand on Google.

“Brands, especially eCommerce brands, found that many of their product pages became unindexed from Google.” says Ryan. “This is because of Google’s canonical push, which means that if Google determined several pages on your website were too similar, they would only index one of those pages and consider it the canonical version of all the other pages that were very similar. If this happened to you, update your individual product/service pages to be completely unique and give lots of info about the product/service. Then, push to the Google search console for a recrawl.”

5. Ensure Your Site Supports Strong User Experience for Desktop and Mobile

Michael Zima, Co-Founder of Zima Media, LLC, wraps it all up by returning to the need to support the user.

“We have to remember that Google’s mission is to make the information of the world available in one click,” says Zima. “Now more than ever, your website content has to solve the searcher’s intent, visiting your website has to be a pleasure with a modern experience and everything has to be blazing fast since the mass rollout of the Google mobile-first indexing. We know Google is prioritizing the mobile version of your website for both searchers coming from either mobile devices or desktop computers as implied by the mobile-first name.”

Zima likens well-performing sites to Swiss army knives, unfolding with many utilities for the user. To accomplish that, he says, “We see more and more success by creating a reliable pillar webpage to bring more qualified clicks from Google by creating a meaningful piece of content instead of sprinting and creating several weaker and shorter pages.”

The post Google’s June 2019 Core Update: What You Need to Know appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/news/googles-june-2019-core-update-what-you-need-to-know/feed/ 0
What Freelancers Need to Know About Writing Amazon Product Descriptions https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/everything-you-need-to-know-about-writing-product-descriptions-for-amazon/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/everything-you-need-to-know-about-writing-product-descriptions-for-amazon/#respond Thu, 13 Jun 2019 19:00:43 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=24217 Amazon has an enormous share of the American eCommerce market. In 2018, the retail giant was controlling just under half the industry, capturing 49% of eCommerce and 5% of all retail spending for the nation. Those numbers include third-party sellers on Amazon, as well as direct sales from the giant itself. As of 2019, more than 5 million sellers hawked their […]

The post What Freelancers Need to Know About Writing Amazon Product Descriptions appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Amazon has an enormous share of the American eCommerce market. In 2018, the retail giant was controlling just under half the industry, capturing 49% of eCommerce and 5% of all retail spending for the nation.

Those numbers include third-party sellers on Amazon, as well as direct sales from the giant itself. As of 2019, more than 5 million sellers hawked their wares on the Amazon marketplace, with more than a million Amazon sellers joining the ranks in the last year alone. Those sellers are divided across 12 markets globally, but wherever you’re working as a freelance product description writer, Amazon provides an opportunity for branching out into a specialty: writing Amazon product descriptions.

An Amazon product description writer helps clients who sell in the Amazon marketplace ensure their items appear in search results and listing pages and increase conversion rates via well-written marketing copy. Here are seven tips for becoming the best Amazon product description writer you can to keep clients coming back for more.

1. Write to Capture Conversions During Micro Moments

Roughly 90% of people check prices on Amazon even when they’re shopping elsewhere. They also turn to Amazon as a retail search engine, bypassing Google to get quick facts about goods on the retail site. Keep this in mind when writing Amazon listing copy. During a micro moment, the person is thinking about the product and may even consider making a purchase, but you only have a few seconds to capture their interest.

  • Keep PDs short whenever possible
  • Follow journalistic best practices and lead with the “meat;” in product copy, that means putting the best selling points first
  • Organize information in a way that’s logical for browsers; if the item isn’t the right size, they won’t want to waste their time reading more

2. Optimize Descriptions with the Right Keywords

Amazon’s algorithm takes both sales page content and CTS into account when positioning products in its search results. CTS is a reflection of the number of people who click on products and then actually purchase them.

Only 30% of people even click to the second page of Amazon product results, so it’s critical to land as high in the results as possible for your targeted search terms.

As an Amazon product description copywriter, you can help your clients achieve this important goal by incorporating the right keyword phrases into your descriptions. If clients don’t provide keywords, do some quick research to find out how people are searching on Amazon for these types of products. Then, include those phrases in the product title and the first and last sentences of your description whenever possible.

ALSO: Watch This Webinar to Learn the Secret to Creating Product Descriptions

3. Don’t Forget to Write with Google in Mind

Google does index Amazon product listings, so keep search engine optimization in mind when you’re writing. You might include top Google keywords alongside Amazon keywords — these aren’t necessarily the same thing.

Just remember — focus on delivering a good customer experience and don’t sacrifice it trying to include too many keywords.

You should also keep snippets in mind; Google will automatically pull a helpful snippet straight from product descriptions and use it in the meta description position in the search results. Keep that 160-ish character limit in mind when you’re crafting the first sentence or two of your Amazon PD; would it make a good hook when appearing in the search engine results?

ALSO: 3 Ways to Improve Your Product Page SEO

4. Write in Feature/Benefit Format

Use strong marketing copy practices, including writing about features and benefits. Since most Amazon product descriptions appear alongside images of the goods and specification listings, you can concentrate more on the benefits instead of describing exactly what the item looks like.

5. Use Bullets and White Space to Make Content Easy to Scan

When someone is perusing products online, they may be comparing numerous items or taking a quick gander into the eCommerce options while they’re standing in a physical store. The point here is this: no one has time to sift through bulky product descriptions or face down huge paragraphs of text.

Write Amazon PDs that are easy to scan so individuals can look for the specific information they require. Some tips include:

  • Using bullet points to list key features with related benefits
  • Including line breaks between short paragraphs to increase white space
  • Organize your PD with key features and benefits up front and sample use cases or less important considerations toward the bottom
  • Format all PDs for a brand the same way for easy scannability and brand recognition

6. Study Amazon’s Rules for Product Description Content

Did you know Amazon has its own style guide? That’s definitely something professional Amazon copywriters need to be aware of.

The Amazon Services Quick Start Style Guide offers concise information on best practices and rules for formatting Amazon product descriptions. For example, product titles can’t be more than 200 characters and Amazon has some preferences for capitalization.

Amazon also publishes rules for descriptions related to specific types of products. It doesn’t allow descriptions that include spoilers related to media products such as movies and books, for example.

Knowing the rules for various listing types helps Amazon product description writers provide viable content for clients. And when clients can upload your content without worrying about a negative impact on their listing status, they’ll remember you for future jobs.

7. Check Out the Product Descriptions of High-Performing Products

Finally, check out what other brands — especially the top performers — are doing when it comes to Amazon product descriptions. By considering the descriptions that already help products rank high, you can understand what types of keywords are working for various types of goods. You can also get ideas about how to format, phrase and build Amazon product descriptions that best serve your target audience and perform well for clients.

ALSO: 3 Examples of Great Product Descriptions that Convert and Rank

Become an Amazon Product Description Writer

Does it take some time and work to become an effective Amazon product description writer? Yes. You have to keep up with Amazon’s style guide and requirements as well as general best practices for SEO and marketing copy. But with the eCommerce giant taking an ever bigger piece of the pie, honing your Amazon PD writing skills can mean a big payoff down the line.

The post What Freelancers Need to Know About Writing Amazon Product Descriptions appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/everything-you-need-to-know-about-writing-product-descriptions-for-amazon/feed/ 0
How Can PR Support Your Content Marketing Strategy? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-press-releases-support-your-content-marketing-strategy/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-press-releases-support-your-content-marketing-strategy/#respond Mon, 10 Jun 2019 15:15:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=24163 News flash: Press releases aren’t the outdated rotary phones of marketing you may think they are. While it’s true we no longer rely solely on PRs to let journalists know about an event or appearance, we’ve found a new use for these handy pieces of communicatory collateral. Learning how press releases support your content marketing […]

The post How Can PR Support Your Content Marketing Strategy? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

News flash: Press releases aren’t the outdated rotary phones of marketing you may think they are. While it’s true we no longer rely solely on PRs to let journalists know about an event or appearance, we’ve found a new use for these handy pieces of communicatory collateral.

Learning how press releases support your content marketing strategy can help you get more bang for your buck out of every blog, social post and white paper, and that’s something worth talking about.

AlSO Find out how to hire the web’s best press release writers

Combining PR and Marketing

Whether you’re a new startup, a global Fortune 500 company or something in between, press releases will work for you on some level because they revolve around a story. And everyone has a story.

While it’s true that journalists are still probably going to pay more attention to big companies than small ones, a great press release (built around an equally great story) can help you gain traction as journalists pick up your release and pass it on. And that’s an important point — though you’ll see press releases pulling double duty in your online newsroom or as extra collateral for your social media pages (more on that in a moment), your primary audience is still journalists rather than end users. Keeping that in mind as you create and distribute could go a long way toward helping you shape content that resonates with the people who have the power to pass on your news.

But how does PR support content marketing? Skilled PR teams and professionals craft press releases that they distribute to journalists, journalists and bloggers that they can use as inspiration to write articles about.

As you’re designing your next marketing program, consider if you could build in a PR campaign to support it. If you’re able to get your story picked up by journalists in significant and industry relevant publications, that can get a lot more eyes on your content as well as some powerful backlinks.

You can create press releases with a customer-centric bent and use it to tell a tale your audience wants to hear:

  • Announce your newest celebrity endorsement or an appearance by a local sports star
  • Discuss how your upcoming fundraiser will benefit neighborhood initiatives
  • Share why your small business block party is going to be kid-friendly
  • Highlight what problems your new ebook will help solve

Man reading news on a tablet with a cup of coffee next to him

Use Press Releases to Support Your Content Strategy Via an Online Newsroom

As the owner of Redhead Marketing & PR, Hilary Reiter has a plethora of experience in both content marketing and public relations. She advises clients to include press releases in the newsroom of their website as “this helps them keep their content fresh to enhance organic SEO.”

Combine those PRs with in-house announcements, messages from the founder and other time-sensitive tidbits, and you’ll maintain a steady flow of information without being repetitive or sacrificing cohesion.

In addition to keeping your site’s content fresh, a newsroom adds a sense of legitimacy to any company’s site which can help build trust with your audience.

Press Releases Can Help Drive Traffic

Reiter’s multipronged approach to press releases also includes a dash of social media strategy. After all, your content is useless if nobody’s reading it, and with two-thirds of adults on Facebook, most on a daily basis, social platforms are an invaluable resource for anyone hoping to build readership.

“We advise them to link their press releases from social media to drive traffic to the site,” says Reiter. “Distributing press releases to media to get 3rd party coverage and credibility results in greater awareness as well as referral links that drive traffic to your website.”

ALSOHow Social Media Impacts Your SEO in 2019

Keri Lindenmuth, marketing manager at KDG, uses weekly press releases to fuel his company’s content marketing strategy and stay ahead of the competition. “To find a topic for our press release, we first look at our keyword rankings. If there is a keyword that seems to be struggling or a keyword that our competitors are catching up on, we’ll put out a press release concentrating on that keyword and link back to our website.”

Follow Keri’s advice and you’ll usually garner the added benefit of publications writing about that keyword and linking back to your site which can help rankings even further with powerful contextual backlinks.

ALSO5 Tips for Optimizing Your Press Release

Man reviewing SEO report on a laptop

Establish and Expand Your Authority

Most content creators have two primary goals: creating pieces that are SEO-driven and those that capitalize on thought leadership. The value of SEO is indisputable, but thought leadership is far more underutilized. By becoming an authority in your field, you insert yourself into the public conscious as the go-to source for industry trends, new ideas, and interesting takes on existing concepts. People build entire businesses on the back of their authority, and according to Michelle Calcote King, founder of PR and content marketing agency Reputation Ink, press releases can help get the word out in a big way.

“If [the content] is thought leadership-driven,” says Calcote King, “the press release can announce important content pieces that you want your target audience to be aware of (i.e. announcing an e-book, research report, etc.). The fact that you’ve created a resource for your audience can be news. You can also announce speeches, industry involvement, etc. — anything that will build a reputation for being a thought leader in your space.”

Anyone can hold a seminar on personal finance or self-publish a book on flipping houses, but only someone with a sound content marketing strategy that incorporates press releases will get maximum exposure when time in the spotlight matters most.

Getting Your Press Releases to Journalists and Influencers

Once you get the hang of writing press releases, you have to know where to send them. You can distribute the PRs yourself via social media, as part of your email marketing plan (a great way to flesh out your newsletters), or on your website, or you can hire a professional press release company. Many PR pros build media contact lists as well, and pitch those contacts to write stories about their latest press release (often offering early access to the press release to help them get a jump on competing publications).

News wire distribution agencies know which publications are best suited for the topic at hand and they likely have relationships and contacts you don’t.

Reiter recommends services such as PRWeb to help boost online visibility while minimizing the burden on your in-house resources. Lindenmuth favors multiple distribution points. “EINPresswire is a paid platform, but it is perhaps the best for building backlinks across the web. It submits your press release to hundreds of news outlets. PRLog is a free service that also lets you include links back to your website. Using both sites together, and distributing a press release weekly, ensures that fresh, new content about your site is always on the web, which does wonders for SEO.”

Marketing reading about how PR supports content marketing on her laptop

Distributing press releases is a specialty job, and sometimes it’s best to have specialty help.

As with most things in marketing, writing content alone won’t guarantee success. By using press releases to support your overall content marketing strategy, you help your brand gain visibility, build authority, improve search rankings and reach journalists who act as your conduit to a new, larger audience. Focus on careful integration and look at your press releases from the audience’s point of view and you may soon see just how relevant PRs continue to be.

Need help mastering the art of the press release? Hire a professional press release writer and get your story the attention it deserves.

The post How Can PR Support Your Content Marketing Strategy? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-press-releases-support-your-content-marketing-strategy/feed/ 0
Social Media SEO: Essential for Businesses in Every Industry https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/social-media-seo/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/social-media-seo/#respond Thu, 30 May 2019 19:21:55 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=24031 Search engine optimization, commonly called SEO, is a set of techniques used to improve a website’s search engine rankings. The higher your pages rank, the more visitors you’re likely to attract, leading to increased sales. Although social media usage doesn’t directly influence your page rankings, it can help you drive more traffic to your website, […]

The post Social Media SEO: Essential for Businesses in Every Industry appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Search engine optimization, commonly called SEO, is a set of techniques used to improve a website’s search engine rankings. The higher your pages rank, the more visitors you’re likely to attract, leading to increased sales.

Although social media usage doesn’t directly influence your page rankings, it can help you drive more traffic to your website, making it an essential component of an SEO plan. Keep reading to learn more about the importance of social media SEO for business.

How Social Media Usage Affects SEO

Just because social media usage doesn’t directly influence your rankings doesn’t mean you don’t need to use Facebook, Twitter and other social networks to grow your business. Social media SEO affects your rankings indirectly in the following ways:

Backlinks

Backlinks are one of the most important factors in determining how well a page will rank compared to competing pages on the same topic. In simple terms, a backlink is a link that refers to another website. If you cite a subject matter expert in one of your blog posts and link back to that expert’s site, you’re giving them a backlink. Google and other search engines place a lot of emphasis on backlinks because these links represent a “seal of approval” of sorts. Linking to a site shows you think the site has something worth reading or viewing.

Done right, social media SEO gives you an opportunity to collect backlinks from authoritative websites, increasing your site’s overall authority. For example, if one of your blog posts “goes viral,” you’re likely to receive backlinks from major media outlets and established influencers.

December-January-IG-FB-Posts-13

Site Authority

Social media SEO also helps you build a positive reputation and establish authority in your industry. Think about the process you follow when you need to buy something online. You probably type product-related keywords into your search engine, look through the results and visit the website with the most relevant information. But what if multiple sites sell the same item at the same price? You need a way to determine which site to visit. That’s where authority comes into play.

The more social media accounts you maintain, the more opportunities you have to share your brand. If people search for what you sell and see your company’s name showing up on Facebook, Instagram and other networks, they may feel more comfortable buying from you or at least visiting your website to get more information.

Search Results

With many people now using social networks as search engines, it’s more important than ever for your business to have a strong social media presence. This is especially important if you run a business that makes the bulk of its revenue from local customers, such as a restaurant or roofing company. Instead of opening a separate browser window, navigating to Google or Bing and searching for companies, products and services, some users just type their queries right into the search bar of their favourite social network. If you don’t have a profile on that network, you won’t show up in these searches.

Traffic Source

The more pages you control, the more opportunities you have for people to find your business and learn more about what you do. If you have a single website with a few pages on it, you have few opportunities to show up in search results for relevant keywords. When you use social media, however, you’re producing additional content that can help people find your business. If someone searches for relevant keywords, they may find one of your Facebook posts, tweets or Instagram photos.

Social Media SEO Tips to Grow Your Business

It’s clear that social media SEO has positive benefits for business owners, but it’s important to develop a cohesive strategy that helps you achieve your SEO goals. Here’s what we recommend. If you need help writing tweets, Facebook posts and other types of content, our team of experienced professionals can help.

Partner with Influencers

According to Neil Patel, an influencer is someone who serves as an expert within a specific community. On social media, influencers may write thought leadership pieces, review products related to their areas of expertise or promote specific brands. Partnering with influencers in your industry has several potential benefits for your business. One of those benefits is exposure to a much larger audience. Influencers may have hundreds of thousands—or even millions—of followers. If just a small percentage of an influencer’s audience sees a post about your products or services, you could experience a surge in site traffic and sales.

Working with an influencer also gives you the opportunity to strengthen your brand. Depending on how you structure the partnership, the influencer may agree to post about your product a certain number of times or do a video review that features your product prominently. Every post is an opportunity for an audience member to see your logo or hear your company name. Partnering with an influencer can even help your brand seem more legitimate, especially if you work with someone who has a positive reputation in your industry.

Christian Anderson, president of Lost Boys entertainment, offers the following tips for identifying influencers in your industry and partnering with them to promote your brand:

  1. Check with an agency. Some agencies represent multiple influencers, so contacting a single agent could help you identify several potential partnerships. Agents also have experience making sure an influencer’s content aligns well with a brand’s goals. Therefore, working with an agent can help you avoid partnering with an influencer who could damage your brand instead of helping you build it.
  2. Contact influencers directly. This takes much more time than contacting an agency because you need to research your industry and determine which influencers have the largest audiences. You also need to determine if each influencer posts content that aligns with your goals. Although this is time-consuming, it can also help you get better pricing.
  3. Be clear about your goals. You must provide enough information for the influencer to make an informed decision about whether they want to partner with you. It’s important to be clear about what you expect in terms of content type, content length and publishing frequency.

Focus on Engagement

Many business owners make the mistake of thinking content frequency is more important than content quality. That couldn’t be further from the truth. While the search engines do take publication frequency into account when determining page rankings, they also look for quality signals to tell them if one page is more relevant than another for a specific keyword. It’s better to publish high-quality content three times per week than low-quality content every day.

One way to make your content more engaging is to include photos and videos. Huge walls of text are a barrier to engagement because they make your content more difficult to read. It also takes a lot more time to read a long post than it does to look at a photo or view a 30-second video. Another way to increase engagement is to skip the stock photos and do your own photography. You don’t have to be the next Ansel Adams to take photos for Instagram or Facebook; simply use a point-and-shoot digital camera or the built-in camera on your cell phone to snap photos of your products or employees.

December-January-IG-FB-Posts-14

Pick the Right Platforms

Facebook, TikTok, Snapchat, Instagram…the list of social media platforms seem endless, especially if you don’t have experience using social media for SEO. The good news is that you don’t need to be on every single platform—just the platforms where people in your target audience are likely to hang out. Nearly 80% of adults between the ages of 30 and 49 use Facebook, but only 48% of them use Instagram. If your target audience includes adults in this age group, using Facebook is a better use of your time than using Instagram.

Age is an important consideration, but it isn’t the only factor you should use to determine where to spend your time online. You also need to consider race, ethnicity, sex and household income. If you sell a high-end product, it’s important to know that 50% of adults who earn more than $75,000 per year use LinkedIn. Adult women are more active on the top three platforms—Facebook, Instagram and LinkedIn—than adult men, a fact that can help you determine the best way to spend your time and your marketing dollars.

Repurpose Your Content

You shouldn’t post the exact same thing on multiple platforms; that would defeat the purpose of using more than one social network to improve your page rankings, drive traffic to your website and connect with members of your target audience. But that doesn’t mean you can’t repurpose your content to save time. Repurposing involves taking your existing content and using it as the basis for new content. This eliminates the need to “reinvent the wheel” and keep coming up with new ideas. Here are a few examples of content repurposing:

  • A few years ago, you wrote a blog post on how to use your product to save time or increase efficiency. You can repurpose the content by updating it with recent statistics and editing some of the content based on current best practices in your industry. Sharing a link to the updated blog post gives the content new life and eliminates the need to come up with a brand-new idea and write a blog post from scratch.
  • You have an e-book that introduces potential customers to your business and provides an overview of your products and services. If the e-book contains statistics, you can add those statistics to infographics and share them with your social media followers.
  • If you have a podcast related to your business, you can link to the transcripts on Facebook or post “behind-the-scenes” videos on your Instagram account. Not only does this help you repurpose your original podcast content, but it can also help you appeal to new audience members.
  • You can even turn existing infographics into short blog posts by using the infographic content as an outline and filling in each section with new content.

Repurposing content saves you time, but it can also help you improve your search engine rankings, as Google is more likely to see your site as an authority if it has several pages of content focusing on closely related keywords.

December-January-IG-FB-Posts-15

The Takeaway

It’s easy to write off social media as something teens do after school, but the truth is that social media is an effective way to market a wide variety of products and services. SEO content creates more opportunities for search engines to find your pages and determine how relevant they are to specific search queries, driving traffic to your website and giving your business more authority.

The post Social Media SEO: Essential for Businesses in Every Industry appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/social-media-seo/feed/ 0
Benefits of Freelance Writing as Told By Top Content Writers https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/9-benefits-of-freelance-writing-as-told-by-top-content-writers/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/9-benefits-of-freelance-writing-as-told-by-top-content-writers/#respond Thu, 23 May 2019 17:06:00 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=23797 Calling all aspiring freelance writers! You can make money online by crafting website content, blog posts, e-books, and social media posts. What’s the catch? If you’re a strong writer willing to put in the necessary work, there isn’t one.  But there are plenty of benefits. Have you ever dreamed of working in your PJs from […]

The post Benefits of Freelance Writing as Told By Top Content Writers appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Calling all aspiring freelance writers! You can make money online by crafting website content, blog posts, e-books, and social media posts. What’s the catch? If you’re a strong writer willing to put in the necessary work, there isn’t one. 

But there are plenty of benefits. Have you ever dreamed of working in your PJs from the comfort of your home or sipping a cappuccino behind your laptop screen in a coffee shop with fellow digital nomads? 

a freelance writer indoor

The possibilities don’t end there. From earning as much as you choose to helping companies engage their audiences, freelance writing is a fantastic career.

Join us as we explore the benefits of freelance writing. 

8 Benefits of Freelance Writing

Ready to join the freelance writing world? Here are nine perks waiting for you on the other side of the keyboard. 

1. Earn flexible money

Drew Berger, a professional marketer who manages a team of copywriters for a growing agency, loves that freelancing lets him “scale up and down based on needs and availability.”

“Over the years,” Berger says, “I’ve been able to use freelance writing as a primary income that I was able to support myself with, but it’s also been a great option for supplementary income.”

That’s the great thing about freelancing. You make your schedule and choose whether to do it part-time or full-time. 

2. Work on a diverse range of projects

Flexibility doesn’t solely cover money matters. Selina Kyle is a nomadic writer who successfully combines her love of writing with seasonal campground hosting. She thinks being able to work on a wide range of projects is a big win when it comes to freelance writing.

Kyle says, “You can choose a diversity of projects and goals that help you avoid mind-numbing routines and mundane writing assignments.” 

Olive Armstrong has been a freelance writer since 2011 and adds to this sentiment: “Freelancing allows me to write on a wide variety of topics, so writing never gets stale. Time never, ever drags when you’re freelancing. If you’re watching the clock, it’s probably because you’re racing to meet a deadline.”

3. Work wherever you want

Kyle says, “You can work wherever you want, which includes at home in your PJs (my personal favorite).”

Several freelancers talked about pajamas, but they’re all happy about working in various places. Think local libraries, coffee shops, restaurants, cars or trains, and, in at least one case, a tree house.

a freelance writer outdoor

If you love travel, the life of a freelance writer could be a dream come true. The world is your oyster when you’re not tied to an office or a territory. As a freelance writer, you can make that dream of visiting every continent a reality — and get paid while you do it.  

4. Choose your work/life balance

All that freedom positively impacts a freelancer’s life, provided you manage your workflow smartly. Here’s how some of our best content writers take advantage of the benefits of freelance writing so they can live the rest of their lives to the fullest.

Leigh DuBois arranges her writing schedule around the things that make life enjoyable. “I love being able to arrange when I work around my life. If I want to go hiking or shopping on a weekday afternoon, I don’t have to miss work. I just work before I go or when I get home. I can even take the whole day off if I want to do that.”

Tom Emerson is a freelance writer and professional musician who leverages the gig economy to ensure he has opportunities for playing at his other gigs. “Working remotely with a flexible schedule gives me the freedom to say ‘yes’ to many gigs and opportunities I would never be able to in an office.”

5. Build your writing experience

The stronger your writing skills, the easier it becomes to secure freelance writing jobs and enjoy the benefits. 

Mickey David has spent plenty of time in classrooms to learn the art of writing, but he says freelancing has been a huge boon to his growth. “By working with hundreds of clients on a large variety of projects, I was able to refine my writing skills beyond what I learned in a classroom. In just a few years, I went from being unpublished to being a published writer with five credits to my name. That was meaningful growth that I can almost entirely attribute to freelance writing.”

ALSO: How to Find and Succeed With Freelance Copywriting Jobs

6. Be selective with projects

As a freelancer, you’re in control of what work you do and don’t do — a freedom some writers may overlook. Write content for companies specializing in your niche or on topics that interest you. 

As a former freelance writer for Crowd Content, Rick Leach — now our VP of Content Operations — expands on how to evaluate writing opportunities. “Freelance writing comes with the flexibility to accept or decline work as you see fit, which means you get to focus on what’s important to you, whether that includes higher pay, interesting topics, specific content types, or preferred clients. But be careful — you never know when a small or seemingly uninteresting job could become a killer opportunity. But saying no is sometimes necessary if additional work distracts from prior commitments. It’s a deadline-driven industry; missing a due date is a big no-no.”

7. Save money on traditional work expenses

If you’re a savvy freelancer writer, you also save money you might spend on a traditional job. Emerson notes, “I really appreciate the efficiency of working from home and not commuting. I’ve had other ‘flexible’ jobs like restaurants and retail, but the commuting hours really took a bite out of my hour-by-hour earnings.”

Not commuting was a perk mentioned by most of our freelancers. While gig writers don’t get paid time off like many traditionally employed people, Sapphire Knight, who has been writing since 1998, pointed out other benefits that make up for it. She says, “Freelancing made it easy for me to make a living while dealing with health issues that would have taken me out of the workforce.”

Freelancers are happy to avoid expenses for office-appropriate clothing and workday lunches, as well as the psychological price associated with office politics and gossip.

8. Put in overtime when big expenses loom

Freelancing offers another major financial perk: You’re never tied to a specific weekly pay or salary. While freelance writers can stop working to live their lives, the opposite is also true. Established freelancers can work overtime and make more money when necessary.

Simona Osborn writes in the cannabis industry and appreciates that she can increase her workload with extra projects when time permits. “If I feel like putting in a marathon work session, like if a big bill is coming due, I have that option, too,” Osborn says.

Do Freelance Writers Make Good Money?

Freelance writers have the potential to make good money, depending on their skill level, availability, and niche expertise. It all depends on your abilities, how much work you’re willing to put in, and your expectations.

If you don’t know much about SEO, content marketing, and AI’s impact on the industry, making supplementary income is possible, provided you have excellent writing skills. But if you’re knowledgeable about those topics and possess exceptional research skills, you can earn a hefty income. 

In today’s marketplace, topical authority is a needed quality of copywriting, and clients increasingly seek writers with specialized knowledge in fields such as health, science, and finance. 

ALSO: Freelance Writer Rates: How Much Should You Pay in 2024? 

How Hard Is Freelance Writing?

Breaking into the field of freelance writing isn’t easy, and not everyone is suited the uncertainty of freelance work. Success involves being adaptable and open to criticism, keeping up-to-date with industry trends, and developing marketing skills.

Writers who dedicate themselves to constant improvement and work on diverse projects find the job easier — those who embrace the freedom and potential for growth stick around for the long run.  

Discover Freelance Writing for Yourself

Freelance writers love the benefits of freelance writing, such as managing their finances, living their lives, and working outside ordinary spaces and schedules.

If your pen is mightier than your sword, apply for freelance writing jobs at Crowd Content.

The post Benefits of Freelance Writing as Told By Top Content Writers appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/9-benefits-of-freelance-writing-as-told-by-top-content-writers/feed/ 0
How Missing Content Deadlines Impacts Marketing Agencies in a Big Way (and What You Can Do About It) https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-missing-content-deadlines-impacts-marketing-agencies/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-missing-content-deadlines-impacts-marketing-agencies/#respond Tue, 14 May 2019 18:13:06 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=23551 Running an agency is an exercise in managing multiple priorities. You’ve got demanding clients, tight deadlines and a network of staff members and freelancers or content vendors to manage, all while keeping your competitive edge so the next “new kid on the block” agency doesn’t steal your best customers. One of the best ways to […]

The post How Missing Content Deadlines Impacts Marketing Agencies in a Big Way (and What You Can Do About It) appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Running an agency is an exercise in managing multiple priorities.

You’ve got demanding clients, tight deadlines and a network of staff members and freelancers or content vendors to manage, all while keeping your competitive edge so the next “new kid on the block” agency doesn’t steal your best customers.

One of the best ways to maximize efficiency and stay nimble is to outsource content creation, especially if content isn’t your primary service. SEO agencies are particularly adept at finding ways to supplement limited in-house resources, but it makes sense from a financial perspective for a lot of agencies to partner with third-party specialists.

ALSO:  Learn more about content writing for agencies

Here’s the issue: When your content partner fails to keep up with rising volume and starts to blow deadlines, you’re left holding the bag, and the consequences can be monumental.

Late Deliveries and the Domino Effect

One potential pitfall of late content is that it causes everything else to run late. Delays aren’t isolated, and they induce additional setbacks with increasingly troublesome results.

For Markelle Harden, a content strategist with Knowmad Digital Marketing, delays equal lost revenue. “If we are adding a new section to a website to expand a brand’s reach in the search engines or improve conversions from returning visitors, a delay in the content can lead to fewer website visitors, fewer interactions with the existing website and, as a result, fewer conversions.”

Like the butterfly effect, even a small lag on the content end of things could mean a client sees sinking engagement numbers and rapidly plummeting sales.

Missed Deadlines Mean Missed Opportunities

Some content is time-sensitive and failing to deliver on schedule starts a tidal wave of epic proportions. Amanda Sutton of CATALYST Communications Choreography knows this reality all too well. “As a PR pro, missed deadlines are our worst nightmare. [They] could have very immediate implications, such as missing the jump on an important news breaking story due to an unapproved media release… missing content deadlines could also have less devastating but still negative ramifications on your marketing.”

Delivering sales copy late could scuttle plans for a holiday-themed product release and delayed employee bios could leave a client without updated marketing collateral to distribute at their annual industry meetup. “Usually,” continues Sutton, “the point of each piece of content is to elicit action or reaction in the audience, so communication pros need to take into account the reception of each individual message, the tone and the exact timing that will make the biggest impact.”

Harden agrees. “Many businesses have ‘high-value’ market times when website traffic is more valuable than any other time of the year (accountants, home improvement or service companies, niche manufacturing, etc.). It’s important to submit content orders ahead of these high-value times.”

Cue the Employee Confusion

If the content you’re waiting on is for internal use, such as a company newsletter or series of emails talking up the new insurance benefits, you face a different list of potential pitfalls.

“Mismanaged or delayed communications could have an impact on employee engagement, interdepartmental procedures, etc.,” says Sutton. Depending on the goal of the content, Sutton suggests even a small error could lead to drops in event sign ups or meeting attendance, lead to lackluster feedback or survey participation and lead to overall confusion as content gaps throw off your whole company-wide dialogue.

As Sutton reminds us, “In marketing and communications management, timing is everything.”

Loss of Client Trust

For agencies whose bread and butter is customer satisfaction (and that applies to most agencies), late content on the contractor’s side means frustration and even anger on the client side. People hire you because they believe you can get the job done when you say it will be done. If that doesn’t happen, it matters little who’s truly at fault.

Once that confidence is shattered, it’s hard to get it back. With consumer trust at an all-time low, the only way to compete is to offer the best customer service available. Being late isn’t hospitable and it won’t lead to loyalty.

What Can Agencies Do?

If you’re feeling the effects of missed deadlines by your content vendor or freelancers, know that there are ways to right the ship. It may take a bit of time at the outset, but the end result will make it all worthwhile.

There’s No Such Thing as Too Much Information

As an agency account manager, it’s your job to suss out content requirements with clients and then pass all of that along to the writers. In doing so (or trying to), I’m sure that you’ve faced the prospect of unresponsive clients who want their content and want it now but don’t have the time to talk to you about it, and you’ve probably also dealt with your fair share of clients who don’t understand how much and what information you’ll need.

If you’re asking a writer to write a city page for Joe’s Plumbing in Dallas, it’s going to be difficult for them to nail it unless they know whether the company’s value proposition is that they’re the cheapest in town, they have highly specialized professionals or they’ve been family owned and operated for three generations, so they know all the idiosyncrasies of the houses in town.

Before ordering content, have your clients fill out client briefs that you can pass along to the writers so they have all the information they need. Make sure you include everything from voice/tone to target audience, how the company name should be presented and any industry terms to use/avoid. This will help keep revision requests at bay and your content swimming along to an on-time delivery.

Incorporate an Editing Layer

Revisions happen. Sometimes the writer doesn’t completely capture your vision, or perhaps you love the general direction but need to tweak a few sentences to better match the end client’s voice. In other cases, the issue may be that your content partner excels at HVAC and plumbing content but can’t seem to deliver the same high-end results when presented with health or legal topics.

Editing is essential, and basic tweaks are all part of the content creation process. But when orders continue to bounce back and forth, it’s easy to run up against a deadline — and watch in vain as it whizzes by.

If you find yourself polishing subpar content in-house because your content partner dropped the ball, it’s important to find a more efficient way to get from project brief to a brilliant end product, and that starts with good editors.

Feedback, Feedback, Feedback

When you receive the content you ordered, you most likely give it a read, make necessary changes, send it to your client and call it a day. Unfortunately, you’ve missed a crucial step — providing feedback.

Sure, it’s probably faster just to make changes on your own instead of explaining the issues to the writers and then waiting for revisions, but if they can’t see the types of changes you’re making to the content, you’re going to get caught in a continual loop of revision requests and edits that can lead to missed deadlines.

After delivering edited content to your clients, take the time to send the marked up copy to your content partner. This will help them to improve over time, leading to fewer revision requests, less editing time on your part and no more missed deadlines.

Choose the Right Content Partner

It takes time to assemble a group of freelancers or evaluate content vendors, but if things aren’t working out once you’ve made a decision, you need to take action — and that could mean starting the search all over again.

Continued delivery of subpar or late content could be that the writers you chose just aren’t skilled at the type of content you’re producing or knowledgeable in the industries you serve, and it’s also possible that they just don’t have the bandwidth to deliver the amount of content you order in the timeframe you need.

Starting over again is extremely time-consuming and potentially disruptive to your business, so take your time when evaluating content partners to be sure you’ve settled on the right solution in the first place.

Efficiency Courtesy of Our Three-Part Process

At Crowd Content, we use a three-step process that guarantees consistent quality from client to client.

  • Writing: First your order goes to one of our highly vetted native English-speaking writers whose areas of expertise vary from real estate and home improvement to travel nursing recruitment and in-patient rehab facilities. They’ll take a look at your project brief (if applicable) and specific order instructions, and then create content that ticks all the boxes.
  • Editing: After your freelance writer works their magic, the order passes to one of our eagle-eyed editors who will scour it from intro to conclusion looking for grammar and spelling errors, cohesion, word choice and other important elements.
  • Quality Assurance: Finally, the content passes through our QA team, where members do a final sweep to spot any issues. QA also looks for any possible conflicts between the content and your project brief. If you want serial commas or prefer to avoid the word “awesome,” this is where we catch any slip-ups.

Whether you’re looking for an individual writer to complete weekly blogs or need an entire writing, editing and quality assurance team to figure out how to create local city pages Google will love, Crowd Content can help — and we take deadlines seriously.

For more information on how you can harness the power of content creation and make your marketing strategy sing, scale quickly with our Agency Content Solutions. We manage the entire process so you can get back to running your business.

The post How Missing Content Deadlines Impacts Marketing Agencies in a Big Way (and What You Can Do About It) appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-missing-content-deadlines-impacts-marketing-agencies/feed/ 0
Content Marketing for eCommerce: 6 Types of Copy You Need to Succeed https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/content-marketing-for-ecommerce-6-types-of-copy-you-need-to-succeed/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/content-marketing-for-ecommerce-6-types-of-copy-you-need-to-succeed/#respond Wed, 08 May 2019 17:00:56 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=23464 Online shopping has grown by almost 50% in the last five years, and in 2019, more than 1.9 billion people worldwide will turn to the web to make purchases. By 2021, that number is expected to climb to 2.14 billion. With a growing number of potential customers, it’s not surprising that competition in the eCommerce […]

The post Content Marketing for eCommerce: 6 Types of Copy You Need to Succeed appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Online shopping has grown by almost 50% in the last five years, and in 2019, more than 1.9 billion people worldwide will turn to the web to make purchases. By 2021, that number is expected to climb to 2.14 billion. With a growing number of potential customers, it’s not surprising that competition in the eCommerce market continues to heat up.

And that’s why online retailers must continue to drive traffic with the right content marketing for ecommerce.

Defining the eCommerce Content Marketing Mix

Most eCommerce sites need a good mix of content to increase awareness of products and help interested customers make choices throughout the sales funnel.

Here are some of the most common types of eCommerce content that can help your products or services show up in search engines and persuade consumers to take the next step in the buying journey.

Product descriptions or product pages

A product descriptions market a single item or service. Often between 50 and 300 words (with longer formats reserved for specialty or complex goods and for brands who opt to focus on storytelling), product descriptions educate consumers about the item and encourage readers to visualize themselves using the product or service.

This is accomplished through feature/benefit writing that answers the questions: what is this, what does it do and why does the user need it? You should have a product description or page for every product or service you offer.

Product descriptions tend to be bottom of funnel content, so you can focus on converting already interested visitors and ranking for very transactionally focused search terms with your SEO.

ALSO:  Tips and Tricks for Writing the Perfect eCommerce Product Title

Category pages or descriptions

Category pages are ideal for creating content that boosts your performance in the search engines while providing useful information to the reader. Category descriptions provide some overall information about the types of items in a category, such as why they’re necessary, how to choose one or what types of subsections consumers might find.

For example, a category about women’s purses might explain different types of bags, what to look for in a bag, what materials are used, etc. Here’s a category page for women’s purses from Simon’s that helps shoppers narrow down their purchase decision:

Aim to have a category page for at least your highest level categories. Make sure they link off to related products, and you’ll be on your way to moving customers along their buying journey.

Category pages tend to serve customers who are mid-funnel, knowing they’re interested in a certain type of product, but not sure which ones just yet. Your category pages can be a great tool to help consumers find suitable products and can also help you rank for keywords that show an intent of learning more about a certain category of products.

Brand pages

Etailers that carry products from other companies can capture brand-specific SEO traffic and help customers early in their buying journey learn more about specific brand options by adding brand pages.

These are similar to category pages in that the content discusses the specific brand and what types of products it offers or is known for. You might consider adding such a page for every brand you carry or limiting it to special partnerships, highest performers or brands for which you carry many items.

For example, Best Buy has a brand page for Samsung TVs:

Image showing an example of Best Buy's Laptop Buying Guide

This page ranks for search terms related to Samsung televisions, and it also helps shoppers learn more about what their brand options are.

Buying guides

These are typically long-form article or blog pieces targeted to the early parts of the buying journey. While you can mention your goods and services, buying guides are usually meant to be educational pieces that help the consumer decide what type of product they need and how to purchase it. For example, a buying guide for a student laptop computer might cover topics such as how much RAM is preferred, how to choose the best screen type and what peripherals a student most commonly uses.

Let’s look at Best Buy again for a good example. Here’s their buying guide for purchasing laptops:

This page is full of great info that will help shoppers learn about what to look for in a laptop, which will then help them start reviewing your specific products. It also links off to different categories of laptops to help shoppers move along their buyer’s journey even easier.

You might consider publishing buying guides on some of your top-selling products types or aligning them with seasonal sales growth (such as holiday or back-to-school buying guides).

Buying guides are typically long-form content. This gives you a good opportunity to create “complete content,” which will rank well and best serve your visitors.

Blog posts

An on-site blog is a powerful way to expand your content marketing strategy outside of the more marketing-heavy content types above. Blog posts let you educate and entertain your audience, create content that encourages links and shares and engage in building a brand that’s bigger (and longer lasting) than any single product you might sell.

Test how various blog formats and publishing schedules perform with your target audience to drive performance for this type of eCommerce marketing. You may find your audience enjoys seeing blog posts twice a week or that guest posts perform the best.

Blog posts are another great tool to reach those top-of-funnel shoppers. They may not even know they’re interested in a type of product yet, but your blog posts could capture their attention and start them on their buyer’s journey.

ALSO: A Proven Process To Show Writers How To Write Blog Posts That Drive Results

Product Reviews

Often included on an eCommerce company’s blog, product reviews are a great way to spotlight specific products you’d like to move, new technologies and newsworthy items (think new video game releases). They also let you establish your company’s authority in a certain niche by exploring in depth the pros and cons of a product.

Not to beat a dead horse, but let’s look to Best Buy for another example. Here’s their review of Final Fantasy X for Nintendo Switch:

They review a lot of video games on Best Buy’s blog. This lets them build authority as a go-to source for video game news and sales, a following of people who will check out new reviews, organic search rankings and even traffic from social sharing.

The up-side here is that if people are interested in a product enough to read the review, there’s a good chance they’re going to click on a link to buy the product in your review.

Reviews are great for buyers near the end of the buying journey as they’re a great source of product information and may nudge them to checkout. That said, a well placed review might capture a buyer early in their journey and get them interested in the product.

Going Beyond Basics: Digital Marketing Tips from the Experts

Stepping outside of the basic eCommerce business content types above helps you increase your brand authority, capture consumers at different stages of the sales funnel and drive more traffic and conversions. Check out the advice below from three experts on how to go beyond basics with content marketing for eCommerce.

1. Customize content formats for each stage of the buyer journey

Product descriptions and blog posts are proven methods for driving eCommerce sales, but companies must remember that the digital marketing landscape is evolving rapidly. Today, individuals are shopping online via desktop, mobile and even voice-search devices, and they’re likely to use different tools for each stage of the buying journey. Your content marketing has to play the same game.

“The best success we’ve had in driving potential or in marketing customers down the funnel toward eCommerce conversion is to build content themes against our content pillars, leveraging formats for each stage.” says Robb Hecht, an adjunct professor of marketing with Baruch College. “For example, for mobile audiences who need to be made aware of your company (top of the funnel) we target them with large imagery-focused creative with either disruption or value-focused messaging.”

Hecht also provides examples for other parts of the marketing funnel. “For middle of the funnel, where eCommerce consumers are in a consideration stage, we try to obtain their opt-in email messages by leveraging social platform lead gen units and communicating informative messages, educating them about the product. Finally, for bottom of the funnel customers who just need a push, we develop content with offers, coupons and discounts, which drive them to a conversion landing page or physical store.”

2. Don’t just sell: Educate and build brand culture

You’ve probably heard the 80/20 rule of social media marketing: only 20% of your posts should be specifically about selling you and your products. The other 80% should be about building brand culture, educating your target audience and even sharing content from others in the industry. This concept can be applied to other content formats, too. By integrating more organically into the community you’re trying to build, you’ll create lasting relationships that support more sales over the long-term. And you’ll find that all that relationship building can segue easily into sales funnels if you’re authentic and transparent.

Taylor Gilliam, the Director of Social Media at ReadyCloud.com, says, “We’ve used content marketing to great impact for our company. By using education-based content, we have greater appeal to our client base and to industry leaders who influence prospective clients. It has been the most effective way to develop credit and establish our brand as an authoritative resource.”

“Content marketing has also helped us build a cohesive brand imagine that extends into infographics, videos and social media outreach,” says Gilliam. “Currently, branded content drives at least 200k unique web visits per year, and it serves as a gateway to our sales funnel. It has helped us improve our reach massively, especially when combined with retargeting and native ads.”

3. Write a lead magnet book

Vince Massara from We Make Lead Magnets takes the educate and inform premise even further, tying it into lead generation.

“We have seen great success with eCommerce owners using some new content marketing strategies,” says Massara. “Many are using a book, which would typically be a trip-wire lead magnet in eCommerce, as the core of their content marketing. By writing the right book to the right audience, you can put a few advertising dollars behind it to quickly grow a list of interested leads. From there, you create your content with an audience in mind, rather than starting out at zero and waiting months or years for the content to start to pay you back.”

Successful Content Marketing for eCommerce Isn’t Formulaic

Always remember that successful digital marketing doesn’t adhere 100% to a single formula. There’s simply too much going on online for a one-size-fits-all approach to work for anyone; take a look at WordStream’s eCommerce statistics to get an idea of how many approaches you can take to online marketing and why they’re all important for different types of brands.

The key is to figure out what works (and is important) to your brand.

A successful content marketing mix is one that performs for you, so start with the basics and expert tips above to build out your content. Then, test, tweak and test again. Because if there is one truth for all eCommerce businesses it’s that the online marketing job is never finished.

The post Content Marketing for eCommerce: 6 Types of Copy You Need to Succeed appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/ecommerce/content-marketing-for-ecommerce-6-types-of-copy-you-need-to-succeed/feed/ 0
How to Determine Optimal Content Length for SEO https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-determine-optimal-content-lengths-and-why-longer-isnt-always-better/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-determine-optimal-content-lengths-and-why-longer-isnt-always-better/#respond Tue, 30 Apr 2019 19:23:34 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=23317 Ever searched for a simple recipe online, only to find yourself trapped in a seemingly endless scroll past a blogger’s life story before hitting the actual ingredients list? You’re not alone. This phenomenon isn’t just a test of your patience — it’s a glimpse into the complex world of SEO, where the battle cry seems […]

The post How to Determine Optimal Content Length for SEO appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Ever searched for a simple recipe online, only to find yourself trapped in a seemingly endless scroll past a blogger’s life story before hitting the actual ingredients list? You’re not alone. This phenomenon isn’t just a test of your patience — it’s a glimpse into the complex world of SEO, where the battle cry seems to be “the longer, the better.” But should you turn every post into a novel to satisfy Google? Spoiler alert: It’s not that straightforward.

Decoding the Length Myth: Quality Over Quantity

While long content peppered with detailed anecdotes and long-tail keywords can engage readers and please search engines, it’s the substance — not the length — that truly matters. Google values content that fully addresses user queries, acting as a comprehensive resource. Yet, length for the sake of length — filling pages with fluff rather than valuable insights — won’t fool Google’s discerning algorithms. The goal is to create content that directly answers readers’ questions, while avoiding unnecessary tangents. As you aim for SEO success, focus on creating meaningful content that informs and satisfies, rather than on merely extending word counts. 

A Quick Overview of Current Conventional Wisdom on Word Counts

Recent studies indicate that content length matters to Google. According to Yoast, cornerstone pages perform best with over 900 words, but even taxonomy pages should have at least 250 words to maximize rankability.

It’s not just about pure rankings, either. Content with 1,000+ words attracts backlinks from twice the number of referring domains as 400-word content, according to backlink data from Ahrefs. Neil Patel also found that pages with more than 1,500 words receive up to twice the number of Twitter shares.

These findings shape conventional SEO wisdom asserting that longer content is typically better, and most sites such as BuzzSumo, Medium, and CoSchedule, call for content between 1,500 and 2,400 words to optimize performance in Google.

Still, there’s some nuance to content length. Neil Patel points out that different content lengths perform better in various industries, and SEMRush reminds content creators that quality is more important than length. However, as a general guideline, research from Hook Agency pinpoints 1,760 to 2,400 words as optimal.

What’s Google’s Stance on Content Length for SEO?

Google doesn’t like to give too much away regarding how its algorithms work and what might give you a leg up against the competition. However, John Mueller, head of Search Relations at Google, has repeatedly stated that content length isn’t a ranking factor.

Instead, Google looks for authority and overall content quality. Longer content often meets those criteria because it offers more value to users by thoroughly covering the subject matter.

So, what factors do equate to quality in the eyes of Google? Your content should:

  • Approach the topic in an original way
  • Provide a complete resource to answer all questions surrounding the topic
  • Offer a unique analysis of available information
  • Avoid using clickbait to attract users
  • Flow well and be free of glaring spelling or grammar issues

Google also recommends looking for ways to highlight your expertise during content planning and creation:

  • Build overall website and business credibility
  • Present information using evidence and appropriate sourcing to improve trust
  • Highlight the skills and knowledge of your authors so readers know where the information is coming from
  • Double-check everything for factual accuracy

Finally, everything about the content should be oriented toward real people rather than search engines. This means content should be reader-friendly and should answer the questions it promises to answer.

While SEO is important to a page’s success, you must ensure that people don’t leave your page to look for more or better information elsewhere.

Why These Benchmarks Aren’t the Be-All, End-All

Most SEO experts will tell you not to take their numbers as gospel. Yes, research is important, and you should always understand what trends affect content marketing and your industry in general. But you don’t write content in a vacuum made solely of word counts; you write content for actual users — the people whose needs, preferences, and feedback shape its success.

You also have to consider the topic, the time available to create the content, and your budget, as these can all impact content length.

Google won’t rank your content higher for using 1,000 words to say what others say in 100 words. 

Ultimately, you don’t need to write every piece of content according to some benchmark. CoSchedule notes that content that comes in around 2,500 words tends to perform best in the search engines — but that doesn’t mean every page or piece has to be 2,500 words. For example:

  • A product description for a white cotton T-shirt should not be that long.
  • A blog about how to wash a white cotton T-shirt will be full of unnecessary fluff if you try to get it to 2,500 words.
  • A buying guide that discusses all the varieties of white cotton T-shirts and how to find the right one for you could, however, reach 2,500 words without being full of superfluous content.

Padded Content Doesn’t Do You Any SEO Favors

But if 1,500, 2,000, or 2,500 words is the range  for optimal SEO performance, why can’t you make your basic T-shirt description that long?

It’s true. Most writers can meet the word count quota on any type of content by  including irrelevant information, repeating exact phrases and statements, and saying everything in the longest way possible.

We like to refer to this as “peanut butter writing,” illustrated in the following example: “I love peanut butter sandwiches because peanut butter sandwiches have a lot of peanut butter in the sandwich.”

That’s 18 words giving you five words of information and no additional value. Here’s why peanut butter writing should be avoided:

  • People don’t appreciate it. Online searchers are busy and don’t want to parse through fluff to find the information they want. 
  • It reduces the authority of your brand. That means people are less likely to return to your site, share your content, or link to it.
  • Users can only handle so much. Even if someone makes it through one PB writing article on your site, they probably won’t return. This means less traffic flowing to your site.
  • Fluffy writing isn’t as strong. Concise writing converts better because it gets straight to the point and avoids confusion.

In short, too much fluff can negatively affect the time people spend on your pages and the bounce rate. Consequently, people will be less likely link to your content, . hindering your site’s growth potential.

ALSO – Copywriting for SEO

Choosing the Right Word Count

If you’re not sure how to choose the right word count, you’re not alone. 

Here are some tips for identifying the correct word count for every project.

Consider the topic and outline

Start by sketching out a simple outline, assigning each component a word count, and adding it to get a total. For example:

  • Blog post: How to Buy a Book for a Child in Your Life
  • Introduction – 50 words
  • Seven tips – 700 words (100 words each)

  • Find out what reading level they are
  • Discover some of their interests
  • Choose nonfiction or fiction
  • Choose whether you’ll buy online or in the store
  • Talk to bookstore employees for recommendations
  • Buy something from an author or series they already read
  • Consider the parents or guardians when you buy picture books
  • FAQ section with three questions – 300 words

  • What are reading levels, and how do they work?
  • How can you learn more about kids’ books on Goodreads?
  • How much stock should you put in Amazon reviews?

  • Conclusion and call to action – 75 words
  • Total word count: 1,125

An outline helps you determine the right number of words, but it also keeps the writer on the appropriate path and away from padding.

Need help coming up with a topic? Ideation 101: How to Develop Strong Article Themes That Work

Complete competitive benchmarking for your industry

There are industry benchmarks for content length. It makes sense that a blog in the tech industry should look different from one in the medical or fashion fields, and these numbers can be a good starting point. 

But consider conducting benchmark research to help you understand the type and length of content performing in your niche. Tools like MarketMuse and SEMRush Content Templates can help you see how your content measures up against the competition, build strong outlines, and develop winning SEO ideas.

These tools look at the content currently ranking in the top 10 results on Google for the term you’re targeting and tell you how long your content should be to outperform the ranking content. In most cases, creating longer content than your competitors should be a priority for you.

The tools also disclose what topics your competitors’ content covers and suggests what topics to include in your content — one aspect of effective content gap analysis. In most cases, the top 10 results don’t cover all topics, so if you do, your content should outperform the others.

Here’s an example of what a report for the term “peanut butter sandwiches” looks like:

You’ll see a list of semantically related words (topics) you want to explore in your article. Build these into your outline so you naturally discuss them.

You’ll also see it recommends a word count of 651 words or more.

In most cases, the recommended topics are semantically linked to your main topic, so covering them as subtopics should add value for your readers. This is a great way to increase your word count without adding fluff.

Also, there’s a lot of evidence indicating that Google ranks semantically complete content well, as it delivers a high topic relevance. It’s one of the best ways to meet the expertise and authority demands of Google’s E-E-A-T guidelines.

While the tools mentioned above can help you identify ideal keywords, you can also use solutions like LSIgraph to find these related topics.

Consider the type of content page you’re building

The type of page you’re creating tends to dictate length, so that’s another benchmark to consider. Again, you should  conduct your own research and testing. Listed below are the ideal lengths for each type of content:

  • Blog posts: 1,000 to 1,500 words. Ensure the outline and topic are appropriate for the word count.
  • Pillar pages: 3,000+ words. Hook Agency’s research shows continuing improvements in traffic and social shares up to 7,000+ words, but you won’t see this success from topics where there simply isn’t much to discuss.
  • City (or local) pages: 300 to 800 words. Ensure each page targets local SEO accordingly and offers a unique take to avoid duplicate content.
  • Landing pages: 400 to 1,000. Again, the word count depends on the topic you’re covering.
  • Guides: 1,500 to 2,500 words. Google rewards guides that explain how to do things in detail. You should also look for opportunities to include experience and expertise in this type of content. Create how-to guides that fit your company’s practical skill set.
  • Product descriptions: 50 to 300 words. Only the most complex or unique products, such as computers, need the higher end of the word count.
  • Press releases: 400 to 700 words. Keep press releases short to ensure journalists can digest your message quickly and easily.

Remember, these benchmarks for SEO content length are simply guidelines. If you’re struggling to meet these word counts, it could mean you should drop the word count or reassess how you approach your topic.

Conversely, the opposite is also true. More words are better if they help paint a more comprehensive picture of the topic without boring readers.

Does User Intent Affect Optimal Content Length?

User intent — the information a user expects to find when searching for a specific keyword — affects optimal content length. 

For example, someone searching the term “how to build a computer” will want a comprehensive resource that discusses the process at a high level while also explaining how to choose and install individual parts.

However, someone searching the term “buy running shoes” won’t typically want much information because they’re ready to purchase a product. You won’t necessarily benefit from a 2,000-word product page in this case.

Another aspect of search intent is specificity. Some search terms have a narrower scope, and your content needs to go in-depth on the topics. Longer content naturally targets more open-ended keywords, such as “nutritional benefits of apples,” whereas searchers will want quick answers for a term like “capital of Italy.” 

Get the best of both worlds by offering concise featured snippet answers within your longer-form content, targeting narrower keywords.

TL;DR: There’s No Easy Answer

Choosing the right word count comes down to knowing what your audience wants and providing exceptional value. If you’re struggling with either of these, book a consultation call with our content strategy service. Our experienced strategists will utilize their industry knowledge to iron out the wrinkles in your SEO content.

The post How to Determine Optimal Content Length for SEO appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/how-to-determine-optimal-content-lengths-and-why-longer-isnt-always-better/feed/ 0
Ideation 101: How to Develop Strong Article Themes that Work https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/ideation-101-how-to-develop-strong-article-themes-that-work/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/ideation-101-how-to-develop-strong-article-themes-that-work/#respond Wed, 24 Apr 2019 19:59:13 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=23209 Recent data shows that there are 4 million blog posts published every day, making it difficult to stand out online. If you’re having trouble coming up with unique ideas for your content, you’re not alone — ideation is a challenge for most content marketers.   With so much competition, your articles and blog posts should […]

The post Ideation 101: How to Develop Strong Article Themes that Work appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Recent data shows that there are 4 million blog posts published every day, making it difficult to stand out online. If you’re having trouble coming up with unique ideas for your content, you’re not alone — ideation is a challenge for most content marketers.  

With so much competition, your articles and blog posts should offer something new and memorable. But with so much content already out there, it can often feel like everything you can write about has already been covered. Effective content creation relies heavily on great ideas, so it’s critical that your ideation helps you flesh out those topics before you start writing.

There are some strategies, though, that can help you cut through that feeling and generate new, value-added ideas that resonate with your audience. Here are 17 ideation tips to get you started.

Time-Tested Techniques

1. The Skyscraper Technique

The skyscraper technique has been around for a few years, and it still works when executed correctly. Technically, there are two parts to using this technique — developing the article theme and then building backlinks — but let’s focus on the former.

The idea is to find a few high-performing pages in your niche or ones that are ranking for your keywords, and then figure out how you can do the content better to land your page higher in the search results. The easiest way to do this is to look at what’s in those ranking pages and then write a new article that’s longer and more thorough — as if you’re taking a building and adding 40 stories to make it a skyscraper. If the pages you find that rank are out-of-date, then simply update them. It sometimes really is just that easy.

2. Asking the 5 Questions

The 5 Whys is a brainstorming tactic used for root cause analysis and determining what the customer wants, but you can employ a different form of this tool in ideation. When using the 5 Whys, you ask a Why question, and then you keep asking related Why questions until you get to a specific answer — usually you get there by the 5th Why.

When you ideate, you don’t have to limit yourself to Why, but can employ all types of questions.

Here’s an example of the brainstorming method used to come up with topics to write for a client that sells audio equipment.

  • Who are we writing content for? Audiophiles
  • What do audiophiles care about? Music quality and experience
  • How does the client serve that need? By providing the best quality equipment they can and offering custom system designs
  • What is a custom system design? A system designed for the sonic preferences of the customer and his or her space

From just these few questions, you have ideas for articles such as:

  • Why is music quality important?
  • What is a custom system design?
  • How does your room impact your audio experience?
  • The best speakers for small spaces
  • X speakers that deliver great sound in big rooms

You can see how continuing to ask questions can drive even more content ideas.

3. Semantically Speaking

Creating clusters of semantically related content is a great way to boost your SEO, but it’s also a great way to identify good topics to write about. If you use a tool like LSIGraph, and enter one of your targeted keywords, it’ll give you a list of related keywords that you should touch on in whatever piece of content you’re writing for that targeted keyword. Doing this can increase the quality of your content and make it semantically complete.

But again, chances are you’re not going super in-depth on each individual semantically related keyword you find in the pillar article. So why not go super in-depth on a new post that links back to the pillar?

4. Take a Cue from the Unicorns

If you’ve been blogging for a while, chances are you have some unicorn posts that generate a lot of traffic and engagement. Chances are also that you touch on subtopics in those articles that you can branch out from to create new articles.

Identifying those subtopics and creating new articles focused just on them can be a great source of new topics, and you can also leverage the success of the original post to boost the new one. Go into the original post and update it to link to the new one. Email your subscribes to let them know you’ve expanded on the topic.

This helps you corner the market for these related topics, and also helps support a topic cluster approach to SEO.

5. Is and Is Not Matrix

An is/is not matrix is simply a list of all the things something is and is not. It’s a great tool when you’re trying to understand what a brand is, but it can also help you define exactly what type of articles a client wants.

For example, if a client is a lifestyle brand, humorous, coming out with an Easter line of clothing and not averse to listicles but it is not religious, political or heavy on self-promotion, putting these definitions down on paper makes it easier to steer ideation.

With those parameters in mind, you might quickly come up with non-sales titles such as “X Ways to Bring Easter Egg Design Feels to Your Holiday Wardrobe” or “X Adorably Funny Easter Decor and Fashion Concepts.”

Online Tools

6. Use Google’s Suggestions

Google’s auto-complete feature can spark some great ideas fast. You have to turn on trending searches for this function to work, but if it’s on, Google will complete your search as you type with other potentially popular searches. The ideas provided by Google are mined from information about what you’re typing into the search bar, what things you’ve searched for before and the types of things other people are searching for.

You can see in the examples below how you might use this search engine feature to gather ideas for either a DIY blog or a knife brand.

7. Find Questions Consumers Are Asking

Another great tool that can help with ideation is Answer the Public.

This service lets you enter a targeted keyword or topic and then generates a list of questions that actual consumers are asking. You can typically find some good questions from these results, run the Skyscraper method on them and then create a piece of content that delivers exceptional value to consumers with a real need.

8. Use Topic Generators

There are a number of tools available that will help you come up with topics to cover just based on a seed keyword or topic.

Portent’s Content Idea Generator is a great tool for doing this. Just enter your subject, and it will give you a suggested title.

Note that many of these won’t quite make sense or catch your attention, but keep refreshing and chances are you’ll find something you can work with.

Hubspot offers a similar tool as well.

There really are a lot of these tools out there. Don’t make them the lynchpin of your ideation, but they do make great supporting tools.

Curation

9. Repurposing the News

You have to be careful how you repurpose news stories, especially if they’re political in nature at all. You must consider the brand’s voice and style and approach news stories with the right spirit for each client.

It’s also important to remember that “news” encompasses a lot more than what shows up on nightly television, and turning to local events and culture or industry news is often a better tactic for ideation.

First, consider what is going on in your industry. Has anyone made a big announcement or issued a report about trends? While you may not want to leverage announcements from direct competition, you can often use these events to your benefit. For example, if you’re an office supply retailer and someone comes out with a new productivity software, you might write an article titled “XYZ Productivity Software and Other Tools to Help You Get Stuff Done.”

You can do the same thing with local news. If you’re a local cupcakery and there’s a big festival coming up, you might write about how cupcakes can be incorporated into the fun.

10. Content Curation/Best Of Posts

If you do keyword research for something like “SEO WordPress plugin,” you’re likely to see a related term similar to “best SEO WordPress plugins.” With so much information out there, many searchers want someone to give them a review of what’s out there and tell them what’s worthwhile. That could be products, services or even information.

Spend some time to evaluate the market, collect the top options, and write a recap for each where you add your expert opinion. Readers will appreciate this, you might rank for some valuable search traffic and it can position you as an authority in the space.

Feel like all the good content has already been written?
How to Write Unique Articles

Look Externally

11. Evaluate How Others Are Doing Something

You’ll often find that many blog posts focus on giving fairly generic advice without a lot of data, examples or actionable information. A great way to counter this trend is to write posts that let you show off your understanding of a topic by applying it to real word examples and writing up your analysis.

For example, let’s say you’re an SEO expert. What if you looked at 5 sites in the real estate industry and analyzed their tactics, explained what was good and bad and then showed how they’re currently ranking?

This is a great way for you to show your knowledge in a way that’s really valuable for your readers, and might prompt them to contact you to get more of your expert advice.

12. Interview an Industry Expert

Everyone can write an article on “how to train a dog” by researching the exact same sources available to all on the web. That’s part of what results in creating generic content.

But, what if you were able to go directly to an expert source and get new information?

While it can take a bit of hustle to connect with and convince an expert to participate in your interview, if you can do it, these types of posts can really generate a ton of buzz.

You might even take the approach of asking them to be on your podcast or webinar, and then transcribe the video to create your article.

13. Pay Attention On Social

If you know where your audience hangs out and discusses things, you should be hanging out there too. Places like Twitter, Reddit, forums and even industry-focused Slack groups are a great place to chat with experts in your industry.

Picking up on things they’re chatting about, questions they’re asking or things they’re complaining about can be a great starting off point for your next article.

Look Internally

14. Share How You Did Something Well

People love reading about success (and failure) stories backed up by real data. And in a content landscape lacking in concrete data, if you can share how you succeeded in doing something along with some performance data, it can really resonate with your audience.

For example, did you just create a sweet explainer video? We did that a while ago, and our CEO, Clayton, shared the process he used step by step. This continues to be one of our most popular blog posts because it’s actionable and shows real results.

15. Make a Prediction

We’re not asking you to be the next Nostradamus (but there’s good money in it if you can), but you know your industry better than most, and you probably have a good idea where it’s headed.

That’s knowledge that a lot of your competitors might not have, and if you share a bit, it can go a long way toward establishing your authority in the space. And with authority comes an increased chance that people will turn to you when they need help, resulting in more leads.

16. Evaluate New Tools and Services

You’re probably trying out a lot of new tools and services all the time. Hubspot found that marketers average using 12 tools when doing their jobs, with many using way more.

If you’re doing this, why not share your experiences? Your readers will appreciate your expert opinions, the tool you’re using would probably appreciate it and it can keep your blog fresh.

17. Answering Your Customer’s Questions

You don’t even have to ask your own questions. Spend a little time on your social media, forums or blog to see what consumers are asking and turn those queries into articles.

Chatting with your sales and customer service teams to find out what questions they get asked most often is also a great source of topics. A side benefit to this is that by answering these questions with blog posts, you can create sales enablement content that your reps can share with their clients. This helps your reps and your customers.

ALSO – How To Write Blog Posts That Drive Results

Ideas, Ideas, Ideas

This list features some of our favorite methods for ideation, but it’s honestly not complete. There are many great ways to come up with article ideas that will resonate with your audience, but what’s important is that you find the ones that work for you and your business.

Any other ideation tactics you think we should include? Let us know in the comments!

The post Ideation 101: How to Develop Strong Article Themes that Work appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/ideation-101-how-to-develop-strong-article-themes-that-work/feed/ 0
What Types Of Email Newsletters Are Most Effective in 2019? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-types-of-email-newsletters-are-most-effective-in-2019/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-types-of-email-newsletters-are-most-effective-in-2019/#respond Thu, 28 Mar 2019 15:30:22 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=22402 Email dates back more than four decades, but it’s still got a lot to offer for businesses that want to connect authentically and powerfully with a target audience. If you think the email list is dead (or even dying) as a marketing tactic, think again. It’s alive and well, even among younger generations. According to […]

The post What Types Of Email Newsletters Are Most Effective in 2019? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Email dates back more than four decades, but it’s still got a lot to offer for businesses that want to connect authentically and powerfully with a target audience.

If you think the email list is dead (or even dying) as a marketing tactic, think again. It’s alive and well, even among younger generations. According to a study commissioned by PowerInbox, more than half of all adults age 18 and up subscribe to at least one email newsletter. And those same subscribers do engage with advertising and offers in the emails; in fact, two-thirds say they’ll click special offers in an email if it’s interesting and relevant.

With so much to sort through online, consumers naturally spend more time and effort on the brands that do the work to reach them. That means you can’t rely on a tried-and-true automated email campaign or newsletter format to keep hitting it out of the ballpark, and if you’re seeing email engagement slide, it might be a good idea to try some new approaches (or possibly hire a talented newsletter writer).

But you don’t have to go far to scout out effective email campaigns: We’ve put together some tips and tricks garnered from real-life examples of effective lead-nurturing emails for you to check out.

1. Create Simple Messages from Individuals

Larry Kim of Mobile Monkey often shares great advice on Facebook Messenger marketing and specifics about his own marketing campaigns, and he’s scored some winning open and click-through rates with email marketing. It’s not surprising, because he knows how to put together an effective email that resonates with the reader and catches their attention.

But the unicorn marketer doesn’t make it flashy: he keeps it simple and direct. Check out the screenshot below for an example of one his marketing emails. The subject line, “check your phone” is simple but attention grabbing. In a list of emails in your inbox, this will stand out on a scan through because your immediate thought may be “Wait, did someone text me?”

Image showing how to create simple messages from individuals

Once you open the email, it’s addressed to you, poses an immediate question and starts to convey the message — all in a way that seems like Larry is talking directly to you. It’s a tactic that makes it more likely someone will click on the call to action or links provided later in the message. He also often links to his social media and blog posts, linking one piece of content with his entire channel.

You can create email newsletters like this that get great open and engagement rates by:

  1. Sending specific messages instead of automated digests

  2. Positioning emails from a specific person at your company instead of the brand

  3. Writing for an audience of one instead of a group (even though the emails go to a group)

  4. Treating email as part of an omnichannel marketing approach rather than a single channel

2. Give Real Value for Free

Words like free, gift, freebie and give-away still resonate with individuals and drive crazy open rates. And that’s true whether you’re engaged in B2C or B2B marketing.

That said, used improperly or too frequently in your subject lines, these words can set off spam filters. Be sure to use them carefully, and make sure your subject lines don’t come across as spammy.

More than just promising value in your subject line, figure out what you can offer your subscribers that’s easy to deliver and not costly to you but will be valuable to readers.

Check out Digital Marketer’s early January promotional email below. Like the example from Larry Kim, it’s simple, personalized and comes from an individual in the company. But it also comes bearing free gifts, a fact which is stated in bold right in the first sentence. Talk about a hook.

image

3. Keep Mobile Users in Mind

Mobile bypassed desktop computing as the preferred platform for accessing internet content in general sometime between 2015 and 2016, and it didn’t take long for access to email to follow suit. According to ReturnPath, users were choosing mobile access to email over webmail at a rate of two to one as of 2017. (Webmail refers to online mail providers such as Gmail). Use of desktop email programs such as Outlook to receive and send emails was low on the preference list, and desktop email programs such as Outlook to receive and send emails was even further down.

Given those numbers, it’s critical to design your newsletters with mobile devices in mind. Keeping it simple does this, because a text-only email with basic links is going to display well on most screens. Just keep the length of paragraphs and list elements in mind. Shorter may be better, because mobile users could get tired of scrolling before they get to the goods if you’re long-winded.

But mobile doesn’t completely preclude longer content. Check out the screen shots below from part of a digest-style email from The Hustle. While this email had a single header graphic (that would have scaled on a mobile device), the rest is fairly simple and features small content chunks broken up by headers and white space.

image

4. Design and Write for Your Audience

When a sports scout is looking for a new pitcher for a baseball team, they aren’t just looking for someone who ticks all the boxes when it comes to curveballs and game stats. A good scout also looks for a player who will work well with and complement the existing team.

Your job in creating email marketing materials is similar: No matter what is performing for everyone else, you do what performs for your audience.

Check out the screen shot below of an email from Sarah Foil, who provides editing and other services to authors. You’ll note that the bulk of the email actually looks a lot like an Instagram post. That’s followed up with a very direct and conversational CTA that asks for the reader to take specific actions.

Image showing a new blog post

This works for Foil specifically because she knows exactly who her audience is: they’re also the audience for Bookstagram, a subset of Instagram that posts pictures and content about creating and reading books and general bookish lifestyle. It’s likely this image is going to naturally resonate with her audience.

To follow Foil’s example, figure out what your audience is interested in and what type of content they are likely to engage with online. Then, convert that into something that works for email.

Expert Advice, but No Easy Answers

If you’re here looking for a magic formula for email newsletters that succeed in 2019, we’re sorry to disappoint. The truth is, there aren’t typically easy answers in marketing. Instead, there’s a lot of expert advice, such as the breakdown above about types of email newsletters that work.

But the coach (or advice giver) can’t make the play for you. You might use a pinch hitter to create quality content for your newsletter or tweak your subject lines with an expert’s eye, but no one understands your brand like you do.

Whether you’re working with an agency to create your email marketing campaigns or doing the work in-house, take some time to really understand your audience and your message so you can hit it out of the ballpark with email marketing.

The post What Types Of Email Newsletters Are Most Effective in 2019? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-types-of-email-newsletters-are-most-effective-in-2019/feed/ 0
What Is a Ghostwriter Best Able to Help With? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-a-ghostwriter-best-able-to-help-with/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-a-ghostwriter-best-able-to-help-with/#respond Tue, 19 Mar 2019 15:30:12 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=22216 Harry Houdini used one. So did Johnnie Cochran. Sarah Palin hired her own, as did Naomi Campbell, Aretha Franklin, and (rumor has it) Alexandre Dumas. George Takei and Kerry Washington each have their own who specialize in social media. Ghostwriters are the secret forces hired to write some of the most recognized literary works in […]

The post What Is a Ghostwriter Best Able to Help With? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Harry Houdini used one. So did Johnnie Cochran. Sarah Palin hired her own, as did Naomi Campbell, Aretha Franklin, and (rumor has it) Alexandre Dumas. George Takei and Kerry Washington each have their own who specialize in social media.

Video showing who specializes in social media

Ghostwriters are the secret forces hired to write some of the most recognized literary works in the world, but they also mastermind magazine articles, web content, blogs, and so much more.

If you’ve ever wondered “what could a ghostwriter do for me?”, you’re about to discover that the answer is rather complex—and full of potential.

Ghostwriting at a Glance

Simply put, a ghostwriter is someone who creates content that will be published under someone else’s name. Some ghostwriters get a secondary byline or “title credit,” but most are sworn to secrecy and sign non-disclosure agreements banning them from ever claiming the final work.

Though the exact details vary from project to project, ghostwriters are most often the unseen, unrecognized talent that helps everyone from musicians to industry influencers to politicians build an audience and a reputation.

ALSO Ghostwriters – The Secret to Maximizing Your In-House Writing Team

Ghostwriting as You Probably Know It

Ghostwriters are probably best known for being the talent behind celebrity tomes. When an A-lister wants to share their story, they bring on a professional writer who can turn a life’s work into a work of art. But that’s just the beginning of what a ghostwriter can do.

Politicians almost exclusively rely on ghostwriters to create stump speeches and translate policy—a writer may not come up with the answer to healthcare, but they can put legalese into layman’s terms, so their boss’s next press conference actually makes sense. Political ghostwriters may see to constituent correspondence too, writing response to letters regarding everything from immigration to traffic complaints to requests for arts funding.

The Business Case for Hiring Ghostwriters

Businesses often use ghostwriters, but rather than creating novels and political speeches, they’re focused on creating a wide variety of professional content.

When you’re already running yourself ragged trying to manage a growing company, the last thing you have time to do is sit down and write your weekly newsletter. Dashing off some bullet points and handing them off to a ghostwriter means you can offer your audience cohesive, on-brand content without stretching yourself ridiculously thin.

For entrepreneurs looking to establish a secure foothold in their industry, a guest post on a high-traffic site can work wonders, but only if that post is well-written and compelling. In this case, hiring an industry expert ghostwriter can do the trick.

Then there are on-site blog posts—the ones brands put on their own websites to help increase traffic, generate leads, and establish a rapport with consumers.

You’d be surprised how many big-name influencers, life coaches, CEOs, marketing directors, athletes, lifestyle gurus, Kardashians, and other notables employ a professional writer to turn their blogs into something special. Sometimes there’s an entire team of ghostwriters involved; one writer may specialize in the “color” posts while another will give authority to more technical content.

Social media is ripe for ghostwriting, too. While Kim Kardashian certainly posts her own selfies, she also has a social media team creating sponsored posts under her name, and she’s far from the only celebrity to do so. Many high-profile people understand the necessity of an ongoing, engaging online presence but few have the time to post regularly. A social media ghostwriter adopts their client’s personality and creates tweets, status updates, and promotional posts to help further the client’s reputation and career.

Even famous authors bring on help from time to time. Some have more ideas than they can feasibly execute, so they create detailed outlines and then allow ghostwriters to write the actual books. V. C. Andrews, an author known for her edgy work in the young adult category, passed away from breast cancer in the ’80s, but thanks to her family and a ghostwriter named Andrew Neiderman, Andrews’ legacy continues with new fiction books published for decades after her death.

How Ghostwriting Benefits Your Brand

First and foremost, ghostwriters save you time. Even if you’re a skilled scribe with tons of content under your belt, creating new pieces requires setting aside a chunk of your schedule, often repeatedly.

Do you have the resources to take your eyes of other projects and concentrate solely on content? Hire a ghostwriter and your book or blog will show up ready for your stamp of approval, and the timeline will likely be far more faster than if you had written the content yourself.

Secondly, ghostwriters know how words work. No sending off your book to a publishing company and then doing exhaustive rewrites because there’s a total lack of cohesion or numerous typos in every line. A pro writer or author can create a narrative and make your story flow from beginning to end.

Finally, partnering with a ghostwriter means double the ideas. You have someone to brainstorm with, someone who’ll tell you whether something’s working or not, and a voice of reason when you’re straying too far from the subject matter or not digging deep enough. If your ghostwriter is an expert in content marketing, you’ve also got someone who knows what will connect with online audiences and how you can make your writing SEO friendly.

The Transformative Power of Ghostwriting

One benefit of ghostwriting is so monstrously compelling it deserves its own callout. That benefit? An authoritative, trustworthy voice.



You may be downright deft with an Elmo Band-Aid, but if you break your arm, you’re going to see an actual doctor. If your car goes kaput, you take it to a mechanic, and if you need to get from Sacramento to Syracuse safely, you hire a trained pilot, not your cousin Ralph who once flew a drone.

The same principle applies to ghostwriting. Your message is only as strong as the words with which it’s conveyed; poor writing can easily obscure your story, while great writing can turn a fledgling idea into copy that converts.

If you’re a business that recently launched or is just entering a new niche, you might hire a ghostwriter to give your content clout. For instance, if you’re a DIY store that just expanded your catalog with a ton of security products, a ghostwriter who specializes in smart-home tech could create content that sounds authoritative and offers value an in-house writer couldn’t touch.

For businesses eager to compete, meaty content can lead to a huge boost in visibility. Authority, along with relevance and trust, is one of the three pillars of SEO, meaning it plays a major role in how search engines like Google will rank your site.

Check out this post for some ideas on how you can find a writer that has that niche expertise you need to build authority in your content.

Hire a Ghostwriter and Give Your Ideas a Chance to Shine

Across the board, ghostwriters deliver content that’s authoritative and trustworthy. When something is written well, it’s easy to believe—how quickly do you dismiss a blog with a typo in the title or nonsensical sentence in the first paragraph?

Ghostwriters are experts, so they also write more efficiently, more effectively, and they’re known for producing work that’s humorous, impactful, memorable, educational—whatever your heart desires.

If you’ve ever wanted to give your brand a leg up in terms of marketing or need help speeding up your writing projects, it’s time to consider having your content written by a ghostwriter.

Crowd Content’s platform gives you access to professional freelance writers who specialize in everything from Facebook posts to e-books to blogs. To connect with a ghostwriter, sign up today.

The post What Is a Ghostwriter Best Able to Help With? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/what-is-a-ghostwriter-best-able-to-help-with/feed/ 0
How Can You Find a Great Content Writer Who Has Niche Expertise? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-can-you-find-a-great-content-writer-who-has-niche-expertise/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-can-you-find-a-great-content-writer-who-has-niche-expertise/#respond Thu, 14 Mar 2019 15:30:47 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=21079 When you’re looking to get a writer to create content for your brand, you’re likely hoping to find someone who knows your subject matter inside and out. While many experienced content writers pull double duty as master researchers, those who are already familiar with your niche are invaluable. They can hit the ground running, creating […]

The post How Can You Find a Great Content Writer Who Has Niche Expertise? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

When you’re looking to get a writer to create content for your brand, you’re likely hoping to find someone who knows your subject matter inside and out. While many experienced content writers pull double duty as master researchers, those who are already familiar with your niche are invaluable. They can hit the ground running, creating content using insider knowledge and industry specific keywords a newbie may not know.

Today I’d like to share a few ideas and suggestions to hire freelance content writers who specialize in your industry. You can try navigating the hunt on your own or take advantage of these ideas and suggestions, as well as Crowd Content tools that help simplify the process.

Tip 1: Reach Out to Writers Whose Work You Admire

When you read great blogs posts in your industry, see which great content writer is behind all that pithy prose. You’re already seeing the author’s talent at work, making it easier to see how they approach your niche.

Their voice might also be in line with your vision.

Often a content writer’s byline will also connect to their website, portfolio or an author page for that specific publication. Take a moment to sift through their catalog for insight into their body of work.

This approach allows you to skip the “Do you have any samples?” back-and-forth that typically goes with the interview process. But you may find that published writers have an exclusivity clause or are not interested in freelancing.

Tip 2: Create Job Postings

Job postings are a great way to let you specify the exact knowledge and experience you need your writers to have. Many companies post these directly on their own sites, and you can also choose to post job ads on sites like Indeed and ZipRecruiter. 

Other places you can post on include various writing service sites, industry job boards and on social media (linking back to a posting on your site).

Creating a digital “help wanted” ad can help you find candidates who should have the niche expertise you want (if they pay attention to your requirements before applying).

Doing this often results in many, many applications, and the sheer volume of applicants may make it a bit overwhelming to sift through and qualify.

Too much information

There’s a good chance you can find a great writer with the niche expertise you want among all those applications, but it can prove very time consuming to review large numbers of them. Remember, you’ll also have to review samples, check references and generally vet all applicants before working with them.

Tip 3: Casting Calls

Casting calls are a special Crowd Content feature that let you audition a large number of vetted writers as quickly and painlessly as possible. With casting calls, qualified writers come to you.

Your casting call lists important project information and may share other details such as pay rate and scope. You’ll specify questions that all applicants need to answer in their submission, and you can also ask for a project-specific sample to help whittle down your choices.

Casting calls are a lot like job posts, except you’re shrinking the applicant pool significantly. Rather than broadcasting your opening to the entire world, you’re targeting Crowd Content’s cache of qualified writers. And, you can even restrict your casting call further to only make it available to writers of certain ranks and qualifications.

This system gets you responses and samples tailored to your business, so there’s no guessing as to whether a writer’s past work is a good example of their ability. You also won’t have to imagine how they’d interpret your niche.

The only downside here is you’ll still have to do a bit of digging. Most casting calls get a lot of applications you’ll still have to review, but you can rest easy knowing that Crowd Content has already qualified these writers for you.

Plus, you can also review each applicant’s profile on the site to learn more about them, see how other clients have rated their work, and see more samples.

And that leads me to the next tip…

Tip 4: Writer Search/Profile Reviews

Curious who’s a search engine optimization wunderkind and who rocks at writing website content? Crowd Content clients have an option to search and view writer profiles, sharing insights into everything from a writer’s areas of expertise to their performance stats.

Each profile includes all of the following:

  • A short bio created by the writers themselves, detailing their education, experience and key writing skills
  • A quality star level determined by Crowd Content’s performance-based rating algorithm
  • Category badges denoting whether a writer is among the top 10 in a specific category
  • Testimonials and client ratings/reviews
  • Performance stats by category
  • General writer statistics such as average words written per hour and how many orders a writer currently has in progress
  • Samples of the writer’s work

These are metrics you wouldn’t normally have access to, even if you had a contract with a marketing agency or had your own in-house writers. After all, who has the time to track so many moving parts?

Ahem…. Crowd Content’s awesome algorithm 🙂

Tip 5: Networking in Industry Groups

Word of mouth is powerful in any industry, but it’s especially valuable in content marketing. Consider asking for writer recommendations from colleagues. You’ll quickly learn which writers are known for great content, who delivers on-time, who nails ideation and whose copy has increased conversion rates by 300 percent.

You may even meet writers themselves, and you’ll be able to zero in on a few high-quality candidates without opening yourself up to a barrage of hopeful contractors who are also total strangers.

You probably already know some great industry groups locally, but consider checking out professional groups on LinkedIn, Reddit and Slack communities for some online recommendations.

This approach might not be as scalable as others, but it can help you find really authoritative writers in your niche.

One caveat for this approach — while industry experience is great, it doesn’t always mean that the writer’s writing is strong enough for you. Be sure to still check out samples of their writing before starting any projects.

Not All Roads to Niche Expertise Are Equal

There’s no inherently wrong way to to find a freelance writer who knows your niche, but some paths may be more difficult. Ultimately, you’ll have to decide which approach makes the most sense for your business.

But, the benefits of finding a great niche writer with solid writing chops are huge.

Regardless of your niche, save yourself time and energy by connecting with writers who are proven performers.



If you’d like a hand finding the perfect writer for your business, sign up for Crowd Content services today or call our team at 1-888-983-3103 to talk about our talent.

The post How Can You Find a Great Content Writer Who Has Niche Expertise? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-can-you-find-a-great-content-writer-who-has-niche-expertise/feed/ 0
A Proven Process To Show Writers How To Write Blog Posts That Drive Results https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/a-proven-process-to-show-writers-how-to-write-blog-posts-that-drive-results/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/a-proven-process-to-show-writers-how-to-write-blog-posts-that-drive-results/#respond Wed, 27 Feb 2019 16:30:46 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=21067 Words aren’t just words. These tiny bundles of potential have the power to make or break your business. Hiring a freelance content writer means you’re investing in that potential, but how will you find a content partner you can trust? The path to incredible content is best traveled with care, and selecting a writer is just […]

The post A Proven Process To Show Writers How To Write Blog Posts That Drive Results appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Words aren’t just words. These tiny bundles of potential have the power to make or break your business. Hiring a freelance content writer means you’re investing in that potential, but how will you find a content partner you can trust?

The path to incredible content is best traveled with care, and selecting a writer is just the beginning. What you really want — what you really need — is a writer who can create blog posts that drive traffic. Why? Because traffic is the lifeblood of any marketing campaign.

Bring the people, and they might buy. Write a compelling headline, and they will come. Start sharing great blog posts, and those people might even stick around. Pair all those features with high-quality copy from homepage to post-purchase thank-you emails, all peppered with irresistible calls to action, and you just might see sales soar.

But I digress.

Long before you get the satisfaction of nudging your mouse across your screen, hitting publish on your blog and watching your writer-for-hire‘s words dance across the internet, you have a job to do. Your task, should you choose to accept it, is to give your writer everything they need to understand how to write blog posts you and your audience will love.

Recruit Writers with Proven Experience in Your Niche

If you’re a baseball player dealing with a possibly career-ending knee injury, are you going to book an appointment with a general practitioner or call a board-certified orthopedist with stellar references and a jaw-droppingly impressive track record? The answer is obvious. You wouldn’t trust your livelihood, your passion or your future to just anyone.

Good writers aren’t that hard to find. Great writers who specialize in the type of content you need are far more difficult to source. Did you know there are three main categories of writers? And each of those categories explodes into a plethora of subcategories.

Writers may specialize by topic, such as hospitality or personal finance, or they may narrow their focus to email marketing or landing pages. Some writers are riveted on a teeny tiny slice of the pie, tailoring their offerings by both topic and content type.

What kind of writer are you looking for? Decide before you jump headfirst into your search. It’ll help you stay on target — no shiny object syndrome when you spot a writer who looks great but is completely wrong for the task at hand — and expedite the hunt.

How do you gauge a writer’s experience?

  • Check their samples. Most writers have some kind of portfolio, though these days ghostwriting and NDAs may make it more difficult for even the most experienced writers to share their best work. That’s why it’s a good idea to…
  • Let the writing speak for itself. Whittle your list down to two or three writers and hire each of them to create a post. This way, you’re getting a true sense of what they can do given your parameters, your topic, and your brand’s style guide.

To further streamline the process, use Crowd Content’s platform to search and review writer profiles or set up a casting call and let the talent come to you.

Provide Examples of Good Posts

Most people have an idealized version of the things they like, and everything that comes after is compared to that paragon. When you order a piping-hot slice of pizza or listen to an up-and-coming rock band’s new song, you’re automatically (if unconsciously) comparing it to the best pepperoni pie you’ve ever had and hearing the Rolling Stones in your head. Blog posts are no different.

It’s human to gravitate toward a writing style or certain blog post ideas that makes you feel something. If you want your writer to evoke those same emotions, give your freelancer a solid starting point. A couple links or a short list of names accompanied by a few notes sets the bar, letting writers know exactly how high they’re expected to jump.



Include a Detailed Creative Brief and Style/Brand Guide

One of the most common mistakes in content marketing is skipping the creative brief. It takes time and energy, and it requires you to focus on mapping out a project from start to finish before you hand it off to your team. That’s daunting.

Image showing putting ideas on paper

Putting your ideas on paper is a big hairy deal because it’s a gigantic part of conveying your vision to the people tasked with bringing it to life.

You’ll need to include:

  • A brand statement
  • An introduction to the project objectives
  • Central messaging
  • Pain points you intend to address
  • Who the audience is
  • Where the content is going to go

It’s essentially a blueprint on how to write blog posts that will resonate with your readers, advance your branding and capture reader attention in a lasting way.

Style guides are similar in that they serve as a road map to how you want your content to look, read and feel. They’re crucial for one gargantuan reason: cohesion. If you’re working with multiple writers or really any team members other than yourself, a style guide ensures everyone stays on the same page. From logos to color schemes, font preferences, tone and so much more, your brand or style guide spells out your identity, so customers learn to recognize you even when your name isn’t front and center.

Share Persona Info

No matter how many times you give your freelancer tips to write a blog that rocks, if they have no clue who they’re writing for, you’re just wasting your time. In content marketing, the audience is everything. In fact, 63 percent of smart marketers create content around a specific buyer persona, and they do it because they know buyer personas fuel dynamic content.

Learning how to develop a buyer persona is a specialized skill in of itself. Simply closing your eyes and guessing who your ideal customer is won’t cut it. It’s funny how often the reality of who follows your brand differs from who you think is loyal to your company. Gather information gleaned from user surveys, sales insights, email capture forms, subscriptions, app opt-ins and general industry/market segment profiles and identify some common denominators.

Telling your writer they’re speaking to Paul, a 33-year-old software engineer from Indiana with two kids, a mortgage and a serious Fortnite habit is beneficial beyond words. This is the same info you’ll later use to target Facebook ads and perfect your sales funnel, so make your research count.

Give Detailed, Ongoing Feedback

Copywriters may be many things — creators, strategists, SEO experts, social media gurus, spelling and grammar purists — but they’re not mind readers. They can’t correct something if they don’t know it’s wrong. On the other hand, creative types often become attached to their work, and wondering whether it’s being appreciated can feel stifling.

Clients jump at the chance to offer feedback after the initial sample or at the start of a new project, but that’s frequently the end of the road. The rest of the partnership goes by without comment until one of three things happens:

  • The writer starts to feel like a nameless, faceless cog in the wheel and their creativity stagnates
  • The writer makes a mistake and, after a long period of silence, gets negative feedback out of the blue
  • You become so accustomed to the status quo you skim the intro to each blog post and barely read the rest, gradually becoming disconnected from the heart and soul of your content strategy

Making feedback part of your process from the very beginning helps prevent critiques from feeling personal. If your writer feels attacked they won’t perform as well, but freelancers do want to hear how they’re doing.

Editing and performance reviews are par for the course in this industry, and anyone who is unwilling to accept they have room to improve won’t last very long—but that doesn’t mean you have carte blanche to rip apart every draft.

When giving feedback:

  • Be specific. Saying “it just doesn’t feel right” isn’t useful. Saying “the tone doesn’t match our brand voice” or “I prefer shorter paragraphs” is.
  • Be respectful. This is your brand’s reputation at stake, so you deserve to get the content you asked for. That said, belittling a writer won’t get anywhere.
  • Be constructive. You’re not trying to show how much you know, you’re trying to empower your writer to think bigger and be more proactive.

Above all, remember you hired this writer for a reason. Ask questions if you’re doubtful about sentence structure or word choice, but also trust you were savvy enough to partner with someone who’s an expert in their field.

Share Performance Data

No one performs well in a vacuum. Imagine being a dedicated long-distance runner but never knowing how fast your competition runs or whether you’ve improved your own time since your last outing. It’s frustrating.

Content writing and digital marketing are ever-changing works in progress. Your writer wants to get better, they want to improve conversion rates and create even more compelling content, but they can’t do that without some knowledge of where they’re starting from and how they’re doing along the way.

When you contract a new freelancer, be up front with your current state of affairs. Have you been disappointed in your social media engagement? Are you getting blog hits but no sales? Do your landing pages fall short? All of this should be part of the initial instructions or you’re not giving your writer everything they need to succeed.

Once you’ve established and shared your starting point, deliver regular updates. If a blog performs particularly well, send your writer a message. If you’re seeing a steady rise in conversions, mention that too. When numbers are going in the opposite direction, that’s important information as well — though recognize that the writing may not be the only factor contributing to your burgeoning success or stuttering traffic.

Bringing It All Together

Remember, the writer-client relationship is a partnership, and communication is imperative. Your writer is going on a trip and you’re not going to be in the passenger’s seat the whole time, so give them what they need to reach the correct destination in one piece. The whos, the whats, the whys, the hows — it all matters. Your writer knows good blogging, but you’re a stranger until you step up, introduce yourself and make it clear what you need.

Your brand is one-of-a-kind. Help your writer help you shine.

For more help kicking off the writing process, contact the Crowd Content team or reach out to your customer success manager today.

The post A Proven Process To Show Writers How To Write Blog Posts That Drive Results appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/a-proven-process-to-show-writers-how-to-write-blog-posts-that-drive-results/feed/ 0
Is SEO for Metadata Important to You? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/is-seo-for-metadata-important-to-you/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/is-seo-for-metadata-important-to-you/#respond Wed, 13 Feb 2019 20:14:12 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=20461 It should be. While the days of stuffing the meta keywords field full of search terms you’d love to rank for are long gone, metadata still impacts your rankings in a few key ways. Title tags have always been an important ranking factor on their own, and including your primary keyword naturally in the title […]

The post Is SEO for Metadata Important to You? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

It should be.

While the days of stuffing the meta keywords field full of search terms you’d love to rank for are long gone, metadata still impacts your rankings in a few key ways.

Title tags have always been an important ranking factor on their own, and including your primary keyword naturally in the title is an important aspect of optimization.

While meta descriptions have not been a direct ranking factor since Google launched RankBrain in 2015, behavioral metrics such as bounce rate, dwell time and organic clickthrough rate (OCTR) are key. Google pulls the page title and meta description to display in its search results, so both of them are now playing an active role in how RankBrain evaluates your site.

Google’s search result for Crowd Content featuring our meta title and description.

Metadata influences these behavioral metrics in a few ways:

  1. OCTR – If you achieve a great OCTR, RankBrain will see that searchers find your metadata compelling enough to click on and might reward you with higher search rankings.
  2. Bounce rate – If your bounce rate is too high, RankBrain might interpret it as searchers are not finding the content they expect based on your metadata, leading to lower placements in the search results.
  3. Dwell time – This is the inverse of bounce rate. If searchers spend a lot of time on your site after clicking a link, that indicates to RankBrain that they find your content a good match for what they searched for.

These are the three primary factors that influence RankBrain’s “Relevance Score.” If your metadata does well with these factors, RankBrain should reward you with better search results.

While good metadata helps you rank, it’s also intrinsically important in encouraging searchers to click on your links and drive traffic. It acts as a guide to search engine crawlers and your audience, letting them know exactly what the pages are all about.

Think of your title and meta description as ad copy — it needs to entice a click and communicate what your page is all about.

But what does good metadata look like?

Let’s take a look at that.

A Quick Recap of Metadata Elements

There are two primary metadata elements that impact your SEO — title and description. These are the elements you should optimize for when trying to improve your SEO through metadata.

ALSO: The Do’s and Don’ts Of Metadata

If you’d like a more technical, in-depth look at these elements, be sure to check out the w3school page on the Meta Tag.

Title Tag

The title tag specifies your web page’s title. Potential visitors see this in a few places, including search engine result pages and when your content is shared in social media (if you’re not using Open Graph tags).

Note: try to keep titles to under 60 characters, as Google only shows about that many in the search results.

As mentioned, the title tag is the only metadata element that’s a direct ranking factor, and as such, it should be optimized for the primary keyword. Typically, this means you’ll include the keyword in the title in a natural way, including using stop words and punctuation to ensure it flows well.

The title also needs to be written in an engaging way that compels people to click on it.

In the Google search result below, Impact Branding does a good job compelling searchers to click with their title. They’ve also integrated the keyword “social media conversations” into their title. Though that’s not the only reason it’s helped them rank on the first page of Google results for that keyword, it’s certainly important.

What makes a strong title? Focus on the following:

  1. Keep it succinct – less than 60 characters ideally
  2. Use words that are action focused and elicit emotional responses
  3. Follow a title convention that readers are familiar with such as lists, reviews, how-to and questions
  4. Make sure the title connects well to your content

Meta Description

Your meta description is a short summary of the page. Similar to titles, descriptions get used in search results and social media previews. Google shows roughly 160 characters of a meta description in its results, so most marketers focus on keeping theirs under that count.

While not a direct ranking factor, the description lets you really sell your content to encourage clicks and boost OCTR, helping you with RankBrain. When displayed in the search results, Google even highlights any matching search terms in your meta description, increasing the likelihood of you capturing a click. If possible, include your target keyword (and secondary keywords) in your meta descriptions to give your OCTR a boost.

Here’s an example of Google doing that for the search term “social media conversation.”

The same advice we discussed for titles also applies to meta descriptions, but consider these as well:

  1. Make sure you succinctly describe what your page is about, while piquing readers’ interest
  2. Include a call to action encouraging searchers to click on the link
  3. Include keywords you expert to rank for to help searchers know your content is a match for that term
  4. Use a variety of keywords you expect to rank for and not just your primary keyword

Tesla delivers a strong meta description that tells us exactly what the brand’s website is all about in just a few words and compels searchers to click:

What happens if your meta description isn’t succinct and doesn’t accurately reflect what your page is about? Google might ignore your description and generate its own based on the content on your page.

That’s not an ideal outcome, so make sure you put lots of care into your descriptions.

As you come to terms with how important your SEO metadata is in terms of ranking, know you don’t have to go it alone. The internet is brimming with tools to help you test, analyze and audit to keep you on the right track.

Tools to Help You Optimize Metadata SEO

SEO metadata optimization ultimately comes down to working on your meta title and descriptions, and there are a number of great tools that help you do that. We’ve chosen six of the top choices that we just couldn’t do without.

1. ClickFlow

ClickFlow is an awesome tool that lets you test the effectiveness of your metadata so you can make minor adjustments for huge rewards.

Essentially, it lets you test metadata variations and see which one delivers the highest OCTR. All you need to do is connect your Google Search Console to the tool, and you’ll be able to start optimizing. ClickFlow organizes and manages all your metadata experiments, which is a huge benefit, as metadata experiments can be a pretty manual exercise otherwise.

image

The dashboard lets you organize all your experiments and get some high-level performance metrics. It’s pretty easy to prove your efforts are successful if you can show increased clicks, OCTR and revenue increases.

The beauty of this is that you get to grow your organic traffic without having to keep building lots of links or producing lots more content, as simply increasing your OCTR helps you with RankBrain. Subsequently, you can boost your rankings.

Besides — what marketer ever said no to more clicks?

2. Google Analytics/Google Search Console

This might be an obvious one, but these are two important tools for metadata optimization.

Google Analytics is a totally free web analytics service that lets you analyze a website’s traffic. It’s pretty encompassing, and when used in conjunction with Google Search Console (also free), it can help you monitor your organic clickthrough rate.

While not as structured as ClickFlow,  you can use it to work out how effective your titles and descriptions are by tracking a page’s OCTR.

To access this, navigate to Aquisition > Search Console > Landing Pages.

Here you’ll see how your pages are performing in Google’s organic search. By making changes to your page’s metadata and tracking changes to your OCTR, you can create your own metadata tests manually that are similar to ClickFlow’s.

Plus, Analytics will let you see which pages have the highest number of organic impressions. Finding a page with a large number of impressions can yield the best results if you successfully boost your OCTR.

While clickthrough rate alone can help you gauge how effective or ineffective your metadata is, Google Search Console also comes with an HTML Improvements section that flags potential problems with your title tags and meta descriptions. This includes missing titles or descriptions or duplicate titles and descriptions. I’ve focused on how you can improve existing metadata so far, but missing or duplicate metadata is a bigger issue and extremely low-hanging fruit.

3. Spreadsheets

Spreadsheets are necessary to keep organized if you’re manually experimenting with metadata.

Make sure you create a spreadsheet that tracks:

  1. Current metadata
  2. Test metadata
  3. Current Impressions
  4. Current Clicks
  5. Current OCTR
  6. Test Impressions
  7. Test Clicks
  8. Test OCTR
  9. Current search rankings
  10. Test search rankings

All of this data comes from Analytics and Search Console, but keeping it organized lets you track the results of your experiments. It also lets you track titles and descriptions in case you need to switch back to them.

Any spreadsheet tool will work for this — Excel, Google Sheets, Open Office, Libra, etc.

4. CoSchedule Headline Analyzer

CoSchedule’s Headline Analyzer is a great  tool to experiment with your meta title tags. A title tag works a lot like a headline, and it’s your chance to grab the attention of searchers in the SERPs. A title tag must be compelling and direct, and it needs to succinctly and powerfully explain what the content is all about.

As this is not always easy, it’s a good idea to use a testing tool that lets you analyze your data and results.

Headline Analyzer evaluates your headlines and gives you a score from between 1 to 100, with 100 being a perfect score. (Not sure if anyone has ever achieved that though!).

It evaluates your word choice, title length, keywords included and more. In general, if you can earn a good score with Headline Analyzer, your title should perform well.

Note: This tool suggests you have a minimum of 55 characters in your headlines; just make sure you don’t go too far above that or Google may truncate your title in search results.

This tool is free to use. If you want to use CoSchedule’s broader set of tools that let you organize your marketing and social media, packages start out at only $80 per month.

5. SEMrush

Image result for semrush logo

SEMrush is a premium search engine marketing suite that’s designed to boost your marketing efforts. Whether you’re running PPC campaigns, social media campaigns, or want to increase traffic organically, it’s pretty handy to have by your side.

There are many ways it can benefit your metadata SEO game, but one of my favorite features is the SEO audit. The tool scans all your web pages and identifies any that are lacking metadata or have duplicate content.

Many online marketers either sometimes forget to add meta descriptions to new pages or have inherited sites with missing metadata. In either case, adding metadata to a page that doesn’t have it is a big opportunity.

Here’s a resource on how to perform an SEO audit with SEMrush and nail your metadata.

SEMrush is a paid service, but if you’re looking for a tool that will audit your site’s metadata in a similar fashion, check out Screaming Frog, which offers a free plan that lets you audit up to 500 pages.

6. Crowd Content

Writing meta descriptions and title tags isn’t easy, especially when you have a large number of pages and want to run experiments.

Crafting compelling, persuasive bite-sized pieces of content that convince searchers to click on your web page at scale is tricky.

ALSOGetting Metadata With Your Orders

This is where a service such as Crowd Content proves useful. Home to versatile, professional metadata writers, it lets you connect with a writer who knows what makes internet users tick. They’ll acquaint themselves with your business and your content, and then deliver compelling metadata that hits the mark with your target audience.

Wrapping It Up

Title tags and meta descriptions remain the most important metadata elements in 2019, and they should continue to form a key part of your SEO strategy moving forward. The overall role of metadata SEO has changed over the years, but it’s key that you continue to nail these two.

With RankBrain using behavioral metrics such as organic clickthrough rates to determine how useful and relevant a piece of content is to the end user, you need to leverage the power of title tags and meta description to persuade Google and the searcher that you’ve got the best piece of content.

The tools I’ve mentioned here should help you get organized and focused on improving your metadata’s SEO.

Have any other tools you think I should have covered? Please let me know in the comments below.

The post Is SEO for Metadata Important to You? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/is-seo-for-metadata-important-to-you/feed/ 0
How to Write Unique Articles When It Seems Everything Has Been Written https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/article-writing/how-to-write-unique-articles-when-it-seems-everything-has-been-written/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/article-writing/how-to-write-unique-articles-when-it-seems-everything-has-been-written/#respond Thu, 17 Jan 2019 21:50:59 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=18658 I hate to break it to you. If you’re struggling with how to write unique articles, Mark Twain was right. He famously said: “There is no such thing as a new idea. It is impossible. We simply take a lot of old ideas and put them into a sort of mental kaleidoscope. We give them […]

The post How to Write Unique Articles When It Seems Everything Has Been Written appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

I hate to break it to you. If you’re struggling with how to write unique articles, Mark Twain was right. He famously said:

“There is no such thing as a new idea. It is impossible. We simply take a lot of old ideas and put them into a sort of mental kaleidoscope. We give them a turn, and they make new and curious combinations. We keep on turning and making new combinations indefinitely, but they are the same old pieces of colored glass that have been in use through all the ages.”

Words are words, and aside from new entries to the lexicon, such as “fleek” and “yeet,” replacing words such as “thou” and “thine,” we wield the same vocabulary used centuries ago.

Truly unique ideas are hard to come by, but here’s the thing: You don’t necessarily need a unique idea — all that’s required is a different approach, point of view, or personal experience that makes an old idea new again.

Whether you’re a writer looking for inspiration or a business owner hoping to use a professional article writing service to create a unique piece of content for your website or blog, we have a few ideas to help you breathe life into an internet that often feels filled to the brim with the same old, same old.

Shake Up the Angle

You may struggle if you try to write 100% unique content using the same brainstorming and research methods every writer uses. The internet is filled with low-level content because those articles practically write themselves. They require little research and provide equally little value.

Flip the script by changing up how you look at the topic at hand:

  • Look for long-tail, related search terms. Long-tail keywords are at least three words long and offer specificity, such as “content marketing tips and tricks” instead of “content marketing.” Google is helpful for that — just type in your primary keyword or topic and see what Google’s autocomplete feature comes up with.
  • “Listen” on social media. Visit your competitors’ social media pages, search for relevant hashtags, check out groups dedicated to your topic, and see what people have to say. It’s one of the easiest ways to surreptitiously survey real people reporting what matters to them — it’s essentially market research without the gasp-inducing price tag. Social listening also has the advantage of being an agile tactic. You can gather information quickly and put that data to work just as fast, slashing your turnaround time.
  • Collect audience feedback/input. This is a more direct form of market research. Send an email to your followers, or create a social media poll asking the public for their thoughts on a given topic. “If you could ask your podiatrist any question, what would it be?” “What should people know about motherhood?” “What did you like least about the last marketing book you read?”
  • Make an old topic new again. Perhaps there’s an article on wine pairing that everyone calls the gold standard, but it was written in 2008. A lot can happen in nearly 2 decades, and tastes and trends evolve. Twenty years ago, people would get a case of the vapors if you suggested pairing red wine and fish; today, sommeliers love to serve a light and juicy pinot noir with fatty, succulent salmon. Use modern data and current trends to spin an outdated article into something that reflects current tastes and, even better, your expertise.

Break New Ground

Tim Soulo, Chief Marketing Officer and Product Advisor at Ahrefs, has a wonderful anecdote from the days when he was a newbie blogger. He wanted to write an article about guest blogging, but there were already plenty of posts on the topic. So, he set out to get information no one else had.

“I acted like a journalist and reached out to over 500 bloggers, big and small, and asked them to share some data with me on how their guest articles performed and if they were happy with the results,” Soulo explained in an Ahrefs video. “This whole venture resulted in one of my best articles to date. And even though it was published on my personal blog, which hardly had any traffic, that article generated quite a buzz and got over a hundred links from 60 different websites.”

This example demonstrates that you can always find new ways to add authority to your content — just roll up your sleeves, and gather the information inquiring minds want to know.

Play with Different Formats

A title, an intro, subheaders, and a conclusion — it’s the go-to format for writing articles, and it works. But it’s also so common it can make your eyes glaze over. When you shake up how your article is put together, you inevitably shake up the content as well.

Make each subheader a well-known quote instead of a short, generic phrase. Use resources such as HARO to gather expert insights, and build your article around that input. Instead of talking about what your readers should do, tell them how they can do it. Frame your info using a series of dos and don’ts. Create a Q&A, which is a fantastic way to boost search engine optimization. Incorporate anecdotes and real-life experience to comply with Google’s E-E-A-T principle. Doing the unexpected can get you noticed, and that’s important when you’re trying to turn a good idea into a way to make money online.

Move Beyond Words

Blogs are traditionally text-based, but audiences do more than read online. They’re watching videos, scrolling through TikTok, and exchanging opinions on Reddit and LinkedIn. Draw inspiration from this rich landscape, and give your written musings a makeover with compelling visuals, informative graphics, and video snippets.

Is there an opportunity to illustrate a how-to guide by making a video or a way to conceptualize a process by creating a graphic? Perhaps a screenshot of a savvy post on X underscores your message. Integrating other media types can set your written content apart and appeal to different learning styles and preferences.

Brainstorm With AI

While you don’t want to rely on technology to write your content, you can fire up ChatGPT or other AI chatbots to toss ideas around. AI can help generate ideas and determine keyword intent, supplementing your thoughts and sparking that “a-ha!” moment.

Just be sure to add your point of view to any AI output. For SEO purposes, your content should reflect experience, expertise, authoritativeness, and trustworthiness. Many websites are also reeling from Google’s helpful content update, which knocked web pages deemed as unhelpful down the SERPs.ChatGPT isn’t quite at the point where it can create expert content on its own. As discussed in our post about whether AI content ranks in Google, AI combined with human oversight is where the magic happens.

Spy on the Competition — And Then Outdo Them

You’ve probably heard the old adage, “If you can’t beat ’em, join ’em,” but if there isn’t a way to outsmart, out-ideate, and outwrite the competition, you can hire someone with the writing skills who can.

You need to know what your competition is up to so you can be one step ahead. Perform a content gap analysis to see what’s been covered and what your content is missing, then fill in the gaps. You should attempt to create the most comprehensive content available.

To do that, use tools such as MarketMuse and Semrush to inform your ideation process. MarketMuse is an optimization powerhouse, but instead of optimizing for keywords, it focuses on topics. You enter the general subject matter, and MarketMuse gives you the top-ranking pages for that theme and topic suggestions that can add depth. Semrush is known for its SEO capabilities, but it also generates topic ideas and analyzes content on a given domain. In a conversation with Rick Leach, Crowd Content’s Vice President of Content Operations, he and I dive into how we differentiate content. It’s worth a listen if you want to pick up actionable tips for your own blog.

Take a Total Left Turn

It’s hard to come up with something fresh when everything you’re reading is staler than 3-day-old popcorn. When everyone in the real estate industry is writing about the same staging techniques and negotiation tactics, it’s time to get your inspiration elsewhere. 

Jason Patterson saying

Stop reading blog posts and books from within your niche. Instead, give your brain an intellectual jolt, and see what comes out. Brainstorm with your readers in mind, and never settle for anything but high-quality content. 

How to Write Unique Articles With Crowd Content

When you’re immersed in writing about the same topics day in and day out, it’s easy to fall into a rut. No matter how talented and creative you or your writing team are, you might find yourself relying on the same humdrum phrasing and approach. If you’re feeling stuck, send us an SOS for fresh perspectives. Our freelance article writers can inject energy into your content and revitalize a tired blog while ensuring your vision shines through.

The post How to Write Unique Articles When It Seems Everything Has Been Written appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/article-writing/how-to-write-unique-articles-when-it-seems-everything-has-been-written/feed/ 0
How To Get a Ghostwriter To Craft an eBook That Drives Results https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-get-a-ghostwriter-to-craft-an-ebook-that-will-drive-results/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-get-a-ghostwriter-to-craft-an-ebook-that-will-drive-results/#respond Tue, 08 Jan 2019 20:17:07 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=18580 What do you do when you have a story but aren’t sure how to tell it? When you have a killer idea burning a hole in your brain, you find someone who can give your tale the literary genius it deserves. In short, you get a ghostwriter. Everyone from Richard Branson to Michelle Obama has […]

The post How To Get a Ghostwriter To Craft an eBook That Drives Results appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What do you do when you have a story but aren’t sure how to tell it? When you have a killer idea burning a hole in your brain, you find someone who can give your tale the literary genius it deserves.

In short, you get a ghostwriter.

Everyone from Richard Branson to Michelle Obama has brought their books to market with the help of professional writers who know how to turn a life well lived and meteoric business successes into a narrative the public would ultimately devour. Other authors, like Bond-inventor Ian Fleming and thrill-expert Tom Clancy used ghostwriters to create new works of fiction in order to meet audience demand.

Whatever your goal, realizing your long-awaited book project isn’t as easy as hiring a ghostwriter and awaiting the finished copy. This is without a doubt a collaboration, and it all hinges on you setting your writer up for success.

Recruiting Talent

When interviewing ebook ghostwriters, consider — or outright ask — the following:

  • How are they with deadlines?
  • Are they working on other projects, or can they dedicate their time solely to you? (If it’s the latter, be prepared to pay accordingly.) Hiring an ebook writer who tells you they don’t have the time to work on your project midway through could set you back significantly.
  • Do they have set work hours? In other words, will they return an email on a Saturday, or should you expect a couple days before you get a response? Every ghostwriter works their own schedule, so knowing this upfront is key.
  • Do they have experience writing in your niche? There are different types of writers, and not all will be well-suited for the task at hand. Can they reference any other ghostwriting clients of theirs?
  • Are they willing to do interviews or conduct research, if applicable?
  • How flexible are they? Can they adjust their writing style to fit your tone?
  • Can they handle constructive criticism? Will they act as a book coach and be proactive or are they only willing to take a passive role?
  • Can they share examples of other quality ebooks they’ve written?

These questions help you identify if a writer has the experience you need and if their working style matches yours. It’s critical you know this upfront, because given the time, research and writing that goes into ebooks, discovering your writer isn’t a good fit mid-project can be very costly.

Once you know what you’re looking for in a writer, the question turns to where you can find them.

You can place ads on well-known job sites and sift through resumes or ask friends for referrals; if you have a social media following or room in your budget, sponsored posts and ads may work too.

I know this sounds like a ton of work and it will take a lot of time, but there’s a shortcut: shop for writers via a platform like Crowd Content. We’ve already vetted our talent and have account managers standing by to help streamline your experience, so you won’t have to worry about the nitty-gritty details like writing up a contract or arranging payment.

Laying Out Your Objectives

Once you’ve chosen “the one” (swoon!), make your intentions clear. Traditional companies include a detailed job description in the onboarding process, and you should too. Your writer shouldn’t have any doubt as to what you’re trying to accomplish.

Photo of Grease actors dancing, singing

There’s a huge difference between writing for an audience already familiar with your work or writing a book intended for mass-market distribution. There’s also a big difference between creating a book that will be downloaded as part of an email-capture campaign or writing a book you hope will one day be turned into a major motion picture.

How the finished asset will fit into your overall campaign or sales funnel will shape the entire project. Skip this step and you put your writer at a major disadvantage — and you’re unlikely to get the results you’re hoping for, either.

Putting Together a Game Plan

Some things in life are more fun when they’re left to chance. Ghostwriting is not one of those things. You need a framework in place that includes a comprehensive to-do list and shared milestones — basically checkpoints where you and your writer will touch base or exchange notes.

Everyone’s method is different, but in general your plans should look a little something like this:

  1. Know your goals, budget and basic content design elements such as target length and tone
  2. Identify a few promising candidates, conduct interviews and ask your finalists for their project proposal
  3. Choose your ghostwriter
  4. Hand over any existing research and other relevant materials
  5. Decide on an outline for the book
  6. Set dates for a call or series of calls so the writer can ask whatever questions they need to flesh out the outline
  7. Agree on an expanded outline that includes a detailed chapter-by-chapter blueprint
  8. Look over a single-chapter draft and evaluate for structure and tone, and then let the writer loose
  9. Receive and read through an entire draft
  10. Offer feedback and go through the agreed-upon number of revisions
  11. Submit for editing (if you’ve hired a separate editor)
  12. Revel in your monumental accomplishment

Providing Data and Info

If you want data-backed results (and you do), you must start out with plenty of data your writer can use to paint an accurate and authentic picture. The type of information involved depends on the kind of book you’re creating. For an autobiography, you may want to gather everything from elementary school report cards to pictures from spring break ’99.

A business book on launching a startup won’t work without real-life success stories, while a company manual will be almost entirely made up of tech-speak you’ll probably want to run by your legal and mechanical experts before sharing.

Other bits of data are linked to your objectives. Things like your buyer persona are crucial — no one can write quality content without a specific reader in mind.

Communicating with Your Writer

I’m going to let you in on a little secret: some writers are serious introverts. And by serious, I mean that some of my favorite content writers would rather give up their beloved Oxford commas than answer a phone call. I get all that, I really do, but ghostwriting jobs are more demanding and, in many ways, more intimate than typical freelancing gigs, and your chosen form of communication should be more personal as well.

Feel free to use email to create a paper trail of ideas, trade edits or scribble and send moments of inspiration, especially if your best brainstorming happens in the wee hours. When it comes to your initial communication and ongoing discussions, though, it’s often better to connect via phone or video conference. From a face-to-face interview to shared readings of chapters currently in progress, picking up the phone or signing on to Zoom is a fast and efficient way to quickly iron out any kinks and make sure that everyone is on the same page.

Reviewing Drafts and Formulating Feedback

Real talk: you aren’t doing anyone any favors by being too nice.

Your penchant for passivity? Ditch it.

Your tendency to swallow critiques because you don’t want anyone to feel bad? Stop it right now.

Your book is your baby. That’s why you’re investing time and money into finding a professional ghostwriter to whip your concept into an award-winning book. When your ghostwriter sends you a draft, pore over it like it’s in the running for Oprah’s book club. Depending on the type of book and intended audience, you may be more concerned with grammar and citations or tone and feel.

Do the chapters feel isolated or does the book read like a cohesive whole? Does the narrative feel authentic and personal? Does the introduction grab you immediately? Is your message clear? Does the conclusion give the reader a sense of finality — or leave them wanting, depending on your goal? Are the statistics or study numbers accurate? Is this book something you’d be proud to put your name on?

It may help to read the draft out loud. Repeated readings are also useful, especially if you read the book once, sit on it for a day or two, then read it again. Don’t rush the editing process. When you do make comments, be clear about what you don’t like and why. “This doesn’t feel right” isn’t an actionable piece of feedback, but “This has a more negative tone than I wish to convey” does.

If you’d like more tips on revising effectively, check out The Writer Center’s guide for some great advice.

A Quick But Effective Process

To sum things up, remember these core tenets:

  • Hire smart. A blog post is not a book, and hiring a writer who excels at one form of content doesn’t necessarily mean they can nail your ghostwriting project.
  • Pony up the data/details. We’ve all read a book that went on and on without saying a thing. That’s not what you want from your own project, is it? Nope. Whether you’re sitting on client surveys, Yelp reviews, case studies, Google analytics, personal anecdotes, proof of concept — whatever it is, it should be in your writer’s inbox.
  • Communicate often. Cultivate a relationship with your writer that encourages an open dialogue. If you value your writer’s opinion, they’re more likely to make suggestions that could exponentially improve your book.
  • Own your results. With ghostwriting, you’ll only get what you give and ultimately, your book sales are your responsibility.

The world is waiting for your story. Isn’t it time to write a book and give your readers what they want? If you’d like to get started today, check out our ghostwriting services to find the perfect writer today.

The post How To Get a Ghostwriter To Craft an eBook That Drives Results appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-get-a-ghostwriter-to-craft-an-ebook-that-will-drive-results/feed/ 0
Can You Outsource Landing Page Copywriting? 7 Things to Consider First https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/can-you-outsource-landing-page-copywriting-7-things-to-consider-first/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/can-you-outsource-landing-page-copywriting-7-things-to-consider-first/#respond Fri, 04 Jan 2019 17:45:30 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=18487 Landing page copywriting requires a lot of technique infused with a heady dose of artistic flair. You need a writer who can convey the best aspects of your product or service to consumers and convince them to buy in; numbers and data work, but only if they’re buoyed by emotion. People want a reason to […]

The post Can You Outsource Landing Page Copywriting? 7 Things to Consider First appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Landing page copywriting requires a lot of technique infused with a heady dose of artistic flair.

You need a writer who can convey the best aspects of your product or service to consumers and convince them to buy in; numbers and data work, but only if they’re buoyed by emotion. People want a reason to stop scrolling by and tricking them into clicking through to a web-based snoozefest just isn’t going to cut it.

With so much at stake, it makes sense to hire a freelance copywriter to write your landing page copy, but outsourcing comes with its own unique set of key considerations. Follow these tips for making the most of landing page copywriting services and see what high-converting landing pages can truly do.

ALSOWhat is Copywriting and What Are Its Best Practices?

1. Hire the Right Person for Your Landing Page Copywriting Job

Many business owners aren’t aware that copywriting and content writing are different.

Copywriters specialize in creating copy closely tied to sales — think ads, landing pages, websites, billboards, brochures and product descriptions — while content writers lean more toward informative writing and storytelling, creating blogs, press releases, white papers, books and so on. Hiring a copywriter who excels at landing pages is a crucial part of properly shaping and sharing your brand’s message and reaching your goals.

ALSODo You Need a Copywriter or a Content Writer?

2. Double-Check Whether Your Writer Knows Their Limits

No, I’m not talking about pushing your contractor to eat three squares a day and get decent shut-eye. Some forms of content come with restrictions. Violate them, and the content could be less effective or even unusable. Landing pages often rely on templates that have fixed lengths for text — does your copywriter know what those limits are, and can they write fluid, compelling content that fits?

Crowd Content lets users build templates that dictate how long each content element can be (either by word or character count), keeping writers on task and ensuring everyone is on the same page.

3. Be Crystal Clear About Your Offer

Writers who work in the dark rarely submit picture-perfect content. It’s difficult if not impossible to create a high-converting landing page if you don’t understand what the page is supposed to do. Tell your writer:

  • Where the landing page fits in the funnel
  • What the purpose of the landing page is
  • Where the user is at in the buyer journey

Paint a vivid version of the big picture and your writer will be better equipped to craft any landing page that helps you accomplish your goals.

4. Know Where Your Page’s Traffic Will Be Coming From

…and share that information with your copywriter. Landing pages should be relevant to the buyer journey, and that means continuing a conversation that started elsewhere. Whether the buyer clicked on a Facebook post or a paid ad or an affiliate link, they’re already mid-conversation and it’s up to the writer to create a landing page that’s consistent.

Remember, ad platforms also rate your page’s user relevancy—Google Ad’s Quality Score and Facebook’s ever-changing ad algorithm have the ability to scan your landing page and decide whether it’s in line with the content used to send consumers there. At the very least, you need to give your writer info on which audience is being targeted, and a set of keywords would be helpful too.

ALSOCopywriting For SEO

5. Give Your Writer the Gift of Social Proof

Social proof is kind of like the modern, more positive version of peer pressure. Every time you look at a restaurant’s Yelp reviews before making a reservation or buy into the “4 out of 5 moms recommend…” line featured in a diaper commercial you’re taking action based on the actions of others.

Marketers use social proof to give new concepts, products and services perceived value. Consumers are understandably hesitant to spend their hard-earned cash on a fancy frying pan that could easily be a dud, but show those same consumers a Facebook video of people flipping golden-brown pancakes and talking about how the pan revolutionized breakfast and the hesitancy starts to disappear.

It’s possible to write landing page copy without social proof, but writing copy that incorporates testimonials, case studies or social media engagement figures is a far more effective way to urge potential customers through the sales funnel.

6. Compare Your Landing Page Copy with Split Testing

Even the most experienced copywriter isn’t omniscient. All the writing talent, word acrobatics and technical marketing expertise in the world can’t predict with absolute certainty how a landing page will connect with your ideal customer. The only way to know for sure is to ask your copywriter to create variants for key text elements—headlines, bullet points versus block text and so on — then use A/B testing to compare conversion rates and choose which page to launch in full.

You can also choose to A/B test other elements of your landing page; vary your offer, reframe your selling point, swap out images, or tweak your forms and see how consumers respond. While those decisions are for the client to make rather than the writer, your offer also informs the landing page copy, so if you change one, you’ll need to change the other.

7. Don’t Skip Over the Small Things

Why pay someone to dither over a few words here and a call to action there when you can dash them off yourself? Well, there are several reasons actually, but here’s the big one: you hired an expert, and you should let them do their job.

Cohesion is vital to the success of a landing page, and that’s best achieved by sticking to one voice, one writer, one cook in the kitchen.

Every word on that page plays a role and it often takes writers hours or even days to wrangle those words into submission. You may not be able to see how one stray phrase here or there could make a difference, but trust me, consumers can sense a disjointed message from a million miles away. Great copy is like alchemy—you don’t need to understand how it happens in order to appreciate the result.

Wrapping It Up

A good copywriter is worth her weight in gold… and sometimes more. But, even the best copywriter will struggle to craft copy that drives results if they’re lacking clear instructions along with information and context about how their work fits into the buyer’s journey.

In my experience, following the 7 tips I’ve outlined above will set your writer up for success, and in turn, setup your campaigns to print money.

The post Can You Outsource Landing Page Copywriting? 7 Things to Consider First appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/can-you-outsource-landing-page-copywriting-7-things-to-consider-first/feed/ 0
Are Short Blog Posts Worth It in a Long-Form World? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/are-short-blog-posts-worth-it-in-a-long-form-world/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/are-short-blog-posts-worth-it-in-a-long-form-world/#respond Tue, 27 Nov 2018 18:21:49 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=18472 How long should your blog posts be to attract visitors and rank highly with the search engines? Are shorter blog posts your best bet, or does long-form content generate more engagement? In a world of shifting content marketing expectations, it’s easy for companies to miss the mark and suffer the SEO consequences. Here’s what you […]

The post Are Short Blog Posts Worth It in a Long-Form World? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How long should your blog posts be to attract visitors and rank highly with the search engines?

Are shorter blog posts your best bet, or does long-form content generate more engagement?

In a world of shifting content marketing expectations, it’s easy for companies to miss the mark and suffer the SEO consequences. Here’s what you need to know about blogs, length and getting the most for your digital content dollars.

Long Story Short: Content Trends

The title gives it away — long-form content is quickly becoming the standard for sites that want to drive solid SEO. Total it up, and you’ll find that this piece falls into a sweet spot of 1,200 to 1,300 words — enough to offer more in-depth insight without overwhelming audiences.

But what’s driving this trend? And are companies really seeing a difference between long and short blog posts?

To answer the last question first, absolutely. As noted by Search Engine Land, long posts rank extremely well.

serp-iq-content-length
Photo Credit: Search Engine Land

Top-ranked posts typically break the 2,000 word mark, and longer posts generate more backlinks on average. According to Small Business Trends, search engines theoretically find long-form content easier to categorize and contextualize.

At first glance, it definitely makes sense to write or buy blog content in excess of 2,000 words to capitalize on this trend.

But is that the whole story?

The Value Challenge

The data is clear. Longer pieces generally perform better, make it easier to add links and, as noted by The Next Web, can help improve social media sharing.

So why bother with short-form blog posts?

Because there’s a marked difference between a good blog post that happens to be short and a long blog post that’s only long because it “should” be. And that difference has a name: Value.

Longer posts aren’t just generating traffic because they’re long — they offer companies the chance to go in-depth about topics that interest them and add value for users.

However, it quickly becomes very obvious if businesses are prioritizing post length over value.

Think of it as finding a balance between fluff and fact. If you only need 500 words to get the message across, don’t write 1,000 words. While smaller posts may not generate as much traffic, they’re often a great source of inspiration for longer posts that draw out or dive into specific details.

And while data seems to indicate that longer posts perform better (and on average they do), that’s largely because they better satisfy searcher intent. If you do an excellent job satisfying searcher intent with a shorter post, you may outrank competitors with longer posts that are made up of weaker information.

ALSOThought Leadership in Content: What It Really Means

Short Blog Posts: Finding the “Write” Amount

Numbers should be your secondary concern behind searcher intent. If you can answer customers’ questions with short content or solve their problems with a short blog post, do it. Prioritize creating content to solve searcher needs and not word count targets if positive organic outcomes are your goal.

That said, word count is your secondary concern, and you should be aware of how long your competitors’ content is. I’d recommend using a tool such as SEMrush’s SEO Content Template to see how long your competitors’ content is and what topics they’ve covered. While you don’t necessarily have to write more than they have, this can give you a good ballpark and guide you to create more semantically complete content.

Because every search term has a different competitive landscape, how much you need to write varies a lot. In general, though, different lengths of blog posts are going to serve different objectives.

So what’s the ideal amount to write? Let’s break it down:

  • 500 words(ish): These quick-hitter blogs are useful if you’re reporting on newsworthy items, announcing new products or bringing in guest posters. Don’t expect massive traffic returns here, but a well-written piece may generate some organic shares and comments.
  • Sub-1000 words: Content that’s anywhere between 500 and 1000 words is still considered short content and remains the length of choice for most online journalists. It’s long enough to tackle one topic and delve just below the surface, in turn prompting further discussion.
  • 1000 – 1500 words: This is what many advertising and content marketing firms now consider the “ideal” blog post length. It’s not exactly long or short, falling somewhere in the middle and making it possible to take on multiple aspects of a single topic in one post. Well-written pieces of this length can generate solid SEO and reliable traffic over time.
  • 2000 words and over: These are the big ones — in-depth, well-researched blog posts that don’t shy away from going deep and discussing complex topics. If they’re well-written, these longer posts own the ranking game. Keep in mind, though, that low-quality posts are easy to spot and entirely ignored by curious users.

ALSOIs Long-Form Content The Way to Go?

Look Before You Long-Form

If everyone else is going long-form, you should too — right?

Not without a plan.

Longer content alone doesn’t guarantee consumer interest, organic shares and backlinks. You need to create content that users want to read.

Start with what’s sometimes referred to as the “skyscraper method:”

  • Research top keywords that align with your business objectives to see what content tops the list.
  • Read through and discover what type of content is already on the web. How long are these pieces? How in-depth?
  • Look for spaces where your company can fill in knowledge gaps or offer deeper coverage to stand out from the crowd. Tools such as SEMrush’s SEO Content Template or MarketMuse can help you identify possible topic areas and begin building out your content strategy.

What does this mean for longer posts?

If you find high-quality short content that’s generating significant traffic for your competitors, consider building out a long-form strategy that leverages key points but delivers more in-depth analysis.

If keyword analysis turns up minimal content of any length, start with short-form pieces to prime your audience and update the pieces over time as needed.

No matter the existing content landscape, remember that your goal isn’t just to hit a particular word count or write longer posts than your competitors — it’s to create high-quality content that aligns with consumer interest and delivers immediate value.

Reader, Interrupted

Short posts also come with a unique advantage over their longer cousins. They’re quicker to read and digest. Sure, this is obvious, but what’s not so apparent is the impact on users if they’re interrupted while reading a long-form article.

Let’s say they’re halfway through a 2000-word piece you’ve put weeks of work into. A colleague or family member breaks their concentration, and after the distraction, they try to refocus on the post at hand. As noted by Inc., however, it takes 23 minutes to recover after a distraction and get back on track. The result is that readers may give up halfway through your content — not because it’s poorly-written or missing the mark, but because they can’t find enough time.

Short content in the 500 to 1000 word range can be consumed in 2-5 minutes, making it far more likely that readers will stay until the end and be curious enough to comment or read more.

The Short Stack

Long isn’t always better. There are some areas where short-form posts excel. These include “episodic” content posted over a set period of time; smaller connected posts published at regular intervals can help keep readers engaged. Diving into cluster items from SEO topic clusters are also well-served by shorter posts since they may not require the depth to support longer-form content.

Don’t just take our word for it. As noted by Forbes, sites like Tech Crunch are out there generating $2.5 million every month. Take a look at their site, and you’ll find the vast majority of content is less than 1000 words. Meanwhile, massively popular site Huffington Post covers breaking news with pieces ranging from sub-500 words to more than 2,000.

TL;DR?

The stats are in. It’s a long-form world — in-depth, deep-coverage content outperforms shorter blog pieces.

But this isn’t a hard-and-fast rule. Badly-written, extremely long content won’t do you any favors, while tight, short copy can help engage users and set the stage for more in-depth discussions, comments and social media shares.

Bottom line? There’s still a place for short blogs posts in a long-form world.

 

The post Are Short Blog Posts Worth It in a Long-Form World? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/are-short-blog-posts-worth-it-in-a-long-form-world/feed/ 0
The Three Types of Writers Your Brand (Probably) Needs https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-three-types-of-writers-your-brand-probably-needs/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-three-types-of-writers-your-brand-probably-needs/#respond Wed, 21 Nov 2018 17:00:11 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=18457 So, you want to hire a writer. Hiring outside help is a phenomenal way to boost marketing efforts while ensuring your brand is in experienced, linguistically capable hands — but writers aren’t all created the same. In fact, there are several different types of writers, all of whom have their own strengths, weaknesses and areas […]

The post The Three Types of Writers Your Brand (Probably) Needs appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
So, you want to hire a writer.

Hiring outside help is a phenomenal way to boost marketing efforts while ensuring your brand is in experienced, linguistically capable hands — but writers aren’t all created the same. In fact, there are several different types of writers, all of whom have their own strengths, weaknesses and areas of specialty.

Finding the right person to write content for your website isn’t just a matter of connecting with someone who can string together a convincing combination of nouns and verbs.

For your content to excel, you need a writer whose skill set and expertise matches the project at hand.

With that in mind, here’s a quick overview of the three types of writers your business might consider hiring and for what jobs.

Copywriters

Copywriters are the word-spinning geniuses behind marketing content and other kinds of promotional material. “Copy” generally has three goals:

  • Connect with the target demographic
  • Communicate brand messaging
  • Convert, as in compelling a sale or inspiring the reader to click, email or call

Think of copywriting as action-based writing. It’s sales, but instead of knocking on doors and demonstrating the handy-dandy features of an upright vacuum cleaner or convincing car shoppers that they really need that upgraded interior, copywriters are using the power of the written word to position a client’s products or services as the solution to a specific pain point.

ALSO: What is Copywriting?

You might hire a copywriter for:

  • Ads
  • Product descriptions
  • Landing pages
  • Sales pages
  • Copy-based search engine optimization (SEO)

Some copywriters dabble in multiple niches, while others are the master of landing pages or Facebook ads and won’t touch anything else. If you’d prefer to have one writer take care of everything, make sure you discuss that up front, but also know that sometimes it’s good to have a surgeon, anesthesiologist and scrub nurse all on your team. In other words, there are occasions when a copywriter with a practically Lilliputian area of expertise is far more valuable than a supposed jack-of-all-trades.

ALSO: Copywriting for SEO: How to Be Sure Your eCommerce Copy Converts and Ranks

Content Writers

Content writing is also part of marketing, but it’s a softer sell and involves more layers of the overall sales funnel. Depending on the piece, content writers may try to inform, entertain, establish authority, nurture rapport and build trust — or all of the above.

Where copywriting seeks to make a sale, content writing is how you soften up a potential customer, laying the groundwork for the idea and promise behind a product.

Most often, content writers create content that’s top of funnel near the awareness and interest stages. Copywriters tend to create content at the desire and action stages.

Content writers are responsible for projects such as:

  • Blog posts
  • Articles
  • White papers
  • Ebooks
  • Social media posts
  • Press releases
  • Reviews
  • Web content
  • Employee bios

As with copywriters, the content writers you hire may do a little bit of everything, or they might stick to a single industry — say, plumbing or wine — or a single category of content.

ALSO: How to Tell Freelance Content Writers What You Really Need

Fiction Writers

All writing involves a certain level of imagination, but creative writing has more leeway. Fiction writers may be inspired by real-life people and events, but they aren’t tied to that narrative. They can conjure characters out of thin air. They can even conceive of entire worlds a la Tolkien or Rowling, writing a book that takes readers places nobody on the planet has ever been before.

It may not seem like fiction writers have a place in the cold, hard world of sales and marketing. While it’s true that both content writing and copywriting require a strong factual thread that lends credibility and legitimacy, how you flesh out that truth skeleton is up for grabs.

Some people choose to fuel their marketing initiatives with pie charts and statistics. Others turn to storytelling to share information in a format that’s attention-getting and gently leading. It’s not surprising, then, that some of the greatest literary minds of the last century also offer up some sage marketing advice.

ALSO: How to Revolutionize Your Copywriting Strategy

How They All Work Together

While many freelancer writers specialize in one kind of writing — and some niche down even further, focusing their energies just on newsletters or blogs posts, for instance — others offer overlapping services. You may find a talented writer who churns out unbelievably pithy social media posts but also creates catalog copy and collaborates on children’s books on the side.

Sound confusing?

It can be. Maybe this will help: Pretend you have a business selling a new kind of mop. Everybody needs mops, right? But there’s also a thousand other mops on the market, so you need to find a way to differentiate your brand.

A fiction writer might create a story around your mop, introducing the Duke of Dirt and the Princess of Perfection who are locked in an eternal battle of clutter versus cleanliness.

Your content writer will build on those tales from the Land of Tidying Up by referencing them in blogs, using the characters to connect with consumers on social media or author an article that uses the Duke and Princess to recount the many benefits of clean floors and research behind your brand’s cutting-edge mop technology.

Finally, a copywriter steps in to create a sales page to convince those clicking on a Facebook post or blog CTA that this is the mop they want — no, the mop they need.

The point is this: take the time to vet and hire a writer who knows how to open closed doors and invite readers in. Whether you’re looking to publish a book or launch a new website, the writing process doesn’t start when your freelancer picks up an order and starts tapping on their laptop’s keyboard — it starts when you choose the talent whose skill set best serves your needs.

The post The Three Types of Writers Your Brand (Probably) Needs appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/the-three-types-of-writers-your-brand-probably-needs/feed/ 0
Answers to 10 Interesting Questions About Creating High-Quality City Pages https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/answers-to-10-interesting-questions-about-creating-high-quality-city-pages/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/answers-to-10-interesting-questions-about-creating-high-quality-city-pages/#respond Fri, 16 Nov 2018 19:58:04 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=18418 We recently cohosted a webinar with our friends at SEMrush where we delved into how companies focused on local SEO can earn huge traffic and leads by creating high-quality city pages. In case you missed it, here’s a link to the slides and recording. I had a great time chatting with Krista about this topic […]

The post Answers to 10 Interesting Questions About Creating High-Quality City Pages appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
We recently cohosted a webinar with our friends at SEMrush where we delved into how companies focused on local SEO can earn huge traffic and leads by creating high-quality city pages.

In case you missed it, here’s a link to the slides and recording.


I had a great time chatting with Krista about this topic and seeing firsthand how SEMrush’s suite of tools can support a great city page program with keyword research, topic and question discovery and local rank tracking.

Be sure to check out the replay if you’re looking for help with those areas, or send Krista a note.

The live chat was pretty lively for this webinar, and we were asked some really great questions.

I answered the questions that came up during the webinar, but I feel that many of them deserve more in-depth information.

With that in mind, here are the top questions I was asked along with some more detailed responses.

Google likes fresh content. What do you add to the city pages to make them fresh?

This is a great question, as freshness is an important ranking factor with Google. If you’re creating and managing a large number of city pages, keeping their content fresh could be a challenge.

The way I see this, there are two main ways you can keep fresh content on your pages:

  1. Dynamically
  2. Manually

Dynamic content can be a lot easier to manage, as it shouldn’t require you to spend any time creating it. This can include things such as user-generated content (reviews, questions and answers, etc), product or data feeds (MLS listings, event feeds, etc) and even social media feeds.

The beauty in this type of content is that it’s always updating. You can’t get much fresher than that.

The downside is you might not always have control over it. If there’s a risk of bad content being published, you might need to jump in and curate the content. These elements typically represent a small portion of your page’s overall content, so the bulk of your page would still be static.

What we see most of our clients do is develop a schedule for manually refreshing all of their city page content. One partner has a list of 300 city pages that they constantly refresh, starting over once they’ve finished a cycle.

If you get into a regular routine and have the resources to manage and stick to it, freshness should be easy for you.

Here are the main reasons we see companies refreshing their content:

  1. Seasonality: Getting fresh content in advance of the holiday season, for example, is a good way to boost search rankings and connect with users.
  2. Business changes: If you change how you operate in a city, it’s important your copy is updated.
  3. Local changes: Sometimes the environment you operate in changes, so it’s also important to refresh your content to reflect that.
  4. SEO driven: This is probably the biggest reason, but clients tend to refresh pages when its SEO performance calls for it. If rankings slip or new competitors emerge with better content, it might be time to improve your content.

If you’d like more info on creating fresh content for city pages, be sure to check out our ebook.

ALSO: 3 Simple but Powerful Blogging Strategies for Local SEO

Is Schema markup useful with city pages?

Absolutely!

Google uses schema markup to find relevant content that it can include in featured snippets. With city pages, this often shows up with your page’s content being included in their Instant Answers and People Also Ask sections.

Say I was considering a trip to Iceland and searched for “What type of car to rent in Iceland?”

This is what I’d see at the top of Google results (beneath the ads):

 

Screenshot of Google results showing people also ask questions in the featured snippets, linking to city pages using schema

You can see the Instant Answer points to a page created to answer questions like this. You can also check out the Instant Answers from Iceland Like a Local and Frommers . If you click through to those pages, you can see that they’ve set up schema, which makes them more likely to get picked for these featured snippets.

Note: I used the OpenLink Structured Data Sniffer (OSDS) to look at these pages. Doing this, you can see what types of schema markup your competitors are using. SEMrush can also help you identify competitors using schema.

While schema can help you get selected for Google’s featured snippets, you do need to have high-quality content that will deliver a great result to searchers who see the snippet.

In the case of the People Also Ask section, you need to have great answers to those questions. Adding an FAQ section to your page is a good way to present this content in an easy-to-read manner that also makes it easy for Google to pull your content.

You probably know what a lot of these FAQs are, but as I mentioned on the webinar, often you’ll discover long-tail keywords when doing your keyword research that are actually questions you can answer on your page. If you do this, you’ll help your chances for getting featured in a snippet and create more semantically complete content that delivers a better user experience, which on its own can lift all your search rankings.

Tip: Krista actually highlighted how SEMrush’s keyword research tools can surface questions for you, which makes for great content on your pages.

Can you get covered if you are in a suburb?

Yep, but you want to approach how you present information about suburbs with caution.  

If you have great locally relevant content for the suburb that visitors would be looking for and is more useful than getting generic corporate info, you’re probably safe to create a suburb page of its own.

You’ll also want to do some keyword research to determine if there is sufficient search volume to make it worth your time. What I’ve seen is that many suburbs don’t have search terms with enough search volume to make creating a page for it worth your while. If this is the case, searchers might be looking for your services in the main metro, and you might want to focus on ranking for terms at the metro level.

Including sections about each suburb on the main metro’s page can actually beef up the content of that page, make it more semantically complete and more likely to rank well.

You might still create city pages if there’s a bigger business case for doing so. If you have locations in multiple suburbs, you might want them to each present their unique info and make it so that visitors to your site can navigate to their closest location.

How do you handle “surrounding cities” when our service area isn’t just the current city but other cities? We do not have locations in other cities.

This question is similar to the one above. I mentioned this on the webinar, but if you provide services in surrounding cities but don’t have physical locations there (hence are not eligible for a GMB account or inclusion in the Local Pack), city pages can get you ranked for valuable local search terms from those surrounding cities.

Make sure you can reasonably provide services to those cities, and if you can, go ahead and create a city page for them — as long as there’s enough search volume to make it worth your while.

​Does content length matter? I was once advised to aim for 2,500 words with my keywords intermixed throughout, but I found this to be content overload for my users

It does matter.

But, it’s not a simple answer, and I would never throw out a ballpark number to hit with every page. There are a few factors you should look into:

  1. How many words do you need to write to solve the searcher intent you found doing your keyword research and create semantically diverse content?
  2. How long is your competitors’ content? You’ll likely want to write more than them (and solve searcher intent better). Check out SEMrush’s SEO Content Template to get detailed analysis on your competitors’ pages
  3. How much content can you fit into your page’s design without overwhelming visitors?

If you answer all these questions, you should get a sense of how long your content should be.

Creating comprehensive content that fits nicely into a design template is incredibly effective.

​How do you pass authority to these city pages from the main site? For example, do you just link to the main overall Locations page, which then links to all the town/city pages?

That’s probably the easiest and most effective way of doing it. This also makes it simple for your visitors to find the city pages they’re interested in and switch between locations.

If you have a smaller volume of pages, you might also consider creating fresh content on your blog or news section that covers topics unique to each city, and then link back to the associated city page. We do see many clients doing this, but it can be a bit of work.

Many companies will also tie their local SEO programs in with these city pages by linking directly to the city page from the associated local directory and GMB profiles.

When you say navigation, is the sitemap enough, or do you need it in the menu or just a link from a landing page?

I don’t think the sitemap alone would be enough for these pages. It’s really important to remember that you should only be creating city pages if you can present unique, locally relevant info to your visitors. If you can, you should make it easy for them to access that info, which means it should be a prominent part of your navigation.

Just including them in your sitemap might also run the risk of Google considering your pages Doorway Pages.

When identifying Doorway Pages, Google looks at a few things that might cause problems here:

  1. Is the page a part of the site’s navigation?
  2. Does the page exist only to rank for search traffic?
  3. Do the pages all funnel visitors to an actual page with value?

​What are the different actions we can take to land in the local pack versus organic results?

This webinar focused mostly on getting ranked in the organic results, as does our ebook. At a high level, a good city page program can help you get ranked in organic results for city specific search terms for your locations or areas you serve.

Getting found in the local pack is the focus of local SEO at large. SEMrush has some great local SEO resources, and I’d really suggest diving into those.

ALSO: How to Design and Implement a Local Landing Page SEO Program

Do you recommend creating town or area pages in addition to city pages?

Sometimes.

I can’t say that would be a good strategy for every business, but I think it comes down to two main questions you need to ask:

  1. Do I provide uniquely local services at the town or area level such that users will find local info valuable?
  2. Is there sufficient search traffic for search terms that these pages could try to rank for?

If the answer to both questions is yes, you might consider going to the town, area or neighborhood level with your local pages.

Creating the content for these would be much the same as what we presented on the webinar and in the ebook.

There are actually some cool things if you do this. If you’re familiar with Hubspot’s Topic Clusters model for SEO, you can treat the city page as your pillar, and then the smaller locations become cluster items that support the city page.

Do you usually add the state to the city page URL or H1?

This can be valuable, but you’d want to consider what you’re trying to optimize for and what your overall local page structure looks like.

Again, I’d look at the keyword research to see what the search volumes are for the locations you’re targeting. If a lot of the search terms include state, this could be a really good idea. A lot of our clients do this.

Many clients also create state pages, which then link down to each city page that state includes. If you opt for a setup like that, you’d want to make sure you don’t end up cannibalizing the state page’s targeted keywords.

Wrapping Up

These were the top questions we were asked that I felt warranted more detailed answers. If you have any other questions about city pages, be sure to get in touch, and I’d be happy to chat.

 

The post Answers to 10 Interesting Questions About Creating High-Quality City Pages appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/answers-to-10-interesting-questions-about-creating-high-quality-city-pages/feed/ 0
6 Situations Where Content Rewriting Can Help Your Marketing https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/6-situations-where-content-rewriting-can-help-your-marketing/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/6-situations-where-content-rewriting-can-help-your-marketing/#respond Tue, 13 Nov 2018 16:00:28 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=18292 As much as I like to avoid cliches, there’s truth in them, and sometimes they’re just the best way of saying something. We all know — quality content is king. As noted by Forbes, “It’s what separates the winners from the losers online; it’s what will help your site rank well in the search engines, […]

The post 6 Situations Where Content Rewriting Can Help Your Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
As much as I like to avoid cliches, there’s truth in them, and sometimes they’re just the best way of saying something.

We all know — quality content is king.

As noted by Forbes, “It’s what separates the winners from the losers online; it’s what will help your site rank well in the search engines, what will naturally attract high-quality inbound links and what will help you build trust, credibility and authority with your audience.”

That’s a tall order for any digital strategy, made more so by the fact that content doesn’t last forever — what once generated backlinks and visitor numbers worthy of social media humblebrags can quickly become stale and unappealing.

But how do you know when it’s time to shift gears and consider content rewriting to get your website or blog back on track?

Here are six situations that call for digital do-overs.

You’ve Changed, Man

Gif of Bart Simpson telling Homer he's changed, highlighting that content rewriting is necessary if a company changes significantly.

Change is inevitable. Maybe it’s your corporate focus. Maybe you’ve updated your mission statement or branched out into new industry verticals.

Guess what?

That “perfect” blog post you purchased last year isn’t doing the job. Sure, you could spend the time and money creating an entirely new post, or you could hire an article rewriter to put a fresh spin on your content while adding updated information.

Think of it like this: There’s no reason to toss quality articles, but their value shifts over time. If your company incorporates big changes, make sure your content follows suit.

ALSO: 3 Reasons Why Spring Calls For a Content Refresh 

Content Rewriting: Readin’ for the Season?

Targeted copy outperforms generic content. This is especially true as the months-long period of the “holiday season” emerges from its food coma each year — your site needs relevant, seasonal keyword-driven content to help capture user interest during this period

If most of your content is mostly working, it’s probably not worth the cost of complete text rewriting just to hop on the holiday bandwagon.

Worth your time, though, are quick rewrites and updates that leverage what you’ve already got to create seasonally-themed web copy, product descriptions or gift-buying guides.

Performance Problems

Image showing a bull in a business meeting saying he's
SEO performance drops can happen to any company, and so can a love for terrible puns.

It can happen to any company. Suddenly your SEO numbers aren’t up to their usual standards and unique visitor numbers are dropping.

First step? Find your problem. It might be:

  • New Competitors Up in Your Business: The nature of digital business makes it possible for new competitors to spring up seemingly overnight. If your SEO numbers drop, it’s time for a competitive SEO analysis. If you’re not number one, opt for a competitive content do-over.
  • The Smell of Stale Content: Fresh content drives SEO. Stale content — even if it’s still relevant — limits search engine exposure. Keep things fresh with periodic content rewrites.
  • Major Search Engine Algorithm Updates: Big search engines like Google occasionally change how they rank and list page results. The caveat? They don’t always make these changes obvious (or public). If you notice tanking rankings with no other cause, be sure to check with a tool like SEMrush’s search sensor, which will tell you if there’s been an algorithm change and what it seems to target.  If the change targets site content (and it often will), learn what you need to change and consider content writing with a focus on the new reality of SEO.

Break it Down

It’s worth paying for long-form, high-quality outsourced content such as white papers and case studies prepared by research firms and professional freelancers: You get above-average textual content that’s data-rich and brand-driven to help your business perform.

The challenge?

Many readers won’t wade through long-form studies and surveys; they want bite-size readable content that satisfies their desire for info without wasting their time. Here, high-quality content rewriting services can help break existing resources down into multiple assets. For example, you could turn a 2000-word white paper into four or five blog posts or break a case study into multiple articles.

Repurposing content presents a huge opportunity to make it more digestible for readers and help you extract more value from the investment you’ve made in creating it. Many content marketers report repurposing a single piece of content more than 10 times.

ALSO: Repurposing Content to Drive SEO Results

Inherited Issues

Maybe you’ve inherited subpar content from another marketer or content that was written for a different age. Often, the domain age — rather than any in-text value — makes this content worth keeping.

But what’s the best strategy to make use of this content?

In some cases, a quick pass with proofreading tools or paraphrasing tools can snap this content into shape. In others, you may need full-on rewrites to preserve the pages’s domain age but deliver readable text.

Regardless of the level of work required, rewriting this older content presents an opportunity for you to take under performing content and make it shine.

Looking For Budget Friendly Content

The need for fresh, relevant content is more present than ever. And, in a pinch, a company light on time or budget might look for easy ways to get content to promote.

There’s no such thing as free content — at least not content of value. While free online article spinners promise something for nothing, offering to create new articles from your existing content, you’re better served improving content than simply imitating its style.

Do a quick search, and you’ll come across a host of article rewriting tools or “article spinners” that (for a low, low fee!) will repurpose old articles by paraphrasing current content, inserting synonyms where possible and effectively giving your digital assets a second life.

Google search result showing multiple article spinning tools
There are a number of article spinning tools available, but most don’t produce content that will perform well for you.

As noted by Search Engine Journal, however, these article spinning services often deliver unreadable results.

For example, one synonym for the word “digital” is “numerary.”

If your original content dives into the need for “digital transformation” but the text spinner spits out a piece about “numerary revolution,” your SEO isn’t going anywhere but down. And, your readers are going to be very confused.

In practice, rewriting content presents an alternative to risky methods of getting low-cost content such as content spinning. This means tapping experienced article rewriters to repurpose old content but add new insights, in effect keeping what works without (effectively) ripping off your own resources.

Wrapping It Up

I’ve gone through a number of reasons why you might consider rewriting existing content, but fundamentally, I want to stress that it’s a powerful tool to help your content program perform better. Whatever the reason you decide to rewrite content, it gives you the opportunity to learn from what’s worked and hasn’t worked with the existing content and create something better.

If you’ve decided that it’s time to spruce up your content, be sure to check out our wide range of content creation services.

Are there any other situations we didn’t cover that would warrant rewriting content? Let me know in the comments.

The post 6 Situations Where Content Rewriting Can Help Your Marketing appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/6-situations-where-content-rewriting-can-help-your-marketing/feed/ 0
Boiling Down the Top 6 Challenges in Content Writing for Agencies https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/boiling-down-the-top-6-challenges-in-content-writing-for-agencies/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/boiling-down-the-top-6-challenges-in-content-writing-for-agencies/#respond Fri, 09 Nov 2018 19:01:30 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=17905 Creating content that moves the needle has gotten a lot harder. And, content marketing is no longer the simple game it used to be ten years ago, when just publishing a decent piece every now and again would be sufficient. Not anymore — with over 2 million blog posts published online every day, the occasional […]

The post Boiling Down the Top 6 Challenges in Content Writing for Agencies appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Creating content that moves the needle has gotten a lot harder.

And, content marketing is no longer the simple game it used to be ten years ago, when just publishing a decent piece every now and again would be sufficient.

Not anymore — with over 2 million blog posts published online every day, the occasional piece of average quality just won’t cut it. To cut through the noise and produce strong results for clients, agencies need to deliver high-quality content that provides significant value to the reader.

But, that isn’t always so simple or easy.

From our experience, many agencies are faced with multiple dilemmas when it comes to writing content for their clients. I’ve reached out to a number of digital marketing agencies and asked them what the most common challenges in content writing for agencies are.

Here are the most common challenges they reported.

The Need for Expert Insight

Finding a capable writer — who also happens to be an expert on a specific niche or highly technical topic and is available to produce content when you need it — is no more different than hunting the proverbial unicorn.

Finding an expert writer can be like finding a unicorn
They do exist… I promise.

Why?

Simply because the vast majority of content writers are generalists. Sure, they possess excellent language skills, the ability to adapt their style to effectively capture the unique voice of each brand they’re working with, and a very good understanding of different content structures — from blog posts to press releases, whitepapers, product descriptions, and beyond. Their SEO knowledge is also pretty polished and they know how to work in the right keywords to boost the reach of every piece of content they produce.

While talented, content writers may lack the expertise required to create top-level content in extremely specialized industries. They’re jacks of all trades.

But, they can’t deal with the more advanced stuff. Like, say, gramework, or the golang web framework.

What does that mean for your agency?

Simply – finding expert writers among a sea of generalists could prove challenging. And, for certain clients, finding those experts could be critical to creating content that’s going to help their business.

According to Julien Raby, president of web marketing agency Combustible, “In the past, we tackled this issue with extensive research on our end, but the result was bland, uninspiring content and our clients weren’t happy with the results.”

There are many industries that require that expert knowledge to create content clients will be happy with. For your content to stand out, you need someone who is intimately acquainted with that industry area or niche; someone who can artfully combine their professional expertise with their exceptional writing skills to produce expert-level content sprinkled with some good humor and a dash of personality; someone ready and willing to pour himself into every bit of the creation process.

In these cases – you need a specialist.

For most digital marketing agencies, it’s downright impossible — and decidedly unrealistic — to have specialists on staff for every single industry area or niche there is.

ALSOGhostwriters: The Secret to Maximizing Your In-House Writing Team

Unrealistic Expectations

Successful content marketing is “a byproduct of strong planning and consistent execution,” as Ben Sailer of digital marketing giant CoSchedule very well puts it.

Before any content is created, agencies need to articulate an effective plan, with both short- and long-term goals, and share it with clients.

There’s no shortcut to achieving content marketing success. It doesn’t happen overnight, and there’s no telling exactly how long it can take to see any results.

I’ve chatted with agencies whose clients regard content creation and content marketing as a small part of their overall marketing mix and under-appreciate the great deal of work that goes into every step of this process. And, they often don’t appreciate that it can take time to yield results.

Writers and content marketers work really hard to produce content and promote it.

And writing exceptional content is no easy task, especially when there’s a specific goal or need to be addressed.

According to Nelson Jordan, co-founder of Agency Match, “Although most clients understand that content creation [and inbound marketing] can take months or years to bear fruit, other stakeholders with a lesser understanding of content marketing can sometimes questions why results haven’t been achieved, particularly if they’re more familiar with the instant results that paid advertising can generate.”

When clients realize their content isn’t garnering any ROI, they may get concerned. They want results — the kind of immediate results they get when boosting a Facebook post or running a Google AdWords campaign. Instant. Almost palpable.

We all know it’s not going to happen in a flash. But there’s no definite answer as to how long content marketing takes to produce positive ROI. Three, maybe six months, seems to be a good estimate.

It’s only natural that your clients will fear they’ll invest in content marketing for months on end without anything to show at the end.

But that’s all the more reason why agencies should educate clients on the huge potential they have for generating ROI with content marketing. Results from paid advertising will stop generating anything the moment you stop your campaigns, whereas each piece of content you publish will continue to generate compound traffic growth and leads over time. It’s a bit like real estate.

There’s so much potential, but you’ll need to prepare your clients to be patient.

Budget Constraints

The U.S. is the largest market for content marketing, with spends estimated to have exceeded $16 billion in 2016. A 2018 study by the Content Marketing Institute shows that successful B2B marketers spend a staggering 40 percent of their marketing budget on content, which is higher than the industry average of 29 percent. At the same time, as much as 37 percent of marketers who aren’t successful with content marketing blame it on their inadequate budget.

The average recommended budget for content marketing ranges from 7 to 8 percent of gross revenue for companies with annual revenues below $5 million and a net profit margin — after all expenses — in the 10 percent to 12 percent range.

Unfortunately, smaller companies often don’t have the financial resources necessary to map out and execute well-articulated content strategies consistently. “Smaller budgets see smaller campaigns and smaller results. Rarely will clients invest all that is truly needed for a really impactful content strategy,” says Katie Mayberry, senior director of social media marketing agency Releventure.

But it’s not just smaller companies that don’t invest. Larger companies with more sizable revenues aren’t always willing to allocate reasonable budgets for their content marketing, either, which limits agencies’ ability to grow their content marketing efforts.

If you don’t have a robust strategy in place with both short-term and long-term goals and a well-laid-out plan to achieve them, your efforts will fall flat, point blank. And, if you don’t have the resources to execute in both the short and long term, your efforts will fail.

Quality Versus Quantity

Marketers are under pressure to create more content than ever. The 2017 B2B Content Marketing Report by Content Marketing Institute shows that 70 percent of marketers expect to produce more content this year.

It takes a lot of perseverance to make content marketing work, and delivering content consistently is of the utmost importance. Eighty-five percent of top performers publish content on a regular basis, compared to 58 percent of the overall sample and 32 percent of bottom performers.

For every digital marketing agency, the same old dilemma almost always crops up: should you scale back on the sheer volume of content you’re producing for clients and focus on quality, or should you increase the volume and let the quality suffer in the process?

Little girl asking if you should create large amounts of content or high-quality content
It’s nice to have both quality and quantity when it comes to content, but it’s not always possible.

For agencies with limited creatives, this dilemma becomes a serious concern. Spending more time producing less content means you’re paying more for less — not to mention you could be delivering more content in that same time. But churning out content that is devoid of any value won’t help your content marketing efforts, either.

Why? Simply because:

  • Every piece of content you produce should accurately capture the unique voice of your clients and portray their values.
  • Your content must address very specific content marketing goals.
  • Your content must be authentic, engaging, and valuable.
  • Google is rewarding content that best solves searcher intent, which means your content needs to comprehensively address each topic you cover.

But as I always say, your content marketing strategy isn’t measured in volume or quality — it’s measured in results. And you’ll often find that, to get results, you need to strike the right balance between the two.

You need to produce content consistently, and the content you produce must really resonate your client’s target audience, rank well with search engines, and showcase thought leadership — something I talked about in this post.

Content is just words until you put motivational goals behind it.

A Mismatch Between What the Client Wants and What Works

According to Jason Lavis, managing director of Out of Box Innovations, one of the biggest pain points when managing a content strategy is the mismatch between what the client wants and what actually works.

“A business owner might genuinely care about their technology or processes, whereas the customers — and the public in general — might prefer entertainment or fundamental information. This mismatch makes it harder to achieve growth in page views or social media following.”

It’s all a matter of trust, as Steve Page of Giant Partners points out: “Getting them to trust you to do what’s right is a struggle. They know they need to do something different to transform their business but are hesitant to do so.”

And it’s no surprise, given the great level of commitment that comes with every content marketing strategy. If digital marketing agencies cannot earn their clients’ trust, they cannot build the kind of campaign that would actually produce results.

ALSOBuild a Brilliant Content Strategy in 6 Easy Steps

Not Committing to Content Promotion

In the content marketing world, creating and publishing content are just the very first steps of the journey — critically important but scarcely sufficient on their own. To maximize the reach and visibility of the content you produce, consistent promotion is a must.

Overlook it, and you’ll end up missing a huge chunk of ROI.

Yet the need for consistent promotion might catch some clients by surprise — isn’t content, in itself, already designed to market their business?

Sure, provided people see it.

If the content sits without any promotion, then nobody is likely to just stumble upon it. Promotion means more people will see the content, and this increased visibility will eventually pay off later on.

Content promotion starts with an initial distribution across key external channels. Think Facebook, Twitter, LinkedIn, and even email, if that’s what works for your client. Spread the word, spark some interest in the content, and you’ve got yourself a solid audience that wants to hear what you’ve got to say — or to be precise, what your client’s got to say.

Successful content creation relies on great content promotion
Promoting your content in multiple channels is critical to content marketing success.

Moving on.

After the initial distribution, you need to think about ongoing distribution, which usually takes place in the long term. There likely are many who’ve missed the initial distribution, so why not give them a few “in case you’ve missed it” opportunities along the way?

For many agencies, content promotion is a time-extensive process. If you’re one of them, you’ve very likely come across at least one client who was unwilling to commit to promoting their content.

After all, if they’re already paying you to write great content to promote their business and generate ROI, they may not want to spend more.

If you can convince them that ongoing content promotion actually helps them maximize their ROI, you can often alleviate this concern.

Content promotion shouldn’t be an option, like having an extra dollop of chocolate drizzled on top of your vanilla ice cream or a brand-new garage door with built-in smartphone connectivity (heck, I’d love one for myself).

Content promotion should be an integral part of any effective content marketing campaign — and the keyword here is integral.

Addressing Content Writing Challenges

I could probably list out a dozen more challenges, but you’ve probably picked up on a couple common themes by now — clients won’t benefit from sub-par content, nor by overlooking or neglecting any of the steps involved in content marketing.

If your agency simply doesn’t have the manpower or resources to produce the kind of content your clients need to achieve content marketing success, consider checking out our agency services.

The post Boiling Down the Top 6 Challenges in Content Writing for Agencies appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/boiling-down-the-top-6-challenges-in-content-writing-for-agencies/feed/ 0
Buying Pre-Written Articles: The Pros, Cons and Everything In Between https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/buying-pre-written-articles-the-pros-cons-and-everything-in-between/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/buying-pre-written-articles-the-pros-cons-and-everything-in-between/#respond Thu, 11 Oct 2018 21:30:29 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=17971 Content is king. As noted by AdWeek, “Consumers have flat-out become fatigued with the standard fare historically represented in brand marketing.” Companies must find a way to create content that breaks the mold, engages potential customers and ultimately drives increased revenue. And, with over 70 percent of companies outsourcing content creation, finding the best outsourcing […]

The post Buying Pre-Written Articles: The Pros, Cons and Everything In Between appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Content is king.

As noted by AdWeek, “Consumers have flat-out become fatigued with the standard fare historically represented in brand marketing.” Companies must find a way to create content that breaks the mold, engages potential customers and ultimately drives increased revenue.

And, with over 70 percent of companies outsourcing content creation, finding the best outsourcing option is critical in today’s environment.

When it comes to blogging, buying pre-written articles or ordering custom-created articles offer a way for companies short on time, expertise or capacity to quickly scale up, but what’s the best route? Are pre-written pieces the best investment, or does custom creation provide better returns?

Let’s dig into the pros, cons — and everything else — that comes with buying articles.

The Content Conundrum

Recent research shows that companies are struggling with content management. As the Content Marketing Institute points out, 72 percent of organizations say they’re “challenged with managing content strategically,” and 61 percent point to their top challenge as a lack of skilled staff to ensure content meets expectations and marketing is effective across channels.

Read: How to Build a Brilliant Content Strategy in 6 Easy Steps

Beyond a reliable content pipeline and the ability to ensure content regularly reaches customers, businesses also need to make sure that what they’re producing engages and excites users. In a content-rich market, potential consumers won’t bother stopping for articles, case studies or white papers that don’t immediately grab their attention and offer actionable information.

According to Business 2 Community, the sheer volume of available content now means that, “Even if you’re filling your site with countless blog posts jam packed with stellar written content, you may still be disappointed.”

Why?

Because well-written content is no longer enough to grab attention. It must also offer something unique to consumers; something they haven’t seen before.

Read: Thought Leadership in Content – What Does it Really Mean?

Pre-Written Versus Content Development Services

To reach consumers and drive revenue, companies must find article sources that are reliable, high-quality and in alignment with business expectations.

There are two broad types available: Pre-written content and custom-created articles.

Pre-written articles are exactly what the name says: Already written, ready to be purchased and posted.

There’s also a subset of pre-written pieces known as private label rights (PLRs). As noted by Medium, what makes PLR pieces unique is the associated licensing. Companies can edit articles and change author attribution as needed. They can also resell the articles and basically do whatever they want with them.

Often you’ll find PLR articles in packages offering dozens for a surprisingly low price. The reason they’re so affordable is that the seller is selling the package to many people, so you can’t be sure your content is unique.

Screen capture of an offer to buy thousands of PLR articles
That’s a lot of articles!

Custom content, meanwhile, is typically governed by resell rights that let companies keep 100 percent of the profits if content is resold via gateways or as part of subscription services but limits the ability of businesses to change author attributions or modify content. In general, ownership and attribution rights are typically bound by the service agreement you establish when working with your writer.

Over the past few years, pre-written content use has declined while custom writing services have enjoyed a significant uptick. Part of the change stems from evolving search engine algorithms, which tend to prioritize unique, never-before-seen content over similar articles tweaked just enough to suit businesses needs.

Social media also plays a role in this shift. Social giant Facebook now claims over 1.47 billion daily active users as of June 2018, making it more important than ever for companies to deliver content that’s easily consumable, provides a unique perspective and compels users to share it with friends and coworkers. This content needs to engage users — and be unique.

But, there’s still a case for pre-written and PLR content, since it lets organizations quickly customize and repurpose content as required.

For example, a single blog post can be purchased immediately and posted across corporate blogs, social media sites and leading industry publications. For companies looking to keep up with the pace of content consumption, PLR provides a viable solution in a pinch.

Pre-Written (and PLR) Pros

Let’s dig a little deeper. Beyond the basics, what are some of the key benefits associated with pre-written pieces?

  • No waiting time: Pre-written marketplaces are full of already-written articles waiting to be claimed. You don’t need to create a content brief, find a writer, conduct edits and finally make payment — available articles are complete and ready to use.
  • See before you buy: Since these pieces are already written, you can view and evaluate them before making a purchase. While this does mean some time spent searching article inventories, it makes it possible to find content that aligns with content strategies before making a purchase.
  • Evergreen offerings: PLR generally only works for evergreen content (newsworthy content has a very short shelf life), since it’s been written previously and designed for on-demand modification. Many sites offer deals on evergreen content, helping to fill gaps in your content strategy or flesh out your website with articles that remain relevant over time.
  • Volume discounts: If you’re willing to purchase large volumes of articles at once, it’s often possible to find bulk discounts. It makes sense. Pre-written content is often sold to many customers, so sellers can earn more money selling discounted content to multiple buyers instead of charging full price to one.
  • Makes it easy to jump-start content campaigns: As noted by Forbes, “You don’t need 15 pre-written articles to launch. You just need one.” Choosing an article that covers one high-level, relevant topic can jump-start blogs or other offerings while content strategists develop next steps. The instant availability of pre-written articles also makes it easy to quickly build out campaigns across multiple social channels.

Drawbacks of PLR and Pre-Written Content

While buying pre-written articles can help get campaigns off the ground and streamline content deployment, they also come with potential drawbacks, including:

  • Lack of specificity: Pre-written content wasn’t created for your brand in particular but rather based on current search and social media trends in your industry. This means PLR articles are inherently off-brand and must be either used as “filler” content or modified to empower brand-driven engagement.
  • Higher cost: While the basic cost of a PLR piece is less than one produced by custom content writers, it may be more costly in the long run. Why? Because making it useful for your brand often requires significant revisions and updates, meaning staff must spend time — which costs you money — to ensure pre-written articles meet expectations. (Read: How Businesses Can Save Money by Spending More on Content Writing)
  • Minimal SEO focus: Your SEO differs from other brands and similar companies in your industry. Pre-written articles may provide general SEO targeting but don’t identify specific searcher intent or address semantically related topics, making these pieces potentially less valuable than they appear.
  • Lack of Unique Content: Look at 10 pre-written pieces for the same topic, and they’ll bear strong similarities. In the case of PLR articles, they might even be identical. While they’ll be different enough to pass basic plagiarism checks, this content won’t stand out from the crowd.
  • Missing Links: PLR and pre-written content isn’t designed with your business in mind, so it won’t contain any links to product pages, other blog articles or thought leadership pages. You can embed these links, but this may require significant restructuring to ensure articles don’t lose readability.
  • Quickly out of date: Pre-written content is continually created to match potential needs, meaning it may be weeks or months old. Considering the velocity and volume of big data and the speed of social trends, PLR pieces can quickly outlive their usefulness.
  • Limited applicability: Companies must now manage multiple channels and content streams to ensure they’re reaching the right customer base. Pre-written articles are often too broad and generic to drive interest across diverse content channels.

Final Thoughts

Pre-written pieces have potential — they’re an easy way to fill in gaps in your content calendar and give you the power to change author attributions to suit business needs.

Content development services, however, have largely overtaken pre-written marketplaces as organizations recognize the need for unique, high-quality articles that deliver targeted SEO and compelling content.

The main advantage of buying pre-written articles is that you can buy them and post them instantly. This is certainly appealing, but with the extra time you need to spend editing and making the content fit your brand, it might actually take longer.

Doing the math and calculating your time spent with both options might surprise you.

The post Buying Pre-Written Articles: The Pros, Cons and Everything In Between appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/buying-pre-written-articles-the-pros-cons-and-everything-in-between/feed/ 0
Are Editors Essential to Your Content Marketing Success? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/are-editors-essential-to-your-content-marketing-success/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/are-editors-essential-to-your-content-marketing-success/#respond Thu, 02 Aug 2018 20:00:36 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=17509 Content marketing is driven by a quest for the best possible ROI. What you get in return for your investment determines which strategies stick. After all, no one wants to throw good money after bad, and funneling your financial commitment toward the channels that work best is the smartest play you can make. What does […]

The post Are Editors Essential to Your Content Marketing Success? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

Content marketing is driven by a quest for the best possible ROI. What you get in return for your investment determines which strategies stick. After all, no one wants to throw good money after bad, and funneling your financial commitment toward the channels that work best is the smartest play you can make.

What does all that have to do with editing? Everything.

Businesses tend to pony up for copywriting services without too much hesitation, but when it comes to the other two tiers in the content marketing system (editing and quality assurance), the ROI isn’t always so easy to identify. A good writer should be able to forge a cohesive message, work in the right keywords, and arrange words in an entertaining and accessible manner, but even the best scribes benefit from a keen eye and the digital version of a big fat red pen.

Investing in copy editing services is like supercharging your copywriter; their talents are suddenly magnified and, at the same time, given extra focus until your vision is expertly tailored for maximum connection, conversion, and engagement.

Crossing I’s and Dotting Your T’s

See what I did there…? Seriously though, as potent as great content can be, web copy or blogs marred by typos and grammatical oopsies can be just as potent — albeit in a decidedly negative fashion.

Editors are the gatekeepers who swoop in and clean up any literary detritus accidentally left behind by the creative types. Some writers are technically brilliant; others are stellar at generating compelling concepts but wouldn’t know an infinitive from a gerund.

A talented editor ensures that you’re never called out on social media for an oh-so-egregious your vs. you’re error (and we all know how forgiving those eagle-eyed commenters can be) or surprised by awkward copy that makes your new site launch less than perfect.

Quote

I can practically hear the “but what about Grammarly?” protests already, and it’s true that there are tons of online editing tools that will catch basic errors and keep you from inserting commas willy-nilly, but AI editors are deeply flawed too.

Grammarly flags every instance of passive voice with admirable enthusiasm but eliminating those completely will likely cause your content to read aggressive or robotic. Other times you’ll intentionally use colloquialisms or grammatically incorrect language to make a point or reinforce a specific voice; Grammarly can’t recognize tone and giggle at cheeky reference the way a real editor can.

When you’re commissioning content for a live audience, you should hire a live editor to review it.

A Quick Review: Two Types of Editors

The confusion over why you need an editor when spellcheck is so darned effective (not) is probably at least partially connected to the misconception that an editor is an editor is an editor.

Nope.

A copyeditor is the hawk-eyed specialist who pores over things like parallelism and punctuation. They can typically rattle off the finer points of Chicago style or AP guidelines with the greatest of ease, and their ability to spot even the tiniest typo is legendary.

A strategic content editor, on the other hand, is your audience’s representative during content creation. Your customers have wants, needs, concerns, and questions. They have pain points that must be addressed and preferences in terms of visual components. Your editor looks not so much at how a piece is written, but at how it reads. Does it tick all the boxes attached to your brand persona? Does it slot into your overall content marketing strategy? Is it useful? Will your audience care?

A copyeditor is valuable; a strategic content editor is priceless.

Ann Gynn, editorial consultant for the Content Marketing Institute, defines these two types of editors this way: “Strategic editors (or someone who has that role) are critical to ensuring first that the content meets the needs of the audience and the company. Second, this editor can review and edit the piece to ensure the content is written appropriately — it puts the topic in the relevant context, includes pertinent details (and excludes unrelated ones), is accurate, and explains the topic in a way that the audience can understand and wants to read/consume.”

She goes on to say, “Then, this editor can smooth the rough edges, refine its structure, and make it audience ready. A line editor or proofreader who is fresh to the copy will be able to catch grammatical and style errors more easily.” As the strategic editor for CMI, she focuses on making sure that the content published speaks to the brand’s audience and meets the company’s business goals and needs.

ai

With the rapid evolution of technology, we’re now also seeing what you might call a third type — AI-based editors. Cynthia Spiers, who heads up content and digital at Acrolinx, relies on human content creators, but then everything is put through the company’s content optimization platform. “Powered by artificial intelligence, it ensures the content we produce is aligned to our content strategy. That means that the platform understands our standards for brand, style, tone, and terminology, and it evaluates our content against those standards,” she reports.

Here’s the Sad Part

We heard from more than 50 companies on the subject of how critical an editor is to the content creation process, and more than half of them don’t understand that there are different types of editors. In fact, they view editors as little more than human spell-checkers. These are brands that are missing out.

Shelby Rogers, content marketing manager for Solodev and DigitalUS, sums things up quite nicely on this front: “I’ve seen on a handful of reputable marketing resources that editing should be an afterthought, and I cringe each time. Clearly, no one thought to edit that piece of ridiculous advice. Editing — both prescriptively and conceptually — plays a massive role in our content creation.”

Highlighting Your Differentiator

Brands get ahead by showcasing whatever makes them different from their competitors. That much you probably already know, but the how of this whole scenario is harder to pinpoint. Some C-level suits turn to a strategist, but marketing mastermind Seth Godin backs a different approach.

According to Godin, the key to building a better brand media property is to avoid playing it safe and instead figure out how to make your content more interesting. “You need editors, not brand managers,” says Godin, “who will push the envelope to make the thing go forward.”

Good editors are strategic and largely responsible for driving results. Have a specific business goal in mind? Editors shape drafts to better conform to the task at hand. When your messaging threatens to meander away from the point, an editor can step in and tweak the content until it better adheres to the directive. Concerned that your core values aren’t reflected in your home page? Editors also look over content to see whether you’ve had a chance to shine.

There is such a thing as flawless content that is also lifeless. Cold copy never drives traffic. Bring on an editor who has a feel for your brand’s heart and soul and you have another person on your team who’s dedicated to capturing the spirit of your message rather than just joylessly adhering to the style guide.

The Importance of Consistency

The modern editor isn’t just a proofreader with an attitude but a smart and savvy brand tactician that knows how to wield content on a way that fuels max ROI. When you’re churning out content on the regular – and by all accounts you should be – it can be tempting to try and be all things to all people. Don’t.

Random acts of marketing are disorienting, and a disoriented audience isn’t inspired to take action. It’s fine to have blog posts, newsletters, emails, eBooks, white papers, case studies, and social posts all in various stages of development and publication, but each type of content needs to relate to each to each other and back to a central strategy for any of it to make sense. Editors are big-picture people who monitor flow, delivery, and cohesion, asking for rewrites or revisions and rallying the troops so that everything that arrives in your inbox commands the right kind of attention not just separately but also as a whole.

military-655630_1280

As Lisa Barone, Chief Marketing Office for New York-based creative agency Overit, puts it, “It’s great for content to be well-written and grammatically correct, but if it doesn’t connect to the larger marketing strategy than it isn’t truly serving its purpose.” Her content editors are tasked with upholding strategy and brand standards and ensuring a high level of quality control.

Barone goes on to say, “A good editor is someone well-versed in the industry and larger business goals who can help guide a writer to make sure he or she is touching on the important aspects of a topic, that they are finding the right way to engage, that they are using terms with correct context (not just grammatically correct), and that they are seeding content for reader shares from the very onset. There is a lot more to content than simply words on a page and a good editor can help guide this process.”

At Crowd Content, we utilize a three-tier editorial system that funnels content from the writing stage through editing and QA, so our clients get the best of copyediting and that strategic eye. You get exponentially more attention, and those extra steps often translate into content that sells faster and reaches farther. In other words, it fuses the talents of our visionary writers, editors and reviewers into a dynamic, multitasking Transformer-like entity that could very well save the world. Or at least give your brand the market share it deserves.

The post Are Editors Essential to Your Content Marketing Success? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/are-editors-essential-to-your-content-marketing-success/feed/ 0
How to Design and Implement A Local Landing Page SEO Program https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/design-implement-local-landing-page-seo-program/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/design-implement-local-landing-page-seo-program/#respond Tue, 03 Jul 2018 23:06:27 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=17338 How often do you go to Google to search for something like “auto mechanic in Seattle” or “pharmacy in 10019?” If you’re like most people, the answer is probably quite often; 89 percent of people do local searches at least once a week, with 58 percent searching locally once a day on average. [Free Ebook] […]

The post How to Design and Implement A Local Landing Page SEO Program appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
How often do you go to Google to search for something like “auto mechanic in Seattle” or “pharmacy in 10019?” If you’re like most people, the answer is probably quite often; 89 percent of people do local searches at least once a week, with 58 percent searching locally once a day on average.

[Free Ebook] The Complete Guide to Creating City Pages For SEO – How to Create Engaging City Pages at Scale That Will Delight Visitors, DriveTraffic and Get You More Business

Local searches also drive sales: 50 percent of smartphone users and 34 percent of computer or tablet users who perform local searches make a purchase within a day.

The bottom line is — local traffic is significant and valuable. Many businesses are taking advantage of this through local SEO, which most often revolves around creating and managing their Google My Business (GMB) profile and local citation building. That’s important, but it does miss a couple things:

  1. A lot of organic traffic goes to search results beneath the “local pack” — the local results and map section pictured below. The amount of traffic going to the local pack varies a lot by industry with some industries like restaurants seeing most traffic going to the local pack, whereas rehabilitation centers see significantly less.Photo showing the local pack of a google search result.2. If you don’t have a physical location for each location you service, you can’t create a GMB account for that location — and that means missing out on local traffic

This represents a huge lost opportunity — for you and your potential customers.

To capitalize on this opportunity, many businesses create local landing pages (often called city or state pages) to rank for these local searches and connect with customers in those markets.

 

Why Local Landing Pages Matter

Local landing pages can benefit your business in multiple ways, but the biggest benefits are:

  1. Search traffic: Ranking for keywords with local intent so your pages show up directly beneath the local pack
  2. Better engagement: Connect with your local customers by sharing information relevant to their area
  3. More leads: Companies with more landing pages get a higher number of leads than those with fewer landing pages
  4. Competitive advantage: In many industries, creating local landing pages is not a widely used tactic or it’s done poorly, which means you can leapfrog your competition

Dwight agrees that local landing pages are important

Increased Search Traffic

There’s a huge amount of search traffic with local intent on the major search engines, predominantly Google. Capturing that local traffic can prove challenging, especially for businesses that don’t take advantage of all local SEO opportunities available to them.

Google My Business, for example, only allows address listings for the area where a business has a physical location, leaving your brand out in the cold if you don’t have multiple brick-and-mortars but you do service multiple areas.

The inability to create a Google My Business page for other relevant areas only means you won’t appear in the local pack.

While many searchers will click on a result in the map, many folks searching for “mechanic in Seattle” are still going to scroll down to see the traditional search results.

If you can’t be in the local pack, creating content that ranks for these traditional search results is your best shot at capturing local intent traffic. And, if you are in the local pack, you can still benefit from increased exposure.

 

Better Engagement

Local landing pages provide an easy way to communicate location-specific information and target regional trends, landmarks, neighborhoods and characteristics that may be the tipping point for a shopper on the fence or those customers not in your immediate location.

For many customers, knowing that a business has a strong connection to their community can make a world of difference to their decision-making process and who they actually end up working with.

Take our example of someone looking for a mechanic in Seattle. If that person landed on the homepage of a large auto service business with a long list of locations and only found contact info for the their nearest branch, how strong of a local connection has been made?

On the other hand, if they find information such as:

  • How long that branch has been active
  • Info about the staff, such as a message from the manager
  • Examples of community involvement
  • Reviews from local clients
  • Photos of the shop and some of the staff
  • Information unique to the area, such as how you need to have the right tires to drive in Seattle’s rainy weather

These are just a few examples, but this type of content can make visitors feel like a business has a strong connection their city and make them more likely to do business with them. It drives an emotional connection, and that’s powerful when marketing your business.

This type of content also usually contains relevant LSI keywords (latent semantic indexing) — keywords that are related to the primary keywords of your page. For example, if your primary keyword is “dog parks,” LSI keywords that your writers might naturally work into the text could be “canine parks” or “parks for dogs.”

Google tends to reward pages that have covered a topic in depth, and good use of LSI keywords is a great way to do that. So, while you’re delivering a better experience to visitors, you’re also keeping Google happy.

Finally, customers who visit your site often look for information on how you operate in their area. Having these types of pages built into your site’s navigation can help you easily deliver what they’re looking for, which also provides a better user experience.

More Leads

A recent HubSpot study indicated a 55 percent boost in leads for companies that increase their number of landing pages from 10 to 15, and companies with 40 or more landing pages get 12 times the leads of those with five or fewer pages. This happens for several reasons, but a primary cause is that these companies tend to have landing pages that are highly targeted and relevant for their audience.

While this is a great stat, marketers often struggle with how to get to a point where they have more than 40 landing pages. Given each landing page should serve a single purpose and provide unique value to visitors, it can be a challenge to justify getting that many landers up.

Creating local landing pages (or city pages) is a great way to get your site’s landing page count up because the local information you provide can be very valuable to your visitors from that area. Even if the conversion goal is similar, the focus of each page is sufficiently unique. And, each page will be highly targeted to the intended audience which should give it a strong conversion rate.

By creating your local landing pages, you’re very likely to see your site’s overall number of leads generated significantly increase.  

Competitive Advantage

Finally, local landing pages can offer competitive advantages as well, keeping you ahead of your regional competitors.

In many industries, creating local landers is not a widespread tactic, and in many more, companies have created very low-quality, generic pages. In either case, you have a great opportunity to get a leg up on your competitors by creating high quality local landers.

That leg up can manifest in several ways:

  • Bigger share of local search traffic
  • More awareness of your offerings in the area versus competitors’
  • A stronger sentiment that your company is connected to the community

These are all big wins for any company serving multiple markets.

What Makes a Great Local Landing Page?

As effective local SEO tools, local landing pages are most often created to drive local traffic. They also help convert local traffic into leads, because they offer more personalized and relevant content to visitors.

A great local landing page goes beyond the basics, delving into the features and factors that define areas, cities, towns or counties, and highlighting the things that will make consumers purchase from you rather than from the business down the street. As mentioned earlier, this often results in pages that naturally make good use of LSI keywords.

When creating a local landing page, consider including:

  • Unique, relevant content customized to regional information, including sites of interest, colloquial language, city or town nicknames, neighborhood information and any other community-specific selling points
  • Strong use of location-based keywords
  • LSI keywords (cover the topics they suggest)
  • Unique and location-specific metadata
  • Internal links to other relevant areas of your site
  • External links to trusted sources with info your visitors would find useful
  • Business reviews
  • Staff quotes
  • Local images and videos
  • Service area maps
  • A place within the main navigation of your site

These are just a few of many elements you could include on your city pages. Fundamentally, you just want to include content that connects your business to the community you serve and convince local visitors that your solution can help them.

An effective local landing page can take many forms, and how you choose to make a point can vary greatly from one business or purpose to another. Just be sure the location you’re using plays a leading role.

Note: this largely covers what you can do on-page to make your local landing pages great. There are a number of other things you can do off-page such as link building, soliciting reviews, and encouraging social updates about your pages. Check out this great resource from Moz for more info.

The Logistics of Landing Page Creation

If you’re reading this shaking your head and thinking, “My business serves multiple counties full of small towns. How can I possibly make a landing page for every one?” — you’re not alone.

The process of creating a large number of landing pages can be daunting — and some marketers ignore the process entirely in fear of the workload. However, mass-producing city pages isn’t quite as labor-intensive as it sounds.

Here’s a proven process that can help you manage a large local landing page creation project.

1. Develop a Template

Before you get started with content creation, you need a template that defines which parts of your pages will remain constant and which elements will update with every geographic area. For example, the headline, intro and photos may be region-specific, while the core call to action is more general. Be sure to set specific guidelines for each section to make sure all relevant information is captured.

Most companies will create a keyword strategy that supports each page’s SEO. If you’re creating a small number of local landing pages, you might just use a tool like SEMrush, Moz or Ahrefs to find targeted keywords in each area.

If you’re producing a large number of pages, you might consider creating a formula for your keywords. This most often involves finding your top-level keywords and then adding the location you’re targeting.

For example, “auto mechanic” + “Seattle” gives you “auto mechanic Seattle.”

2. Create a Style Guide

Like most brands, your business likely has its own style and corporate identity. This can vary from professional and polished to fun and casual, depending on the persona you want to share with customers. Your local landing pages should utilize this same tone, highlighting who you are and what you do.

To ensure all content meets your expectations, create a style guide providing an overview into language preferences, writing style, tone and voice. If you don’t do your own writing, this can guide your content creation team or freelancers in the right direction.

3. Assemble Resources

Once you know the kind of information you need, start pulling together resources to use when writing. These can range from Wikipedia pages to town or community websites; if it’s legitimate and it provides a well-rounded and authentic impression, it’s a potential source.

Common sources include Yelp! and TripAdvisor reviews, city hall and Chamber of Commerce sites, Zillow and Trulia for real estate information and even financial metrics from Nerd Wallet and the Bureau of Labor and Statistics. You can also pull from your own experiences, using turns of phrase and colloquialisms that you’re familiar with.

If you have access to internal resources such as customer reviews, staff interviews or quotes and local pictures, it’s also great to collect those to use for your pages.

4. Create Content

If writing is in your wheelhouse and you have time to take on a large-scale project, it’s certainly possible to create content yourself. However, if you have dozens of pages and not enough internal resources, a professional hand will help.

Crowd Content’s team of talented writers can tackle content projects for you, utilizing a deep knowledge of language and SEO expertise to create local landing pages that convert.

With writers and editors across Canada, the US, the UK and Australia, it’s possible to put together a team for virtually any location, giving you instant access to experts in your region. Your team of writers can work with any format or style of your choice, ensuring a finished project that pleases.

Crowd Content will take your template and map each unique section to a field that your team of writers will complete. By doing this, you can provide writers with specific instructions for each field as well as minimum or maximum word counts. This ensures consistency and quality of your content which makes creating the actual pages much easier.

If you’d like to get Crowd Content’s help building out your content, please get in touch with us to get started.

5. Export Your Content

As writers finish each city page using your custom template, Crowd Content will export the finished content into a CSV file that will have each city page’s content one row. Each field you’ve mapped will live in a cell within that row.

This makes it possible to collect data for hundreds of landing pages in one concise document that’s ready to upload and publish.

6. Publish Your Pages

If the thought of manually publishing page after page sounds a little unpleasant, you’ll love what RallyMind can do.

Instead of building each page manually, RallyMind uses Google Sheets to collect data from properly-formatted CSV files to automatically populate and publish hundreds of landing pages at once.

Note: you’ll need to import your CSV file into Google Sheets and use the Google Sheet for this process.

Getting this set up is quick and easy:

  1. Create your RallyMind  account
  2. Build a master template design using the site builder. Use the drag and drop tool to create your template, and specify which fields you want to include. This will be the base for all of your local landing pages and should include all fields you wish to populate from the Google Sheet you’ve created.
  3. Make sure that all fields are mapped exactly as how they are set up in your Crowd Content template. This ensures each city page will be properly filled out and formatted.

When you’re ready to go with your landing pages, you can then sync your Google Sheet with your Rally Mind project and template. In minutes this will auto-create a new landing page for each row of data in the Google Sheet based on your template.

If you love the idea of local landing pages but have been hesitant to make the leap, the partnership between RallyMind and Crowd Content is the opportunity you’ve been waiting for.

Give it a try yourself, or drop us a line to help you get this process set up for your company.

 

The post How to Design and Implement A Local Landing Page SEO Program appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/seo/design-implement-local-landing-page-seo-program/feed/ 0
6 Crucial Questions for Finding a Content Partner You Can Trust https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-find-a-trusted-content-partner/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-find-a-trusted-content-partner/#respond Wed, 30 May 2018 14:00:38 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=16719 Marketing is a team effort. No matter how talented your crew is, they may not have the bandwidth or the manpower to adequately deal with high-volume content projects. Finding a trusted content partner is a crucial part of unlocking a brilliantly successful future, but zeroing in on the right contractor is harder than it seems. […]

The post 6 Crucial Questions for Finding a Content Partner You Can Trust appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
Marketing is a team effort. No matter how talented your crew is, they may not have the bandwidth or the manpower to adequately deal with high-volume content projects.

Finding a trusted content partner is a crucial part of unlocking a brilliantly successful future, but zeroing in on the right contractor is harder than it seems. You’re about to put your brand’s image and online communication in someone else’s hands. Do you know if you’re making the right decision?

Some 91 percent of B2B marketers use content in their strategies, and 85 percent of B2C marketers do the same. Of those few marketers not currently incorporating content, 54 percent have plans to launch soon. Content marketing is hot, and where there’s heat there are tons of agencies and platforms eager to get a cut of the profit.

The key to wading your way through the noise and finding a content partner you can trust is knowing what questions to ask and what answers will likely serve you best.

[ctt template=”4″ link=”d7_4j” via=”yes” nofollow=”yes”]Here are the 6 questions you should ask before hiring a #content partner. [/ctt]

1. What is the Production Process?

There’s an old saying that advises “you don’t want to see how the sausage is made,” but this is one time that a behind-the-scenes peek does a body good. You need to know how your content is being produced and who is managing the project while it’s in progress. Is a 20-something recent grad with little to no practical experience in charge of your account? Or is it an expert editor with a flair for content strategy and an eye for detail?

Project managers who are familiar with both the writer and client side of things are better able to convey instructions, interpret feedback, facilitate an efficient and effective onboarding process, anticipate needs and make recommendations when appropriate.

More from Meghan: Holder of the Content Marketing Budget? Here are 3 Awesome Ways to Spend It in 2018

2. Does the Prospective Content Partner Have Any References?

Looking for a content team with big-name experience? Everyone and their dog says they’ve worked with the biggest Fortune 500 companies, and sure, that seems impressive, but in what capacity did they serve? What kind of content did they produce? Is the relationship current? If not, why did the contract end? Did they mess it up?

You ask your in-house hires for references alongside their resume, so why wouldn’t you expect the same credential check and character testimonials from the company about to get custody of your content? Ask for the contact information of a couple current clients (some may subject to an NDA agreement, but not all of them), and you’ll find answers to all your burning questions.

  • Listen to see if the reference offers enthusiastic feedback or canned phrasing.
  • Ask what type of content they purchased and how they felt the deliverables measured up.
  • Are they happy with their account manager?
  • Has work ever been late? If so, why?

3. What’s Their Take on Scale v. Quality?

Content marketing isn’t a one-and-done deal. Even if you have a stellar strategy in place when you launch your business, your marketing efforts will need to evolve as your operations expand — in fact, one often drives the other. Scaling up your content efforts is both exciting and expensive, so finding a way to do it right truly matters.

Ask your potential content partner how they handle volume. If you suddenly surge from 20 articles a month to 200, what systems are in place to oversee the change? How will deliverables be structured? Are there enough writers, editors and admins to handle your new workload in stride?

4. How Will They Manage Your Writing Team?

Some smaller-scale projects only require a single writer, but when you’re ordering up a few thousand product descriptions or contracting weekly blog posts for each of your dozen franchise sites, you’ll more than likely have a team of content experts assigned to your account. There is a bevy of pros to that approach, including more access to fresh ideas and the ability to generate mass content in shorter periods of time, but some important new questions crop up as well:

  • How will you ensure cohesion of your brand message and voice?
  • What measures will be in place to prevent duplicate topics and boilerplating?
  • How will quality be monitored and maintained so that it doesn’t tank a few months into the contract? Are there editor and quality control steps? Or does content go straight from the writer to the client?

Learn More: The Struggles with Content Planning – and How to Overcome Them

5. What Experience Do the Writers Have?

A talented writer can do some research and generate an interesting take on almost any topic, but if your company is in a particularly nuanced niche or an industry with a ton of high-level lingo then you may need a writer or two who specializes in your field. Some companies — an online magazine with multiple columns, for instance — require a bank of writers to cover a variety of topics relevant to their expertise, and diversity becomes much more important.

The last thing you want to do is hop from platform to platform or agency to agency in search of the right writer for the right piece. Ask your potential content partner what their writer roster looks like, how writers are vetted and whether your account manager will play matchmaker when you’re ready to build your team.

6. What is Their Track Record in Terms of Time Management?

When deadlines loom large, you can be sure there’s a writer chugging coffee and furiously typing as the clock ticks down. That may be life as they know it in the crazy world of freelance writers, but your company has a schedule to stick to and blowing a deadline could force you to appear less than reliable to your own clients.

Ask your content agency or platform contact how they manage timelines and determine the pacing of a project. How long does turnaround typically take? For larger projects, will you get everything at once or will there be a series of milestones to keep everyone on track? What happens if something is submitted late, and how often does that happen?

You don’t have time to micromanage writers or proofread press releases, but spending a few hours investigating your list of content partners could prove to be exponentially beneficial. Content marketing costs less than paid search, generates more than triple the number of leads compared to outbound marketing and turns boring blogs into lead-generation factories. All you have to do is connect with a platform that knows how to turn words into wins.

Keep Reading: Content Seasonality – How Far Out Should You Plan Your Calendar?

The post 6 Crucial Questions for Finding a Content Partner You Can Trust appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/how-to-find-a-trusted-content-partner/feed/ 0
Thought Leadership in Content: What It Really Means https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/thought-leadership-what-it-really-means/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/thought-leadership-what-it-really-means/#respond Wed, 23 May 2018 15:00:45 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=16679 What in the world is thought leadership, really? It’s no secret that I’m a big fan of words, but what you might not know is that I play favorites. I don’t really care whether you serve me guacamole or salsa with my chips, but I’ll happily shout from the hilltops about my favorite adjectives and […]

The post Thought Leadership in Content: What It Really Means appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
What in the world is thought leadership, really?

It’s no secret that I’m a big fan of words, but what you might not know is that I play favorites. I don’t really care whether you serve me guacamole or salsa with my chips, but I’ll happily shout from the hilltops about my favorite adjectives and verbs — seriously, give me half a chance and I’ll be hollering. But amidst all that love and affection there is some caution, too, mostly in regards to some of the industry buzzwords that keep coming up time and time again.

One of the biggest “hmmm” bits of terminology flying around right now? Thought leadership.

People love to talk about thought leadership, but few people can accurately explain what the phrase means. Even fewer people embody thought leadership in a way that means anything.

That’s not good — not for the industry, the influencer or marketer in question or for the reader.

See, thought leadership is all about content, authenticity and value, wrapped up in a pretty bow and delivered with a generous yet balanced sprinkle of confidence and humility.

[ctt template=”4″ link=”209Mg” via=”yes” nofollow=”yes”]Thought leadership involves originality, but that originality has to be grounded in reality. It either makes sense or you lose face, and when you lose face, you lose your readers’ trust.[/ctt]

What is Thought Leadership?

Think of your audience as thousands of pilgrims who are lost in the desert. They’re determined to find an oasis, but they’re dying from thirst as they struggle aimlessly through the endless miles of sand. You know where they can find water. Better than that, you’ve got an ingenious way for those pilgrims to pump, clean and store that water so they never go thirsty again.

No one cares if you went to school to study the history of water divination or if you spent 10 years studying under Bob Mapovitch, the guy who charted all the known underground water sources in the Sahara.

What people care about is that you have an answer to their question and that answer is new, exciting, unique and effective.

That’s thought leadership.

thought leadership

Being Unique Versus Being Insane

The difference factor can be difficult to sort out. You want to be a thought leader. and that requires a singular point of view. But it feels like every great idea has already been discussed, dissected and immortalized in print, art or via a 2 a.m. Tweet, so you decide to get a little zany. Maybe you could bomb the desert and see if the exploding sand reveals a long-forgotten well? Perhaps you can tell people to collect their own set of Infinity Stones and use them to reveal a life-giving water source.

Sound nuts? That’s because it is. Thought leadership involves originality, but that originality has to be grounded in reality. It either makes sense or you lose face, and when you lose face, you lose your readers’ trust.

Originality is hard to come by. If it wasn’t, everyone would be a Steve Jobs-level innovator. Instead of trying to reinvent the wheel by making it square, try to rethink originality altogether:

  • Use a new medium to breathe life into an older, staler concept
  • Draw on your own experiences to find an exciting solution to a pesky problem
  • Explain an existing solution from a different angle

More from Meghan: Holder of the Content Marketing Budget? Here are 3 Awesome Ways to Spend it in 2018

Why Does Thought Leadership Matter?

If you’re interested in thought leadership, chances are you’re building or revamping a brand. Thought leadership and successful branding are forever intertwined; it’s nearly impossible to build a business based off of a hackneyed concept or without a forward-thinking solution.

Become a thought leader, and you shove your expertise into the spotlight. Nice, right? But people don’t fall in love with companies because their CEOs are oh-so smart. They love them because the CEO developed a product or concept that’s irresistible and showcased it in a way that’s interesting and attention-grabbing.

The amount of content hitting the internet is mind-boggling. Every 60 seconds, people:

  • Hit “like” on Facebook 4,166,667 times
  • Like Instagram posts 2,430,555 times
  • Upload some 300 hours of video on YouTube
  • Send 347,222 Tweets

Add to that more than 83.6 million posts that hit WordPress each month — and that’s just WordPress!! — and content has reached near-cacophonic levels.

Thought leadership is how you initiate a conversation that can steer the entire consumer journey. It’s how you rise above the noise and get noticed for the right reasons.

[ctt template=”4″ link=”B4GxU” via=”yes” nofollow=”yes”]Thought leadership is how you initiate a conversation that can steer the entire consumer journey. It’s how you rise above the noise and get noticed for the right reasons. [/ctt]

What Thought Leadership is Not

There are some muddy waters here, and it can be difficult to wade through the muck and mire to find what thought leadership really is. To aid in your journey, get a firm understanding of what content leadership is not:

  • Regurgitation. Anyone can act like a parrot, but few people want to listen to one. If your content simply summarizes the ideas put forth by others, you’re not anywhere in the neighborhood of thought leadership.
  • Confirmation. You’re not trying to remind people of what they already know, but rather inspire them to see an existing problem in a new light.
  • Flippant. Jokes are great. I love a giggle-inducing blog post or a wry meme just as much as the next person (probably more), but at the heart of thought leadership is a metric ton of meaning. A dime-store solution to a major problem isn’t even worth the ten cents you’ll spend on it. A thoughtful, purposeful, useful fix, on the other hand, is practically priceless.
  • Boring. If you’re doing thought leadership correctly, it’ll stop people mid-scroll. This is how difference-makers capture a following. They don’t wait for someone to discover their genius; they use that genius to make something no one can ignore, then they deliver it in a way that grabs the reader by the eyeballs.

Keep Reading: The Struggles with Content Planning and How to Overcome Them

Thought Leadership at Work

Perhaps the best way to understand thought leadership is to see it in action.

Let’s take a look at Gary Vaynerchuck, the former wine retailer turned digital marketing pro is a millionaire many times over. Sure, that fortune started with his family’s liquor business, but things really took off for Gary Vee when he started Vayner Media and began offering social media-based advice in his now-signature off-the-cuff, no-holds-barred style. He tells it like it is, and he often peppers his delivery with curse words and blunt truths. He’s solving people’s problems with zero apologies for his methodology. Are his ideas new? Not necessarily, but he’s presenting solutions in a way his audience understands, many of them for the first time — and there is real value there.

I could give you a dozen examples of thought leadership in the real world, but I think you get the picture. Now you need to put it into practice. This is how you’ll clamber over the competition to sit at the top of your industry. Be smart. Be beneficial. Be a thought leader. The world is waiting for you to tell them what they need to do next. What do you have to say for yourself?

The post Thought Leadership in Content: What It Really Means appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/thought-leadership-what-it-really-means/feed/ 0
Content Seasonality: How Far Out Should You Plan Your Calendar? https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-seasonality-how-far-out-should-you-plan-your-calendar/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-seasonality-how-far-out-should-you-plan-your-calendar/#respond Wed, 09 May 2018 14:00:58 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=16699 About 42 percent of B2B marketers think their current content marketing strategy is effective. That doesn’t seem too bad until you remember that leaves 58 percent of marketers flinging words at the wall and hoping they stick. Are you a 58 percenter? Have you often found yourself staring into the editorial abyss or crying onto […]

The post Content Seasonality: How Far Out Should You Plan Your Calendar? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>

About 42 percent of B2B marketers think their current content marketing strategy is effective. That doesn’t seem too bad until you remember that leaves 58 percent of marketers flinging words at the wall and hoping they stick.

Are you a 58 percenter? Have you often found yourself staring into the editorial abyss or crying onto your jumbled desk calendar? Would you give your left earlobe for some insight into content planning strategies that actually work?

Fear not, friends. You’re so not alone.

Look, I’ll be honest. I’m an old hat at content planning but I’m still not perfect. If you’re like me, choosing what you’re having for dinner tomorrow night is an epic feat, so the idea of laying out your content calendar months or even a year ahead of time is enough to make you duck back under the covers and watch Brooklyn Nine-Nine GIFs in peace. Andy Samberg – swoon. To achieve any measure of content planning success, it feels like you need to be part psychic and part thought leader with a whole lot of educated guessing thrown in.

The best approach? Experts agree that top-notch content planning is an ever-changing combination of solid strategy and calculated room for growth. Add a splash of intuitiveness and a shot or two of tequila (your mileage may vary), and you just may have a recipe for audience engagement.

Plan your #content calendars in advance, but ensure you have the flexibility to include relevant, timely news and events.”]

Laying it Out Long Term

Most major publishers plan their content out a few months in advance. That’s an ideal timeline for content you know won’t change. Scheduling your Top 10 Sugar Cookie Recipes and Gift Guide for Wookie Enthusiasts posts to drop right after Thanksgiving or posting your ode to all things Irish in early March is pretty much always going to work. Marketing Land refers to these types of content as“time-based” and “event-based.” Put yourself in the shoes of your ideal customer and imagine what they’d like to see pop up on their smartphones. What would draw them in? What would make other publishers and news outlets take notice and share?

The same goes for evergreen content that’s going to be interesting and useful no matter when it’s read. A buyer’s guide for blenders might be slightly more useful right around Mother’s Day (kidding), but people shop for small kitchen appliances year-round. Put up the initial post when it makes sense, then reshare on social media when the topic becomes particularly relevant again.

Worried about getting out of sync with your readers? Don’t. First of all, you’ll be balancing out this long-play content with more timely stuff (see below), but there’s another factor at work. As an editorial master, content guru, chief strategist and lead planner with all the power, you’re not just following the crowd, you’re telling them where to go. Prep for Vogue’s iconic September issue starts 6-8 months in advance. Are they worried about relevance? On the contrary, they’re deciding what will be relevant and it works because the editorial staff is supremely confident.

More from Meghan: Holder of the Content Marketing Budget? Here Are 3 Awesome Ways to Spend It

Space for Special Features

Here’s the thing: If you plan all your content out ahead of time, your blog is going to get staler than an extra-large bucket of discount movie theater popcorn. To be an authority, you also need to create content that oozes urgency. Of-the-moment references, breaking news, day-of reactions — all of these things teach readers that you have your finger on the throbbing pulse of society (or of your industry, as the case may be), and that lesson will drive traffic in some pretty impressive ways.

Posts that go from ideation to creation to publication in hours or days have a certain magic to them. Readers can smell the importance. They’ll feel the buzz, feed off it and begin to associate your brand with being “in the know.” That can be a key asset when it comes to establishing and/or reinforcing your authority. Want to be an influencer? Then this kind of content is imperative.

Looking at an Overview

I like a three-pronged approach to calendar creation (though, to be completely transparent, I’m constantly tweaking my strategy and finding new ways to be more efficient — or to compensate for procrastination). Brands that post 16 or more blogs per month more than triple their traffic compared to low-posting competitors, but how you allocate those blog posts matters too.

  • Start by plugging in seasonal features: spring cleaning, summer vacation ideas, back-to-school sales, how to winterize your home.
  • Next, add in your monthly features and regular columns. This could be the newsletter you send out the first of every month or the bi-weekly “Ask Arnie” Twitter chat that’s taken the interwebs by storm.
  • Finally, leave a little space for spontaneous acts of marketing. These could be a simple as writing up a reaction to a news item or creating a day-of ad drumming up interest in the act you just booked into your nightclub for this weekend. By building in wiggle room, you’re ensuring that you get a full calendar without being the company that overloads everyone’s news feeds with a motormouth-like deluge.

Here’s the kicker: Content planning is a lot like being a Kanye West fan. Just when you think things are plugging along nicely, something happens, and your entire belief system is suddenly thrown into chaos. You have to be able to roll with the punches, and having a firm foundation — those long-play content ideas we discussed above — is your key to remaining creatively available and strategically open to those last-minute topics that resonate with trend-hungry consumers.

Remember, the majority of marketers create at least one new piece of content every single day. If you don’t fancy living life tethered to your keyboard, you better start thinking ahead.

Keep Reading: Scaling Content Creation: What Can Go Wrong and How To Mitigate the Risks

The post Content Seasonality: How Far Out Should You Plan Your Calendar? appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/content-marketing/content-seasonality-how-far-out-should-you-plan-your-calendar/feed/ 0
Is Multitasking Killing Your Freelance Career? And How to Rescue It https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/is-multitasking-killing-your-freelance-career-and-how-to-rescue-it/ https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/is-multitasking-killing-your-freelance-career-and-how-to-rescue-it/#respond Fri, 04 May 2018 14:30:36 +0000 https://crowdcontent.com/blog/?p=17230 I used to believe I was great at doing multiple things at once and that gave me an edge over the competition, whether it was during my corporate career or my later freelance writing career. It turns out that everything I thought about multitasking was probably a myth, and the same might be true for […]

The post Is Multitasking Killing Your Freelance Career? And How to Rescue It appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
I used to believe I was great at doing multiple things at once and that gave me an edge over the competition, whether it was during my corporate career or my later freelance writing career. It turns out that everything I thought about multitasking was probably a myth, and the same might be true for you.

Scientific studies illustrate that most people aren’t nearly as good at multitasking as they think they are. In fact, much of the process we refer to as multitasking may be impossible. And what we do instead — called task switching — could be messing with our careers and breaking our brains.

What Is Multitasking, Technically?

Multitasking is the ability to do two things at once. Technically, our brains and bodies multitask constantly while performing habitual actions that have become completely natural, such as walking and talking at the same time. So, it’s not completely impossible to multitask.

But when we’re performing more complex, less innate functions, such as attending a conference call while writing an email, we’re probably not multitasking. That would imply we were doing both things equally well.

In reality, most people task-switch, which means they stop doing one thing to do the other. When reading and writing an email during a phone call, you might still hear the phone call, but you aren’t actively listening and processing the information.

Before I moved to full-time freelance writing, I worked as a manager in a corporate environment. At one point, I ran two departments and was involved in several big projects, which meant I was scheduled for meetings almost 90 percent of most days. I’d dial in for a meeting, say I was present, put the phone on mute and immediately check out mentally to do other work until someone said my name and brought me back to the discussion.

Read more from Sarah: It’s a Small World: Why Freelance Writers Should Build, Not Burn, Bridges

I wasn’t fully present in any meeting, and I wasn’t fully concentrating on any of the other tasks before me either. It was a combination that brewed burn out, stress, anxiety and errors.

While freelancers don’t always deal with corporate schedules (that’s one reason I switched to freelance writing in the first place), we do engage in a lot of multitasking that could lead to the same issues. Here are just some of the ways you might be rapidly task switching throughout your day:

  • Jumping between chat windows/social media and work
  • Moving between work and parenting all day
  • Switching the type of task or client you work for every few minutes
  • Toggling between writing, editing or research
  • Watching Netflix while you complete work

We Often Believe in False Benefits of Multitasking

But multitasking is what ensures the jobs all get done, say a lot of freelancers. Plus, the fact that I can Netflix and chill while I also write and make money is one of the perks of the freelance lifestyle, right?

Maybe not. A study conducted by Stanford University demonstrated that those who attempted to multitask often were worse at it. The more they multitasked, the worse they performed at processing and remembering information. They also performed slower overall than the nonmultitaskers, in part because they were so distracted.

One researcher noted that high multitaskers couldn’t keep information separate in their minds, and they constantly thought about the tasks they weren’t doing at the moment.

This makes complete sense to me. I recently started using a tracking method called a time ladder in my bullet journal, because at the end of every day, I couldn’t figure out if I’d used time well. I noticed two things when I started doing this.

  • I have an extremely difficult time sticking to a single task. My task switching habit is so ingrained, I switch on autopilot even when it makes little sense to do so. Like the Stanford researcher noted: I couldn’t help thinking about the tasks I wasn’t doing.
  • When I did stay focused on a single task, I could complete it much faster than expected. Switching between tasks was slowing me down, potentially as much as 50 percent or more.

Real Dangers of Multitasking, for Your Freelance Career and Otherwise

Efficiency isn’t the only thing at risk when you multitask.

Multitasking increases stress.

A study performed by the University of California at Irvine and Humboldt University in Germany found that constant interruptions in tasks lead to higher stress, more effort expended, frustration and even an increased workload. And it only takes 20 minutes of this type of work to start generating these negative consequences.

This explains a lot for me personally. I can put in a long day working on a single project and be exhausted that night, but I’m usually tired in that satisfactory way that comes from doing good work I enjoy. But even a short or medium day of constant multitasking on smaller projects — especially once you throw in email, call and chat interruptions — and I’m equally as tired and not as satisfied with what was accomplished that day. I often end the day feeling much more frustrated, and I know I’m not the only one.

stress-2379631_1280

Do too many things, and you don’t do any well.

The UC Irvine/Humboldt study also noted that when performing the task that interrupted the primary workflow, individuals worked faster — potentially to compensate for the time lost in task switching. That wasn’t a happy efficiency win, though, because the faster work led to as much as 50 percent higher error rates.

As a freelance writer or editor, mistakes can impact your bottom line. An increased error rate isn’t just something noticed in this study, either; as a project manager, I can always tell when writers are project hopping because their error rates — especially on certain types of mistakes — go up substantially.

Constant task-switching could be hurting your brain.

We’re not talking the kind of brain hurt you pop an Excedrin for, either. Studies have also shown that focusing on multiple things temporarily brings down your IQ by as much as 15 points. That might not sound like much, but it could put you in the range of an 8-year-old child, say researchers.

Ever feel like you’re dumber in the afternoon than you were when you woke up? I usually start feeling this phenomenon by lunch or shortly after, and it makes it harder for me to find the right words when writing or speaking, make decisions or concentrate on more difficult tasks.

Some researchers note that your IQ might be temporarily impacted during multitasking. So, if you’re swapping between projects rapidly or trying to finish one article while on a conference call for another project, your full brain power isn’t supporting your work.

Multitasking may lower your EQ.

The damage to your brain may not be temporary, either. Researchers from the University of Sussex looked at brain composition for people who regularly multitasked across technical devices (working while watching television, for example). They found less density in an area of the brain called the anterior cingulate cortex for those individuals.

That area of the brain is responsible for some of the key tasks required for a healthy EQ, or emotional intelligence. That’s what helps you handle interpersonal relationships well.

While many people might turn to freelancing to get away from people, successfully navigating communications, teams and partnerships is critical to establishing a thriving freelance career, so you probably need all the EQ you can get.

Learn more: 3 Style and Grammar Tips to Put You Ahead of the Freelance Pack

What Can You Do Instead of Attempting to Multitask?

You don’t have to strip your client list or stop living the freelance lifestyle to remove some multitasking from each day. Here are some tips for getting plenty of things done without trying to do them at the same time.

Batch Processing and Clustertasking

Batch processing means you do all of the same types of tasks at the same time. By grouping similar tasks together, you reduce the gear changes your brain has to do and create efficiencies because you become faster at dealing with similar tasks the more you do in a row.

Clustertasking is a similar concept that involves processing batches of work in groups throughout the day. You might answer emails for 15 minutes in the morning, early afternoon and evening, for example.

Why don’t freelancers batch process more often? Sometimes we let tedium or boredom drive us to hop between tasks. Other times, years of multitasking just make it difficult to pay attention to one type of thing for even 20-30 minutes.

Financial drivers also exist: you do have to grab and do the work when it’s available, sometimes, but how often is the problem less financial and more focus?

Sequential Mono-Tasking and Pomodoro

Experts say you can train — or retrain — your mind to focus better. First, commit to sequential mono-tasking rather than multitasking. That means you do one thing at a time, working through your list until everything is done. Take a small break, even if it’s just a 20 second breather, between tasks so your mind can reset and ready itself for the next piece of work.

Break larger tasks into smaller bits for this purpose; most people can’t concentrate for more than 45 minutes on the same thing. Plus, sitting at the computer for hours at a time without getting up to move is bad for your overall health.

One proven method for sequential mono-tasking — and something that can help you triage a short attention span — is the Pomodoro method. Using this method, you work with high focus on single tasks for set amounts of time, taking a break after that time is over. Start with small increments of focus time if you need and work up to about 25 minutes for each session.

You can access a free Pomodoro timer online at Tomato-Timer.com.

Create a Dump File for Extraneous Thoughts

One thing that derails me during mono-tasking is stray thoughts. I can’t turn off the spigot 100 percent, and you wouldn’t necessarily want to. Some great ideas and solutions can hit you when you’re working on something else.

To keep me from chasing stray thoughts down the rabbit hole, I keep a notebook or dump file open so I can quickly write or type a note about the thought before continuing with work. I also keep a file on my smartphone so I can do the same thing when I’m out of the house.

Create Boundaries

Finally, try to develop some boundaries between various parts of your life and work. I’m lucky enough to have an office with a door, so I’m not constantly aware of everything that goes on in the house when I’m working. I’m also trying to create pre-appointed times when I work, handle family stuff and engage in self-care activity like exercise.

Since I’m a wife, mother, full-time freelancer and part-time children’s and youth minister, boundaries do often slip into each other. I’m working on it.

And if you’re a freelancer who struggles with multitasking, I hope you will to. After all, whether this is your side hustle or a career, the last thing you want is for freelance opportunities to damage your brain and potential future success.

Keep reading: Marketing Copy Writing Tips From the Pros: How to Craft Creative Copy that Converts

The post Is Multitasking Killing Your Freelance Career? And How to Rescue It appeared first on Crowd Content - Blog.

]]>
https://www.crowdcontent.com/blog/writers-hub/is-multitasking-killing-your-freelance-career-and-how-to-rescue-it/feed/ 0